--- page 1 ---
GLOBAL
OFFERING
(Incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability)
Stock Code: 2268
WuXi XDC Cayman Inc.
藥明合聯生物技術有限公司
*
* For identification purpose only
WuXi XDC Cayman Inc.
藥明合聯生物技術有限公司
*
Joint Sponsors, Overall Coordinators, Joint Global Coordinators, Joint Bookrunners and Joint Lead Managers
Joint Global Coordinators, Joint Bookrunners and Joint Lead Managers
(in alphabetical order)


--- page 2 ---
IMPORTANT: If you are in any doubt about any of the contents of this prospectus, you should obtain independent professional advice.
WuXi XDC Cayman Inc.
ʮ̡ *
(Incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability)
Global Offering
Total number of Offer Shares under the
Global Offering
: 178,446,000 Shares (subject to the Over-
allotment Option)
Number of Hong Kong Offer Shares : 17,845,000 Shares (subject to reallocation)
Number of International Offer Shares : 160,601,000 Shares (including 8,922,000
Reserved Shares under the Preferential
Offering) (subject to reallocation and the
Over-allotment Option)
Maximum Offer Price : HK$20.60 per Share, plus brokerage of 1%,
SFC transaction levy of 0.0027%, the Stock
Exchange trading fee of 0.00565% and
AFRC Transaction Levy of 0.00015%
(payable in full on application in Hong
Kong dollars and subject to refund)
Nominal value : US$0.00005 per Share
Stock code : 2268
Joint Sponsors, Overall Coordinators, Joint Global Coordinators,
Joint Bookrunners and Joint Lead Managers
Morgan Stanley Goldman Sachs J.P. Morgan
Joint Global Coordinators, Joint Bookrunners and Joint Lead Managers
(in alphabetical order)
CICC Citigroup HTSC
Hong Kong Exchanges and Clearing Limited, The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited and Hong Kong Securities Clearing Company Limited take no responsib ility for the contents
of this prospectus, make no representation as to its accuracy or completeness and expressly disclaim any liability whatsoever for any loss howsoever arising from or in reliance upon
the whole or any part of the contents of this prospectus.
A copy of this prospectus, having attached thereto the documents specified in “Documents Delivered to the Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong and On Di splay” in Appendix V
to this prospectus, has been registered by the Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong as required by Section 342C of the Companies (Winding Up and Miscella neous Provisions)
Ordinance (Chapter 32 of the Laws of Hong Kong). The Securities and Futures Commission of Hong Kong and the Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong take no re sponsibility for
the contents of this prospectus or any of the other documents referred to above.
The Offer Price is expected to be fixed by agreement between the Overall Coordinators (for themselves and on behalf of the Underwriters), and our Compa ny on or around Friday,
November 10, 2023 or such later time as may be agreed between the parties, but in any event, no later than Wednesday, November 15, 2023. Applicants for Ho ng Kong Offer Shares
are required to pay, on application, the maximum Offer Price of HK$20.60 for each Hong Kong Offer Share together with brokerage of 1.0%, SFC transactio n levy of 0.0027%, Stock
Exchange trading fee of 0.00565% and AFRC Transaction Levy of 0.00015%, subject to refund if the Offer Price is lower than HK$20.60. If, for any reason, the Overall Coordinators
(for themselves and on behalf of the Underwriters), and our Company are unable to reach an agreement on the Offer Price by Wednesday, November 15, 2023, the Global Offering
will not become unconditional and will lapse immediately. The Offer Price will be not more than HK$20.60 per Share and is expected to be not less than HK$ 19.90 per Share although
the Overall Coordinators (for themselves and on behalf of the Underwriters), and our Company may agree to a lower price.
The Overall Coordinators (for themselves and on behalf of the Underwriters), may, with the consent of our Company, reduce the number of Hong Kong Offer Shares and/or the
indicative Offer Price range below that stated in this prospectus at any time on or prior to the morning of the last date for lodging applications under t he Hong Kong Public Offering.
In such a case, notices of the reduction in the number of Hong Kong Offer Shares and/or the indicative Offer Price range will be published on the websites of the Stock Exchange
at www.hkexnews.hk and our Company at www.wuxixdc.com as soon as practicable but in any event not later than the morning of the day which is the latest day for lodging
applications under the Hong Kong Public Offering. For further information, see the sections headed “Structure of the Global Offering” and “How to App ly for Hong Kong Offer Shares
and Reserved Shares” in this prospectus.
Prior to making an investment decision, prospective investors should carefully consider all of the information set out in this prospectus, and in par ticular, the risk factors
set out in the section headed “Risk Factors.”
The obligations of the Hong Kong Underwriters under the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement to subscribe for, and to procure applicants for the subscrip tion for, the Hong
Kong Offer Shares, are subject to termination by the Overall Coordinators for themselves and on behalf of the Hong Kong Underwriters, if certain groun ds arise prior to
8:00 a.m. on the Listing Date. Further details of such grounds are set out in the section headed “Underwriting — Underwriting Arrangements and Expense s — Hong Kong
Public Offering — Grounds for Termination.” It is important that you refer to that section for further details.
The Offer Shares have not been and will not be registered under the U.S. Securities Act or any state securities laws in the United States, and may not be of fered, sold, pledged or
transferred within the United States or to, or for the account or benefit of U.S. persons (as defined in Regulation S), except in transactions exempt fr om, or not subject to, the registration
requirements of the U.S. Securities Act. The Offer Shares are being offered and sold (1) solely to qualified institutional buyers in reliance on Rule 1 44A or another exemption from
registration under the U.S. Securities Act and (2) outside of the United States in offshore transactions in reliance on Regulation S.
ATTENTION
We have adopted a fully electronic application process for the Hong Kong Public Offering. We will not provide printed copies of this prospectus or prin ted copies of
any application forms to the public in relation to the Hong Kong Public Offering. This prospectus is available at the website of the Hong Kong Stock Exch ange at
www.hkexnews.hk and our website at www.wuxixdc.com. If you require a printed copy of this prospectus, you may download and print from the website addr esses above.
* For identification purpose only
IMPORTANT
November 7, 2023


--- page 3 ---
IMPORTANT NOTICE TO INVESTORS:
FULLY ELECTRONIC APPLICATION PROCESS
We have adopted a fully electronic application process for the Hong Kong Public
Offering. We will not provide printed copies of this prospectus or printed copies of any
application forms to the public in relation to the Hong Kong Public Offering.
This prospectus is available at the website of the Stock Exchange at www.hkexnews.hk
under the “HKEXnews > New Listings > New Listing Information” section, and our website
at www.wuxixdc.com. If you require a printed copy of this prospectus, you may download and
print from the website addresses above.
To apply for the Hong Kong Offer Shares, you may:
(a) apply online through the White Form eIPO service at www.eipo.com.hk ;o r
(b) apply through the CCASS EIPO service to electronically cause HKSCC Nominees to
apply on your behalf, including by:
(i) instructing your broker or custodian who is a CCASS Clearing Participant or a
CCASS Custodian Participant to give electronic application instructions via
CCASS terminals to apply for the Hong Kong Offer Shares on your behalf; or
(ii) if you are an existing CCASS Investor Participant , giving electronic application
instructions through the CCASS Internet System ( https://ip.ccass.com )o r
through the CCASS Phone System by calling +852 2979 7888 (using the
procedures in HKSCC’s “An Operating Guide for Investor Participants” in effect
from time to time). HKSCC can also input electronic application instructions for
CCASS Investor Participants through HKSCC’s Customer Service Center at 1/F.,
One & Two Exchange Square, 8 Connaught Place, Central, Hong Kong by
completing an input request.
We will not provide any physical channels to accept any application for the Hong Kong Offer
Shares by the public. The contents of the electronic version of this prospectus are identical to the
printed prospectus as registered with the Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong pursuant to Section
342C of the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance.
If you are an intermediary , broker or agent , please remind your customers, clients or
principals, as applicable, that this prospectus is available online at the website addresses above.
Please refer to the section headed “How to apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved
Shares” in this prospectus for further details of the procedures through which you can apply for the
Hong Kong Offer Shares electronically.
IMPORTANT


--- page 4 ---
Y our application through the White Form eIPO service or the CCASS EIPO service must be for
a minimum of 500 Hong Kong Offer Shares and in one of the numbers set out in the table. Y ou are required
to pay the amount next to the number you select.
No. of
Hong Kong
Offer Shares
applied for
Amount
payable on
application
No. of
Hong Kong
Offer Shares
applied for
Amount
payable on
application
No. of
Hong Kong
Offer Shares
applied for
Amount
payable on
application
No. of
Hong Kong
Offer Shares
applied for
Amount
payable on
application
HK$ HK$ HK$ HK$
500 10,403.88 7,000 145,654.26 50,000 1,040,387.56 250,000 5,201,937.76
1,000 20,807.75 8,000 166,462.01 60,000 1,248,465.05 500,000 10,403,875.50
1,500 31,211.63 9,000 187,269.77 70,000 1,456,542.56 750,000 15,605,813.26
2,000 41,615.50 10,000 208,077.51 80,000 1,664,620.08 1,000,000 20,807,751.00
2,500 52,019.38 15,000 312,116.26 90,000 1,872,697.59 2,000,000 41,615,502.00
3,000 62,423.25 20,000 416,155.02 100,000 2,080,775.10 3,000,000 62,423,253.00
3,500 72,827.13 25,000 520,193.78 125,000 2,600,968.88 4,000,000 83,231,004.00
4,000 83,231.00 30,000 624,232.54 150,000 3,121,162.66 5,000,000 104,038,755.00
4,500 93,634.88 35,000 728,271.29 175,000 3,641,356.43 6,000,000 124,846,506.00
5,000 104,038.75 40,000 832,310.05 200,000 4,161,550.20 7,000,000 145,654,257.00
6,000 124,846.51 45,000 936,348.80 225,000 4,681,743.98 8,922,500
(Note) 185,657,158.30
Note: Maximum number of Hong Kong Offer Share you may apply for.
IMPORTANT


--- page 5 ---
If there is any change in the following expected timetable, our Company will issue an
announcement to be published on the websites of the Stock Exchange at www.hkexnews.hk and our
Company at www.wuxixdc.com .
Date (1)
Dispatch of BLUE Application Forms to Qualifying WXB
Shareholders on or before ................................................. T uesday,
November 7, 2023
Hong Kong Public Offering and Preferential Offering
commence ................................................. .9:00 a.m. on Tuesday,
November 7, 2023
Latest time to complete electronic applications under White
Form eIPO service through the designated website
www.eipo.com.hk (2) ............................................ 1 1:30 a.m. on Friday,
November 10, 2023
Application lists of the Hong Kong Public Offering and the
Preferential Offering open (3) ...................................... 1 1:45 a.m. on Friday,
November 10, 2023
Latest time for (a) completing payment of White Form
eIPO applications by effecting internet banking transfer(s)
or PPS payment transfer(s) (4); (b) giving electronic
application instructions to HKSCC (4) and (c) lodging
BLUE Application Forms ...................................... .12:00 noon on Friday,
November 10, 2023
If you are instructing your broker or custodian who is a CCASS Clearing Participant or a CCASS
Custodian Participant to give electronic application instructions via CCASS terminals to apply for the
Hong Kong Offer Shares on your behalf, you are advised to contact your broker or custodian for the latest
time for giving such instructions which may be different from the latest time as stated above.
Application lists of the Hong Kong Public Offering and the
Preferential Offering close (2) .................................... .12:00 noon on Friday,
November 10, 2023
Expected Price Determination Date (5) ........................................... Friday,
November 10, 2023
Announcement of the Hong Kong Offer Price and the
International Offer Price on the websites of the Stock
Exchange at www.hkexnews.hk and our Company at www.wuxixdc.com
(6)
on or before ......................................................... .Thursday,
November 16, 2023
EXPECTED TIMETABLE
—i—


--- page 6 ---
Announcement of the level of indications of interest in the
International Offering, the level of applications in the
Hong Kong Public Offering and the Preferential Offering
and the basis of allocation of the Hong Kong Offer Shares
under Hong Kong Public Offering and the Reserved
Shares under the Preferential Offering on our website at
www.wuxixdc.com and the website of the Hong Kong Stock Exchange at
www.hkexnews.hk
(6) on or before ........................................ .Thursday,
November 16, 2023
Results of allocation in the Hong Kong Public Offering and
the Preferential Offering (with successful applicants’
identification document numbers, where applicable) will
be available through a variety of channels as described in
the section headed “How to apply for Hong Kong Offer
Shares and Reserved Shares — F. Publication of Results” from
(8) ................. .Thursday,
November 16, 2023
Dispatch/Collection or deposit of Share certificates into
CCASS in respect of wholly or partially successful
applications pursuant to the Hong Kong Public Offering
and the Preferential Offering on or before
(7) ................................ .Thursday,
November 16, 2023
Dispatch/Collection of White Form e-Refund payment instructions or
refund cheques in respect of wholly or partially successful
applications if the final Offer Price is less than the price
payable on application (if applicable) or wholly or
partially unsuccessful applications pursuant to
the Hong Kong Public Offering and the Preferential
Offering on or before
(8) ............................................... .Thursday,
November 16, 2023
Dealings in the Shares on the Stock Exchange expected to
commence at ............................................... .9:00 a.m. on Friday,
November 17, 2023
(1) All times refer to Hong Kong local time and dates, except as otherwise stated. Details of the structure of the Global Offering,
including its conditions, are set out in the section headed “Structure of the Global Offering” in this prospectus.
(2) Y ou will not be permitted to submit your application through the designated website at www.eipo.com.hk after 11:30 a.m.
on the last day for submitting applications. If you have already submitted your application and obtained an application
reference number from the designated website prior to 11:30 a.m., you will be permitted to continue the application process
(by completing payment of application monies) until 12:00 noon on the last day for submitting applications, when the
application lists close.
EXPECTED TIMETABLE
—i i—


--- page 7 ---
(3) If there is a tropical cyclone warning signal number 8 or above; a black rainstorm warning; and/or an “extreme conditions”
announcement issued after a super typhoon, in force in Hong Kong at any time between 9:00 a.m. and 12:00 noon on Friday,
November 10, 2023, the application lists will not open and close on that day. Further information is set out in the paragraph
headed “E. Effect of Bad Weather and Extreme Conditions on the Opening and Closing of the Application Lists” under the
section headed “How to apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares” in this prospectus.
(4) Applicants who apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares via White Form eIPO Service and CCASS EIPO service should refer
to the section headed “How to Apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares — A. Applications for the Hong Kong
Offer Shares” in this prospectus.
(5) The Price Determination Date is expected to be on or around Friday, November 10, 2023 and, in any event, not later than
Wednesday, November 15, 2023. If, for any reason, we do not agree with the Overall Coordinators for themselves and on
behalf of the Underwriters on the pricing of the Offer Shares by Wednesday, November 15, 2023, the Global Offering will
not proceed and will lapse.
(6) None of the websites or any of the information contained on the website forms part of this prospectus.
(7) Share certificates for the Hong Kong Offer Shares are expected to be issued on Thursday, November 16, 2023 but will only
become valid evidence of title provided that the Global Offering has become unconditional, and the right of termination as
described in the paragraph headed “Grounds for Termination” under the section headed “Underwriting” in this prospectus has
not been exercised and has lapsed. Investors who trade Shares on the basis of publicly available allocation details or prior
to the receipt of Share certificates or the Share certificates becoming valid do so entirely at their own risk.
(8) e-Refund payment instruction or refund cheques will be issued in respect of wholly or partially unsuccessful applications
pursuant to the Hong Kong Public Offering and the Preferential Offering and also in respect of wholly or partially successful
applications if the Offer Price is less than the price payable per Offer Share on application. Applicants should refer to the
section headed “How to Apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares — I. Dispatch/Collection of Share
Certificates/e-Refund Payment Instructions/Refund Cheques”.
The above expected timetable is a summary only. Y ou should refer to the sections headed “Structure
of the Global Offering” and “How to Apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares” in this
prospectus for further details and conditions of the Global Offering and the application procedures for the
Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares.
The BLUE Application Forms have been despatched to all Qualifying WXB Shareholders.
Qualifying WXB Shareholders may obtain a copy of this prospectus in the manner they have elected,
or are deemed to have elected, to receive corporate communications under WuXi Biologics’ corporate
communication policy. See “How to Apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares” in this
prospectus for further details. Distribution of this prospectus and/or the BLUE Application Forms into any
jurisdiction other than Hong Kong may be restricted by law. Persons in possession of this prospectus
and/or the BLUE Application Forms (including, without limitation, agents, custodians, nominees and
trustees) should inform themselves of, and observe, any such restrictions. Any failure to comply with such
restrictions may constitute a violation of the securities laws of any such jurisdiction. In particular, this
prospectus should not be distributed, forwarded or transmitted in, into or from any of the Specified
Territories with or without the BLUE Application Forms, except to Qualifying WXB Shareholders as
specified in this prospectus.
You should read carefully the sections headed “Underwriting,” “Structure of the Global Offering”
and “How to Apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares” for details relating to the structure
of the Global Offering, procedures on the applications for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares
and the expected timetable, including conditions, effect of severe weather and the dispatch Share
certificates and refund of application monies.
EXPECTED TIMETABLE
— iii —


--- page 8 ---
This prospectus is issued by our Company solely in connection with the Hong Kong Public
Offering and the Hong Kong Offer Shares and does not constitute an offer to sell or a solicitation
of an offer to buy any security other than the Hong Kong Offer Shares. This prospectus may not be
used for the purpose of, and does not constitute, an offer or invitation in any other jurisdiction or
in any other circumstances. No action has been taken to permit a public offering of the Offer Shares
or the distribution of this prospectus in any jurisdiction other than Hong Kong. The distribution of
this prospectus and the offering and sale of the Offer Shares in other jurisdictions are subject to
restrictions and may not be made except as permitted under the applicable securities laws of such
jurisdictions pursuant to registration with or authorization by the relevant securities regulatory
authorities or an exemption therefrom.
You should rely only on the information contained in this prospectus and the Application Form
to make your investment decision. Our Company has not authorized anyone to provide you with
information that is different from what is contained in this prospectus. Any information or
representation not made in this prospectus must not be relied on by you as having been authorized
by our Company, the Joint Sponsors, the Overall Coordinators, the Capital Market Intermediaries,
the Joint Global Coordinators, the Joint Bookrunners, the Joint Lead Managers, any of the
Underwriters, any of our or their respective directors, officers, representatives, or affiliates, or any
other person or party involved in the Global Offering. Information contained in our website, located
at www.wuxixdc.com does not form part of this prospectus.
Page
Expected Timetable ...................................................... i
Contents .............................................................. i v
Summary .............................................................. 1
Definitions ............................................................. 2 6
Glossary ............................................................... 3 8
Forward-Looking Statements ............................................... 4 3
Risk Factors ........................................................... 4 5
Waivers and Exemption from Strict Compliance with the Listing Rules and
the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance ............. 8 8
Information about this Prospectus and the Global Offering ........................ 9 7
Directors and Parties Involved in the Global Offering ............................ 1 0 1
Corporate Information .................................................... 1 0 8
CONTENTS
—i v—


--- page 9 ---
Regulatory Overview ..................................................... 1 1 1
Industry Overview ....................................................... 1 3 2
History, Reorganization and Corporate Structure ............................... 1 5 3
Business ............................................................... 1 6 7
Relationship with Our Controlling Shareholders ................................ 2 3 6
Connected Transactions ................................................... 2 5 4
Directors and Senior Management ........................................... 2 7 2
Substantial Shareholders .................................................. 2 8 7
Cornerstone Investors ..................................................... 2 8 8
Share Capital ........................................................... 2 9 6
Financial Information .................................................... 2 9 9
Future Plans and Use of Proceeds ........................................... 3 5 5
Underwriting ........................................................... 3 6 0
Structure of the Global Offering ............................................ 3 7 1
How to Apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares ................... 3 8 6
Appendix I — Accountants’ Report ..................................... I - 1
Appendix II — Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information .................. II-1
Appendix III — Summary of the Constitution of the Company and Cayman Islands
Company Law ........................................ III-1
Appendix IV — Statutory and General Information ......................... I V - 1
Appendix V — Documents Delivered to the Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong
and On Display ....................................... V - 1
CONTENTS
—v—


--- page 10 ---
This summary aims to give you an overview of the information contained in this prospectus and
should be read in conjunction with the full text of this prospectus. As it is a summary, it does not
contain all the information that may be important to you. You should read the whole prospectus,
including our financial statements and the accompanying notes, before you decide to invest in the
Offer Shares. There are risks associated with any investment. Some of the particular risks in
investing in the Offer Shares are set out in “Risk Factors” in this prospectus. You should read that
section carefully before you decide to invest in the Offer Shares.
OVERVIEW
We are a leading contract research, development and manufacturing organization (“ CRDMO ”)
focused on the global antibody-drug conjugate (“ ADC”) and broader bioconjugate market and dedicated
to providing integrated and comprehensive services. Leveraging expertise in both biologics and small
molecules, we offer interdisciplinary and comprehensive services, covering bioconjugate discovery,
research, development and manufacturing. We provide these services from proximately located and
dedicated laboratories and manufacturing facilities, leading to potentially significant reduction of
development timeline and costs. We are the second largest CRDMO for ADCs and other bioconjugates
globally in terms of revenue in 2022, according to Frost & Sullivan. Our global market share by revenue
increased from 1.8% in 2020 to 4.6% in 2021 and 9.8% in 2022.
Our Services
Our fully integrated, one-stop bioconjugate platform offers comprehensive CRDMO services,
including discovery, process development and Good Manufacturing Practice (“ GMP”) manufacturing for
bioconjugates, monoclonal antibody intermediates and payload-linkers associated with bioconjugates. Our
discovery services involve discovery chemistry, conjugation discovery, in vitro and in vivo
characterization and developability for preclinical candidate selection. We also enable preclinical and
clinical studies through bioconjugate drug substance process development, bioconjugate formulation
development, analytical method development and late-stage development and process validation. In
addition, we have capability of GMP-compliant manufacturing of drug substance and drug product through
our dedicated and specialized facilities. We also expect to launch the commercial GMP manufacturing of
ADC and broader bioconjugate products in the near future. The following diagram depicts our
bioconjugate CRDMO services. See “Business — Our Services” for more details about our services.
Drug Discovery
Bioconjugate DS/DP Manufacturing — DS Up to 2,000L Conjugation, Vial DP (Liquid & Lyophilized), Packaging & Labeling
Pre-Clinical Development Early-Phase (Phase I & II) Late-Phases (Phase III) Commercial Production (Expected to Launch in 2024)
Non-GMP Manufacturing of Drug
Substance (DS) and Drug Product (DP)
Discovery Chemistry
Payload-Linker Synthesis
Conjugation Discovery
Developability Study
In Vitro/In Vivo Characterization
IND Enabling Process Development
Analytical Method Development
Late-Stage Process Optimization, Process Characterization and PPQ
GMP Manufacturing and ADC DS/DP Testing Release
mAb Intermediate Manufacturing — Up to 2,000L
Payload Linker Manufacturing
CMC Regulatory Support
SUMMARY
—1—


--- page 11 ---
Abbreviations: PPQ = process performance qualification; DS = drug substance; DP = drug product; mAb = monoclonal antibody.
Note: ADC/Bioconjugate CMC scope (process development, analytical method development, manufacturing) includes mAb
intermediate for bioconjugates, payload-linker and bioconjugate DS and DP .
Our Capabilities
We are committed to continuously enhancing our platform, propelling and transforming the
development of the bioconjugate industry, enabling global biopharmaceutical partners and benefiting
patients worldwide. Our fully integrated, one-stop bioconjugate platform boasts a rich portfolio of
conjugation technologies, extensive expertise in payload-linker synthesis and process development,
industry-leading process development know-how, comprehensive analytical methods, as well as dedicated
and specialized facilities. In particular, we seamlessly integrate the multidisciplinary expertise in both
biologics and small molecules critical to comprehensive discovery, development and manufacturing of
ADCs and other bioconjugates.
We have accumulated vast hands-on experience in bioconjugates, generating over 7,000 bioconjugate
molecules for our customers incorporating over 500 protein carriers and over 600 payload-linkers. We
have completed chemistry, manufacturing and control (“ CMC”) development and initiated GMP
manufacturing using over 10 conjugation technologies for both ADC and other bioconjugates, making our
portfolio of conjugation technologies one of the richest among bioconjugate outsourcing service providers,
according to Frost & Sullivan. Our conjugation expertise goes beyond ADC and encompasses radionuclide
drug conjugates (“ RDC”), peptide-drug conjugate (“ PDC”), antibody-chelator conjugate (“ ACC”),
PEGylated protein or peptide (i.e., protein or peptide conjugated with polyethylene glycol (“ PEG”)),
antibody PROTAC conjugate (i.e., antibody conjugated with proteolysis targeting chimera (“ PROTAC ”),
which is a type of targeted protein degradation agent), antibody-oligonucleotide conjugate (“ AOC”) and
fatty-acid conjugate, among others. We have also built extensive expertise in payload-linkers, which are
critical components of bioconjugates. We not only have developed a rich library of off-the-shelf
payload-linkers, but also enable our customers to develop and manufacture a wide variety of tailor-made
or proprietary payload-linkers by offering synthesis, process development and GMP manufacturing
services. Through expanding collaborations with our partners, we also provide customers with access to
a large variety of proprietary payload-linkers and conjugation technologies.
Moreover, we have developed industry-leading process development know-how for various types of
bioconjugates. Our process development expertise ensures optimization of critical quality attributes,
including drug load ratio (DAR), free drug removal, process efficiency and consistency. As a
demonstration of our capabilities, we have initiated GMP manufacturing of bioconjugates involving
several conjugation technologies, including our patented WuXiDAR4 technologies, non-natural amino
acid (“ NNAA ”) site-specific conjugation, tyrosine tubulin ligase-assisted conjugation, sortase-assisted
conjugation, farnesyltransferase-assisted conjugation, and traceless affinity peptide labeling conjugation.
WuXiDAR4 technologies enable customers to achieve tight control of product homogeneity and lot-to-lot
consistency, which in turn improve the pharmacokinetics profile and stability of bioconjugate products and
potentially result in better clinical outcomes.
Our integrated capabilities are also reflected in the one-stop GMP manufacturing of bioconjugates.
We strategically offer our services from proximately located operation sites in Wuxi, Shanghai and
Changzhou in China, where we have established dedicated and specialized facilities for bioconjugates. As
such, we can better manage the supply chain and coordinate development and manufacturing operations,
leading to potentially expedited development timelines and improved quality and cost efficiencies for
SUMMARY
—2—


--- page 12 ---
customers. For example, in general, we are able to process from the antibody DNA sequence to
bioconjugate IND filing in approximately 13 to 15 months. Our fully integrated capabilities lay a solid
foundation for our comprehensive service offerings that enable our customers to bring innovative
bioconjugate therapeutic solutions to patients worldwide with high quality and speed. At the forefront of
the global bioconjugate development, we believe our platform will also enable us to address the industry
challenges and lead the global development trends of ADCs and other bioconjugates. As an industry
recognition of our capabilities, we won the runner-up prize in the “Best Contract Manufacturing (CMO)
Provider” category of the 2022 World ADC Awards and the “Best Contract Development Manufacturing
Organization (CDMO)” prize at the 2023 World ADC Awards.
Our Achievements
We ranked No. 2 globally and No. 1 in China among CRDMO for ADCs and other bioconjugates in
terms of revenue in 2022, according to Frost & Sullivan. Our global market share by revenue increased
from 1.8% in 2020 to 4.6% in 2021 and 9.8% in 2022. By the end of 2022, we had 94 ongoing integrated
projects, representing over 35% of the total number of outsourced integrated projects for bioconjugates
globally in the same year, according to Frost & Sullivan. With our extensive technical capabilities and
impeccable track record, we have become a trusted partner leading the bioconjugate development globally
with a broad, loyal and fast-growing customer base. We employ an “enable, follow and win the molecule”
strategy to not only grow with our existing customers by providing services from an early stage of their
product development cycle, but also win new customers as their bioconjugates progress. As of the end of
2020, 2021, 2022 and June 30, 2023, as the result of our “enable” strategy, we had cumulatively progressed
9, 12, 24 and 30 ADC candidates, respectively, from discovery to CMC development. As the result of our
“win the molecule” strategy, among the 110 ongoing integrated projects we had as of June 30, 2023, 36
were transferred to us from our customers or their outsourcing service providers. Our diverse and growing
customer base includes both innovative biotechnology companies and global pharmaceutical companies,
many of which are leading players in the ADC and bioconjugate space with potentially first-in-class or
best-in-class pipeline programs. The number of our customers grew significantly from 49 in 2020 to 115
in 2021, 167 in 2022 and 169 in the six months ended June 30, 2023. As of June 30, 2023, we had served
304 customers cumulatively, including most of the major players in the global ADC and bioconjugate
market. As of the same date, we had won ADC development contracts for all ADC candidates in China
with dual filing of IND and/or BLA in China and the United States, and eight out of the 10 China-based
companies that out-licensed their ADC pipelines overseas since 2022 are our customers.
We have a large number of integrated projects for ADCs and other bioconjugates. As of June 30,
2023, we had 110 ongoing integrated projects and helped customers to submit IND applications for 47
ADC candidates globally, and in 2022 alone, we helped customers submit IND applications for 18 ADC
candidates globally. We have executed 350 discovery projects since our inception and as of June 30, 2023.
The following funnel diagram sets forth the developmental stages and other details of ongoing integrated
projects as of June 30, 2023. The duration and contract value of discovery projects can vary significantly
due to their nature.
SUMMARY
—3—


--- page 13 ---
1 – 2 years
3 – 5 years
US$8 – 11 million
US$40 – 70 million
Number of ongoing projects Typical range of
duration
Typical range of
contract value
1 – 3 years US$6 – 9 million
350 Discovery1
67 Preclinical
27 Phase I
11 Phase II
5 Phase III
“R”
“D”
“M”
Commercial
(BLA expected
in 2023)2
2 – 4 years US$8 – 15 million
Type of projects
ADC and
broader XDC
ADC and
broader XDC
ADC and
broader XDC
ADC
1. It is the cumulative number of discovery projects since our inception and as of June 30, 2023.
2. We have completed process validation, which is a critical step before the BLA submission, for two integrated projects.
The following table sets forth the details of ongoing projects by each development stage during the
Track Record Period. As of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023, nil, 3, 20 and 7 ongoing
post-IND projects were advanced in the year/period from the pre-IND stage leveraging our CRDMO
services.
As of December 31, 2020 As of December 31, 2021 As of December 31, 2022 As of June 30, 2023
Development
Stage
Typical
Duration
Number of
Ongoing
Projects (3)
Type of
Projects
Number
of New
Projects (5)
Number of
Ongoing
Projects (3)
Type of
Projects
Number
of New
Projects (5)
Number of
Ongoing
Projects (3)
Type of
Projects
Number
of New
Projects (5)
Number of
Ongoing
Projects (3)
Type of
Projects
Number
of New
Projects (5)
Discovery . . N/A (1) 100(4) ADC(78) and
XDC(22)
52 176 (4) ADC(148) and
XDC(28)
76 299 (4) ADC(244) and
XDC(55)
123 350 (4) ADC(283) and
XDC(67)
51
Preclinical . . 1-2 years 28 ADC(24) and
XDC(4)
12 45 ADC(38) and
XDC(7)
20 57 ADC(51) and
XDC(6)
33 67 ADC(59) and
XDC(8)
17
Clinical . . . Multiple
years (2)
12 ADC(11) and
XDC(1)
– 15 ADC(13) and
XDC(2)
– 37 ADC(33) and
XDC(4)
2 43 ADC(39) and
XDC(4)
–
1. The duration of discovery projects can vary significantly in light of their ad hoc nature and depends on the types of projects
at issue. Therefore, there is not a typical range for discovery projects.
2. The typical duration of projects in Phase I, II and III stages are 1-3 years, 2-4 years and 3-5 years, respectively.
3. “Number of ongoing projects” is the number of integrated projects excluding the number of integrated projects that are
inactive or for which the customers notify us that they do not intend to further pursue. We deem an integrated project inactive
if we have not been requested to provide services for three years.
4. It is the cumulative number of discovery projects since our inception and as of the indicated date. Because the duration and
chance of success of discovery projects can vary significantly due to their early-stage nature, we present the cumulative
number, instead of the ongoing project number, of discovery projects to demonstrate our experience in bioconjugate discovery.
5. For preclinical-stage integrated projects, “number of new projects” is the number of preclinical projects that we were able to
“enable” (advance from the discovery-stage) or “win” (bring into our project pipeline) during the year/period ended on the
indicated date. For discovery and clinical-stage projects, “number of new projects” is the number of projects that we were able
to “win” (bring into our project pipeline) during the year/period ended on the indicated date. We do not count clinical projects
that we “follow” (advance from preclinical stage to clinical stage) as new clinical projects, as we deem an integrated project,
regardless of its developmental stage, as one project.
SUMMARY
—4—


--- page 14 ---
We attribute our success to our visionary team of seasoned senior management supported by a pool
of talented scientists. We are led by Dr. Jincai Li, our chief executive officer, who is supported by members
of our senior management team, all of whom have extensive experience and diverse expertise in the
pharmaceutical industry both domestically and internationally. We also benefit from a strong shareholder
support from the WXB Group and the WXA T Group. Our heritage brings us with strong trust from industry
participants in our field-tested capabilities and world-class quality.
Our Market Opportunities
ADCs and other bioconjugate drugs constitute a separate modality distinct from small molecules or
biologics. Taking ADCs as an example, they consist of a biologic component (the antibody), which is
covalently attached, also referred to as conjugated, to a cytotoxic small molecule drug (the payload) via
a chemical linker. ADCs are therefore designed to combine the target selectivity of antibodies and the
cell-killing potency of highly cytotoxic small molecule drugs. This combinatorial design potentially
reduces off-target toxicity of classic chemotherapy while enhancing the efficacy, thereby leading to an
improved safety and efficacy. Recently, several ADCs have shown favorable efficacy for various cancers
and quickly gained market share. The global sales of ADC drugs reached approximately US$7.9 billion
in 2022, representing an over 40% CAGR since 2018. With constant advancement in conjugation
technologies and expanding bioconjugate component library, bioconjugates are being developed for
therapeutic areas in addition to oncology, including autoimmune diseases, infectious diseases, metabolic
disorders and beyond.
Riding on the recent trend of transformative advancements in drug design and conjugation
technologies, the ADC and bioconjugate drug market is at a growth inflection point. According to Frost
& Sullivan, the global ADC drug market size is anticipated to grow to US$64.7 billion in 2030 from
US$7.9 billion in 2022 at a CAGR of 30.0%. The expected growth of the global ADC drug market is
considerably faster than that of the global biologics drug market (excluding bioconjugates), which is
expected to grow at a CAGR of 9.2% during the same period. As of June 30, 2023, 15 ADC drugs have
been approved globally, of which 11 have been approved since 2018 and four have been approved since
2021. There has also been a promising pipeline of ADC drugs. As of June 30, 2023, 231 ADC drug
candidates around the globe had been advanced to the clinical stage, with 134, 79 and 18 under phase I,
II and III clinical trials, respectively, and globally 57 ADC drug candidates entered clinical trials in 2022,
according to Frost & Sullivan. Nonetheless, the development of other bioconjugates beyond ADC is still
at a preliminary stage, facing uncertainties to progress from traditional ADCs to broader bioconjugates and
application expansion in terms of timing, market acceptance and likelihood of obtaining approval.
The potential of ADCs and other bioconjugate drugs is also evidenced by high-profile acquisition
and licensing activities in the space. According to Frost & Sullivan, there have been over 100 deals
involving ADCs since 2022, including the recently announced acquisition of Seagen Inc., a leading
biotechnology company specializing in the development of ADCs for cancer treatment, by Pfizer Inc. for
a total of approximately US$43 billion. China biotechnology companies have been at the forefront of ADC
out-licensing arrangements, according to Frost & Sullivan. Since 2022 and as of June 30, 2023, there had
been 10 China pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies that reached 14 ADC out-licensing deals with
overseas partners, totaling US$22.0 billion, according to the same source. Of these 10 China companies,
eight are our customers.
SUMMARY
—5—


--- page 15 ---
The development of ADCs and other bioconjugates requires a suite of interdisciplinary capabilities
in both biologics and small molecules that are beyond the reach of most biopharmaceutical companies.
Therefore, the outsourcing rate of bioconjugate development reached around 70%, which is much higher
than the 34% outsourcing rate for other biologics. The global market for ADC and broader bioconjugates
outsourcing services reached US$1.5 billion in 2022, exhibiting a CAGR of 34.5% between 2018 and
2022, and is expected to expand significantly to reach US$11.0 billion by 2030, with a CAGR of 28.4%
from 2022 to 2030. Furthermore, the logistic difficulties in transporting different bioconjugate
components, the stringent requirements for safe manufacturing and handling of cytotoxics, as well as the
increasing demand for shortened development timelines, present significant challenges for a vast majority
of outsourcing service providers in the space. We believe these challenges are best addressed with a
comprehensive CRDMO with integrated service capabilities and geographically proximate facilities like
us.
Our Financial Performance and Path Forward
We experienced robust growth in our revenue during the Track Record Period. For the years ended
December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, our revenue was RMB96.4
million, RMB311.1 million, RMB990.4 million and RMB993.5 million, respectively. We recorded net
profit of RMB26.3 million, RMB54.9 million, RMB155.7 million and RMB177.2 million for the same
periods, respectively. Our adjusted net profit (non-IFRS measure) amounted to RMB32.8 million,
RMB77.1 million, RMB194.4 million and RMB216.4 million in the same periods, respectively. See
“Financial Information — Non-IFRS Measures.” Our backlog was US$318.0 million as of December 31,
2022 and US$410.6 million as of June 30, 2023. The aggregate amount of the transaction price allocated
to performance obligations* that are unsatisfied (or partially unsatisfied) were nil, RMB475 million and
RMB1,495 million, and RMB2,958 million as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023,
respectively. Our management expects the majority of the transaction price allocated to the unsatisfied
contracts as of each of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023 will be recognized as
revenue within five years from such date. As of June 30, 2023, we had 67 ongoing preclinical bioconjugate
projects and 43 ongoing post-IND bioconjugate projects. As pre-IND projects advance into the post-IND
stage and post-IND projects progress across clinical and commercial stage, the typical range of project
contract values is also expected to increase, providing robust revenue growth momentum and visibility.
Going forward, we look to capitalize on the opportunities and solidify our leading position in the
global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market. We plan to continue expanding our
capability beyond ADCs and broader bioconjugates, strengthen our in-house discovery and development
capabilities and manufacturing capacity, deepen our relationship with existing customers and attract new
customers, as well as continue to invest in cutting-edge technologies. We strive to continuously enhance
our fully integrated one-stop bioconjugate platform and become a partner of choice for global industry
participants seeking to develop and manufacture bioconjugate therapeutics.
* Performance obligation is a promise in a contract with our customers to transfer our services to them.
SUMMARY
—6—


--- page 16 ---
Our Business Model
We employ an “enable, follow and win the molecule” strategy to not only grow with our existing
customers by providing services from an early stage of their product development cycle, but also win new
customers as their bioconjugates progress. We have been able to achieve a high customer retention because
of our service quality, industry-leading development timeline, world-class and innovative process
development technology and proven GMP manufacturing capabilities. Since our inception in 2013 and up
to June 30, 2023, nearly all our customers for bioconjugate discovery or integrated projects advancing
their bioconjugate candidates along the development process have stayed with us. Winning customers at
the CMC stage is another key driver of our future growth. Also due to the aforementioned factors, we
expect to continuously win over customers and integrated bioconjugate projects going forward. Our global
market share by revenue increased from 1.8% in 2020 to 4.6% in 2021 and 9.8% in 2022.
During the Track Record Period, we generated revenue from a mix of bioconjugate projects in
various development stages, which can be broadly categorized into (i) revenue from pre-IND projects,
primarily bioconjugate discovery projects at the drug discovery stage and preclinical development stage,
and (ii) revenue from post-IND projects, primarily for clinical and commercial stage projects. The
following table lays out a breakdown of our revenue by the development stages of projects for the periods
indicated, both in actual terms and as a percentage of total revenue.
For the year ended December 31, For the six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(in thousands, except for percentages )
(unaudited)
Pre-IND Services ..... 53,122 55.1 152,506 49.0 381,071 38.5 99,267 30.1 371,273 37.4
Post-IND Services .... 43,231 44.9 158,625 51.0 609,352 61.5 230,169 69.9 622,195 62.6
Total ............. 96,353 100.0 311,131 100.0 990,423 100.0 329,436 100.0 993,468 100.0
Our Fee Models
Our service fee arrangement can be primarily divided into two types: (i) fee-for-service, or FFS,
model and (ii) full-time-equivalent, or FTE, model.
Fee-for-service Model
During the Track Record Period, we generated fee income primarily on an FFS basis for the services
provided. Under the FFS model, we determine the fee level based on the scope of the services, the
estimated costs and expenses, the estimated amount of time to deliver our services, and the prices charged
by our competitors for similar services, among others. Fees received from our service contracts and work
orders under the FFS model contributed 100.0%, 100.0%, 98.4% and 98.7% of our revenue in the years
ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively.
SUMMARY
—7—


--- page 17 ---
Full-time-equivalent Model
Under the FTE model, we designate employees to the customer’s projects at a fixed rate per FTE
employee per period of time. We determine the amount of service fees based on the number of employees
and the amount of time required for completing the project, among others. Fees received from our service
contracts under the FTE model contributed nil, nil, 1.6% and 1.3% of our revenue in the years ended
December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively.
For details of the payment terms of our fee models, see “Business — Customers — Payment Terms.”
For details on our revenue recognition mechanism, see “Financial Information — Critical Accounting
Policies, Judgments and Estimates — Revenue.”
Facilities
Our Current Facilities
We are headquartered in Wuxi, China. As of the Latest Practicable Date, we operated three sites in
Wuxi, Shanghai and Changzhou. These sites are proximately located within a 200-kilometer radius, or
approximately a two-hour drive, which ease logistic coordination and management, improve efficiency
and thereby potentially reduce the overall costs. The following table sets forth a summary of certain key
information about our facilities as of the Latest Practicable Date. For more property information about
these sites, see “Business — Properties.” During the Track Record Period, we did not have GMP-
compliant manufacturing facilities to produce antibody intermediates and sufficient payload-linkers used
in ADC and other bioconjugate drugs, and we relied on the Controlling Shareholders to carry out the
relevant manufacturing activities. We believe that our new payload-linker production line and the
dual-function production line for antibody intermediates for bioconjugates and drug substance in our Wuxi
site will allow us to meet a large portion of our antibody intermediates and payload-linker requirements.
For additional information, see “Business” and “Relationship with Our Controlling Shareholders.”
Site
Site Area
(sq.m.) Owned/Leased Primary Use Capacity Utilization Rate (1)
W u x i........ 48,067 Owned Drug
Substance/Drug
Product
 GMP-compliant
production
 Formulation and
analytical
development
 QC release and
stability testing
Antibody
Intermediates for
Bioconjugates
 GMP-compliant
production
Conjugation drug substance and
antibody intermediates production
 Conjugation drug substance
production line (“XBCM1”)
with single-use reactor systems
ranging from five liters to 500
liters to produce up to 500 liters
of conjugation drug substance.
 The dual-function production
line for antibody intermediates
for bioconjugates and drug
substance (“XmAb/XBCM2”) is
designed with capacities ranging
from 200 liters to 2,000 liters
per batch for monoclonal
antibody intermediates or up to
2,000 liters of bioconjugate drug
substance per batch.
Conjugation drug
substance
production
 51% (2020)
 73% (2021)
 85% (2022)
Conjugation drug
product production
 38% (2020)
 57% (2021)
 78% (2022)
SUMMARY
—8—


--- page 18 ---
Site
Site Area
(sq.m.) Owned/Leased Primary Use Capacity Utilization Rate (1)
Conjugation drug product
production
 The conjugation drug product
(“XDP1”) facility is designed to
produce the liquid and
lyophilization dosage forms with
the annual capacity of up to
three million vials in an isolated
filling line equipped with one 5
sq.m. lyophilizer and one 20
sq.m. lyophilizer.
 The conjugation drug product
(“XDP2”) facility is designed to
produce the liquid and
lyophilization dosage forms with
the annual capacity of up to five
million vials in an isolated
filling line equipped with one 5
sq.m. lyophilizer and one 20
sq.m. lyophilizer.
Shanghai
Waigaoqiao . . .
8,927 Owned Bioconjugate
discovery and
process development
 Bioconjugate
discovery,
research and
process
development
 Analytical and
formulation
development
 Scale-up
conjugation
Discovery lab
 Laboratories for bioconjugate
discovery and process
development.
Bioconjugate process development
lab
 Laboratory-scale sample
preparation to pilot-scale
manufacturing of ADCs and
other bioconjugates.
N/A
Changzhou ..... 8 1 9 Leased Payload-linker
 Discovery,
research and
process and
analytical
development
 Pilot-scale
synthesis
 GMP-compliant
production
Payload-linker
 Laboratory with a field-tested
containment design to safely
handle highly potent compounds
that are OEB5-rated materials.
 Equipped with reaction kettles
for GMP-compliant production
with capacity of up to 150
liters, enabling kilogram-scale
production of payload-linkers.
N/A
SUMMARY
—9—


--- page 19 ---
(1) The utilization rate for a particular year is calculated using the actual days in that year that our facilities are in operation to
carry out manufacturing projects for customers (including the actual manufacturing and the necessary clean-up steps) divided
by the theoretical maximum days in a year that the manufacturing facilities can be in operation assuming non-stop operations
(being 350 days, taking into account total downtime of 15 days for necessary equipment maintenance).
We do not calculate the utilization rate for the Shanghai Waigaoqiao or Changzhou sites, as those sites are primarily
laboratories, instead of manufacturing facilities, for bioconjugate discovery, process development and payload-linkers. The
production lines XmAb/XBCM2 and XDP2 in our Wuxi site commenced operation in September 2023 and are therefore not
taken into account in the calculation of utilization rate for 2020, 2021 and 2022.
Our Facility Expansion Plans
Wuxi Site
We seek to expand our manufacturing capabilities and capacity at the Wuxi site, so that our
capabilities encompass the full-spectrum from antibody intermediates to drug products to achieve
self-sufficient operations, and our capacity meets the needs of multiple late-stage bioconjugate
development and manufacturing projects. In particular, we are building additional facilities in Wuxi for
clinical or commercial manufacturing, including a kilogram-scale payload-linker production line
(“XPLM1 ”), which will be equipped with reaction kettles for GMP-compliant production with capacity
of 5 to 100 liters. We expect that the XPLM1 facility will commence GMP-compliant operations in the
fourth quarter of 2023, and that both the XmAb/XBCM2 and the XDP2 facilities will commence
GMP-compliant operations in the third quarter of 2023. Should the need arise, we will plan and build
additional manufacturing facilities at our Wuxi site ahead of time.
Singapore Site
Outside of China, we are planning to establish a manufacturing base in Singapore to meet the
growing demand from customers worldwide for comprehensive bioconjugate CRDMO services and
implement a “global dual sourcing” strategy, which supports continuous and timely provision of services
to our customers around the globe. We selected Singapore as the location of our new manufacturing
facility because Singapore is a vibrant hub of the global biopharmaceutical industry that may bring us
significant opportunities in brand promotion and customer acquisition.
Four production lines are planned to be established at the Singapore site for clinical and commercial
manufacturing, including a dual-function production line for antibody intermediates for bioconjugates and
drug substance (“ XmAb/XBCM3 ”), a production line for drug substance (“ XBCM4 ”), as well as two drug
product manufacturing lines (“ XDP3 ” and “ XDP4 ”). The dual-function XmAb/XBCM3 facility is
designed with capabilities ranging from 200 liters to 2,000 liters per batch for monoclonal antibody
intermediates or up to 2,000 liters of bioconjugate drug substance per batch. The XBCM4 facility is
designed with capabilities of up to 500 liters of bioconjugate drug substance per batch. The conjugation
drug product facilities XDP3 and XDP4 are designed to produce the liquid and lyophilization dosage forms
with the annual capacity of up to eight million vials and three million vials in isolated filling lines
equipped with one 10 sq.m. lyophilizer and two 30 sq.m. lyophilizers, and one 5 sq.m. lyophilizer and one
10 sq.m. lyophilizer, respectively. Our facilities in China will supply the payload-linkers needed for
Singapore site’s operations. We do not expect the transport of such payload-linkers will significantly
increase the operating costs of our facilities, as the transportation of payload-linkers is generally
uncomplicated, and we plan to utilize bulk shipment to lower potential transportation and logistics
expenses. We have started the design of the site and expect to commence GMP-compliant operations by
2026.
SUMMARY
—1 0—


--- page 20 ---
COMPETITIVE STRENGTHS
We believe the following strengths have contributed to our success and differentiate us from our
competitors: (i) uniquely positioned to capture the growth in the global ADC and broader bioconjugate
market; (ii) leading global CRDMO dedicated to ADCs and other bioconjugates with fully integrated,
one-stop service capabilities; (iii) industry-leading technical capabilities and integrated capacity; (iv)
CRDMO of choice with broad, loyal and fast-growing customer base; and (v) seasoned management team
supported by a diversified and strong talent pool and shareholders.
GROWTH STRATEGIES
We plan to execute the following key strategies: (i) leverage our fully integrated platform to further
solidify industry leading position as we continue to focus on integrated projects and comprehensive
service capabilities; (ii) expand manufacturing capacities globally to meet growing demands; (iii) continue
to focus on cutting-edge technologies through internal R&D and strategic partnerships; (iv) deepen
relationship with existing customers and broaden customer base; and (v) pioneer through the industry
development from ADC to XDC.
OUR CUSTOMERS
Our diverse and growing customer base includes both innovative biotechnology companies and
global pharmaceutical companies, many of which are leading players in the ADC and bioconjugate space
with potentially first-in-class or best-in-class pipeline programs.
During the Track Record Period, part of our bioconjugate CRDMO services were provided to
customers that had formally contracted with the Remaining WXB Group. Because these contracts were
entered into before the Spin-off, the customers did not directly contract with a member of our Group. We
view this practice as being in line with our historical development. After the formation of joint venture
in May 2021 between WuXi Biologics and STA Pharmaceutical, we started to gradually educate customers
about our distinct capacity and encourage customers to sign contracts directly with members of our Group.
For additional information about the historical amount of the ADC Master Services Agreement in each
period of the Track Record Period, see “Connected Transactions.”
We have a broad, loyal and fast-growing customer base globally. We served a total of 49, 115, 167
and 169 ultimate customers (taking into account the customers of the legacy contracts who formally
contracted with the Remaining WXB Group but made use of our bioconjugate CRDMO services) in each
year of 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively. In the first six months of
2023, 37.0%, 35.9%, 23.1% and 4.0% of the total revenue was generated from ultimate customers from
North America, China, Europe and the rest of the world, respectively, based on the location of the
customers’ headquarters. During the same periods, our five largest ultimate customers for each year/period
contributed to 51.9%, 39.8%, 34.1% and 45.7%, respectively, of our total revenue, and our largest ultimate
customer for each year/period accounted for 14.5%, 13.1%, 8.9% and 13.2%, respectively, of our total
revenue. See “Risk Factors — Risks Relating to Our Business and Industry — The potential loss of major
customers or any of our large contracts could materially and adversely affect our business, financial
condition and results of operations” for more information.
SUMMARY
—1 1—


--- page 21 ---
None of our Directors, their respective associates, or Shareholders who, to the knowledge of our
Directors, own 5% or more of our issued share capital had any interest in any of our five largest direct
or ultimate customers, other than with respect to the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group, during
the Track Record Period. For additional information about our relationship with the Remaining WXB
Group and the WXA T Group, see “Relationship with Our Controlling Shareholders” and “Connected
Transactions.”
OUR SUPPLIERS
The raw materials and equipment required for the provision of our services are generally readily
available in the market through a number of suppliers. During the Track Record Period, procurement of
raw materials for the WXB Group was conducted on a centralized basis, which had enabled us to benefit
from the substantial economies of scale that are associated with the magnitude of the global business of
the WXB Group. During the Track Record Period, we also sourced certain property, plant and equipment
(“PPE”) through the aforementioned centralized procurement system rather than directly from suppliers.
For additional information on the arrangement, see “Connected Transactions.”
We trace the raw materials and PPE from third-party suppliers to our Group by matching the unique
material code in the WXB Group’s transaction records, and we thereby attribute expenses to specific
ultimate suppliers of our Group. We believe such treatment fairly depicts the relationship between our
Group and our ultimate suppliers during the Track Record Period. In the years ended December 31, 2020,
2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, our five largest ultimate suppliers for each
year/period together accounted for 52.6%, 52.7%, 71.8% and 78.7%, respectively, of our cost of services,
and our largest ultimate supplier for each year/period accounted for 32.8%, 15.0%, 39.9% and 60.8%,
respectively, of our cost of services.
None of our Directors, their respective associates, or Shareholders who, to the knowledge of our
Directors, own 5% or more of our issued share capital had any interest in any of our five largest direct
or ultimate suppliers, other than with respect to the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group, during
the Track Record Period. During the Track Record Period, none of our major independent direct suppliers
was also our customer. For details of our connected transactions with the Remaining WXB Group and the
WXA T Group, see “Connected Transactions.”
SALES AND MARKETING
We market our services directly to pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies through regular
sales meetings with their representatives and senior management. We also utilize multiple digital
marketing and promotional channels, including advertisements, press releases, social media, webinars,
podcasts and email updates, to promote our technologies, platforms and services. We also gain our
business through referrals from our customers. In addition, we actively participate in trade conferences,
trade shows and scientific conferences.
SUMMARY
—1 2—


--- page 22 ---
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY
We develop and use a number of proprietary methodologies, technologies, trade secrets, know-how
and other intellectual property during the conduct of our business. We rely on a combination of patent,
trademark, intellectual property laws and contractual arrangements to protect our intellectual property. As
of the Latest Practicable Date, the Remaining WXB Group has transferred material patents, patent
applications, registered trademarks and pending trademark applications relating to our business to us. In
particular, we have been assigned with three issued patents relating to the WuXiDAR4 technologies in the
United States, Japan and Taiwan, 13 pending patent applications in China and overseas, as well as seven
registered trademarks relating to the WuXiDAR4 technologies in China, the United States, the EU, the
United Kingdom and Japan.
Protecting the proprietary rights of our customers has been a top priority since our inception. We
have established an intellectual property protection process to properly manage the document transmission
and archiving, preservation of documents related to R&D and manufacturing, supervision and control of
laboratory computers and access to documents in connection with confidential information. Our customers
generally retain ownership of all intellectual property associated with their projects, including the
intellectual property that they provide to us and the intellectual property arising from the services we
provide.
During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, we were not subject to, nor
were we party to, any intellectual property rights infringement claims or litigations and were not aware
of any material infringement of our intellectual property rights that had a material adverse effect on our
business. We had complied with all applicable intellectual property laws and regulations in all material
respects during the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date. See “Business —
Intellectual Property” for more details.
COMPETITION
We face competition from other third-party outsourcing service providers for the discovery,
development and manufacturing of ADCs and other bioconjugates. The global ADC and broader
bioconjugates outsourcing services market is relatively concentrated with the top five players accounting
for an aggregate market share of 50.0% in terms of revenue in 2022, according to Frost & Sullivan. Our
global market share by revenue increased from 1.8% in 2020 to 4.6% in 2021 and 9.8% in 2022, ranking
second in the global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market in 2022. We are the only
Chinese company among the top 5 players in terms of revenue in 2022. We ranked first in China, the most
active ADC out-licensing market globally, with a market share of 69.5% in terms of revenue in 2022,
according to the same source.
SUMMARY
—1 3—


--- page 23 ---
We face competition based on several factors, including quality and breadth of services, timeliness
of delivery, price and geography, maintenance of GLP , GMP and cGMP standards and depth of customer
relationships. In terms of key success factors, according to Frost & Sullivan, the global ADC and broader
bioconjugates outsourcing services market generally favors participants with integrated and
comprehensive services capabilities, geographical proximity of facilities, proprietary technical
capabilities and proven quality track record to accomplish the highly regulated process.
We believe that we are able to maintain our services’ competitiveness by leveraging our established
position in the global ADC and broader bioconjugate outsourcing services market and capitalizing on the
opportunities offered by the booming ADC and broader bioconjugate market globally. It is worth noting
that bioconjugates are extending beyond ADC by first conjugating various payloads other than chemical
drugs with antibody, and then further to conjugate various carriers other than antibody with various
payloads (“ XDC”). The development of XDC beyond ADC, however, is still at a preliminary stage, facing
uncertainties to progress from traditional ADCs to broader bioconjugates and application expansion in
terms of timing, market acceptance and likelihood of obtaining approval. We therefore face uncertainty
while our business gradually expanding beyond ADC into the XDC field. We are also of the view that a
comprehensive and integrated service portfolio and effective quality assurance are critical to the
continuing success of our business. In addition, our expanding capacity enables us to satisfy the increasing
needs of bioconjugate outsourcing and grow with our customers to establish long-term relationships. For
more details, see “Business — Competition” and “Industry Overview — Overview of Global ADC and
Broader Bioconjugates Outsourcing Services Market.”
ENVIRONMENTAL, SOCIAL AND GOVERNANCE MATTERS
We view environmental, social and governance (“ ESG”) responsibilities as an integral component of
our ethos and business strategy. During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, we
complied with the relevant environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations in all
material aspects. We were not subject to any administrative penalties relating to environmental, health or
safety compliance that would have a material adverse effect on our financial position or results of
operations as a whole.
We have monitored our resource consumption and waste management since 2021 to assess and
manage the environmental impact of our operations. To the extent possible, our facilities use
next-generation technologies and clean energy, which we believe would improve resource conservation
and reduce the level of waste produced by our operations. For the years ended December 31, 2021 and
2022, our greenhouse gas emissions were approximately 8,041 tons and 13,056 tons of CO
2 equivalent,
respectively. We have built activated charcoal filters to ensure the waste gas is safe for emission. For
wastewater generated during our operations, we perform coagulation and sterilization and then send the
processed wastewater to a third party for further processing. We contract with qualified third parties to
dispose solid hazardous waste in a safe and environmentally friendly manner.
Our Board will set ESG-related targets with a view of balancing business growth and environmental
protection to achieve sustainable development. The targets will be reviewed on an annual basis to ensure
that they remain appropriate to the needs of our Group. We aim to reduce our Scope 1 and Scope 2
greenhouse gas emissions intensity by 50% (tons/RMB10,000) by 2030 from a 2021 base year. For the
near term, we aim to curb the increment of our resource consumption and waste generation in spite of the
growing size of our business operations.
SUMMARY
—1 4—


--- page 24 ---
In view of the nature of our business, to the best knowledge of our directors, climate change will not
have any major impact on our business operation. We will conduct an enterprise risk assessment at least
once a year to cover the current and potential risks faced by our Group, including, but not limited to, the
risks arising from the ESG aspects and strategic risk around disruptive forces such as climate change. Our
Board will assess or, when needed, engage an external expert to evaluate the risks and review our Group’s
existing strategy, target and internal controls, and necessary improvements will be implemented to
mitigate the risks. For additional information about environmental, social and governance matters, see
“Business — Environmental, Social and Governance Matters.”
RISKS AND CHALLENGES
Our business and the Global Offering involve certain risks, which are set out in the section headed
“Risk Factors” in this prospectus. Some of the major risk factors that we face include:
 reductions in our customers’ spending or demand for our services, such as reduction in
spending by domestic customers due to the lack of sufficient funding and overseas customers
choosing not to engage Chinese companies for ADC CRDMO services, and uncertainties of
future advancements of ADCs and other bioconjugates beyond ADC could have a material
adverse effect on our business, particularly given that its development is still at a preliminary
stage;
 competition may intensify as the industry grows and attracts new market entrants;
 the difficulty in developing our new technologies and improving existing technologies could
materially and adversely affect our future business;
 the loss of services of our senior management and key scientific personnel could severely
disrupt our business and growth; and
 we operate in a highly competitive industry and we cannot assure you that we will continue to
compete successfully.
SUMMARY OF HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
The following is a summary of our historical financial information as of and for the years ended
December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023,
extracted from the Accountants’ Report set out in Appendix I to this prospectus. The summary below
should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial information in Appendix I, including the
accompanying notes and the information set forth in the section headed “Financial Information” in this
prospectus. Our consolidated financial information was prepared in accordance with IFRSs.
SUMMARY
—1 5—


--- page 25 ---
Summary of Results of Operations
The following table sets forth a summary of our results of operations for the periods indicated. Our
historical results presented below are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected for any
future period.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Revenue .................. 96,353 100.0 311,131 100.0 990,423 100.0 329,436 100.0 993,468 100.0
Cost of services .............. (88,272) (91.6) (197,637) (63.5) (729,340) (73.6) (225,481) (68.4) (764,068) (76.9)
Gross profit ................ 8,081 8.4 113,494 36.5 261,083 26.4 103,955 31.6 229,400 23.1
Selling and marketing expenses ..... (478) (0.5) (2,028) (0.7) (8,769) (0.9) (4,152) (1.3) (5,823) (0.6)
Administrative expenses ......... (9,608) (10.0) (27,858) (9.0) (49,210) (5.0) (15,248) (4.6) (42,739) (4.3)
Listing expenses ............. — — — — — — — — (7,374) (0.7)
Research and development expenses . . (4,075) (4.2) (13,815) (4.4) (33,842) (3.4) (11,059) (3.4) (29,749) (3.0)
Finance costs ................ — — (493) (0.2) (2,916) (0.3) (1,573) (0.5) (569) (0.1)
Other income ................ 41,446 43.0 8,966 2.9 26,152 2.6 18,812 5.7 39,579 4.0
Other gains and losses .......... (2,711) (2.8) (855) (0.3) 46,672 4.7 25,679 7.8 4,461 0.4
Impairment losses (recognized)/
reversed, under expected credit loss
model, net of reversal ......... (289) (0.3) (10,558) (3.4) (43,369) (4.4) 2,976 0.9 24,382 2.5
Profit before tax ............. 32,366 33.6 66,853 21.5 195,801 19.8 119,390 36.2 211,568 21.3
Income tax expense ............ (6,067) (6.3) (11,923) (3.8) (40,070) (4.0) (21,123) (6.4) (34,354) (3.5)
Profit for the period ........... 26,299 27.3 54,930 17.7 155,731 15.7 98,267 29.8 177,214 17.8
Other comprehensive
income/(expense)
Items that may be reclassified
subsequently to profit or loss:
Fair value gain/(loss) on hedging
instruments designated in cash flow
hedges, net of income tax ....... 1,668 1.7 499 0.2 (3,313) (0.3) (4,025) (1.2) 1,146 0.1
Exchange gain arising on translation of
foreign operations ........... — — — — — — — — 4,635 0.5
Other comprehensive
income/(expense) for the period . . 1,668 1.7 499 0.2 (3,313) (0.3) (4,025) (1.2) 5,781 0.6
Total comprehensive income for the
period .................. 27,967 29.0 55,429 17.8 152,418 15.4 94,242 28.6 182,995 18.4
SUMMARY
—1 6—


--- page 26 ---
Non-IFRS Measures
Our consolidated financial information was prepared in accordance with IFRSs. To supplement our
consolidated results which are prepared and presented in accordance with IFRSs, we use adjusted net
profit (non-IFRS measure), EBITDA (non-IFRS measure), and adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) as
additional financial measures, which are not required by, or presented in accordance with, IFRSs. We
believe that these measures facilitate comparisons of operating performance from period to period and
company to company by eliminating the potential impact of items, such as certain non-cash items. The use
of these non-IFRS measures has limitations as an analytical tool, and you should not consider them in
isolation from, as a substitute for, analysis of, or superior to, our results of operations or financial
condition as reported under IFRSs. In addition, these non-IFRS financial measures may be defined
differently from similar terms used by other companies, and may not be comparable to other similarly
titled measure used by other companies.
We define adjusted net profit (non-IFRS measure) as net profit for the period, adjusted by adding
non-cash items. Listing expenses are the expenses relating to the Global Offering. Share-based
compensation is non-cash expenses arising from granting restricted share award and options to senior
management and employees. The following table sets forth a reconciliation of our adjusted net profit
(non-IFRS measure) for 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023 to the nearest
measure prepared in accordance with IFRSs.
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months ended
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
(RMB in thousands)
(unaudited)
Profit for the period .......... 26,299 54,930 155,731 98,267 177,214
Add:
Listing expenses .............. ———— 7,374
Share-based compensation
expense .................. 6,476 22,157 38,626 10,595 31,780
Adjusted net profit (non-IFRS
measure) ................. 32,775 77,087 194,357 108,862 216,368
SUMMARY
—1 7—


--- page 27 ---
We define adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) as EBITDA (non-IFRS measure), adjusted by
adding back listing expenses and share-based compensation. The following table sets forth a reconciliation
of our EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) and adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) for 2020, 2021, 2022 and
the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023 to the nearest measures prepared in accordance with IFRSs.
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months ended
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
(RMB in thousands)
(unaudited)
Profit for the period ......... 26,299 54,930 155,731 98,267 177,214
Add:
Income tax expense ........... 6,067 11,923 40,070 21,123 34,354
Depreciation and amortization .... 13,465 18,981 30,812 13,872 22,750
Finance costs ................ — 4 9 3 2,916 1,573 569
Subtract:
Interest income from banks ...... (31) (28) (4,612) (562) (3,424)
EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) . . . 45,800 86,299 224,917 134,273 231,463
Add:
Listing expenses .............. ———— 7,374
Share-based compensation
expense .................. 6,476 22,157 38,626 10,595 31,780
Adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS
measure) ................. 52,276 108,456 263,543 144,868 270,617
Our net profit increased from RMB26.3 million in 2020 to RMB155.7 million in 2022 and increased
from RMB98.3 million in the six months ended June 30, 2022 to RMB177.2 million in the six months
ended June 30, 2023, generally in line with our revenue and business growth. Our net profit margin
decreased from 27.3% in 2020 to 17.7% in 2021, primarily due to the decrease in research and other grants
related to income awarded to us in 2021. Our net profit margin slightly decreased to 15.7% in 2022,
primarily due to the outsourcing of antibody intermediate manufacturing. Our net profit margin decreased
from 29.8% in the six months ended June 30, 2022 to 17.8% in the six months ended June 30, 2023,
primarily due to the increase in our indirect production cost and overheads incurred for the outsourcing
of antibody intermediate manufacturing.
SUMMARY
—1 8—


--- page 28 ---
Summary of Consolidated Statements of Financial Position
The following table sets forth a summary of our consolidated statements of financial position as of
the dates indicated.
As of December 31, As of
June 30, 20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Total non-current assets .............. 308,550 629,450 1,094,048 1,285,859
Total current assets .................. 99,918 250,303 1,402,331 1,454,091
Total assets ....................... 408,468 879,753 2,496,379 2,739,950
Total current liabilities ............... 32,231 858,490 1,013,973 1,038,852
Net current assets/(liabilities) .......... 67,687 (608,187) 388,358 415,239
Total assets less current liabilities ....... 376,237 21,263 1,482,406 1,701,098
Total non-current liabilities ............ 5 5 6 3 8 2 1,627 2,477
Total liabilities ..................... 32,787 858,872 1,015,600 1,041,329
Net assets ........................ 375,681 20,881 1,480,779 1,698,621
During the Track Record Period, our net current assets position as of each of December 31, 2020 and
2022 and June 30, 2023 was primarily attributable to our trade and other receivables and bank balances
and cash, partially offset by trade and other payables and contract liabilities. We had net current liabilities
of RMB608.2 million as of December 31, 2021, primarily due to the consideration payable to a related
party for transfer of XDC Wuxi and consideration payable for acquisition of Payload & Linker Business.
We had net current assets of RMB67.7 million as of December 31, 2020 compared to net current liabilities
of RMB608.2 million as of December 31, 2021, primarily due to the consideration payable as part of
transfer of XDC Wuxi and the consideration for acquisition of Payload & Linker Business. We recorded
net current assets of RMB388.4 million as of December 31, 2022, primarily due to an increase of
RMB400.0 million in financial assets at FVTPL, an increase of RMB333.7 million in trade receivables
from third parties, and an increase of RMB308.6 million in bank balances and cash, as a result of our
business growth and capital injection from our Shareholders. Our net current assets then increased to
RMB415.2 million as of June 30, 2023, primarily due to an increase of RMB251.6 million in trade and
other receivables, an increase of RMB226.7 million in bank balances and cash, and a decrease of RMB71.1
million in loans from related parties.
We recorded net assets of RMB375.7 million, RMB20.9 million, RMB1,480.8 million and
RMB1,698.6 million as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023, respectively. Our net
assets decreased from RMB375.7 million as of December 31, 2020 to RMB20.9 million as of December
31, 2021, primarily due to a decrease of RMB404.4 million in merger reserve as a result of deemed
distribution to our equity holders in connection with our acquisition of XDC Wuxi. Our net assets then
increased substantially to RMB1,480.8 million as of December 31, 2022, primarily due to an increase of
RMB1,285.1 million in share premium, as a result of issue of shares to WuXi Biologics and STA
Pharmaceutical and an increase of RMB149.1 million in retained earnings. Our net assets then increased
to RMB1,698.6 million as of June 30, 2023, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB177.2 million in
retained earnings and (ii) an increase of RMB30.1 million in equity-settled share-based compensation
reserve in relation to recognition of equity-settled share-based compensation.
SUMMARY
—1 9—


--- page 29 ---
We had an accumulated loss of RMB9.0 million at the beginning of 2020, which was primarily
attributable to the fixed cost incurred prior to 2020 as we ramped up our operations and production
capacity. In particular, we incurred significant cost as we constructed our production facilities, such as our
DP3 facility, and commenced GMP manufacturing since August 2019.
Summary of Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
The following table sets forth a summary of our cash flows for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31,
Six
months ended
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Operating cash flows before movements in
working capital .................. 51,677 123,626 300,940 240,103
Changes in working capital ............ (21,845) (58,847) (5,991) (67,851)
Cash generated from operations ........ 29,832 64,779 294,949 172,252
Income taxes paid .................. (8,978) (5,643) (43,133) (12,621)
Net cash from operating activities ...... 20,854 59,136 251,816 159,631
Net cash (used in)/from investing
activities ....................... (52,424) (51,587) (1,279,543) 137,117
Interest paid ....................... — – (325) (149)
Net cash from/(used in) financing
activities ....................... 69,116 22,343 1,328,213 (73,729)
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash
equivalents ...................... 24,627 (2,065) 308,647 226,672
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning
of the period .................... 3,763 28,390 26,325 334,972
Cash and cash equivalents at end of the
period ......................... 28,390 26,325 334,972 561,644
SUMMARY
—2 0—


--- page 30 ---
KEY FINANCIAL RATIOS
The following table sets forth certain of our key financial ratios for the periods indicated.
As of/for the year ended December 31,
As of/for the six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
(unaudited)
Profitability ratios
Gross profit margin (1) .......... 8.4% 36.5% 26.4% 31.6% 23.1%
Net profit margin (2)............ 27.3% 17.7% 15.7% 29.8% 17.8%
Adjusted net profit margin (non-
IFRS measure) (3) ............ 34.0% 24.8% 19.6% 33.0% 21.8%
EBITDA margin (non-IFRS
measure) (4) ................ 47.5% 27.7% 22.7% 40.8% 23.3%
Adjusted EBITDA margin (non-
IFRS measure) (5) ............ 54.3% 34.9% 26.6% 44.0% 27.2%
Return on total assets (6) ........ 6.4% 6.2% 6.2% N/A NM (8)
Liquidity ratios
Current ratio (7) ............... 3 . 1 0 . 3 1 . 4 N / A 1 . 4
(1) Gross profit for the period divided by revenue for the respective period and multiplied by 100.0%.
(2) Profit for the period divided by revenue for the respective period and multiplied by 100.0%.
(3) Adjusted net profit (non-IFRS measure), defined as profit for the period adjusted by adding back listing expenses and
share-based compensation expense, divided by revenue for the respective period and multiplied by 100.0%.
(4) EBITDA (non-IFRS measure), defined as profit for the period adjusted by adding back depreciation and amortization, income
tax expense and finance costs and subtracting interest income from banks, divided by revenue for the respective period and
multiplied by 100.0%.
(5) Adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS measure), defined as profit for the period adjusted by adding back listing expenses and
share-based compensation expense, depreciation and amortization, income tax expense and finance costs and subtracting
interest income from banks, divided by revenue for the respective period and multiplied by 100.0%.
(6) Profit for the period divided by the closing balance of total assets of for the respective period and multiplied by 100.0%.
(7) Current assets divided by current liabilities as of period end.
(8) Not meaningful.
See “Financial Information — Key Financial Ratios” for details.
OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
As of the Latest Practicable Date, WuXi Biologics was directly interested in 60% of our total issued
share capital and STA Pharmaceutical, an indirect subsidiary of WuXi AppTec, was directly interested in
40% of our total issued share capital. STA Pharmaceutical is directly wholly-owned by STA, which is in turn
held as to 98.56% by WuXi AppTec (Shanghai), and WuXi AppTec (Shanghai) is directly wholly-owned by
WuXi AppTec. Immediately following completion of the Global Offering, WuXi Biologics and STA
Pharmaceutical will respectively own approximately 50.91% and 33.94% of the total issued share capital
of our Company (assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised and without taking into account any
exercise of the share options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes), or approximately 50.10%
and 33.40% of the total issued share capital of our Company (assuming the Over-allotment Option is
exercised in full and without taking into account any exercise of the share options granted under the
SUMMARY
—2 1—


--- page 31 ---
Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes). Immediately upon the Listing, WuXi Biologics, STA Pharmaceutical,
STA, WuXi AppTec (Shanghai) and WuXi AppTec will remain as our Controlling Shareholders and our
Company will remain as a subsidiary of WuXi Biologics. See “Relationship with Our Controlling
Shareholders” for more information.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
We have entered into certain transactions with certain connected persons (as defined under Chapter
14A of the Listing Rules), and following the Listing, the transactions contemplated thereunder will
continue and constitute continuing connected transactions under Chapter 14A of the Listing Rules. We
have applied to the Stock Exchange for, and the Stock Exchange has granted to us, a waiver from strict
compliance with the announcement, circular, independent shareholders’ approval and annual reporting
requirements as applicable, as set out in Chapter 14A of the Listing Rules in respect of such continuing
connected transactions. See “Connected Transactions” for details of the connected transactions.
SPIN-OFF AND PREFERENTIAL OFFERING
Our Listing constitutes a spin-off of our Company from WuXi Biologics (stock code: 2269) under
Practice Note 15 of the Listing Rules. The proposal in relation to the Spin-off has been submitted by WuXi
Biologics to the Stock Exchange for approval pursuant to Practice Note 15 of the Listing Rules and the
Stock Exchange has confirmed that WuXi Biologics may proceed with the Spin-off. WuXi Biologics
considers that the spin-off and separate listing of our Group will be beneficial to WuXi Biologics, our
Company and our Shareholders as a whole. For details, please see the section headed “History,
Reorganization and Corporate Structure — Spin-off of our Group from WuXi Biologics”.
As the highest applicable percentage ratio under the Listing Rules for the Spin-off will not exceed
5%, the Spin-off will not constitute a notifiable transaction for WuXi Biologics under Chapter 14 of the
Listing Rules. The Spin-off is not subject to shareholder’s approval of WuXi Biologics. WuXi Biologics
and our Company will comply with the requirements under Practice Note 15 to the Listing Rules and the
applicable requirements of the Listing Rules regarding the Spin-Off.
In order to enable the Qualifying WXB Shareholders to participate in the Global Offering on a
preferential basis as to allocation only, subject to the Stock Exchange granting approval for the listing of,
and permission to deal in, the Shares on the Main Board and such approval not having been withdrawn
and the Global Offering becoming unconditional, the Qualifying WXB Shareholders are invited to apply
for an aggregate of 8,922,000 Reserved Shares in the Preferential Offering as an Assured Entitlement. For
details, please see the section headed “Structure of the Global Offering — The Preferential Offering” in
this prospectus.
SUMMARY
—2 2—


--- page 32 ---
LISTING EXPENSES
We expect to incur a total of approximately RMB174.8 million (HK$190.5 million) of listing
expenses in connection with the Global Offering, representing approximately 5.3% of the proceeds from
the Global Offering (assuming an Offer Price of HK$20.25, being the mid-point of the indicative Offer
Price range between HK$19.90 and HK$20.60, and assuming that the Over-allotment Option is not
exercised), including (1) sponsor fees and underwriting commissions, SFC transaction levy, Stock
Exchange trading fees and AFRC transaction levy for all Offer Shares of approximately RMB116.3 million
(HK$126.8 million), and (2) non-underwriting expenses of approximately RMB58.5 million (HK$63.7
million), which consist of (i) fees and expenses of legal advisors and accountants of approximately
RMB37.1 million (HK$40.4 million), and (ii) other fees and expenses of approximately RMB21.4 million
(HK$23.3 million). Approximately RMB7.4 million has been charged to our consolidated statements of
profit or loss in the six months ended June 30, 2023, approximately RMB54.5 million is expected to be
charged to our consolidated statements of profit and loss after the Track Record Period, and approximately
RMB112.9 million is expected to be deducted from equity. The listing expenses above are the best estimate
as of the Latest Practicable Date and for reference only. The actual amount may differ from this estimate.
OFFERING STATISTICS
All statistics in the following table are based on the fact that (1) the Global Offering has been
completed and 178,446,000 Offer Shares are issued pursuant to the Global Offering; and (2) the
Over-allotment Option is not exercised.
Based on an
Offering Price of
HK$20.60 per
Offer Share
Based on an
Offering Price of
HK$19.90 per
Offer Share
Market Capitalization of our Shares (1) ....................
HK$24,276.0
million
HK$23,451.1
million
Unaudited pro forma adjusted net tangible asset per Share (2) .... HK$4.28 HK$4.18
(1) The calculation of market capitalization is based on 1,178,446,000 Shares expected to be in issue immediately upon
completion of the Global Offering (assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised).
(2) The unaudited pro forma net tangible assets per Shares is arrived at after adjusting for the estimated net proceeds from the
Global Offering and on the basis that 1,178,446,000 Shares were in issue assuming that the Global Offering has been
completed on June 30, 2023 but takes no account of any Shares which may be allotted and issued pursuant to the exercise
of the Over-allotment Option or any Shares which may be issued or repurchased by the Company.
* No adjustment has been made to our unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets attributable to our owners
as of June 30, 2023 to reflect any trading result or our other transaction entered into subsequent to June 30, 2023. In particular,
our unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets attributable to our owners per Share as of June 30, 2023
have not been adjusted to illustrate the effect of the subsequent events as disclosed in Note 44 to Appendix I in this prospectus
as such subsequent events would not have material impact on the unaudited pro forma financial information.
SUMMARY
—2 3—


--- page 33 ---
FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS
We estimate that the net proceeds of the Global Offering, after deducting the estimated underwriting
commissions and other fees and expenses payable by us in connection with the Global Offering, will be
approximately HK$3,423.0 million, assuming an Offer Price of HK$20.25 per Share (being the mid-point
of the indicative range of the Offer Price of HK$19.90 to HK$20.60 per Share), without the exercise of
the Over-allotment Option. We currently intend to use the net proceeds from the Global Offering for the
following purposes: (1) approximately 67% of the net proceeds, or HK$2,293.4 million, will be used to
further expand our manufacturing capacity by (i) constructing our manufacturing facilities in Singapore
and (ii) expanding our production capacity in China with respect to antibody intermediates; (2)
approximately 23% of the net proceeds, or HK$787.3 million, will be used to selectively pursue strategic
alliances, investment and acquisition opportunities to enrich our technology platform and service
offerings; and (3) approximately 10% of the net proceeds, or HK$342.3 million, for working capital and
other general corporate purposes.
See “Future Plans and Use of Proceeds” for further information relating to our future plans and use
of proceeds from the Global Offering, including the adjustment on the allocation of the proceeds in the
event that the Offer Price is fixed at a higher or lower level compared to the midpoint of the estimated
Offer Price range.
DIVIDENDS
During the Track Record Period, we did not pay or declare any dividend. According to our dividend
policy adopted on October 30, 2023, the Articles of Association and applicable laws and regulations, the
determination to pay dividends will be made at the discretion of our Directors, subject to the Listing Rules,
and will depend upon, among others, the financial results, cash flow, business conditions and strategies,
future operations and earnings, capital requirements and expenditure plans, any restrictions on payment of
dividends, and other factors that our Directors may consider relevant. We do not have a pre-determined
dividend payout ratio. We will continue to re-evaluate our dividend policy in light of our financial
condition and the prevailing economic environment.
As advised by our Cayman Islands legal advisors, we are a holding company incorporated under the
laws of the Cayman Islands, pursuant to which, a company may declare and pay a dividend out of either
profits or share premium account. The financial position of accumulated losses does not prohibit us from
declaring and paying dividends to our Shareholders, as dividends may still be declared and paid out of our
share premium account notwithstanding our profitability, provided that this would not result in our
Company being unable to pay debts as they fall due in the ordinary course of business.
RECENT DEVELOPMENT
No Material Adverse Change
After performing sufficient due diligence work which our Directors consider appropriate and after
due and careful consideration, our Directors confirm that, as of the date of this prospectus, there has been
no material adverse change in our financial and trading positions or prospects since June 30, 2023, being
the date on which our latest audited consolidated financial statements were prepared, and that there is no
event since June 30, 2023 which would materially affect the information in the Accountants’ Report set
out in Appendix I to this prospectus.
SUMMARY
—2 4—


--- page 34 ---
Regulations on Overseas Listing
On February 17, 2023, the China Securities Regulatory Commission (“ CSRC ”) released the Trial
Administrative Measures of Overseas Securities Offering and Listing by Domestic Companies ( ྤʫΆุ
جand five supporting guidelines (together, the “ Trial Measures ”),
which came into effect on March 31, 2023. Pursuant to the Trial Measures, domestic companies that seek
to list overseas, both directly and indirectly, should fulfill the filing procedure and report relevant
information to the CSRC. Specifically, following the principle of substance over form, if an issuer meets
both of the following criteria, its overseas offering and listing will be deemed as an indirect overseas
offering and listing by a domestic enterprise: (1) any of the total assets, net assets, revenue or profits of
the domestic operating entities of the issuer in the most recent accounting year accounts for more than 50%
of the corresponding figure in the issuer’s audited consolidated financial statements for the same period;
and (2) its major operational activities are carried out in China or its main places of business are located
in China, or a majority of the senior management in charge of operation and management of the issuer are
Chinese citizens or are domiciled in China. The filing is required to be conducted within three business
days after the submission of the application for initial public offering and listing overseas to the overseas
regulators. Our PRC Legal Advisor is of the view that this Listing shall be deemed as an indirect overseas
offering and listing by PRC domestic enterprise, and we are required to submit filings with the CSRC
within three business days after we submit application for this Listing. We submitted the required filing
documents to the CSRC on July 12, 2023 and on October 19, 2023, the CSRC issued a notification on our
completion of the PRC filing procedures for the listing of our Shares on the Stock Exchange and the
Global Offering. As advised by our PRC Legal Advisor, no other approvals from the CSRC are required
to be obtained for the listing of our Shares on the Stock Exchange.
SUMMARY
—2 5—


--- page 35 ---
Unless the context otherwise requires, the following expressions have the following meanings
in this prospectus. Certain other terms are explained in the section headed “Glossary” in this
prospectus.
“2021 Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme”
the share option scheme adopted by our Company on November
23, 2021, the principal terms of which are summarized in “2021
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme” in Appendix IV to this prospectus
“2023 Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme”
the share option scheme adopted by our Company on March 22,
2023, the principal terms of which are summarized in “2023
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme” in Appendix IV to this prospectus
“Accountants’ Report” the accountants’ report from the Reporting Accountants, the text of
which is set out in Appendix I to this prospectus
“affiliate” any other person, directly or indirectly, controlling or controlled by
or under direct or indirect common control with such specified
person
“AFRC” Accounting and Financial Reporting Council
“Application Form(s)” GREEN Application Form(s) in relation to the Hong Kong Public
Offering and BLUE Application Form(s) in relation to the
Preferential Offering
“Articles of Association” or
“Articles”
our second amended and restated articles of association,
conditionally approved and adopted on October 30, 2023 effective
on the Listing Date, and as amended from time to time, a summary
of which is contained in Appendix III to this prospectus
“Assured Entitlement” the entitlement of the Qualifying WXB Shareholders to apply for
the Reserved Shares on an assured basis pursuant to the
Preferential Offering determined on the basis of their respective
shareholdings in WuXi Biologics on the Record Date
“Audit Committee” the audit committee of the Board
“BCD business unit” the bioconjugate drug business unit of our Group or the WXB
Group prior to its transfer to our Group, as the context requires
“Beneficial WXB Shareholder(s)” any beneficial owner(s) of shares of WuXi Biologics whose shares
of WuXi Biologics are registered, as shown in the register of
members of WuXi Biologics, in the name of a registered
shareholder of WuXi Biologics on the Record Date
DEFINITIONS
—2 6—


--- page 36 ---
“Biologics (Shanghai)” WuXi Biologics (Shanghai) Co., Ltd.* (ʮ
̡), a limited liability company established in the PRC on January
6, 2015, a wholly-owned subsidiary of WuXi Biologics
“Biologics Holdings” WuXi Biologics Holdings Limited, a business company
incorporated with limited liability under the laws of the BVI on
December 17, 2015, a substantial shareholder of WuXi Biologics
“BLUE Application Form(s)” the application form(s) to be sent to the Qualifying WXB
Shareholders to subscribe for the Reserved Shares pursuant to the
Preferential Offering
“Board” or “Board of Directors” the board of directors of our Company
“business day” any day (other than a Saturday, Sunday or public holiday) on which
banks in Hong Kong are generally open for business
“BVI” the British Virgin Islands
“CAGR” compound annual growth rate
“Capital Market Intermediaries” or
“Capital Market
Intermediary(ies)” or “CMI(s)”
the capital market intermediaries participating in the Global
Offering and has the meaning ascribed thereto under the Listing
Rules
“Cayman Companies Act” the Companies Act, Cap 22 (Act 3 of 1961, as consolidated and
revised) of the Cayman Islands as amended, supplemented, or
otherwise modified from time to time
“CCASS” the Central Clearing and Settlement System established and
operated by HKSCC
“CCASS Clearing Participant” a person admitted to participate in CCASS as a direct clearing
participant or a general clearing participant
“CCASS Custodian Participant” a person admitted to participate in CCASS as a custodian
participant
DEFINITIONS
—2 7—


--- page 37 ---
“CCASS EIPO ” the application for the Hong Kong Offer Shares to be issued in the
name of HKSCC Nominees and deposited directly into CCASS to
be credited to your or a designated CCASS Participant’s stock
account through causing HKSCC Nominees to apply on your
behalf, including by (i) instructing your broker or custodian who
is a CCASS Clearing Participant or a CCASS Custodian
Participant to give electronic application instructions via CCASS
terminals to apply for the Hong Kong Offer Shares on your behalf,
or (ii) if you are an existing CCASS Investor Participant, giving
electronic application instructions through the CCASS Internet
System ( https://ip.ccass.com ) or through the CCASS Phone
System by calling at +852 2979 7888 (using the procedures in
HKSCC’s “An Operating Guide for Investor Participants” in effect
from time to time). HKSCC can also input electronic application
instructions for CCASS Investor Participants through HKSCC’s
Customer Service Centre at 1/F., One & Two Exchange Square, 8
Connaught Place, Central, Hong Kong by completing an input
request
“CCASS Investor Participant” a person admitted to participate in CCASS as an investor
participant who may be an individual or joint individuals or a
corporation
“CCASS Participant” a CCASS Clearing Participant, a CCASS Custodian Participant or
a CCASS Investor Participant
“China” or “the PRC” the People’s Republic of China excluding, for the purpose of this
prospectus, Hong Kong, Macau and Taiwan
“Companies Ordinance” the Companies Ordinance (Chapter 622 of the Laws of Hong
Kong), as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from
time to time
“Companies (Winding Up and
Miscellaneous Provisions)
Ordinance”
the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions)
Ordinance (Chapter 32 of the Laws of Hong Kong), as amended,
supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time
“Company,” “our Company,”
“Group,” “our Group,” “we” or
“us”
WuXi XDC Cayman Inc. (ʮ̡*), an
exempted company incorporated under the laws of Cayman Islands
with limited liability on December 14, 2020, and, except where the
context indicated otherwise, all of its subsidiaries and companies
whose financial results have been consolidated and accounted as
the subsidiaries of our Company
DEFINITIONS
—2 8—


--- page 38 ---
“Controlling Shareholder(s)” has the meaning ascribed thereto under the Listing Rules and
unless the context requires otherwise, refers to WuXi Biologics,
WuXi AppTec, WuXi AppTec (Shanghai), STA and STA
Pharmaceutical, or any one of them
“Director(s)” the director(s) of our Company or any one of them
“EMA” the European Medicines Agency
“ESG Committee” the ESG committee of the Board
“FDA” the U.S. Food and Drug Administration
“Frost & Sullivan” Frost & Sullivan (Beijing) Inc., Shanghai Branch Co., the industry
consultant of our Company
“Global Offering” the Hong Kong Public Offering and the International Offering
“GREEN Application Form(s)” the application form(s) to be completed by the White Form eIPO
Service Provider designated by our Company, Computershare
Hong Kong Investor Services Limited
“HK$” or “Hong Kong dollars” Hong Kong dollars, the lawful currency of Hong Kong
“HKSCC” Hong Kong Securities Clearing Company Limited
“HKSCC Nominees” HKSCC Nominees Limited, a wholly-owned subsidiary of HKSCC
“Hong Kong” the Hong Kong Special Administrative Region of the PRC
“Hong Kong Offer Shares” the 17,845,000 Shares being initially offered for subscription in the
Hong Kong Public Offering, subject to reallocation
“Hong Kong Public Offering” the offer of the Hong Kong Offer Shares for subscription by the
public in Hong Kong
“Hong Kong Share Registrar” Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services Limited
“Hong Kong Underwriters” the underwriters of the Hong Kong Public Offering listed in
“Underwriting — Hong Kong Underwriters”
DEFINITIONS
—2 9—


--- page 39 ---
“Hong Kong Underwriting
Agreement”
the underwriting agreement dated November 6, 2023, relating to
the Hong Kong Public Offering and entered into by, among others,
the Joint Sponsors, the Overall Coordinators, the Hong Kong
Underwriters, our Company and WuXi Biologics, as further
described in “Underwriting — Underwriting Arrangements and
Expenses — Hong Kong Public Offering” in this prospectus
“IFRSs” International Financial Reporting Standards
“independent third party(ies)” a party, who/which, to the best of our Directors’ knowledge,
information and belief, having made all reasonable enquiries,
which is not a connected person (as defined in the Listing Rules)
of our Company
“International Offer Shares” the 160,601,000 Shares being initially offered by our Company at
the Offer Price in the International Offering (including, for the
avoidance of doubt, 8,922,000 Reserved Shares under the
Preferential Offering), together with, where relevant, any
additional Shares which may be issued by our Company pursuant
to the exercise of the Over-allotment Option, subject to any
adjustment or reallocation
“International Offering” the offer of the International Offer Shares at the Offer Price outside
the United States in offshore transactions in accordance with
Regulation S and in the United States to QIBs only in reliance on
Rule 144A or any other available exemption from registration
under the U.S. Securities Act, as further described in the section
headed “Structure of the Global Offering”
“International Underwriters” the group of underwriters that are expected to enter into the
International Underwriting Agreement to underwrite the
International Offering
“International Underwriting
Agreement”
the international underwriting agreement relating to the
International Offering, which is expected to be entered into by,
among others, our Company, WuXi Biologics, the Overall
Coordinators, the Joint Global Coordinators and the International
Underwriters, as further described in “Underwriting —
Underwriting Arrangements and Expenses — International
Offering” in this prospectus
DEFINITIONS
—3 0—


--- page 40 ---
“Joint Bookrunners” and
“Joint Lead Managers”
Morgan Stanley Asia Limited, Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C., J.P .
Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited (in relation to the Hong
Kong Public Offering only), J.P . Morgan Securities plc (in relation
to the International Offering only), (in alphabetical order) China
International Capital Corporation Hong Kong Securities Limited,
Citigroup Global Markets Asia Limited (in relation to the Hong
Kong Public Offering only), Citigroup Global Markets Limited (in
relation to the International Offering only) and Huatai Financial
Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited
“Joint Global Coordinators” Morgan Stanley Asia Limited, Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C., J.P .
Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited, (in alphabetical order)
China International Capital Corporation Hong Kong Securities
Limited, Citigroup Global Markets Asia Limited and Huatai
Financial Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited
“Joint Sponsors” Morgan Stanley Asia Limited, Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C. and
J.P . Morgan Securities (Far East) Limited
“Latest Practicable Date” October 30, 2023, being the latest practicable date prior to the
printing of this prospectus for the purpose of ascertaining certain
information contained in this prospectus
“Listing” the listing of the Shares on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange
“Listing Committee” the Listing Committee of the Stock Exchange
“Listing Date” the date, expected to be on or about Friday, November 17, 2023 on
which the Shares are listed on the Stock Exchange and from which
dealings in the Shares are permitted to commence on the Stock
Exchange
“Listing Rules” the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on The Stock
Exchange of Hong Kong Limited, as amended or supplemented
from time to time
“Memorandum” or “Memorandum
of Association
our second amended and restated memorandum of association,
conditionally approved and adopted on October 30, 2023 effective
on the Listing Date, as amended, supplemented or otherwise
modified from time to time
“MOF” the Ministry of Finance of the PRC (௅)
“MOFCOM” the Ministry of Commerce of the PRC ( ʕശɛ͏΍ձ਷ਠਕ௅)
“NMPA” National Medical Product Administration (္ຖ၍ଣ҅)
DEFINITIONS
—3 1—


--- page 41 ---
“Nomination Committee” the nomination committee of the Board
“Non-Qualifying WXB
Shareholders”
WXB Shareholder(s) whose names appeared in the register of
members of WuXi Biologics on the Record Date and whose
addresses as shown in such register in any of the Specified
Territories, and any WXB Shareholder(s) or Beneficial WXB
Shareholder(s) at that time who are otherwise known by WuXi
Biologics to be resident in any of the Specified Territories
“Offer Price” the final offer price per Offer Share in Hong Kong dollars
(exclusive of brokerage of 1.0%, SFC transaction levy of 0.0027%,
Stock Exchange trading fee of 0.00565% and AFRC Transaction
Levy of 0.00015%) of not more than HK$20.60 and expected to be
not less than HK$19.90, at which Hong Kong Offer Shares are to
be subscribed, to be determined in the manner further described in
“Structure of the Global Offering — Pricing and Allocation” in this
prospectus
“Offer Shares” the Hong Kong Offer Shares and the International Offer Shares
together with, where relevant, any additional Shares which may be
issued by our Company pursuant to the exercise of the Over-
allotment Option
“Ordinary Shares” or “Shares” ordinary shares in the share capital of our Company with a par
value of US$0.00005 each
“Overall Coordinators” Morgan Stanley Asia Limited, Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C. and
J.P . Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited
“Over-allotment Option” the option expected to be granted by our Company to the
International Underwriters, exercisable by the Overall
Coordinators (for themselves and on behalf of the International
Underwriters), pursuant to which our Company may be required to
allot and issue up to an aggregate of 19,158,500 Shares
(representing approximately 10.74% of the Offer Shares initially
offered) at the Offer Price to, among other things, cover over-
allocations in the International Offering, if any, the details of
which are described in the section headed “Underwriting” in this
prospectus
“Payload & Linker Business” the payload & linker business, which includes the customer
resources, personnel and assets relating to such business, acquired
by our Group from STA Pharmaceutical
DEFINITIONS
—3 2—


--- page 42 ---
“Payload-Linkers Master Services
Agreement”
the payload-linkers master services framework agreement entered
into between our Company and WuXi AppTec on November 3,
2023, pursuant to which the WXA T Group will provide research
and development and manufacturing services in relation to
payload-linkers and supply the related intermediate products to our
Group for use in our ADC CRDMO services
“PRC Legal Advisor” Fangda Partners, being the legal advisor to the PRC laws
“Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes” collectively, the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and the 2023
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
“Preferential Offering” the preferential offering to the Qualifying WXB Shareholders of
8,922,000 Shares (representing approximately 5.0% of the Offer
Shares initially being offered under the Global Offering) as an
Assured Entitlement out of the International Offer Shares being
offered under the International Offering at the Offer Price, on and
subject to the terms and conditions set out in this prospectus, as
further described in “Structure of the Global Offering — The
Preferential Offering”
“Price Determination Date” the date, expected to be on or around Friday, November 10, 2023
(Hong Kong time), when the Offer Price is determined and, in any
event, no later than Wednesday, November 15, 2023
“QIBs” qualified institutional buyers within the meaning of Rule 144A
“Qualifying WXB Shareholder(s)” WXB Shareholder(s) whose name(s) appeared in the register of
members of WuXi Biologics on the Record Date, other than
Non-Qualifying WXB Shareholders
“Record Date” Monday, November 6, 2023, being the record date for determining
the Assured Entitlement of the Qualifying WXB Shareholders to
the Reserved Shares
“Regulation S” Regulation S under the U.S. Securities Act
“related parties” has the meaning as set out in the paragraph headed “Related Party
Transactions and Balances” under Note 37 to the Accountants’
Report set out in Appendix I to this prospectus
“Remaining WXB Group” WuXi Biologics and its subsidiaries, excluding our Group
“Remuneration Committee” the remuneration committee of the Board
DEFINITIONS
—3 3—


--- page 43 ---
“Reserved Shares” the 8,922,000 Offer Shares being offered by the Company to the
Qualifying WXB Shareholders pursuant to the Preferential
Offering as the Assured Entitlement at the Offer Price, representing
approximately 5.0% of the Offer Shares being offered under the
Global Offering (without taking into account any Shares which
may be issued or allotted pursuant to the Over-allotment Option),
which are to be allocated out of the Shares being offered under the
International Offering
“RMB” or “Renminbi” Renminbi, the lawful currency of the PRC
“Rule 144A” Rule 144A under the U.S. Securities Act
“SA T” the State Administration of Taxation of the PRC (೼ਕᐼ
҅)
“SFC” the Securities and Futures Commission of Hong Kong
“SFO” the Securities and Futures Ordinance Chapter 571 of the Laws of
Hong Kong, as amended, supplemented or otherwise modified
from time to time
“Shareholder(s)” holder(s) of Shares
“Specified Territories” jurisdiction outside Hong Kong where, taking into account the
legal restrictions under the applicable laws or requirements of the
relevant regulatory body or stock exchange of such jurisdiction,
WuXi Biologics and our Company consider the exclusion of the
shareholders of WuXi Biologics with registered addresses in or
who are otherwise known by WuXi Biologics to be residents of,
such jurisdiction from the Preferential Offering to be necessary or
expedient
“Spin-off” the separate listing of our Shares on the Main Board by way of the
Preferential Offering and the Global Offering
“STA” Shanghai SynTheAll Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd.* (ٰ
ʮ̡), a limited liability company established in the PRC on
January 23, 2003, a non-wholly owned subsidiary of WuXi AppTec
and one of our Controlling Shareholders
“STA Changzhou” Changzhou SynTheAll Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd.* ( ੬ψΥΌᖹุ
ʮ̡), a limited liability company established in the PRC on
September 29, 2013, a non-wholly owned subsidiary of WuXi
AppTec
DEFINITIONS
—3 4—


--- page 44 ---
“STA Pharmaceutical” STA Pharmaceutical Hong Kong Investment Limited* (࠰
ʮ̡), a limited liability company incorporated in
Hong Kong on November 30, 2020, a non-wholly owned
subsidiary of WuXi AppTec and one of our Controlling
Shareholders
“Stabilizing Manager” Morgan Stanley Asia Limited
“Stock Exchange” or “Hong Kong
Stock Exchange”
The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited
“Strategy Committee” the strategy committee of the Board
“Takeovers Code” the Code on Takeovers and Mergers issued by the SFC, as
amended, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time
“Track Record Period” the period consisting of the three years ended December 31, 2022
and the six months ended June 30, 2023
“Underwriters” the Hong Kong Underwriters and the International Underwriters
“Underwriting Agreements” the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement and the International
Underwriting Agreement
“U.S.” or “United States” the United States of America
“U.S. Securities Act” the United States Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the rules
and regulations promulgated thereunder
“US$” or “U.S. dollar(s)” United States dollar(s), the lawful currency of the United States
“V A T” the PRC value-added tax
“White Form eIPO ” the application for Hong Kong Offer Shares to be issued in the
applicant’s own name, submitted online through the designated
website of the White Form eIPO at www.eipo.com.hk
“White Form eIPO Service
Provider”
Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services Limited
“WuXi AppTec” WuXi AppTec Co., Ltd.* (ʮ̡), a
joint stock company with limited liability incorporated in the PRC
on December 1, 2000, with its A shares being listed on the
Shanghai Stock Exchange (SSE stock code: 603259) and its H
shares being listed on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange
(HKEx stock code: 2359), one of our Controlling Shareholders
DEFINITIONS
—3 5—


--- page 45 ---
“WuXi AppTec (Shanghai)” WuXi AppTec (Shanghai) Co., Ltd. (ʮ
̡), a limited liability company incorporated in the PRC on
April 2, 2002, a wholly-owned subsidiary of WuXi AppTec and one
of our Controlling Shareholders
“WuXi Biologics” WuXi Biologics (Cayman) Inc. (ʮ̡)*, an
exempted company incorporated with limited liability in the
Cayman Islands on February 27, 2014, with its shares being listed
on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange (HKEx stock code:
2269), one of our Controlling Shareholders
“WuXi Biologics Investment” WuXi Biologics Investment Limited (ʮ̡), a
limited liability company incorporated in Hong Kong on
November 18, 2020, a wholly-owned subsidiary of WuXi Biologics
“WXA T Group” Wuxi AppTec together with its subsidiaries
“WXB Group” WuXi Biologics together with its subsidiaries
“WXB Share(s)” ordinary share(s) in the capital of WuXi Biologics with nominal
value of US$1/120,000 each
“WXB Shareholder(s)” holder(s) of WXB Share(s)
“XDC Changzhou” WuXi XDC (Changzhou) Co., Ltd.* (ࠢ
ʮ̡), a limited liability company established in the PRC on July
2, 2021, a wholly-owned subsidiary of our Company
“XDC Hong Kong” WuXi XDC Hong Kong Limited, a limited liability company
incorporated in Hong Kong on June 7, 2021, a wholly-owned
subsidiary of our Company
“XDC Shanghai” WuXi XDC Shanghai Co., Ltd.* (ʮ
̡), a limited liability company established in the PRC on March
31, 2021, a wholly-owned subsidiary of our Company
“XDC Singapore” WuXi XDC Singapore Private Limited, a limited liability company
incorporated in Singapore on November 16, 2022, a wholly-owned
subsidiary of our Company
“XDC Wuxi” WuXi XDC Co., Ltd.* (ʮ̡), a
limited liability company incorporated in the PRC on March 13,
2018, a wholly-owned subsidiary of our Company
* For identification purpose only
DEFINITIONS
—3 6—


--- page 46 ---
In this prospectus, the terms “associate,” “close associate,” “connected person,” “core connected
person,” “connected transaction,” “controlling shareholder ,” “subsidiaries” and “substantial
shareholder” shall have the meanings given to such terms in the Listing Rules, unless the context
otherwise requires.
Certain amounts and percentage figures included in this prospectus have been subject to rounding.
Accordingly, figures shown as totals in certain tables may not be an arithmetic aggregation of the figures
preceding them. Any discrepancies in any table or chart between the total shown and the sum of the
amounts listed are due to rounding.
For ease of reference, the names of the PRC-incorporated companies or entities or PRC laws or
regulations have been included in this prospectus in both the Chinese and English languages; in the event
of any inconsistency, the Chinese versions shall prevail.
DEFINITIONS
—3 7—


--- page 47 ---
This glossary contains certain technical terms used in this prospectus in connection with us
and our business. Such terms and their meaning may not correspond to standard industry definitions
or usage.
“ACC” antibody-chelator conjugate
“antibody” or “Ab” large, Y -shaped protein produced mainly by plasma cells that is
used by the immune system to identify and neutralize pathogens
such as bacteria and viruses
“antibody drug conjugates” or
“ADCs”
an emerging class of highly potent biopharmaceutical drugs
designed as a targeted therapy combining the specific targeting
capabilities of monoclonal antibodies with the cancer-killing
ability of cytotoxic drugs for the treatment of cancer
“AOC” antibody-oligonucleotide conjugate
“assay” or “bioassay” an investigative analytical process in medicine, pharmacology or
biology that aims to identify either the qualitative or quantitative
presence or function of the analytical target, which can be a drug
or biochemical substance or a cell in an organism or organic
sample
“bioconjugate” complex molecule engineered by covalently attaching two or more
biological components in order to achieve improved targeting,
efficacy and pharmacokinetics for therapeutic applications
“biohazardous” of or relating to the health risk posed by the possible release of a
pathogen into the environment
“biologics” a subset of pharmaceuticals that are composed of a mixture of
sugars, proteins, nucleic acids or complex compositions and may
be made from biological sources
“Biologics License Application” or
“BLA”
a request for permission to introduce, or deliver for introduction, a
biologic product for commercialization in a specific jurisdiction
“bispecific antibody” artificial protein that is composed of fragments of two different
monoclonal antibodies and consequently binds to two different
types of antigen
“chemistry, manufacturing and
controls” or “CMC”
an important and detailed section in a dossier to support clinical
studies conducted in human and marketing applications
“clinical trial” a type of research carried out on human that studies new tests and
treatments and evaluates their effects on human health outcomes
GLOSSARY
—3 8—


--- page 48 ---
“conjugation” the joining of two compounds
“contract research, development
and manufacturing organization”
or “CRDMO”
a company that mainly provides discovery, CMC and
manufacturing services in the pharmaceutical and/or biotech
industry
“contract testing, development and
manufacturing organization” or
“CTDMO”
a company that mainly provides testing, CMC and manufacturing
services in the pharmaceutical and/or biotech industry
“Current Good Manufacturing
Practice” or “cGMP”
regulations enforced by the FDA on pharmaceutical and biotech
firms to ensure that the products produced meet specific
requirements for identity, strength, quality and purity
“drug product” or “DP” a dosage form that contains an active drug ingredient
“drug product formulation” the process in which different chemical substances, including the
active drug, are combined to produce a final medicinal product
“drug substance” or “DS” an active ingredient that is intended to furnish pharmacological
activity or other direct effect in the diagnosis, cure, mitigation,
treatment, or prevention of disease or to affect the structure or any
function of the human body, but does not include intermediates
used in the synthesis of such ingredient
“drug-to-antibody ratio” or “DAR” refers to the average number of drug molecules that are attached to
each antibody molecule
“enzyme-linked immunosorbent
assay” or “ELISA”
a commonly used laboratory test that measures the concentration of
an antigen in a sample
“FDA” the U.S. Food and Drug Administration
“fill and finish” the last process in the production of pharmaceuticals that involves
the filling of the bottle and any post-filling processes
“global ADC and broader
bioconjugates outsourcing
services market”
the global outsourcing research, development and manufacturing
services market for both ADC and broader bioconjugates
“Good Laboratory Practices” or
“GLP”
a quality system of management controls for research laboratories
and organizations to try to ensure the uniformity, consistency,
reliability, reproducibility, quality and integrity of chemical and
pharmaceuticals non-clinical safety tests
GLOSSARY
—3 9—


--- page 49 ---
“HPLC” High Performance Liquid Chromatography, a form of column
chromatography that pumps a sample mixture in a solvent at high
pressure through a column with chromatographic packing material
“IND” Investigational New Drug, an application submitted to the FDA or
the NMPA to seek permission or no objection to ship unapproved,
experimental drug or biologic agents across jurisdictions (usually
to clinical investigators) for use in clinical studies before a
marketing application for the drug has been approved
“in vitro” Latin for “in glass”; studies in vitro are conducted using
components of an organism that have been isolated from their
usual biological surroundings, such as microorganisms, cells or
biological molecules
“in vivo” Latin for “within the living”; studies in vivo are those in which the
effects of various biological entities are tested on whole, living
organisms as opposed to a partial or dead organism, or those done
in vitro (“within the glass”), i.e., in a laboratory environment using
test tubes, petri dishes etc.
“integrated projects” post-discovery projects (i.e., in preclinical and subsequent stages)
that involve clinical or commercial manufacturing
“linker” a chemical group that covalently attaches the payload to the
biomolecule in a bioconjugate, serving as a flexible tether between
the two components
“lot release testing” the process of evaluating each batch of a product before giving
approval for its release onto the market
“McMMAE” Maleimidocaproyl-monomethylauristatin E
“McMMAF” Maleimidocaproyl-monomethylauristatin F
“MMAE” Monomethyl auristatin E
“modality” a type of treatment for a disease or medical condition
“molecule” an electrically neutral group of two or more atoms held together by
chemical bonds
GLOSSARY
—4 0—


--- page 50 ---
“monoclonal antibody” or “mAb” antibodies capable of binding to specific antigens and inducing
immunological responses against the target antigens. Monoclonal
antibodies when used as a cancer treatment have the ability to bind
only to cancer cell-specific antigens and interrupt the growth of
cancer cells to achieve efficient treatment with low dosages and
less toxic side effects than traditional chemotherapy
“NMPA” National Medical Products Administration (္ຖ၍ଣ҅)
and its predecessor, the China Food and Drug Administration ( ਷
္ຖ၍ଣᐼ҅) from 2013 to 2018 and the State Food
and Drug Administration (္ຖ၍ଣ҅) from 2003 to
2013
“occupational exposure band” or
“OEB”
a process that is used to quickly and accurately assign chemicals
into specific categories (bands), which correspond to a range of
exposure concentrations designed to protect worker health. The
OEB system typically ranges from OEB1 (least hazardous) to
OEB5 (most hazardous)
“oncology” the study and treatment of tumors
“outsourcing rate” the outsourcing rate is calculated by dividing the size of the
relevant outsourcing services market of a modality by the total
outsourceable research, development and manufacturing expenses
on that modality
“payload” the component that elicits the desired therapeutic response, which
is attached to the antibody by a linker and is released at the desired
target
“payload-linker” payload, linker and/or payload-linker, which combines both the
payload and the linker, as the context requires. Conjugation, which
typically refers to the combination of the antibody intermediate
and payload-linker and is one of the most important steps in
generating bioconjugates, is a separate step from combining the
payload and linker molecules
“PCC” preclinical candidate
“PDC” peptide-drug conjugate
“PMDA” the Pharmaceuticals and Medical Devices Agency of Japan
“process performance
qualification” or “PPQ”
a part of the validation process which ensures that a certain
process, system, or method used in production maintains the
desired level of compliance at all stages
GLOSSARY
—4 1—


--- page 51 ---
“PROTAC” proteolysis targeting chimera, a molecule that induces selective
intracellular proteolysis
“preclinical” of or relating to a stage preceding clinical stage
“R&D” research and development
“stability studies” studies on the capability of a drug in a specific container/closure
system to remain within its physical, chemical, microbiological
therapeutic and toxicological specification
“synthesis” the production of chemical compounds by reaction from simpler
materials
“therapeutic window” the dose range of a drug that provides safe and effective therapy
GLOSSARY
—4 2—


--- page 52 ---
We have included in this prospectus forward-looking statements. Statements that are not
historical facts, including statements about our intentions, beliefs, expectations or predictions for
the future, are forward-looking statements.
This prospectus contains forward-looking statements that are, by their nature, subject to significant
risks and uncertainties, including the risk factors described in this prospectus. Forward-looking statements
can be identified by words such as “may,” “will,” “should,” “would,” “could,” “believe,” “expect,”
“anticipate,” “intend,” “plan,” “continue,” “seek,” “estimate” or the negative of these terms or other
comparable terminology. Examples of forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to,
statements we make regarding our projections, business strategy and development activities as well as
other capital spending, financing sources, the effects of regulation, expectations concerning future
operations, margins, profitability and competition. The foregoing is not an exclusive list of all
forward-looking statements we make.
Forward-looking statements are based on our current expectations and assumptions regarding our
business, the economy and other future conditions. We give no assurance that these expectations and
assumptions will prove to have been correct. Because forward-looking statements relate to the future, they
are subject to inherent uncertainties, risks and changes in circumstances that are difficult to predict. Our
results may differ materially from those contemplated by the forward-looking statements. They are neither
statements of historical fact nor guarantees or assurances of future performance. We caution you therefore
against placing undue reliance on any of these forward-looking statements. Important factors that could
cause actual results to differ materially from those in the forward-looking statements include regional,
national or global political economic, business, competitive, market and regulatory conditions and the
following:
 our business prospects;
 our business strategies and plans to achieve these strategies;
 future developments, trends and conditions in and competitive environment for the industries
and markets in which we operate;
 general economic, political and business conditions in the markets where we operate;
 our financial condition and performance;
 our capital expenditure plans;
 changes to the regulatory environment, policies, operating conditions of and general outlook in
the industries and markets in which we operate;
 our expectations with respect to our ability to acquire and maintain regulatory licenses or
permits;
 the amount and nature of, and potential for, future development of our business;
FORW ARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
—4 3—


--- page 53 ---
 the actions of and developments affecting our competitors;
 certain statement in the sections headed “Risk Factors,” “Industry Overview,” “Regulatory
Overview,” “Business,” “Financial Information,” “Relationship with Our Controlling
Shareholders” and “Future Plans and Use of Proceeds” with respect to trends in interest rates,
foreign exchange rates, prices, operations, margins, risk management and overall market
trends.
Any forward-looking statement made by us in this prospectus speaks only as of the date on which
it is made. Factors or events that could cause our actual results to differ may emerge from time to time,
and it is not possible for us to predict all of them. Subject to the requirements of applicable laws, rules
and regulations, we undertake no obligation to update any forward-looking statement, whether as a result
of new information, future developments or otherwise. All forward-looking statements contained in this
prospectus are qualified by reference to this cautionary statement.
FORW ARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
—4 4—


--- page 54 ---
Potential investors should read and consider carefully all the information set out in this
prospectus, and, in particular , should evaluate the following risks and uncertainties before deciding
to make any investment in our Shares. You should pay attention to the fact that we conduct
substantial operations in China where the legal and regulatory environment is commensurate with
its own economic and social conditions. Any of the risks and uncertainties listed below could have
a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition or on the trading
price of our Shares, and could cause you to lose all or part of your investment. The risks and
uncertainties identified below are not the only ones we face. Additional risks and uncertainties not
presently known to us or that we currently deem immaterial may also affect our business and results
of operations.
Our business and operations involve certain risks and uncertainties, many of which are beyond our
control. These risks can be broadly categorized into (1) risks relating to our business and industry, (2) risks
relating to our relationship with the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group, (3) risks relating to
conducting business in China and other jurisdictions where we operate, and (4) risks relating to the Global
Offering.
RISKS RELATING TO OUR BUSINESS AND INDUSTRY
We are dependent on our customers’ spending on and demand for our services. A reduction in
customer spending or demand and uncertainties of future advancements of ADCs and other
bioconjugates beyond ADC could have a material adverse effect on our business, particularly given
that its development is still at a preliminary stage.
The success of our business depends primarily on the number and size of service contracts with our
customers, primarily pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies that develop and commercialize ADCs
and other bioconjugates. Over the past several years, we have benefited from an increased demand for our
services as a result of the continued growth of the global ADC and broader bioconjugate market, and a
greater degree of development and manufacturing outsourcing by our customers. A slowing or reversal of
any of these trends could have a material adverse effect on the demand for our services. Specifically, the
global ADC and broader bioconjugate market is still at a nascent stage of development, and the
pharmacological profile and efficacy of this novel treatment may be subject to further clinical validation.
In particular, the development of other bioconjugates beyond ADC is still at a preliminary stage, facing
uncertainties to progress from traditional ADCs to broader bioconjugates and application expansion in
terms of timing, market acceptance and likelihood of obtaining approval. If ADCs and other bioconjugates
are perceived to be less viable than other drug modalities, customer demands for our CRDMO services for
ADCs and other bioconjugates may decline, which may materially and adversely affect our business,
results of operations and financial condition.
In addition to the foregoing industry trends, our customers’ willingness and ability to utilize our
services are also subject to, among other things, their own financial performance, changes in their
available resources, access to capital, their decisions to acquire in-house discovery, development or
commercial manufacturing capacity, their spending priorities, their budgetary policies and practices, and
their need to develop new products, which, in turn, are dependent upon a number of factors, including their
competitors’ research, development and product initiatives and the anticipated market uptake, and clinical
and reimbursement scenarios for specific products and therapeutic areas. We may experience reduction in
RISK FACTORS
—4 5—


--- page 55 ---
spending by domestic customers due to the lack of sufficient funding and overseas customers choosing not
to engage Chinese companies for the provision of ADC CRDMO services leading to the narrowing of our
customer base to domestic customers. In addition, consolidation in the industries in which our customers
operate may also impact such spending as customers integrate acquired operations, including R&D
departments and manufacturing operations. Any reduction in customer spending on CRDMO services for
their ADC and other bioconjugate products as a result of these and other factors could have a material
adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Competition may intensify as the industry grows and attracts more market entrants.
The global ADC and broader bioconjugate market is booming, benefiting the growth of the ADC and
broader bioconjugates outsourcing services industry as a whole. However, the fast evolving industry may
attract an influx of new entrants, which could substantially increase competition within the industry. These
new entrants may include established outsourcing service providers from other sectors as well as new
start-ups, and each may bring substantial financial resources, advanced technologies or innovative
business strategies. If these new market entrants offer lower prices, superior technology or more
comprehensive service capabilities, we may be forced to adjust our own pricing strategies, upgrade our
service capabilities, and consequently incur significant expenses and expenditure, which may not
necessarily provide the return as anticipated. Moreover, outsourcing service providers with a business
focus on payload-linkers and antibody intermediates may compete with us for customers’ budget on
outsourced discovery, development and manufacturing for ADCs and other bioconjugates. If we are unable
to compete effectively against these new market entrants, our business, results of operations, financial
condition and prospects may be adversely affected.
We may face customer attrition as a result of fierce market competition.
Given the project-based nature of our services, our customers are not obligated to stay with us for
subsequent development stages. Customers who engage our services during the early stages of their
projects, such as the discovery or preclinical stages, may not necessarily continue their association with
us for subsequent stages of development. As they progress, customers may evaluate our performance and,
based on comparative quality, pricing, or technological advantage, may decide to transition to other
CRDMOs. As most of our ongoing projects are in early stages, which are subject to higher risks of
experimental failure, such projects may not be able to progress to subsequent developmental stages and
expose us to higher risks of customer attribution. As the competition within the ADC and broader
bioconjugates outsourcing services industry intensifies, we cannot assure you that we will maintain our
competitive edge in every aspect of our service offerings. Our competitors may target our customers by
offering more attractive service solutions in terms of pricing, technology or service scope, and we may be
unable to beat their offers and consequently face customer attrition. If we are unable to maintain our
competitive position and fail to retain our customers as they progress to subsequent development stages,
our business, financial condition, and results of operations could be adversely affected. See also “— We
may fail to retain our existing customers.”
RISK FACTORS
—4 6—


--- page 56 ---
We may not be successful in developing new technologies and improving existing technologies to
maintain our competitive position.
The global ADC and broader bioconjugate industry is characterized by rapid technological changes.
The development of new ADCs and other bioconjugates relies on advancements of several technologies,
such as linker and conjugation technology, mAb discovery and manufacturing, and the introduction of new
payloads that are powerful against tumor cells with limited side effects. Demand for our services may
change in ways that we may not be able to anticipate because of evolving industry standards or as a result
of evolving customer needs that are increasingly sophisticated and varied or because of the introduction
by competitors of new services and technologies. To maintain our technological advantages and expand
our discovery and development capabilities, we have invested significant amounts of capital and resources
into our R&D activities, through which we have mastered over 10 conjugation technologies and
established our growing library of ready-made payload-linkers. In 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months
ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, our research and development expenses were RMB4.1 million, RMB13.8
million, RMB33.8 million, RMB11.1 million and RMB29.7 million, respectively. We must continue to
invest significant amounts of human and capital resources to develop or acquire technologies that will
allow us to enhance the scope and quality of our services. See “Business — Our Strategies — Continue
to focus on cutting-edge technologies through internal R&D and strategic partnerships” for details.
However, we cannot assure you that we will be able to develop, enhance or adapt to new technologies and
methodologies. Any failure to do so may make our techniques and services obsolete, which could
significantly reduce demand for our services and harm our business and prospects. Even if we are able to
successfully develop new technologies or optimize existing technologies after we spend significant time
and efforts on research and development, we cannot guarantee you that we will definitely be able to
generate sufficient return on our investment.
In addition, to develop and market our new technologies successfully, we must accurately assess and
meet customers’ needs, make significant capital expenditures, optimize the process of discovery, testing,
development and manufacturing of ADC and broader bioconjugate drugs to predict and control costs, hire,
train and retain the necessary personnel, and obtain required regulatory clearances or approvals. If we fail
to create demand for or incorrectly predict customer demand for new technologies, our future business,
results of operations, financial condition and prospects could be materially and adversely affected.
Our growth strategies and business expansion may not be successful.
We pursue certain strategies to further grow our business. For more information, see “Business —
Our Strategies.” Pursuing our growth strategies has resulted in, and will continue to result in, substantial
demands on capital and other resources. In addition, managing our growth and executing on our growth
strategies will require, among other things, our ability to continue to innovate and develop advanced
technology in the highly competitive ADC and broader bioconjugate market globally, effective
coordination and integration of our facilities and teams across different sites, successful hiring and
training of personnel, effective cost control, sufficient liquidity, effective and efficient financial and
management control, increased marketing and customer support activities, effective quality control, and
management of our suppliers to leverage our purchasing power. Any failure to execute our growth
strategies or realize our anticipated growth could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results
of operations and prospects.
RISK FACTORS
—4 7—


--- page 57 ---
The success of our business expansion also depends on our customers’ success in launching drug
candidates through development, regulatory approval and commercial manufacturing. Any delay in
regulatory approvals, lower than expected treatment effectiveness, unexpected side effect, low success rate
or lack of patient demand may have a material impact on their demands for our services. If our growth
strategy or business expansion is not successful or sufficient or does not earn a satisfactory return on
investment, our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects could be materially and
adversely affected.
If we fail to implement our expansion plan to enhance our manufacturing capabilities as planned, or
if such plan fails to achieve expected benefits, our business and prospects could be materially and
adversely affected.
We experienced significant increase in the demand for our services during the Track Record Period
and expect such increase to continue. We expect to launch commercial manufacturing of the first ADC
drug in the near future. We provide manufacturing services at different scales, including laboratory scale,
non-GMP pilot scale and cGMP-compliant commercial scale, to support our customers’ non-clinical,
clinical and commercialization needs. We currently rely on our facilities in Shanghai, Changzhou and
Wuxi to manufacture bioconjugate components, drug substances and drug products. We plan to increase
our production capacity by building additional facilities in Wuxi for clinical or commercial manufacturing
of bioconjugate components, drug substances and drug products, which is expected to be completed by the
end of 2023. We also intend to establish a manufacturing base in Singapore to better serve our global
customers. However, we cannot assure you that our expansion plan will be successfully implemented
without delays or at all. Our ability to implement our expansion plan is subject to a number of factors. New
manufacturing facilities may require prior review by regulatory authorities and/or approval of the
manufacturing process and procedures in accordance with applicable requirements. This review may be
costly and time-consuming. In addition, we will need to ensure that our new manufacturing facilities meet
applicable quality standards, such as GLP , GMP and cGMP , for which we may incur substantial costs.
Any failure or delay in implementing any part of our expansion plan may result in a lack of
production capacity to support our growth, market expansion, and the commercialization of our customers’
products, which in turn could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Specifically, if the manufacturing capacity of our existing and future facilities is not sufficient to cover
the volume of antibodies or payload-linkers required by customer and project demands, we may need to
acquire such additional intermediates from other suppliers, including the Remaining WXB Group and the
WXA T Group. Moreover, our plans to increase our production capacity require significant capital
investment, and the actual costs of our expansion plan may exceed our original estimates, which could
materially and adversely affect the realization of expected return on our expenditures. In addition, if we
fail to fully utilize the additional production capacity due to any adverse change to the market
environment, technologies, and relevant policies, our business, results of operations and financial
condition could be materially and adversely affected.
RISK FACTORS
—4 8—


--- page 58 ---
If we are unable to successfully expand or operate in new geographic markets, our growth, results
of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected.
During the Track Record Period, we generated a majority of our revenue from customers in the
United States, China and Europe. We intend to further expand our geographic footprint, and specifically,
we intend to establish a manufacturing base in Singapore to meet the growing demand from customers
worldwide and implement a “global dual sourcing” strategy. The legal and regulatory frameworks and
competitive landscapes in Singapore and any other jurisdictions where we may maintain operations in the
future may be different from those of the PRC. We may encounter unforeseeable barriers and challenges,
which may result in a delay to or failure of our expansion plans. In addition, we may not be able to manage
our costs or generate sufficient revenue to justify the time and resources spent on such expansion plan. If
our geographic expansion is unsuccessful, our business operation and financial condition could be
materially and adversely affected.
Our success depends on our ability to attract, train, motivate and retain highly skilled scientists and
other technical personnel.
Our success depends, to a significant extent, on our team of scientists and other technical personnel
and their ability to deliver high-quality and timely services to our customers and keep abreast of
cutting-edge technologies and developments in the global ADC and broader bioconjugate market. We
compete vigorously with pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies, other contract development and
manufacturing companies and research and academic institutions for qualified and experienced scientists
and other technical personnel. In particular, our customers value trained scientists with experience at
renowned pharmaceutical or biotechnology companies. As a result, such scientists are well-sought after by
our competitors and we may face challenges in attracting and retaining skilled scientists and other
technical personnel. We may not be able to hire and retain sufficient skilled and experienced scientists or
other technical personnel at our current level of compensation. As a result, we may need to offer higher
compensation and other benefits, which could materially and adversely affect our profit margin, financial
condition and results of operations. In addition, we may not be successful in training our professionals to
keep pace with changes in customer needs and technological and regulatory standards. Any inability to
attract, motivate, train or retain qualified scientists or other technical personnel may have a material
adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flows and prospects.
The loss of services of our senior management and key scientific personnel could severely disrupt our
business and growth.
Our commercial success depends significantly on the continued service of our senior management.
The loss of any of our senior management or key scientific personnel could have a material adverse effect
on our business and operations. If we lose the services of any senior management members or key
scientific personnel, we may be unable to identify, hire and train suitable qualified replacements and may
incur additional expenses and time to recruit and train new personnel, which could severely disrupt our
business and growth. In addition, although each member of our senior management and key scientific
personnel has signed a non-compete agreement with us, we may not be able to successfully enforce these
clauses should any of them leaves us, which could adversely affect our business operations.
RISK FACTORS
—4 9—


--- page 59 ---
We operate in a highly competitive market, and if we do not compete effectively, our business, results
of operations, financial condition and prospects could be harmed.
The global ADC and broader bioconjugate market is highly competitive and we expect this high level
of competition to be increasingly fierce. As a CRDMO service provider for ADCs and other bioconjugates,
we compete, both domestically and internationally, with other players in the market, such as full-service
or specialty pharmaceutical outsourcing companies, large pharmaceutical companies offering third-party
manufacturing services to fill their excess capacity, and universities and other research institutions. In
addition, some pharmaceutical companies may elect to utilize their own development and manufacturing
capabilities internally rather than outsourcing those functions to us or any of our competitors. We compete
primarily on the basis of scientific expertise, knowledge and experience in research and development,
availability of a broad range of equipment, technology availability (e.g., chemical and biotechnology
means), on-time delivery, compliance with cGMPs, regulatory compliance, cost-effective services and
financial stability. Moreover, we face multi-faceted competition from outsourcing service providers that
focus on other drug modalities for customers’ limited spending on drug discovery. See “— We are
dependent on our customers’ spending on and demand for our services. A reduction in customer spending
or demand and uncertainties of future advancements of ADCs and other bioconjugates beyond ADC could
have a material adverse effect on our business, particularly given that its development is still at a
preliminary stage” for details.
Some of our competitors may have substantially greater financial, marketing, technical or other
resources than we do, which may allow them to respond to changes in market demand more quickly with
new, alternative or emerging technologies. Changes in the nature or extent of our customer requirements
may render our service and product offerings obsolete or non-competitive. In addition, our competitors
may improve the performance of their services and introduce new services at lower prices and with
improved performance characteristics. Furthermore, increased competition could create pricing pressure
on our services, which could reduce our revenue and profitability. There is no assurance that we will be
able to compete effectively with existing competitors or new competitors or that the level of competition
will not adversely affect our business, results of operations, financial condition and prospects.
Any failure to comply with existing or future laws, regulations and industry standards, any failure
to pass inspections conducted by relevant regulatory authorities or any adverse actions by the drug
approval authorities against us could negatively impact our reputation and our business, financial
condition, results of operations and prospects.
In many countries or regions where an ADC or other bioconjugate drug is intended to be ultimately
sold, such as China, the United States and Europe, the relevant government agencies and industry
regulatory bodies impose high standards on the safety and efficacy of such drug, as well as strict rules,
regulations and industry standards on the development and manufacture of such drug. Depending on
different jurisdictions in which our customers operate, our provision of CRDMO services for those
customers is subject to various and extensive ongoing regulations of the NMPA, the FDA, the EMA and
equivalent regulatory authorities of other jurisdictions. These regulatory authorities may conduct
inspections of our facilities to monitor our regulatory compliance from time to time. Although we passed
all the inspections and obtained clearance in relation to drug development and manufacturing from the
relevant regulatory authorities in all material respects during the Track Record Period, we cannot assure
you that we will be able to do so going forward. Any failure by us to comply with the requirements of these
regulatory authorities, existing regulations and industry standards could result in warning letters, product
recalls or seizures, monetary sanctions, injunctions to halt manufacture and distribution, restrictions on
RISK FACTORS
—5 0—


--- page 60 ---
our operations, civil or criminal sanctions, or withdrawal of existing or denial of pending approvals,
including those relating to products or facilities. Such a failure could expose us to contractual or product
liability claims, contractual claims from our customers, including claims for reimbursement for lost or
damaged active pharmaceutical ingredients, as well as ongoing remediation and increased compliance
costs. Any of the above negative consequences could have a material adverse effect on our reputation,
business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects. In addition, any action against us for
violation of the relevant regulations or industry standards, even if we successfully defend against it, could
cause us to incur significant legal expenses, divert our management’s attention from the operation of our
business and adversely affect our reputation and financial results.
Changes in government regulations or in practices relating to the pharmaceutical and biotechnology
industries, including reform of the drug approval process in relevant jurisdictions, could decrease demand
for the services we provide, and compliance with new regulations may result in additional costs. Changes
that result in a relaxation in regulatory requirements, or the introduction of simplified approval procedures
which will lower the entry barrier for potential competitors, or an increase in regulatory requirements
which may increase the difficulty for us to satisfy such requirements or may make our services less
competitive, could eliminate or substantially reduce the demand for our services.
Our failure to obtain or renew certain approvals, licenses, permits and certificates required for our
business may materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of
operations.
Pursuant to the relevant laws and regulations, we are required to obtain and maintain various
approvals, licenses, permits and certificates from relevant authorities to operate our business. Any failure
to obtain any approvals, licenses, permits and certificates necessary for our operations may result in
enforcement actions thereunder, including orders issued by the relevant regulatory authorities causing
operations to cease, and may include corrective measures requiring capital expenditure or remedial
actions, which in the future could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and
results of operations. There is also no assurance that the relevant authorities would not take any
enforcement action against us. In the event that such enforcement action is taken, our business operations
could be materially and adversely disrupted.
In addition, some of these approvals, permits, licenses and certificates are subject to periodic renewal
and/or reassessment by the relevant authorities, and the standards of such renewal and/or reassessment
may change from time to time. We are committed to applying for the renewal and/or reassessment of these
approvals, permits, licenses and certificates when required by applicable laws and regulations; however,
we cannot assure you that we will be able to successfully maintain or renew existing permits, licenses or
any other regulatory approvals or obtain permits, licenses or other approvals needed for the operation of
our businesses in the future. Any failure by us to obtain the necessary renewals and/or reassessment and
otherwise maintain all approvals, licenses, permits and certificates necessary to carry out our business at
any time could severely disrupt our business and prevent us from continuing to carry out our business,
which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
Furthermore, if existing laws and regulations evolve or new regulations come into effect requiring
us to obtain any additional approvals, permits, licenses or certificates that were previously not required
to operate our existing businesses, we cannot assure you that we will successfully obtain such approvals,
permits, licenses or certificates. Our failure to obtain the additional approvals, permits, licenses or
certificates may restrict the conduct of our business, decrease our revenue and/or increase our costs, which
could materially reduce our profitability.
RISK FACTORS
—5 1—


--- page 61 ---
We have made significant capital investments to meet growing demands of our customers, and, as a
result, we depend on the continued success of our customers’ projects and business.
We have made and are continuing to make significant capital expenditures based on anticipated
demand from existing and potential new businesses. We depend on our customers’ success in advancing
their products through development, regulatory approval and commercialization. As of June 30, 2023, we
had 67 ongoing preclinical bioconjugate projects and 43 ongoing post-IND bioconjugate projects. We
depend on the continued success of these projects, as well as exploration of new business opportunities,
to support our sustained growth. Any delay, non-approval or lack of demand may have a material impact
on our business. Consequently, we may be required to reallocate our resources, a decision that could cause
delays in our service offerings and result in lower-than-expected revenue.
Our customers operate in a heavily regulated industry and are subject to the oversight of regulators
across the globe, including in China, the United States and Europe. Changes in laws and regulations in
those jurisdictions relating to the pharmaceutical and biotechnology industries could materially and
adversely affect the business of our customers and in turn affect the demand for our services. For example,
the Guiding Principles for Clinical Research and Development of Oncology Drugs Oriented by Clinical
V alue (ۆࡡissued by the NMPA ’s Center for Drug
Evaluation came into force in November 2021. The guidelines call for a patient-oriented approach to the
R&D of oncology drugs and require drug innovators to use the standard-of-care treatment as control in
late-stage clinical trials, rather than comparing to treatments that have already been replaced in clinical
practice. The Guiding Principles for Clinical Research and Development and Technology of Oncology
Antibody Drug Conjugates (ۆࡡissued by the NMPA ’s Center
for Drug Evaluation came into force in April 2023, which provided for, among others, several key areas
of focus for the R&D of ADC drugs. Any such existing or proposed regulations could expose our services
to higher requirements and the evolving interpretation and application of these laws and regulations may
have a material impact on our and our customers’ operation and business. If the business of our customers
is negatively affected, the demand for our services may decrease as a result.
Specifically, early-stage biotech companies which have little assets or capital may rely particularly
on the success of their projects to maintain their business. If their projects were to fail, these companies
may not be able to continue to operate and may become insolvent. If this were to happen, these companies
may not be able to pay our service fees and may need to terminate their service agreement with us.
Our services are highly complex, and if we are unable to provide high quality services to our
customers or if our services do not meet evolving demands of our customers, our business could be
adversely affected.
The services we offer are highly customized, exacting and complex. Failure to deliver our CRDMO
services to the satisfaction of our customers may impair our reputation and result in decline in customer
demands for our services. Our results of operations further depend on our ability to execute and, when
necessary, improve our quality management strategy and systems, and our ability to effectively train and
maintain our employee base with respect to quality management. A failure of our quality control systems
in our existing and future operations and facilities could result in problems with facility operations or
preparation or provision of product, service or technology. In each case, such problems could arise from
a variety of factors, including equipment malfunction, failure to follow specific protocols and procedures,
RISK FACTORS
—5 2—


--- page 62 ---
problems with raw materials or manufacturing operations, operator error, and failure to comply with
regulations enforced by relevant government. Such problems could affect our development and production
process, and may result in project suspension, destruction of products or a halt of facility production
altogether.
In addition, our failure to meet required quality standards may result in our failure to timely deliver
high quality work products, including the intermediates and products we manufacture for our customers’
projects, to our customers, which in turn could damage our reputation and business relationship with our
customers. Any such failure could, among other things, lead to increased costs, lost revenue,
reimbursement to customers for lost drug product, registered intermediates, registered starting materials,
and active pharmaceutical ingredients, other customer claims, damage to and possibly termination of
existing customer relationships, time and expense spent investigating the cause and, depending on the
cause, similar losses with respect to other products. If problems are not discovered before a product is
released to the market by our customers, product recall and liability costs may also be incurred. In
addition, such risks may be greater at facilities that are new or going through significant expansion or
renovation.
We may not be successful in protecting the intellectual property owned by us or our customers or
licensed from third parties.
Our success depends on the protection of the intellectual property owned by us or our customers or
licensed from third parties. We primarily rely on our own know-how, trade secrets and other intellectual
property to carry out our CRDMO services for ADCs and other bioconjugates. In addition, due to the
nature of our services, we typically have access to a significant amount of know-how, intellectual property
and even trade secrets owned by our customers. Our customers typically retain ownership of all
intellectual property associated with their projects, including the intellectual property provided to us and
the intellectual property arising from the services we provide, except for intellectual property created or
developed in connection with the provision of our services that is derivative of our own intellectual
property or that relates to manufacturing processes developed at our expense. We take significant efforts
to protect our customers’ proprietary and confidential information, including requiring our employees and
relevant other third parties to enter into confidentiality agreements prohibiting them from disclosing our
customers’ proprietary information or technology. However, these agreements may not provide meaningful
protection for our customers’ trade secrets and proprietary know-how as relevant parties may breach these
agreements, which is out of our control. Any failure to protect the intellectual property owned by our
customers or licensed from third parties may subject us to liability for breach of contract, as well as
significantly damage our reputation, which is fundamental to our business.
Further, unauthorized third parties may obtain access to our trade secrets or know-how, and others
may independently develop similar or equivalent trade secrets or know-how. Although we strive to
diligently protect our intellectual property rights, we cannot assure you that all of our efforts to protect
and defend our intellectual property will be successful, and we may encounter challenges in securing and
enforcing our intellectual property rights. If our proprietary information is divulged to third parties,
including our competitors, or our intellectual property rights are otherwise misappropriated or infringed,
our competitive position could be harmed. Any failure to protect our own intellectual property may
severely disrupt our business operations and reduce or eliminate any competitive advantage we have
developed. Failure to protect the intellectual property owned by us or our customers or licensed from third
parties could materially harm our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects, and
any remediation may significantly divert management’s attention and resources from other activities.
RISK FACTORS
—5 3—


--- page 63 ---
Our services and our customers’ products may infringe on or misappropriate the intellectual
property rights of third parties.
We cannot assure you that we do not infringe on the intellectual rights of third parties. Any claims
that our services infringe third parties’ rights, including claims arising from our contracts with our
customers, regardless of their merit or resolution, could be costly and may divert the efforts and attention
of our management and technical personnel. We may not prevail in such proceedings given the complex
technical issues and inherent uncertainties in intellectual property litigation. If such proceedings result in
an adverse outcome, we could be required, among other things, to pay substantial damages, discontinue
the use of the infringing technology, expend significant resources to develop non-infringing technology,
license such technology from the third party claiming infringement (which license may not be available
on commercially reasonable terms or at all) and/or cease the infringing processes or offerings, any of
which could have a material adverse effect on our business.
In addition, our customers’ products may be subject to intellectual property infringement claims and
such claims could materially affect our business if their products cease to be manufactured and they have
to discontinue the use of the infringing technology which we may provide. Any of the foregoing could
affect our ability to compete or could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition
and results of operations.
Under most of our long-term service agreements and project-based service contracts and work
orders, we have agreed to indemnify the customer for intellectual property infringement claims arising out
of our infringement of a third party’s intellectual property. Our liability is usually capped at the total
payments we have received under the service contract or work order except for losses arising from breach
of confidentiality obligations or from our gross negligence or willful misconduct. As a result, if any aspect
of a deliverable to a customer that we create infringes a third party’s intellectual property rights due to our
gross negligence or willful misconduct, and particularly if such deliverable ultimately becomes a
commercially successful product, we could be exposed to substantial liability. Any material intellectual
property infringement claim, if raised against us, could have a material adverse impact on our reputation,
business, financial condition and results of operations.
If we fail to acquire new customers, our business, financial condition and results of operations may
be adversely affected.
Our success depends on our ability to acquire new customers. We may not be able to attract new
customers if we are unable to maintain our competitive edges including, among others, service capabilities
and quality, timeliness of delivery and proprietary technical capabilities. Our success in attracting
customers will also depend, in part, on our ability to be responsive to pricing pressures and changing
industry trend. To remain competitive in the global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services
market, we must continuously expand our integrated service capabilities, develop and upgrade our
proprietary technical capabilities and grow with our customers to establish long-term relationship. We also
may not be able to attract customers if we are unable to market ourselves effectively. If we are unable to
attract new customers, our business, financial condition or results of operations could be materially and
adversely affected.
RISK FACTORS
—5 4—


--- page 64 ---
We may fail to retain our existing customers.
We have a diverse and growing customer base with a global footprint. However, we cannot assure
you that we will be able to retain all existing or future customers. A large number of projects we have
executed are at discovery or preclinical stages characterized by a high rate of experimental failure,
inherent uncertainties and other complexities, which may lead to our customers’ decision to discontinue
the project earlier than we expected. Additionally, given the project-based nature of our services,
customers are not obligated to stay with us for subsequent development stages and may seek services
elsewhere. We rely on our ability to deliver high-quality services and maintain strong relationships with
our customers to retain them. Our ability to retain customers may also be affected if we fail to maintain
our competitive edges and be responsive to pricing pressures and changing industry trend. See “— If we
fail to acquire new customers, our business, financial condition and results of operations may be adversely
affected.” If we are unable to retain customers effectively, our business, financial condition and results of
operations may be materially and adversely affected.
The potential loss of major customers or any of our large contracts could materially and adversely
affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
In 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, revenue generated from our five largest
customers accounted for 51.9%, 39.8%, 34.1% and 45.7% of our revenue in each year/period, respectively,
and revenue generated from our largest customer accounted for 14.5%, 13.1%, 8.9% and 13.2% of our
revenue in each year/period, respectively, taking into account the customers who formally contracted with
the Remaining WXB Group but made use of our services. For more information about our top five
customers, see “Business — Customers.” We cannot assure you that we will be able to maintain or
strengthen our relationships with our major customers, or that our major customers will continue to
outsource projects to us. If there is any significant reduction in spending on our CRDMO services by our
major customers due to industry consolidation, deterioration of their financial conditions, budget cuts on
R&D activities, pending regulatory approvals or other reasons, and we are unable to obtain suitable
contracts or work orders of a comparable size and terms in substitution, our business, financial condition
and results of operations may be materially and adversely affected. In addition, any deterioration on our
key customers’ ability to settle their trade receivables in a timely manner will have a material adverse
effect on our results of operations.
We may not recover some or all of our cost or receive service fees, if we fail to complete our services
stipulated under our contracts or work orders, or if we under-price our services for any reason.
We generate revenue primarily for CRDMO services provided on an FFS basis. We generally receive
payments in accordance with a pre-agreed payment schedule specified in the contract or work order. The
payment schedule sets out the fees for services we provide at relevant discovery, development or
manufacturing steps that fall under the scope of work in the contract or work order. Our service contracts
and work orders under the FFS model typically include a detailed schedule that sets forth specifications
of and anticipated time required for completing each step as well as the corresponding payment. For more
information, see “Business — Our Business Model — Our Fee models.” As a result, if we fail to deliver
services in a timely manner in accordance with our contractual requirements, regulatory standards or
ethical considerations, if we incur cost overruns or if we price these contracts or work orders below our
costs because of competitive pressures, we could be subject to significant costs.
RISK FACTORS
—5 5—


--- page 65 ---
Moreover, we generally allow our customers to terminate the contracts or work orders without cause
by giving prior written notice. If a customer terminates a project-based service contract or a work order,
the customer is typically obligated to pay for the services already rendered and costs and expenses already
incurred or irrevocably committed up to the date we receive the termination notice, and in some cases the
customer is also obligated to pay a cancellation fee. Therefore, even if we are able to deliver services as
required in the contracts or work orders and recognize such revenue, we are still exposed to the risks of
early termination of contracts or work orders or delay in payment due to factors such as unsatisfactory
research results, failure in clinical development or changes in our customers’ willingness to research and
develop drugs, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of
operations, cash flows and prospects. Furthermore, if our customers’ drug candidates fail to pass the
requisite steps or proceed through development, regulatory approval or commercialization, our services
would be cut short and we would not be able to fully realize the value of our contracts or work orders.
Cancellation or modification of a large contract or work order, or cancellation or modification of multiple
smaller contracts or work orders, could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition,
results of operations and prospects.
We determine the fee level of our services based on the scope of the services, the estimated costs and
expenses, the estimated amount of time to deliver our services, and the prices charged by our competitors
for similar services, among others. However, our evaluation of these factors may be inaccurate or
incorrect. If we underprice our contracts or experience cost overruns, we could incur losses from our
contracts or work orders, and our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flows and
prospects would be adversely affected.
We are subject to product and other liability risks that could have a material adverse effect on our
results of operations and financial condition.
In providing our services, we face a range of potential liabilities. We typically undertake to defend,
indemnify and hold our customers harmless from and against any liabilities and damages (including
reasonable attorneys’ fees) resulting from any third-party claims, demands, suits or proceedings to the
extent arising out of or relating to our negligence, willful misconduct, unlawful activities or material
breach of the long-term service agreement or project-based service contract or a work order under the
long-term service agreement. In particular, we may face product liability risks if the ADCs and other
bioconjugates we help to discover, develop or manufacture are subject to product liability claims. We
provide services in the discovery, development and commercial manufacturing of ADCs and other
bioconjugates that are intended ultimately to be used in humans, either in clinical trials or as marketed
products, although we do not commercially market or sell these products to end users. If any of these drugs
harms people due to our negligence, willful misconduct, unlawful activities or material breach, we may
be subject to litigation and may be required to pay damages. Damages awarded in a product liability action
could be substantial and could have a material adverse effect on our reputation, business, financial
condition, results of operations and prospects. Although we currently maintain product liability insurance,
our insurance coverage may be inadequate or may become unavailable on terms acceptable to us.
Our customers’ ADCs and bioconjugates are, or may in the future be, sold, in jurisdictions,
particularly in developed markets such as the United States and Europe, which may have onerous product
liability and pharmaceutical product regulatory regimes, as well as litigious environments that may further
expose us to the risk of product liability claims. Even if we are able to successfully defend ourselves
against any such product liability claims, doing so may require significant resources and the time and
attention of our management.
RISK FACTORS
—5 6—


--- page 66 ---
Outsourcing certain development steps to other outsourcing service providers may expose us to
potential risks and liabilities.
We may outsource certain development steps to other outsourcing service providers from time to
time during the ordinary course of our business. Historically, we have outsourced antibody intermediate
manufacturing to the Remaining WXB Group and payload-linker manufacturing to the WXA T Group to
meet the unfulfilled customer demand which exceeded our capacity. We cannot assure you that we will not
continue to outsource certain development steps to other outsourcing service providers in the future even
though we are actively building up our manufacturing capacities. Outsourcing to other service providers
may subject us to potential risks and liabilities. Our outsourcing partners may face challenges or
interruptions in their operations due to various factors that are beyond our control, including but not
limited to labor disputes, raw material shortages and equipment failures. Such disruptions may result in
delays or compromises to the projects. Failure on their part to meet deadlines, maintain product quality
or comply with regulatory standards can affect our ability to fulfill our service obligations to our
customers, which may harm our reputation and relationships with customers. Additionally, any negligent
or willful misconduct by our outsourcing partners may expose us to potential liabilities. While we may
seek indemnities from these partners, any such attempt can be costly and any indemnities obtained could
be time-consuming and may not fully cover our losses.
The ADCs and other bioconjugates we help to discover, develop or manufacture may cause
undesirable adverse events or have other properties that could delay or prevent their regulatory
approval, limit their commercial profile or harm our reputation.
Undesirable adverse events caused by the ADCs and other bioconjugates we help to discover,
develop or manufacture could cause our customers or regulatory authorities to interrupt, delay or halt
clinical trials and could result in a more restrictive label or the delay or denial of regulatory approval for
the relevant drugs. Results of our customers’ trials could reveal a high and unacceptable level of severity
or prevalence of adverse events. In such event, trials could be suspended or terminated and the regulatory
authority may order our customers to cease further development of, or deny approval of, such drugs. If any
of adverse events is attributable to or associated with our services, with or without merits, our reputation
may be harmed, which may cause a decline in customer demand for our services and materially and
adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Any disruption of our current facilities could restrict our ordinary business operations and
materially and adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.
As of the Latest Practicable Date, we operated three sites in Shanghai, Changzhou and Wuxi,
respectively. These sites are proximately located within a 200-kilometer radius, or approximately a
two-hour drive. Our facilities may be harmed or rendered inoperable by physical damage from fires,
floods, earthquakes, typhoons, power outages, mechanical breakdowns, telecommunications failures, loss
of licenses, certifications and permits, changes in governmental planning for the land underlying the
facility, and the regulatory development, many of which are beyond our control. We intend to further
expand our geographic footprint, and specifically, we intend to establish facilities in Singapore to meet the
growing demand from customers worldwide. However, we cannot assure you that such overseas expansion
could effectively diversify and hedge against the risks arising from the proximity of our current facilities.
RISK FACTORS
—5 7—


--- page 67 ---
Any substantial interruption in the development and manufacturing operations at our current facilities
could result in our inability to satisfy customer demands, or even lead to our failure to fulfill contractual
obligations, which could in turn materially and adversely affected our business, results of operations and
financial condition.
Our reputation is key to our business success. Negative publicity may adversely affect our
reputation, business and growth prospect.
Any negative publicity concerning us, our affiliates or any entity that shares the “WuXi” name, even
if untrue, could adversely affect our reputation and business prospects. In particular, in light of our
specialized customer base, customer referrals and word-of-mouth marketing have significantly contributed
to our ability to acquire customers. Furthermore, a significant number of our affiliates or unrelated entities
bear the “WuXi” name. As a result, any negative publicity about us or any of our affiliates or any entity
that shares the “WuXi” name could also adversely affect our ability to retain our existing customers or
attract new customers which in turn could negatively affect our revenue and profitability. Damage to our
reputation could be difficult, expensive and time-consuming to repair and could make potential or existing
customers reluctant to select us for new engagements, resulting in a loss of business and could adversely
affect our recruitment and retention efforts. Damage to our reputation could also reduce the value and
effectiveness of our brand name and could reduce investor confidence in us, adversely affecting the price
of our Shares.
The economic, social and other general conditions in China could affect our business, results of
operations, financial conditions and prospects.
We conduct a substantial part of our business operations in China. Accordingly, our business, results
of operations and financial condition are influenced by economic, social, legal and other general
developments in China. In particular, factors such as consumer, corporate and government spending,
business investment, level of economic development, and resource allocation could affect the growth of
our business.
The PRC economy has experienced significant growth over the past decades since the
implementation of China’s reform and opening-up policy. In recent years, the PRC government has
implemented measures emphasizing the utilization of market forces in economic reform and the
establishment of sound corporate governance practices in business enterprises. These economic reform
measures may be adaptively adjusted from industry to industry or across different regions of the country.
If the business environment in China changes, our business in China and the growth of our business may
also be adversely affected.
Doing business with overseas customers and planned international expansion may subject us to a
number of economic, political, regulatory, operation and management risks.
We have developed a global customer base, covering customers from the United States, China and
Europe. In 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, 28.7%, 58.7%, 69.1%,
70.7% and 64.1% of our revenue were attributable to ultimate customers with headquarters located outside
China. As a CRDMO, we may have obligations under the medicinal products regime that applies in the
jurisdictions where our customers are located to the extent that we are involved in R&D, preclinical
studies and/or clinical trials. Failure to comply with any of the legal and regulatory requirements may
result in material impact on our provision of services to customers in the relevant jurisdictions. We intend
RISK FACTORS
—5 8—


--- page 68 ---
to establish facilities in Singapore to meet the growing demand from customers worldwide. As of the
Latest Practicable Date, the WXB Group had secured a land offer from the relevant authority in Singapore
for its Singapore expansion as well as our Singapore site. We were formulating the detailed construction
plan as of the same date. We face risks and challenges in serving overseas customers, future overseas
operations and competing in international markets, including, but not limited to:
 our ability to effectively manage our employees at remote locations, or in different business
environments from that of the PRC;
 our ability to develop and maintain relationships with customers, suppliers and other local
businesses;
 compliance with product safety requirements and standards that are different from those of the
PRC;
 variations and changes in laws applicable to our operations in different jurisdictions, including
enforceability of intellectual property and contract rights;
 a rising trade protectionism, a decline in world trade or a downturn in the economy of the
United States or the European Union (including the impact of the exit of the United Kingdom
from the European Union);
 customs regulations and the import and export of goods and raw materials;
 the ability to provide sufficient levels of technical support in different locations;
 our ability to obtain and renew licenses that may be needed in various jurisdictions to support
operations;
 fluctuations in currency exchange rates;
 changes in local tax laws, tax rates in certain countries that may exceed those of the PRC and
lower earnings due to withholding requirements or the imposition of tariffs, exchange controls
or other restrictions;
 seasonal reductions in business activity;
 local laws related to, and relationships with, local labor unions and works councils; and
 general economic and political conditions.
If any of these risks later materializes and we have failed to anticipate and effectively manage them,
we may suffer a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations.
RISK FACTORS
—5 9—


--- page 69 ---
We may be subject to various laws relating to export controls.
We procure a substantial portion of raw materials and equipment and license technologies required
for our operations from overseas, including the United States, and we may thus be subject to export control
laws and regulations in the applicable jurisdictions, and specifically, the U.S. Export Administration
Regulations, U.S. customs regulations and economic and trade sanctions administered by the United States
governments, including but not limited to the U.S. Department of Commerce and its agencies, such as the
Bureau of Industry and Security, and the U.S. Department of the Treasury and its agencies. These
regulations provide that certain products may be exported outside of the United States only with the
required export authorizations, including by license, license exception or other appropriate government
authorizations. If we fail to comply with these laws or complete inspections required by the regulatory
authorities in the United States, such as the U.S. Department of Commerce, in coordination with relevant
government authorities of China, we may be adversely affected by reputational harm or loss of access to
certain materials and equipment. During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date,
we did not procure raw materials or equipment or license technologies that were subject to the export
control laws and regulations of the United States or that required authorization from government
authorities of the United States.
China imposes controls on the import and export of technology and software products. Under the
Regulations on Administration of Imports and Exports of Technologies ( Ҧஔආ̈ɹ၍ଣૢԷ)
promulgated by the State Council, which were amended in November 2020, technology import and export
is defined to include, among others, the transfer or licensing of patents and know-how, and the provision
of services related to technology. Depending on the nature of the relevant technology, the import and
export of technology require either approvals by or registrations with the relevant PRC governmental
authorities. As advised by our PRC Legal Advisor, on the basis of the aforesaid definition of technology
export, the provision of our CRDMO services to overseas customers involving our technologies may be
deemed as technology export. Nevertheless, our exported technologies do not fall within the currently
effective catalogue of prohibited or restricted technologies for exportation, and therefore can be freely
exported outside the PRC. The Measures for the Administration of Registration of Technology Import and
Export Contracts (جissued by MOFCOM in February 2009, specify that
agreements involving freely exported technologies shall be registered with the applicable PRC
governmental authorities. Although there are no explicit penalties set forth in these regulations for lack
of such registration, failure to register an agreement where such registration is required may result in
restrictions concerning foreign exchange, banking and taxation matters relating to such agreements. We
have registered some of our agreements involving the export of the relevant technologies, and with respect
to other agreements which have not been registered, we have so far not encountered any issues with
respect to foreign exchange, banking and taxation matters, nor have we received any penalties imposed by
the competent government authority or received any notice from any government authority requiring us
to complete the registration procedures. As advised by our PRC Legal Advisor, considering the relevant
regulatory policies and the facts stated above, failure to register such agreements involving freely exported
technologies will not have a material adverse effect on our overall financial condition or results of
operations.
RISK FACTORS
—6 0—


--- page 70 ---
Our investments in different countries may be adversely affected by regulatory or government
scrutiny of the target countries.
We may selectively pursue strategic alliances, licensing arrangements, investments and acquisitions
in the future to enhance our technology platform. See “Business — Our Strategies — Continue to focus
on cutting-edge technologies through internal R&D and strategic partnerships.” Such investments may be
subject to stringent regulatory or governmental scrutiny imposed by relevant authorities. For example, the
United States Congress has passed legislation that will expand the jurisdiction and powers of the
Committee on Foreign Investment in the United States (“ CFIUS ”), the United States interagency
committee that conducts national security reviews of foreign investment. The Foreign Investment Risk
Review Modernization Act (“ FIRRMA ”) was signed into law in August 2018. Pursuant to FIRRMA,
investments in companies that deal in “critical technology” are subject to filing requirements and, in some
instances, review and approval by CFIUS. The term “critical technology” includes, among others,
technology subject to United States export controls and certain “emerging and foundational technology,”
a term that is still being defined but that is expected to include a range of United States biotechnology.
If an investment by a foreign entity in a United States business dealing in “critical technology” meets
certain thresholds, a filing with CFIUS is mandatory. While FIRRMA currently grants CFIUS jurisdiction
on only controlling and certain non-controlling investments made by foreign persons in United States
businesses in research and development in biotechnology, CFIUS’s jurisdiction may be further expanded
in the future, which may increase the uncertainty and transaction costs of our future investments in and
acquisitions of United States biotechnology businesses and therefore adversely affect the implementation
of our future merger and acquisition activities and investment strategies in respect of United States
biotechnology assets and businesses.
We are subject to environmental protection and health and safety laws and regulations and may be
exposed to potential costs for compliance and liabilities, including consequences of accidental
contamination, chemical or biological hazards or personal injury.
Our business operations are subject to national and local laws and regulations of the PRC pertaining
to protection of the environment and health and safety, including but not limited to the treatment and
discharge of pollutants into the environment and the use of highly toxic and hazardous chemicals in our
development and manufacturing process. In addition, our construction projects can only be put into
operation after the relevant administrative authorities in charge of environmental protection and health and
safety have examined and approved the relevant facilities. Since the requirements imposed by such laws
and regulations may change and more stringent laws or regulations may be adopted, we may be unable to
comply in a timely manner, or to accurately predict the potentially substantial cost of complying, with
these laws and regulations. If we fail to comply with environmental protection and health and safety laws
and regulations, we may be subject to rectification orders, substantial fines, potentially significant
monetary damages, suspend production or suspensions in our business operations. As a result, any failure
by us to control the use or discharge of hazardous substances could have a material and adverse impact
on our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects.
In addition, we cannot fully eliminate the risk of accidental contamination, biological hazards or
personal injury at our facilities during the development and manufacturing process. In the event of such
accident, we could be held liable for damages and clean-up costs which, to the extent not covered by
existing insurance or indemnification, could harm our business. Other adverse effects could result from
such liability, including reputational damage resulting in the loss of business from customers. We may also
RISK FACTORS
—6 1—


--- page 71 ---
be forced to close or suspend operations at certain of our affected facilities temporarily, or permanently.
As a result, any accidental contamination, biological hazards or personal injury could have a material and
adverse impact on our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects.
We may be directly or indirectly subject to applicable anti-corruption and anti-bribery laws and
regulations, which could expose us to penalties and other adverse effects.
We provide CRDMO services primarily for pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies that
develop and commercialize ADCs and other bioconjugates, and we and our customers are subject to
anti-bribery laws of China. The PRC government has taken increasingly stringent measures to correct
corruptive practices in the pharmaceutical industry (“ Anti-Corruption Campaign ”) since 2023. For
example, in May 2023, 14 governmental departments including the National Health Commission jointly
issued the Key Points for the Correction of Malpractice in the Purchase and Sales of Medical Products and
Medical Services in 2023 (2023ᓃ), emphasizing the
need to address prominent corruption issues in the healthcare industry, particularly to rectify the
malpractice that may occur involving the medical industrial associations and during the process of the
purchases and sales of medical products. The Anti-Corruption Campaign targets not only at the medical
and health institutions, but has also extended to upstream manufacturers, distribution channels, and
third-party organizations, such as medical industrial associations. As this campaign deepens, the proposed
sales and marketing programs of our customers may be impacted and the demand for our services may
decrease. In addition, many of our customers are located in the United States and are subject to the Foreign
Corrupt Practices Act (“ FCPA”) that generally bans an entity from, directly or indirectly, making improper
payments to foreign officials for the purpose of obtaining or retaining business. As a result, our service
contracts often include anti-bribery provisions which require us to comply with the FCPA and other
anti-bribery laws in the United States. As our business has expanded, the applicability of the FCPA and
other anti-bribery laws to our operations has increased.
Although we have procedures and controls to monitor anti-bribery compliance, we cannot guarantee
these measures can fully protect us from reckless or criminal acts committed by our employees or agents,
and we could be held liable for actions taken by our employees or agents, which could expose us to risks
of regulatory investigations and penalties. If we fail to comply with applicable anti-bribery laws due to
our own deliberate or inadvertent acts or those of our employees, our reputation could be harmed and we
could incur criminal or civil penalties, other sanctions and significant expenses, which could have a
material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
We may not be able to continue to serve our customers if we fail to meet our customers’ standards
in audits and inspections.
Our customers regularly audit and inspect our facilities, processes and practices to ensure that our
services meet their standards in the discovery, development and manufacturing process. However, we
cannot assure you that we will be able to pass all the customer audits and inspections at all times. Failure
to pass any of these audits or inspections to our customers’ satisfaction could significantly harm our
reputation and result in the termination of ongoing projects by our customers, which could materially and
adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects.
RISK FACTORS
—6 2—


--- page 72 ---
Increased labor costs could slow our growth and affect our profitability.
Our operations require a sufficient number of qualified employees. In recent years, the average labor
cost in the global ADC and broader bioconjugate market, has been steadily increasing as the competition
for qualified employees has become more intense, according to Frost & Sullivan. Our direct labor costs
accounted for 51.3%, 41.5%, 20.7%, 29.1% and 14.2% of our cost of services in 2020, 2021, 2022 and
the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively. We cannot assure you that there will not be
further increase in labor cost. If there is a significant increase in our labor cost, our operations and
profitability may be adversely affected.
We depend on a stable and adequate supply of quality raw materials from our suppliers, and price
increases or interruptions of such supply could have an adverse impact on our business.
Our business operations require a substantial amount of raw materials, pharmaceutical intermediates
and consumable materials. In 2020, 2021, 2022 and June 30, 2022 and 2023, our cost of raw materials
accounted for 29.2%, 30.5%, 13.4%, 26.2% and 10.4% of our cost of services, respectively. During the
Track Record Period, procurement of raw materials for the WXB Group was conducted on a centralized
basis, and we also sourced certain property, plant and equipment through such centralized procurement
system rather than directly from suppliers. Going forward, as our business continues to scale up, we intend
to independently procure raw materials. The raw materials and equipment required for the provision of our
services are generally readily available in the market through a number of suppliers. In the event of
significant price increases for raw materials, we cannot assure you that we will be able to raise the prices
of our services sufficiently to cover the increased costs. As a result, any significant price increase for our
raw materials may have an adverse effect on our profitability.
Furthermore, suppliers may fail to provide us with raw materials and other components that meet the
qualifications and standards required by us or our customers. If suppliers are not able to provide us with
materials that meet our or our customers’ specifications on a timely basis, our discovery, development and
manufacturing activities may be interfered, or such materials may be available only at a higher cost or after
a long delay, which could prevent us from successful and timely completion of the specified tasks in the
drug development process as prescribed in our service contracts or work orders. Any such inability to
deliver or delay in delivering our services may create liability for us to our customers for breach of
contract or cause us to experience order cancellations and loss of customers.
We cannot assure you that we will be able to secure a stable supply of raw materials going forward.
Our suppliers may not be able to keep up with our fast growth or may reduce or cease their supply of raw
materials to us at any time. Our supplier relationships could be interrupted due to natural disasters,
international supply disruptions caused by geopolitical issues, trade frictions, global shipping crises, or
other events beyond our control or could be terminated in the future. Any sustained interruption in our
receipt of adequate supplies could have an adverse effect on our business and financial results.
In addition, while we have supply chain processes intended to reduce volatility in component and
material pricing, we may not be able to successfully manage price fluctuations. Price fluctuations or
shortages could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition. In
addition, we cannot assure you that our suppliers have obtained and will be able to renew all licenses,
permits and approvals necessary for their operations or comply with all applicable laws and regulations,
and such failure by them may lead to interruption in their business operation, which in turn may result in
RISK FACTORS
—6 3—


--- page 73 ---
shortage of raw materials supplied to us. Some of our suppliers are based overseas and therefore may need
to maintain export or import licenses. If the supply of raw materials is interrupted, our business operation
and financial position may be adversely affected.
We may not be able to effectively manage our inventory levels.
Our inventories include raw materials and consumables used for our services, such as laboratory
supplies, antibody intermediates, and payload-linkers. We manage the raw materials’ inventory level by
monitoring the status of our ongoing projects and incoming new projects, and place orders through the
centralized procurement system or with suppliers for any inventory that is expected to decline below
targeted levels. We procure raw materials and equipment in accordance with our business expansion plan
or to replace obsolete equipment on an as-needed basis. Adequate inventory level, however, is subject to
numerous uncertainties, including current project progress, our level of success in securing new projects
and other factors beyond our control. We recorded inventories of RMB7.7 million, RMB23.8 million,
RMB62.9 million and RMB47.4 million as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023,
respectively.
If we fail to manage our inventory levels effectively, we may be subject to a heightened risk of
inventory obsolescence, a decline in the value of inventories, and potential inventory write-downs or
write-offs. Procuring additional inventories may also require us to commit substantial working capital,
preventing us from using such capital for other purposes. Any of the foregoing may materially and
adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.
Significant impairment losses with respect to our trade receivables and contract assets may
materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
We allow our customers a credit period ranging from 10 to 90 days. As of December 31, 2020, 2021
and 2022 and June 30, 2023, our trade receivables, net of impairment of credit loss, were RMB23.9
million, RMB89.2 million, RMB453.3 million and RMB672.7 million, respectively, and we recorded
allowance for impairment of trade receivables of RMB0.3 million, RMB10.8 million, RMB51.9 million
and RMB28.1 million as of the same dates, respectively. We recognized impairment losses with respect
to trade receivables of RMB0.3 million, RMB10.6 million and RMB41.0 million in 2020, 2021 and 2022,
respectively, and a reversal of impairment losses with respect to our trade receivables of RMB3.0 million
and RMB23.8 million in the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively. Additionally, we
recorded contract assets, net of allowance for credit losses, of RMB1.0 million, RMB10.7 million,
RMB17.3 million and RMB24.7 million as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023, and
we recorded allowance for credit losses in relation to our contract assets of nil, RMB2,000, RMB0.2
million and RMB1.7 million as of the same dates, respectively. We recognized impairment losses with
respect to our contract assets of nil, RMB2,000, RMB0.1 million, nil and RMB1.6 million in 2020, 2021,
2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively. If any of our customers’ cash flow,
working capital, financial condition or results of operations deteriorates, it may be unable, or it may
otherwise be unwilling, to pay trade receivables owed to us promptly or at all. Any substantial default or
delay of a customer’s payment obligations may materially and adversely affect our business, financial
conditions and results of operations.
RISK FACTORS
—6 4—


--- page 74 ---
We may incur impairment losses with respect to our intangible assets and goodwill in the future,
which may materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of
operations.
Our intangible assets, primarily comprising technology and customer relationships, were RMB4.8
million, RMB61.0 million, RMB50.6 million and RMB57.0 million as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and
2022 and June 30, 2023, respectively. Our goodwill, which primarily related to our acquisition of Payload
& Linker Business in 2021, amounted to RMB215.2 million, RMB215.2 million and RMB215.2 million
as of December 31, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023, respectively. During the Track Record Period, we
did not recognize impairment losses with respect to our intangible assets or goodwill. We cannot assure
you that we will not recognize such impairment losses in the future. Impairment losses could arise from
various factors such as a decrease in the future utility of our technology assets due to industry
advancements that render them obsolete or less useful. Changes in market conditions could also erode the
value attributed to customer relationships. Moreover, an economic downturn affecting our sectors could
necessitate a re-evaluation of the carrying value of both our intangible assets and goodwill. Should any
such impairments be recognized, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be
materially and adversely affected.
We recorded net current liabilities during the Track Record Period, and if we continue to incur net
current liabilities in the future, we may be exposed to liquidity risks.
We recorded net current liabilities of RMB608.2 million as of December 31, 2021, primarily due to
the consideration payable to a related party for transfer of XDC Wuxi and consideration payable for
acquisition of Payload & Linker Business. See “Financial Information — Liquidity and Capital
Resources.” We cannot assure you that we will not incur net current liabilities in the future. A net current
liabilities position can expose us to the risk of shortfalls in liquidity, in which case our ability to raise
funds and declare and pay dividends will be materially and adversely affected.
The discontinuation of any of research and other grants or preferential tax treatment currently
available to us could adversely affect our financial position, results of operations, cash flows and
prospects.
During the Track Record Period, we have benefited from research and other grants. In 2020, 2021,
2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, we recorded research and other grants under other
income of RMB39.6 million, RMB0.9 million, RMB15.8 million, RMB15.3 million and RMB31.3 million,
respectively. We also enjoyed preferential tax treatment during the Track Record Period. See “Financial
Information — Key Components of Our Results of Operations — Other Income” and “Financial
Information — Key Components of Our Results of Operations — Income Tax Expense” for more details.
Our eligibility to receive these financial incentives requires that we continue to meet the specified
qualifications. Subject to applicable PRC laws and regulations, tax incentive schemes of the PRC are
determined at the discretion of the central government or relevant local government authorities, which
could determine to eliminate or reduce the financial incentives, generally with prospective effect. There
can be no assurance that we will be able to obtain similar preferential tax treatment or financial incentives
on recurring basis, or at all, in the future. Since our receipt of the financial incentives may be subject to
periodic time lags and varied practices across different governmental departments, as long as we continue
to receive these financial incentives, our net income in a particular period may be higher or lower relative
to other periods depending on the potential changes in these financial incentives in addition to any
RISK FACTORS
—6 5—


--- page 75 ---
business or operational factors that we may otherwise experience. The discontinuation of financial
incentives currently available to us could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results
of operations, cash flows and prospects.
We may not be able to fulfill our obligations in respect of contract liabilities, which may have a
material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.
As of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023, our contract liabilities, primarily
comprising deposits paid by customers, was RMB0.2 million, RMB10.0 million, RMB151.5 million and
RMB232.4 million, respectively. See “Financial Information — Discussion of Major Balance Sheet Items
— Contract Liabilities.” If we fail to fulfill our obligations under our contracts with customers, we may
not be able to convert such contract liabilities into revenue, and our customers may also require us to
refund the deposits we have received, which may adversely affect our cash flow and liquidity condition.
In addition, it may adversely affect our relationship with such customers, which may also affect our
reputation and results of operations in the future.
We may undertake acquisitions or joint ventures that may have a material adverse effect on our
ability to manage our business and may not be successful.
To pursue our growth strategy, we may acquire new technologies, businesses or services or enter into
strategic alliances with third parties. We may not be able to identify attractive targets, and we have limited
experience in acquisitions. In addition, we may not be able to successfully acquire the targets identified
despite spending significant amount of time and resources on pursuing such acquisition. Furthermore,
integration of an acquired company, its intellectual property or technology into our own operations is a
complex, time-consuming and expensive process. The successful integration of an acquisition may require,
among other things, that we integrate and retain key management, sales and other personnel, integrate the
acquired technologies or services into our integrated services from both an engineering and a sales and
marketing perspective, integrate and support preexisting supplier, distribution and customer relationships,
coordinate research and development efforts, and consolidate duplicate facilities and functions.
The geographic distance between companies, the complexity of the technologies and operations
being integrated and the disparate corporate cultures may altogether increase the difficulties of integrating
an acquired company or technology. In addition, it is common in our industry for competitors to attract
customers and recruit key employees away from companies during the integration phase of an acquisition.
Our available cash and stock may be used for our future acquisitions, which will possibly result in
significant acquisition-related charges to earnings and dilution to our shareholders. Future acquisitions
will likely present challenges and could require that our management develop expertise in new areas,
manage new business relationships and attract new types of customers. The diversion of our management’s
attention and any difficulties encountered in these acquisitions could have an adverse effect on our ability
to effectively manage our own business. These acquisitions and equity investments may also expose us to
other potential risks, including loss of the invested amounts, inability to earn an adequate return,
unforeseen liabilities, diversion of resources from our existing businesses and potential harm to
relationships with employees or customers.
RISK FACTORS
—6 6—


--- page 76 ---
We have granted, and may continue to grant, share options and other types of awards under our
share incentive plans, which may result in increased share-based payment expenses. Those
share-based awards may also adversely impact our results of operations and be dilutive to your
shareholding.
We adopted the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme to
enhance our ability to attract and retain exceptionally qualified individuals and to encourage them to
acquire a proprietary interest in the growth and performance of us. See “Appendix IV — Statutory and
General Information — E. Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes.” We incurred share-based compensation
expenses of RMB6.5 million, RMB22.2 million, RMB38.6 million, RMB10.6 million and RMB31.8
million in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively.
Similar to other biotech companies, we believe share-based awards as part of an overall
compensation package are important to attracting and retaining key personnel and employees, and we plan
to continue to grant share-based compensation to employees in the future. As a result, our share-based
payment expenses may increase, which may have an adverse effect on our results of operations and
financial condition and dilute your shareholding.
We have limited insurance coverage, and any claims beyond our insurance coverage may result in
us incurring substantial costs and a diversion of resources.
We maintain property insurance policies, employer’s liability insurance and product liability and
professional errors and omissions insurance, among our other insurance coverage. We do not maintain
key-man life insurance for any members of our senior management or other key personnel or business
disruption insurance. See “Business — Insurance” for details. Our insurance coverage may be insufficient
to cover any claim for product liability, damage to our facilities, plant and equipment or employee injuries.
In particular, we may face product liability risks if the ADCs and other bioconjugates we help develop or
manufacture are subject to product liability claims. Our liability is not always capped under our service
agreements, and in certain cases, the product liability cap is not applicable for claims relating to personal
injuries or death. Any liability or damage to, or caused by, our facilities or our personnel beyond our
insurance coverage may result in us incurring substantial costs and a diversion of resources.
We may become subject to legal proceedings and claims during the ordinary course of our business.
We may become, from time to time, subject to legal proceedings and claims that arise in the ordinary
course of business or pursuant to governmental or regulatory enforcement activity. Actions brought against
us, with or without merit, may result in administrative measures, settlements, injunctions, fines, penalties,
negative publicity, or other results that could have material adverse effect on our reputation, business,
financial condition, results of operations, and prospects. Even if we are successful in defending ourselves
against these actions, we may incur significant costs and divert management’s attention and resources in
such defense. Furthermore, any litigations, legal disputes, claims or administrative proceedings which are
initially not of material importance may escalate and become important to us due to a variety of factors,
such as the facts and circumstances of the cases, the likelihood of loss, the monetary amount at stake and
the parties involved. During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, we were not
subject to any claims, damages or losses which would have a material adverse effect on our financial
position or results of operations as whole. As of the Latest Practicable Date, no material litigation,
arbitration or administrative proceedings had been threatened against us.
RISK FACTORS
—6 7—


--- page 77 ---
Our insurance might not cover claims brought against us, or might not provide sufficient payments
to cover all of the costs to resolve one or more such claims and might not continue to be available on terms
acceptable to us. In particular, any claim could result in unanticipated liability to us if the claim is outside
the scope of the indemnification arrangement we have with our customers, our customers do not abide by
the indemnification arrangement as required, or the liability exceeds the amount of any applicable
indemnification limits or available insurance coverage. A claim brought against us that is uninsured or
underinsured could result in unanticipated costs and could have a material adverse effect on our financial
condition, results of operations or reputation.
We may not be able to secure additional financing on favorable terms, or at all, to meet our future
capital needs.
We may need additional capital, aimed to expand our capacity, develop new services and remain
competitive. We expect to meet such capital commitments by using cash from operations and net proceeds
to be received from the Global Offering. However, financing may be limited in amounts or on terms
acceptable to us. Our ability to obtain additional capital is subject to a variety of uncertainties, including
our future financial condition, results of operations and cash flows, general market conditions for
capital-raising activities within the industry, global political conditions, economic and other conditions in
China, the United States or globally. The sale of additional equity or equity-linked securities could lead
to dilution to the shares held by our shareholders. The incurrence of indebtedness would result in increased
debt service obligations and could result in operating and financing covenants restricting our operations
or our ability to pay dividends, which may adversely impact our business, financial conditions and results
of operations.
Any failure of our information systems, such as from data corruption, cyber-based attacks or
network security breaches, could have a material adverse effect on our business and results of
operations.
We rely on a variety of information technology and automated operating systems to manage or
support our operations, including protecting our customers’ intellectual property. The proper functioning
of these systems is critical to the efficient operation and management of our business. In addition, these
systems may require modifications or upgrades as a result of technological changes or growth in our
business. These changes may be costly and disruptive to our operations and could impose substantial
demands on management time. Our systems and those of third-party providers may be vulnerable to
damage or disruption caused by circumstances beyond our control, such as catastrophic events, power
outages, natural disasters, computer system or network failures, viruses or malware, physical or electronic
break-ins, unauthorized access, cyber-attacks and thefts. We cannot assure you that the measures and steps
we take to secure our systems and electronic information are adequate. Any significant disruption to our
systems could result in unauthorized disclosure of confidential information and adversely affect our
business and operating results.
RISK FACTORS
—6 8—


--- page 78 ---
An occurrence of a natural disaster, widespread health epidemic or other outbreaks, such as the
COVID-19 pandemic, could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and
financial condition.
Our business could be materially and adversely affected by natural disasters and extreme weather
conditions, such as snowstorms, earthquakes, fires or floods, the outbreak of a widespread health
epidemic, such as the COVID-19 pandemic, or other events, such as wars, acts of terrorism, environmental
accidents, power shortage or communication interruptions. The occurrence of such a disaster or prolonged
outbreak of contagious diseases or other adverse public health issues could materially disrupt our business
and operations. For example, a series of precautionary and control measures have been implemented
worldwide to contain the virus since the COVID-19 outbreak. Our Directors confirmed that, up to the
Latest Practicable Date, the COVID-19 outbreak had not had a material adverse effect on our business,
results of operations and financial condition. Any future impact caused by the COVID-19 pandemic will
depend on its subsequent development. We cannot be entirely certain as to when the COVID-19 pandemic
will be fully contained, and its impact will be completely alleviated. There remain significant uncertainties
surrounding the COVID-19 outbreak and its further development as a global pandemic, considering the
severe global situation and occasional regional resurgence of COVID-19 cases. We are closely monitoring
the development of the COVID-19 pandemic and continually evaluating any potential impact on our
business operations.
We are also vulnerable to natural disasters and other force majeure events. Fire, floods, typhoons,
earthquakes, power shortages, telecommunications failures, wars, riots, terrorist attacks or similar events
could adversely affect our ability to conduct our business. Our business could also be adversely affected
by the effects of Ebola virus diseases, H1N1 flu, H7N9 flu, avian flu, Severe Acute Respiratory Syndrome
(SARS), or other epidemics. The occurrence of any of the foregoing events may, among others, disrupt our
R&D and manufacturing activities and affect the business environment and sentiment, all of which may
have a material and adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and prospects.
Fluctuations in exchange rates may result in foreign exchange losses and adversely impact our
profitability.
We develop and maintain a global customer base and transact business with global suppliers and
partners. Fluctuations in exchange rates between the Renminbi and the U.S. dollar and other currencies
may fluctuate and is affected by, among other things, changes in the global geopolitical and economic
conditions and the foreign exchange policies. Our foreign currency exposure is mainly with respect to U.S.
dollars. During the Track Record Period, a majority of our revenue was generated from sales denominated
in U.S. dollars. However, a majority of our cost of services and operating costs and expenses are
denominated in Renminbi, and our financial information is presented in Renminbi. As a result, when the
Renminbi appreciates against the U.S. dollar, our margins are pressured, and we may not be able to price
our service contracts or work orders, in particular those with our U.S. customers, in currencies other than
the U.S. dollar. We incurred net foreign exchange losses of RMB2.7 million, RMB1.0 million and RMB1.4
million in 2020, 2021 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively, and net foreign exchange gain
of RMB46.3 million and RMB25.5 million in 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022, respectively.
During the Track Record Period, we utilized derivative contracts to hedge against our exposure to currency
risk. The availability and effectiveness of these hedges may be limited, and we may not be able to
successfully hedge our exposure at all.
RISK FACTORS
—6 9—


--- page 79 ---
Changes in geopolitical relationships, international trade policies and other tensions may impact our
business operations.
During the Track Record Period, we generated a substantial portion of our revenue from customers
in foreign countries and regions, in particular the United States. Our business is therefore subject to
constantly changing international economic, regulatory, social and global political conditions, and local
conditions in those foreign countries and regions. As a result, China’s relationships with those foreign
countries and regions may affect the demand for our services and our ability to serve foreign customers.
There can be no assurance that such customers will not alter their perception of us or their preferences as
a result of adverse changes to the relationships between China and the relevant foreign countries or
regions. Any tensions and concerns between China and the relevant foreign countries or regions may cause
a decline in the demand for our services and adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of
operations, cash flows and prospects.
In recent years, as trade frictions increase between the United States and China, concerns exist
among PRC enterprises transacting with United States companies that a possible trade war between the
two countries could have possible impact on their business. Elevated tensions between the two countries
have been driven by a range of factors, including global pandemic, legislative actions, economic sanctions,
and executive orders. These developments have led to restrictions on various transactions and
investments involving Chinese enterprises. Rising tensions could reduce levels of trades, investments,
technological exchanges and other economic activities between the two major economies, which would
have a material adverse effect on global economic conditions and the stability of global financial markets.
A trade friction between global large trade partners could also threaten the ongoing global economic
development and the increasing cross-border transactions trend. A deterioration in Sino-US relationship
could negatively impact the global economic development and the cross-border transactions between
China and the United States. Given that a substantial number of our customers are pharmaceutical and
biotechnology companies in the United States, the demands of our services are significantly influenced by
United States government’s attitude toward Chinese services providers in pharmaceutical and
biotechnology industries. We cannot assure you that we will not be negatively influenced by the increasing
trade frictions between the United States and China as well as by adverse changes in United States laws
and regulations toward diplomatic relations. As a result, our business, financial condition, results of
operations and business prospects could be materially and adversely affected.
We are required to make adequate contributions to social insurance and housing provident fund for
our employees under the PRC regulations.
Pursuant to the relevant PRC laws and regulations, employers are obligated to contribute to the social
insurance and housing provident funds for their employees. If any of the relevant social insurance
authorities is of the view that the social insurance contributions we made for our employees do not comply
with the requirements under the relevant PRC laws and regulations, it may order us to pay the outstanding
balance within a prescribed time period plus a late fee of 0.05% of the total outstanding balance per day.
If we fail to do so within the prescribed period as requested by the relevant social insurance authorities,
we may be subject to a fine ranging between one to three times of the total outstanding balance. In
addition, if any of the relevant housing provident fund authorities is of the view that our contributions to
the housing provident fund do not satisfy the requirements under the relevant PRC laws and regulations,
it may order us to pay the outstanding balance within a prescribed period. If we fail to do so within the
prescribed period, the relevant housing provident fund authority may apply to a PRC court for an order
of mandatory payment.
RISK FACTORS
—7 0—


--- page 80 ---
As of the Latest Practicable Date, no material administrative action, fine or penalty had been
imposed by relevant regulatory authorities with respect to our social insurance or housing provident fund
contributions. In addition, we did not receive any notice from judicial or administrative authorities on any
claim from our current and former employees regarding any inadequate contributions.
During the Track Record Period, we engaged third-party human resource agencies to make social
insurance and housing provident fund contributions for certain employees. As of the Latest Practicable
Date, the practice had not been explicitly prohibited by PRC laws and regulations, and we had not received
any administrative penalty from the regulatory authorities for such practice. As of the Latest Practicable
Date, we had not been subject to any labor dispute relating to such arrangements. However, as the
labor-related laws and regulations and their interpretation and implementation continue to evolve, we
cannot assure you that our arrangements with third-party agencies are and will at all times be deemed to
be in full compliance with relevant laws and regulations, which may subject us to labor disputes or
government investigations. In addition, if these agencies fail to fulfill their obligations to make the social
insurance and housing provident fund contributions for the relevant employees, we may be subject to
additional contribution obligations, late payment fees and/or penalties imposed by relevant regulatory
authorities for failing to discharge our obligations as an employer or be ordered to rectify. The occurrence
of any of the foregoing could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Failure to comply with PRC property laws and relevant regulations may affect our business, results
of operations and financial condition.
We lease certain properties from third parties to be used mainly as office, factories and R&D
premises. As of the Latest Practicable Date, three of our leased properties had title defects that may affect
our ability to continue to use them normally in the future. The existence of title defects is mainly due to
the following reasons: (1) the lessors of two leased properties are different from the real estate owners of
such leased properties, and (2) the intended purposes contained in the property ownership certificates of
one property is inconsistent with the actual use of property. The relevant lease agreements may be deemed
invalid or we may face challenges from the property owners or other third parties regarding our right to
lease the premises. Furthermore, if the landlords fail to perform its obligations under the lease agreements
between the landlords and us due to any reason, including but not limited to its own non-compliance with
relevant laws and regulations, government demolition or any other unforeseeable events, we may be
unable to continue using such properties. As of the Latest Practicable Date, we are not aware of any
challenges being made by a third party or government authority on the titles of any of these leased
properties that might affect our current occupation. Although we do not expect to become subject to any
fines or penalties if any of these leases are terminated as a result of challenges by third parties or
government authorities for any of these title defects, we may be forced to relocate the affected offices,
factories and R&D premises and incur additional expenses accordingly. If we fail to find suitable
replacement sites in a timely manner or on terms commercially acceptable to us, our business and results
of operations could be materially and adversely affected.
Under the applicable PRC laws and regulations, the parties to a lease are required to register and file
such lease with the relevant government authorities. As of the Latest Practicable Date, certain lease
agreements of our leased properties had not been registered or filed, and we had not obtained registration
certificate for one lease agreement. While the lack of registration will not affect the validity of the leases
under PRC laws and regulations, we may be ordered by the relevant government authorities to register the
relevant leases within a prescribed period, failing which we may be subject to a fine ranging from
RMB1,000 to RMB10,000 for each non-registered lease.
RISK FACTORS
—7 1—


--- page 81 ---
There may be difficulty in protecting your interest under the law of Cayman Islands.
Our corporate affairs are governed by our Memorandum of Association, Articles of Association, the
Cayman Companies Act, and the common law of the Cayman Islands. Y our rights, as a Shareholder, to take
action against the Directors, the rights of minority Shareholders to institute actions and the fiduciary
responsibilities of our Directors to us under Cayman Islands law are to a large extent governed by the
common law of the Cayman Islands. The common law of the Cayman Islands is derived in part from
comparatively limited judicial precedent in the Cayman Islands as well as from English common law,
which has persuasive, but not binding, authority on a court in the Cayman Islands. There may be difficulty
in protecting your interest under the law of Cayman Islands.
Inflation could affect our profitability and growth.
The governments of the jurisdictions where we operate have implemented various policies and may
continue to implement various policies from time to time to reduce inflation, including imposing various
corrective measures designed to regulate the availability of credit or regulate growth. High inflation in the
future may cause the governments of the jurisdictions where we operate to regulate credit and/or price of
commodities, or to take other similar actions. Any action on the part of such governments that seeks to
regulate credit and/or price of commodities may affect our business operations, causing impact on our
profitability and growth.
RISKS RELATING TO OUR RELATIONSHIP WITH REMAINING WXB GROUP AND WXAT
GROUP
If we are no longer able to benefit from our cooperation with the Remaining WXB Group and the
WXAT Group, our business may be adversely affected.
We have benefited from during the Track Record Period, and expect to continue to benefit from, our
cooperation with the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group for various forms, such as discovery
and development, manufacturing and quality testing services in relation to antibodies, payload-linkers, raw
material procurement services, project management services and overseas technical support services. In
2020, 2021 and 2022, the amount of non-exempt continuing connected transactions with the Remaining
WXB Group was RMB51.5 million, RMB253.3 million and RMB794.8 million, respectively, and the
amount of non-exempt continuing connected transactions with the WXA T Group was nil, RMB23.3
million and RMB137.8 million in the same periods, respectively. See “Connected Transactions —
Non-exempt Continuing Connected Transactions.” If the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group
fail to continue their cooperation with us, provide support to us, or conducts business in an unacceptable
manner or takes other actions that are detrimental to our interests, we may have to renegotiate with them
for the cooperation or support or attempt to approach other business partners as replacements, which may
be expensive, time-consuming and disruptive to our operations. If we are unable to maintain our
relationship with the Remaining WXB Group or the WXA T Group, our business and operations could be
severely disrupted, which could materially and adversely affect our results of operations and financial
condition.
RISK FACTORS
—7 2—


--- page 82 ---
The Remaining WXB Group and the WXAT Group may exert substantial influence over our
operations and may not act in the best interests of the independent Shareholders.
Immediately following the completion of the Global Offering (assuming the Over-allotment Option
is not exercised and without taking into account of any exercise of the share options granted under the
Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes), WuXi Biologics and STA Pharmaceutical will each control over 30% of
the voting power of Shares in issue. See “History, Reorganization and Corporate Structure” for details.
Therefore, the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group will be able to exercise significant influence
over matters requiring Shareholders’ approval, including the election of Directors and the approval of
certain significant corporate transactions. Such concentration of ownership also may have the effect of
delaying, preventing or deterring a change in control of the Company that would otherwise benefit the
Shareholders. The interests of the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group may not always coincide
with our or your best interests. If the interests of the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group
conflict with our interests or those of the other Shareholders, or if the Remaining WXB Group and the
WXA T Group choose to cause our business to pursue strategic objectives that conflict with our interests
or those of the other Shareholders, we or those other Shareholders, including you, may be disadvantaged
as a result.
We may have conflict of interest with the Remaining WXB Group and the WXAT Group and,
because of their ownership interest in our Company, we may not be able to resolve such potential
conflicts on terms favorable to us.
We may have conflict of interest with the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group and,
because of their ownership interest in our Company, we may not be able to resolve such conflict on terms
favorable to us. Conflict of interest may arise between the Remaining WXB Group or the WXA T Group
and us in a number of areas relating to our ongoing relationships, for example, for employee and talent
recruitment. Although the Company will become a stand-alone public company, we expect to operate, for
as long as WuXi Biologics and STA Pharmaceutical remain our Controlling Shareholders, as a subsidiary
or an affiliate of our Controlling Shareholders. They may from time to time make strategic decisions that
they believe are in the best interests of their business and shareholders as a whole. These decisions may
be different from the decisions that we would have made on our own. Their decisions with respect to us
or our business may be resolved in ways that favor themselves and therefore their Shareholders, which
may not coincide with our interests and the interests of our other Shareholders. After we become a
stand-alone public company, we will have an audit committee, consisting of independent non-executive
Directors, to review and approve all proposed connected transactions as defined in the Listing Rules.
However, we may not be able to resolve all potential conflicts, and even if we do so, the resolution may
be less favorable to us than if we were dealing with a non-controlling shareholder. For further details as
to how we address such conflicts, see “Relationship with our Controlling Shareholders.”
Any negative development in the WXB Group’s market position and brand image may adversely
affect the strength and integrity of our brand.
We have benefited significantly and expect to continue to benefit significantly from the WXB
Group’s strong brand recognition and broad customer base, which provide us credibility and a broad
marketing reach. If the WXB Group loses its market position, the effectiveness of our marketing efforts
through our association with the WXB Group may be materially and adversely affected. In addition, any
negative publicity associated with the WXB Group or any negative development with respect to the WXB
Group’s market position and brand image, it could have an adverse impact on our business, our marketing
efforts, our relationships with strategic partners and users, our reputation and brand.
RISK FACTORS
—7 3—


--- page 83 ---
RISKS RELATING TO CONDUCTING BUSINESS IN CHINA AND OTHER JURISDICTIONS
WHERE WE OPERATE
We may be subject to the approval, filing or other requirements of the CSRC or other PRC
governmental authorities in connection with future capital raising activities, and, if required, we
cannot predict whether we will be able to obtain such approval or complete such filing.
On July 6, 2021, the General Office of the State Council, together with another regulatory authority,
jointly promulgated the Opinions on Strictly Combating Illegal Securities Activities in Accordance with
the Law (จԈ), which calls for, among others, enhanced administration
and supervision of overseas-listed China-based companies, proposes to revise the relevant regulation
governing the overseas issuance and listing of shares by such companies, and clarifies the responsibilities
of competent domestic industry regulators and government authorities.
On February 17, 2023, the China Securities Regulatory Commission (“ CSRC ”) released the Trial
Administrative Measures of Overseas Securities Offering and Listing by Domestic Companies ( ྤʫΆุ
جand five supporting guidelines (together, “ Trial Measures ”), which
came into effect on March 31, 2023. Pursuant to the Trial Measures, domestic companies that seek to list
overseas, both directly and indirectly, should fulfill the filing procedure and report relevant information
to the CSRC. Specifically, following the principle of substance over form, if an issuer meets both of the
following criteria, its overseas offering and listing will be deemed as an indirect overseas offering and
listing by a domestic enterprise: (1) any of the total assets, net assets, revenue or profits of the domestic
operating entities of the issuer in the most recent accounting year accounts for more than 50% of the
corresponding figure in the issuer’s audited consolidated financial statements for the same period; and (2)
its major operational activities are carried out in China or its main places of business are located in China,
or a majority of the senior management in charge of operation and management of the issuer are Chinese
citizens or are domiciled in China. The filing is required to be conducted within three business days after
the submission of the application for initial public offering and listing overseas to the overseas regulators.
The CSRC will review the filing application and may have queries and may consult with other relevant
regulators. Filings granted by the CSRC will have a valid term of one year during which the issuer should
complete the offering. Further follow-up offerings after overseas listings also require a filing within three
business days after the completion of the offering, and the listed companies will need to report to the
CSRC upon the occurrence and public disclosure of certain significant matters such as a change in control,
penalty received from overseas securities regulators or relevant PRC regulators, a switch of listing status
and a termination of listing. See “Regulatory Overview — Laws and Regulations of the PRC —
Regulations on Overseas Listing” for details. If a domestic company fails to complete the filing procedure
or conceals any material fact or falsifies any major content in its filing documents, such domestic company
may be subject to administrative penalties, such as orders to rectify, warnings, fines, and its controlling
shareholders, actual controllers, the person directly in charge and other directly liable persons may also
be subject to administrative penalties, such as warnings and fines.
RISK FACTORS
—7 4—


--- page 84 ---
Our PRC Legal Advisor is of the view that this Listing shall be deemed as an indirect overseas
offering and listing by PRC domestic enterprise, and we are required to submit filings with the CSRC
within three business days after we submit application for this Listing. We submitted the required filing
documents with the CSRC on July 12, 2023. On October 19, 2023, the CSRC issued a notification on our
completion of the PRC filing procedures for the listing of our Shares on the Stock Exchange and the
Global Offering. As advised by our PRC Legal Advisor, no other approvals from the CSRC are required
to be obtained for the listing of our Shares on the Stock Exchange. A rescission of any such approval or
filing obtained by us would subject us to sanctions by the CSRC or other PRC regulatory authorities, and
such failure may materially adversely affect our ability to finance the development of our business and,
in turn, our business and financial condition. Furthermore, if the filing procedure with the CSRC under
the Trial Measures is required for any future offerings, listing or any other capital raising activities, it is
uncertain whether we could complete the filing procedure in relation to any further capital raising
activities in a timely manner, or at all.
On February 24, 2023, the CSRC, the Ministry of Finance, the National Administration of State
Secrets Protection, and the National Archives Administration of China published the revised Provisions on
Strengthening the Confidentiality and Archives Administration of Overseas Securities Offering and
Listing by Domestic Companies (஝
֛“() Archives Rules ”) which came into effect on March 31, 2023. The Archives Rules require that, in
relation to the overseas securities offering and listing activities of domestic enterprises, either in direct or
indirect form, such domestic enterprises, as well as securities companies and securities service institutions
providing relevant securities services, are required to strictly comply with relevant requirements on
confidentiality and archives management, establish a sound confidentiality and archives system, and take
necessary measures to implement their confidentiality and archives management responsibilities.
According to the Archives Rules, during an overseas offering and listing, if a domestic company needs to
provide or publicly disclose to securities companies, securities service providers and overseas regulators,
any materials that contain relevant state secrets or that have an adverse impact on the national security or
public interests, the domestic company should complete the relevant approval/filing and other regulatory
procedures.
The CSRC or other PRC regulatory authorities may also take actions requiring us, or making it
advisable for us, to halt this offering or future capital raising activities before settlement and delivery of
the Shares offered hereby. Consequently, if you engage in market trading or other activities in anticipation
of and prior to settlement and delivery, you do so at the risk that settlement and delivery may not occur.
In addition, if the CSRC or other regulatory authorities later promulgate new rules or explanations
requiring that we obtain their approvals or accomplish the required filing or other regulatory procedures
in addition to those prescribed under the Trial Measures for this offering or future capital raising activities,
we may be unable to obtain a waiver of such approval requirements, if and when procedures are
established to obtain such a waiver. Any such circumstances regarding such approval, filing or other
requirements could materially and adversely affect our business, prospects, financial condition, reputation,
and trading price of the Shares.
However, given that the Trial Measures and Archives Rules were recently promulgated, their
interpretation, application, and enforcement are still evolving and we are closely monitoring how they will
affect our operations and our future financing.
RISK FACTORS
—7 5—


--- page 85 ---
Failure to comply with PRC regulations relating to the establishment of offshore special purpose
companies by PRC residents may subject our PRC resident beneficiaries to personal liability, may
affect our ability to acquire PRC companies or to inject capital into our PRC subsidiaries, may affect
the ability of our PRC subsidiaries to distribute profits to us or may otherwise materially and
adversely affect us.
Pursuant to the Circular on Issues concerning the Foreign Exchange Administration of the Overseas
Investment and Financing and the Round-Tripping Investment Made by Domestic Residents through
Special-Purpose Companies (೻ҳ༟̮ි၍ଣϞᗫਪᕚ
ٝ“() Circular 37 ”), which was promulgated by the State Administration for Foreign Exchange of the
PRC ( ʕശɛ͏΍ձ਷ ̮ි၍ଣ҅ )( “ SAFE ”) and became effective on July 4, 2014, (1) a PRC resident
(including PRC institutions and individuals) must register with the local SAFE branch before he or she
contributes assets or equity interests in an overseas special purpose vehicle (“ Overseas SPV ”) that is
directly established or indirectly controlled by the PRC resident for the purpose of conducting investment
or financing; and (2) following the initial registration, the PRC resident is also required to register with
the local SAFE branch for any changes of the basic information in respect of the Overseas SPV , including,
among other things, a change in the Overseas SPV’s PRC resident shareholder, name of the Overseas SPV ,
term of operation, or any substantial changes in respect of the Overseas SPV , including, among other
things, any increase or reduction of the contributions by the PRC resident, share transfer or swap, and
merger or division. Pursuant to the SAFE Circular on Further Simplification and Improvement in Foreign
Exchange Administration Policies on Direct Investment (ટҳ༟
ٝ“() Circular 13 ”), which was promulgated on February 13, 2015 and amended on
December 30, 2019, the aforesaid registration shall be directly reviewed and handled by qualified banks
in accordance with the Circular 13, and SAFE and its branches shall perform indirect regulation over the
foreign exchange registration via qualified banks.
We may not at all times be fully aware or informed of the identities of all our beneficiaries who are
PRC residents, and may not always be able to compel our beneficiaries to comply with the requirements
of the Circular 37. As a result, we cannot assure you that all of our beneficiaries who are PRC residents
will at all times comply with, or in the future make or obtain any applicable registrations or approvals
required by the Circular 37 or other related regulations. Under the relevant rules, failure to comply with
the registration procedures set forth in the Circular 37 may limit the foreign exchange activities of the
relevant PRC enterprise and may also subject the relevant PRC resident to penalties under the PRC foreign
exchange administration regulations.
Any failure to comply with PRC regulations regarding our employee equity incentive plans may
subject the PRC plan participants or us to fines and other legal or administrative sanctions.
In February 2012, SAFE promulgated the Circular on Relevant Issues Concerning the Foreign
Exchange Administration for Domestic Individuals Participating in Stock Incentive Plans of Overseas
Publicly Listed Companies (ٝ)
“(SAFE Circular 7 ”), replacing the previous rules issued by SAFE in March 2007. Under the SAFE
Circular 7 and other relevant rules and regulations, PRC residents who participate in an equity incentive
plan in an overseas publicly-listed company are required to register with SAFE or its local branches and
complete certain other procedures. Participants of an equity incentive plan who are PRC residents must
retain a qualified PRC agent, which could be a PRC subsidiary of the overseas publicly listed company
or another qualified institution selected by the PRC subsidiary, to conduct the SAFE registration and other
procedures with respect to the equity incentive plan on behalf of its participants. The participants must
RISK FACTORS
—7 6—


--- page 86 ---
also retain an overseas entrusted institution to handle matters in connection with their exercise of stock
options, the purchase and sale of corresponding stocks or interests and fund transfers. In addition, the PRC
agent is required to amend the SAFE registration with respect to the equity incentive plan if there is any
material change to the equity incentive plan, the PRC agent or the overseas entrusted institution or other
material changes. We and our PRC employees who have been granted share options will be subject to these
regulations upon the completion of this Global Offering. Failure of our PRC share option holders to
complete their SAFE registrations may subject these PRC residents to fines of up to RMB300,000 for
entities and up to RMB50,000 for individuals, and legal sanctions and may also affect our ability to
contribute additional capital to our PRC subsidiary, affect our PRC subsidiary’s ability to distribute
dividends to us, or otherwise materially and adversely affect our business.
The SA T has also issued relevant rules and regulations concerning employee share incentives. Under
these rules and regulations, our employees working in the PRC will be subject to PRC individual income
tax upon exercise of the share options. Our PRC subsidiary has obligations to file documents with respect
to the granted share options or restricted shares with relevant tax authorities and to withhold individual
income taxes for their employees upon exercise of the share options or grant of the restricted shares. If
our employees fail to pay or we fail to withhold their individual income taxes according to relevant rules
and regulations, we may face sanctions imposed by the competent governmental authorities
Any uncertainties embedded in the legal systems of certain jurisdictions where we operate could
adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations and our investors could
be affected as a result.
The legal systems of the jurisdictions where we operate vary significantly. Some jurisdictions have
a civil law system based on written statutes and others are largely based on common law. Unlike common
law systems where the case laws have binding effects, prior court decisions under civil law systems may
be cited for reference but have limited precedential value. We are based in China and our business in China
are governed by PRC laws and regulations. The PRC legal system is a civil law system based on written
statutes. Since the late 1970s, the PRC government has promulgated laws and regulations dealing with
economic matters, such as foreign investment, corporate organization and governance, commerce, taxation
and trade, with a view towards developing a comprehensive system of commercial law. However, as the
legal system in China continues to develop, and many of these laws and regulations are relatively new and
continue to evolve, these laws and regulations may be subject to interpretation. As other civil law
countries, there is a limited volume of published court decisions, which may be cited for reference but are
not binding on subsequent cases and have limited precedential value unless the Supreme People’s Court
otherwise provides. As these laws and regulations are continually evolving in response to changing
economic and other conditions, we cannot foresee how these laws, rules and regulations will be interpreted
and enforced, which may adversely affect the legal protections and remedies that are available to investors
and us.
It may be difficult to effect service of process, enforce foreign judgments and arbitral awards against
us or our Directors and senior management.
We are incorporated in the Cayman Islands. A significant number of our operating subsidiaries are
incorporated in China. In addition, most of our Directors and senior management reside in China. A
substantial amount of our assets and some of the assets of our management are located in China. As a
result, it may be difficult or impracticable for you to effect service of process within Hong Kong upon us
RISK FACTORS
—7 7—


--- page 87 ---
or these persons, to bring an action in Hong Kong against us or these individuals. Moreover, China does
not have treaties with most of the other jurisdictions that provide for the reciprocal recognition and
enforcement of judicial rulings and awards.
On July 14, 2006, the Supreme People’s Court of China and Hong Kong entered into the
Arrangement on Reciprocal Recognition and Enforcement of Judgments in Civil and Commercial Matters
by the Courts of the Mainland and of the Hong Kong Special Administrative Region Pursuant to Choice
of Court Agreements between Parties Concerned (ʝႩ̙ձੂБ຅ԫɛ
τર)( “ 2006 Arrangement ”), which became effective on August 1, 2008.
Pursuant to such arrangement, a party with a final judgment rendered by a Hong Kong court requiring
payment of money in a civil and commercial case according to a choice of court agreement in writing may
apply for recognition and enforcement of the judgment in China, and vice versa. However, it is subject to
the parties in the dispute agreeing to enter into a choice of court agreement in writing under the 2006
Arrangement.
On January 18, 2019, the Supreme People’s Court of China and Hong Kong entered into the
Arrangement on Reciprocal Recognition and Enforcement of Judgments in Civil and Commercial Matters
by the Courts of the Mainland and of the Hong Kong Special Administrative Region (ಥत
τર)( “ 2019 Arrangement ”), the commencement date
of which shall be announced after the Supreme People’s Court promulgates judicial interpretations and
relevant procedures are completed in Hong Kong. The 2019 Arrangement will supersede the 2006
Arrangement and afford greater clarity and certainty for reciprocal recognition and enforcement of
judgments in civil and commercial matters. The 2006 Arrangement will remain applicable to a “choice of
court agreement in writing” entered into before the 2019 Arrangement taking effect. However, outcomes
of any applications to recognize and enforce such judgments and arbitral awards in China will be subject
to the PRC courts further adjudication in accordance with PRC laws, including the PRC civil procedure
law.
Furthermore, an original action may only be brought in China against us or our Directors and senior
management if the actions are not required to be arbitrated by PRC law and upon satisfaction of the
conditions for commencing a cause of action pursuant to the PRC civil procedure law. As a result of the
conditions set forth in the PRC civil procedure law, we cannot assure you whether investors will be able
to bring an original action in China in this manner.
Laws and regulations over currency conversion and future fluctuation of Renminbi exchange rates
could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition, and may reduce the value
of, and dividends payable on, our Shares in foreign currency terms.
The PRC government imposes laws and regulations on the convertibility of the Renminbi into
foreign currencies and, in certain cases, the remittance of currency out of China. Under our current
corporate structure, our Company in the Cayman Islands relies on dividend payments from our PRC
subsidiaries to fund any cash and financing requirements we may have. Under existing PRC foreign
exchange regulations, payments of current account items, such as profit distributions and trade and
service-related foreign exchange transactions, can be made in foreign currencies without the prior
approval of SAFE, by complying with certain procedural requirements. Therefore, our PRC subsidiaries
are able to pay dividends in foreign currencies to us without prior approval from SAFE, subject to the
condition that the remittance of such dividends outside of the PRC complies with certain procedures under
PRC foreign exchange regulations, such as the overseas investment registration by the beneficial owners
RISK FACTORS
—7 8—


--- page 88 ---
of our Company who are PRC residents. However, approval from or registration with appropriate
governmental authorities is required where Renminbi is to be converted into foreign currency and remitted
out of China to pay capital expenses, such as the repayment of loans denominated in foreign currencies.
The PRC government may further regulate access to foreign currencies for current account
transactions in the future. If the foreign exchange regulation system makes it difficult for us to obtain
sufficient foreign currencies to satisfy our foreign currency demands, we may not be able to pay dividends
in foreign currencies to our shareholders. Further, there is no assurance that new regulations will not be
promulgated in the future that would have the effect of further regulating the remittance of Renminbi into
or out of China.
The value of Renminbi against the Hong Kong dollar, the U.S. dollar and other currencies fluctuates,
is subject to change resulting from the PRC government’s policies, and depends to a large extent on
domestic and international economic and global political developments as well as supply and demand in
the local market. It is difficult to predict how market forces or government policies may impact the
exchange rate between the Renminbi and the Hong Kong dollar, the U.S. dollar or other currencies in the
future.
The proceeds from the Global Offering will be received in Hong Kong dollars. As a result, any
appreciation of the Renminbi against the Hong Kong dollar may result in a decrease in the value of our
proceeds from the Global Offering. Conversely, any depreciation of the Renminbi may affect the value of,
and any dividends payable on, the Shares in foreign currency terms. Further, we may not be able to find
suitable instruments to reduce our foreign currency risk exposure at reasonable costs. All of these factors
could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition, and could reduce the
value of, and dividends payable on, the Shares in foreign currency terms.
We may be classified as a PRC resident enterprise for PRC enterprise income tax purposes under
the EIT Law, and our income may be subject to PRC withholding tax under the EIT Law.
Under the Enterprise Income Tax Law of the PRC (ج“() EIT Law ”), an
enterprise established outside of the PRC with a “de facto management body” within China is considered
a resident enterprise and will be subject to the enterprise income tax on its global income at the rate of
25%. The implementation rules (“ EIT Rules ”) define the term “de facto management body” as the body
that exercises full and substantial control over, and overall management of, the business, production,
personnel, accounts and properties of an enterprise. On April 22, 2009, the State Administration of
Taxation (೼ਕᐼ҅)( “ SAT”) issued a circular, known as Circular 82, which was last amended on
December 29, 2017. Circular 82 provides certain specific criteria for determining whether the “de facto
management body” of a PRC-controlled enterprise that is incorporated offshore is located in China.
Although this circular only applies to offshore enterprises controlled by PRC enterprises or PRC enterprise
groups, not those with no single individual controller like us, the criteria set forth in the circular may
reflect the SA T’s general position on how the “de facto management body” test should be applied in
determining the tax resident status of all offshore enterprises. According to Circular 82, an offshore
incorporated enterprise controlled by a PRC enterprise or a PRC enterprise group will be regarded as a
PRC tax resident by virtue of having its “de facto management body” in China and will be subject to PRC
enterprise income tax on its global income only if all of the following conditions are met: (1) the primary
location of the day-to-day operational management is in China; (2) decisions relating to the enterprise’s
financial and human resource matters are made or are subject to approval by organizations or personnel
RISK FACTORS
—7 9—


--- page 89 ---
in China; (3) the enterprise’s primary assets, accounting books and records, company seal, and board and
shareholder resolutions, are located or maintained in China; and (4) at least 50% of voting board members
or senior executives habitually reside in China.
We believe none of our entities outside of China is a PRC resident enterprise for PRC tax purposes.
However, the tax resident status of an enterprise is subject to determination by the PRC tax authorities and
we cannot be certain on how the tax authorities will interpret the term “de facto management body”. As
most of our management members are based in China, it remains unclear how the tax residency rule will
apply to our case. If the PRC tax authorities determine that our Company or any of our subsidiaries outside
of the PRC is a PRC resident enterprise for PRC enterprise income tax purposes, our Company or such
subsidiary could be subject to PRC tax at a rate of 25% on its worldwide income, which could materially
reduce our net profit. In addition, we will also be subject to PRC enterprise income tax reporting
obligations. Furthermore, if the PRC tax authorities determine that we are a PRC resident enterprise for
enterprise income tax purposes, gains realized on the sale or other disposition of our ordinary shares may
be subject to PRC tax, at a rate of 10% in the case of non-PRC enterprises or 20% in the case of non-PRC
individuals (in each case, subject to the provisions of any applicable tax treaty), if such gains are deemed
to be from PRC sources. There is possibility that non-PRC shareholders of our Company would not be able
to claim the benefits of any tax treaties between their country of tax residence and the PRC in the event
that we are treated as a PRC resident enterprise. Any such tax may reduce the returns on your investment
in our Shares.
Our potential growth through acquisitions in China is subject to the procedures established under
China’s M&A rules, laws and certain other PRC regulations, which could make it more difficult for
us to complete such acquisitions.
On August 8, 2006, MOFCOM, State-owned Assets Supervision and Administration Commission of
the State Council (ึ), SA T, the State Administration for Industry and
Commerce of the PRC (၍ଣᐼ҅), the CSRC and SAFE jointly issued the Regulations for
Mergers with and Acquisition of Domestic Enterprises by Foreign Investors (ԻᒅྤʫΆ
֛“() M&A Rules ”), which was effective on September 8, 2006 and amended in June 2009. Merger
and acquisition activities by foreign investors are subject to procedures and requirements under M&A
Rules, laws and other regulations and rules concerning M&A, including requirements in some instances
that MOFCOM be notified in advance of any change-of-control transaction in which a foreign investor
takes control of a PRC domestic enterprise, which could potentially require a foreign investor to spend
more time navigating through the review process. In addition, the Provisions of the Ministry of Commerce
on the Implementation of the Safety Review System for Merger and Acquisition of Domestic Enterprises
by Foreign Investors (֛issued by MOFCOM
that became effective in September 2011 specify that mergers and acquisitions by foreign investors that
raise “national defense and security” concerns and mergers and acquisitions through which foreign
investors may acquire de facto control over domestic enterprises that raise “national security” concerns are
subject to strict review by MOFCOM, and the rules prohibit any activities attempting to bypass a security
review, including by structuring the transaction through a proxy or contractual control arrangement.
Moreover, the Anti-Monopoly Law promulgated by the Standing Committee of the National People’s
Congress of China and effective in 2008, as most recently amended on June 24, 2022 and effective from
August 1, 2022, requires that transactions which are deemed concentrations and involve parties with
specified turnover thresholds must be cleared by the relevant anti-monopoly authority before they can be
completed. It also requires business operators not to abuse data, algorithms, technology, capital advantages
and platform rules to exclude or limit competition.
RISK FACTORS
—8 0—


--- page 90 ---
In the future, we may grow our business by acquiring complementary businesses. Complying with
the requirements of the abovementioned regulations and other relevant rules to complete such transactions
could be time-consuming, and any required approval processes, including obtaining approval from
MOFCOM or its local counterparts may affect our ability to complete such transactions, which could
affect our ability to expand our business or maintain our market share.
PRC regulation of loans to and direct investments in PRC entities by offshore holding companies
may make it difficult for us to use the proceeds of the Global Offering to make loan or additional
capital contributions to our PRC subsidiaries, which could materially and adversely affect our
liquidity and our ability to fund and expand our business.
We are an offshore holding company conducting our operations in China through our PRC
subsidiaries. We may make loans to our PRC subsidiaries, subject to the administrative procedures and
limitation of amount, or we may make additional capital contributions to our PRC subsidiaries in China.
Any funds we transfer to our PRC subsidiaries, either as a shareholder loan or as an increase in
registered capital, are subject to reporting with or approval by or registration with the relevant
governmental authorities in China. According to the relevant PRC regulations on foreign-invested
enterprises in China, capital contributions to our PRC subsidiaries are subject to the requirement of
making necessary filings or reports in the Foreign Investment Comprehensive Management Information
System, and registration with a local bank authorized by SAFE and also registration with the local branch
of State Administration for Market Regulation. In addition, any foreign loan procured by our PRC
subsidiaries is required to be registered with SAFE or its local branches. Also, any medium- or long-term
loan exceeding one year to be provided by us must be recorded and registered by the National
Development and Reform Committee. Our PRC subsidiaries which are foreign-invested enterprises cannot
procure loans exceeding the statutory limits, which is either in the difference between the registered
capital and the total investment amount of such foreign-invested enterprise or a multiple of the net assets
of such foreign-invested enterprise in the previous year. Our PRC subsidiaries which are domestic
enterprises cannot procure loans exceeding the multiples of the net assets of such enterprises in the
previous year. We may not be able to complete such recording, filing or registrations on a timely basis,
if at all, with respect to future capital contributions or foreign loans by us directly to our PRC subsidiaries.
If we fail to complete such recording, filing or registrations, our ability to use the proceeds of the Global
Offering and to capitalize our PRC operations may be negatively affected, which could adversely affect
our liquidity and our ability to fund and expand our business.
SAFE issued the Circular on the Reform of the Management Method for the Settlement of Foreign
Exchange Capital of Foreign-invested Enterprises (ഐ
ٝ“() Circular 19 ”) which took effect on June 1, 2015 and amended on December 30,
2019 and March 23, 2023. SAFE further issued the Circular of the State Administration of Foreign
Exchange on Reform and Standardization of the Management Policy of the Settlement of Capital Projects
(ٝ“() Circular 16 ”), effective on June 9,
2016, which, among other things, amend certain provisions of Circular 19. The Circular 19 and the
Circular 16 allow for the use of Renminbi converted from the foreign currency-denominated capital for
equity investments in the PRC, provided that such usage shall fall into the scope of business of the foreign
invested enterprise, which will be regarded as the reinvestment of foreign-invested enterprise. In addition,
SAFE promulgated the Circular on Further Facilitating the Convenience of Cross-border Trade and
Investment (ٝ“() SAFE Circular 28 ”) on
October 23, 2019, which took effect on the same day. SAFE Circular 28, subject to certain conditions,
RISK FACTORS
—8 1—


--- page 91 ---
allows foreign-invested enterprises whose business scope does not include investment, or non-investment
foreign-invested enterprises, to use their capital funds to make equity investments in China. As of the
Latest Practicable Date, its interpretation and implementation in practice continue to evolve. Whether
SAFE will permit such capital funds to be used for equity investments in the PRC is subject to SAFE’s
case-by-case determination in practice. The Circular 19, the Circular 16 and SAFE Circular 28 may affect
our ability to transfer to and use in China the net proceeds from the Global Offering, which may adversely
affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Dividends payable by us to our foreign investors and gains on the sale of our Shares may become
subject to withholding taxes under PRC tax laws.
Under the PRC EIT Law and the EIT Rules, its implementation regulations, subject to any applicable
tax treaty or similar arrangement between the PRC and your jurisdiction of residence that provides
otherwise, we may be deemed as a PRC resident enterprise by the PRC tax authorities for tax purpose.
PRC income tax at the rate of 10% is applicable to dividends payable by a PRC “resident enterprise” to
investors that are “non-resident enterprises” (i.e., those enterprises that do not have an establishment or
place of business in China, or those that have such an establishment or place of business but the relevant
income of which is not effectively connected with the establishment or place of business) to the extent
such dividends have their source within China. Similarly, any gain realized on the transfer of shares by
such enterprises is also subject to 10% PRC income tax if such gain is regarded as income derived from
sources within China. If the dividends we pay to our shareholders are regarded as income derived from
sources within China, we may be required to withhold a 10% PRC withholding tax for the dividends we
pay to our investors who are non-PRC enterprise shareholders.
Under PRC Individual Income Tax Law (جand its implementation
rules, dividends from sources within China paid to foreign individual investors who are not PRC residents
and gains from PRC sources realized by such investors on the transfer of share are generally subject to
PRC income tax at a rate of 20% for individuals. Any PRC tax may be reduced or exempted under
applicable tax treaties or similar arrangements.
If we are treated as a PRC resident enterprise, dividends we pay with respect to our Shares, or the
gain realized from the transfer of our Shares, may be treated as income derived from sources within China
and as a result be subject to the PRC income taxes described above. See “— We may be classified as a
PRC resident enterprise for PRC enterprise income tax purposes under the EIT Law, and our income may
be subject to PRC withholding tax under the EIT Law.” However, shareholders who are not PRC tax
residents and seek to enjoy preferential tax rates under relevant tax treaties may apply to the PRC tax
authorities to be recognized as eligible for such benefits in accordance with the Announcement of State
Taxation Administration on Promulgation of the Administrative Measures on Non-resident Taxpayers
Enjoying Treaty Benefits (ʮѓ),
which was issued on October 14, 2019 and took effect on January 1, 2020. If determined to be ineligible
for the applicable tax treaty benefits, gains obtained from sales of our Shares and dividends on our Shares
paid to such Shareholders would subject to higher PRC tax rates. In such cases, the value of your
investment in our Shares may be materially affected by the unfavorable tax treatment.
RISK FACTORS
—8 2—


--- page 92 ---
The regulations over indirect transfers of PRC assets by the PRC tax authorities may have a negative
impact on our business operations, our acquisition or restructuring strategy or the value of your
investment in us.
Pursuant to the Notice on Strengthening the Administration on Enterprise Income Tax for
Non-resident Enterprise Equity Transfer (ٝ)
“(SAT Circular 698 ”) issued by the SA T in December 2009 with retroactive effect from January 1, 2008,
where a non-resident enterprise transfers the equity interests of a PRC resident enterprise indirectly by
disposition of the equity interests of an overseas non-public holding company (an “ Indirect Transfer ”),
and such overseas holding company is located in a tax jurisdiction that (1) has an effective tax rate of less
than 12.5% or (2) does not impose income tax on foreign income of its residents, the non-resident
enterprise, being the transferor, must report such Indirect Transfer to the competent tax authority of the
PRC resident enterprise. Using a “substance over form” principle, the PRC tax authority may disregard the
existence of the overseas holding company if it lacks a reasonable commercial purpose and was
established for the purpose of reducing, avoiding or deferring PRC tax. As a result, gains derived from
such Indirect Transfer may be subject to PRC withholding tax at a rate of up to 10%.
On February 3, 2015, the SA T issued a Public Notice Regarding Certain Corporate Income Tax
Matters on Indirect Transfer of Properties by Non-Tax Resident Enterprises (͏Άุගટᔷᜫৌ
ʮѓ)( “ SAT Public Notice 7 ”). SA T Public Notice 7 supersedes the rules with
respect to the Indirect Transfer under SA T Circular 698, but does not touch upon the other provisions of
SA T Circular 698. SA T Public Notice 7 has introduced a new tax regime that is significantly different from
the previous one under SA T Circular 698. SA T Public Notice 7 extends its tax jurisdiction to not only
Indirect Transfers set forth under SA T Circular 698 but also transactions involving transfer of other taxable
assets through offshore transfer of a foreign intermediate holding company. In addition, SA T Public Notice
7 provides clearer criteria than SA T Circular 698 for assessment of reasonable commercial purposes and
has introduced safe harbors for internal group restructurings and the purchase and sale of equity through
a public securities market. SA T Public Notice 7 also brings challenges to both foreign transferor and
transferee (or other person who is obligated to pay for the transfer) of taxable assets. Where a non-resident
enterprise transfers taxable asset indirectly by disposing of the equity interests of an overseas holding
company, which is an Indirect Transfer, the non-resident enterprise as either transferor or transferee, or the
PRC entity that directly owns the taxable assets, may report such Indirect Transfer to the relevant tax
authority. Using a “substance over form” principle, the PRC tax authority may disregard the existence of
the overseas holding company if it lacks a reasonable commercial purpose and was established for the
purpose of reducing, avoiding or deferring PRC tax. As a result, gains derived from such Indirect Transfer
may be subject to PRC enterprise income tax, and the transferee or other person who is obligated to pay
for the transfer is obligated to withhold the applicable taxes, currently at a rate of 10% for the transfer of
equity interests in a PRC resident enterprise. Both the transferor and the transferee may be subject to
penalties under PRC tax laws if the transferee fails to withhold the taxes and the transferor fails to pay
the taxes.
On October 17, 2017, SA T issued a Public Notice of SA T on Issues Concerning the Withholding of
Non-resident Enterprise Income Tax at Source (ʮѓ)( “ SAT
Public Notice 37 ”), which, among others, repeals the Circular 698 on December 1, 2017. SA T Public
Notice 37 further details and clarifies the tax withholding methods in respect of income of non-resident
enterprises under Circular 698, and certain rules stipulated in SA T Public Notice 7 are replaced by SA T
Public Notice 37. Where the non-resident enterprise fails to declare the tax payable pursuant to Article 39
of the Enterprise Income Tax, the tax authority may order it to pay the tax due within required time limits,
RISK FACTORS
—8 3—


--- page 93 ---
and the non-resident enterprise shall declare and pay the tax payable within such time limits specified by
the tax authority; however, if the non-resident enterprise voluntarily declares and pays the tax payable
before the tax authority orders it to do so within required time limits, it shall be deemed that such
enterprise has paid the tax in time.
Different interpretations remain as to the application of SA T Public Notice 7 and SA T Public Notice
37. For example, while the term “Indirect Transfer” is not clearly defined, it is understood that the relevant
PRC tax authorities have jurisdiction regarding requests for information over a wide range of foreign
entities having no direct contact with the PRC. Moreover, the relevant authority has not yet promulgated
any formal provisions or made any formal declaration as to the process and format for reporting an Indirect
Transfer to the competent tax authority of the relevant PRC resident enterprise. In addition, there are no
formal declarations with regard to how to determine whether a foreign investor has adopted an abusive
arrangement in order to reduce, avoid or defer PRC tax. SA T Public Notice 7 and SA T Public Notice 37
may be determined by the tax authorities to be applicable to previous investments by non-resident
investors in our Company, if any of such transactions were determined by the tax authorities to lack
reasonable commercial purpose. As a result, we and our existing non-resident investors may become at risk
of being taxed under SA T Public Notice 7 and SA T Public Notice 37 and may be required to expend
valuable resources to comply with SA T Public Notice 7 and SA T Public Notice 37 or to establish that we
should not be taxed under SA T Public Notice 7 and SA T Public Notice 37, which may adversely affect our
results of operations and financial condition or such non-resident investors’ investments in us. We may
conduct acquisitions involving changes in corporate structures, and historically we surrendered Shares and
reissued to our current shareholders. We cannot assure you that the PRC tax authorities will not, adjust any
capital gains and impose tax return filing obligations on us or require us to provide assistance for the
investigation of PRC tax authorities with respect thereto. Any PRC tax imposed on a transfer of our Shares
or any adjustment of such gains would cause us to incur additional costs and may affect the value of your
investment in us.
RISKS RELATING TO THE GLOBAL OFFERING
There has been no prior public market for our Shares, and the liquidity and market price of our
Shares may be volatile.
Prior to the Global Offering, there has been no public market for our Shares. The Offer Price range
for our Shares was the result of negotiations between us and the Overall Coordinators, and the Offer Price
may differ significantly from the market price for our Shares following the Global Offering. We have
applied for listing of, and permission to deal in, our Shares on the Stock Exchange. A listing on the Stock
Exchange, however, does not guarantee that an active and liquid trading market for our Shares will
develop, or if it does develop, that it will be sustained following the Global Offering or that the market
price of our Shares will not decline following the Global Offering. Furthermore, the market price and
trading volume of our Shares may be volatile. The following factors may affect the trading volume and
market price of our Shares:
 actual or anticipated fluctuations in our operating performance and revenue;
 news regarding recruitment or departure of key personnel by us or our competitors;
 announcements of competitive developments, acquisitions or strategic alliances in our
industry;
RISK FACTORS
—8 4—


--- page 94 ---
 potential litigation or regulatory investigations;
 general market conditions or other developments affecting us or our industry;
 the operating and stock price performance of other companies and industries, and other events
or factors beyond our control; and
 the release of lock-up or other transfer restrictions on our outstanding Shares or sales or
perceived sales of Shares by us or other Shareholders.
Moreover, the capital market has from time to time experienced significant price and trading volume
fluctuations that were unrelated or not directly related to the operating performance of the underlying
companies in the market. These broad market and industry fluctuations may have a material and adverse
effect on the market price and trading volume of our Shares.
An active and liquid trading market for our Shares may not develop.
Prior to the Global Offering, our Shares were not traded on any other market. We cannot assure you
that an active and liquid trading market for our Shares will be developed or be maintained after the Global
Offering. Liquid and active trading markets usually result in less price volatility and more efficiency in
carrying out investors’ purchase and sale orders. The market price of our Shares could vary significantly
as a result of a number of factors, some of which are beyond our control. In the event of a drop in the
market price of our Shares, you could lose a substantial part or all of your investment in our Shares.
Since there will be a gap of several days between pricing and trading of our Shares, holders of our
Shares are subject to the risk that the price of our Shares could fall during the period before trading
of our Shares begins.
The Offer Price of our Shares is expected to be determined on the Price Determination Date.
However, our Shares will not commence trading on the Stock Exchange until several Hong Kong business
days after the Price Determination Date. As a result, investors may not be able to sell or otherwise deal
in our Shares during that period. Accordingly, holders of our Shares are subject to the risk that the price
of our Shares could fall before trading begins, as a result of unfavorable market conditions or other adverse
developments that could occur between the time of sale and the time trading begins.
Because the initial public offering price of our Shares is substantially higher than the consolidated
net tangible assets book value per Share, purchasers of our Shares in the Global Offering may
experience immediate dilution upon such purchases.
As the Offer Price of our Shares is higher than the consolidated net tangible assets per Share
immediately prior to the Global Offering, purchasers of our Shares in the Global Offering will experience
an immediate dilution in pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets. Our existing Shareholders
will receive an increase in the pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible asset value per Share of their
shares. In addition, holders of our Shares may experience further dilution of their interest if the
Underwriters exercise the Over-allotment Option or if we issue additional shares in the future to raise
additional capital.
RISK FACTORS
—8 5—


--- page 95 ---
Future sales or perceived sales of substantial amounts of our securities in the public market could
have a material and adverse effect on the prevailing market price of our Shares and our ability to
raise additional capital in the future, or may result in dilution of your shareholdings.
Future sales of substantial amounts of our Shares or other securities relating to our Shares in the
public market, or the issuance of new Shares or other securities relating to our Shares, or the perception
that such sales or issuances may occur could all cause a decline in the market price of our Shares. Future
sales, or perceived sales, of substantial amounts of our securities or other securities relating to our Shares,
including part of any future offerings, could also materially and adversely affect the prevailing market
price of our Shares and our ability to raise capital in the future at a time and at a price which we deem
appropriate.
We may not be able to pay any dividends on our Shares.
We cannot guarantee when and in what form dividends will be paid on our Shares following the
Global Offering. The declaration of dividends is proposed by the Board and is based on, and limited by,
various factors, including without limitation, our business and financial performance, capital and
regulatory requirements, and general business conditions. We may not have sufficient or any profits to
enable us to make dividend distributions to our Shareholders in the future, even if our financial statements
indicate that our operations have been profitable. For details, see “Financial Information — Dividend.”
If securities or industry analysts do not publish research reports about our business, or if they
adversely change their recommendations regarding our Shares, the market price and trading volume
of our Shares may decline.
The trading market of our Shares may be influenced by research reports that industry or securities
analysts publish about us or our business. If one or more analysts who cover us downgrade our Shares or
publish negative opinions about us, the market price of our Shares would likely decline regardless of the
accuracy of the information. If one or more of these analysts cease coverage of us or fail to regularly
publish reports on us, we could lose visibility in the financial markets, which, in turn, could cause the
market price or trading volume of our Shares to decline.
Forward-looking statements contained in this prospectus are subject to risks and uncertainties.
This prospectus contains forward-looking statements with respect to our business strategies,
operating efficiencies, competitive positions, and growth opportunities for existing operations, plans and
objectives of management, certain pro forma information and other matters.
The words “anticipate,” “believe,” “could,” “potential,” “continue,” “expect,” “intend,” “may,”
“plan,” “seek,” “will,” “would,” “should” and the negative of these terms and other similar expressions
identify a number of these forward-looking statements. These forward-looking statements, including,
among others, those relating to our future business prospects, capital expenditure, cash flows, working
capital, liquidity and capital resources are necessary estimates reflecting the best judgment of our
Directors and management and involve a number of risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results
to differ materially from those suggested by the forward-looking statements. As a result, these
forward-looking statements should be considered in light of various important factors, including those set
out in “Risk Factors” in this prospectus. Accordingly, such statements are not a guarantee of future
performance and you should not place undue reliance on any forward-looking information. All
forward-looking statements in this prospectus are qualified by reference to this cautionary statement.
RISK FACTORS
—8 6—


--- page 96 ---
Certain facts, forecasts and statistics contained in this prospectus are derived from various official
or third-party sources and may not be accurate, reliable, complete or up to date.
We have derived certain information and statistics in this prospectus, particularly the section headed
“Industry Overview,” the report prepared by Frost & Sullivan, which was commissioned by us, and from
various official government publications and other publicly available publications provided by the PRC
government, industry associations, independent research institutes and other third-party sources. The
information from official government sources has not been independently verified by us, the Joint
Sponsors, the Joint Bookrunners, the Joint Lead Managers, the Underwriters, any of their respective
directors and advisers, or any other persons or parties involved in the Global Offering, and, therefore, we
cannot assure you as to the accuracy and reliability of such information and statistics, which may not be
consistent with other information compiled inside or outside the PRC. Due to possibly flawed or
ineffective collection methods or discrepancies between published information and market practice and
other problems, the statistics herein may be inaccurate or may not be comparable with statistics produced
for other economies, and you should not place undue reliance on them. Furthermore, we cannot assure you
that they are stated or compiled on the same basis, or with the same degree of accuracy, as similar statistics
presented elsewhere. In all cases, you should consider carefully how much weight or importance you
should attach to or place on such information or statistics.
Y ou should read the entire prospectus carefully and should not rely on any information contained
in press articles or other media regarding us and the Global Offering.
We strongly caution you not to rely on any information contained in press articles or other media
regarding us and the Global Offering. Prior to the publication of this prospectus, there may have been press
and media coverage regarding us and the Global Offering. Such press and media coverage may include
references to certain information that does not appear in this prospectus, including certain operating and
financial information and projections, valuations and other information. We have not authorized the
disclosure of any such information in the press or media and do not accept any responsibility for any such
press or media coverage or the accuracy or completeness of any such information or publication. We make
no representation as to the appropriateness, accuracy, completeness or reliability of any such information
or publication. To the extent that any such information is inconsistent or conflicts with the information
contained in this prospectus, we disclaim responsibility for it and you should not rely on such information.
RISK FACTORS
—8 7—


--- page 97 ---
In preparation for the Global Offering, we have sought the following waivers from strict compliance
with the relevant provisions of the Listing Rules and the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous
Provisions) Ordinance.
MANAGEMENT PRESENCE
Rule 8.12 of the Listing Rules requires that a new applicant applying for a primary listing on the
Stock Exchange must have a sufficient management presence in Hong Kong. This normally means that at
least two of its executive directors must be ordinarily resident in Hong Kong. The business operations of
our Group are located in China. Due to the business requirements of our Group, none of the executive
Directors (save for Mr. Xiaojie Xi) has been, is or will be based in Hong Kong. Our Company considers
that it would be impracticable and commercially infeasible to appoint two Hong Kong residents as
executive Directors or to relocate the existing executive Directors to Hong Kong considering that the
operations of our Group are based outside of Hong Kong. Accordingly, we have applied to the Stock
Exchange for, and the Stock Exchange has granted, a waiver from strict compliance with the requirement
of Rule 8.12 of the Listing Rules. In order to maintain effective communication with the Stock Exchange,
we will adopt the following measures:
(a) pursuant to Rule 3.05 of the Listing Rules, we have appointed two authorized representatives
who will act as our principal communication channel with the Stock Exchange and will ensure
that we comply with the Listing Rules at all times. These two authorized representatives
appointed are Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang and Mr. Xiaojie Xi. Mr. Xiaojie Xi is ordinarily resident
in Hong Kong. Each of the authorized representatives will be available to meet with the Stock
Exchange within a reasonable time frame upon the request of the Stock Exchange and will be
readily contactable by telephone, e-mail and fax. Each of the two authorized representatives
has been duly authorized to communicate on our Company’s behalf with the Stock Exchange.
Our Company will inform the Stock Exchange promptly in respect of any change in its
authorized representatives;
(b) pursuant to Rule 3.20 of the Listing Rules, each Director will provide his/her contact details,
including mobile phone numbers, office phone numbers, residential phone numbers, e-mail
addresses and facsimile numbers to the Stock Exchange and the authorized representatives.
This will ensure that the Stock Exchange and the authorized representatives should have means
for contacting all Directors promptly at all times as and when required;
(c) all our executive Directors, non-executive Directors and independent non-executive Directors
who are not ordinarily resident in Hong Kong have confirmed that they possess or can apply
for valid travel documents to visit Hong Kong and will be able to meet with relevant members
of the Stock Exchange in Hong Kong upon reasonable notice;
(d) pursuant to Rule 3A.19 of the Listing Rules, we have appointed Somerley Capital Limited as
our compliance advisor (the “ Compliance Advisor ”), who will act as our additional
communication channel with the Stock Exchange and will be available to respond to enquiries
from the Stock Exchange. The Compliance Advisor will provide us with professional advice on
ongoing compliance with the Listing Rules. We will ensure that the Compliance Advisor has
prompt access to our authorized representatives and Directors. In turn, they will provide the
Compliance Advisor with such information and assistance as the Compliance Advisor may need
W AIVERS AND EXEMPTION FROM STRICT COMPLIANCE WITH THE LISTING RULES AND
THE COMPANIES (WINDING UP AND MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS) ORDINANCE
—8 8—


--- page 98 ---
or may reasonably request in connection with the performance of the Compliance Advisor’s
duties. The Compliance Advisor will also provide advice to us when consulted by us in
compliance with Rule 3A.23 of the Listing Rules; and
(e) meetings between the Stock Exchange and our Directors can be arranged through the
authorized representatives or the Compliance Advisor, or directly with our Directors within a
reasonable time frame. We will inform the Stock Exchange as soon as practicable in respect of
any change in the authorized representatives and/or the Compliance Advisor in accordance with
the Listing Rules.
CONTINUING CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
Our Group has entered into certain transactions which would constitute non-exempt continuing
connected transactions under Chapter 14A of the Listing Rules after the Listing. Further particulars about
such transactions together with the application for a waiver from strict compliance with the relevant
requirements under Chapter 14A of the Listing Rules are set out in “Connected Transactions” in this
prospectus.
W AIVER AND EXEMPTION IN RELATION TO PRE-IPO SHARE OPTION SCHEMES
The Listing Rules and the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance
prescribes certain disclosure requirements in relation to the share options granted by our Company (the
“Share Option Disclosure Requirements ”):
(a) pursuant to Rule 17.02(1)(b) of the Listing Rules, a new listing applicant must disclose in the
prospectus full details of all outstanding options and their potential dilution effect on the
shareholdings upon listing as well as the impact on the earnings per share arising from the
exercise of such outstanding options under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes;
(b) paragraph 27 of Appendix 1A to the Listing Rules also requires the disclosure of particulars of
any capital of any member of our Group which is under option, or agreed conditionally or
unconditionally to be put under option, including the consideration for which the option was
or will be granted and the price and duration of the option, and the name and address of the
grantees; and
(c) further, under paragraph 10 of Part I of the Third Schedule to Companies (Winding Up and
Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance, this prospectus is required to include details of the
number, description and amount of any Shares which any person has, or is entitled to be given,
an option to subscribe for, together with certain particulars of each option, namely the period
during which it is exercisable, the price to be paid for the Shares subscribed for under it, the
consideration (if any) given or to be given for it or for the right to it and the name and address
of the person to whom it was given.
W AIVERS AND EXEMPTION FROM STRICT COMPLIANCE WITH THE LISTING RULES AND
THE COMPANIES (WINDING UP AND MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS) ORDINANCE
—8 9—


--- page 99 ---
As of the date of this Prospectus, our Company has granted outstanding options under the Pre-IPO
Share Option Schemes to 279 grantees (including Directors, members of senior management of our
Company and other employees of our Group) to subscribe for an aggregate of 117,262,546 Options. The
Shares underlying the granted options represent approximately 9.95% of the total number of issued and
outstanding Shares immediately after completion of the Global Offering (assuming the Over-allotment
Option is not exercised and no further Shares are issued under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes). No
further options will be granted pursuant to the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes on or after the Listing Date.
For further details of our Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, see the section headed “Statutory and General
Information — E. Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes” in Appendix IV in this prospectus.
We have applied to (i) the Stock Exchange for a waiver from strict compliance with the requirements
under Rule 17.02(1)(b) of the Listing Rules and paragraph 27 of Appendix 1A to the Listing Rules and (ii)
the SFC for an exemption from strict compliance with paragraph 10(d) of Part I of the Third Schedule to
the Companies (Winding up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance regarding certain options granted
under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes on the following grounds:
(a) as of the date of this Prospectus, we have granted outstanding options to a total of 279 grantees
under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes to acquire an aggregate of 117,262,546 options
representing approximately 9.95% of the total number of Shares in issue immediately after
completion of the Global Offering (assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised and
no further Shares are issued under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes);
(b) our Directors consider that it would be unduly burdensome to disclose in this prospectus full
details of all the options granted by us to each of the grantees, which would significantly
increase the cost and time required for information compilation and prospectus preparation for
strict compliance with such disclosure requirements;
(c) material information on the options has been disclosed in this prospectus to provide prospective
investors with sufficient information to make an informed assessment of the potential dilutive
effect and impact on earnings per Share of the options in making their investment decision, and
such information includes:
(i) a summary of the latest terms of the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes;
(ii) the aggregate number of Shares subject to the options and the percentage of our Shares
of which such number represents;
(iii) the dilutive effect and the impact on earnings per Share upon full exercise of the options
immediately following completion of the Global Offering (assuming the Over-allotment
Option is not exercised and no further Shares are issued under the Pre-IPO Share Option
Schemes);
W AIVERS AND EXEMPTION FROM STRICT COMPLIANCE WITH THE LISTING RULES AND
THE COMPANIES (WINDING UP AND MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS) ORDINANCE
—9 0—


--- page 100 ---
(iv) full details of the options granted to Directors, members of senior management,
connected persons (if any) and other grantee who has been granted options to subscribe
for more than 2,500,000 shares of our Company, on an individual basis, under the
Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes are disclosed in this prospectus, and such details include
all the particulars required under Rule 17.02(1)(b) of the Listing Rules, paragraph 27 of
Appendix 1A to the Listing Rules and paragraph 10 of Part 1 of the Third Schedule to the
Companies Ordinance;
(v) with respect to the options granted to other grantees (other than those referred to in (iv)
above) under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, disclosure are made on an aggregate
basis, categorized into lots based on the number of Shares underlying each individual
grantees, being (1) 1-500,000; (2) 500,001-1,000,000; (3) 1,000,001-2,000,000; and (4)
2,000,001-2,500,000 for each lots of Share, the following details are disclosed in this
prospectus, including (1) the aggregate number of such grantees and the number of Shares
subject to the options; (2) the consideration paid for the grant of the options; and (3) the
exercise period and the exercise price for the options;
(vi) the particulars of the waiver and exemption granted by the Stock Exchange and the SFC,
respectively; and
(vii) a full list of all the grantees under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, containing all the
particulars as required under the applicable Share Option Disclosure Requirements be
made available for public inspection in accordance with the section headed “Documents
Delivered to the Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong and on Display” in Appendix V
in this prospectus.
the above disclosure is consistent with the conditions ordinarily expected by the Stock
Exchange in similar circumstances as set out in Guidance Letter HKEX-GL11-09 issued in July
2009 and updated in March 2014 by the Stock Exchange.
(d) the grant and the exercise in full of the options will not cause any material adverse change in
the financial position of our Company; and
(e) our Directors consider that non-compliance with the above disclosure requirements would not
prevent our Company from providing potential investors with sufficient information for an
informed assessment of the activities, assets, liabilities, financial position, management and
prospects of our Group. Strict adherence to the disclosure requirements, including to disclose
the names, addresses, and entitlements on an individual basis of over 250 grantees without
reflecting the materiality of the information does not provide any additional meaningful
information to the investing public.
In light of the above, our Directors are of the view that the grant of the waiver and exemption sought
under this application and the non-disclosure of the required information will not prejudice the interests
of the investing public.
W AIVERS AND EXEMPTION FROM STRICT COMPLIANCE WITH THE LISTING RULES AND
THE COMPANIES (WINDING UP AND MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS) ORDINANCE
—9 1—


--- page 101 ---
The Stock Exchange has granted to our Company a waiver from strict compliance with the disclosure
requirements under Rule 17.02(1)(b) of the Listing Rules and paragraph 27 of Appendix 1A to the Listing
Rules with respect to the options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes on the condition that:
(a) on an individual basis, full details of the options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option
Schemes to each of the Directors, members of senior management and connected persons (if
any) of our Company are disclosed in the section headed “Statutory and General Information
— E. Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes” in Appendix IV in this prospectus as required under Rule
17.02(1)(b) of, and paragraph 27 of Appendix 1A to, the Listing Rules, and paragraph 10 of
Part I of the Third Schedule to the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions)
Ordinance;
(b) in respect of the options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes to other grantees
(other than those set out in (a) above), disclosure are made on an aggregate basis, categorized
into lots based on the number of Shares underlying each individual grantees, being (1)
1-500,000; (2) 500,001-1,000,000; (3) 1,000,001-2,000,000; and (4) 2,000,001-2,500,000 for
each lots of Share, the following details are disclosed in this prospectus, including (1) the
aggregate number of the grantees other than those set out in (a) above and the number of Shares
subject to the options granted to them under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes; (2) the
consideration paid for the grant of the options under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes; and
(3) the exercise period and the exercise price for the options granted under the Pre-IPO Share
Option Schemes;
(c) the aggregate number of Shares underlying the outstanding options granted under the Pre-IPO
Share Option Schemes and the percentage of our Company’s total issued share capital
represented by such number of Shares as of the Latest Practicable Date are disclosed in this
prospectus;
(d) the dilutive effect and impact on earnings per Share upon the full exercise of the options under
the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes are disclosed in the section headed “Statutory and General
Information — E. Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes” in Appendix IV in this prospectus;
(e) a summary of the major terms of the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes are disclosed in the section
headed “Statutory and General Information — E. Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes” in Appendix
IV in this prospectus;
(f) the particulars of this waiver are disclosed in this prospectus;
(g) the grant of certificate of exemption under the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous
Provisions) Ordinance from the SFC exempting our Company from the disclosure requirements
provided in paragraph 10(d) of Part I of the Third Schedule to the Companies (Winding Up and
Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance; and
W AIVERS AND EXEMPTION FROM STRICT COMPLIANCE WITH THE LISTING RULES AND
THE COMPANIES (WINDING UP AND MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS) ORDINANCE
—9 2—


--- page 102 ---
(h) a full list of all the grantees under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, containing all the
particulars as required under the applicable Share Option Disclosure Requirements will be
made available for public inspection in accordance with the section headed “Documents
Delivered to the Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong and on Display” in Appendix V to this
prospectus.
The SFC has agreed to grant to our Company the certificate of exemption under section 342A of the
Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance with respect to the options granted
under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes exempting our Company from strict compliance with paragraph
10(d) of Part I of the Third Schedule to the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions)
Ordinance on the conditions that:
(a) full details of the options under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes granted to each of the
Directors, members of senior management, connected persons (if any) and other grantee who
has been granted options to subscribe for more than 2,500,000 shares of our Company are
disclosed in the section headed “Statutory and General Information — E. Pre-IPO Share Option
Schemes” in Appendix IV in this prospectus as required by paragraph 10 of Part I of the Third
Schedule to the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance;
(b) in respect of the options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes to grantees (other
than those referred to in (a) above), disclosure are made on an aggregate basis, categorized into
lots based on the number of Shares underlying each individual grantees, being (1) 1-500,000;
(2) 500,001-1,000,000; (3) 1,000,001-2,000,000; and (4) 2,000,001-2,500,000 for each lots of
Share, the following details are disclosed in this prospectus: (1) the aggregate number of the
grantees and the number of Shares subject to the options granted to them under the Pre-IPO
Share Option Schemes; (2) the consideration paid for the grant of the options under the Pre-IPO
Share Option Schemes; and (3) the exercise period and the exercise price for the options
granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes;
(c) a full list of all the grantees under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, containing all the
particulars as required under paragraph 10 of Part I of the Third Schedule to Companies
(Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance will be made available for public
inspection in accordance with the section headed “Documents Delivered to the Registrar of
Companies in Hong Kong and on Display” in Appendix V to this prospectus; and
(d) the particulars of this exemption are disclosed in this prospectus and that this prospectus will
be issued on or before November 7, 2023.
Further details of the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes are set forth in the section headed “Statutory
and General Information — E. Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes” in Appendix IV in this prospectus.
W AIVERS AND EXEMPTION FROM STRICT COMPLIANCE WITH THE LISTING RULES AND
THE COMPANIES (WINDING UP AND MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS) ORDINANCE
—9 3—


--- page 103 ---
W AIVER AND CONSENT IN RESPECT OF ALLOCATION OF SHARES TO DIRECTORS AND
THEIR CLOSE ASSOCIATES IN PREFERENTIAL OFFERING
The Qualifying WXB Shareholders who are entitled to participate in the Preferential Offering
(details of which are set out in the section headed “Structure of the Global Offering — The Preferential
Offering”) include our Directors, namely Dr. Jincai Li, Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang, Dr. Zhisheng Chen,
Dr. Weichang Zhou and Ms. Ming Shi (the “ Relevant Directors ”) and/or their close associates. The
Relevant Directors’ respective roles and interests in Wuxi Biologics, immediately following the
completion of the Global Offering and prior to any exercise of the Over-allotment Option, are set out in
the sections headed “Directors and Senior Management” and “Appendix IV — Statutory and General
Information — D. Further Information of Our Directors and Substantial Shareholders”, respectively.
In the absence of a written waiver and consent from the Stock Exchange, participation by the
Relevant Directors and/or their close associates who are Qualifying WXB Shareholders in the Preferential
Offering would be prohibited by Rule 10.03 and paragraph 5(2) of Appendix 6 to the Listing Rules which
restrict share allocations to directors of the listing applicant or their close associates, whether in their own
names or through nominees, unless the conditions set out in Rule 10.03 of the Listing Rules are fulfilled.
Rule 10.03 of the Listing Rules provides that directors of the listing applicant and their close associates
may only subscribe for or purchase securities for which listing is sought which are being marketed by or
on behalf of a new applicant if (i) no securities are offered to them on a preferential basis and no
preferential treatment is given to them in the allocation of the securities; and (ii) the minimum public float
requirement under Rule 8.08(1) of the Listing Rules is fulfilled. Further, Rule 9.09(b) of Listing Rules
provides that there must be no dealing in the securities for which listing is sought by any core connected
person (including directors and their close associates) of the issuer in the case of a new applicant, from
4 clear business days before the expected hearing date until listing is granted.
The Reserved Shares offered to the Relevant Directors (and/or their close associates) who are
Qualifying WXB Shareholders are to be offered on a preferential basis pursuant to the Preferential
Offering and therefore the condition set out in Rule 10.03(1) is not fulfilled. However, the Directors
(and/or their close associates) who are eligible to participate in the Preferential Offering will be
participating in their capacity as Qualifying WXB Shareholders (rather than in their capacity as Directors
or close associates of Directors), on the same terms as all other Qualifying WXB Shareholders, and no
preferential treatment will be given to them in the allocation of the Reserved Shares under the Preferential
Offering as compared to any other Qualifying WXB Shareholders.
Even where the Relevant Directors apply for the Reserved Shares in excess of their Assured
Entitlement, and to the extent that the excess applications for the Reserved Shares are more than the
available reserved shares (the “ Available Reserved Shares ”) (i.e. the Reserved Shares not taken up by the
Qualifying WXB Shareholders’ Assured Entitlement), the Available Reserved Shares will be allocated on
a fair and reasonable basis, consistent with the allocation basis commonly used in the case of
oversubscriptions in public offerings in Hong Kong. Allocation will be based on the level of valid
applications of excess Reserved Shares where a higher allocation percentage will be applied in respect of
smaller applications of excess Reserved Shares and no preferential treatment will be given to the Relevant
Directors.
W AIVERS AND EXEMPTION FROM STRICT COMPLIANCE WITH THE LISTING RULES AND
THE COMPANIES (WINDING UP AND MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS) ORDINANCE
—9 4—


--- page 104 ---
Moreover, any Reserved Shares to be subscribed by the Relevant Directors and/or their close
associates under the Preferential Offering will not form part of the public float of the Company. And the
Company has applied and the Stock Exchange has granted the waiver in relation to the public float
requirements. The Company will ensure that the minimum public float requirement, as prescribed in the
waiver from strict compliance with the requirements of Rule 8.08(1)(a) of the Listing Rules in relation to
the public float granted by the Stock Exchange to the Company, will be complied with after completion
of the Global Offering. For detail, please see “Waiver in relation to Public Float Requirements” in this
section.
In view of the above, we have applied to the Stock Exchange for, and the Stock Exchange has
granted, a waiver from strict compliance with Rule 10.03 and Rule 9.09(b) of the Listing Rules and a
consent under Paragraph 5(2) of Appendix 6 to the Listing Rules for the inclusion of the Relevant
Directors and/or their close associates (being core connected person) who are Qualifying WXB
Shareholders in the Preferential Offering, subject to the conditions that (a) no preferential treatment will
be given to the Relevant Directors (and/or their dose associates) who are Qualifying WXB Shareholders
in the allocation of the Reserved Shares under the Preferential Offering and (b) the minimum public float
requirement, as prescribed in the waiver from strict compliance with the requirements of Rule 8.08(1)(a)
of the Listing Rules in relation to the public float granted by the Stock Exchange to the Company will be
complied with after completion of the Global Offering.
W AIVER IN RELATION TO PUBLIC FLOAT REQUIREMENTS
Rule 8.08(1)(a) of the Listing Rules requires that there shall be an open market for the securities for
which listing is sought, and that a sufficient public float of an issuer’s listed securities shall be maintained.
This normally means that at least 25% of the issuer’s total issued shares must at all times be held by the
public. Pursuant to Rule 8.08(1)(d) of the Listing Rules, the Stock Exchange may, subject to certain
conditions and at its discretion, accept a lower percentage of between 15% and 25% in the case of issuers
with an expected market capitalization at the time of listing of over HK$10 billion.
We have applied to the Stock Exchange to request the Stock Exchange to exercise its discretion under
8.08(1)(d), and the Stock Exchange has granted us a waiver from strict compliance with the requirements
of Rule 8.08(1)(a) of the Listing Rules.
Based on the minimum Offer Price of HK$19.90 and assuming no exercise of the Over-allotment
Option, we expect that our market capitalization will be over HK$23.4 billion at the time of Listing.
Accordingly, our minimum public float shall be the highest of:
(a) 15.01% of our total issued Shares, being the minimum percentage of Shares held by public
immediately after the completion of the Global Offering, prior to any exercise of the
Over-allotment Option and assuming that Relevant Directors and/or their close associates were
allocated the number of Reserved Shares commensurate with their indicative interests in
participating in the Preferential Offering;
W AIVERS AND EXEMPTION FROM STRICT COMPLIANCE WITH THE LISTING RULES AND
THE COMPANIES (WINDING UP AND MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS) ORDINANCE
—9 5—


--- page 105 ---
(b) 15.14% of our total issued Shares, being the minimum percentage of Shares held by public
immediately after the completion of the Global Offering, prior to any exercise of the
Over-allotment Option and assuming that no Reserved Share was allocated to our Directors
under the Preferential Offering; and
(c) such percentage of Shares to be held by the public immediately after the completion of the
Global Offering (as increased by the Shares to be issued upon any exercise of the
Over-allotment Option),
provided that the highest of (a) and (b) above is below the minimum public requirement of 25% under Rule
8.08(1) of the Listing Rules.
In order to support the application of this waiver, we have confirmed to the Stock Exchange that:
(a) we will have an expected market capitalization at the time of Listing of over HK$23.4 billion;
(b) there will be an open market in the Shares offered, and the quantity and scale of the Shares
would enable the market to operate properly with a lower percentage of public float;
(c) we will comply with Rules 8.08(2) and 8.08(3) of the Listing Rules;
(d) we will make appropriate disclosure of the lower percentage of public float as approved by the
Stock Exchange in this prospectus;
(e) we will confirm sufficiency of public float in our successive annual reports after the Listing;
and
(f) we will implement appropriate measures and mechanisms to ensure continuous maintenance of
the minimum percentage of public float.
W AIVERS AND EXEMPTION FROM STRICT COMPLIANCE WITH THE LISTING RULES AND
THE COMPANIES (WINDING UP AND MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS) ORDINANCE
—9 6—


--- page 106 ---
DIRECTORS’ RESPONSIBILITY STATEMENT
This prospectus, for which the Directors (including any proposed director who is named as such in
this prospectus) collectively and individually accept full responsibility, includes particulars given in
compliance with the Companies (Winding up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance, the Securities and
Futures (Stock Market Listing) Rules (Chapter 571 V of the Laws of Hong Kong) and the Listing Rules
for the purpose of giving information with regard to us. The Directors, having made all reasonable
enquiries, confirm that to the best of their knowledge and belief the information contained in this
prospectus is accurate and complete in all material respects and not misleading or deceptive, and there are
no other matters the omission of which would make any statement herein or this prospectus misleading.
THE HONG KONG PUBLIC OFFERING, THE PREFERENTIAL OFFERING AND THIS
PROSPECTUS
The Global Offering consists of the Hong Kong Public Offering of initially 17,845,000 Offer Shares
and the International Offering of initially 160,601,000 Offer Shares (including, for the avoidance of doubt,
the Reserved Shares offered pursuant to the Preferential Offering, subject to adjustment (as applicable)
and the Over-allotment Option). For applicants under the Hong Kong Public Offering and/or the
Preferential Offering, this prospectus and the Application Forms set out the terms and conditions of the
Hong Kong Public Offering and the Preferential Offering.
The Hong Kong Offer Shares and the Reserved Shares are offered for subscription or sale solely on
the basis of the information contained and statements made in this prospectus and the Application Forms,
and on the terms and subject to the conditions set out herein and therein. No person is authorized to give
any information in connection with the Global Offering or to make any statement not contained in this
prospectus, and any information or statement not contained herein must not be relied upon as having been
authorized by our Company, the Joint Sponsors, the Overall Coordinators, the Joint Global Coordinators,
the Joint Bookrunners, the Joint Lead Managers, the Underwriters, any of their respective directors,
agents, employees or advisors or any other party involved in the Global Offering.
Neither the delivery of this prospectus nor any offering, sale or delivery made in connection with the
Shares should, under any circumstances, constitute a representation that there has been no change or
development reasonably likely to involve a change in our affairs since the date of this prospectus or imply
that the information contained in this prospectus is correct as of any date subsequent to the date of this
prospectus.
UNDERTAKING AND INFORMATION ON THE GLOBAL OFFERING
This prospectus is published solely in connection with the Hong Kong Public Offering, which forms
part of the Global Offering. For applicants under the Hong Kong Public Offering, this prospectus set out
the terms and conditions of the Hong Kong Public Offering.
The Hong Kong Offer Shares are offered solely on the basis of the information contained in this
prospectus and on the terms and subject to conditions set out herein and wherein. We have not authorized
anyone to provide you with information that is different from what is contained in this prospectus. Any
information or representation not made in this prospectus must not be relied on by you as having been
authorized by us, the Joint Sponsors, the Overall Coordinators, the Joint Global Coordinators, the Joint
Bookrunners, the Joint Lead Managers, the Capital Market Intermediaries, any of the Underwriters, any
of our or their respective directors, officers or representatives or any other person involved in the Global
Offering.
INFORMATION ABOUT THIS PROSPECTUS AND THE GLOBAL OFFERING
—9 7—


--- page 107 ---
The Listing is sponsored by the Joint Sponsors and the Global Offering is managed by the Overall
Coordinators. The Hong Kong Public Offering is fully underwritten by the Hong Kong Underwriters under
the terms of the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement and is subject to us and the Overall Coordinators
(for themselves and on behalf of the Underwriters) agreeing on the Offer Price. An International
Underwriting Agreement relating to the International Offering is expected to be entered into on or around
Price Determination Date, subject to the Offer Price being agreed.
Neither the delivery of this prospectus nor any offering, sale or delivery made in connection with the
Shares should, under any circumstances, constitute a representation that there has been no change or
development reasonably likely to involve a change in our affairs since the date of this prospectus or imply
that the information contained in this prospectus is correct as of any date subsequent to the date of this
prospectus.
DETERMINATION OF THE OFFER PRICE
The Offer Shares are being offered at the Offer Price which will be determined by us and the
Overall Coordinators (for themselves and on behalf of the Underwriters) on or around Friday, November
10, 2023 or such other date as agreed between parties, and in any event no later than Wednesday,
November 15, 2023.
If, for any reason, the Offer Price is not agreed among us and the Overall Coordinators (for
themselves and on behalf of the Underwriters) on or before Wednesday, November 15, 2023, the Global
Offering will not proceed and will lapse.
STRUCTURE AND CONDITIONS OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
Details of the structure of the Global Offering, including its conditions, are set out in the section
headed “Structure of the Global Offering” in this prospectus.
PROCEDURES FOR APPLICATION FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND THE RESERVED
SHARES
The procedures for applying for the Hong Kong Public Offer Shares are set out in the section headed
“How to Apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares” in this prospectus.
COMMENCEMENT OF DEALING IN THE SHARES
Dealings in the Shares on the Stock Exchange are expected to commence on Friday, November 17,
2023. Except for our application to the Hong Kong Stock Exchange for the listing of, and permission to
deal in, the Shares, no part of our Shares is listed on or dealt in on any other stock exchange and no such
listing or permission to list is being or proposed to be sought. All Offer Shares will be registered on the
Hong Kong Share Registrar of our Company in order to enable them to be traded on the Stock Exchange.
RESTRICTIONS ON OFFER AND SALE OF THE OFFER SHARES
Each person acquiring the Hong Kong Offer Shares under the Hong Kong Public Offering will be
required to, or be deemed by his acquisition of Offer Shares to, confirm that he is aware of the restrictions
on offers of the Offer Shares described in this prospectus.
INFORMATION ABOUT THIS PROSPECTUS AND THE GLOBAL OFFERING
—9 8—


--- page 108 ---
No action has been taken to permit a public offering of the Offer Shares or the general distribution
of this prospectus in any jurisdiction other than in Hong Kong (save for the Preferential Offering made
to the Qualifying WXB Shareholders). Accordingly, this prospectus may not be used for the purposes of,
and does not constitute, an offer or invitation in any jurisdiction or in any circumstances in which such
an offer or invitation is not authorized or to any person to whom it is unlawful to make such an offer or
invitation. The distribution of this prospectus and the offering of the Offer Shares in other jurisdictions
are subject to restrictions and may not be made except as permitted under the applicable securities laws
of such jurisdictions and pursuant to registration with or authorization by the relevant securities regulatory
authorities or an exemption therefrom.
APPLICATION FOR LISTING ON THE STOCK EXCHANGE
We have applied to the Stock Exchange for the listing of, and permission to deal in, the Shares in
issue, Shares to be issued pursuant to the Global Offering (including any Shares which may be issued
pursuant to the exercise of the Over-allotment Option) and Shares to be issued upon the exercise of any
options to be granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes.
No part of our Company’s share or loan capital is listed on or dealt in on any other stock exchange
and no such listing or permission to list is being or proposed to be sought on the Stock Exchange or any
other stock exchange as of the date of this prospectus. All the Offer Shares will be registered on the Hong
Kong Share Registrar of our Company in order to enable them to be traded on the Stock Exchange.
Under section 44B(1) of the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance, any
allotment made in respect of any application will be invalid if the listing of, and permission to deal in, the
Shares on the Stock Exchange is refused before the expiration of three weeks from the date of the closing
of the application lists, or such longer period (not exceeding six weeks) as may, within the said three
weeks, be notified to our Company by or on behalf of the Stock Exchange.
OVER-ALLOTMENT OPTION AND STABILIZATION
Details of the arrangements relating to the Over-allotment Option and stabilization are set forth in
the section headed “Structure of the Global Offering” in this prospectus.
SHARES WILL BE ELIGIBLE FOR ADMISSION INTO CCASS
Subject to the granting of the listing of, and permission to deal in, the Shares on the Stock Exchange
and compliance with the stock admission requirements of HKSCC, the Shares will be accepted as eligible
securities by HKSCC for deposit, clearance and settlement in CCASS with effect from the Listing Date
or on any other date as determined by HKSCC. Settlement of transactions between participants of the
Stock Exchange is required to take place in CCASS on the second settlement day after any trading day.
All activities under CCASS are subject to the General Rules of CCASS and CCASS Operational
Procedures in effect from time to time.
All necessary arrangements have been made for the Shares to be admitted into CCASS. Investors
should seek the advice of their stockbroker or other professional advisor for details of those settlement
arrangements and how such arrangements will affect their rights and interests.
INFORMATION ABOUT THIS PROSPECTUS AND THE GLOBAL OFFERING
—9 9—


--- page 109 ---
SHARE REGISTRAR AND HONG KONG STAMP DUTY
Our principal register of members will be maintained by its principal share registrar, Maples Fund
Services (Cayman) Limited, in the Cayman Islands, and our Hong Kong register of members will be
maintained by Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services Limited, in Hong Kong. All Offer Shares will
be registered on our Company’s register of members in Hong Kong.
Dealings in the Shares will be subject to Hong Kong stamp duty. For further details of Hong Kong
stamp duty, please seek professional tax advice.
PROFESSIONAL TAX ADVICE RECOMMENDED
Y ou should consult your professional advisors if you are in any doubt as to the taxation implications
of subscribing for, purchasing, holding or disposing of, or dealing in, the Shares or exercising any rights
attaching to the Shares. We emphasize that none of our Company, the Joint Sponsors, the Overall
Coordinators, the Joint Global Coordinators, the Joint Bookrunners, the Joint Lead Managers, the Capital
Market Intermediaries, the Underwriters, any of our or their respective directors, officers or
representatives or any other person involved in the Global Offering accepts responsibility for any tax
effects or liabilities resulting from your subscription, purchase, holding or disposing of, or dealing in, the
Shares or your exercise of any rights attaching to the Shares.
EXCHANGE RATE CONVERSION
Unless otherwise specified, this prospectus contains certain translations for the convenience
purposes at the following rates:
US$1.00: HK$7.82192
RMB0.91769: HK$1.00
US$1.00: RMB7.1781
No representation is made that any amounts in HK$, RMB and US$ can be or could have been
converted at the relevant dates at the above rates or any other rates at all.
ROUNDING
Certain amounts and percentage figures included in this prospectus have been subject to rounding
adjustments. Accordingly, figures shown as totals in certain tables may not be an arithmetic aggregation
of the figures preceding them.
LANGUAGE
If there is any inconsistency between this prospectus and the Chinese translation of this prospectus,
this prospectus shall prevail unless otherwise stated. However, the translated English names of the PRC
and foreign national, entities, departments, facilities, certificates, titles, laws, regulations (including
certain of our subsidiaries) and the like included in this prospectus and for which no official English
translation exists are unofficial translations for your reference only. If there is any inconsistency, the
names in their original languages shall prevail.
INFORMATION ABOUT THIS PROSPECTUS AND THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 100 —


--- page 110 ---
DIRECTORS
Name Address Nationality
Executive Directors
Dr. Jincai Li Room 601
No. 49, Lane 18
Qing Tong Road
Pudong New District
Shanghai
China
American
Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang Room 601, 6/F
No. 19, Lane 1399
Huifeng West Road
Nanqiao Town, Fengxian District
Shanghai
China
American
Mr. Xiaojie Xi Flat A, 36/F, Block 3 Island Harborview
11 Hoi Fai Road, Tai Kok Tsui
Kowloon
Hong Kong
Chinese
Non-Executive Directors
Dr. Zhisheng Chen 10-402, Shengyuan Binhu District
Wuxi City
Jiangsu Province
China
Chinese
Dr. Weichang Zhou Room 802, No. 11, Lane 1777, Langu Road
Pudong New District
Shanghai
China
American
Ms. Ming Shi No. 42, Lane 951 Fanglin Road
Nanxiang town, Jiading District
Shanghai
China
Chinese
DIRECTORS AND PARTIES INVOLVED IN THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 101 —


--- page 111 ---
Name Address Nationality
Independent Non-Executive Directors
Dr. Ulf Grawunder Ru ¨tenenstrasse 41
6375 Beckenried
Switzerland
German
Mr. Stewart John Hen 25 North Moore Street 15A
New Y ork, NY 10013
United States
American
Mr. Hao Zhou 32 Y unnan Drive 1
Singapore
Singaporean
Further information about our Directors and other senior management members are set out in
“Directors and Senior Management.”
DIRECTORS AND PARTIES INVOLVED IN THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 102 —


--- page 112 ---
PARTIES INVOLVED IN THE GLOBAL OFFERING
Joint Sponsors Morgan Stanley Asia Limited
Level 46, International Commerce Centre
1 Austin Road West Kowloon
Hong Kong
Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C.
68/F, Cheung Kong Center
2 Queen’s Road Central
Hong Kong
J.P. Morgan Securities (Far East) Limited
28/F, Chater House
8 Connaught Road Central
Hong Kong
Sponsor-Overall Coordinators and Overall
Coordinators
Morgan Stanley Asia Limited
Level 46, International Commerce Centre
1 Austin Road West Kowloon
Hong Kong
Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C.
68/F, Cheung Kong Center
2 Queen’s Road Central
Hong Kong
J.P. Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited
28/F, Chater House
8 Connaught Road Central
Hong Kong
Joint Global Coordinators Morgan Stanley Asia Limited
Level 46, International Commerce Centre
1 Austin Road West Kowloon
Hong Kong
Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C.
68/F, Cheung Kong Center
2 Queen’s Road Central
Hong Kong
J.P. Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited
28/F, Chater House
8 Connaught Road Central
Hong Kong
DIRECTORS AND PARTIES INVOLVED IN THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 103 —


--- page 113 ---
(in alphabetical order)
China International Capital Corporation
Hong Kong Securities Limited
29/F, One International Finance Centre
1 Harbour View Street
Central
Hong Kong
Citigroup Global Markets Asia Limited
50/F, Champion Tower
3 Garden Road
Central
Hong Kong
Huatai Financial Holdings (Hong Kong)
Limited
62/F, The Center
99 Queen’s Road Central
Hong Kong
Joint Bookrunners, Joint Lead Managers
and Capital Market Intermediaries
Morgan Stanley Asia Limited
Level 46, International Commerce Centre
1 Austin Road West Kowloon
Hong Kong
Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C.
68/F, Cheung Kong Center
2 Queen’s Road Central
Hong Kong
J.P. Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited
(in relation to the Hong Kong Public Offering only)
28/F, Chater House
8 Connaught Road Central
Hong Kong
J.P. Morgan Securities plc
(in relation to the International Offering only)
25 Bank Street
Canary Wharf
London E14 5JP
United Kingdom
DIRECTORS AND PARTIES INVOLVED IN THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 104 —


--- page 114 ---
(in alphabetical order)
China International Capital Corporation
Hong Kong Securities Limited
29/F, One International Finance Centre
1 Harbour View Street
Central
Hong Kong
Citigroup Global Markets Asia Limited
(in relation to the Hong Kong Public Offering only)
50/F, Champion Tower
3 Garden Road
Central
Hong Kong
Citigroup Global Markets Limited
(in relation to the International Offering only)
33 Canada Square
Canary Wharf
London E14 5LB
United Kingdom
Huatai Financial Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited
62/F, The Center
99 Queen’s Road Central
Hong Kong
Legal Advisors to Our Company As to Hong Kong laws:
Fangda Partners
26/F, One Exchange Square
8 Connaught Place
Central
Hong Kong
As to United States laws:
Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati
Suite 1509, 15/F, Jardine House
1 Connaught Place
Central
Hong Kong
DIRECTORS AND PARTIES INVOLVED IN THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 105 —


--- page 115 ---
As to PRC laws:
Fangda Partners
24/F, HKRI Centre Two
HKRI Taikoo Hui
288 Shi Men Yi Road
Shanghai
China
As to Cayman Islands laws:
Maples and Calder (Hong Kong) LLP
26th Floor, Central Plaza
18 Harbour Road, Wanchai
Hong Kong
Legal Advisors to our Controlling
Shareholders
As to Hong Kong and United States laws with respect
to WuXi Biologics:
Fangda Partners
26/F, One Exchange Square
8 Connaught Place
Central
Hong Kong
As to Hong Kong and United States laws with respect
to WuXi AppTec Co., Ltd.:
Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati
Suite 1509, 15/F, Jardine House
1 Connaught Place
Central
Hong Kong
Legal Advisors to the Joint Sponsors and
the Underwriters
As to Hong Kong and United States laws:
Davis Polk & Wardwell
10/F, The Hong Kong Club Building
3A Chater Road
Central
Hong Kong
DIRECTORS AND PARTIES INVOLVED IN THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 106 —


--- page 116 ---
As to PRC laws:
Jingtian & Gongcheng
45/F, K. Wah Center
1010 Huaihai Road (M)
Xuhui District
Shanghai
PRC
Auditor and Reporting Accountants Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu
Certified Public Accountants
35/F, One Pacific Place
88 Queensway
Hong Kong
Industry Consultant Frost & Sullivan (Beijing) Inc.,
Shanghai Branch Co.
Suite 2504
Wheelock Square
1717 Nanjing West Road
Shanghai
China
Receiving Banks Bank of China (Hong Kong) Limited
1 Garden Road
Hong Kong
CMB Wing Lung Bank Limited
16th Floor, 45 Dex V oeux Road
Central
Hong Kong
DIRECTORS AND PARTIES INVOLVED IN THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 107 —


--- page 117 ---
Registered Office PO Box 309, Ugland House
Grand Cayman
KY1-1104
Cayman Islands
Headquarters No. 11 Xinhui Ring Road
Xinwu District
Wuxi City
Jiangsu Province
China
Principal Place of Business in Hong Kong 31/F, Tower Two, Times Square
1 Matheson Street
Causeway Bay
Hong Kong
Company’s Website www.wuxixdc.com
(Note: the information contained on this website
does not form part of this prospectus)
Company Secretary Mr. Xiaojie Xi
Authorized Representatives Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang
Mr. Xiaojie Xi
Audit Committee Mr. Hao Zhou (Chairman)
Dr. Ulf Grawunder
Mr. Stewart John Hen
Remuneration Committee Dr. Ulf Grawunder (Chairman)
Mr. Stewart John Hen
Ms. Ming Shi
Nomination Committee Dr. Zhisheng Chen (Chairman)
Dr. Ulf Grawunder
Mr. Hao Zhou
Strategy Committee Dr. Jincai Li (Chairman)
Dr. Zhisheng Chen
Dr. Weichang Zhou
Dr. Ulf Grawunder
Mr. Stewart John Hen
ESG Committee Dr. Jincai Li (Chairman)
Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang
Dr. Weichang Zhou
Ms. Ming Shi
CORPORATE INFORMATION
— 108 —


--- page 118 ---
The Cayman Islands Principal Share Registrar Maples Fund Services (Cayman) Limited
PO Box 1093, Boundary Hall
Cricket Square
Grand Cayman
KY1-1102
Cayman Islands
Hong Kong Share Registrar Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services
Limited
Shops 1712-1716, 17th Floor, Hopewell Centre
183 Queen’s Road East
Wan Chai
Hong Kong
Compliance Advisor Somerley Capital Limited
20/F, China Building, 29 Queen’s Road
Central
Hong Kong
Principal Banks Agricultural Bank of China Wuxi Xinwu Sub-
branch
No. 2, Xinfa Huirong Plaza
Wuxi City
Jiangsu Province
China
China CITIC Bank Wuxi Branch
No. 187, Zhongshan Road
Wuxi City
Jiangsu Province
China
China Minsheng Bank Wuxi Branch
China Minsheng Bank Wuxi Branch, No. 555
Y unhe East Road, Liangxi District
Wuxi City
Jiangsu Province
China
Bank of China Wuxi High-tech Industrial
Development Zone Sub-branch
No. 140 Wangzhuang Road, Xinwu District
Wuxi City
Jiangsu Province
China
CORPORATE INFORMATION
— 109 —


--- page 119 ---
Shanghai Pudong Development Bank Konggang
Branch
No. 1000, Qihang Road
Pudong New Area
Shanghai
China
Bank of China Shanghai Branch
Room 216, No. 23, Zhongshan East 1st Road
Huangpu District
Shanghai
China
Bank of Communications Changzhou Branch
No. 255, Tongjiang South Road
Changzhou City
Jiangsu Province
China
Bank of China Changzhou Xinbei Sub-branch
Bank of China Xinbei Sub-branch, No.118
Zhujiang Road, Xinbei District
Changzhou City
Jiangsu Province
China
BNP Paribas Hong Kong Branch
16/F, PCCW Centre, Taikoo Place
979 King’s Road
Quarry Bay
Hong Kong
Standard Chartered Bank Singapore Branch
Marina Bay Financial Centre (Tower 1), 8 Marina
Boulevard, Level 00
Singapore
CORPORATE INFORMATION
—1 1 0—


--- page 120 ---
This section sets forth a summary of the principal laws, rules and regulations in the PRC that are
relevant to our business.
PRINCIPAL REGULATORY AUTHORITIES
The principal regulatory authorities governing the CRDMO industry in the PRC include the NMPA
and the National Development and Reform Commission (the “ NDRC ”).
The NMPA, under and supervised by the State Administration for Market Regulation, is the primary
regulatory agency in the PRC for the supervision and management of the pharmaceutical products and
related businesses, and regulates almost all the key stages of the life-cycle of pharmaceutical products. As
our principal business is the discovery of bioconjugates, development and manufacturing of drug
substance and drug products when providing CRDMO services, we are subject to the NMPA ’s and its local
counterpart’s administration and supervision.
The NDRC, being the macro-economic management administrative authority under the PRC State
Council, has broad and extensive administrative and planning control over the economic activities in
China, including promoting the development of strategic new industries including drug research and
contract research and development, reviewing and formulating policies.
LA WS AND REGULATIONS OF THE PRC
Regulations of Bio-industry
To promote the development of bio-industry, the PRC government has promulgated a series of
industry policies in recent years. The General Office of the PRC State Council promulgated the Circular
on Printing and Issuing Certain Policies for Promotion of Accelerated Development of Bio-industry ( ᗫ
ٝon June 2, 2009, clearly indicating that accelerating the
development of bio-industry is a major initiative for China to grasp the strategic opportunity of the
revolution of new scientific technology and to build an innovation-oriented country in an all-round way
in the new century. On October 9, 2010, the Guidance on the Acceleration of the Structural Adjustment
of the Pharmaceutical Industry (ኬจԈ) was promulgated and it requests
boosting the development and innovation of biological technologies and pharmaceutical agents and
breakthroughs of technologies, including large-scale and high throughput gene cloning and protein
expression, humanization of antibody, preparation of humanized antibody, new vaccine adjuvants and
large-scale cell culturing and protein purification. On October 10, 2010, the PRC State Council issued the
Decision on Accelerating the Fostering and Development of Strategic Emerging Industries (̋Ҟ੃ԃ
֛categorizing the bio-industry as a strategic emerging industry and calling
for strong supports to not only develop biotechnology-derived pharmaceuticals, new types of vaccines,
diagnostic reagents, chemical drugs and other large varieties of innovative pharmaceuticals used for the
prevention and control of critical diseases, but also raise standards of biomedical industry.
According to the Notice of the NDRC on Printing and Distributing of the “13th Five-Y ear Plan” for
Biological Industry (Ι೯“ɤɧʞ”ٝFa Gai Gao Ji [2016] No. 2665) issued
on December 20, 2016, the PRC government, among others, intends to foster new types of business in the
industry of bio-pharma services by establishing professional specialized service platforms and improving
the level of specialization, including prioritizing the pharmaceutical services, which are in conformity
with international standards, covering translational medicine, CRO, CMO, third-party medical testing
services, and health management services, to research and develop a batch of internationally-leading
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 111 —


--- page 121 ---
innovative drugs, particularly in treatment of malignant tumors and fatal infectious diseases. According to
the Notice of the NDRC on Printing and Distributing of the “14th Five-Y ear Plan” for Bio-economy
Development Planning (Ι೯“ɤ̬ʞ”ٝFa Gai Gao Ji [2021] No. 1850)
issued on December 20, 2021, the PRC government, among others, intends to emphasize on the
development of bio-economy industry, which will become a key driving force to boost high-quality
development by 2025.
Regulations on Drug Research, Development and Manufacturing Services
Regulations on Drug Research and Development
The institutions for non-clinical safety evaluation and study shall implement the Good Laboratory
Practice for Non-Clinical Laboratory Studies (Ӻሯඎ၍ଣ஝ᇍ) (the “ GLP”). GLP contains
a set of rules and criteria for the quality system concerned with the organizational process and conditions
under which non-clinical laboratory studies are planned, performed, monitored, recorded, achieved and
reported. Other pre-clinical related research activities for the purpose of drug registration shall be carried
out with reference to the GLP .
Regulations on Drug Manufacturing
According to the Drug Administration Law of the PRC (جor the Drug
Administration Law, which was promulgated by the Standing Committee of the National People’s
Congress (the “ SCNPC ”) in September 1984 and last amended in August 2019, a drug manufacturing
enterprise is required to obtain a Drug Manufacturing License (͛ପ஢̙ᗇ) from the relevant
provincial counterpart of the NMPA. According to the Measures for the Supervision and Administration
of Drugs (جpromulgated by the China Food and Drug Administration (the
predecessor of the NMPA) on August 5, 2004 and last amended on January 15, 2020, a Drug
Manufacturing License is valid for five years and may be renewed upon the application by the holder of
such Drug Manufacturing License at least six months prior to the expiration date and the approval by the
provincial counterpart of the NMPA originally issues the Drug Manufacturing License.
The Good Manufacturing Practice for Drugs (͛ପሯඎ၍ଣ஝ᇍ) (the “ GMP”) which was
promulgated in March 1988 and last amended in January 2011 and took effect on March 1, 2011, comprises
a set of detailed standard guidelines governing the manufacture of the drugs, including institution and staff
qualifications, production premises and facilities, equipment, hygiene conditions, production
management, quality controls, product operation, raw material management, maintenance of sales records
and manner of handling customer complaints.
In November 2019, the NMPA issued the Announcement on Matters Pertaining to the
Implementation of the Drug Administration Law of the PRC (၍ଣ
ʮѓ), in accordance to which the GMP certification was canceled from December 1,
2019, and no application for GMP certification would be accepted and no GMP certificate would be
granted. However, according to the Drug Administration Law, drug manufacturers shall still comply with
the GMP , establish and improve the GMP system, and ensure the whole drug production process is
consistently in compliance with statutory requirements.
In May 2021, the NMPA promulgated the Administrative Measures for Drug Inspection (Trial
Implementation) (ج(༊Б)) which became effective on the same date, and the
Administrative Measures for the Certification of Good Manufacturing Practice for Drugs (͛ପሯඎ
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
—1 1 2—


--- page 122 ---
جwere repealed concurrently. The Administrative Measures for Drug Inspection
(Trial Implementation) provide that if a drug manufacturer applies for a drug manufacturing license for
the first time, onsite inspections to be conducted in accordance with the GMP requirements is required,
while for a drug manufacturer applying for the renewal of a drug manufacturing license, the review will
be conducted based on the risk management principles, taking into account certain factors, including the
drug manufacturer’s compliance with the laws and regulations of drug administration, the drug
manufacturer’s operation of the GMP system and quality management system, and inspections on the drug
manufacturer’s conformity to the GMP requirements may be conducted where necessary.
Regulation on Pathogenic Microorganism Laboratories
According to the Regulations on Administration of Bio-safety in Pathogenic Microorganism
Laboratories (τΌ၍ଣૢԷ), which were promulgated by the PRC State Council
on November 12, 2004 and last amended on March 19, 2018, the pathogenic microorganism laboratory is
classified into four levels, namely Bio-safety Level 1, 2, 3 and 4 in terms of the national standard on
biosafety of the laboratory. A laboratory of Bio-safety Level 1 or 2 shall not conduct laboratory activities
related to highly pathogenic microorganisms. The construction, alteration or expansion of a laboratory of
Bio-safety Level 1 or 2 shall be reported for the record to competent health authorities. The establisher
of a laboratory shall develop a scientific and strict management system, regularly inspect the
implementation of the regulations on bio-safety, and regularly inspect, maintain and update the facilities,
equipment and materials in the laboratory, to ensure its compliance with the national standards. As of the
Latest Practicable Date, we have two pathogenic microorganism laboratories of Bio-safety Level 2.
Regulations on Company Establishment and Foreign Investment
The establishment, operation and management of corporate entities in China are governed by the
Company Law of the PRC (جor the PRC Company Law, which was promulgated
by the SCNPC, in December 1993 and further amended in December 1999, August 2004, October 2005,
December 2013 and October 2018, respectively. According to the PRC Company Law, companies are
generally classified into two categories: limited liability companies and companies limited by shares. The
PRC Company Law also applies to foreign-invested limited liability companies. According to the PRC
Company Law, where laws on foreign investment have other stipulations, such stipulations shall prevail.
Investment activities in the PRC by foreign investors are governed by the Provisions on Guiding
Foreign Investment Direction (֛which was promulgated by the PRC State Council
in February 2002 and came into effect in April 2002, the Special Administrative Measures for the Access
of Foreign Investment (Negative List) (2021 V ersion) (݄(૶ఊ)(2021 ϋ
وor the Negative List, which was promulgated by the Ministry of Commerce of the PRC, or
MOFCOM, and the NDRC, in December 2021 and came into effect in January 2022, and the Catalogue
of Encouraged Industries for Foreign Investment (2022 version) ( ོᎸ̮ਠҳ༟ପุͦ፽(2022وor
the Encouraged Catalogue, which was promulgated by MOFCOM and the NDRC in October 2022 and
came into effect in January 2023. The Provisions on Guiding Foreign Investment Direction divides foreign
investment projects into four categories, namely “encouraged,” “permitted,” “restricted” and “prohibited”
categories. The Encouraged Catalogue lists the foreign investment projects of the encouraged category,
while the Negative List set out the foreign investment projects of the restricted and prohibited categories,
and foreign investment projects which fall outside the encouraged, restricted and prohibited categories
belong to the permitted category. The Negative List sets out the restrictive measures in a unified manner,
such as the requirements on shareholding percentages and corporate governance, for the access of foreign
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
—1 1 3—


--- page 123 ---
investments, and the industries that are prohibited from receiving foreign investment. The Negative List
covers 12 industries, and any field not falling under the Negative List shall be administered under the
principle of equal treatment to domestic and foreign investment.
The Foreign Investment Law of the PRC (جor the PRC Foreign
Investment Law, was promulgated by the National People’s Congress or NPC in March 2019 and came into
effect in January 2020. The Law on Wholly Foreign-owned Enterprises of the PRC ( ʕശɛ͏΍ձ਷̮༟
جthe Law on Sino-foreign Equity Joint V entures of the PRC ( ʕശɛ͏΍ձ਷ʕ̮Υ༟຾ᐄΆุ
جand the Law on Sino-foreign Cooperative Joint V entures of the PRC ( ʕശɛ͏΍ձ਷ʕ̮ΥЪ຾ᐄ
جwere repealed upon the PRC Foreign Investment Law coming into effect. The investment
activities of foreign natural persons, enterprises or other organizations (collectively, the “ foreign
investors ”) directly or indirectly within the territory of China shall comply with and be governed by the
PRC Foreign Investment Law. Such activities include establishments by foreign investors of foreign-
invested enterprises in China alone or jointly with other investors; acquisitions by foreign investors of
shares, equity, property shares, or other similar interests of Chinese domestic enterprises; investments by
foreign investors in new projects in China alone or jointly with other investors; and other forms of
investment prescribed by laws, administrative regulations or the PRC State Council.
In December 2019, the PRC State Council promulgated the Regulations on Implementing the Foreign
Investment Law of the PRC (ૢԷ), which came into effect in January
2020. Upon the Regulations on Implementing the Foreign Investment Law of the PRC coming into effect,
the Regulations on Implementing the Sino-Foreign Equity Joint V enture Enterprise Law of the PRC ( ʕ
ૢԷ), Provisional Regulations on the Duration of Sino-Foreign
Equity Joint V enture Enterprise (֛the Regulations on Implementing
the Wholly Foreign-Invested Enterprise Law of the PRC (ۆand the
Regulations on Implementing the Sino-Foreign Cooperative Joint V enture Enterprise Law of the PRC ( ʕ
ۆwere repealed simultaneously.
In December 2019, MOFCOM and the State Administration for Market Regulation, or the SAMR,
promulgated the Measures on Reporting of Foreign Investment Information (ج,)
which came into effect in January 2020 and supersedes the Interim Measures for the Administration of
Filing for Establishment and Changes in Foreign Investment Enterprises (၍ଣᅲ
جSince January 1, 2020, for foreign investors carrying out investment activities directly or
indirectly in China, the foreign investors or foreign-invested enterprises shall submit investment
information to the relevant commerce administrative authorities in accordance with the Measures on
Reporting of Foreign Investment Information.
In December 2020, the NDRC and MOFCOM promulgated the Measures on the Security Review of
Foreign Investment (جwhich came into effect in January 2021, setting forth
provisions concerning the security review mechanism on foreign investment, including the types of
investments subject to review, the scopes of review and procedures to review, among others.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
—1 1 4—


--- page 124 ---
Regulations on Import and Export of Goods
According to the Foreign Trade Law of the PRC (ج׸promulgated by the
SCNPC on May 12, 1994 and last amended with effect from December 30, 2022, foreign trade operators
engaged in the import and export of goods or technologies are no longer required to make a record-filing
with the administrative authority of the foreign trade of the PRC State Council or its authorized agency
from December 30, 2022.
According to the Regulations on the Administration over Import and Export of Goods of the PRC ( ʕ
ආ̈ɹ၍ଣૢԷ) promulgated by the PRC State Council on December 10, 2001 with
effect from January 1, 2002, the import and export of goods are generally allowed by the PRC government,
but the prohibitions or restrictions explicitly stipulated in the laws or administrative regulations shall still
be complied with during the conduct of import and export of goods by individuals or entities. The PRC
government adopts an automatic import and export licensing administration system for some freely
imported and exported goods and technologies, and has a catalog of such goods and technologies. From
time to time, the PRC government promulgates and updates the catalogue of restricted and prohibited
goods and technologies. For goods and technologies subject to import or export restrictions, the PRC
government maintains separate quota managing and licensing systems. Restricted goods or technologies
may only be imported or exported with the approval of the relevant foreign trade administrative authority.
Prohibited goods or technologies may not be imported or exported at all. In addition, according to the
Provisions on the Administration of the Health and Quarantine of Entry/Exit Special Articles ( ̈ɝྤत
֛promulgated by the General Administration of Customs of the PRC and last
amended with effect from November 23, 2018, import and export of special articles such as
microorganisms, human tissues, biological products, blood and blood products shall be subject to
sanitation and quarantine administration. The owner of special articles or its customs broker shall apply
for an approval of sanitation and quarantine of special articles with local customs before handing over the
special articles for shipment.
According to the Customs Law of the PRC (جwhich was last amended with
effect from April 29, 2021, the General Administration of Customs of the PRC is the State’s entry and exit
customs supervision and administration authority. The General Administration of Customs is responsible
for supervising the transportation vehicles, goods, luggage, postal articles and other articles entering and
leaving the country, collecting customs duties and other taxes and fees, and preventing and countering
smuggling. The consignees and consignors for imported or exported goods and the customs brokers
engaged in customs declaration shall file with the competent customs authorities for record in accordance
with law. The customs brokers or individuals engaged in customs declaration shall not illegally make
customs declaration on behalf of others.
According to the Administrative Provisions on the Record-Filing of Customs Declaration Entities of
the PRC (֛which were promulgated by the General
Administration of Customs of the PRC on November 19, 2021 and came into effect on January 1, 2022,
consignors or consignees of imported or exported goods or customs declaration enterprises that apply for
record-filing shall obtain market entity qualifications.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
—1 1 5—


--- page 125 ---
Regulations on Enterprise Investment Projects
According to Regulations on the Administration of Approval and Record-Filing of Enterprise
Investment Projects (၍ଣૢԷ) which were promulgated by the PRC State
Council on November 30, 2016 and became effective from February 1, 2017, pre-approval is required for
projects that have national security concern or relate to major productivity distribution, strategic resource
development and major public interests, and projects other than the aforesaid ones are subject to
administration by way of filing. The Notice of the PRC State Council on Issuing the Catalogue of
Investment Projects Approved by the Government (2016 V ersion) (ҳ༟ධͦͦ
፽(2016 ϋ͉)ٝissued by the PRC State Council and taking effect from December 12, 2016 set out
projects required for pre-approval.
Regulations on Construction
Construction Work Planning Permit
In accordance with the Urban and Rural Planning Law of the PRC (ج)
promulgated by the SCNPC on October 28, 2007 and last amended with effect from April 23, 2019, where
construction work is conducted in a city or town planning area, the relevant construction entity shall apply
for a construction work planning permit (ணʈ೻஝ྌ஢̙ᗇ) from the competent administrative
authority in charge of urban and rural planning.
Construction Work Commencement Permit
According to the Construction Law of the PRC (جpromulgated by the SCNPC
on November 1, 1997 and last amended with effect from April 23, 2019, a construction entity shall, prior
to the commencement of a construction work, apply for a construction permit (ʈ஢̙ᗇ) from the
competent construction administrative authority, except that certain small-scale projects that meet the
requirements and conditions set by the competent construction administrative authority are exempted from
obtaining a construction permit.
According to the Administrative Measures for Construction Permits of Building Projects (ጘʈ೻
جpromulgated by the Ministry of Housing and Urban-Rural Development of the PRC
(“MOHURD ”) on October 15, 1999 and last amended with effect from March 30, 2021, any entity in
China that carries out construction, fitting-out or decoration of a building and its ancillary facilities,
installation of supporting lines, pipelines or equipment, as well as the construction of municipal
infrastructure projects shall, prior to the commencement of the construction, apply for a construction
permit. Construction works with a construction investment amount of less than RMB300,000 or a
construction area of less than 300 square meters are not required for construction permits.
Acceptance on Completion of Construction
According to the Administrative Measures for the Administration of Completion Acceptance and
Filing of Housing Construction and Municipal Infrastructure Projects (ʈ೻ംʈ
جpromulgated by the MOHURD and taking effect from October 19, 2009, any entity in
China that carries out construction works to build, expand or re-build real properties or municipal
infrastructure projects shall, within 15 days after the acceptance and of the relevant construction work,
make a record-filing with the competent construction administration authority.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
—1 1 6—


--- page 126 ---
Regulations on Environmental Protection, Health and Safety
Environmental Protection
The Environmental Protection Law of the PRC (جpromulgated by the
SCNPC on December 26, 1989 and last amended with effect from January 1, 2015, summarizes the rights
and responsibilities of environmental protection regulatory authorities. The former Ministry of
Environmental Protection (now the Ministry of Ecology and Environment, the “ MEE”) is authorized to
promulgate national standards for environmental quality and discharge. At the same time, local
environmental protection authorities may formulate local standards that are stricter than the national
standards, in which case, the companies concerned shall comply with the national and local standards.
Environmental Impact Assessment
According to the Regulations on the Administration of Construction Project Environmental
Protection (ᚐ၍ଣૢԷ), promulgated by the PRC State Council on November 29, 1998
and last amended with effect from October 1, 2017, the construction entity shall submit an environmental
impact report or an environmental impact statement, or fill in a registration form, as applicable, depending
on the degree of impact the construction project has on the environment. For a construction project for
which an environmental impact report or environmental impact statement shall be prepared, the
construction entity shall submit the environmental impact report and environmental impact statement to
the competent administrative authority of environmental protection for approval before the
commencement of the construction. If the environmental impact assessment documents of a construction
project have not been reviewed by the competent administrative authority in accordance with the law or
have not been granted approval after the review, the construction entity shall be prohibited from
commencing construction works of such project.
According to the Environmental Impact Assessment Law of the PRC ( ʕശɛ͏΍ձ਷ᐑྤᅂᚤ൙ᄆ
جpromulgated by the SCNPC on October 28, 2002 and last amended with effect from December 29,
2018, for construction projects that have an impact on the environment, entities shall prepare an
environmental impact report, environmental impact statement or registration form in accordance with the
severity of the impact that the project may have on the environment.
Completion and Acceptance
The Interim Measures for Acceptance of Environmental Protection upon Completion of Construction
Projects (جpromulgated and implemented by the former Ministry of
Environmental Protection (now the MEE) on November 20, 2017, regulate the procedures and standards
for environmental protection acceptance by construction entities upon the completion of construction
projects.
Pollutant Discharge
According to the Law of the PRC on Prevention and Control of Environmental Pollution Caused by
Solid Wastes (2020 Revision) (جط2020ࠈࡌpromulgated on
October 30, 1995 and last amended with effect from September 1, 2020, the construction of projects which
discharge solid waste and the construction of projects for storage, use and treatment of solid waste shall
be carried out upon the assessment regarding their effects on the environment and in compliance with the
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
—1 1 7—


--- page 127 ---
relevant regulations concerning the administration of environmental protection in respect of construction
projects. The necessary supporting facilities for the prevention and control of environmental pollution
caused by solid wastes as specified in the environmental impact assessment documents of the construction
project must be designed, constructed and put into operation simultaneously with the major construction
works of the construction project.
According to the Catalog of Classified Management of Pollutant Discharge Permits for Stationary
Pollution Sources (2019 Edition) (๕રϮ஢̙ʱᗳ၍ଣΤ፽(2019وpromulgated by the
MEE on December 20, 2019 and effective as of the same date, key management, simplified management
and registration management of pollutant discharge permits are implemented based on factors such as the
volume of pollutants generated, the amount of pollutants discharged and the degree of impact on the
environment. The pollutant discharging entity subject to registration management does not need to apply
for the pollutant discharge permit, but shall fill in the pollutant discharge registration form on the national
pollutant discharge permit administration information platform.
According to the Guidelines for the Registration of Pollutant Discharge for Stationary Pollution
Sources (Trial Implementation) (یܸ(༊Б)), issued by the MEE on January 6,
2020 and effective as of the same date, registration of pollutant discharge refers to the situation where
enterprises that do not need to apply for a pollutant discharge permit in accordance with the law because
the volume of pollutants they generate, discharge is small and the impact on the environment is limited,
such enterprises shall carry out pollutant discharge registration in accordance with the relevant provisions.
According to the Regulations on Urban Drainage and Sewage Treatment (ᕄર˥ၾϮ˥ஈଣૢԷ),
promulgated by the PRC State Council on October 2, 2013 with effect from January 1, 2014, urban entities
and individuals shall dispose of sewage through urban drainage facilities covering their geographical area
in accordance with the law. Companies or other entities engaging in medical activities shall apply for a
sewage disposal drainage license ( Ϯ˥રɝર˥၍ၣ஢̙ᗇ) before disposing sewage into urban drainage
facilities. Sewage-disposing entities and individuals shall pay sewage treatment fees in accordance with
the law.
According to the Measures for the Bio-safety Environmental Management of Pathogenic Microbe
Laboratories (جpromulgated by the former State Environmental
Protection Administration (now the MEE) on March 8, 2006 with effect from May 1, 2006, where a
laboratory intends to discharge waste water or waste gas, it shall comply with the relevant provisions
issued by the former Ministry of Environmental Protection (now the MEE) and implement an internal
system for reporting and conduct the pollutant discharge registrations.
The Law of the PRC on Prevention and Treatment of Water Pollution (ط
جpromulgated by the SCNPC on May 11, 1984, last amended with effect from January 1, 2018, requires
that the environmental impact assessment shall be conducted in accordance with the law in case of any
new construction, reconstruction, and expansion of those projects which directly or indirectly discharge
pollutants into the water or other facilities on water. The water pollution prevention and treatment facilities
of a construction project must be designed, constructed and put into operation simultaneously with the
major construction works of the said construction project. The water pollution prevention and treatment
facilities shall comply with the requirements set out in the environmental impact assessment documents
approved by or filed with the competent administrative authority.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
—1 1 8—


--- page 128 ---
According to the Law of the PRC on Prevention and Treatment of Atmospheric Pollution ( ʕശɛ͏
جطpromulgated by the SCNPC on September 5, 1987 and last amended with effect
from October 26, 2018, entities undertaking construction projects which have an impact on the
atmospheric environment shall conduct an environmental impact assessment and make the environmental
impact assessment documents available to public. The pollutants discharged into the air shall meet relevant
discharge standards formulated by the MEE or the provincial level people’s governments and comply with
the requirements for the control of the discharge volume of key atmospheric pollutants.
Production Safety
According to the Safety Production Law of the PRC (جpromulgated by
the SCNPC on June 29, 2002 and last amended with effect from September 1, 2021, any enterprise that
carries out production and business operation activities shall (1) abide by the Safety Production Law of
the PRC and other laws and regulations related to production safety, strengthen production safety
management, and establish a sound production safety responsibility system and formulate a set of
production safety rules and regulations for all employees; (2) increase the efforts to guarantee the input
of funds, supplies, technology and personnel to production safety, improve production safety conditions,
and strengthen standardization and informatization of production safety; (3) construct a “dual-prevention”
mechanism consisting of graded management and control of safety risks and examination and control of
potential risks, improve the risk prevention and resolution mechanism, enhance production safety levels
and ensure production safety. Enterprises that do not have the conditions for safe production shall not
engage in production and business activities.
The person in charge of an enterprise shall be fully responsible for the work safety of the enterprise.
An enterprise with more than one hundred employees shall set up an institution for the management of
work safety or designate full-time staff for the management of work safety. The management personnel of
the enterprise in charge of work safety shall conduct regular inspections of the work safety status
according to the production and operation characteristics of the enterprise; the safety risks identified
during the inspection shall be dealt with immediately; if they cannot be dealt with, they shall be reported
to the relevant person in charge in a timely manner, who shall then promptly take measures to eliminate
the safety risks. The inspection and measures taken for elimination of the safety risks must be truthfully
recorded. Enterprises shall educate their employees on work safety, and truthfully inform them of the
dangerous factors that exist in the workplaces and positions, preventive measures and emergency response
measures. In addition, enterprises must provide employees with personal protective equipment that meets
national or industry standards, and supervise and train employees to use the equipment.
According to the Measures for the Supervision and Administration of “Three Simultaneities”
Requirements for the Safety Facilities of Construction Projects (݄“ࣛ”္ຖ၍ଣ፬
جwhich were promulgated by the former State Administration of Work Safety (now the Ministry of
Emergency Management (the “ MEM”)) on April 2, 2015 and became effective on May 1, 2015, the safety
facilities of a construction project must be designed, constructed and put into operation simultaneously
with the major construction works of the construction project.
According to the Regulation on the Administration of Precursor Chemicals (၍ଣૢԷ),
promulgated by the PRC State Council on August 26, 2005 and last amended and with effect from
September 18, 2018, a classified administration and licensing system are applied to the production,
distribution, purchase, transportation, and import and export of precursor chemicals. An enterprise shall
report the variety and quantity in demand to the competent public security bureau for filing before
purchasing any precursor chemicals in Category II and III.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
—1 1 9—


--- page 129 ---
Fire Prevention
According to the Fire Prevention Law of the PRC (جor the Fire Prevention
Law, promulgated by the SCNPC on April 29, 1998 and last amended with effect from April 29, 2021,
design and construction of the fire control facilities for a construction work shall comply with the national
fire control technical standards. The developer, designer, constructors and project supervisor of a
construction project shall be responsible for the quality of the design and construction of the fire control
facilities for the construction work according to the relevant laws.
According to the Fire Prevention Law and the Interim Provisions on Design Inspection and
Acceptance of Fire Protection of Construction Works (֛o rt h e
Interim Provisions on Fire Protection, promulgated by the MOHURD on April 1, 2020 and effective as of
June 1, 2020, a special construction work as stipulated in the Interim Provisions on Fire Protection shall
be subject to fire protection design review before the construction of such work is commenced and shall
be subject to fire protection inspection before such work is put into use. Construction works other than a
special construction work shall be subject to fire protection inspection filing, and the competent
administrative authority in charge of the examination and acceptance of fire protection design shall
conduct spot inspections. If a construction work fails to pass the spot inspection, the use of such
construction shall cease, and rectification actions must be taken with a view to applying for a
re-inspection.
Prevention and Control of Occupational Diseases
According to the Law of the PRC on the Prevention and Control of Occupational Diseases ( ʕശɛ
جطwhich was promulgated by the SCNPC on October 27, 2001 and last amended
with effect from December 29, 2018, the Measures for the Supervision and Administration of “Three
Simultaneities” Requirements for the Prevention and Control of Occupational Diseases Facilities of
Construction Projects (݄“ࣛ”جwhich were promulgated by the
MEM on March 9, 2017 and became effective on May 1, 2017, and the Measures for the Declaration of
Projects with Occupational Hazards (جwhich were promulgated by the MEM on
April 27, 2012 and became effective on June 1, 2012, the facilities for the prevention and control of
occupational diseases of a construction project must be designed, constructed and put into operation
simultaneously with the major construction works of the construction project.
Regulations on Self-Owned Real Properties
According to the Civil Code of the PRC (Պ) or the PRC Civil Code, which was
promulgated by the NPC on May 28, 2020 and became effective from January 1, 2021, properties referred
to in this law include real property and personal property. The creation, alteration, alienation, or
extinguishment of the property right of a real property shall become effective upon registration in
accordance with law.
The certificate of ownership of real property shall be an evidence of the right holder’s entitlement
in the real property. The right to use a land parcel for construction purposes may be created by way of
grant, allocation or by other means. A person who has the right to use a land parcel for construction
purposes shall make reasonable use of the land parcel and may not change its planned purpose of use.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 120 —


--- page 130 ---
According to the Land Administration Law of the PRC (جpromulgated
by the SCNPC on June 25, 1986 and last amended with effect from January 1, 2020, China implements
“socialist public ownership of land”, that is, ownership by the whole people or collective ownership by
the working masses. The State formulates an overall land utilization plan to stipulate land use, classifying
land into agricultural land, construction land, or unused land. Entities or individuals using land must use
the land strictly in accordance with the purposes of land use determined in the overall land utilization plan.
Regulations on Lease of Real Property
According to the PRC Civil Code, a lease contract generally shall contain clauses specifying the
name, quantity and purpose of use of the leased object, the term of the lease, rent, the schedule and method
of its payment, the maintenance and repair of the leased object, etc. The lessee of a lease may, with the
consent of the lessor, sublease the leased object to a third party.
On December 1, 2010, the MOHURD promulgated the Administrative Measures for Leasing of
Commodity Housing (جwhich became effective on February 1, 2011. According to
such measures, a commodity housing lease contract should be registered with the competent municipal or
county level housing and construction authority within 30 days after the execution of the lease contract.
Failure to comply with the above filing requirements may subject the relevant lessor and lessee to
administrative penalties including rectification order and fine.
Regulations on Product Liability
The Product Quality Law of the PRC (جor the PRC Product Quality Law
promulgated by the SCNPC on February 22, 1993 and last amended on December 29, 2018, is the principal
law relating to the supervision and administration of product quality. The PRC Product Quality Law
clarified liabilities of the manufactures and sellers. Manufactures shall be responsible for the quality of
the products manufactured by them and sellers shall take measures to ensure the quality of the products
sold by them.
If a defect in a product causes physical injury or damage to property other than the defective product,
the manufacturer of the product shall be liable for compensation, unless the manufacturer is able to prove
that: (1) the product has not been put into circulation; (2) the defects causing the physical injury or
property damage did not exist at the time when the product was put in circulation; or (3) the science and
technology at the time when the product was circulated were at a level incapable of detecting the defects.
A seller shall be liable for compensation if the physical injury or property damage of others is caused by
defects due to the fault on the part of seller. A seller shall also be liable for compensation if it cannot
identify neither the manufacturer nor the supplier of the defective products. A person who is injured or
whose property is damaged by the defects in the product may claim for compensation from the producer
or the seller.
According to the PRC Civil Code and the PRC Product Quality Law, where a defective product
causes any harm to another person, the manufacturer shall assume the tort liability. Where any harm is
caused to another person by a defective product, the victim may require compensation to be made by the
manufacturer of the product or the seller of the product. If the defect of the product is caused by the
manufacturer and the seller has made the compensation for the defect, the seller shall be entitled to be
reimbursed by the manufacturer. If the defect of the product is caused by the fault of the seller and the
manufacturer has made the compensation for the defect, the manufacturer shall be entitled to be
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 121 —


--- page 131 ---
reimbursed by the seller. The PRC Civil Code also stipulates that where the defect of a product endangers
the personal or property safety of another person, the victim shall be entitled to require the manufacturer
or seller to assume the tort liability by ceasing infringement, removing the obstruction, or eliminating the
danger.
Regulations on Information Security and Data Protection
Personal Data
According to the PRC Civil Code, the personal information of an individual shall be protected by the
law. Any organization or individual that needs to obtain personal information of others shall obtain such
information legally and ensure the safety of such information, and shall not illegally collect, use, process
or transmit personal information of others, or illegally purchase or sell, provide or publish personal
information of others. In addition, the processing of personal information shall follow the principles of
lawfulness, appropriateness and necessity.
On August 20, 2021, the SCNPC promulgated the Personal Information Protection Law of the PRC
(جor the Personal Information Protection Law, which became effective
on November 1, 2021. The Personal Information Protection Law requires, among others, that the
processing of personal information should have a clear and reasonable purpose and should be limited to
the minimum scope necessary to achieve the processing purpose, adopt a method that has the least impact
on personal rights and interests, and shall not process personal information that is not related to the
processing purpose.
The Interpretations of the Supreme People’s Court and the Supreme People’s Procuratorate on
Several Issues Concerning the Application of Law in the Handling of Criminal Cases Involving
Infringement of Citizens’ Personal Information (ɛ
༆ᙑ), or the Interpretations were promulgated on May 8, 2017 and
became effective on June 1, 2017. The Interpretations clarify several concepts regarding the crime of
“infringement of citizens’ personal information” stipulated by Article 253A of the Criminal Law of the
PRC (جincluding “citizens’ personal information”, “violation of relevant national
provisions”, “provision of citizens’ personal information” and “illegally obtaining any citizen’s personal
information by other methods”. In addition, the Interpretations specify the standards for determining
“serious circumstances” and “extraordinary serious circumstances” of this crime.
Information security and censorship
On June 10, 2021, the SCNPC promulgated the Data Security Law of the PRC ( ʕശɛ͏΍ձ਷ᅰ
جor the Data Security Law, which came into effects on September 1, 2021. The Data Security
Law sets forth the regulatory framework and the responsibilities of the relevant administrative authorities
in regulating data security. It provides that the central government shall establish a central data security
work liaison system, which shall coordinate the relevant authorities covering different industries to
formulate the catalogues of key data, and the special measures that shall be taken to protect the security
of the key data.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 122 —


--- page 132 ---
On November 7, 2016, the SCNPC promulgated the Cyber Security Law of the PRC ( ʕശɛ͏΍ձ
جwhich became effective on June 1, 2017, according to which, network operators shall
fulfill their obligations to safeguard the security of the network when conducting business and providing
services. Those who provide services through networks shall take technical measures and other necessary
measures according to laws, regulations and compulsory national requirements to safeguard the safe and
stable operation of the networks, respond to network security incidents effectively, prevent illegal and
criminal activities, and maintain the integrity, confidentiality and usability of network data. The network
operator shall not collect personal information irrelevant to the services it provides or collect or use the
personal information in violation of the provisions of laws or agreements concluded with its users, and
network operators of key information infrastructure shall store within the PRC all the personal information
and important data collected and produced within the PRC. The purchase of network products and services
that may affect national security shall be subject to national cyber security review.
On July 30, 2021, the PRC State Council promulgated the Regulations on the Protection of the
Security of Critical Information Infrastructure (ᚐૢԷ), which became effective
on September 1, 2021. According to the Regulations on the Protection of the Security of Critical
Information Infrastructure, a “critical information infrastructure” refers to an important network facility
and information system in important industries such as, among others, public communications and
information services, as well as other important network facilities and information systems that may
seriously endanger national security, the national economy, the people’s livelihood, or the public interests
in the event of damage, loss of function, or data leakage. These regulations supplement and specify the
provisions on the security of critical information infrastructure as stated in the Cyber Security Law of the
PRC, and provide that the competent administrative authorities and supervision and management
authorities of the aforementioned important industries will be responsible for (1) organizing the
identification of critical information infrastructures in their respective industries in accordance with
certain identification rules, and (2) promptly notifying the identified operators and the Ministry of Public
Security of the identification results. These regulations require that the relevant operator shall submit a
report to the competent PRC administrative authority in accordance with relevant provisions upon the
occurrence of any major cybersecurity incident or the discovery of any major cybersecurity threat to the
critical information infrastructures, and the operators of critical information infrastructures shall purchase
the safe and trusted network products and services in the first place. If the purchase of network products
and services may affect national security, such operators shall pass the cybersecurity review accordingly.
On December 28, 2021, the Cyberspace Administration of China, or the CAC, jointly with 12 other
administrative authorities, promulgated the Measures for Cybersecurity Review (جor
the MCR, which became effective on February 15, 2022. According to the MCR, critical information
infrastructure operators that purchase network products and services, and network platform operators
engaging in data processing activities that affect or may affect national security are subject to
cybersecurity review under the MCR. In addition, network platform operators with personal information
of over one million users shall be subject to cybersecurity review before listing abroad ( ਷̮ɪ̹). The
competent administrative authorities may also initiate a cybersecurity review against the operators if the
authorities believe that the network product or service or data processing activities of such operators affect
or may affect national security. As of the Latest Practicable Date: (1) we had not been designated as a
critical information infrastructure operator by any administrative authorities; (2) we believe that we had
not engaged in any data processing activities that affect or may affect national security; and (3) we had
not been involved in any investigations on cybersecurity review made by CAC, and had not received any
inquiry, notice, warning or sanctions in this regard.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 123 —


--- page 133 ---
On July 7, 2022, the CAC promulgated the Cross-border Data Transfer Security Assessment
Measures (جor the Security Assessment Measures, which became effective on
September 1, 2022. The Security Assessment Measures provide that, among others, data processors shall
apply to competent authorities for security assessment when (1) the data processors transferring important
data abroad; (2) a critical information infrastructure operator or a personal information processor that has
processed personal information of more than one million people, transferring personal information abroad;
(3) a data processor who has provided personal information of 100,000 individuals or sensitive personal
information of 10,000 individuals abroad, in each case as calculated cumulatively, since January 1 of the
last year, transferring personal information abroad, and (4) other circumstances where the security
assessment of data cross-border transfer is required as prescribed by the CAC. In addition, on February
24, 2023, the Provisions on the Prescribed Agreement on Cross-border Data Transfer of Personal
Information (جor the Provisions on Prescribed Agreement were promulgated
by the CAC, which took effect on June 1, 2023. The Provisions on Prescribed Agreement attach the
prescribed template for cross-border data transfer agreement that could be used as an available option to
satisfy the condition for cross-border transfer of personal information under Article 38 of the Personal
Information Protection Law.
Regulations on Intellectual Property Rights
Trademark
Trademarks are protected by the Trademark Law of the PRC (جwhich was
promulgated by the SCNPC on August 23, 1982 and last amended with effect from November 1, 2019, and
the Implementation Regulation of the PRC Trademark Law (ૢԷ), which was
promulgated by the PRC State Council on August 3, 2002 and came into effect on September 15, 2002,
and last amended with effect from May 1, 2014. The Trademark Office of the China National Intellectual
Property Administration is in charge of trademark registration and grants registered trademarks a validity
term of 10 years which may be renewed for consecutive 10-year periods upon application by the owner
of the registered trademark.
Patent
According to the Patent Law of the PRC (جpromulgated by the SCNPC on
March 12, 1984 and last amended with effect from June 1, 2021, and the Implementing Regulations of the
Patent Law of the PRC (ۆpromulgated by the PRC State Council on
December 21, 1992 and last amended with effect from February 1, 2010, the Patent Office of the China
National Intellectual Property Administration is responsible for the patent work nationwide, and its
counterparts at provincial level are responsible for the administration of patents within their respective
administrative regions. An invention or utility model for which a patent is granted shall be novel, inventive
and practically applicable. The protection period is 20 years for an invention patent, 10 years for a utility
model patent, and 15 years for design patent, commencing from their respective application dates. Any
entity or individual that intends to use a patent of another party must enter into a licensing agreement with
the patent owner and pay patent royalties to the patent owner. Any use of a patent without the permission
of the patent owner constitutes an infringement of the patent right.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 124 —


--- page 134 ---
Domain Name
In accordance with the Administrative Measures for Internet Domain Names (ج)
promulgated by the Ministry of Industry and Information Technology (the “ MIIT ”) on August 24, 2017
with effect from November 1, 2017, to establish domain name root servers and domain name root server
operating organizations, domain name registration management organizations and domain registration
service organizations within the territory of China, licenses from the MIIT or the telecommunications
administration authority at the provincial level shall be obtained in accordance with the relevant
regulations. The domain name registration service shall be conducted following the principle of “apply
first, register first”. The Notice of the Ministry of Industry and Information Technology on Regulating the
Use of Domain Names in Internet Information Services (ਕԴ͜ਹ
ٝissued by the MIIT on November 27, 2017 with effect from January 1, 2018 provides for the
obligations of internet information service providers and other entities to fight against terrorism and
maintain the network security of China.
Regulations on Taxation
PRC Enterprise Income Tax
The PRC enterprise income tax, or EIT, is calculated based on the taxable income determined under
the Enterprise Income Tax Law of the PRC (جor the PRC EIT Law, and its
implementation rules, both of which became effective on January 1, 2008 and were last amended with
effect from December 29, 2018 and April 23, 2019, respectively. The PRC EIT Law generally imposes a
uniform enterprise income tax rate of 25% on all resident enterprises in China, including foreign-invested
enterprises. The PRC EIT Law and its implementation rules permit the enterprises qualified as “High and
New Technologies Enterprises”, or HNTEs, to enjoy a reduced 15% enterprise income tax rate.
PRC V alue Added Tax
On March 23, 2016, MOF and the SA T jointly issued the Circular on the Pilot Program for Overall
Implementation of the Collection of V alue Added Tax Instead of Business Tax (પකᐄุ೼ҷᅄ
ٝthe “ Circular 36 ”), which took effect on May 1, 2016 and was last amended with
effect from April 1, 2019 following the enactment of the Announcement 39 (as defined below). According
to the Circular 36, all of the companies operating in construction, real estate, finance, modern service or
other sectors which were required to pay business tax are required to pay value-added tax, or V A T, in lieu
of business tax. A V A T rate of 6% applies to revenue generated from the provision of certain services.
Unlike business tax, a taxpayer is allowed to offset the qualified input V A T paid on taxable purchases
against the output V A T chargeable on the revenue from services provided.
On March 20, 2019, MOF, the SA T and the General Administration of Customs of the PRC issued
the Announcement on Policies for Deepening the V A T Reform (ʮѓ) (the
“Announcement 39 ”), which came into effect on April 1, 2019, to further slash V A T rates. According to
Announcement 39, (1) the 16% or 10% V A T rate previously imposed on sales and imports by general V A T
taxpayers is reduced to 13% or 9% respectively; (2) the 10% V A T deduction rate previously allowed for
the procured agricultural products is reduced to 9%; (3) for the agricultural products procured for
production or commissioned processing with a 13% V A T rate, the amount of input V A T shall be calculated
at the 10% V A T deduction rate; and (4) the 16% or 10% export V A T refund rate previously granted to the
exportation of goods or labor services is reduced to 13% or 9%, respectively.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 125 —


--- page 135 ---
Regulations on Foreign Exchange and Dividend Distribution
Foreign Exchange Control
The PRC Regulations for the Foreign Exchange Administration ( ʕശɛ͏΍ձ਷̮ි၍ଣૢԷ),
which were promulgated by the PRC State Council in January 1996 and amended in January 1997 and
August 2008, established the regulatory framework of the administration on foreign currency exchange in
China. Under the PRC Regulations for the Foreign Exchange Administration, payments of current account
items, such as trade, services, benefits or current transfer-related transactions in foreign currencies, in
foreign currency may be proceeded without prior approval from the State Administration of Foreign
Exchange of the PRC (“ SAFE ”) as long as certain procedural requirements are complied with. By contrast,
approval from, or registration with, appropriate administrative authorities is required where RMB is to be
converted into foreign currency and remitted out of China for items under the capital account such as
repayment of foreign currency denominated loans or foreign currency is to be remitted into China under
the capital account, such as a capital increase or foreign currency loans extended by an offshore entity to
an entity in China.
The Provisions on the Administration of Foreign Exchange in Domestic Direct Investments by
Foreign Investors (֛which were promulgated by SAFE in May
2013 and amended in October 2018 and December 2019, regulate and clarify the administration over
foreign exchange administration in foreign investors’ direct investments, and provide that the
administration by SAFE or its local branches over direct investment by foreign investors in China shall
be conducted by way of registration and banks shall process foreign exchange business relating to the
direct investment in China based on the information recorded with the SAFE and its branches.
According to the Circular of the State Administration of Foreign Exchange on Further Improving and
Adjusting the Foreign Exchange Policies on Direct Investment (ٜ
ٝand its appendix promulgated in November 2012 and amended in May 2015,
October 2018 and December 2019 by the SAFE, the foreign exchange procedures are further simplified:
(1) the opening of and payment into foreign exchange accounts under direct investment are no longer
subject to approval by the SAFE; (2) reinvestment with legal income of foreign investors in China is no
longer subject to approval by SAFE; (3) the procedures for capital verification and confirmation that
foreign-invested enterprises need to go through are simplified; (4) purchase and external payment of
foreign exchange under direct investment are no longer subject to approval by SAFE; (5) domestic transfer
of foreign exchange under direct investment is no longer subject to approval by SAFE; and (6) the
administration over the settlement of foreign exchange capital of foreign-invested enterprises is improved.
Later, the SAFE issued the Circular on Further Simplifying and Improving Foreign Exchange
Administration Policies in Respect of Direct Investment (ٙ
ٝin February 2015 which became effective in June 2015 and was further amended in December 2019,
prescribed that the banks instead of the SAFE can directly handle foreign exchange registrations under
foreign direct investment and outbound investment while the SAFE and its branches indirectly supervise
the foreign exchange registration under foreign direct investment through the bank.
According to the Circular on the Reform of the Management Method for the Settlement of Foreign
Exchange Capital of Foreign-invested Enterprises (ஷ
ٝissued by the SAFE in March 2015 and amended in December 2019 and March 2023, and the Circular
on the Reform and Standardization of the Management Policy of the Settlement of Capital Projects (׵
ٝissued by the SAFE in June 2016, the settlement of foreign
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 126 —


--- page 136 ---
exchange by foreign-invested enterprises shall be governed by the policy of foreign exchange settlement
on a discretionary basis. However, the settlement of foreign exchange shall only be used for their own
operational purposes relating to the business activities that fall within their respective business scope of
the foreign-invested enterprises and follow the principles of authenticity.
On October 23, 2019, the SAFE issued the Circular on Further Facilitating the Convenience of
Cross-border Trade and Investment (ٝor the Circular 28,
which took effect on the same day. The Circular 28 allows non-investment foreign-invested enterprises to
use their capital funds to make equity investments in China, for so long as such investments do not violate
the requirements set out in the Negative List and the target projects to be invested are genuine and in
compliance with laws and regulations.
According to the Circular on Optimizing Administration of Foreign Exchange to Support the
Development of Foreign-related Business (ٝissued by the
SAFE in April 2020, eligible enterprises are allowed to make domestic payments by using their funds
received by way of capital contribution, foreign debts and overseas listing, with no need to provide the
evidentiary materials concerning authenticity of such payment to banks in advance, provided that their
capital use shall be authentic and compliant, and conform with the prevailing administrative regulations
on the use of income under capital accounts. The concerned bank shall conduct ex post spot check and the
local branches of the SAFE shall strengthen monitoring analysis and interim and ex post regulation in
accordance with the relevant requirements.
Dividend Distribution
The principal regulations governing distribution of dividends of wholly foreign-owned enterprise, or
WFOE, include the PRC Company Law. Under these regulations, limited liability companies (including
WFOEs) in China may pay dividends only out of their accumulated profits, if any, determined in
accordance with the PRC accounting standards and regulations. In addition, limited liability companies
(including WFOEs) in the PRC are required to allocate at least 10% of their accumulated profits each year,
if any, to fund certain reserve funds unless these reserves have reached 50% of the registered capital of
the enterprises. These reserves are not distributable as cash dividends.
The SAFE issued the Notice on Improving the Check of Authenticity and Compliance to Further
Promote Foreign Exchange Administration Reform (ٙࣨ
ٝin January 2017, which stipulates several capital control measures with respect to outbound
remittance of profits from domestic entities to offshore entities, including the following: (1) under the
principle of genuine transaction, banks shall check board resolutions regarding profit distribution, the
original version of tax filing records and audited financial statements for any remittance of profits of more
than (not excluding) USD50,000; and (2) domestic entities shall hold income to account for previous
years’ losses before remitting the profits. Moreover, domestic entities shall make detailed explanations of
sources of capital and utilization arrangements, and provide board resolutions, contracts and other proof
when completing the registration and outward remittance procedures in connection with an outbound
investment.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 127 —


--- page 137 ---
Foreign Exchange Registration of Offshore Investment by PRC Residents
The SAFE issued the Circular on Relevant Issues Concerning the Foreign Exchange Administration
of the Overseas Investment and Financing and the Round-Tripping Investment Made by Domestic
Residents through Special-Purpose Companies (೻ҳ༟
ٝthe “ Circular 37 ”), which became effective on July 4, 2014. The Circular 37
requires PRC residents (including PRC enterprise and individuals) to register with local branches of the
SAFE in connection with their respective direct or indirect offshore investment in an overseas special
purpose vehicle, or the SPV , directly established or indirectly controlled by PRC residents for offshore
investment and financing with their legally owned assets or interests in domestic enterprises, or their
legally owned offshore assets or interests. Such PRC residents are also required to amend and update their
registrations with the SAFE when there is a change to the basic information of the SPV , such as changes
of a PRC resident individual shareholder, the name or operating period of the SPV , or when there is a
substantial change to the SPV , such as changes of the PRC individual resident’s increase or decrease of
its capital contribution in the SPV , or any share transfer or exchange, merger, spin-off of the SPV .
Failure to comply with the registration procedures set forth in the Circular 37 may result in
restrictions on the foreign exchange activities of the relevant onshore company, including the payment of
dividends and other distributions to its offshore parent or affiliate, the capital inflow from the offshore
entities and settlement of foreign exchange capital, and may also subject relevant onshore company or
PRC residents to penalties under PRC foreign exchange administration regulations for evasion of foreign
exchange controls.
Employee Stock Incentive Plan
In February 2012, the SAFE issued the Circular on Relevant Issues Concerning the Foreign
Exchange Administration for Domestic Individuals Participating in Stock Incentive Plans of Overseas
Publicly Listed Company (ٝor
the Stock Option Rules, which replaced the earlier rules promulgated by the SAFE in March 2007. Under
the Stock Option Rules, PRC residents who participate in stock incentive plans in an overseas publicly
listed company are required, through a PRC agent or PRC subsidiary of such overseas publicly listed
company, to complete the foreign exchange registration and certain other procedures. These participants
must also retain an overseas entrusted institution to handle matters in connection with their exercise of
stock options, the purchase and sale of corresponding stocks or interests and fund transfers. In addition,
the PRC agent is required to amend and update the registration with respect to the share scheme if there
is any material change to the stock incentive plan, the PRC agent or the overseas entrusted institution or
other material changes.
Regulations on Labor Protection and Social Insurance
General Labor Contract Rules
According to the Labor Law of the PRC (جwhich was promulgated by the
SCNPC on July 5, 1994 and subsequently amended on August 27, 2009 and December 29, 2018, the Labor
Contract Law of the PRC (جwhich was promulgated by the SCNPC on June
29, 2007 and subsequently amended on December 28, 2012 and the Implementing Regulations of the
Labor Contract Law of the PRC (ૢԷ) which were promulgated by the
PRC State Council on September 18, 2008, a labor contract in writing is required to establish a labor
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 128 —


--- page 138 ---
relationship between an employee and his employer. Wages may not be lower than the local standards of
minimum wages. Employer must establish their respective system of occupational safety and sanitation,
implement the rules and standards issued or imposed by the State from time to time, provide education
regarding occupational safety and sanitation to their employees, provide their employees with labor safety
and sanitation conditions and necessary articles of labor protection conforming to the provisions of the
State, and provide regular health examination for employees engaged in work involving occupational
hazards.
Social Security and Housing Provident Fund
According to the Social Insurance Law of the PRC (جeffective on July
1, 2011 and amended with effect from December 29, 2018, the Regulations on Occupational Injury
Insurance (ᎈૢԷ) effective on January 1, 2004 and last amended with effect from January 1, 2011,
the Interim Measures Concerning the Maternity Insurance for Enterprises Employees (ᎈ
جeffective on January 1, 1995, the Interim Regulations Concerning the Levy of Social Insurance
(ᎈ൬ᅄᖮᅲБૢԷ) effective on January 22, 1999 and amended with effect from March 24, 2019,
the Unemployment Insurance Regulations (ᎈૢԷ) effective on January 22, 1999, and the
Regulations Concerning the Administration of Housing Fund (၍ଣૢԷ) effective on April 3,
1999 and last amended with effect from March 24, 2019, employers in China are required to contribute,
on behalf of their employees, to a number of social security funds, including funds for basic pension
insurance, unemployment insurance, maternity insurance, occupational injury insurance and medical
insurance, as well as a housing provident fund and other welfare plans. These payments are made to local
competent administrative authorities, and any employer who fails to contribute may be ordered to correct
the deficit within a stipulated time limit and be fined if it still fails to contribute after such stipulated time
limit has passed.
On July 20, 2018, the General Office of the Communist Party of China and the General Office of the
PRC State Council jointly issued the Reform Plan of the State Tax and Local Tax Collection
Administration System (ࣩunder which, starting from January 1, 2019, tax
authorities are responsible for the collection of social insurance contributions in China. According to the
Notice on Conducting the Relevant Work Concerning the Administration of Collection of Social Insurance
Premiums in a Steady, Orderly and Effective Manner (ٝ)
issued by the SA T in September 2018 and the Urgent Notice on Implementing the Spirit of the Executive
Meeting of the PRC State Council in Stabilizing the Collection of Social Security Contributions (஫
ٝissued by the General Office of the
Ministry of Human Resources and Social Security in September 2018, all the local authorities responsible
for the collection of social insurance are strictly forbidden to conduct self-collection of historical unpaid
social insurance contributions from enterprises. The Notice on Implementing Measures to Further Support
and Serve the Development of Private Economy (ஷ
ٝissued by the SA T in November 2018, repeated that tax authorities at all levels may not organize
self-collection of arrears of taxpayers including private enterprises in the previous years. The Notice on
Issuing the Comprehensive Plan for the Reduction of Social Insurance Premium Rate (ึ
ٝpromulgated by the General Office of the PRC State Council in April 2019,
generally reduces the social insurance contribution burden of enterprises, underlines that the duties for
collection of social insurances premium paid by the enterprises in any province shall not be transferred
to tax authorities until the condition of the province is mature, and re-emphasizes that local authorities
shall not conduct self-collection of historical unpaid social insurance contributions from enterprises.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 129 —


--- page 139 ---
Regulations on Overseas Listing
CSRC Filing Requirements for Overseas Offering and Listing
On February 17, 2023, the China Securities Regulatory Commission (the “ CSRC ”) released the Trial
Administrative Measures of Overseas Securities Offering and Listing by Domestic Companies ( ྤʫΆุ
جand five supporting guidelines (together, the “ Trial Filing
Measures ”), which came into effect on March 31, 2023. The Trial Filing Measures shall apply to the
following overseas issuance: (1) direct overseas offerings and listings of PRC domestic companies, and
(2) indirect overseas offering and listing of a foreign company with major business operations and/or
assets located in the PRC. An issuer will be qualified for the scenario (2) above, if it satisfies both
conditions below: (1) more than 50% of its audited financial indicators (operating revenue, profits, total
assets or net assets) for the most recent accounting year is accounted for by the domestic companies of
the issuer; and (2) major business activities or operations are conducted in PRC, or main places of business
are located in PRC or the majority of senior management domicile in PRC or are Chinese citizens. Despite
the foregoing, regulators have the discretion to determine whether or not an overseas offering and listing
is indirect on a substance over form basis. The securities subject to the Trial Filing Measures include
equity shares, depository receipts, corporate bonds convertible to equity shares, and other equity
securities.
According to the Trial Filing Measures, the issuer shall submit the required filing documents to the
CSRC within three working days after the overseas listing application is submitted to the relevant overseas
regulator or listing venue. Once the filing documents are complete and in compliance with the stipulated
requirements, the CSRC will, within 20 working days, conclude the review procedure and publish the
filing results on the CSRC website. To the extent the filing documents are incomplete or do not conform
to stipulated requirements, the CSRC will, within five working days upon receipt of filing documents,
request supplementation and amendment to the filing. Then the issuer has 30 days to prepare any requested
supplemented/amended filing. In addition, following the listing in an overseas market, the issuer shall
submit a report to the CSRC within three working days after the occurrence and public disclosure of the
following events involving the issuer: (1) change of control; (2) investigations or sanctions imposed by
overseas regulators; (3) change of listing status or transfer of listing market; and (4) voluntary or
involuntary delisting.
The Trial Filing Measures also stipulate that following cases may be rejected by the CSRC: (1)
offerings and listings are explicitly prohibited by laws and regulations; (2) offerings and listings may
endanger national security as reviewed and determined by competent authorities under the PRC State
Council in accordance with law; (3) domestic companies of the listing applicant or its controlling
shareholder or actual controlling person are involved in criminal offenses in the last three years, such as
corruption, bribery, embezzlement, misappropriation of property, or undermining the order of the socialist
market economy; (4) domestic companies of the listing applicant is under investigations for suspicion of
criminal offenses or is involved in major violations of laws and regulations and no conclusion of the
investigation has yet been made; or (5) there are material ownership disputes over equity interests held by
controlling shareholders or by shareholders who are controlled by the controlling shareholder or actual
controlling person.
Non-compliance with the Trial Filing Measures will result in regulatory action by the CSRC and
fines for PRC issuers in an amount up to RMB10 million.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 130 —


--- page 140 ---
CSRC Requirements on Confidentiality and Archives Administration for Overseas Offering and Listing
On February 24, 2023, the CSRC, MOF, the National Administration of State Secrets Protection and
National Archives Administration of China jointly released the revised Provisions on Strengthening the
Confidentiality and Archives Administration of Overseas Securities Offering and Listing by Domestic
Companies (֛or the Archives
Administration Provisions, which came into effect on March 31, 2023. The Archives Administration
Provisions shall apply to both (1) PRC domestic companies seeking a direct listing on the overseas stock
exchange and (2) the PRC domestic operating entities of a foreign company seeking listing on the overseas
stock exchange that qualifies as an “indirect listing” (above (1) and (2) collectively, “ Domestic
Companies ”).
According to the Archives Administration Provisions, the Domestic Companies shall establish and
implement a solid confidentiality and archives administration system. If a Domestic Company decides to
disclose any documents or materials containing state secrets, work secrets of state authorities or any
information that may be detrimental to national security or public interest once leaked, proper
governmental approval procedures should be followed. After obtaining the governmental clearance, the
Domestic Company disclosing such information, as one party, and the securities companies and securities
services providers receiving such information, as the other party, shall also enter into non-disclosure
agreements, setting forth the confidentiality obligations of the securities companies and securities services
providers. When providing the above information to the securities companies and securities services
providers retained by it, the Domestic Companies are also required to issue a written statement outlining
its compliance with the relevant regulatory requirements and procedures.
In terms of providing accounting archives or copies thereof to any other entities or persons (such as
securities companies, securities services providers and overseas regulators), the Archives Administration
Provisions stipulate that relevant governmental procedures should be complied.
Any violation of the above regulations may subject the Domestic Companies to regulatory penalties
under the Safeguarding State Secrets Law of the PRC (جand the Archives
Law of the PRC (جࣩand even criminal liabilities to the extent applicable.
REGULATORY OVERVIEW
— 131 —


--- page 141 ---
The information and statistics set out in this section and other sections of this prospectus were
extracted from the report prepared by Frost & Sullivan, which was commissioned by us, and from
various official government publications and other publicly available publications. We engaged
Frost & Sullivan to prepare the Frost & Sullivan Report, an independent industry report, in
connection with the Global Offering. The information from official government sources has not been
independently verified by us, the Joint Sponsors, the Overall Coordinators, Joint Global
Coordinators, Joint Bookrunners, Joint Lead Managers, Underwriters, any of their respective
directors and advisers, or any other persons or parties involved in the Global Offering, and no
representation is given as to its accuracy.
SOURCES OF INFORMATION
We commissioned Frost & Sullivan, an independent consulting firm, to conduct a detailed research
on the ADC and broader bioconjugate markets and the outsourcing services industry. Frost & Sullivan is
an independent global market research and consulting company which was founded in 1961 and is based
in the United States. Services provided by Frost & Sullivan include market assessments, competitive
benchmarking, and strategic and market planning for a variety of industries. We have agreed to pay a fee
of RMB550,000 to Frost & Sullivan in connection with the preparation of the Frost & Sullivan Report.
We have extracted certain information from the Frost & Sullivan Report in this section, as well as in the
sections headed “Summary,” “Risk Factors,” “Business,” “Financial Information” and elsewhere in this
prospectus to provide our potential investors with a more comprehensive presentation of the industry in
which we operate.
During the preparation of the Frost & Sullivan Report, Frost & Sullivan performed both primary and
secondary research, and obtained knowledge, statistics, information and industry insights on the industry
trends of the global ADC and broader bioconjugate markets and the global ADC and broader bioconjugates
outsourcing services market, as well as major players in the ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing
services industry. Primary research involved discussing the status of the industry with leading industry
participants and industry experts. Secondary research involved reviewing annual reports of public
companies, independent research reports and Frost & Sullivan’s proprietary databases. The Frost &
Sullivan Report was compiled based on the assumptions that (i) the global economies, in particular, the
United States and China, are likely to maintain a steady rate of growth in the next decade; (ii) the key
growth drivers mentioned in this section are likely to drive the growth of the global ADC and broader
bioconjugate markets and the ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing market from 2022 to 2030, and
(iii) there is no force majeure or industry regulation that affects any of such markets dramatically or
fundamentally. For the avoidance of doubt, the impacts of COVID-19 have been considered when
compiling information in the Frost & Sullivan Report. In this section, Frost & Sullivan presents historical
market information for five years (i.e., from 2018 to 2022) which is longer than the Track Record Period
and, we believe, is a more accurate reflection of the trends that affect our markets.
Our Directors confirmed that, after taking reasonable care, as of the Latest Practicable Date, there
had been no adverse change in the market information set forth herein since the date on which the Frost
& Sullivan Report was issued.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 132 —


--- page 142 ---
OVERVIEW OF ADC AND BROADER BIOCONJUGATE MARKETS
Antibody Drug Conjugates (“ADCs”)
ADC is an innovative biologics drug modality composed of a biologic component (i.e., the antibody)
attached to a small molecule drug (i.e., the cytotoxic payload) via a specifically designed linker. A
traditional ADC drug utilizes the antibody to bind to the tumor-specific antigen, delivers the payload to
the target cancer cell, and then releases the payload to cause cancer cell death. An ADC combines the
target selective antibody and highly active cell-killing toxic drug, and has demonstrated the potential of
significantly improving therapeutic window, which is the dose range of a drug that provides safe and
effective therapy, compared to current standard-of-care therapies.
The following diagram illustrates an ADC’s structure and its mechanism of action (“ MoA”).
Structure of ADC Mechanism of Action of ADC
Antibody
Linker
Payload
Attaches the cytotoxic payload to the antibody
and releases the payload under designed conditions
3
2
1
Kills target cells when internalized and released
Specific for a tumor-associated antigen that
has restricted expression on normal cells
The cancer cell is killed by the cytotoxic payload and
undergoes apoptosis.
The active cytotoxic payload is detached from the antibody
and released within the cancer cell.
ADC binds to a receptor on the surface of cancer cells and
the ADC-receptor complex is internalized.
3
2
1
Source: Frost & Sullivan Analysis
Two categories of payloads are frequently utilized among the marketed ADCs: (1) tubulin inhibitors,
and (2) DNA damaging agents. With respect to antibodies, the IgG antibody stands as the most widely
utilized antibody. When it comes to conjugation methods, there are typically two options commonly used:
(i) leveraging stochastic conjugation by targeting existing lysine or cysteine residues through suitable
coupling reactions, and (ii) employing site-specific conjugation strategies.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 133 —


--- page 143 ---
Overview of Global ADC Market
Following the FDA ’s approval of the first ADC, Mylotarg® (gemtuzumab ozogamicin), in 2000, both
academic and industrial sectors have dedicated decades of effort towards the development of ADC
therapies. In recent years, there have been significant advancements in ADC drug development, such as
the emergence of new conjugation technology, optimization of drug-to-antibody ratios (DARs), and
improved linker design. Consequently, the field has seen an acceleration in development, leading to an era
of explosive growth. For the period from 2019 to 2022, ADCs represent approximately 15.4% of biologics
approved by the FDA, according to Frost & Sullivan.
As of June 30, 2023, 15 ADC drugs had received approval worldwide, out of which 11 had been
approved since 2018 and 4 have been approved since 2021. Several of these drugs have shown promising
clinical benefits and have the potential to become blockbusters. For instance, Enhertu, a groundbreaking
treatment for HER2+ cancers, generated revenue exceeding US$200 million in 2020, its first year on the
market after its commercial launch in December 2019. In 2022, three third-generation ADCs generated
significant annual sales. Enhertu sales surpassed US$1.2 billion, Padcev sales reached over US$750
million, and Trodelvy sales amounted to approximately US$680 million. These impressive sales figures
were achieved in their third year after launch. In addition, 15 to 57 ADC drug candidates have entered
clinical trials annually since 2018. As of June, 2023, there were over 500 ongoing clinical trials globally,
involving 231 ADC drug candidates, among which, 134, 79 and 18 are currently undergoing phases I, II
and III clinical trials, respectively. The flourishing clinical development of ADC drugs has led to the
publication of over 100 abstracts related to ADCs at the 2023 American Society of Clinical Oncology
(“ASCO ”) Annual Meeting.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 134 —


--- page 144 ---
Details of 15 Approved ADC Drugs Globally As of June 30, 2023
Adcetris CD30Seagen/Takeda2011 (FDA)
Classical Hodgkin Lymphoma,
Systemic Anaplastic Large
Cell Lymphoma,
Primary Cutaneous Anaplastic Large
Cell Lymphoma, Mycosis Fungoides,
Peripheral T-Cell Lymphoma,
Kadcyla HER2Roche2013 (FDA) HER2-Positive Breast Cancer
Mylotarg CD33Pfizer2017 (FDA)* Acute Myeloid Leukemia
Besponsa CD22Pfizer2017 (FDA) B-Cell Acute
Lymphoblastic Leukemia
Lumoxiti CD22AstraZeneca2018 (FDA) Hairy Cell Leukemia
Polivy CD79BRoche2019 (FDA) Diffuse Large B-Cell Lymphoma,
Large B-Cell Lymphoma
Padcev NECTIN-4Seagen/Astellas2019 (FDA) Urothelial Carcinoma
Enhertu HER2Daiichi Sankyo/AstraZeneca2019 (FDA)
HER2-Positive Breast Cancer,
HER2 Low Expression Breast Cancer,
Gastric Cancer,
Non-Small Cell Lung Cancer,
Gastroesophageal Junction Cancer
Trodelvy TROP-2Gilead2020 (FDA)
Triple-Negative Breast Cancer,
Urothelial Carcinoma,
HR-Positive, HER2-Negative
Breast Cancer
Commercial Name Target IndicationsDeveloperFirst Approval Year
Blenrep BCMAGlaxoSmithKline2020 (FDA) Multiple Myeloma
Akalux EGFRRakuten Medical2020 (PMDA) Head And Neck Cancer
Zynlonta CD19ADC Therapeutics2021 (FDA) Diffuse Large
B-Cell Lymphoma
Aidexi HER2RemeGen2021 (NMPA)
Urothelial Carcinoma,
Gastric Cancer,
Gastroesophageal
Junction Carcinoma
Elahere FR-AImmunoGen/Huadong
Medicine2022 (FDA)
Ovarian Cancer,
Fallopian Tube Cancer
And Peritoneal Cancer
Tivdak TFGenmab/Seagen2021 (FDA) Cervical Cancer
Source: FDA, NMP A, PMDA, Frost & Sullivan Analysis
Note:
* The Mylotarg from Pfizer was initially approved in 2000, which was subsequently withdrawn from the market in 2010
voluntarily, and was re-approved in 2017.
Global ADC market is poised for substantial growth over the next decade. The global ADC market
in 2022 has grown to US$7.9 billion with a CAGR of 40.4% between 2018 and 2022, and is expected to
further grow to US$64.7 billion in 2030 at a CAGR of 30.0% between 2022 and 2030, according to Frost
& Sullivan. The share of ADC drugs in the overall biologics market is expected to increase from 2.2% in
2022 to 8.3% in 2030, according to the same source.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 135 —


--- page 145 ---
The following chart sets forth global market size of ADC and its percentage of overall biologics for
the period between 2018 and 2030:
Global Market Size of ADC Between 2018 and 2030E
2.0 2.8 4.1 5.5 7.9 11.4 14.2 18.7
23.8
31.5
41.2
52.8
64.7
2018
0.8% 1.0%
CAGR ADC
2018-2022
2022-2030E
Billion USD
40.4%
30.0%
1.4% 1.6%
2.2%
2.8%
3.1%
3.6%
4.1%
4.9%
6.0%
7.1%
8.3%
2019 2020 2021
ADC Percentage of ADC in Biologics Market
2022 2023E 2024E 2025E 2026E 2027E 2028E 2029E 2030E
Source: Frost & Sullivan Analysis and Companies’ Annual Reports
Furthermore, the commercial potential of ADCs and other bioconjugate drugs has been evidenced by
significant acquisition and licensing activities globally. According to Frost & Sullivan, over 100 deals
involving ADCs have taken place since 2022. These include the recent acquisition of Seagen, a leading
biotech company specializing in developing ADCs for cancer treatment, by Pfizer, for a total consideration
of approximately US$43 billion. The surge in licensing deals for ADCs is driven by the technological
developments in ADC, in particular, improvements in ADC platforms, linker technologies and new
applications such as combination approaches with immunotherapy and chemotherapy to treat cancer, and
profit potential, according to Frost & Sullivan. In 2022, there were a total of 63 ADC licensing deals
worldwide, representing a 270% increase compared to the previous year. The reasons of the high
transaction amount in 2022 include (1) the signing of a number of mega deals, for instance, Merck and
Kelun-Biotech announcing an exclusive license and collaboration agreement for seven investigational
ADC candidates in December 2022, where the upfront payment and milestone payments totaling up to
US$9.5 billion, accounting for 35% of the 2022 full year transaction amount; and (2) the sales performance
and commercial potential of approved ADC drugs, especially some ADCs with breakthrough designation,
drives up the number of deals and transaction amount in 2022. Indeed, the global ADC market increased
by 43.6% in 2022 compared to 2021. Enhertu alone generated sales of US$1,229 million in 2022,
representing an 155% increase from the previous year. The chart below illustrates the number of global
ADC licensing deals over the past five years. The decrease in the number of transactions and total
transaction amount of global ADC licensing deals in 2021 was likely due to the COVID-19 pandemic
impacted decision-making on licensing transactions.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 136 —


--- page 146 ---
Global ADC Licensing Deals from 2018 to 6M2023
7
63
2018 2019 2020 2021 2022
0.8
8.1
13.7
8.1
15.2
33
Number of transactions Total transaction amount (USD billion)
27.4
21 26
17
Six months
in 2023
Source: Frost & Sullivan Analysis and Respective Companies’ Public Disclosures
China has emerged as the frontrunner in ADC development, occupying a prominent position in the
global market. According to Frost & Sullivan, China has been the primary contributor to ADC
out-licensing deals in recent years, with 35 deals between 2022 and June 2023, whereas the United States
has contributed 25 deals in the same period. The chart below illustrates the number of ADC out-licensing
deals from China and the U.S. over the past five years.
ADC Out-Licensing Deals from China and the U.S. from 2018 to 6M2023
2 3 4
77
9
66
21
15 14
10
2018 2019 2020 2021 2022 Six months
in 2023
China U.S.
Source: Frost & Sullivan Analysis and Respective Companies’ Public Disclosures
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 137 —


--- page 147 ---
According to Frost & Sullivan, since 2022 and as of June 30, 2023, there had been 10 China
pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies that reached 14 ADC out-licensing deals with overseas
partners, totaling US$22.0 billion. Of these 10 China companies, eight of them are clients of our Company.
The following table sets forth out-licensed ADC deals by China-based biotechnology companies with
overseas partners since 2022 and as of June 30, 2023.
China Out-licensing ADC Deals with Overseas Partners since 2022
Number Licensor Licensee Asset Transaction Amount
(billion USD) Date
1 Kelun Biotech MSD 7 ADCs 9.5 2022.12
2 Bliss Bio Eisai BB-1701 2.0 2023.5
3 Duality Biologics BioNTech 2 ADCs 1.7 2023.4
4 Kelun Biotech MSD SKB-264 1.4 2022.5
6 KYM Biosciences AstraZeneca CMG901 1.2 2023.2
7 LaNova Medicines Turning Point LM-302 1.0 2022.5
8 GeneQuantum Pyramid Biosciences GQ1010 1.0 2023.4
5 CSPC Megalith
Biopharmaceutical
Elevation
Oncology SYSA1801 1.2 2022.7
9 Kelun Biotech MSD SKB-315 0.9 2022.7
10 Evopoint Biosciences AmMax AMB-05X 0.9 2023.1
11 CSPC Corbus Nectin-4 ADC 0.7 2023.2
LaNova Medicines12 AstraZeneca LM-305 0.6 2023.5
Multitude
Therapeutics
OnCusp
Therapeutics
Highly differentiated ADC
targeting CDH613 NA 2022.6
Biocytogen ADC therapeutics 3 mAb/BsAb molecules against tumor
targets for ADC development14 NA 2022.11
Total Transaction Amount (billion USD) 22.1
Source: Frost & Sullivan Analysis and Respective Companies’ Public Disclosures
Broader bioconjugates — from ADCs to XDCs
Ongoing research and development endeavors continually explore novel variations in payloads,
linkers, antibodies (or alternative carrier categories), and conjugation methods. These efforts have
generated a wide range of potential bioconjugates, providing diversified treatment options for various
therapeutic applications.
Bioconjugates are extending beyond ADC by first conjugating various payloads other than chemical
drugs with antibody, and then further to conjugate various carriers other than antibody with various
payloads (“ XDC”). The following chart illustrates transition from traditional ADCs to broader
bioconjugates and application expansion. It is worth noting, however, that the development of XDC
beyond ADC is still at a preliminary stage, facing uncertainties to progress from traditional ADCs to
broader bioconjugates and application expansion in terms of timing, market acceptance and likelihood of
obtaining approval.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 138 —


--- page 148 ---
Traditional ADC to XDC
mAb
Carrier Payload
BiologicsSmall moleculesBiologics
BsAb
scFV/Fab
Fusion Proteins
Peptides
Synthetic Polymer
Chemical drugs
Radioisotopes
Conjugation
Linker
Carrier / payload for ADC Innovative carrier / payload
Steroids
PROTAC
Biotin
PEG
Small proteins
TLRs
Peptides
Enzyme
Nucleotides
Indications Beyond Oncology
Oncology
Cardiovascular
Infectious
Neurodegenerative
Diabetes Diagnostics
Vaccines
......
Autoimmune
Orphan Diseases
Source: Literature Review, Frost & Sullivan Analysis
Beyond the traditional cytotoxins, more than seven different types of payloads with novel
mechanisms are currently being incorporated into ADC designs. Notably, radionuclide drug conjugates
(“RDC”), or radioligand therapy, utilize radioisotopes to emit therapeutic radiation, causing damage to
cells, while the target ligand selectively binds to specific markers on target cells. RDCs have demonstrated
notable advantages in targeting specificity across various indications and a number of RDCs have achieved
strong commercial performance. Novartis has made significant investments in RDC space, with two
approved therapeutic RDCs. Pluvicto was approved in 2022 and achieved sales of US$271 million in its
first year of launch. Novartis has invested over US$7 billion in RDCs since 2017, including the acquisition
of Advanced Accelerator Applications (“ AAA”) for Lutathera and NetSpot of US$3.9 billion and Endocyte
for Pluvicto of US$2.1 billion. In March 2023, Novartis further invested US$1.7 billion in Bicycle for
collaboration in novel RDC candidates, further emphasizing the significance of RDCs in the
pharmaceutical industry.
The IgG antibody stands as the most widely utilized antibody, although researchers are actively
working on reducing its size by eliminating the Fc segment. The advancement of bispecific antibody
technology has opened up new possibilities for innovation in ADCs. In addition to antibodies, alternative
molecules such as peptides, fusion proteins, and synthetic polymers are being investigated as potential
carriers. Peptide-drug conjugates (“ PDCs ”) have emerged as the next generation of targeted therapeutics
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 139 —


--- page 149 ---
following ADCs, offering enhanced cell permeability, improved efficacy and reduced off-target toxicity.
Compared with antibodies, peptides have the advantages of smaller molecular weight, which leads to
enhanced cell permeability and higher feasibility to synthesize and purify, resulting in lower production
cost of PDCs. As of June 30, 2023, there were three approved PDCs globally and over 10 PDCs in clinical
stage, including two in the Phase III stage. Lutathera, the peptide conjugated to a radioisotope developed
by Novartis, received FDA approval in 2018 and achieved sales of US$471 million in 2022.
PEGylated recombinant protein is also an active ingredient that is increasingly used in XDC.
PEGylation of recombinant protein allows for an increased stability of the bioconjugate drug and a
prolonged circulation time in the body, therefore potentially contributes to an enhanced overall efficacy.
With the continuous advancements in technology development, XDCs including PDC, RDC,
antibody-oligonucleotide conjugates (“ AOC”), antiviral Fc conjugates and nanoparticle conjugates, etc.
have seen increasing investment in global R&D activities. The following chart shows the global private
market financings for XDCs in addition to ADCs in recent years. The decrease in the global private market
financings for XDC (excluding ADC) as a percentage of total bioconjugates in 2021 was primarily due to
a significant increase in the financing for ADCs. The absolute amount of financings for XDC remained
relatively stable, and such a fluctuation in the private market financing for emerging modalities, such as
XDC, is not uncommon.
Global Private Market Financings for ADCs and XDCs Between 2018 and 2022
0.24
0.15
0.05
0.43 0.63 0.71
0.37 1.79
1.08
0.48
0.78
2018 2019 2020 2021 2022
2.02
9.7%
19.5%
34.5%
11.8%
25.5%
1.39
1.03
0.35
XDC (excluding ADC)
ADC
XDC (excluding ADC) as percentage of total bioconjugates
Billion USD
Source: Frost & Sullivan Analysis and Respective Companies’ Public Disclosures
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 140 —


--- page 150 ---
As conjugation technologies continue to advance, there is also a growing exploration of carriers
beyond mAb and payloads beyond small molecular drugs. These broader drug conjugates have the
potential to target various aspects of treatment of cancer as well as other therapeutic areas. This
diversification further enhances the market potential and contributes to the sustained growth of the
industry.
As of June 30, 2023, there are 135 XDC products (excluding ADCs) undergoing clinical trials
worldwide. Among them, 65 are in Phase II, while 56 are in Phase I and 14 are in Phase III, including 12
RDC candidates in Phase III, according to Frost & Sullivan. As of the same date, there are 98 RDC projects
and 17 PDC projects in clinical stage, as well as three FDA-approved therapeutic RDCs. A significant
number of XDC products in clinical development are focused on emerging targets, showcasing the
considerable potential of XDCs in offering expanded treatment options. It is anticipated that 17 XDCs
(excluding ADCs) will receive approval within the next five years, according to Frost & Sullivan.
Although we have witnessed ongoing research and development endeavors continually explore broader
bioconjugates, ADCs still form a substantial portion of the overall XDC market. There are very limited
number of XDCs (other than ADC) approved globally and no XDCs (other than ADC) approved in China,
according to Frost & Sullivan. As noted previously, over majority of XDC products (other than ADC) are
still in pre-clinical and clinical stages.
Major trends and growth driver of global ADC market
ADC technology has evolved significantly since the development of the first-generation ADCs. The
introduction of site-specific conjugation technology has contributed significantly to the third generation
of ADCs. This advancement has allowed the production of homogenous ADCs with well-defined DARs.
As a result, these ADCs exhibit the desired cytotoxicity and reduce off-target toxicity. Furthermore, the
use of fully humanized antibodies, as opposed to chimeric antibodies, in the third generation helps
mitigate immunogenicity concerns. This switch to fully humanized antibodies enhances the overall safety
and effectiveness of ADCs. Highly potent payloads are adopted in the third generation ADCs, which
further improve efficacy. Additionally, ADCs with homogenous DARs offer improved pharmacokinetics,
ensuring optimal drug delivery and distribution throughout the body.
The global ADC market will continue to advance driven by the following factors:
 Advances in ADC design and conjugation strategie s — Continued research in ADC
technology and cancer biology is anticipated to fuel the exploration of innovative targets,
payload molecules, linker designs, and conjugation strategies. This pursuit holds the potential
to develop new ADC designs that enhance therapeutic efficacy and address toxicity concerns
associated with existing ADCs available in the market.
 Expansion of applications and treatment lines — The progress in ADC technologies is
projected to lead to a wider array of potential targets and applications, extending beyond
oncology to include other therapeutic areas. It is anticipated that around 30 ADCs will receive
approval within the next five years globally, covering applications such as cancers,
autoimmune diseases, diabetes, cardiovascular diseases, and genetic diseases. ADCs are also
expected to enter earlier treatment lines and expand into the early stages of cancers.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 141 —


--- page 151 ---
 Combination with other treatment modalities — The mechanisms of action of ADCs have the
potential to synergize with other treatment modalities, resulting in enhanced tumor cell
eradication. Therefore, ADC is being actively studied in preclinical activities and clinical trials
in combination with other anticancer agents including chemotherapy, molecularly targeted
drugs, and immunotherapy in recent years. With the extensive efforts currently underway, it is
believed that the ADC-based combination therapy holds promising prospects in the future. For
example, the combination of ADC and immunotherapy has the potential to become the primary
approach in immunotherapy. Nearly half of the current combination therapies involving
immunotherapy and chemotherapy could be replaced by immunotherapy combined with ADC,
according to Frost & Sullivan.
Challenges in ADC Discovery and Development Process
The discovery, development and manufacturing of ADC require an interdisciplinary expertise in both
biologics and small molecule compounds, as well as a deep understanding of complex supply chain
management.
Key challenges in ADC discovery, development, and manufacturing process involve but not limited
to following and oftentimes are intertwined:
 Challenging ADC design and discovery conjugation scenarios — Achieving success in
discovering and generating stable antibodies and payload-linkers of high purity demands
interdisciplinary expertise. When venturing into conjugation discovery, it becomes crucial to
extensively explore different conjugation methods, especially when working with less stable
antibodies or highly hydrophobic payload-linkers. Additionally, a considerable level of
expertise is required to align specific desired profiles, such as the desired DAR and drug load
distribution. Furthermore, versatile analytical characterization methods are essential due to the
involvement of diverse molecule types in each study.
 Developability assessment for seamless transition to CMC — When considering novel
biologics as a modality, it becomes crucial to conduct a developability assessment to validate
the selection of a lead candidate for subsequent preclinical studies. Before progressing to the
CMC process, a substantial amount of time and resources may be required to verify the
conjugability and stability of the lead molecule through thorough physicochemical and
developability assessments.
 Complexity on conjugation process optimization and formulation development — Parameters
such as DAR and heterogeneity (drug load distribution) are key in the conjugation process
development, as they directly influence the stability and quality of the bioconjugates. The
formulation development process becomes intricate as it involves the formulation of both the
antibody intermediate and ADC drug substance and drug products. This necessitates the
adoption of complex analytical method development and product characterization, which often
requires double the effort compared to working solely with antibodies. Achieving proficiency
in process development, formulation development, and analytical method development
demands a high level of expertise. Ensuring process efficiency and consistency is also of
utmost importance in this context.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 142 —


--- page 152 ---
 Handling of high potent compounds — The requirement for specialized facilities, experienced
staff, and substantial investments in environmental health and safety (“ EHS”) compliance in
handling highly potent compounds during the development and manufacturing process result in
high outsourcing demand, because few companies possess these capabilities in-house.
 Complex supply chain management — To produce various components of ADCs and manage
the manufacturing of ADC drug substances and final drug products, multiple manufacturing
facilities for both biologics and small molecule drugs are typically required. The complexity
of the supply chain management requires in-depth execution expertise and all-rounded
facilities. The geographical proximity of these facilities becomes a significant distinguishing
factor, as it enables better quality assurance and cost efficiency by minimizing logistical
challenges.
 Multiple outsourcing service providers required and fragmented supplier network —
Considering all the challenges in each discovery and development steps of ADC development,
outsourcing has become a natural strategy for pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies.
Despite strong outsourcing demands, most outsourcing service providers are only capable of
handling specific segments of the process due to the interdisciplinary nature of antibody and
payload-linker discovery, complex transition to CMC and multiple facilities required for
development and manufacturing. Consequently, completing the full discovery and development
process usually entails engaging multiple outsourcing service providers, which resulted in long
development life cycle, potential delays and disruptions in the supply chain and potential loss
of accountability when transitioning between outsourcing service providers.
For a typical ADC project, antibody, payload-linker, conjugation process development and
formulation are moving forward in parallel, and highly dependent on each other. As ADCs are complex
molecules, which require clean room biologic and high containment cytotoxic facilities for safe handling,
most companies may find it challenging and even economically unviable to manage every aspect of the
entire ADC development process. Hence, outsourcing has emerged as a preferred business strategy in this
domain.
OVERVIEW OF GLOBAL ADC AND BROADER BIOCONJUGATES OUTSOURCING SERVICES
MARKET
Overview of key process and value chain of ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services
market
ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services cover every stage of the ADC and broader
bioconjugates development process, starting from discovery and extending to commercial manufacturing.
The intricate and highly technical nature of ADC and broader bioconjugates development has led the
majority of pharmaceutical and biotech companies to rely on outsourcing partners for ADC and broader
bioconjugates development.
 Discovery — The process of ADC discovery, leading to the identification of a preclinical ADC
drug candidate with desired properties, involves six crucial steps. These steps encompass: (1)
target selection, (2) discovery of antibody intermediate for bioconjugate, (3) payload-linker
discovery chemistry, (4) conjugation discovery, (5) physicochemical characterization and
developability discovery, (6) in vitro and in vivo bio-function activity studies.
 Development — During the development phase, various activities are undertaken to optimize
ADC’s production to ensure manufacturing consistency and successful scale-up. This includes
optimizing the antibody expression conditions and purification processes, conducting payload-
linker medicinal chemistry analysis and optimization, developing the payload-linker synthesis
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 143 —


--- page 153 ---
process, optimizing the conjugation process, formulating and developing the drug product
(“DP”), non-GMP manufacturing, conducting IND-enabling toxicity studies, preparing the
CMC dossier, and providing regulatory support until the drug candidate receives approval from
regulatory authorities.
Due to the complex nature of the development process and the stringent quality control
requirements, it is uncommon to switch outsourcing service providers after this stage, if the
chosen outsourcing service provider offers a comprehensive range of services spanning
development and manufacturing.
 Manufacturing — Manufacturing services encompass the production of all components
necessary for ADCs, including manufacturing antibody intermediates specifically tailored for
ADCs. This also entails manufacturing payload-linkers, ADC drug substances, and ADC drug
products in various scales and forms to meet the clinical and commercialization needs of
customers, which needs to comply with requirements of FDA, the NMPA, the EMA and other
regulatory agencies.
According to Frost & Sullivan, the global outsourcing rate for ADC and broader bioconjugates
discovery, development and manufacturing has reached approximately 70%, surpassing the 34%
outsourcing rate observed for overall biologics by the end of 2022.
It is noteworthy that out of the 15 globally approved ADC drugs, 13 have been manufactured by
outsourcing service providers, with the majority of them being outsourced to multiple outsourcing service
providers. The following table illustrates an overview of global approved ADC outsourcing
manufacturing:
Approved ADC Globally and Outsourcing Status
Drug Name Company Outsourcing
Status
Whether Outsourced to
Multiple Suppliers
N –PfizerMylotarg
YYSeagen/TakedaAdcetris
Y YRocheKadcyla
N –PfizerBesponsa
Y YAstraZenecaLumoxiti
Y NRochePolivy
Y YSeagen/AstellasPadcev
YYDaiichi Sankyo/
AstraZenecaEnhertu
Y YGileadTrodelvy
Y YGlaxoSmithKlineBlenrep
Y NARakuten MedicalAkalux
YYADC TherapeuticsZynlonta
Y NARemeGenDisitamab
vedotin
Y NGenmab/SeagenTivdak
Y NAImmunoGen/
Huadong MedicineElahere
Source: Frost & Sullivan Analysis, European Medicines Agency (“EMA”)
Note: “NA” means information not publicly available.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 144 —


--- page 154 ---
Global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market
The global market for ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services reached a value of
US$1.5 billion in 2022, exhibiting a CAGR of 34.5% between 2018 and 2022. This growth outpaced the
overall biologics outsourcing services market, which had a CAGR of 21.8% during the same period. It is
expected that the global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market will expand
significantly to reach US$11.0 billion by 2030, with a CAGR of 28.4% from 2022 to 2030.
The following chart sets forth global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market
size between 2018 and 2030.
Global ADC and Broader Bioconjugates Outsourcing Services Market Size
Between 2018 and 2030E*
2018 2019 2020 2021 2023E 2024E 2025E 2026E 2027E 2028E 2029E 2030E2022
Billion USD
0.5 0.6 0.8 1.1
2.0
2.6
3.5
4.6
5.9
7.5
9.2
11.0
1.5
2018-2022 34.5%
28.4%2022-2030E
Period CAGR
Source: Frost & Sullivan Analysis and Company Annual Reports
Note: “Global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market” refers to the global outsourcing research, development
and manufacturing services market for both ADC and broader bioconjugates.
/H11569In general, the global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market size is derived from a bottom-up approach
by studying the historical and current related revenues of the top players in the market, which contributed the substantial
majority of current market size. The future market size is primarily forecasted by estimating each top player’s work order
growth rate, per project pricing growth rate and revenue growth rate during the forecast period. The following key
assumptions are used for the purpose of global ADC and other bioconjugates outsourcing services market size estimation:
(a) The current top players in the market will continue to lead the market during the forecast period;
(b) It is estimated that the number of new preclinical and clinical stage ADC and broader bioconjugate pipelines in a given
year will grow at 30% to 50% annually during the forecast period;
(c) It is estimated that the outsourcing rate for ADC and broader bioconjugates market will be approximately 70% to 80%
during the forecast period;
(d) It typically takes approximately one to three years, three to five years and five to eight years, respectively, to advance
a Phase III-, Phase II- and Phase I-staged ADC and broader bioconjugate candidates, respectively, to market approval
stage;
(e) In addition, factors such as the industry interests in ADC and broader bioconjugates, the funding momentum, as well
as research and development activities were also taken into account.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 145 —


--- page 155 ---
Competitive landscape of Global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market
The global market for ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services exhibits a relatively
concentrated landscape, with the top 5 and top 10 players collectively holding a market share of 50.0%
and 74.3% in 2022 in terms of revenue, respectively.
In terms of revenue in 2022, our Company ranked the second in the global ADC and broader
bioconjugates outsourcing service market with a market share of approximately 9.8%, according to Frost
& Sullivan. The largest player has approximately 21.4% market share measured by revenue in 2022. The
following pie chart shows the market shares of top players in the global ADC and broader bioconjugates
outsourcing service market in terms of revenue in 2022:
Global Competitive Landscape (by Revenue) in 2022
21.4%
9.8%
7.2%
6.0%
5.2%5.0%
4.9%
4.7%
4.5%
5.6%
25.7%
Company A Our Company Company B Company C
Company D Company G Company H Company I
Company J Company K Others
Source: Frost & Sullivan Analysis and Company Annual Reports
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 146 —


--- page 156 ---
The following table sets forth further details of top ten players in the global ADC and broader
bioconjugates outsourcing service market in terms of revenue in 2022.
Certain Details of Top 10 Global ADC and Broader Bioconjugates Outsourcing Service Players
Company A
Company B
Tuas (Singapore) /
Slough (UK)
Visp
(Switzerland)
Visp
(Switzerland) 21.4%
Company
mAb
Revenue,
million USD
Payload-Linker Conjugation
319.0
Shanghai (China),
Wuxi (China)
Changzhou (China)
(Wuxi (China) under
construction, to commence
operation by 2023)
Wuxi (China) 9.8%146.0
Geographical presence
Market
share
Martillac (France) Madison, Wisconsin (US) St. Louis, Missouri (US) 7.2%107.5
Company C N/A France France 6.0%89.5
Company D Worcester (US) Ireland,
Chicago (US)
Chicago (US),
Worcester (US) 5.6%83.0
Company G Latina (Italy) Latina (Italy) Latina (Italy) 78.0 5.2%
Company H Wisconsin (US) N/A California (US) 75.0 5.0%
Company I N/A India and US Grangemouth (UK) 72.3 4.9%
Company J Teesside (UK)/
North Carolina (USA) N/A N/A 70.0 4.7%
Company K* N/A N/A N/A 67.3 4.5%
Notes:
1. All services performed by our Company are conducted in facilities located within 1-2 hours of driving distance.
2. Company A is a multinational CDMO company that offers development and manufacturing services for fine chemicals,
advanced intermediates, active pharmaceutical ingredients (“ APIs ”), biologics and functional ingredients. Company A is a
public company with decades of operations and headquartered in Switzerland.
3. Company B is the life science business unit of a global science and technology company. It has CDMO expertise in the
development and manufacturing of highly potent APIs, linkers and monoclonal antibodies for both clinical and commercial
use. The parent company of Company B is a public company with decades of operations and is headquartered in Germany.
Company B is a private company established less than ten years ago and headquartered in the United States.
4. Company C is a multinational company specialized in the development and upscaling of complex API production processes,
as well as in the production of small molecule APIs for generic industry. Company C was a private company formed recently
and headquartered in Germany.
5. Company D is a multinational biopharmaceutical company with a business unit focusing on CDMO services. Its capabilities
includes development and manufacture of biologics and small molecule APIs as well as drug product services. Company D
is a public company established ten years ago and headquartered in the United States.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 147 —


--- page 157 ---
6. Company G is a CDMO service provider focusing on the development and manufacturing of oncology drugs with high potency
and cytotoxic characteristics for the pharmaceuticals industry. Company G is a private company with decades of operations
and headquartered in Italy.
7. Company H is a CDMO service provider with expertise in development sciences, delivery technologies, and multi-modality
manufacturing for the pharmaceutical industry. Company H is a public company with decades of operations and headquartered
in the United States.
8. Company I is a multinational CDMO service provider offering services including drug discovery solutions, process &
pharmaceutical development services, clinical trial supplies, commercial supply of APIs, and finished dosage forms. Company
I is a public company with decades of operations and headquartered in India.
9. Company J is a CDMO service provider providing process development and cGMP production in cell culture, microbial
fermentation and gene therapies for pharmaceutical companies. Company J is a private company formed more than ten years
ago and headquartered in the United States. The parent company of Company J is a public company.
10. *Company K only provides drug product services for ADC products. Company K is a global CDMO service provider
providing scientific expertise, sterile contract manufacturing solutions, parenteral delivery systems, and customized support
services for pharmaceutical companies. Company K is a public company with more than ninety years of operations and
headquartered in the United States.
Source: Frost & Sullivan Analysis; Respective Companies’ Public Filings/Disclosures
The following table sets forth further details of top three players in the China ADC and broader
bioconjugates outsourcing service market in terms of revenue in 2022.
Certain Details of Top 3 China ADC and Broader Bioconjugates Outsourcing Service Players
Company E
Company
R
Full spectrum of ADC
production facilities
located within
1-2 hours drivingD M
YY YY
ADC dedicated Process
N Y YY 1
Company F N Y YY 2
Revenue,
million RMB
69.5%982.6
Market share
in China
8.3%117.8
2.3%32.1
Notes:
1. ADC production facilities locate in Y antai, China.
2. ADC production facilities locate in Suzhou, China. R: Research; D: Development, M: Manufacture.
3. Company E is a China-based company that provides CDMO services primarily for biologics including antibodies and
antibody-drug conjugates. Company E is a private company established ten years ago and headquartered in China.
4. Company F is a China-based biopharmaceutical company that is dedicated to developing and commercializing oncology
drugs. It also provides innovative drug CDMO services for pharmaceuticals. Company F is a public company with more than
a decade of operations and headquartered in China.
Source: Companies’ Official Websites and Disclosures, Annual Reports, Frost & Sullivan Analysis
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 148 —


--- page 158 ---
In addition, our Company stands out as the sole global player offering dedicated full-spectrum
capabilities throughout the entire discovery, development, and manufacturing process of ADCs. The
following table sets forth a comprehensive comparison of capabilities of top global ADC and broader
bioconjugates outsourcing service players as of June 30, 2023.
Comparison of Capabilities of Top Global ADC and Broader Bioconjugates Outsourcing Service
Players
mAb Payload-linker Conjugation DP
(Drug product) RD M
√√√
√√√
√√√
√√
√√√ √
√
√
√√ √
√√
√√
√√
√√
Yes
No
No
No
No
Company A
Company B
Company C
Company D
Company Capabilities ADC Dedicated Process
Full spectrum of ADC
production facilities located
within 1-2 hours driving
Company G Yes
Company H No
Company I No
Company J No
Company K No
√√√√ √ √
√√ √ √ √
√√√ √ √ √
√√ √ √
√√ √
Source: Frost & Sullivan Analysis; Respective Companies’ Public Filings/Disclosures
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 149 —


--- page 159 ---
Following the global trend of high demand of ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services,
China ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market will continue its upward trajectory,
reaching an estimated value of RMB$16.5 billion by 2030, with a CAGR of 35.9% from 2022 to 2030.
Our Company holds the No.1 position in China’s ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services
market in both revenue and the number of integrated projects for ADCs and other bioconjugates in 2022.
Our Company’s market leading position is highlighted by a significant market share of approximately
69.5% by revenue for 2022 in the China market.
It is likely that as the ADC industry continues to grow, CRDMO companies currently providing
payloads/payload-linkers components or antibody components for ADC would expand their capabilities to
provide full spectrum ADC CRDMO services and compete with the Company. However, as discussed in
greater detail below, new players looking to tap into the full-spectrum ADC and broader bioconjugates
outsourcing services market would need to overcome the entry barriers and accumulate interdisciplinary
know-how and capabilities that span across biologics, small molecules and conjugations. It takes great
efforts for biologics focused outsourcing service providers to master chemical drugs capabilities and
expertise for payload-linkers, and vise versa. In addition, with years of cultivation of client relationship
and collaboration, market leading players such as our Company have established a solid and royal client
base. Accordingly, CRDMO companies currently focusing on providing only payload-linkers components
or antibody components for ADC would need to re-establish their credentials and expertises to persuade
the client to change their services provider.
Key success factors in the ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market
The following factors present key success factors that contribute to the dynamic and competitive
ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market.
 Research, development and manufacturing expertise across modalities — The development
of ADCs requires interdisciplinary capabilities and expertise in both biologics and small
molecules, which requires seamless coordination among different steps of development. To
advance an ADC project from DNA synthesis to IND, the industry timeline typically ranges
from 24 to 30 months involving different outsourcing service providers. Companies with
integrated comprehensive capabilities dedicated for ADC development enjoy unparalleled
advantages by saving time and costs while ensuring superior quality control.
 Facilities with integrated capabilities — As ADC and broader bioconjugates development and
manufacturing requires specialized facilities for different components and conjugation process,
suppliers with integrated capabilities in both biologics and small molecules, across the supply
chain from discovery to manufacturing are key in ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing
services. Companies operating facilities with integrated capabilities can effectively reduce
logistical challenges, shorten ADC production time with assured quality and reduced cost. In
addition, as a matter of practice, there is a trend of domestic regulations that strongly favor
centralized manufacturing of biologics drugs, such as the Several Policies and Measures for
Promoting the High-quality Development of Wuxi Biomedical Industrial Park (ආೌ፼
݄Xi Zheng Ban Fa [2022] No.29) issued by the
office of Wuxi Municipal People’s Government on March 6, 2022.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 150 —


--- page 160 ---
 Comprehensive technical capabilities and capacity to support diversified needs — Players
with integrated and comprehensive technology toolbox, characterized by extensive experience
in a myriad of bioconjugates and their components, conjugation technologies, as well as
scale-up capabilities can effectively deliver quality results efficiently for the discovery and
development process. Moreover, world-class laboratories and GMP manufacturing facilities are
necessary to handle highly toxic compounds safely, including but not limited to the facilities
designed to handle Occupational Exposure Band 5 (“ OEB 5 ”) substances, ranging from
milligrams to kilograms.
 Highly regulated process requiring proven quality track record — The strict and complex
quality assurance standards mandated by regulatory bodies, coupled with the protracted
approval process, have elevated barriers to entry for new entrants in the market. Customers,
especially global leading pharmaceutical companies, would prefer to partner with outsourcing
players that possess GMP quality track records and advanced quality control systems. Only the
most exceptional players are able to achieve a proven track record in meeting customer
specifications and applicable regulatory standards, and as a result to secure long-term contracts
with existing clients and attract new ones.
The R&D of ADCs requires extensive biological, chemical and manufacturing know-how and
capabilities that span across biologics, small molecules and bioprocessing. The increasing development
and manufacturing needs for ADCs are expected to demand more outsourcing services from ADC
CRDMOs with fully integrated comprehensive capabilities that enable the rapid advancement of ADC
candidates. Our Company stands out as a global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing service
provider with full-spectrum capabilities, encompassing discovery, development, and manufacturing, as
well as facilities conveniently located within a 1-2 hour driving distance.
Market trends and growth drivers of ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market
With the rise in R&D investments of the global ADC market, the demand for outsourcing services
for ADC and other bioconjugates development will continue to grow. Outsourcing service providers with
integrated comprehensive capabilities that are able to accelerate development timelines and ensure high
quality for clients have rapidly gained market share in the past three years and are expected to continue
to lead the outsourcing services market growth. As ADC-focused biotech companies in China continue to
seek global partners, they are expected to partner with leading CRDMOs with stringent quality standard
and global reputation. Capacities are expected to increase globally for discovery, development, and
manufacturing of ADC and other bioconjugate drugs.
The following is a summary of the key growth drivers that are expected to further contribute to the
global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market.
 Continuous innovation and increasing R&D spending in ADC and broader bioconjugates —
The continuous innovation in conjugation technology and ADC drug development is expected
to further drive the high demand for outsourcing services. Other than ADC, broader
bioconjugate drugs with novel carriers and payload-linkers targeting expanding therapeutic
areas require continuous support from outsourcing service providers, especially those with
integrated comprehensive service capabilities that can provide efficient and reliable solutions.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 151 —


--- page 161 ---
 Increasing demand for efficient supply chain management — The complicated discovery,
development and manufacturing process requires interdisciplinary expertise in both biologics
and small molecule compounds. The ability to efficiently manage the complex supply chain to
ensure smooth transition between steps with assured quality is increasingly important for
pharmaceutical companies. Outsourcing service providers with strong capabilities in supply
chain management, especially those with strategically located facilities within geographical
proximity, are expected to benefit from the increasing demand.
 Continuous technology improvement — As the industry evolves and expands from ADCs to
broader bioconjugates, outsourcing service providers with innovative technologies focused on
developing conjugation technology for novel linkers, new carriers and payloads would be in
increasing demand. Leading players with cutting-edge technologies and proprietary
conjugation platforms can provide customers with various choices in the fast-growing
bioconjugates development process, which is critical for biopharmaceutical companies in its
discovery and development process.
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW
— 152 —


--- page 162 ---
OVERVIEW
Our history can be traced back to 2013 when the WXB Group recognized the opportunities
associated with ADCs and the ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market, and
commenced the ADC CRDMO business internally within its BCD business unit for the research,
development and manufacturing of ADCs. The ADC CRDMO business was established and remained as
an internal business unit within the WXB Group under its BCD business unit as the ADC market in China
was still at its early stages. In 2018, with the take-off of the ADC drug market, the WXB Group established
a separate and dedicated ADC facility in Wuxi to meet to the customers’ growing interests in ADC
development.
Our Company was incorporated in December 2020 in the Cayman Islands and is the holding
company of our Group. For further details of the incorporation and shareholding change of our Company,
please see “— Corporate Development and Reorganization” in this section below. We are a leading
CRDMO which provides fully integrated one-stop CRDMO services including discovery, process
development and GMP manufacturing for bioconjugates, monoclonal antibody intermediates and
payload-linkers associated with bioconjugates.
The Listing constitutes a spin-off of our Group from WuXi Biologics under Practice Note 15 to the
Listing Rules. The proposal in relation to the Spin-off was submitted by WuXi Biologics to the Stock
Exchange for approval pursuant to Practice Note 15 to the Listing Rules and the Stock Exchange has
confirmed that WuXi Biologics may proceed with the Spin-off. WuXi Biologics and our Company will
comply with the requirements of the Listing Rules and respective articles of associations regarding the
Preferential Offering and Spin-off as and when necessary. For further details of the Spin-off, please see
“— Spin-off of our Group from WuXi Biologics” in this section below.
KEY BUSINESS MILESTONES
The following is a summary of our key business development milestones in our corporate and
business development:
Y ear Event
2013 ........... W e signed the first ADC CMC contract and commenced the ADC CRDMO
business internally within the WXB Group’s BCD business unit
2016 ........... W e completed our first NMPA IND filing for our customer
2018 ........... W e established a separate and dedicated ADC facility, DP3, in Wuxi, the PRC
February 2019 .... W e established our proprietary WuXiDAR4 technology platform, further
enriching our portfolio of conjugation technologies
April 2019 ...... W e commenced partnership with our first EU customer, NBE-Therapeutics, a
Swiss biotech company subsequently acquired by Boehringer Ingelheim, on the
development and manufacturing of NBE-Therapeutics’ first ADC product
demonstrating our strong R&D capability and service quality
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 153 —


--- page 163 ---
Y ear Event
August 2019 ..... O u rA D C facility, DP3, in Wuxi, the PRC, commenced GMP manufacturing
February 2020 .... W e obtained the drug manufacturing license from the NMPA
December 2020 . . . Our Company was incorporated in the Cayman Islands
April 2021 ...... W e were presented with the “Bioprocessing Excellence in Antibody and ADC
Therapeutics Manufacturing in the Greater China Region” award by the IMAPAC
May 2021 ....... W e entered into equity subscription agreement with WuXi Biologics and STA
Pharmaceutical in relation to subscription of our Shares, upon completion of
which we were owned as to 60% by WuXi Biologics and 40% by STA
Pharmaceutical, respectively
July 2021 ....... W e entered into agreements for the transfers of BCD business unit and XDC
Wuxi and the acquisition of the Payload & Linker Business to strengthen our
capabilities
August 2022 ..... O u r Shanghai facilities began operations, greatly improving our discovery and
PD capacities
October 2022 .... W e received the runner up prize in the “Best Contract Manufacturing Provider”
category at the 2022 World ADC Awards
November 2022. . . We established XDC Singapore, an important step in the implementation of our
“global dual sourcing” strategy and to build a manufacturing base in Singapore
September 2023 . . Our new ADC facility in Wuxi formally commenced operations, strengthening
our in-house discovery and development capabilities and manufacturing capacity
October 2023 .... W ew o nt h e “Best Contract Development Manufacturing Organization (CDMO)”
prize at the 2023 World ADC Awards
OUR SHAREHOLDERS
WuXi Biologics
As of the Latest Practicable Date, our Company was held directly by WuXi Biologics as to 60%.
WuXi Biologics is an exempted company incorporated with limited liability in the Cayman Islands, and
its shares have been listed on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange since June 2017 (HKEx stock code:
2269).
The WXB Group is a leading global fully-integrated biologics contract research, development and
manufacturing organization, which combines the business models of a contract research organization and
a contract development and manufacturing organization to provide one-stop end-to-end biologics services.
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 154 —


--- page 164 ---
The WXB Group’s CRDMO platform enables its clients and partners from early as the discovery and
pre-clinical stages of product development by establishing a strong position in terms of program design,
to advancing promising programs into the early and late stages of clinical development and ultimately to
commercial manufacturing.
WuXi AppTec
As of the Latest Practicable Date, our Company is held indirectly by WuXi AppTec as to 40%. WuXi
AppTec is a joint stock company with limited liability incorporated in the PRC, and its A shares have been
listed on the Shanghai Stock Exchange since May 2018 (SSE stock code: 603259) and its H shares have
been listed on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange since December 2018 (HKEx stock code: 2359).
As a global company with operations across Asia, Europe, and North America, the WXA T Group
provides a broad portfolio of R&D and manufacturing services that enable the global pharmaceutical and
healthcare industry to advance discoveries and deliver groundbreaking treatments to patients. Through its
unique business models, the WXA T Group’s integrated, end-to-end services include chemistry drug
CRDMO, biology discovery, preclinical testing and clinical research services, cell and gene therapies
CTDMO, helping customers improve the productivity of advancing healthcare products through
cost-effective and efficient solutions.
Relationship with and among our Shareholders
Prior to the respective listings of WuXi Biologics and WuXi AppTec on the Stock Exchange and/or
the Shanghai Stock Exchange (in the case of WuXi AppTec), the businesses of WXB Group and the WXA T
Group were part of the business of WuXi PharmaTech (Cayman) Inc. WuXi PharmaTech (Cayman) Inc.
was co-founded by Dr. Ge Li, other founding individuals and certain other Independent Third Parties, and
is a Cayman Islands-incorporated company which was listed on the New Y ork Stock Exchange and
subsequently delisted on December 10, 2015.
Upon Listing, our Company will remain a consolidated subsidiary of WuXi Biologics, and an
associate of WuXi AppTec, both of which will continue to be our Controlling Shareholders. To the best
of our Company’s knowledge, as of June 30, 2023, Dr. Ge Li, through Biologics Holdings, and other
founding individuals collectively control approximately 13.75% of the total voting rights in WuXi
Biologics; on the other hand, Dr. Ge Li and other founding individuals collectively control approximately
21.04% of the total voting rights of WuXi AppTec as of June 30, 2023. For more details of the relationships
of WuXi Biologics, WuXi AppTec and our Group, please see the section headed “Relationship with our
Controlling Shareholders”.
CORPORATE DEVELOPMENT AND REORGANIZATION
1. Incorporation of our Company
Our Company was incorporated in the Cayman Islands as an exempted company with limited
liability on December 14, 2020. The authorized share capital of our Company was US$50,000 divided into
50,000 ordinary Shares with a par value of US$1.00 each. Upon incorporation, one Share was allotted and
issued to an independent third party at US$1.00 and on the same day, the one Share was transferred to
WuXi Biologics at US$1.00.
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 155 —


--- page 165 ---
2. Capital Contribution and First Allotment of Shares
On May 13, 2021, our Company entered into an equity subscription agreement with WuXi Biologics
and STA Pharmaceutical, an indirect non-wholly-owned subsidiary of WuXi AppTec, pursuant to which,
WuXi Biologics and STA Pharmaceutical agreed to subscribe for 60% and 40% shareholding interest in
our Company and make capital contributions (the “ Capital Contribution ”) of US$120 million and US$80
million, respectively, to our Company.
On June 4, 2021, our Company, after repurchase of one ordinary share from WuXi Biologics at par
value, issued and allotted three new ordinary shares to WuXi Biologics and two new ordinary shares to
STA Pharmaceutical, following which our Company has been owned by WuXi Biologics and STA
Pharmaceutical as to 60% and 40%, respectively.
3. Shares Subdivision, Second Allotment of Shares and Interim Restructuring Steps
On September 13, 2021, our Company subdivided each ordinary share of a par value of US$1.00 per
share to 20,000 ordinary shares of a par value of US$0.00005 per share. The authorized share capital of
our Company was changed to US$50,000 divided into 1,000,000,000 ordinary shares of a par value of
US$0.00005 each. On September 29, 2021, additional 599,940,000 Shares and 399,960,000 Shares were
issued and allotted at par to WuXi Biologics and STA Pharmaceutical, respectively. After the subdivision
and the second allotment of shares, WuXi Biologics and STA Pharmaceutical continued to hold
600,000,000 and 400,000,000 Shares, representing 60% and 40% shareholding interest in our Company,
respectively.
To enable STA Pharmaceutical to complete the requisite overseas direct investment procedures in
connection with the Capital Contribution (the “ ODI Procedures ”), our Company cancelled and forfeited
the 400,000,000 Shares held by STA Pharmaceutical on January 28, 2022, and re-issued the 400,000,000
Shares to STA Pharmaceutical on June 8, 2022 after the ODI Procedures and the Capital Contribution by
STA Pharmaceutical were duly completed (the “ Interim Period ”). Notwithstanding that there was not any
written agreement entered or general meeting held during the Interim Period, WuXi Biologics and STA
Pharmaceutical had agreed by way of oral agreement before the Interim Period (which was later
documented in writing after the Interim Period) that the above interim restructuring steps were merely a
procedural necessity conducted solely for the purpose of enabling STA Pharmaceutical to complete the
ODI Procedures required for making the Capital Contribution and did not alter STA Pharmaceutical’s
entitlement to 40% of the beneficial ownership and voting power in our Company during the Interim
Period. As confirmed by our Company’s legal advisors, there is no prohibition or restriction under the laws
of the Cayman Islands against WuXi Biologics and STA Pharmaceutical in respect of the entering into of
the oral agreement and the arrangement contemplated thereunder, and such agreement, which created and
bestowed upon STA Pharmaceutical 40% of the voting power in our Company during the Interim Period,
is a valid and legally binding agreement between WuXi Biologics and STA Pharmaceutical. Further,
nothing has come to the attention of the Joint Sponsors to disagree with the above view of our Company’s
legal advisors. As a result, STA Pharmaceutical had continued to be fully recognized as a 40% beneficial
shareholder of our Company with the right to appoint two out of five members of the Board under the
articles of association of our Company, and the two Directors appointed by STA Pharmaceutical had
remained in office throughout the Interim Period.
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 156 —


--- page 166 ---
4. Establishment of Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes
Our Company adopted the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme in November 2021 and March 2023, respectively, to grant share options to eligible participants
as incentives or rewards for their contribution to our Group so as to recruit and retain high-caliber
employees and attract human resources that are valuable to our Group. For details and principal terms of
the two schemes, please refer to “Statutory and General Information — E. Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes”
in Appendix IV to this prospectus.
5. Increase of Authorized Share Capital
On June 30, 2023, in anticipation of the Global Offering, our Company increased our authorized
Share capital from US$50,000 divided into 1,000,000,000 ordinary Shares of a par value of US$0.00005
each to US$500,000 divided into 10,000,000,000 ordinary Shares of a par value of US$0.00005 each.
OUR SUBSIDIARIES
Set forth below are certain details of our subsidiaries:
Entity
Date and place of
incorporation
Authorized
share capital/
registered capital
Issued/
Paid up capital
Equity interest
attributable to
our Group Principal activities
XDC Hong Kong . . June 7, 2021,
Hong Kong
HK$1 HK$1 100% Investment holding
X D C W u x i ...... March 13, 2018,
PRC
US$200,000,000 US$162,500,000 100% Manufacturing of
ADC drug
substances and
ADC drug
products
XDC Shanghai . . . March 31, 2021,
PRC
RMB30,000,000 RMB30,000,000 100% Research and
process
development of
ADC and process
development and
manufacturing of
antibodies
XDC Changzhou . . July 2, 2021, PRC RMB300,000,000 RMB300,000,000 100% Discovery, process
development and
manufacturing of
payload-linkers
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 157 —


--- page 167 ---
Entity
Date and place of
incorporation
Authorized
share capital/
registered capital
Issued/
Paid up capital
Equity interest
attributable to
our Group Principal activities
XDC Singapore . . . November 16, 2022,
Singapore
US$5,000,000 US$5,000,000 100% Discovery and
development of
drug substances
and drug projects
upon the
commencement of
its facility in
Singapore in 2026
XDC Hong Kong
XDC Hong Kong was incorporated under the laws of Hong Kong with limited liability on June 7,
2021 and is directly wholly-owned by our Company. XDC Hong Kong is primarily engaged in investment
holding.
XDC Wuxi
XDC Wuxi was established in the PRC with limited liability on March 13, 2018 with a registered
share capital of USD200 million and is directly wholly-owned by XDC Hong Kong. XDC Wuxi is
primarily engaged in the manufacturing of ADC drug substances and ADC drug products.
XDC Shanghai
XDC Shanghai was established in the PRC with limited liability on March 31, 2021 with a registered
share capital of RMB30 million and is directly wholly-owned by XDC Wuxi, a wholly-owned subsidiary
of our Company. XDC Shanghai is primarily engaged in the research and process development of ADC
and process development and manufacturing of antibodies.
XDC Changzhou
XDC Changzhou was established in the PRC with limited liability on July 2, 2021 with a registered
share capital of RMB300 million and is directly wholly-owned by XDC Wuxi, a wholly-owned subsidiary
of our Company. XDC Changzhou is primarily engaged in the discovery, process development and
manufacturing of payload-linkers.
XDC Singapore
XDC Singapore was established under the laws of Singapore with limited liability on November 16,
2022 and is directly wholly-owned by XDC Hong Kong, a directly wholly-owned subsidiary of our
Company. XDC Singapore will primarily engage in the discovery and development of drug substances and
drug projects upon the commencement of its facility in Singapore by 2026.
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 158 —


--- page 168 ---
MAJOR ACQUISITION AND TRANSFERS DURING THE TRACK RECORD PERIOD
Transfer of XDC Wuxi
On July 5, 2021, XDC Hong Kong and Biologics Investment entered into an equity transfer
agreement, pursuant to which XDC Hong Kong was transferred the entire shareholding interest in XDC
Wuxi by Biologics Investment at a total consideration of RMB404.41 million. The consideration was
determined with reference to the valuation of all the issued share capital of XDC Wuxi using the income
approach and the market approach, and was settled on April 21, 2022. As XDC Wuxi was considered to
be under the common control of our Group and the Remaining WXB Group since the beginning of the
Track Record Period, the items under the financial statements in relation to XDC Wuxi have been
combined into the consolidated financial statements of our Group. As such, the transfer was accounted for
as a business combination under common control.
Acquisition of the Payload & Linker Business
On July 20, 2021, XDC Changzhou entered into an asset transfer agreement with STA Changzhou,
pursuant to which, XDC Changzhou had acquired the Payload & Linker Business (which include the
customer resources, personnel and assets relating to such business) of STA Pharmaceutical at a total
consideration of RMB280 million, which was determined with reference to the valuation of the Payload
& Linker Business as of December 31, 2020 using the income approach. STA Changzhou is a
wholly-owned subsidiary of STA Pharmaceutical, being a controlling shareholder of our Company, and the
consideration was determined (i) with reference to an asset valuation report prepared by an independent
professional valuer, and (ii) based on arm’s length negotiation between our Group and STA Changzhou.
The transaction was subsequently settled in April 2022.
As part of the acquisition, STA Changzhou transferred to us assets including lab and office
equipment as well as other items essential for the operation of the Payload & Linker Business, such as
computers, furniture and various lab and office apparatus. Furthermore, we have acquired from STA
Changzhou the technical know-how of payload-linker synthesis, using chemical substances and inhibitors
such as MMAE and Exatecan mesylate as payloads, and drug-linkers conjugates such as vcMMAE and
McMMAF as payload-linkers. During the process of transfer, all core personnel of the Payload & Linker
Business, being approximately 50 employees, including technicians and operators of the payload-linker
laboratory brought with them know-how of the Payload & Linker Business (including the technical
know-how on the handling and utilization of chemicals as mentioned above), have terminated their
employment relationship with STA Changzhou and entered into new employment agreements with us.
Such technical know-how, being intangible in nature, was recognized as goodwill of the Payload & Linker
Business under the relevant accounting standards applied. We have also been transferred certain trade
secrets (such as the clients/partners’ project specifications) and documents relating to the Payload &
Linker Business, including customers’ contracts and information, internal reports on operational and
customer practices and information on procurement, among others. We are satisfied that such transfer
together with our leasing of the Changzhou facility from STA Changzhou allow us to have independent
and sufficient and non-GMP payload-linker manufacturing, development and synthesis capabilities, which
will be further supplemented and expanded by our new ADC facility in Wuxi which has commenced
operation in September 2023.
For the financial information on the acquisition of the Payload & Linker Business of our Group,
please refer to note 36 in Appendix I to this prospectus.
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 159 —


--- page 169 ---
Transfer of the BCD business unit
On July 20, 2021, XDC Shanghai entered into an asset transfer agreement with Biologics (Shanghai),
pursuant to which, XDC Shanghai was transferred the BCD business unit of the Remaining WXB Group
by Biologics (Shanghai) at a total consideration of approximately RMB15.59 million. The assets under the
asset transfer agreement have been in use by the BCD business unit in its laboratory in Shanghai and the
legal rights were transferred from Biologics (Shanghai) to XDC Shanghai. The consideration was
determined (i) with reference to an asset valuation report prepared by an independent professional valuer
using the income approach and the market approach, (ii) the valuation of the relevant assets of the BCD
business unit of the Remaining WXB Group using the cost approach; and (iii) based on arm’s length
negotiation between our Group and Biologics (Shanghai). As of September 30, 2023 approximately
RMB5.69 million of the consideration remained outstanding and is expected to be settled before the
Listing. Biologics (Shanghai) is a wholly-owned subsidiary of WuXi Biologics, being a controlling
shareholder of our Company. As the BCD business unit was considered to be under the common control
of our Group and the Remaining WXB Group since the beginning of the Track Record Period, the items
under the financial statements in relation to the BCD business unit have been combined into the
consolidated financial statements of our Group. As such, the transfer was accounted for as a business
combination under common control.
The transfers of XDC Wuxi and the BCD business unit and the acquisition of the Payload & Linker
Business allowed our Group to provide “one-stop” services to better satisfy the growing demand of global
customers for research and development and manufacturing services related to such new drug molecules
and also simplify the CMC process and supply chain management of ADC from development to
commercialization and thus, shorten the drug launching process of our business partners so as to help
patients earlier.
Save as disclosed above, we have not conducted any other acquisitions, disposals, transfers or
mergers that we consider to be material to us since our incorporation and during the Track Record Period.
SPIN-OFF OF OUR GROUP FROM WUXI BIOLOGICS
Our Group has experienced tremendous financial growth throughout the Track Record Period and it
is expected that the strong growth momentum would continue and be appealing to an investor base that
focuses on high growth opportunities in the ADC CRDMO business, supported by exponential growth in
the ADC drug market. In addition, our Group has already established itself as a CRDMO globally
dedicated to providing integrated and comprehensive services for ADCs and other bioconjugates, the
development and manufacturing processes for which proven to be challenging with high entry barriers.
The Listing constitutes a spin-off of our Group from WuXi Biologics under Practice Note 15 to the Listing
Rules. The proposal in relation to the Spin-off was submitted by WuXi Biologics to the Stock Exchange
for approval pursuant to Practice Note 15 to the Listing Rules and the Stock Exchange has confirmed that
WuXi Biologics may proceed with the Spin-off. WuXi Biologics and our Company will comply with the
requirements under Practice Note 15 to the Listing Rules and the applicable requirements of the Listing
Rules regarding the Spin-Off.
Practice Note 15 requires WuXi Biologics to have due regard to the interests of its existing
shareholders by providing them with an assured entitlement to the Shares, either by way of a distribution
in specie of existing Shares or by way of a preferred application in the offering of existing or new Shares
(the “ Assured Entitlement ”). Practice Note 15 provides that the respective minority shareholders of
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 160 —


--- page 170 ---
WuXi Biologics may by resolution in general meeting resolve to waive the Assured Entitlement. WuXi
Biologics will provide the Assured Entitlement to the Qualifying WXB Shareholders by way of the
Preferential Offering. For further details of the Preferential Offering, please see “Structure of the Global
Offering”.
In view of this, our Directors are of the view that the Spin-off, if proceeds, is in the interests of our
Group, WuXi Biologics and its shareholders as a whole and the Spin-off will position each of the
Remaining WXB Group and our Group better for growth in their respective businesses and deliver clear
benefits to both for the following reasons:
 the Spin-Off will allow WuXi Biologics and its shareholders an opportunity to realize the value
of investment in our Group under a separate standalone platform for ADC CRDMO business,
and will improve the operational and financial transparency of each of the WXB Group and our
Group, which will enable the market to appraise and assess the value and performance of our
Group more effectively, and will in turn unlock the value of both our Group and the WXB
Group;
 the Remaining WXB Group and our Group will operate in different business scope and intend
to have different growth paths and different business strategies without being in competition
against each other. The Spin-off will enable our Group to build its identity as a separately listed
group with the following benefits:
(i) A more defined business focus and corporate profile. A more defined and streamlined
business will enhance our Company’s profile amongst client and partners, increase our
ability to attract strategic investors interested in the ADC CRDMO business and
potentially forming strategic partnerships directly with our Group;
(ii) A separate fund-raising platform. The Spin-off would allow our Group to gain direct
access to capital markets for equity and/or debt financing to fund its existing operations
and future expansion without reliance on the WXB Group, thereby improving its
operating and financial management efficiencies, and also allowing the WXB Group to
optimize its capital allocation; and
(iii) To broaden its investor base through the Global Offering.
 leveraging in the attraction of having a standalone listing platform, the Spin-off will
increase the brand awareness of “WuXi” and in turn benefit the businesses of our
Group and the WXB Group;
 the Spin-off will enable more focused development, strategic planning and better
allocation of resources for our Group and the Remaining WXB Group with respect
to their respective businesses. Both our Group and the Remaining WXB Group will
benefit from the efficient decision-making process under the separate management
structures geared towards their respective needs for seizing business opportunities,
especially with a proven and dedicate management team for our Group to focus on
its development, which will improve its ability to attract and motivate talents;
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 161 —


--- page 171 ---
 the Spin-off will lead to a more direct alignment of its management’s
responsibilities and accountability with its operating and financial performance.
This is expected to result in enhanced management focus, which should in turn lead
to improved decision-making process, faster response time to market changes and
increased operational efficiency. The management of our Company will be under
heightened scrutiny from the investor community and it will be possible to measure
their performance against the stock price performance of our Company going
forward. It will also be possible to link management incentives to such performance,
thereby increasing management motivation and commitment;
 the Spin-off will provide clarity of the credit profile of our Group for rating
agencies and financial institutions that wish to analyze and lend against the credit
of the ADC CRDMO business; and
 as our Company is expected to remain as a subsidiary of WuXi Biologics upon
completion of the Spin-off and the Global offering, the WXB Group will continue
to benefit from any potential upside in the business of our Group through the
consolidation of our Group’s accounts and receipt of dividend income from our
Group.
The Spin-off by WuXi Biologics complies with the requirements of Practice Note 15 of the Listing
Rules. The Spin-off is not subject to shareholder’s approval of WuXi Biologics.
PUBLIC FLOAT REQUIREMENTS
Upon completion of the Global Offering (assuming that Over-allotment Option is not exercised), the
Shares held our Controlling Shareholders will not be counted towards public float. We have applied to the
Stock Exchange to request the Stock Exchange to exercise its discretion under Rule 8.08(1)(d) of the
Listing Rules, and the Stock Exchange has granted our Company a waiver from strict compliance with the
requirements of Rule 8.08(1)(a) of the Listing Rules. For details, please see “Waivers and Exemption from
Strict Compliance with the Listing Rules and the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions)
Ordinance — Waiver in Relation to Public Float Requirements.”
REGULATIONS ON OVERSEAS LISTING
On February 17, 2023, the China Securities Regulatory Commission (the “ CSRC ”) released the Trial
Administrative Measures of Overseas Securities Offering and Listing by Domestic Companies ( ྤʫΆุ
جand five supporting guidelines (together, the “ Trial Measures ”),
which came into effect on March 31, 2023. Pursuant to the Trial Measures, domestic companies that seek
to list overseas, both directly and indirectly, should fulfill the filing procedure and report relevant
information to the CSRC. Specifically, following the principle of substance over form, if an issuer meets
both of the following criteria, its overseas offering and listing will be deemed as an indirect overseas
offering and listing by a domestic enterprise: (1) any of the total assets, net assets, revenues or profits of
the domestic operating entities of the issuer in the most recent accounting year accounts for more than 50%
of the corresponding figure in the issuer’s audited consolidated financial statements for the same period;
and (2) its major operational activities are carried out in China or its main places of business are located
in China, or a majority of the senior management in charge of operation and management of the issuer are
Chinese citizens or are domiciled in China. The filing is required to be conducted within three business
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 162 —


--- page 172 ---
days after the submission of the application for initial public offering and listing overseas to the overseas
regulators. Our PRC Legal Advisor is of the view that this Listing shall be deemed as an indirect overseas
offering and listing by PRC domestic enterprise, and we are required to submit filings with the CSRC
within three business days after we submit application for this Listing. On October 19, 2023, the CSRC
issued a notification on our completion of the PRC filing procedures for the listing of our Shares on the
Stock Exchange and the Global Offering. As advised by our PRC Legal Advisor, no other approvals from
the CSRC are required to be obtained for the listing of our Shares on the Stock Exchange. We will continue
to seek guidance from the relevant regulator and/or legal advisors to ensure our compliance in all respects.
For details, please see “Regulatory Overview — Regulations on Overseas Listing” in this prospectus.
M&A RULES
Under the M&A Rules issued on August 8, 2006, effective as of September 8, 2006 and amended in
June 2009, a foreign investor is required to obtain necessary approvals when it:
(a) acquires the equity of a domestic non-foreign invested enterprise thereby converting the
domestic enterprise into a foreign-invested enterprise;
(b) subscribes for the increased capital of a domestic non-foreign invested enterprise so as to
convert the domestic enterprise into a foreign-invested enterprise;
(c) establishes a foreign-invested enterprise which purchases and operates the assets of a domestic
enterprise; or
(d) purchases the assets of a domestic enterprise and injects those assets to establish a foreign
invested enterprise.
Our PRC Legal Advisor has advised that, given that (i) the CSRC currently has not issued any
definitive rule or interpretation concerning whether the Global Offering and Spin-off of our Company is
subject to this regulation and (ii) our wholly-owned PRC subsidiaries were acquired when they were
foreign-invested enterprises or established by foreign-invested enterprises (as the case may be), rather than
through a merger or acquisition of a domestic company as defined under the M&A Rules, they advise that
the establishment and acquisition of our wholly-owned subsidiaries and the reorganization are not subject
to the M&A Rules, and the Global Offering and Spin-off of our Company does not require approvals from
the CSRC and MOFCOM under the M&A Rules. However, the interpretation and enforcement of the M&A
Rules and other PRC laws and regulations are constantly evolving and are subject to the discretion and
judgment of the administrative and judicial authorities implementing and enforcing such laws and
regulations on a case-by-case basis and we cannot assure you that relevant PRC governmental authorities,
including the CSRC and MOFCOM, would reach the same conclusion as our PRC Legal Advisor. For
further information about the risks associated with the CSRC approval, please see “Risk Factors — Risks
Relating to Conducting Business in China and Other Jurisdictions Where We Operate — Our potential
growth through acquisitions in China is subject to the procedures established under China’s M&A rules,
laws and certain other PRC regulations, which could make it more difficult for us to complete such
acquisitions” in this prospectus.
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 163 —


--- page 173 ---
SAFE REGISTRATION IN THE PRC
Pursuant to the SAFE Circular on Relevant Issues Concerning Foreign Exchange Administration of
Overseas Investment and Financing and Round-trip Investments Conducted by Domestic Residents
through Special Purpose V ehicles (೻ҳ
ٝ“() SAFE Circular 37 ”), promulgated by SAFE and became effective on July
4, 2014, (a) a PRC resident must register with the local SAFE branch before he or she contributes assets
or equity interests in an overseas special purpose vehicle (the “ Overseas SPV ”) that is directly established
or indirectly controlled by the PRC resident for the purpose of conducting investment or financing, and
(b) following the initial registration, the PRC resident is also required to register with the local SAFE
branch for any major change in respect of the Overseas SPV , including, among other things, a change of
Overseas SPV’s PRC resident individual shareholder(s), the name of the Overseas SPV , terms of operation,
or any increase or reduction of the Overseas SPV’s capital, share transfer or swap by PRC residents, and
merger or division. Pursuant to SAFE Circular 37, failure to comply with these registration procedures
may result in penalties.
Pursuant to the SAFE Circular on Further Simplification and Improvement in Foreign Exchange
Administration Policies on Direct Investment (ટҳ༟̮ි၍ଣ
ٝ“() SAFE Circular 13 ”), which became effective on June 1, 2015 and amended on
December 30, 2019, the power to accept SAFE registration was delegated from local SAFE to local banks
where the assets or interest in the domestic entity was located.
As advised by our PRC Legal Advisor, the Spin-off, which refers to the separate listing of the Shares
on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange, does not trigger foreign exchange registrations of PRC
individual shareholders of our Company pursuant to SAFE Circular 37, since the Spin-off does not include
new offshore investment and financing and roundtrip investments by such PRC individual shareholders,
being the activities regulated by SAFE in accordance with SAFE Circular 37. Further, as advised by our
PRC Legal Advisor, SAFE Circular 37 is also not applicable to STA Pharmaceutical in respect of its
subscription of Shares in our Company, as registrations under SAFE Circular 37 are only applicable to
PRC residents in connection with their direct or indirect investment in the overseas special purpose
vehicles that are directly established or indirectly controlled by such PRC residents with their legally
owned domestic or offshore assets or interests. Instead, STA, as the shareholder of STA Pharmaceutical,
is required under applicable PRC laws to comply with, and it has complied with, the requisite overseas
direct investment procedures, including the registration and filing procedures with the Ministry of
Commerce of the PRC and the National Development and Reform Commission of the PRC and/or their
respective local counterparts.
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 164 —


--- page 174 ---
OUR SHAREHOLDING AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
Immediately after reorganization and as at the date of this prospectus
The following diagram illustrates our shareholding and corporate structure immediately after the
reorganization and as at the date of this prospectus:
WuXi Biologics(1) WuXi AppTec(3)
STA Pharmaceutical(2)
Our Company
XDC Hong Kong
XDC Shanghai
XDC Wuxi
XDC Changzhou(4)
XDC Singapore
60% 40%
100%
100% 100%
100%100%
98.56%
------ Denotes indirect shareholding
(1) WuXi Biologics is a company listed on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange (stock code: 2269), and to the best of our
Company’s knowledge, as of June 30, 2023, its largest shareholder is Biologics Holdings as to 13.75% shareholding interest.
To the best of our Company’s knowledge, Dr. Ge Li, through Biologics Holdings, and the other founding individuals, are
deemed to be interested in the shares held by Biologics Holdings in WuXi Biologics, representing approximately 13.75% of
the shareholding interest in WuXi Biologics.
(2) STA Pharmaceutical is directly wholly-owned by STA, which is in turn held as to 98.56% by WuXi AppTec (Shanghai) and
WuXi AppTec (Shanghai) is directly wholly-owned by WuXi AppTec.
(3) WuXi AppTec is a company whose A shares are listed on the Shanghai Stock Exchange (stock code: 603259) and H shares
are listed on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange (stock code: 2359). To the best of our Company’s knowledge, as of June
30, 2023, Dr. Ge Li and the other founding individuals collectively control approximately 21.04% of the total voting rights
of WuXi AppTec.
(4) The business of XDC Changzhou is from the acquisition of the Payload & Linker Business. For details, please see “— Major
acquisition and transfers during the Track Record Period — Acquisition of the Payload & Linker Business” and Note 36 to
Appendix I of this prospectus for the audited financials of the Payload & Linker Business during the Track Record Period.
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 165 —


--- page 175 ---
Immediately Upon the Spin-off and Global Offering
The following diagram illustrates our shareholding and corporate structure immediately upon the
completion of the Spin-off and Global Offering (assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised and
without taking into account any exercise of the share options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option
Schemes):
WuXi Biologics(1) WuXi AppTec(3) Public Shareholders
STA Pharmaceutical(2)
Our Company
XDC Hong Kong
XDC Shanghai
XDC Wuxi
XDC Changzhou(4)
XDC Singapore
50.91% 33.94% 15.14%
100%
100% 100%
100%100%
98.56%
------ Denotes indirect shareholding
Please refer to the notes underneath the corporate and shareholding structure chart of our Group
under “Immediately after reorganization and as at the date of this prospectus” above.
HISTORY, REORGANIZATION AND CORPORATE STRUCTURE
— 166 —


--- page 176 ---
OVERVIEW
We are a leading CRDMO focused on the global ADC and broader bioconjugate market and
dedicated to providing integrated and comprehensive services. We are the second largest CRDMO for
ADCs and other bioconjugates globally in terms of revenue in 2022, according to Frost & Sullivan.
Leveraging expertise in both biologics and small molecules, we offer interdisciplinary and comprehensive
services, covering bioconjugate discovery, research, development and manufacturing. We provide these
services from proximately located and dedicated laboratories and manufacturing facilities, leading to
potentially significant reduction of development timeline and costs. As a fully integrated one-stop
bioconjugate discovery, development and manufacturing platform, our mission is to continuously enhance
our platform, propel and transform the development of the bioconjugate industry, enable global
biopharmaceutical partners and benefit patients worldwide.
Our Market Opportunities
ADCs and other bioconjugate drugs constitute a separate modality distinct from small molecules or
biologics. Taking ADCs as an example, they consist of a biologic component (the antibody), which is
covalently attached, also referred to as conjugated, to a cytotoxic small molecule drug (the payload) via
a chemical linker. ADCs are therefore designed to combine the target selectivity of antibodies and the
cell-killing potency of highly cytotoxic small molecule drugs. This combinatorial design potentially
reduces off-target toxicity of classic chemotherapy while enhancing the efficacy, thereby leading to an
improved efficacy and therapeutic window, which is the dose range of a drug that provides safe and
effective therapy. Recently, several ADCs have shown favorable efficacy for various cancers and quickly
gained market share. The global sales of ADC drugs reached approximately US$7.9 billion in 2022,
representing an over 40% CAGR since 2018. With constant advancement in conjugation technologies and
expanding bioconjugate component library, bioconjugates are being developed for therapeutic areas in
addition to oncology, including autoimmune diseases, infectious diseases, metabolic disorders and beyond.
Riding on the recent trend of transformative advancements in drug design and conjugation
technologies, the ADC and bioconjugate drug market is at a growth inflection point. According to Frost
& Sullivan, the global ADC drug market size is anticipated to grow to US$64.7 billion in 2030 from
US$7.9 billion in 2022 at a CAGR of 30.0%. The expected growth of the global ADC drug market is
considerably faster than that of the global biologics drug market (excluding bioconjugates), which is
expected to grow at a CAGR of 9.2% during the same period. As of June 30, 2023, 15 ADC drugs have
been approved globally, of which 11 have been approved since 2018 and four have been approved since
2021. There has also been a promising pipeline of ADC drugs. As of June 30, 2023, 231 ADC drug
candidates around the globe had been advanced to the clinical stage, with 134, 79 and 18 under phase I,
II and III clinical trials, respectively, and globally 57 ADC drug candidates entered clinical trials in 2022,
according to Frost & Sullivan. It is worth noting that bioconjugates are extending beyond ADC by first
conjugating various payloads other than chemical drugs with antibody, and then further to conjugate
various carriers other than antibody with various payloads (“ XDC”). The development of XDC beyond
ADC, however, is still at a preliminary stage, facing uncertainties to progress from traditional ADCs to
broader bioconjugates and application expansion in terms of timing, market acceptance and likelihood of
obtaining approval.
BUSINESS
— 167 —


--- page 177 ---
The potential of ADCs and other bioconjugate drugs is also evidenced by high-profile acquisition
and licensing activities in the space. According to Frost & Sullivan, there have been over 100 deals
involving ADCs since 2022, including the recently announced acquisition of Seagen Inc., a leading
biotechnology company specializing in the development of ADCs for cancer treatment, by Pfizer Inc. for
a total of approximately US$43 billion. China biotechnology companies have been at the forefront of ADC
out-licensing arrangements, according to Frost & Sullivan. Since 2022 and as of June 30, 2023, there had
been 10 China pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies that reached 14 ADC out-licensing deals with
overseas partners, totaling US$22.0 billion, according to the same source. Of these 10 China companies,
eight are our customers.
The development of ADCs and other bioconjugates requires a suite of interdisciplinary capabilities
in both biologics and small molecules that are beyond the reach of most biopharmaceutical companies.
Therefore, the outsourcing rate of bioconjugate development reached around 70%, which is much higher
than the 34% outsourcing rate for other biologics. Furthermore, the logistic difficulties in transporting
different bioconjugate components, the stringent requirements for safe manufacturing and handling of
cytotoxics, as well as the increasing demand for shortened development timelines, present significant
challenges for a vast majority of outsourcing service providers in the space. We believe these challenges
are best addressed with an comprehensive CRDMO with integrated service capabilities and geographically
proximate facilities like us.
Our Capabilities
Our fully integrated, one-stop bioconjugate platform offers comprehensive CRDMO services,
including discovery, process development and GMP manufacturing for bioconjugates, monoclonal
antibody intermediates and payload-linkers associated with bioconjugates.
Our integrated discovery service involves protein carrier generation, payload-linker synthesis,
conjugation research, in vitro and in vivo studies, among others. The seamless integration among protein
sciences, small molecule and conjugation fields, as well as in vitro , in vivo efficacy and safety evaluation
expertise, make our services unique in the field and allow us to propel the overall bioconjugate discovery
and development for our customers and deliver PCCs within as short as 8-10 months from candidate
nomination.
Supported by our extensive toolbox of technical capabilities, honed over years of experience working
with a variety of bioconjugates and their components, our platform boasts a rich portfolio of conjugation
technologies, extensive expertise in payload-linker synthesis and process development, industry-leading
process development know-how, comprehensive analytical methods, as well as dedicated and specialized
facilities. We have accumulated vast hands-on experience in bioconjugates, generating over 7,000
bioconjugate molecules for our customers incorporating over 500 protein carriers and over 600
payload-linkers. We have completed CMC development and initiated GMP manufacturing using over 10
conjugation technologies for both ADC and other bioconjugates, making our portfolio of conjugation
technologies one of the richest among bioconjugate outsourcing service providers, according to Frost &
Sullivan. Our patented WuXiDAR4 technologies enable customers to achieve tight control of product
homogeneity and lot-to-lot consistency, which in turn improve the pharmacokinetics profile and stability
of bioconjugate products and potentially result in better clinical outcomes. Our conjugation expertise goes
beyond ADC and encompasses RDC, PDC, ACC, PEGylated protein or peptide, antibody PROTAC
conjugate, AOC and fatty-acid conjugate, among others.
BUSINESS
— 168 —


--- page 178 ---
We have also built extensive expertise in payload-linkers, which are critical components of
bioconjugates. We not only have developed a rich library of off-the-shelf payload-linkers, but also enable
our customers to develop and manufacture a wide variety of tailor-made or proprietary payload-linkers by
offering synthesis, process development and GMP manufacturing services.
Our integrated capabilities are also reflected in the one-stop GMP manufacturing of bioconjugates.
We strategically offer our services from proximately located operation sites in Wuxi, Shanghai and
Changzhou in China, where we have established dedicated and specialized facilities for bioconjugates. As
such, we can better manage the supply chain and coordinate development and manufacturing operations,
leading to potentially expedited development timelines and improved quality and cost efficiencies for
customers. For example, in general, we are able to significantly reduce the standard industry timeline from
the antibody DNA sequence to bioconjugate IND filing to approximately 13 to 15 months. Our fully
integrated capabilities lay a solid foundation for our comprehensive service offerings that enable our
customers to bring innovative bioconjugate therapeutic solutions to patients worldwide with high quality
and speed. At the forefront of the global bioconjugate development, we believe our platform will also
enable us to address the industry challenges and lead the global development trends of ADCs and other
bioconjugates. As an industry recognition of our capabilities, we won the runner-up prize in the “Best
Contract Manufacturing (CMO) Provider” category of the 2022 World ADC Awards and the “Best Contract
Development Manufacturing Organization (CDMO)” prize at the 2023 World ADC Awards.
Our Achievements
We ranked No. 2 globally and No. 1 in China among CRDMO for ADCs and other bioconjugates in
terms of revenue in 2022, according to Frost & Sullivan. Our global market share by revenue increased
from 1.8% in 2020 to 4.6% in 2021 and 9.8% in 2022. By the end of 2022, we had 94 ongoing integrated
projects, representing over 35% of the total number of outsourced integrated projects for bioconjugates
globally in the same year, according to Frost & Sullivan. With our extensive technical capabilities and
impeccable track record, we have become a trusted partner leading the bioconjugate development globally
with a broad, loyal and fast-growing customer base. We employ an “enable, follow and win the molecule”
strategy to not only grow with our existing customers by providing services from an early stage of their
product development cycle, but also win new customers as their bioconjugates progress. As of the end of
2020, 2021, 2022 and June 30, 2023, as the result of our “enable” strategy, we had cumulatively progressed
9, 12, 24 and 30 ADC candidates, respectively, from discovery to CMC development. As the result of our
“win the molecule” strategy, among the 110 ongoing integrated projects we had as of June 30, 2023, 36
were transferred to us from our customers or their outsourcing service providers. Our diverse and growing
customer base includes both innovative biotechnology companies and global pharmaceutical companies,
many of which are leading players in the ADC and bioconjugate space with potentially first-in-class or
best-in-class pipeline programs. The number of our customers grew significantly from 49 in 2020 to 115
in 2021, 167 in 2022 and 169 in the six months ended June 30, 2023. As of June 30, 2023, we had served
304 customers cumulatively, including most of the major players in the global ADC and bioconjugate
market. As of the same date, we had won ADC development contracts for all ADC candidates in China
with dual filing of IND and/or BLA in China and the United States, and eight out of the 10 China-based
companies that out-licensed their ADC pipelines overseas since 2022 are our customers.
BUSINESS
— 169 —


--- page 179 ---
We have a large number of integrated projects for ADCs and other bioconjugates. As of June 30,
2023, we had 110 ongoing integrated projects and helped customers to submit IND applications for 47
ADC candidates globally, and in 2022 alone, we helped customers submit IND applications for 18 ADC
candidates globally. We have executed 350 discovery projects since our inception and as of June 30, 2023.
The following funnel diagram sets forth the developmental stages and other details of ongoing integrated
projects as of June 30, 2023. The duration and contract value of discovery projects can vary significantly
due to their nature.
1 – 2 years
3 – 5 years
US$8 – 11 million
US$40 – 70 million
Number of ongoing projects Typical range of
duration
Typical range of
contract value
1 – 3 years US$6 – 9 million
350 Discovery1
67 Preclinical
27 Phase I
11 Phase II
5 Phase III
“R”
“D”
“M”
Commercial
(BLA expected
in 2023)2
2 – 4 years US$8 – 15 million
Type of projects
ADC and
broader XDC
ADC and
broader XDC
ADC and
broader XDC
ADC
1. It is the cumulative number of discovery projects since our inception and as of June 30, 2023.
2. We have completed process validation, which is a critical step before the BLA submission, for two integrated projects.
We attribute our success to our visionary team of seasoned senior management supported by a pool
of talented scientists. We are led by Dr. Jincai Li, our chief executive officer, who is supported by members
of our senior management team, all of whom have extensive experience and diverse expertise in the
pharmaceutical industry both domestically and internationally. We also benefit from a strong shareholder
support from the WXB Group and the WXA T Group. Our heritage brings us with a strong trust from
industry participants in our field-tested capabilities and world-class quality.
Our Financial Performance and Path Forward
We experienced robust growth in our revenue during the Track Record Period. For the years ended
December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, our revenue amounted to
RMB96.4 million, RMB311.1 million, RMB990.4 million and RMB993.5 million, respectively. We
recorded net profit of RMB26.3 million, RMB54.9 million, RMB155.7 million and RMB177.2 million for
the same periods, respectively. Our adjusted net profit (non-IFRS measure) amounted to RMB32.8 million,
RMB77.1 million, RMB194.4 million and RMB216.4 million in the same periods, respectively. See
“Financial Information — Non-IFRS Measures.” Our backlog amounted to US$318.0 million as of
December 31, 2022 and US$410.6 million as of June 30, 2023. The aggregate amount of the transaction
price allocated to performance obligations* that are unsatisfied (or partially unsatisfied) were nil,
RMB475 million and RMB1,495 million, and RMB2,958 million as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and
* Performance obligation is a promise in a contract with our customers to transfer our services to them.
BUSINESS
— 170 —


--- page 180 ---
2022, and June 30, 2023, respectively. Our management expects the majority of the transaction price
allocated to the unsatisfied contracts as of each of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023
will be recognized as revenue within five years from the such date. As of June 30, 2023, we had 67
ongoing preclinical bioconjugate projects and 43 ongoing post-IND bioconjugate projects. As pre-IND
projects advance into the post-IND stage and post-IND projects progress across clinical and commercial
stage, the typical range of project contract values is also expected to increase, providing a robust revenue
growth momentum and visibility.
Going forward, we look to capitalize on the opportunities and solidify our leading position in the
global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market. We plan to continue expanding our
capability beyond ADCs, strengthen our in-house discovery and development capabilities and
manufacturing capacity, deepen our relationship with existing customers and attract new customers, as
well as continue to invest in cutting-edge technologies. We strive to continuously enhance our fully
integrated one-stop bioconjugate platform and become a partner of choice for global industry participants
seeking to develop and manufacture bioconjugate therapeutics.
OUR STRENGTHS
Uniquely positioned to capture the growth in the global ADC and broader bioconjugate market
We are a CRDMO dedicated to providing integrated and comprehensive services for ADCs and other
bioconjugates, and therefore uniquely positioned to capture opportunities in the fast-growing global ADC
and broader bioconjugate market.
The ADC and broader bioconjugate drug market is at a growth inflection point. As of June 30, 2023,
15 ADC drugs have been approved globally, of which 11 have been approved since 2018 and four have
been approved since 2021. According to Frost & Sullivan, the global ADC drug market size reached
approximately US$7.9 billion in 2022, representing an over 40% CAGR since 2018, and is anticipated to
continue to grow rapidly to US$64.7 billion in 2030, representing a CAGR of 30% from 2022 to 2030.
The in-depth interdisciplinary expertise required in developing a bioconjugate leads to the high
outsourcing rate
* of approximately 70% for the ADC development, which is significantly higher than the
approximate 34% outsourcing rate for other biologics in 2022, according to Frost & Sullivan. Furthermore,
the collection of capabilities required for the research, development and manufacturing of bioconjugates
are lacking in most outsourcing service providers in this space. Therefore, a single ADC is typically
outsourced to multiple different outsourcing service providers to handle different development and
manufacturing steps. As of June 30, 2023, 13 out of the 15 approved ADC drugs have been developed and
manufactured using outsourcing service providers, with the majority of them being outsourced to multiple
outsourcing service providers. However, such a fragmented and extensive outsourcing service provider
network for the highly regulated products is prone to multiple disadvantages, such as complexities in the
communication and coordination of logistics, testing and quality control, potential delays and disruptions
in the supply chain, potential loss of accountability during handover of projects from one outsourcing
service provider to another, as well as a long overall development and manufacturing cycle.
* According to Frost & Sullivan, the outsourcing rate is calculated by dividing the size of the relevant outsourcing services
market of a modality by the total outsourceable research, development and manufacturing expenses on that modality.
BUSINESS
— 171 —


--- page 181 ---
We believe a fully integrated one-stop bioconjugate research, development and manufacturing
platform like ours is the precise solution to these industry challenges. Our platform ensures that the
different teams involved in a bioconjugate project collaborate seamlessly to achieve an industry-leading
development speed while eliminating potential loss of accountability resulting from multiple service
providers.
We were an early player in the space and have been offering specialized CRDMO services for ADCs
and other bioconjugates since 2013. Over the years, we have built a strong reputation in the industry,
accumulated deep know-how that enabled hundreds of customers through delivery of quality, tailored and
innovative solutions, and won a growing and loyal global customer base. We believe these advantages
serve as important entry barriers and will further solidify our leadership position in the global
bioconjugate outsourcing services industry and empower us to further propel the development of the
global bioconjugate industry.
Leading global CRDMO dedicated to ADCs and other bioconjugates with fully integrated, one-stop
service capabilities
We are a leading player in the global ADC and bioconjugate outsourcing services market. We ranked
No. 2 globally and No. 1 in China among CRDMO for ADCs and other bioconjugates in terms of revenue
in 2022, according to Frost & Sullivan. We have a large number of discovery projects and integrated
projects for ADCs and other bioconjugates. Integrated projects constitute a critical component of our
business because a customer typically commits to us once an integrated project is initiated, which we
believe translates to significant customer stickiness and naturally embodies our “enable, follow and win
the molecule” strategy. By the end of 2022, we had 94 ongoing integrated projects, which represented over
35% of the total number of outsourced integrated projects for bioconjugates globally in the same year,
according to Frost & Sullivan.
We have established a fully integrated one-stop research, development and manufacturing platform
dedicated to ADCs and other bioconjugates. Supported by world-class capabilities in small molecule
compounds, large molecule moieties and conjugation technologies, our comprehensive service offerings
span each critical step of bioconjugate development and manufacturing, including discovery, process
development and GMP manufacturing for bioconjugates, monoclonal antibody intermediates and
payload-linkers associated with bioconjugates. According to Frost & Sullivan, we are one of the very few
CRDMOs worldwide, if not the only one, in possession of such extensive service capabilities.
Our fully integrated service offering platform, single-source solution and extensive experience
enable us to conduct multiple steps in parallel and run iterations seamlessly to improve the overall
productivity and efficiency. We assume the full project management responsibility for the projects, which
ensure the service quality and speed of delivery. In addition, these services are delivered from proximately
located operation sites within a 200-kilometer radius in Shanghai, Changzhou and Wuxi in China, making
us globally the only CRDMO dedicated to ADCs and other bioconjugates that provides full-spectrum
services from proximately located facilities, according to Frost & Sullivan. With these strategically
located operation sites, we are able to better coordinate development and manufacturing operations,
manage the supply chain and ensure seamless technology transfer and quality assurance as compared to
a typical fragmented third-party service network with services provided from geographically dispersed
locations. As such, we expedite development timelines and enhance quality and cost efficiencies for our
customers. For instance, in general, we are able to drastically reduce the traditional ADC development
period to an average of 13 to 15 months from the antibody DNA sequence to bioconjugate IND filing, a
BUSINESS
— 172 —


--- page 182 ---
significantly shorter timeline relative to the industry average of 24-30 months. We also reduce the typical
GMP production cycle of an ADC product, including manufacturing of the monoclonal antibody
intermediate for bioconjugate, payload-linker, ADC drug substance and ADC drug product, of
approximately one and half years to a few months. In addition to the expedited timeline, we operate our
business with a field-tested quality control and assurance system to ensure that we consistently deliver our
comprehensive, fully integrated services in top quality.
Industry-leading technical capabilities and integrated capacity
Our fully integrated, one-stop bioconjugate platform offers comprehensive CRDMO services,
including discovery, process development and GMP manufacturing for bioconjugates, monoclonal
antibody intermediates and payload-linkers associated with bioconjugates. It boasts a rich portfolio of
conjugation technologies, extensive expertise in payload-linker synthesis and process development,
industry-leading process development know-how, comprehensive analytical methods, as well as dedicated
and specialized facilities. In particular, we seamlessly integrate the multidisciplinary expertise in both
biologics and small molecules critical to comprehensive discovery, development and manufacturing of
ADCs and other bioconjugates. As of June 30, 2023, we have generated over 7,000 bioconjugate molecules
for customers incorporating over 500 protein carriers and over 600 payload-linkers.
Rich Portfolio of Conjugation Technologies. We have invested heavily in our technology platform,
mastering over 10 conjugation technologies, making our portfolio of conjugation technologies one of the
richest among bioconjugate outsourcing service providers, according to Frost & Sullivan. Our platform not
only contains our in-house developed conjugation technologies but also provides access to a variety of
technologies through our expanding collaborations with third-party partners, including GeneQuantum
Healthcare and SyntaBio. This equips us to handle challenging discovery scenarios, fulfill unmet needs in
the payload-linker development and deliver bioconjugates with desired properties for our customers. For
example, our in-house developed, patented WuXiDAR4 conjugation technologies achieves tight control of
product homogeneity and lot-to-lot consistency, which in turn improve the pharmacokinetics profile and
stability of bioconjugate products and potentially results in better clinical outcomes.
Extensive Expertise in Payload-linker Synthesis and Process Development. With our decade-long
experience and specially designed laboratory to safely handle highly potent compounds, we provide
synthesis and process development services for customer-specific payload-linkers, including many with
challenging chemical synthesis processes. We have also generated a growing library of off-the-shelf
payload-linkers. Many of the ready-made payload-linkers have drug master files (“ DMFs ”) filed with the
FDA, which helps to effectively shorten development lead time and expedite regulatory submission of
bioconjugates incorporating them. In addition, we provide customers with access to a large variety of
proprietary payload-linkers through our growing collaboration with partners.
Industry-leading Process Development Know-how. We have developed specialized know-how and
unique insights in process development, including scale-up processes, for various types of bioconjugates.
Our process development expertise ensures optimization of critical quality attributes, including drug load
ratio (DAR), free drug removal, process efficiency and consistency. As a demonstration of our capabilities,
we have initiated GMP manufacturing of bioconjugates involving several conjugation technologies,
including non-natural amino acid (“ NNAA ”) site-specific conjugation, tyrosine tubulin ligase-assisted
conjugation, sortase-assisted conjugation, farnesyltransferase-assisted conjugation, and traceless affinity
peptide labeling conjugation. We also initiated GMP manufacturing using our patented WuXiDAR4
technologies.
BUSINESS
— 173 —


--- page 183 ---
Comprehensive Analytical Methods. Our strong in-house expertise in method development across a
full array of analytics also sets us apart from other outsourcing service providers. These capabilities
support precise characterization, identification and potency assessment of intermediates and final products
along the entire bioconjugate development and manufacturing process. These assessments shed critical
light on the conjugation process and the quality of the resulting bioconjugates. For instance, our analytical
panel allows us to perform in-process testing for immediate analysis and speedy in-process control testing
of critical parameters, such as protein concentration, DAR, residual content (including free drug) and
endotoxin level. In addition, we enable customers to evaluate the conjugatability and developability of the
bioconjugates to determine the most suitable lead candidate for further development.
Dedicated and Specialized Facilities. Our dedicated facilities enable manufacturing of ADCs and
other bioconjugates at different scales and in different formulations. Our facilities are equipped with
single-use reactor systems with capacity of producing up to tens of kilograms of bioconjugate drug
substance in each batch. Our drug product filling line contains fully isolated, automated aseptic system
which can fill liquid and lyophilized products in multiple vial sizes. As payloads often are highly potent
substances, our laboratories and GMP manufacturing facilities for payload-linkers, conjugate drug
substances and drug products feature special engineering designs and proper containment systems, such
as isolators designed to accommodate handling of OEB5-rated compounds
* ranging from several
milligrams to tens of kilograms. All our dedicated and specialized facilities are located within
200-kilometer radius, ensuring coordinated development and manufacturing, a well-managed supply
chain, and seamless technology transfer. Our operations adhere to the well-regarded quality control and
assurance system of the WXB Group.
CRDMO of choice with broad, loyal and fast-growing customer base
We are a trusted partner leading the bioconjugate development globally with a diverse, loyal and
fast-growing customer base. We won the runner-up prize in the “Best Contract Manufacturing (CMO)
Provider” category of the 2022 World ADC Awards and the “Best Contract Development Manufacturing
Organization (CDMO)” prize at the 2023 World ADC Awards, a testament to our flawless operational
record during the Track Record Period. Our diverse and growing customer base includes both innovative
biotechnology companies and global pharmaceutical companies. The number of our customers grew
significantly from 49 in 2020 to 115 in 2021, 167 in 2022 and 169 in the six months ended June 30, 2023.
As of June 30, 2023, we had served 304 customers cumulatively, including most of the major players in
the global ADC and bioconjugate market.
Our customer base is also geographically diverse with a global footprint. In the first six months of
2023, 37.0%, 35.9%, 23.1% and 4.0% of the total revenue from ultimate customers from North America,
China, Europe and the rest of the world, respectively, based on the location of the customers’ headquarters.
We believe our ability to establish such a broad and diverse customer base results from our constant
pursuit of fast, smooth and high-quality project execution to propel their global development efforts or
out-licensing or acquisition strategies. As of June 30, 2023, we had won ADC development contracts for
all ADC candidates in China with dual filing of IND and/or BLA in China and the United States, and eight
out of the 10 China-based companies that out-licensed their ADC pipelines overseas since 2022 are our
* OEB5-rated compounds are active pharmaceutical ingredients that have been assigned to an occupational exposure band
(“OEB”) of 5, the most severe rating in the 5-band OEB system developed by the U.S. National Institute for Occupational
Safety and Health, indicating the highly hazardous nature of the compounds.
BUSINESS
— 174 —


--- page 184 ---
customers, according to Frost & Sullivan. We have enabled innovative biotechnology companies, such as
Ambrx, DualityBio and NBE Therapeutics (now a Boehringer Ingelheim company), to expediently
advance their pipeline programs in the fast-growing and competitive ADC and broader bioconjugate
market. Our expertise and capabilities also helped us win projects from global leading pharmaceutical
companies, including Merck Sharp & Dohme (“ MSD”).
We employ an “enable, follow and win the molecule” strategy to not only grow with our existing
customers by providing services from an early stage of their product development cycle, but also win new
customers as their bioconjugates progress. As of the end of 2020, 2021, 2022 and June 30, 2023, as the
result of our “enable” strategy, we had cumulatively progressed 9, 12, 24 and 30 ADC candidates,
respectively, from discovery to CMC development. We believe that growing with our customers enhances
our customer stickiness and loyalty as they see us not only as outsourcing service providers for specific
development stages of their drug candidates, but as a long-term partner in advancing their product
pipelines. Since our inception in 2013 and up to June 30, 2023, nearly all our customers for bioconjugate
discovery or integrated projects advancing their bioconjugate candidates along the development process
have stayed with us. As such, we have cultivated long-term relationships with our customers. Winning
customers is another key driver of our future growth. As our fully integrated one-stop bioconjugate
platform gains increasing industry recognition, we are winning new customers at the CMC stage. As of
June 30, 2023, 36 of our integrated projects were transferred to us from our customers or their outsourcing
service providers after the initial discovery stage. With our continuous efforts to enable our customers to
smoothly develop their pipeline programs and capture the market opportunity, we expect to win more
customers and molecules going forward.
While we did not have commercial-stage manufacturing projects during the Track Record Period, we
have completed process validation for two integrated projects and are helping to prepare for the BLA
submissions. As of June 30, 2023, we had 67 ongoing preclinical bioconjugate projects and 43 ongoing
post-IND bioconjugate projects. As pre-IND projects advance into the post-IND stage and post-IND
projects progress across clinical and commercial stage, the typical range of project contract values is also
expected to increase, providing a robust revenue growth momentum and visibility.
Seasoned management team supported by a diversified and strong talent pool and shareholders
We are led by our team of seasoned senior management who possess extensive experience and
diverse expertise in the pharmaceutical industry both domestically and internationally. Dr. Jincai Li, our
executive director and chief executive officer, has over 20 years of experience in biologics process
development, scale-up and GMP manufacturing. Mr. Xiaojie Xi, our executive director and chief financial
officer, has close to 20 years of experience in the capital market, financing, corporate strategy advisory
and investments. Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang, our executive director and chief operating officer, has over 20
years of experience in the management of business operations, supply chains, sales and product profit and
loss. Dr. Marie Meiying Zhu, our chief technology officer, is a well-regarded expert and executive with
over 28 years of drug development experience in the biotechnology industry and 15 years of experience
in the ADC development. Dr. Jianjun Luo, our vice president supervising drug product formulation
development and manufacturing, has over 20 years of experience in formulation, drug product
development and aseptic manufacturing. Our chairman of the board, Dr. Zhisheng Chen, who is also the
chief executive officer of our parent company WuXi Biologics, has over 20 years of experience in the
development of monoclonal antibodies, therapeutic proteins and vaccines, and assists our senior
management team to establish visionary strategies to propel our continued growth.
BUSINESS
— 175 —


--- page 185 ---
Our senior management team is supported by a pool of experienced, talented employees with strong
execution capabilities. As of the Latest Practicable Date, we had 1,113 employees, among whom 554 have
a science background with a master’s or doctorate degree in biology, chemistry, chemical engineering and
other relevant fields. Many of our employees also had prior work experience at pharmaceutical or
biotechnology companies in China or overseas. We also achieved a high employee retention rate of over
90% in 2022, which is calculated by dividing the number of employees who were with us as of December
31, 2021 and remained our employees as of December 31, 2022 by the number of our employees as of
December 31, 2021. As ADCs and other bioconjugates represent a unique class of modality and the success
of our projects heavily relies on the expertise and experience of our staff, we believe that this strong talent
pool has enabled and will continue to allow us to clearly appreciate our customers’ needs and efficiently
undertake projects at any suitable development stage.
We also benefit from strong shareholder support from the WXB Group and the WXA T Group. Our
heritage empowers us with expertise from the WXB Group, a global leading CRDMO for biologics, with
respect to large molecule moieties such as antibodies, as well as from the WXA T Group, a global leading
CRDMO for small molecule chemicals, with respect to payload-linkers.
OUR STRATEGIES
Leverage our fully integrated platform to further solidify industry leading position as we continue
to focus on integrated projects and comprehensive service capabilities
We look to further solidify our leading position and expand our market share by leveraging our fully
integrated one-stop bioconjugate research, development and manufacturing platform.
Integrated projects will be our key focus in the near future, and we intend to strengthen our
leadership position as an outsourcing service provider for integrated projects of ADCs and other
bioconjugates on a global scale. We plan to fully utilize established multidisciplinary expertise,
technologies and facilities to continuously deliver quality results to our existing customers and actively
promote our service capabilities to win over new customers for integrated services. As our integrated
projects advance into commercial stage, our revenue and market share are expected to grow accordingly.
We expect to launch our first ADC drug commercial manufacturing project in the near future. We will seek
to keep and win more projects for late-stage or commercialized products.
Besides integrated projects, we will also continue to enhance our services in discovery by providing
more innovative payload-linkers and conjugation technologies to expand our customer pool and capture
future upsides of emerging ADC and other bioconjugate pipelines. We plan to continue investing in
technologies and facilities that support efficient bioconjugate discovery efforts. We aim to both support
our existing customers’ new project initiatives and attract new customers with an expedited development
timeline and high efficiency.
Moreover, we plan to further promote our brand recognition as the CRDMO with integrated and
comprehensive service offerings dedicated for ADCs and other bioconjugates globally. We will also
maintain our high service standards to firmly establish that we are the partner of choice for the discovery,
development and manufacturing of bioconjugates and payload-linkers.
BUSINESS
— 176 —


--- page 186 ---
Expand manufacturing capacities globally to meet growing demands
In anticipation of strong demands from our customers globally, we are building more manufacturing
capacity to support our future growth. For example, we are supplementing manufacturing lines for
antibody intermediates associated with bioconjugates, payload-linkers and bioconjugate drug substances
in our Wuxi site with capacities ranging from 200 liters to 2,000 liters per batch for antibody intermediates
and up to 2,000 liters of bioconjugate drug substance per batch for conjugation manufacturing. We are also
enhancing our manufacturing capacity for drug products to prepare us for additional late-stage and
commercialization manufacturing projects, as we continuously help our customers to advance their
pipeline programs to the next stage. While we did not have commercial-stage manufacturing projects
during the Track Record Period, we have completed process validation for two integrated projects and are
helping to prepare for the BLA submissions.
As our “global dual sourcing” strategy, we started the plan to establish a manufacturing base in
Singapore, a vibrant biomedical hub, to better serve global customers and ensure that we always have two
facilities at different geographic region to manufacture each commercial product. Our Singapore site is
designed to include the commercial production facilities similar to the ones at our Wuxi site for
monoclonal antibody intermediate associated with bioconjugate, bioconjugate drug substance and drug
product, with a manufacturing capacity of up to 2,000 liters of monoclonal antibody intermediate, up to
2,000 liters of bioconjugate drug substance per batch for conjugation manufacturing and up to eight
million vials per annum for liquid or lyophilized drug products. It is expected to commence operation by
2026.
Continue to focus on cutting-edge technologies through internal R&D and strategic partnerships
We will continue to invest in cutting-edge technologies and enhance our R&D capabilities, so we
remain at the forefront of the technological frontier and continue delivering high quality results to our
customers. For instance, we will continue to refine or upgrade the WuXiDAR4 technologies and extend
their application to other XDC modalities. We also intend to continue establishing high-throughput
approaches for the generation and screening of all intermediates and bioconjugates under one project
management system.
We may also selectively pursue strategic alliances, licensing arrangements, investments and bolt-on
acquisitions in the future to enrich our technology toolboxes and service offerings and become the
bioconjugate research, development and manufacturing platform of the choice. For instance, in 2022 we
entered into a strategic collaboration with GeneQuantum Healthcare ( ઼ᅃᔼᖹ), an innovative
biotechnology company dedicated to the development of the next generation bioconjugate drugs. Pursuant
to the collaboration we undertook to actively promote GeneQuantum’s proprietary iLDC (intelligent
ligase-dependent conjugation) and iGDC (intelligent glycotransferase-dependent conjugation) platforms
globally to enable innovative bioconjugate development. This collaboration with GeneQuantum
Healthcare has enriched the conjugation technologies at our disposal and further strengthened our
competitiveness.
Deepen relationship with existing customers and broaden customer base
We believe that the breadth and depth of our integrated service capabilities will continue to enhance
our customer stickiness, drive our revenue growth and solidify our leading position in the global ADC and
other bioconjugate outsourcing services space. We will strive to maintain a high customer satisfaction,
BUSINESS
— 177 —


--- page 187 ---
which we believe will help us win new projects from our existing customers and further support the
progression of their pipeline programs with our integrated platform. We also look to attract new customers
through recommendations as well as active promotions of our comprehensive capabilities and well-
regarded brand.
As the industry interest in and market for ADCs and other bioconjugates continue to grow, we aim
to continue to support both innovative biotechnology companies and global pharmaceutical companies to
advance their ADC and other bioconjugate pipeline programs in an expedited and cost-efficient way.
We plan to further enhance our presence in the United States and Europe by continuously expanding
our business development and technical support force in those markets, enhancing our brand awareness
and formulating detailed plans in accordance with our sales efforts and the demand of our services. We
expect to continue to maintain a diversified customer base across geographic locations.
Pioneer through the industry development from ADC to XDC
The scope of bioconjugates extends beyond ADCs through the conjugation of various payloads other
than chemical drugs with antibodies and reaches “XDC” when various carriers other than antibodies are
used to generate the bioconjugates. For example, antibody conjugated with radioisotopes (“ ARC”) is a
novel therapy in radiopharmaceutical space and PDCs have emerged as the next generation of targeted
therapy other than ADCs. We have supported our customers regarding the discovery and development of
other bioconjugates such as AOC, ACC and PDC, among others. With our accumulated hands-on
experience, interdisciplinary expertise and industry-leading technical capabilities in ADCs, we are well
positioned to extend our services to “XDC” by linking various types of carriers with various types of
payloads, an aspiration that is embedded in our company name.
As innovations in the XDC field continue to emerge, we believe opportunities for us as a CRDMO
will follow. We intend to adopt a multifaceted approach to further delve into the XDC space. For example,
in addition to monoclonal antibodies, namely the “A” in “ADC,” we intend to further establish capabilities
in incorporating different types of carriers, such as antibody fragments, nanobodies, bi-specific antibodies,
peptides and synthetic polymers, among others, to improve the specific targeting of diseased cells. With
respect to the payloads, or “D” in “XDC,” we plan to continue developing capabilities in other types of
modalities with differentiated mechanisms of action, including nucleotides, steroids, chelators, biotin,
enzymes or targeted protein degradation agents such as proteolysis targeting chimeras (PROTACs). Last,
we will strive to invest in the research and application of innovative technologies for conjugation, or “C”
in “XDC,” to enhance the stability and homogeneity of XDCs and efficiency in scaling-up and
manufacturing.
OUR BUSINESS MODEL
Who We Are and What We Do
We are a leading CRDMO focused on the global ADC and broader bioconjugate market and
dedicated to providing integrated and comprehensive services. We are the second largest CRDMO for
ADCs and other bioconjugates globally in terms of revenue in 2022, according to Frost & Sullivan.
Leveraging expertise in both biologics and small molecules, we offer interdisciplinary and comprehensive
services, covering discovery, process development and GMP manufacturing of bioconjugates and
payload-linkers.
BUSINESS
— 178 —


--- page 188 ---
During the Track Record Period, a substantial part of our business has been related to ADCs. An
ADC is a conjugate of a biologic component (e.g., an antibody) and a small molecule drug (e.g., a
cytotoxic payload) through a chemical linker. A typical ADC drug utilizes the antibody to bind to the
tumor-specific antigen target on the surface of cancerous cells, delivers the payload to the cell and releases
the payload inside the cell to kill it. The antibody plays the roles of targeting tumor cells and carrying the
payload into the tumor cells, while the payload kills the tumor cells. This combinatorial design potentially
reduces off-target toxicity of classic chemotherapy and leads to an improved safety and efficacy.
Main Structure of ADC
Antibody
Linker
Drug
Specific for a tumor-
associated antigen that has
restricted expression on
normal cells
Attaches the cytotoxic
agent to the antibody
and releases the payload under
designed conditions
Designed to kill target
cells when internalized
and released
Note: For illustrative purposes, the above graph is a schematic representation of an ADC molecule showing payload-linkers attached
to an antibody. In reality, payload-linkers can be attached to different regions of an antibody.
ADCs and other bioconjugates constitute a separate modality distinct from both biologics and small
molecules. There are multiple distinct challenges inherent in the major steps of ADC and broader
bioconjugates drug development, including payload-linker generation, bioconjugate process development
and GMP manufacturing and quality assurance of drug substances and drug products. For additional
information about ADCs and other bioconjugates and the challenges associated with the research,
development and manufacturing of those modalities, see “Industry Overview.” Globally, few companies
have in-house capabilities required to address all the challenges involved in ADC and broader
bioconjugates development in house. Even for companies with in-house capabilities, they may not be able
to conduct all activities in an economically efficient manner. For example, carrying out the ADC and
broader bioconjugates development process in geographically scattered facilities may pose considerable
challenges for supply chain management, technology transfer and quality assurance and could increase the
total costs significantly.
We have established a fully integrated one-stop research, development and manufacturing platform
dedicated to ADCs and other bioconjugates. Supported by world-class capabilities in small molecule
compounds, large molecule moieties and conjugation technologies, our comprehensive service offerings
span each critical step of bioconjugate development and manufacturing, including discovery, process
development and GMP manufacturing for bioconjugates, monoclonal antibody intermediates and
payload-linkers associated with bioconjugates. We provide tailored solutions to our customers at any stage
of the bioconjugate development process. We have accumulated vast hands-on experience in
BUSINESS
— 179 —


--- page 189 ---
bioconjugates, generating over 7,000 bioconjugate molecules for our customers incorporating over 500
protein carriers and over 600 payload-linkers. We have completed CMC development and initiated GMP
manufacturing using over 10 conjugation technologies for both ADC and other bioconjugates. See “— Our
Services” for a more detailed description of our service offerings.
We believe a fully integrated one-stop bioconjugate research, development and GMP manufacturing
platform like ours is the precise solution to industry challenges associated with a traditionally fragmented
and extensive outsourcing service provider network. Our approach to the development of ADC and other
bioconjugates is to provide all services with one source, one platform and one team, as further outlined
below. We provide services from proximately located and dedicated laboratories and manufacturing
facilities, leading to potentially significant reduction of development timeline and costs. As an industry
recognition of our capabilities, we won the runner-up prize in the “Best Contract Manufacturing (CMO)
Provider” category of the 2022 World ADC Awards and the “Best Contract Development Manufacturing
Organization (CDMO)” prize at the 2023 World ADC Awards.
 One source . Leveraging our integrated capabilities in bioconjugate development and our close
relationship with industry-leading outsourcing service providers for small- and large-molecule
development, such as the WXA T Group and the WXB Group, we enable customers to source
key raw materials in the value chain of bioconjugate development, including payload-linkers
and antibodies, singly from or through us, which we believe would contribute to yielding
consistent and high-quality bioconjugates and the final drug products.
 One platform . Our service offerings, which stem from our fully integrated one-stop platform,
empower our customers to conquer major steps of bioconjugate development, spanning from
discovery, process development to GMP manufacturing. We believe our fully integrated
one-stop platform effectively addresses industry challenges associated with bioconjugate
development using a fragmented and extensive outsourcing service provider network, and
ultimately enables customers to expedite development timelines and enhance quality and cost
efficiencies.
 One team . Our team members with different functions, from service and support to product
management and project accountability, seamlessly collaborate and strive to deliver a high
level of customer experience and service.
We employ an “enable, follow and win the molecule” strategy to not only grow with our existing
customers by providing services from an early stage of their product development cycle, but also win new
customers as their bioconjugates progress. We have been able to achieve a high customer retention because
of our service quality, industry-leading development timeline, world-class and innovative process
development technology and proven GMP manufacturing capabilities. Since our inception in 2013 and up
to June 30, 2023, nearly all our customers for bioconjugate discovery or integrated projects advancing
their bioconjugate candidates along the development process have stayed with us. Winning customers at
the CMC stage is another key driver of our future growth. Also due to the aforementioned factors, we
expect to continuously win over customers and integrated bioconjugate projects going forward. Our global
market share by revenue increased from 1.8% in 2020 to 4.6% in 2021 and 9.8% in 2022.
BUSINESS
— 180 —


--- page 190 ---
Figuratively, we view our pipeline programs as sitting at different stages of a cone-shaped “funnel,”
where the opening of the funnel is wider and represents projects that are at an early stage of the
development process, including discovery projects. When a project advances through the development
process, it moves deeper into the funnel and eventually may reach the end of the funnel that represents
commercial manufacturing. We have executed 350 discovery projects since our inception and as of June
30, 2023. The following funnel diagram sets forth the developmental stages and other details of ongoing
integrated projects as of June 30, 2023. The duration and contract value of discovery projects can vary
significantly due to their nature.
1 – 2 years
3 – 5 years
US$8 – 11 million
US$40 – 70 million
Number of ongoing projects Typical range of
duration
Typical range of
contract value
1 – 3 years US$6 – 9 million
350 Discovery1
67 Preclinical
27 Phase I
11 Phase II
5 Phase III
“R”
“D”
“M”
Commercial
(BLA expected
in 2023)2
2 – 4 years US$8 – 15 million
Type of projects
ADC and
broader XDC
ADC and
broader XDC
ADC and
broader XDC
ADC
1. It is the cumulative number of discovery projects since our inception and as of June 30, 2023.
2. We have completed process validation, which is a critical step before the BLA submission, for two integrated projects.
The following table sets forth the details of ongoing projects by each development stage during the
Track Record Period. As of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023, nil, 3, 20 and 7 ongoing
post-IND projects were advanced in the year/period from the pre-IND stage leveraging our CRDMO
services.
As of December 31, 2020 As of December 31, 2021 As of December 31, 2022 As of June 30, 2023
Development
Stage
Typical
Duration
Number of
Ongoing
Projects (3)
Type of
Projects
Number
of New
Projects (5)
Number of
Ongoing
Projects (3)
Type of
Projects
Number
of New
Projects (5)
Number of
Ongoing
Projects (3)
Type of
Projects
Number
of New
Projects (5)
Number of
Ongoing
Projects (3)
Type of
Projects
Number
of New
Projects (5)
Discovery . . N/A (1) 100(4) ADC(78) and
XDC(22)
52 176 (4) ADC(148) and
XDC(28)
76 299 (4) ADC(244) and
XDC(55)
123 350 (4) ADC(283) and
XDC(67)
51
Preclinical . . 1-2 years 28 ADC(24) and
XDC(4)
12 45 ADC(38) and
XDC(7)
20 57 ADC(51) and
XDC(6)
33 67 ADC(59) and
XDC(8)
17
Clinical . . . Multiple
years (2)
12 ADC(11) and
XDC(1)
– 15 ADC(13) and
XDC(2)
– 37 ADC(33) and
XDC(4)
2 43 ADC(39) and
XDC(4)
–
1. The duration of discovery projects can vary significantly in light of their ad hoc nature and depends on the types of projects
at issue. Therefore, there is not a typical range for discovery projects.
2. The typical duration of projects in Phase I, II and III stages are 1-3 years, 2-4 years and 3-5 years, respectively.
BUSINESS
— 181 —


--- page 191 ---
3. “Number of ongoing projects” is the number of integrated projects excluding the number of integrated projects that are
inactive or for which the customers notify us that they do not intend to further pursue. We deem an integrated project inactive
if we have not been requested to provide services for three years.
4. It is the cumulative number of discovery projects since our inception and as of the indicated date. Because the duration and
chance of success of discovery projects can vary significantly due to their early-stage nature, we present the cumulative
number, instead of the ongoing project number, of discovery projects to demonstrate our experience in bioconjugate discovery.
5. For preclinical-stage integrated projects, “number of new projects” is the number of preclinical projects that we were able to
“enable” (advance from the discovery-stage) or “win” (bring into our project pipeline) during the year/period ended on the
indicated date. For discovery and clinical-stage projects, “number of new projects” is the number of projects that we were able
to “win” (bring into our project pipeline) during the year/period ended on the indicated date. We do not count clinical projects
that we “follow” (advance from preclinical stage to clinical stage) as new clinical projects, as we deem an integrated project,
regardless of its developmental stage, as one project.
The cone shape of the funnel reflects the fact that customers may strategically advance selected ADC
or other bioconjugate candidates along the development process. The closer a bioconjugate candidate is
to the end of the funnel, the more commercial visibility it brings to the customers. As bioconjugate
candidates progress deeper into the channel, services required to enable such advancement change
accordingly, and typically the size of the projects increase, leading to a greater revenue for us on a
particular project. Typically, as depicted in the diagram above, we charge varied total fees for our projects
in consideration of, among others, the nature of the projects and the expected workload and technical
requirements of the projects.
During the Track Record Period, we generated revenue from a mix of bioconjugate projects in
various development stages, which can be broadly categorized into (i) revenue from pre-IND projects,
primarily bioconjugate discovery projects at the drug discovery stage and preclinical development stage,
and (ii) revenue from post-IND projects, primarily for clinical and commercial stage projects. The
following table lays out a breakdown of our revenue by the development stages of projects for the periods
indicated, both in actual terms and as a percentage of total revenue.
For the year ended December 31,
For the six months ended
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(in thousands, except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Pre-IND services ..... 53,122 55.1 152,506 49.0 381,071 38.5 99,267 30.1 371,273 37.4
Post-IND services ..... 43,231 44.9 158,625 51.0 609,352 61.5 230,169 69.9 622,195 62.6
Total ............. 96,353 100.0 311,131 100.0 990,423 100.0 329,436 100.0 993,468 100.0
During the Track Record Period, we generated a significant amount of revenue from overseas
ultimate customers (based on the locations of their headquarters), who contributed to RMB27.7 million,
RMB182.7 million, RMB684.2 million and RMB637.4 million in revenue, accounting for 28.7%, 58.7%,
69.1% and 64.1% of our total revenue during the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the
six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively. For additional information, see “Financial Information —
Key Components of Our Results of Operations — Revenue.”
BUSINESS
— 182 —


--- page 192 ---
We expect to maintain a fast-growing revenue stream in the coming years. As of June 30, 2023, we
had 67 ongoing preclinical bioconjugate projects and 43 ongoing post-IND bioconjugate projects,
representing a significant total amount of service fee for services contracted yet to be performed. We also
expect commercial manufacturing projects to gradually become a significant source of our future revenue
with the launch of our first ADC drug commercial manufacturing project in the near future.
Our Fee Models
Our service fee arrangement can be primarily divided into two types: (i) fee-for-service model and
(ii) full-time-equivalent model.
Fee-for-service Model
During the Track Record Period, we generated fee income primarily on a fee-for-service, or FFS,
basis for the services provided. We generally receive payments in accordance with a pre-agreed payment
schedule specified in the contract or work order. The payment schedule sets out the fees for services we
provide at relevant discovery, development or manufacturing steps that fall under the scope of work in the
contract or work order. We determine the fee level based on the scope of the services, the estimated costs
and expenses, the estimated amount of time to deliver our services, and the prices charged by our
competitors for similar services, among others. Our service contracts and work orders under the FFS
model typically include a detailed schedule that sets forth specifications of and anticipated time required
for completing each step as well as the corresponding payment.
The fee-for-service model is our default fee model for a vast majority of our projects during the
Track Record Period. Fees received from our service contracts and work orders under the FFS model
contributed 100.0%, 100.0%, 98.4% and 98.7% of our revenue in the years ended December 31, 2020,
2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively. A small number of our projects also
incorporate a milestone fee structure that is designed to incentivize us to reach predefined milestones
expediently, particularly for projects which utilize our proprietary technologies such as WuXiDAR4.
During the Track Record Period, we have seven projects with milestone fee structure. The milestone
payments are tied to specific milestone events during the research, development, manufacturing and
commercialization of ADCs and broader bioconjugates, such as the dosing of the first patient in different
clinical trial phases and the obtainment of regulatory approvals in different jurisdictions. The revenue
recognition mechanisms for projects with milestone payments are basically the same as that of FFS model.
See “Financial Information — Critical Accounting Policies, Judgments and Estimates — Revenue” for
details. During the Track Record Period, we recorded a small amount of milestone fee income, and we do
not expect significant revenue from milestone fees going forward.
Full-time-equivalent Model
We also generate income under the full-time-equivalent, or FTE, model. Under the FTE model, we
designate employees to the customer’s projects at a fixed rate per FTE employee per period of time. We
determine the amount of service fees based on the number of employees and the amount of time required
for completing the project, among others. Our relationship with customers under the FTE model may last
several years, and the FTE arrangements are subject to annual review. We only adopt this fee model where
a customer requests us to assign a team of employees to its project and strongly prefers the FTE model
BUSINESS
— 183 —


--- page 193 ---
or where the work scope of a project makes it difficult for us to estimate the cost and adopt the FFS model.
Fees received from our service contracts under the FTE model contributed nil, nil, 1.6% and 1.3% of our
revenue in the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023,
respectively.
For details of the payment terms of our fee models, see “— Customers — Payment Terms.” For
details on our revenue recognition mechanism, see “Financial Information — Critical Accounting Policies,
Judgments and Estimates — Revenue.”
OUR SERVICES
Overview
We are committed to continuously enhancing our platform, propelling and transforming the
development of the bioconjugate industry, enabling global biopharmaceutical partners and benefiting
patients worldwide. With our fully integrated, one-stop bioconjugate platform that covers key aspects of
bioconjugate CRDMO services, including discovery, process development and GMP manufacturing for
bioconjugates, monoclonal antibody intermediates and payload-linkers associated with bioconjugates, we
empower our customers at any stage of the development process to advance their projects. The following
diagram depicts our bioconjugate CRDMO services.
Drug Discovery
Bioconjugate DS/DP Manufacturing — DS Up to 2,000L Conjugation, Vial DP (Liquid & Lyophilized), Packaging & Labeling
Pre-Clinical Development Early-Phase (Phase I & II) Late-Phases (Phase III) Commercial Production (Expected to Launch in 2024)
Non-GMP Manufacturing of Drug
Substance (DS) and Drug Product (DP)
Discovery Chemistry
Payload-Linker Synthesis
Conjugation Discovery
Developability Study
In Vitro/In Vivo Characterization
IND Enabling Process Development
Analytical Method Development
Late-Stage Process Optimization, Process Characterization and PPQ
GMP Manufacturing and ADC DS/DP Testing Release
mAb Intermediate Manufacturing — Up to 2,000L
Payload Linker Manufacturing
CMC Regulatory Support
Abbreviations: PPQ = process performance qualification; DS = drug substance; DP = drug product; mAb = monoclonal antibody.
Note: ADC/Bioconjugate CMC scope (process development, analytical method development, manufacturing) includes mAb
intermediate for bioconjugate, payload-linker and bioconjugate DS and DP .
Our experience in bioconjugate development extends beyond ADCs. We are exploring new
technologies and modalities that we believe are promising to address unmet medical needs and could allow
us to eventually provide CRDMO services for “XDC” drugs, an aspiration that is embedded in our
company name. For example, in addition to monoclonal antibodies, namely the “A” in “ADC,” we intend
to further establish capabilities in handling antibody fragments, nanobodies, bi-specific antibodies,
peptides and synthetic polymers such as nanoparticles, among others, to improve specific targeting of
diseased cells or organs. With respect to the payloads, or “D” in “XDC,” we plan to assess other types of
BUSINESS
— 184 —


--- page 194 ---
modalities with differentiated mechanisms of action, including nucleotides, steroids, chelators, biotin,
enzymes or targeted protein degradation agents such as proteolysis targeting chimeras (PROTACs). We
also have experience in and plan to further explore conjugation of labels and reporter groups such as
fluorophores in labeling and imaging applications. Last, we will strive to invest in the research and
application of innovative technologies for conjugation, or “C” in “XDC,” to enhance the stability and
homogeneity of XDCs and efficiency in scaling-up and manufacturing. As of June 30, 2023, we had 67
non-ADC discovery projects and 12 non-ADC integrated projects, including four RDC projects, four
PEGylation projects, three antiviral conjugate (“ AV C”) projects and one other project.
Drug Discovery
Discovery Chemistry
We have been investing heavily in enriching our technology platform with cutting-edge payload-
linkers and conjugation mechanisms to equip ourselves with a vast catalog of discovery chemistry
solutions for customers. Through our discovery chemistry solutions, we empower customers to conduct
screenings of a variety of chemical payloads and linkers to select payloads with desired mechanism of
action (“ MOA”) and linkers with different release MOA and physicochemical properties, and ultimately
identify the proof-of-concept bioconjugate molecules for further optimization and development.
We are also experienced in new chemical entity (“ NCE”) medicinal chemistry support and
optimization for payload-linkers. Beyond commonly used payloads, such as auristatins, camptothecin,
pyrrolobenzodiazepine, mytansinoids, and commonly used linkers, such as maleimidocaproyl (MC)-L-valine
(V)-L-citrulline (C)-p-aminobenzyl alcohol (“ MC-VC-PAB ”) and succinimidyl-4-(N-maleimidomethyl)
cyclohexane-1-carboxylatedisulfide (“ SMCC”), we enable our customers to make structural modifications
of linkers and payloads to further refine the physicochemical properties, in vitro biological characterization,
in vivo efficacy, pharmacokinetics properties and toxicity of bioconjugates to finally determine the optimal
linker and payload combination with the designated monoclonal antibody. Our customers may also obtain
various ready-made payload-linkers from us, which include vcMMAE, mcMMAF, MC-GGFG-DXd,
MC-GGFG-Exatecan, CL2A-SN38, Tesirine, SPBD-DM4 and SMCC-DM1.
Conjugation Discovery
We have conducted conjugation discovery using over 10 conjugation technologies. Our portfolio of
conjugation technologies is one of the richest in the industry, according to Frost & Sullivan. These
conjugation technologies include non-site-specific ones such as lysine or cysteine based random
conjugations, and site-specific ones that involve engineered cysteine, glycan remodeling, disulfide
re-bridging, and enzyme-assisted or peptide-affinity-assisted site-specific conjugations, which has
empowered our customers to explore and assess the optimal conjugation technologies for their respective
bioconjugate candidates.
We are experienced in the conjugation of different carrier and payload-linker combinations. In
addition to commonly used cytotoxic payloads, we enable our customers to conjugate proteins with
non-toxin moieties, including proteolysis-targeting chimeric molecules (PROTACs), polyethylene glycol
(PEG), peptides, chelators and oligonucleotides. Conjugation of these moieties potentially allows our
customers to develop innovative modalities beyond ADCs with desired properties.
BUSINESS
— 185 —


--- page 195 ---
WuXiDAR4 — Our proprietary conjugation technologies
Homogeneity of bioconjugates has significant implications to the complexity and the cost of
manufacturing process. While our comprehensive capabilities allow our customers to explore and assess
various DARs and to develop their ADC candidates with the most favorable DAR, we have developed
proprietary WuXiDAR4 technologies to tightly control the distribution of species with varied drug-to-
antibody ratio (“ DAR”), thereby significantly increasing the homogeneity of the bioconjugates with
lot-to-lot consistency.
Our WuXiDAR4 technologies include both WuXiDAR4 Process that works on native antibodies
without any need for engineering and WuXiDAR4 Scaffold that includes simple engineering of antibodies.
The conjugation products can achieve a high homogeneity (over 65%) of DAR4 species out of the total
ADC product using native antibodies through our WuXiDAR4 Process, which can be further improved to
over 95% by additional polishing steps. WuXiDAR4 Scaffold can make the content of DAR4 species
higher than 85%. Both processes employ simple steps, which would lower the manufacturing costs for our
customers.
Below is a comparison of the DAR4 homogeneity in terms of DAR distribution using conventional
method compared to our WuXiDAR4 technologies:
WuXiDAR4 ProcessADC produced with conventional
method, natural DAR distribution WuXiDAR4 Scaffold
D4
D0
D2
D6 D8
48 61 0 m i n
D4
䣯䣫䣰4 6 8
D0 D2 D6
5 10
D4
D0
D2
D6
D8
min
Note: Different species of ADCs generated from one synthesis reaction are separated using hydrophobic interaction chromatography
(HIC), with more hydrophilic species (i.e., ADC with low DAR values) eluted first. Each peak in the graph represents a
distinct species. The vertical axis represents the abundance of different species of ADC molecules. “Min” on the horizontal
axis means “minutes.” “D” with a number above each peak denotes the DAR value, i.e., the number of payloads attached to
each antibody through linkers. For example, ADCs in which four payload molecules are attached to each antibody is denoted
D4.
Left: ADCs produced with conventional methods contain multiple species with different DAR values, with D2, D4 and D6
being prominent species. Middle and Right: ADCs produced with our WuXiDAR4 technologies have a predominant species
with the DAR value of 4, suggesting an improved homogeneity profile.
BUSINESS
— 186 —


--- page 196 ---
Through our WuXiDAR4 technologies, the payload-linkers are attached to the Fab region of the
antibody without disrupting the interaction between the Fab region and corresponding tumor antigen,
demonstrating a high level of homogeneity in terms of conjugation location as demonstrated in the
diagram below:
min12 14 16 18 20 22
L0
L1
H1
H2 H3
Drugs loaded at Fab Region
Note: H = heavy chain; L = light chain. The numbers depict the number of payload-linkers attached to the respective fragments.
An antibody consists of two heavy chains and two light chains.
WuXiDAR4 technologies in turn contribute to a favorable pharmacokinetics profile. As shown in the
following graph, MMAE conjugated Herceptin produced with WuXiDAR4 is more stable over time in
circulation as compared to the control, potentially contributing to a longer-lasting therapeutic effect.
1,000
10,000
100,000
1,000,000
0 5 0 1 0 01 5 02 0 02 5 03 0 03 5 0
ng/ml
Timepoint/h
Rat PK study of MMAE conjugated Herceptin
Total-T-MMAE-Ctrl
Conj-T-MMAE-Ctrl
Total-T-MMAE-WX
Conj-T-MMAE-WX
Note: “Total” denotes both unconjugated antibodies, from which payload-linkers are detached in circulation, and conjugated ADCs.
“Conj” denotes the conjugated ADCs. PK = pharmacokinetics; MMAE = monomethyl auristatin E ; h = hour .
The above graph illustrates the pharmacokinetic profile of the total MMAE conjugated Herceptin (which may include naked
antibodies) and Herceptin with conjugated MMAE (excluding naked antibodies) in rat. There is a marginal difference between
the half-life of the total group generated with traditional methods (Total-T-MMAE-Ctrl, blue line/dots) and the half-life of the
total group generated by WuXiDAR4 technologies (Total-T-MMAE-WX, gray line/dots). In contrast, the conjugated Herceptin
generated using WuXiDAR4 technologies (Conj-T-MMAE-WX, the yellow line/dots) demonstrated a longer half-life than
conjugated Herceptin generated using traditional methods (Conj-T-MMAE-Ctrl). At each time point, the concentration of
Conj-T-MMAE-WX is higher than that of Conj-T-MMAE-Ctrl in rat in vivo studies.
Besides DAR4, we are exploring application of the same basic technologies to control the
predominant DAR at different values, so that the conjugation product can achieve high homogeneity while
developing their ADC candidates with the most favorable DAR.
BUSINESS
— 187 —


--- page 197 ---
Other Technologies
In addition to site-specific conjugation technologies for ADC generation, we developed high-
throughput conjugation technology to support the antibody selection needs in ADCs discovery projects.
With this technology, large number but small amount (tens to hundreds of micrograms) of ADCs can be
generated regardless of the initial concentrations and purities of the antibodies in hybridoma culture. The
high purity products generated by this way are sufficient to support the following cytotoxicity assays.
In Vitro and In Vivo Characterization
Following conjugation discovery, we provide single-sourced services with multiple in vitro and in
vivo characterization methods within our extensive array of characterization panel to evaluate the
bioconjugate candidates. By applying these methods, such as ELISA, flow cytometry or surface plasmon
resonance, we evaluate physicochemical properties such as the affinity and specificity of the bioconjugate
candidates for certain antigens or cell lines of interest. Well-reserved affinity and specificity are the key
features of bioconjugates to ensure that they target desired diseased cells while sparing other healthy cells.
With respect to in vitro/in vivo studies, we work with our customers to investigate bioconjugate candidates
in relevant xenograft models or through various cellular assays, including cytotoxicity assays,
internalization assays, apoptosis assays and angiogenesis assays, on their efficacy, pharmacokinetics and
pharmacodynamics profiles and toxicity. The Fc effector functions are also assessed through ADCC
assays, CDC assays and phagocytosis assays. These studies assist our customers to assess whether their
drug candidates are appropriate as preclinical candidates.
Developability Study
After the in vitro and in vivo characterization, we apply developability study to bridge proof-of-
concept studies and lead selection to facilitate the selection of suitable preclinical candidates that
potentially enable a smooth transition to subsequent development. Through physicochemical and
developability characterization, we gain a better understanding of certain properties of the products,
including their stability, solubility and conjugability.
Early-stage Process Development
Bioconjugate Drug Substance Process Development
We view process development for bioconjugate drug substance as one of our key competencies. Our
in-depth experience in over 10 conjugation technologies for both ADC and broader bioconjugates
empowers us to optimize the process development of various types of bioconjugates, develop scale-up
processes and support technology transfer to proceed to GMP manufacturing, IND filing and beyond.
With the support of a full array of analytics, we are able to develop methods and perform in-process
testing to monitor crucial steps of conjugate process development and manufacturing. Critical parameters,
such as concentration, DAR, purity, residual content (including free drug) and endotoxin, are routinely
tested and monitored during the process development.
We have been continuing to establish comprehensive expertise in various carrier-specific and
payload-linker-specific conjugation technologies, so that all bioconjugates of our customers can be suited
for process development and GMP manufacturing. We are rich in experience and committed to advancing
BUSINESS
— 188 —


--- page 198 ---
our customers’ bioconjugate drug substance development through conjugation technologies, such as the
non-site-specific ones involving lysine or inter-chain cysteine, and site-specific ones involving engineered
cysteine, engineered NNAA and enzyme-assisted conjugation. We have initiated GMP manufacturing
using several conjugation technologies, including NNAA site-specific conjugation, tyrosine tubulin
ligase-assisted conjugation, sortase-assisted conjugation, farnesyltransferase-assisted conjugation, and
traceless affinity peptide labeling conjugation, as well as our own patented WuXiDAR4 conjugation,
according to Frost & Sullivan.
Our process development efforts are based on the contemporary concept of quality by design and
focus on critical quality attributes to optimize processes. For example, the DAR ratio is a critical quality
attribute for conjugation reactions and bioconjugates themselves. However, the conventional conjugation
processes always result in a very heterogeneous mixture of molecules where the drug moieties are attached
at several different sites on the antibody. The heterogeneous mixture is so complex that it is difficult and
expensive to characterize and purify. Each conjugation product in such a mixture potentially has different
pharmacokinetic, distribution, toxicity and efficacy profiles. Through our expert process development
efforts, we have helped our customers to achieve consistent and favorable DAR for their products.
Our focus on bioconjugate drug substance process development extends beyond the conjugation
reactions. To control impurity, we have developed an extensive collection of purification steps for a wide
variety of different bioconjugates. These purification schemes include ultrafiltration and diafiltration, as
well as column purification technologies, such as ion exchange chromatography, hydrophobic interaction
chromatography and Protein A affinity chromatography, which can be deployed as needed for different
scales of varied types of bioconjugates.
Bioconjugate Formulation Process Development
We offer a broad spectrum of services for conjugation formulation process development for both
highly potent and non-potent bioconjugate drug products with concentration of up to 150 mg/ml. These
services facilitate early-stage molecular assessments and develop proper formulations for first-in-human
clinical trials and commercial product launches. Our versatile capabilities also enable our customers to
choose from various dosage forms including liquid, frozen and lyophilized forms. Lyophilization of ADC
and broader bioconjugate products enhances their stability and requires a more complex process. Over 30
lyophilized products that we contributed to develop have entered the clinical stage. We also offer special
dosage forms for products containing nanoparticles or other molecular complexes. The following list
outlines representative services that we provide to help customers develop formulations and drug products:
 forced degradation studies to identify product degradation pathways;
 high-throughput screening for formulation process development utilizing biophysical methods;
 design of experiments to identify the optimal formulations;
 container and closure selection and integrity testing;
 end-to-end fill process development from drug substance thawing through mixing, filtration,
filling, stoppering and capping to final visual inspection;
 processes development for isolator-based filling systems;
BUSINESS
— 189 —


--- page 199 ---
 pilot-scale (non-GMP) fill finish and lyophilization services for preclinical toxicology studies,
non-GMP stability studies and scale-down process development;
 lyophilization cycle development and optimization;
 fill finish and lyophilization process scale-up and/or technology transfer, from development to
clinical phase or commercial manufacturing;
 in-use compatibility and stability studies to support clinical administration or toxicology
studies; and
 stability studies to support formulation and process development under long-term, accelerated
or stressed conditions.
Analytical Method Development
Analytical characterization is the key for bioconjugate development. We leverage in-house expertise
and analytical equipment to characterize the intermediates, including monoclonal antibodies or other
proteins, payload-linkers, and the bioconjugate molecule at various stages of development. Analytical
methods that we utilize to assess and characterize these molecules include high-performance liquid
chromatography, ELISA, cell-based bioassay and liquid chromatography-mass spectrometry (“ LC-MS ”),
among others. With these methods, we measure key parameters that shed critical light on the conjugation
process and the quality of the resulting bioconjugates. Those parameters include, but are not limited to,
purity, identity, protein concentration, isoelectric point, and potency. The following table sets forth some
of our analytical capabilities to characterize ADCs and other bioconjugate molecules.
Analytical Capability
Purity measurements Identity, determined by Potency, determined by
ADC ..............  D A R
 HMW and LMW
species *
 Charge variants
 Residual free drug
 High order structure
 Capillary isoelectric
focusing
 Peptide mapping
 Drug load
distribution
 Conjugation site
analysis
 Binding assays
 Functional assays
 Cell-based assays
Other Bioconjugates . .  Payload loading
 HMW and LMW
species
 Residues
 Molecular weight
 Polydispersity
 Particle size
 Binding assays
 Functional assays
* HMW = high molecular weight; LMW = low molecular weight
BUSINESS
— 190 —


--- page 200 ---
To support the process development and manufacturing of payload-linker, we also leverage various
sophisticated and precision tools for separation and analytical chemistry at our disposal to ensure delivery
of phase-appropriate quality results to our customers. Those tools include silica gel column
chromatography, medium and high-pressure liquid chromatography, high-performance liquid
chromatography, infrared spectroscopy, differential scanning calorimetry, X-ray powder diffraction and
nuclear magnetic resonance, among others.
Late-stage Development and Process Validation
To help our customers evaluate the late-stage readiness of the developed process, we leverage our
in-depth expertise in process development and offer late-stage development and process validation
services, including process characterization and process performance qualification. These services aim to
ensure that not only optimized processes are developed to achieve more robust performance and better fit
the commercial manufacturing facility, but also regulatory requirements are met with established scientific
and documentary evidence.
The process characterization services aim to enable customers to understand the impact of process
input (operating parameters) on process output (performance parameters) and identify key operating and
performance parameters during the bioconjugate manufacturing. We work with customers to define critical
quality attributes and process ranges, as well as conduct risk assessment, small scale model development
and qualification, and parameters classification. We also offer process performance qualification studies
under GMP conditions as part of the process validation to collect and evaluate various data related to
manufacturing. Through these studies and the associated adjustments to the process, we enable customers
to ensure that all assay methods, raw materials, equipment and cleaning methods are validated, and the
developed process for bioconjugate manufacturing delivers consistent product yield and purity within the
entire operating range.
Manufacturing of Drug Substance and Drug Product
We offer both non-GMP and GMP-compliant manufacturing of bioconjugate drug substance and drug
product to cater to our customer’s varied needs from the preclinical stage to the post-IND stage. We also
expect to launch the commercial GMP manufacturing of ADC and broader bioconjugate products in the
near future. As antibody intermediates are critical components of ADCs and certain other types of
bioconjugates, we are expanding our capacity in the production of antibodies used for conjugation through
facility expansion in Wuxi, China and construction of a new facility in Singapore. For additional
information about our expansion plans, see “— Facilities.” With respect to antibody intermediates used for
conjugation, in addition to sourcing from us, our customers have the option to supply their own antibody
components or procure those from other third parties.
We provide manufacturing services at different scales, including laboratory scale, non-GMP pilot
scale and cGMP-compliant commercial scale, to support our customers’ non-clinical, clinical and
commercialization needs. Overall, we are able to produce 500 liters of bioconjugate drug substance per
batch. With our existing filling lines, we are able to produce vialed drug products in liquid or lyophilized
form of up to approximately three million vials per annum. We will expand our facilities and increase our
manufacturing capacity. For additional information, see “— Facilities — Our Facility Expansion Plans.”
All of our manufacturing operations are conducted in accordance with our comprehensive quality
system that has been audited by multiple regulatory agencies, including the FDA, the EMA and the NMPA,
among others.
BUSINESS
— 191 —


--- page 201 ---
Following bioconjugate drug substance and drug product manufacturing, we perform lot release
testing to confirm that the manufacturing of every batch is performed correctly and the product from every
batch meets the relevant anticipated quality requirements.
CMC Regulatory Support
Our customers typically need to make filings to the relevant authorities before they can initiate
clinical trials for their bioconjugates or commercialize their bioconjugates. We support our customers’
regulatory filings by drafting filing dossiers, addressing regulatory questions and conducting cGMP
readiness assessments for them. We possess extensive knowledge and experience with regard to regulatory
filings in major jurisdictions including China, the United States and Europe. In addition, as a number of
payload-linkers in our library have maintained drug master files (“ DMFs ”) with the FDA, they are ready
for IND filings.
FACILITIES
Our Current Facilities
We are headquartered in Wuxi, China. As of the Latest Practicable Date, we operated three sites in
Wuxi, Shanghai and Changzhou. These sites are proximately located within a 200-kilometer radius, or
approximately a two-hour drive. Generally, each of these operation sites focuses on differentiated
segments of the bioconjugate discovery, development and manufacturing value chain, and they
collectively enable us to provide integrated and comprehensive service offerings for ADCs and other
bioconjugates.
We believe that our proximately located sites in China can effectively reduce logistical challenges,
shorten ADC and broader bioconjugates production time with assured quality and potentially reduce the
overall costs. For instance, we are able to transfer components for bioconjugates across our sites without
going through long distances or long periods and with less release or receiving testings. While the
development timelines for different ADCs and broader bioconjugates vary, these benefits may in certain
cases save months of development period. When components of an ADC are produced at multiple
manufacturing sites located in different regions around the globe, it may take one to three months to ship
those components between different manufacturing sites. In contrast, because the our operation sites in
China are proximately located and manufacturing functions are primarily hosted at our Wuxi site, it would
take much less shipping time for us to transport components of ADCs between or within its own sites,
which potentially contributes to a shortened overall development and manufacturing period. Moreover,
antibody intermediates, as a type of bioactive material, are proteins and may be affected by long-distance
or long-time shipping, which could adversely impact the protein stability and in turn affect the
productivity and quality of the subsequent manufacturing process. We are also able to better coordinate
development and manufacturing operations at different closely-located sites to conduct multiple steps in
parallel and run iterations seamlessly to improve the overall productivity and efficiency, which may also
potentially contribute to a shortened overall development time. As those steps are conducted according to
the same quality standard of ours, and the components of bioconjugate production can avoid long distance
or long period shipping that may adversely affect their quality, we are able to better perform quality
control across components and production steps. Moreover, with proximately located facilities, we can
more easily assume the full project management responsibility for the projects and enable seamless
technology transfer and quality assurance, which ensure the service quality and speed of delivery. In
BUSINESS
— 192 —


--- page 202 ---
general, we are able to reduce the standard industry timeline and process from the antibody DNA sequence
to bioconjugate IND filing in approximately 13 to 15 months. We are also able to reduce the typical GMP
production cycle of an ADC product from approximately one and half years to a few months.
The following table sets forth a summary of certain key information about our facilities as of the
Latest Practicable Date. For more property information about these sites, see “— Properties.”
Site
Site Area
(sq.m.) Owned/Leased Primary Use Capacity Utilization Rate (1)
W u x i........ 48,067 Owned Drug
Substance/Drug
Product
 GMP-compliant
production
 Formulation and
analytical
development
 QC release and
stability testing
Antibody
Intermediates for
Bioconjugates
 GMP-compliant
production
Conjugation drug substance and
antibody intermediates production
 Conjugation drug substance
production line (“XBCM1”)
with single-use reactor systems
ranging from five liters to 500
liters to produce up to 500 liters
of conjugation drug substance.
 The dual-function production
line for antibody intermediates
for bioconjugates and drug
substance (“XmAb/XBCM2”) is
designed with capacities ranging
from 200 liters to 2,000 liters
per batch for monoclonal
antibody intermediates or up to
2,000 liters of bioconjugate drug
substance per batch.
Conjugation drug
substance
production
 51% (2020)
 73% (2021)
 85% (2022)
Conjugation drug
product production
 38% (2020)
 57% (2021)
 78% (2022)
Conjugation drug product
production
 The conjugation drug product
(“XDP1”) facility is designed to
produce the liquid and
lyophilization dosage forms with
the annual capacity of up to
three million vials in an isolated
filling line equipped with one 5
sq.m. lyophilizer and one 20
sq.m. lyophilizer.
 The conjugation drug product
(“XDP2”) facility is designed to
produce the liquid and
lyophilization dosage forms with
the annual capacity of up to five
million vials in an isolated
filling line equipped with one 5
sq.m. lyophilizer and one 20
sq.m. lyophilizer.
BUSINESS
— 193 —


--- page 203 ---
Site
Site Area
(sq.m.) Owned/Leased Primary Use Capacity Utilization Rate (1)
Shanghai
Waigaoqiao . . .
8,927 Owned Bioconjugate
discovery and
process development
 Bioconjugate
discovery,
research and
process
development
 Analytical and
formulation
development
 Scale-up
conjugation
Discovery lab
 Laboratories for bioconjugate
discovery and process
development.
Bioconjugate process development
lab
 Laboratory-scale sample
preparation to pilot-scale
manufacturing of ADCs and
other bioconjugates.
N/A
Changzhou ..... 8 1 9 Leased Payload-linker
 Discovery,
research and
process and
analytical
development
 Pilot-scale
synthesis
 GMP-compliant
production
Payload-linker
 Laboratory with a field-tested
containment design to safely
handle highly potent compounds
that are OEB5-rated materials.
 Equipped with reaction kettles
for GMP-compliant production
with capacity of up to 150
liters, enabling kilogram-scale
production of payload-linkers.
N/A
(1) The utilization rate for a particular year is calculated using the actual days in that year that our facilities are in operation to
carry out manufacturing projects for customers (including the actual manufacturing and the necessary clean-up steps) divided
by the theoretical maximum days in a year that the manufacturing facilities can be in operation assuming non-stop operations
(being 350 days, taking into account total downtime of 15 days for necessary equipment maintenance).
We do not calculate the utilization rate for the Shanghai Waigaoqiao or Changzhou sites, as those sites are primarily
laboratories, instead of manufacturing facilities, for bioconjugate discovery, process development and payload-linkers. The
production lines XmAb/XBCM2 and XDP2 in our Wuxi site commenced operation in September 2023 and are therefore not
taken into account in the calculation of utilization rate for 2020, 2021 and 2022.
Wuxi Site
Our Wuxi site houses our manufacturing facilities for antibody intermediates for bioconjugates,
bioconjugate drug substances and drug products, providing services such as cGMP-compliant
manufacturing of ADCs and other complex protein conjugates, formulation and process development,
technology transfer, lot release testing, stability studies, drug product formulation, fill and finish, and
regulatory support.
We have built a conjugation production line at the Wuxi site with single-use reactor systems ranging
from five liters to 500 liters, purification systems leveraging filtration and chromatography technologies,
a temperature control unit with agile operation and high accuracy, and a well-developed rapid cooling
system for specific products. We have also built a dual-function production line, which commenced
operation in September 2023, for antibody intermediaries for bioconjugates and drug substance with
BUSINESS
— 194 —


--- page 204 ---
designed capacities up to 2,000 liters per batch. We expect the dual-function production line to enable us
to meet a large portion of our own antibody intermediate requirements. Our Wuxi site also has other
equipment that can be adapted as needed in accordance with our customers’ needs. We believe compared
to traditional stainless-steel reactors, single-use reactors possess many advantages, including shorter
downtimes, reduced cleaning and sterilization efforts, a significantly lower risk of cross contaminations,
flexibility and easy shifts in portfolios based on market needs.
The filling line at our Wuxi site adopts a fully isolated and automatically aseptic filling system,
which is compatible with liquid and lyophilized product forms and multiple vial sizes from two milliliters
to 50 milliliters. The Wuxi site also houses five-square meter and twenty-square meter lyophilizers with
fully automated loading and unloading systems. We have also set up pilot plants for the process
development of conjugation and drug product and carry out scale-up activities.
The utilization rate of our facilities at Wuxi site for bioconjugate drug substance manufacturing was
51%, 73% and 85% in 2020, 2021 and 2022, respectively. For bioconjugate drug product manufacturing,
the utilization rate of the relevant facilities at Wuxi site was 38%, 57% and 78% in 2020, 2021 and 2022,
respectively. The utilization rates do not take into account production lines XmAb/XBCM2 and XDP2 in
our Wuxi site, which commenced operation in September 2023. The utilization rate for a particular year
is calculated using the actual days in that year that our facilities are in operation to carry out manufacturing
projects for customers (including the actual manufacturing and the necessary clean-up steps) divided by
the theoretical maximum days in a year that the manufacturing facilities can be in operation assuming
non-stop operations (being 350 days, taking into account total downtime of 15 days for necessary
equipment maintenance). According to Frost & Sullivan, there is no unified industry practice or common
method of measurement for calculating the capacity or utilization rate of manufacturing facilities for
CRDMOs like us.
Shanghai Site
Our Shanghai site in the Waigaoqiao Free Trade Zone houses our laboratories for bioconjugate
discovery and process development, as well as facilities for laboratory-scale sample preparation to
pilot-scale manufacturing of ADCs and other bioconjugates. Through these facilities, we support our
customers in exploring combinations of biologic and small molecule components, identifying suitable
conjugation technologies and processes, and establishing purification, analytical and validation methods,
among others. We also carry out scale-up conjugation production to identify any potential production
challenges and generate sufficient amount of bioconjugate products for subsequent CMC and other studies.
We utilize various equipment at our Shanghai site. For example, we use AKTA chromatography
systems and ultrafiltration/diafiltration systems to purify conjugation products. We also deploy mass-
spectrometers and high-performance liquid chromatography to analyze the various intermediates and
products for characterization and quality control purposes. Our Shanghai site is also equipped with other
analytical or protective instrumentation, which are utilized to test bioconjugates, ensure aseptic production
and handle highly potent compounds.
Changzhou Site
As part of our acquisition of the Payload & Linker business unit from STA, we have leased from STA
and operated the relevant operation site in Changzhou. The Changzhou site houses payload-linker
facilities, providing services such as the discovery, research, process development and analytical
BUSINESS
— 195 —


--- page 205 ---
development of payload-linkers. We also carry out pilot-scale synthesis or GMP-compliant production of
payload-linkers to support our comprehensive bioconjugate discovery, development and manufacturing
services, as well as to offer off-the-shelf payload-linkers for customers in need.
The Changzhou site includes a laboratory with a GFA of approximately 600 sq.m. with a field-tested
containment design to safely handle highly potent compounds that OEB5-rated materials. The site is also
equipped with reaction kettles for GMP-compliant production with capacity of up to 150 liters, enabling
us to produce payload-linkers at a kilogram scale. The Changzhou site is capable of carrying out a wide
variety of chemical reactions, including hydrogenation and temperature-sensitive or light-sensitive
reactions pertaining to high-potent compounds. It is equipped with isolation and purification instruments,
such as HPLC purification and lyophilization systems that can work under GMP conditions. At the
Changzhou site, we also develop quantitative analytical methods for payload-linkers and conduct release
tests and stability studies to ensure product quality.
Our Facility Expansion Plans
The following table sets forth a summary of certain key information about our facility expansion
plans as of the Latest Practicable Date.
Site
Site Area
(sq.m.) Owned/Leased Primary Use Designed Capacity
W u x i......... 48,067 (the new
facility will be
hosted in an
existing building)
Owned Clinical or commercial
manufacturing of payload-linker, in
addition to existing clinical or
commercial manufacturing of
antibody intermediates, drug
substance and drug product
Payload-linker production line
(XPLM1)
 Equipped with reaction kettles
with capacity of 5 to 100 liters
Singapore ....... 18,500 Land acquisition
in process
Clinical or commercial
manufacturing of antibody
intermediates, drug substance and
drug product
Antibody intermediates and drug
substance production
 Dual-function XmAb/XBCM3
production line with capacity of
producing 200 liters to 2,000
liters per batch for monoclonal
antibody intermediates and up to
2,000 liters per batch of
bioconjugate drug substance
 XBCM4 production line with
capacity of up to 500 liters of
bioconjugate drug substance per
batch
Conjugation drug product
production
 Two drug product manufacturing
lines with annual capacities of
up to eight million vials and
three million vials, respectively
BUSINESS
— 196 —


--- page 206 ---
Wuxi Site
We seek to expand our manufacturing capabilities and capacity at the Wuxi site, so that our
capabilities encompass the full-spectrum from antibody intermediates to drug products to achieve
self-sufficient operations, and our capacity meets the needs of multiple late-stage bioconjugate
development and manufacturing projects. We believe our expansion plan for the Wuxi site would allow us
to further integrate manufacturing functions, expedite timelines and facilitate quality assurance, and to
enable us keep pace with the growing global demand for bioconjugate outsourcing services.
In particular, we are building additional facilities in Wuxi for clinical or commercial manufacturing,
including a kilogram-scale payload-linker production line (“ XPLM1 ”), which will be equipped with
reaction kettles for GMP-compliant production with capacity of 5 to 100 liters. XPLM1 will be hosted in
an existing building at the Wuxi site, therefore no additional regulatory approvals are required for the
facility expansion. We expect that the XPLM1 facility will commence GMP-compliant operations in the
fourth quarter of 2023.
We will continue to assess our manufacturing capacity from time to time based on the projects in our
pipeline and the utilization rate of our manufacturing facilities in operation. Should the need arise, we will
plan and build additional manufacturing facilities at our Wuxi site ahead of time.
Singapore Site
Outside of China, we are planning to establish a manufacturing base in Singapore to meet the
growing demand from customers worldwide for comprehensive bioconjugate CRDMO services and
implement a “global dual sourcing” strategy, which supports continuous and timely provision of services
to our customers around the globe. We selected Singapore as the location of our new manufacturing
facility because Singapore is a vibrant hub of the global biopharmaceutical industry that may bring us
significant opportunities in brand promotion and customer acquisition.
The planned Singapore site with a total site area of approximately 18,500 sq.m. will be located in
the new CRDMO center in Tuas, Singapore.
Four production lines are planned to be established at the Singapore site for clinical and commercial
manufacturing, including a dual-function production line for antibody intermediates for bioconjugates and
drug substance (“ XmAb/XBCM3 ”), a production line for drug substance (“ XBCM4 ”), as well as two drug
product manufacturing lines (“ XDP3 ” and “ XDP4 ”). The dual-function XmAb/XBCM3 facility is
designed with capabilities ranging from 200 liters to 2,000 liters per batch for monoclonal antibody
intermediates or up to 2,000 liters of bioconjugate drug substance per batch. The XBCM4 facility is
designed with capabilities of up to 500 liters of bioconjugate drug substance per batch. The conjugation
drug product facilities XDP3 and XDP4 are designed to produce the liquid and lyophilization dosage forms
with the annual capacity of up to eight million vials and three million vials in isolated filling lines
equipped with one 10 sq.m. lyophilizer and two 30 sq.m. lyophilizers, and one 5 sq.m. lyophilizer and one
10 sq.m. lyophilizer, respectively. Our facilities in China will supply the payload-linkers needed for
Singapore site’s operations. We do not expect the transport of such payload-linkers will significantly
increase the operating costs of our facilities, as the transportation of payload-linkers is generally
uncomplicated, and we plan to utilize bulk shipment to lower potential transportation and logistics
expenses. We have started the design of the site and expect to commence GMP-compliant operations by
2026.
BUSINESS
— 197 —


--- page 207 ---
As of the Latest Practicable Date, the WXB Group had secured a land offer from the relevant
authority in Singapore for its Singapore expansion as well as our Singapore site. We were formulating the
detailed construction plan as of the same date. We are not aware of any existing or potential legal
impediments in connection with the planned construction. We intend to fund the establishment of the
Singapore site by using part of the net proceeds from the Global Offering. For additional information, see
“Future Plans and Use of Proceeds” in this prospectus.
RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
We believe research and development is critical to bolster our fully integrated one-stop bioconjugate
discovery, development and manufacturing platform and propel our future growth to remain competitive
in the global bioconjugate outsourcing services market. Our research and development activities are
mainly focused on (i) developing and applying technologies that enhance our integrated and
comprehensive services, in particular to enrich our discovery capabilities, build and apply conjugation
technologies, novel carriers and payload-linkers, and deepen process development expertise including
drug product formulations, among others, and (ii) improving the quality and efficiency of our services and
minimizing costs. Our research and development activities regarding conjugation technologies and novel
carriers and payload-linkers mainly involve expanding the scope of our capabilities in generating and
developing proper processes for different types of bioconjugates, which we refer to as “XDCs,” and
improve the overall quality of those XDCs. During the Track Record Period, we researched and developed
a rich portfolio of conjugation technologies, including optimizing and expanding the application of our
proprietary conjugation technologies, as well as deployed various types of payload-linkers. We have
completed CMC development and initiated GMP manufacturing using over 10 conjugation technologies
for both ADC and other bioconjugates. We believe these efforts and proprietary technologies generated
would keep us ahead of other competitors and enable our customers to develop first-in-class or
best-in-class bioconjugate products for a broader range of therapeutic areas. As of the Latest Practicable
Date, we had 425 research and development personnel, of which 320 hold a master’s or higher degree.
For the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023,
our research and development expenses were RMB4.1 million, RMB13.8 million, RMB33.8 million and
RMB29.7 million, respectively, accounting for 4.2%, 4.4%, 3.4% and 3.0% of our revenue for the
corresponding periods. For a more detailed discussion of our research and development expenses, see
“Financial Information” of this prospectus. We expect to experience an increase in our research and
development expenses generally in line with the growth of our revenue going forward.
EMPLOYEES
As of the Latest Practicable Date, we had a total of 1,113 employees, of whom 270 were located in
Shanghai, 718 were located in Wuxi, Jiangsu Province and 114 were located in Changzhou, Jiangsu
Province. One employee was located in Hong Kong, one employee, who primarily supported our business
development activities in Europe, was located in Germany, and nine employees were working from home
as of the same date. As of the Latest Practicable Date, we had 510 employees who have obtained a master’s
or higher degree, with 82 holding a Ph.D. or equivalent degree.
We have established independent key functional departments, including finance and internal audit.
We intend to enter into relevant agreements with the Remaining WXB Group regarding the sharing of
certain general administrative services with respect to business development, human resources,
information technology and other general administrative services. We intend such shared functions to
BUSINESS
— 198 —


--- page 208 ---
relate only to peripheral aspects of our business operations and can be easily replicated by ourselves
should we decide to do so. For additional details, see “Connected Transactions.” The table below sets forth
a breakdown of our employees by function as of the Latest Practicable Date.
Function Number of Employees
Research and development ........................................ 4 2 5
Bioconjugation manufacturing ...................................... 4 2 3
Quality assurance and quality control ................................. 1 4 9
Management and administration ..................................... 1 1 6
Total ........................................................ 1,113
We believe that our success depends in part on our ability to attract, recruit and retain quality
employees. We enter into individual employment contracts and confidentiality agreements with our
employees. The employment contracts cover matters such as wages, benefits and grounds for termination.
The remuneration package of our employees generally includes salary and bonus elements. In general, we
determine the remuneration package based on the qualifications, position and performance of our
employees. We also make contributions to social insurance fund, including basic pension insurance,
medical insurance, unemployment insurance, childbirth insurance, work-related injury insurance funds,
and housing reserve fund. In addition, we have adopted share option schemes to provide an additional
means to attract, motivate, retain and reward our employees.
The contracts with our key management and research personnel typically include a standard
non-compete agreement that prohibits the employee from competing with us, directly or indirectly, during
his or her employment and typically for one to two years after the termination of his or her employment.
The contracts also typically include undertakings regarding assignment of inventions and discoveries
made during his or her employment.
We provide our employees with opportunities to work on cutting-edge projects on ADCs and other
bioconjugates to develop their knowledge and skills. We have an effective training system, including
orientation and continuous on-the-job training, to accelerate the learning progress and improve the
knowledge and skill levels of our workforce. The orientation process for newly joined employees covers
subjects such as corporate culture and policies, work ethics, introduction to the ADC and other
bioconjugate development process, quality management, as well as occupational safety. Our periodic
on-the-job training covers streamlined technical know-hows of our integrated services, environmental,
health and safety management systems and mandatory training required by applicable laws and
regulations. We also aim to further enhance a collaborative work environment that encourages our
employees to develop their career with us.
In support of our growth, we pay close attention to our capabilities and adjust our workforce to
ensure that our workforce can meet the demand for our services. During the Track Record Period, we had
primarily adopted a direct recruitment policy to seek talents from recent graduates of top universities
through on-campus recruiting events in China and recruit lateral employees with the suitable background.
We believe that we maintain a good working relationship with our employees. We had not
experienced any material labor disputes or any material difficulties in recruiting employees for our
operations during the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date.
BUSINESS
— 199 —


--- page 209 ---
PROJECT MANAGEMENT
We have developed a project management methodology to ensure timely, consistent and accurate
delivery of quality services. We generally assume full project management responsibility for our projects.
Upon receiving a new project from a customer, our project management team will set the schedule of the
project and liaise with other departments to determine the staffing of the project team. A leading scientist
is usually appointed, who is primarily responsible for overall planning, overseeing the entire project and
facilitating discussions and coordination to achieve a seamless alignment between upstream and
downstream functions to smoothen project execution. Scientists assigned on a project team are typically
divided into several groups based on the type of services to be provided. Each group is assigned a group
leader who is responsible for supervising the services carried out by such group and reporting back to the
leading scientist of the project team.
Our project management team also works closely with the project team to monitor the progress of
the project and liaises with the customer through daily emails, bi-weekly reports and regular conference
calls to give the customer timely updates of the progress of the project. To ensure our service quality, each
technical report will be reviewed by the head of the relevant department before being submitted to the
customer.
We strictly adhere to our internal quality and project management processes. We believe our
processes, methodologies and knowledge management systems reduce the overall cost for our customers
and enhance the quality and speed of delivery.
SALES AND MARKETING
We market our services directly to pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies through regular
sales meetings with their representatives and senior management. During those meetings, we highlight the
advantages of our integrated and comprehensive service capabilities and emphasize on how we can address
challenges associated with the discovery, development and manufacturing of ADCs and other
bioconjugates to save time and costs. We utilize multiple digital marketing and promotional channels,
including advertisements, press releases, social media, webinars, podcasts and email updates, to promote
our technologies, platforms and services. We also provide extensive information about our integrated
services and our technology platform, our competitive and technical advantages and training and
educational resources on our corporate website.
In addition, we actively participate in trade conferences, trade shows and scientific conferences.
While the COVID-19 pandemic affected the way we interacted with customers, particularly in China, as
interactions between large groups were primarily virtual events, we were nonetheless able to participate
in many in-person targeted events such as the World ADC London and San Diego conferences tailored to
the ADC market. We are of the view that the COVID-19 pandemic did not have a prolonged material
adverse impact on our sales and marketing efforts, and we were able to grow the number of customers we
served each year during the Track Record Period. With the lifting of COVID-19 restrictions in China and
overseas, we expect to participate in more in-person meetings with customers and industry players to
cultivate relationships and solidify brand recognition. Since our inception, our senior management has
been actively involved in managing our sales and marketing activities and maintaining direct relationships
with our key customers.
BUSINESS
— 200 —


--- page 210 ---
Our sales and marketing efforts are supported by a team of well-trained specialists who are dedicated
to understanding the demands of existing and prospective customers and work closely with our technical
experts to prepare quotes and to secure customer orders. We also gain our business through referrals from
our customers.
CUSTOMERS
Our diverse and growing customer base includes both innovative biotechnology companies and
global pharmaceutical companies, many of which are leading players in the ADC and bioconjugate space
with potentially first-in-class or best-in-class pipeline programs. We provide tailored laboratory
configuration and setup, research plans, operating procedures, information technology and security
protocols to our customers to suit their specifications.
During the Track Record Period, part of our bioconjugate CRDMO services were provided to
customers that had formally contracted with the Remaining WXB Group. Because these contracts were
entered into before the Spin-off, the customers did not directly contract with a member of our Group. We
view this practice as being in line with our historical development. After the formation of joint venture
in May 2021 between WuXi Biologics and STA Pharmaceutical, we started to gradually educate customers
about our distinct capacity and encourage customers to sign contracts directly with members of our Group.
We will continue to contract directly with our customers going forward. For additional information about
the historical amount of the ADC Master Services Agreement in each period of the Track Record Period,
see “Connected Transactions.”
We have a broad, loyal and fast-growing customer base globally. We served a total of 49, 115, 167
and 169 ultimate customers (taking into account the customers of the legacy contracts who formally
contracted with the Remaining WXB Group but made use of our bioconjugate CRDMO services) in each
year of 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively. In the first six months of
2023, 37.0%, 35.9%, 23.1% and 4.0% of the total revenue was generated from ultimate customers from
North America, China, Europe and the rest of the world, respectively, based on the location of the
customers’ headquarters. For a breakdown of our total revenue by geographic locations, see “Financial
Information.” During the same periods, our five largest ultimate customers contributed to 51.9%, 39.8%,
34.1% and 45.7%, respectively, of our total revenue, and our largest ultimate customer accounted for
14.5%, 13.1%, 8.9% and 13.2%, respectively, of our total revenue. See “Risk Factors — Risks Relating
to Our Business and Industry — The potential loss of major customers or any of our large contracts could
materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations” for more
information.
BUSINESS
— 201 —


--- page 211 ---
The following table sets forth certain information about our five largest ultimate customers in terms
of revenue generated in the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June
30, 2023, respectively. We provided CRDMO services to these customers.
Customers
Relationship
Since (1) Background
For the six months ended June 30, 2023
Number of
Projects
Development
Stage Revenue
Revenue
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Customer A . . . 2015 A global healthcare company
headquartered in the U.S.
primarily engaged in innovative
drug development. It recorded
over US$55 billion in revenue
in 2022. It is listed on the New
Y ork Stock Exchange.
11 Pre-IND +
Post-IND
131.3 13.2
Customer B . . . 2021 A clinical-stage company
headquartered in China
committed to the R&D,
manufacturing and
commercialization of novel
drugs and has more than 10
clinical-stage assets under
development in oncology,
immunology and other
therapeutic areas since
incorporation in 2016. It has
established collaboration
partnerships with leading
pharmaceutical companies. It
generated over RMB800
million in revenue in 2022,
which is mainly from license
and collaboration agreements.
It is listed on the HKEx.
5 Post-IND 131.2 13.2
Customer C . . . 2020 A clinical-stage company
headquartered in China
focusing on the discovery and
development of the ADC
therapeutics for cancer and
autoimmune diseases. It has
several clinical-stage assets
under development, which are
for the treatment of tumors,
including two assets in the
Phase II stage. It formed a
global strategic partnership
with a leading European
biotechnology company in
April 2023, with the
development, regulatory and
commercial milestone payments
potentially totaling over
US$1.5 billion. It is not listed
on any stock exchange.
10 Pre-IND +
Post-IND
72.9 7.3
BUSINESS
— 202 —


--- page 212 ---
Customers
Relationship
Since (1) Background
For the six months ended June 30, 2023
Number of
Projects
Development
Stage Revenue
Revenue
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Customer D . . 2021 A biotechnology company
headquartered in France
founded in 2018, focusing on
the discovery and development
of ADCs in solid tumor and
hematology fields. It has one
preclinical-stage asset under
development for the treatment
of tumors as well as multiple
assets in discovery stage. It is
not listed on any stock
exchange.
2 Pre-IND 69.0 6.9
Customer E . . . 2019 A U.S.-based clinical-stage
company developing antibody-
based therapeutics. It has
several clinical-stage assets
under development, which are
for the treatment of tumors. It
is also developing a broad
pipeline of novel preclinical
ADCs and monoclonal
antibodies for oncology
indications. It is not listed on
any stock exchange.
5 Pre-IND +
Post-IND
50.7 5.1
Total 455.1 45.7
Customers
Relationship
Since (1) Background
For the year ended December 31, 2022
Number of
Projects
Development
Stage Revenue
Revenue
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Customer C . . . 2020 A clinical-stage company
headquartered in China
focusing on the discovery and
development of the ADC
therapeutics for cancer and
autoimmune diseases. It has
several clinical-stage assets
under development, which are
for the treatment of tumors,
including two assets in the
Phase II stage. It formed a
global strategic partnership
with a leading European
biotechnology company in
April 2023, with the
development, regulatory and
commercial milestone payments
potentially totaling over
US$1.5 billion. It is not listed
on any stock exchange.
7 Pre-IND +
Post-IND
87.8 8.9
BUSINESS
— 203 —


--- page 213 ---
Customers
Relationship
Since (1) Background
For the year ended December 31, 2022
Number of
Projects
Development
Stage Revenue
Revenue
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Customer A . . . 2015 A global healthcare company
headquartered in the U.S.
primarily engaged in innovative
drug development. It recorded
over US$55 billion in revenue
in 2022. It is listed on the New
Y ork Stock Exchange.
5 Post-IND 78.3 7.9
Customer F . . . 2021 A U.S.-based clinical-stage
company focusing on
developing cancer therapeutics.
It has several clinical-stage
assets under development,
which are for the treatment of
various types of tumors. It is
listed on the Nasdaq.
2 Post-IND 66.4 6.7
Customer E . . . 2019 A U.S.-based clinical-stage
company developing antibody-
based therapeutics. It has
several clinical-stage assets
under development, which are
for the treatment of tumors. It
is also developing a broad
pipeline of novel preclinical
ADCs and monoclonal
antibodies for oncology
indications. It is not listed on
any stock exchange.
7 Pre-IND +
Post-IND
61.5 6.2
Customer B . . . 2021 A clinical-stage company
headquartered in China
committed to the R&D,
manufacturing and
commercialization of novel
drugs and has more than 10
clinical-stage assets under
development in oncology,
immunology and other
therapeutic areas since
incorporation in 2016. It has
established collaboration
partnerships with leading
pharmaceutical companies. It
generated over RMB800
million in revenue in 2022,
which is mainly from license
and collaboration agreements.
It is listed on the HKEx.
4 Post-IND 43.6 4.4
Total 337.6 34.1
BUSINESS
— 204 —


--- page 214 ---
Customers
Relationship
Since (1) Background
For the year ended December 31, 2021
Number of
Projects
Development
Stage Revenue
Revenue
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Customer A . . . 2015 A global healthcare company
headquartered in the U.S.
primarily engaged in innovative
drug development. It recorded
over US$55 billion in revenue
in 2022. It is listed on the New
Y ork Stock Exchange.
2 Post-IND 40.7 13.1
Customer G . . 2016 A U.S.-based clinical-stage
company developing antibody-
based therapeutics. It has
several clinical-stage assets
under development, which are
for the treatment of tumors,
including two assets in the
Phase II stage. It is listed on
the Nasdaq.
3 Pre-IND +
Post-IND
25.5 8.2
Customer H . . 2021 A South Korean clinical-stage
company dedicated to the
discovery and development of
innovative medicines. It has
several clinical-stage assets
under development, which
cover oncology, immunology
and other therapeutic areas,
including one asset in the
Phase III stage. It recorded
more than US$20 million in
revenue in 2022 and is listed
on KOSDAQ.
4 Pre-IND 22.2 7.1
Customer I . . . 2017 A U.S.-based company
developing targeted
therapeutics. It was listed on
the Nasdaq before merging
with another U.S.-based
biotechnology company in 2022
and the combined company
remained listed on the Nasdaq.
3 Pre-IND +
Post-IND
18.5 5.9
BUSINESS
— 205 —


--- page 215 ---
Customers
Relationship
Since (1) Background
For the year ended December 31, 2021
Number of
Projects
Development
Stage Revenue
Revenue
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Customer J . . . 2013 A biotechnology company
headquartered in the U.S.
dedicated to the discovery and
development of medicines. It is
a subsidiary of a leading global
pharmaceutical company and
has over 13,000 employees and
more than 40 marketed
medicines. It is not listed on
any stock exchange.
5 Pre-IND 17.1 5.5
Total 124.0 39.8
Customers
Relationship
Since (1) Background
For the year ended December 31, 2020
Number of
Projects
Development
Stage Revenue
Revenue
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Customer K . . . 2019 A clinical-stage biotechnology
company headquartered in
China with a clinical-stage
pipeline of ADCs. It has
several clinical-stage assets
under development, which are
for the treatment of tumors. It
is a subsidiary of a HKEx-
listed pharmaceutical company.
4 Post-IND 14.0 14.5
Customer J . . . 2013 A biotechnology company
headquartered in the U.S.
dedicated to the discovery and
development of medicines. It is
a subsidiary of a leading global
pharmaceutical company and
has over 13,000 employees and
more than 40 marketed
medicines. It is not listed on
any stock exchange.
5 Pre-IND 13.8 14.3
BUSINESS
— 206 —


--- page 216 ---
Customers
Relationship
Since (1) Background
For the year ended December 31, 2020
Number of
Projects
Development
Stage Revenue
Revenue
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Customer L . . . 2018 A U.S.-based clinical-stage
company primarily engaged in
the discovery and development
of cancer therapies. It was
acquired by Customer A in
2020 with a valuation of over
US$2.7 billion. It is not listed
on any stock exchange.
1 Post-IND 8.9 9.2
Customer M . . 2018 A U.S.-based clinical-stage
company developing drugs for
autoimmune diseases. It is a
subsidiary of a Japanese
pharmaceutical company. It is
not listed on any stock
exchange.
2 Pre-IND 7.5 7.8
Customer N . . 2019 A clinical-stage company
headquartered in South Korea
primarily engaged in
developing drugs in multiple
therapeutic areas. It has several
clinical-stage assets under
development, which cover
oncology and immune-
modulation, including one asset
in the Phase II stage. It is not
listed on any stock exchange.
1 Pre-IND 5.8 6.1
Total 50.0 51.9
(1) Denotes the first time when we were engaged, directly or through the Remaining WXB Group, to provide bioconjugate
CRDMO services.
In years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, our five
largest direct customers (i.e., customers directly contracted with us) for each year/period together
accounted for 98.0%, 91.1%, 61.2% and 53.3%, respectively, of our total revenue, and our largest direct
customer, the Remaining WXB Group, for each year/period accounted for 84.1%, 81.1%, 37.9% and
13.8%, respectively, of our total revenue. The significant decrease of the Remaining WXB Group’s
contribution to our revenue is largely due to our gradual entry into direct contractual relationship with our
customers.
BUSINESS
— 207 —


--- page 217 ---
During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, we had not encountered any
material dispute with our customers or any material breach of our service contracts or agreements. To the
best of our knowledge, as of the Latest Practicable Date, we were not aware of any information or
arrangement that would lead to termination of relationships between any key direct or ultimate customers
and its counterparty (i.e., the Remaining WXB Group or our Group). None of our Directors, their
respective associates, or Shareholders who, to the knowledge of our Directors, own 5% or more of our
issued share capital had any interest in any of our five largest direct or ultimate customers, other than with
respect to the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group, during the Track Record Period. For
additional information about our relationship with the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group, see
“Relationship with Our Controlling Shareholders” and “Connected Transactions.”
Key Contractual Terms with Our Customers
We generally enter into framework service agreements or project-based service contracts with our
customers for our services. Our framework service agreements typically do not have a maturity date and
set forth general rights and obligations of the parties. Services for each project under a framework service
agreement will be provided pursuant to a separate and distinct work order, which sets forth project
specifications, project management regime, project schedule and discovery, development and/or
manufacturing steps, rules governing reporting and transfer of data and results, service fee and payment
instructions. These work orders are not necessarily based on the development stages and instead are based
on the progress of projects and strategically align with the customers’ research and development needs.
Our project-based service contracts, which are of similar nature to the work orders under the framework
service agreements, typically have a term ranging from a number of months to several years. These
contracts terminate upon the completion of the relevant projects and set forth project specifications,
project management regime, project schedule and discovery, development and/or manufacturing steps,
payment terms, confidentiality obligations of the parties, ownership of intellectual property rights,
termination clause and other general terms and conditions.
The table below summarizes the key contractual terms under framework service agreements/work
orders and project-based service contracts with our customers. Our business operations are covered by
various insurance policies, including product liability and professional errors and omission insurance. See
“— Insurance” for additional information about our insurance.
Project Management The customer is entitled to visit the project site, with prior
written notice, to conduct on-site inspections and consult
with the researcher and development staff to monitor the
implementation of the project. Under project-based service
contracts, the customer and we will further establish a project
management committee, which is responsible for the review,
supervision and coordination of the project.
Outsourcing Unless otherwise approved by the customer, we are not
allowed to outsource the research and development services
to third parties other than our affiliates. We should bear joint
liabilities for such third parties, including our affiliates.
BUSINESS
— 208 —


--- page 218 ---
Billing The overall expenses consist of (i) the raw material expenses
and (ii) service fees. Each project under project-based service
contracts is divided into several sub-projects, and each work
order under framework service agreements is split into
several sub-activities, with detailed and pre-agreed research
content and work product. The service fees are billed upon
the completion of each research content, which is subject to
the customer’s inspection of the work product. Typically,
experimental failure, unless caused by us, would not affect
billing.
Inspection After completion of each research content, we will first
conduct the internal quality inspection, and then submit a
report, which is usually issued in our standardized platform
report format, and work product to the customer for
inspection. The customer also has the option to conduct its
own inspection and issue a report. Once the customer has
confirmed the report, the inspection and acceptance of the
deliverables are deemed complete. For project-based service
contracts, the customer should complete the inspection
typically within 10 business days. For framework service
agreements, the inspection period is generally 15 business
days.
Payment Generally, the payment is made by installment. For project-
based service contracts, the customer should make the first
payment, usually 30% of the overall expenses, after signing
the contract. The subsequent payment is made upon the
completion of research content and is settled on a monthly
basis. The customer should also make prepayments for the
initiation of significant sub-projects. For framework service
agreements, the payment is specified within each separate
and distinct work order and is charged by each individual
sub-activity therein. The customer should make the
payments, usually 50% and 50% of the overall expenses for
each sub-activity, at the initiation and upon completion of
such sub-activity, respectively.
BUSINESS
— 209 —


--- page 219 ---
Cancellation If the customer cancels any sub-project for project-based
service contracts or any work order for framework service
agreements, we may be required to seek other potential
alternative customers to avoid loss. If no such alternative
customers are available, we will charge the full amount of
raw material expenses and a portion of service fees, the
percentage of which is set based on the notice period of such
cancellation and/or the services rendered and all non-
cancelable obligations in connection with the services, and
the amount can be up to the full service fees. The percentage
we charge for cancellation based on the notice period of such
cancellation depends on the nature of the relevant work
initially requested and may be subject to negotiation on a
case-by-case basis. For example, for cancellation of a work
order for a cGMP manufacturing run and engineering run of
a bioconjugate product, percentages of service fees we charge
may be nil, 75% or 100% when we receive the cancellation
notice greater than 120 days before the scheduled cGMP
manufacturing run, between 61 to 120 days before the
scheduled cGMP manufacturing run, or within 60 days before
the scheduled manufacturing run or anytime thereafter,
respectively.
Our customers typically retain ownership of all intellectual property associated with their projects,
including both intellectual property it provides to us and that arises from the services we provide, except
for intellectual property created or developed in connection with the provision of our services that is
derivative of our own intellectual property or that relates to manufacturing processes developed at our
expense. Generally, the customer has, and in some cases we as well have, the right to terminate a
framework service agreement or project-based service contract or a work order under the framework
service agreement without cause by giving prior written notice (typically ranging from two months to six
months). In addition, each party typically has the right to terminate a framework service agreement or
project-based service contract or a work order under the framework service agreement immediately upon
notice to the other party if a material breach by the other party is not curable or remains uncured for a
period of time (typically ranging from 30 days to 90 days) after notice of the material breach is received
by the other party. If a customer terminates a project-based service contract or a work order, the customer
is typically obliged to pay for the services already rendered and costs and expenses already incurred or
irrevocably committed up to the date we receive the termination notice, and in some cases the customer
is also obliged to pay a cancellation fee. During the Track Record Period, there was no cancellation of
sub-projects.
During the Track Record Period, there were no material breaches of our service agreements either
on our part or the part of our customers, and there was no termination of any contract. We were not subject
to any exclusivity clause in our provision of services during the same period. There were no amount of
services fees that could not be collected as there were no dispute between customers and us on the
acceptance of deliverables during the Track Record Period.
BUSINESS
— 210 —


--- page 220 ---
Payment Terms
Under the FFS model, a contract or work order typically comprises a number of tasks, each including
several discovery, development and/or manufacturing steps. We bill our customers by task and typically
give our customers a credit term between 30 to 60 days. We typically require our customers to make a
portion of the corresponding payment upon the commencement of each task and the remaining payment
will be paid to us after we complete such task to the satisfaction of our customers. Under an FFS contract
or work order, we are typically required to deliver a technical laboratory report, product/samples and/or
other deliverables and transfer the relevant data and rights to the customer upon completion of each
discovery, development or manufacturing step. Upon the acceptance of such deliverables by our
customers, the relevant discovery, development or manufacturing step is deemed to be completed and
revenue is recognized. Under the FTE model, we typically require the customer to make monthly payments
for services rendered with a credit term between 30 to 60 days. With respect to the milestone fee structure,
we typically require the customer to make payment within 30 to 90 days after the completion of each
predefined milestone.
Customer Support
To facilitate project management, we have developed an online system allowing a customer’s project
manager to monitor and report on the progress of its projects through an encrypted website. Additionally,
our project team interacts with a customer’s project-management team through daily emails, bi-weekly
reports and regular conference calls. Our project management involves strict adherence to our strategic
imperative to protect our customers’ intellectual property and other confidential information. See “—
Intellectual Property” for more information.
We conduct frequent customer satisfaction surveys with certain key customers, which enable us to
measure key performance indicators to improve our planning, execution, evaluation and support. We focus
internally on operational improvement and innovation to achieve lower direct costs, better use of assets,
faster discovery and development time, increased accuracy, greater customization or precision of data,
more added value and simplified processes. Dedicated to improving responsiveness to our customers’
needs and inquiries, our customer support department focuses on sales support and relationship
management with our customers.
During the Track Record Period, our customers conducted an aggregate of approximately 60 audits
and inspections on our facilities. These audits and inspections are intended to ensure that the bioconjugates
manufactured at our facilities meet the cGMP requirements imposed by the relevant government
authorities (for example, the FDA and the NMPA) in the country or region in which the bioconjugates are
intended to be used in clinical trials or distributed after commercialization is approved. Our Directors
confirm that there were no material findings in the audits and inspections conducted by our customers or
material product quality complaints received from our customers during the Track Record Period.
BUSINESS
—2 1 1—


--- page 221 ---
SUPPLIERS
The raw materials and equipment required for the provision of our services are generally readily
available in the market through a number of suppliers. During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest
Practicable Date, we did not procure raw materials or equipment that were subject to export control laws
and regulations. During the Track Record Period, procurement of raw materials for the WXB Group was
conducted on a centralized basis, which had enabled us to benefit from the substantial economies of scale
that are associated with the magnitude of the global business of the WXB Group. During the Track Record
Period, we also sourced certain property, plant and equipment (“ PPE”) through the aforementioned
centralized procurement system rather than directly from suppliers. For additional information on the
arrangement, see “Connected Transactions.”
We trace the raw materials and PPE from third-party suppliers to our Group by matching the unique
material code in the transaction records of the WXB Group, and we thereby attribute expenses to specific
ultimate suppliers of our Group. We believe such treatment fairly depicts the relationship between our
Group and our ultimate suppliers during the Track Record Period. The following table sets forth certain
information about our five largest ultimate suppliers (on a grouped basis) in terms of purchases in 2020,
2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively.
Suppliers
Relationship
Since (1) Background and Principal Business
For the six months ended June 30, 2023
Main Services/
Products/
Equipment
Procured
Procurement
Amount
Procurement
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Remaining WXB
Group ......
2013 A leading global fully-integrated
biologics CRDMO providing one-stop,
end-to-end biologics services. Its
CRDMO platform enables clients and
partners from early as the discovery
and preclinical stages of product
development by establishing a strong
position in terms of program design,
to advancing promising programs into
the early and late stages of clinical
development and ultimately to
commercial manufacturing.
Service and
materials
483.3 60.8
WXA T Group . . . 2013 Headquartered in China, the company is
principally engaged in the provision
of research, development and
manufacturing services which include
chemistry drugs CRDMO, biology
discovery, preclinical testing and
clinical research services, and cell and
gene therapies CTDMO.
Service and
materials
65.0 8.2
BUSINESS
— 212 —


--- page 222 ---
Suppliers
Relationship
Since (1) Background and Principal Business
For the six months ended June 30, 2023
Main Services/
Products/
Equipment
Procured
Procurement
Amount
Procurement
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Supplier A ..... 2021 A China-based company engaging in
construction and engineering
contracting work.
Construction 33.8 4.3
Supplier B ..... 2022 Chinese headquarter of a U.S. non-profit
organization which is a medicine
standard-setting body.
Real estate 25.4 3.2
Supplier C ..... 2019 A U.S.-based supplier of scientific
instrumentation, reagents,
consumables, and software services.
Equipment and
materials
17.6 2.2
Total 625.1 78.7
Suppliers
Relationship
Since (1) Background and Principal Business
For the year ended December 31, 2022
Main Services/
Products/
Equipment
Procured
Procurement
Amount
Procurement
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Remaining WXB
Group ......
2013 A leading global fully-integrated
biologics CRDMO providing one-stop,
end-to-end biologics services. Its
CRDMO platform enables clients and
partners from early as the discovery
and preclinical stages of product
development by establishing a strong
position in terms of program design,
to advancing promising programs into
the early and late stages of clinical
development and ultimately to
commercial manufacturing.
Service and
materials
444.4 39.9
WXA T Group . . . 2013 Headquartered in China, the company is
principally engaged in the provision
of research, development and
manufacturing services which include
chemistry drugs CRDMO, biology
discovery, preclinical testing and
clinical research services, and cell and
gene therapies CTDMO.
Service and
materials
132.9 11.9
BUSINESS
— 213 —


--- page 223 ---
Suppliers
Relationship
Since (1) Background and Principal Business
For the year ended December 31, 2022
Main Services/
Products/
Equipment
Procured
Procurement
Amount
Procurement
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Supplier A ..... 2021 A China-based company engaging in
construction and engineering
contracting work.
Construction 99.4 8.9
Supplier B ..... 2022 Chinese headquarter of a U.S. non-profit
organization which is a medicine
standard-setting body.
Real estate 74.6 6.7
Supplier D ..... 2017 A China-based pharmaceutical
equipment supplier.
Equipment 49.0 4.4
Total 800.3 71.8
Suppliers
Relationship
Since (1) Background and Principal Business
For the year ended December 31, 2021
Main Services/
Products/
Equipment
Procured
Procurement
Amount
Procurement
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Remaining WXB
Group ......
2013 A leading global fully-integrated
biologics CRDMO providing one-stop,
end-to-end biologics services. Its
CRDMO platform enables clients and
partners from early as the discovery
and preclinical stages of product
development by establishing a strong
position in terms of program design,
to advancing promising programs into
the early and late stages of clinical
development and ultimately to
commercial manufacturing.
Service and
materials
31.7 15.0
WXA T Group . . . 2013 Headquartered in China, the company is
principally engaged in the provision
of research, development and
manufacturing services which include
chemistry drugs CRDMO, biology
discovery, preclinical testing and
clinical research services, and cell and
gene therapies CTDMO.
Service and
materials
23.3 11.0
BUSINESS
— 214 —


--- page 224 ---
Suppliers
Relationship
Since (1) Background and Principal Business
For the year ended December 31, 2021
Main Services/
Products/
Equipment
Procured
Procurement
Amount
Procurement
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Supplier A ..... 2021 A China-based company engaging in
construction and engineering
contracting work.
Construction 21.7 10.3
Supplier E ..... 2016 A Germany-based life sciences and
technology company providing a
range of healthcare and chemical
products.
Equipment and
materials
18.3 8.7
Supplier D ..... 2017 A China-based pharmaceutical
equipment supplier.
Equipment 16.2 7.7
Total 111.2 52.7
Suppliers
Relationship
Since (1) Background and Principal Business
For the year ended December 31, 2020
Main Services/
Products/
Equipment
Procured
Procurement
Amount
Procurement
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Supplier F ..... 2020 A China-based company engaging in
construction and engineering
contracting work.
Construction 24.5 32.8
Supplier E ..... 2016 A Germany-based life sciences and
technology company providing a
range of healthcare and chemical
products.
Equipment and
materials
4.5 6.0
Remaining WXB
Group ......
2013 A leading global fully-integrated
biologics CRDMO providing one-stop,
end-to-end biologics services. Its
CRDMO platform enables clients and
partners from early as the discovery
and preclinical stages of product
development by establishing a strong
position in terms of program design,
to advancing promising programs into
the early and late stages of clinical
development and ultimately to
commercial manufacturing.
Service and
materials
4.2 5.6
Supplier G ..... 2020 A China-based company offering design
and construction of pharmaceutical
fluid system.
Construction 3.4 4.5
BUSINESS
— 215 —


--- page 225 ---
Suppliers
Relationship
Since (1) Background and Principal Business
For the year ended December 31, 2020
Main Services/
Products/
Equipment
Procured
Procurement
Amount
Procurement
Contribution
(RMB in
millions) (%)
Supplier C ..... 2019 A U.S.-based supplier of scientific
instrumentation, reagents,
consumables, and software service.
Equipment and
materials
2.8 3.7
Total 39.4 52.6
(1) Denotes the first time we procured products or services directly or through the Remaining WXB Group from the supplier.
The following table sets forth the breakdown of the transaction amounts with the Remaining WXB
Group and the WXA T Group by purchase of services and materials during the Track Record Period.
For the year ended December 31,
For the six
months ended
June 30,
Suppliers Procured Content 2020 2021 2022 2023
(RMB in millions)
Remaining
WXB
Group
Service
(3) 1.9 30.0 441.1 477.1
Materials (2)/
Equipment
2.3 1.7 3.3 6.2
Subtotal 4.2 31.7 444.4 483.3
WXA T
Group
Service (3) – 19.7 67.6 62.6
Materials (3) – 3.6 65.3 2.4
Subtotal – 23.3 132.9 65.0
Notes:
1. These transaction amounts with the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group (the “ Business-related Amounts ”)
are different from the historical transaction amounts of the continuing connected transactions under “Connected
Transactions” of the Prospectus (the “ CCT-related Amounts ”) due to different accounting treatments only.
2. For the materials/equipment supplied between our Group and the Remaining WXB Group, the relevant Business-
related Amounts are presented on a “look-through basis” while the relevant CCT-related Amounts are presented on a
“non look-through basis”.
3. For the services supplied between our Group and the Remaining WXB Group and the services and materials supplied
between our Group and the WXA T Group, the differences are due to different accounting treatments including but not
limited to, labor cost adjustment related to share based payment expenses charged by the Remaining WXB Group to
our Group, expenses charged by the Remaining WXB Group to our Group such as supply chain expenses and staff costs
charged, V A T adjustment charged by our Group.
BUSINESS
— 216 —


--- page 226 ---
The raw materials procured through the centralized procurement system were predominantly
laboratory supplies, such as various types of liquid containers and mixer bags, tubing, filters and
chemicals. These laboratory supplies are readily available from various independent third parties,
according to Frost & Sullivan. The raw materials procured from independent third parties primarily
include chemical reagents and laboratory consumables. Going forward, as the business of our Group
continues to scale up, we intend to independently procure raw materials and expect to also benefit from
our own economies of scale. For the procurement of key equipment, we generally go through a tender
process and invite reputable suppliers to submit bids. The PPE procured from independent third parties
primarily include laboratory equipment, such as freeze dryers, packaging lines and filling lines. We
carefully select our suppliers based on various factors, including their qualifications, product selection,
quality, reputation, pricing, business scale, technological strengths, quality management capabilities and
overall services. We also request for documents such as licenses and permits and ascertain whether our
suppliers have any competitive relationships with us. Our suppliers typically extend to us credit terms
ranging between 30 days and 90 days.
We manage the raw materials’ inventory levels by monitoring the status of our ongoing projects and
incoming new projects and places orders through the centralized procurement system or with suppliers for
any inventory that is expected to decline below targeted levels. We procure raw materials and equipment
in accordance with our business expansion plan or to replace obsolete equipment on an as-needed basis.
Antibody intermediates are critical components of ADCs. Some customers supply their own antibody
intermediates for use in their projects, such that we do not need to procure antibody intermediates for such
project. For other cases where we do need to obtain antibody intermediates for a customer’s project, we
have sourced antibody intermediates, which are generally readily available, from reputable suppliers
including the Remaining WXB Group. For additional information about our connected transactions with
the Remaining WXB Group regarding antibody intermediates, see “Connected Transactions.” We expect
to have the option to manufacture such antibody intermediates using our own facilities that are under
construction or planned. We anticipate that the completion of our new facilities in Wuxi by the end of 2023
and the completion of the planned manufacturing facilities in Singapore in 2026 can help us meet a large
portion of our need for antibody intermediates. For additional information about our planned facility
expansion, see “— Facilities.”
In the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, our
five largest ultimate suppliers for each year/period together accounted for 52.6%, 52.7%, 71.8% and
78.7%, respectively, of our cost of services, and our largest ultimate supplier for each year/period
accounted for 32.8%, 15.0%, 39.9% and 60.8%, respectively, of our cost of services.
None of our Directors, their respective associates, or Shareholders who, to the knowledge of our
Directors, own 5% or more of our issued share capital had any interest in any of our five largest direct
or ultimate suppliers, other than with respect to the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group, during
the Track Record Period. During the Track Record Period, none of our major independent direct suppliers
was also our customer. For details of our connected transactions with the Remaining WXB Group and the
WXA T Group, see “Connected Transactions.”
BUSINESS
— 217 —


--- page 227 ---
During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, we had not encountered any
material dispute with our suppliers or any material breach of our supply contracts or agreements. We had
not experienced any material shortages of our supplies during the Track Record Period. To the best of our
knowledge, as of the Latest Practicable Date, we were not aware of any information or arrangement that
would lead to termination of our relationships with any of our major suppliers.
QUALITY MANAGEMENT
We believe that an effective quality management system for procuring raw materials, R&D and
manufacturing is critical to ensuring the quality of our services and maintaining our reputation and
success. We have inherited from the WXB Group and further developed an in-house quality management
system, and we have devoted significant attention to quality control and assurance. We seek to ensure that
our services consistently meet high industry standards and requirements. We have established a quality
assurance department, which is responsible for supervising the implementation of the quality standards.
Based on the research and development and specific manufacturing processes of bioconjugates, we have
established quality control measures for all stages of our operations, covering procurement of raw and
auxiliary materials, research and development and process development, and manufacturing of
bioconjugate intermediates, drug substances and drug products.
As of the Latest Practicable Date, our quality assurance department consisted of 35 dedicated
employees with biology, chemistry or related educational backgrounds, of whom 13 held master’s or
higher degrees. The department is led by Dr. Jincai Li, our executive Director and chief executive officer,
who has over 20 years of extensive experience in the pharmaceutical industry. Our quality assurance
department also organizes regular training programs to provide updates to its members regarding new
quality assurance measures and policies.
Raw Material and Equipment Quality Control
During the Track Record Period, we obtained a substantial part of raw materials from the Remaining
WXB Group through the WXB Group’s centralized procurement system. The WXB Group has a
field-tested raw material quality control system that ensures the quality and trustworthiness of raw
materials and their suppliers, and the procurement of raw materials by the WXB Group can benefit from
substantial economies of scale that are associated with the magnitude of its global business.
Going forward, as our business continues to scale up and reach certain economies of scale, we will
gradually procure our own raw materials independently. We will carefully select raw material suppliers
and conduct background checks on supplier candidates in the form of questionnaires and/or on-site audits.
For each supply of raw materials, we will request accompanying quality reports from the supplier, which
usually contain various quantitative analysis.
For our manufacturing projects, we also perform our own testing of each supply of raw materials,
such as the antibody intermediates, in accordance with quality requirements set forth in the relevant
specifications. We release raw materials into the manufacturing process only after receiving satisfactory
results from our internal testing. Each step of our raw material procurement is documented for our internal
records as well as customer audits. During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date,
we did not experience any material quality issue relating to our raw materials.
BUSINESS
— 218 —


--- page 228 ---
We purchase equipment and spares only from selected reputable suppliers. We conduct inspections
and relevant testing on the incoming equipment to ensure that the equipment is in satisfactory condition
and fully functional before we accept delivery from our suppliers. We also communicate with the technical
and customer support staff of our equipment suppliers regularly for the maintenance and upgrade of our
equipment.
R&D and Process Development Procedures
We have implemented comprehensive standard operating procedures to control the quality of service
and ensure that the research and development and process development procedures follow the relevant
GLP specifications. The quality assurance department is responsible for reviewing GLP experimental
plans and experiment execution process, submitting analysis reports to management, submitting
experimental plans and summary reports to the relevant regulatory authority, and participating in
management meetings to discuss quality/compliance matters, on a regular basis or as appropriate.
Manufacturing
We have also developed standard operating procedures for quality control in the manufacturing
process. We have specifically established quality assurance departments to review the integrity of each
batch of products manufactured, in order to ensure that cGMP-compliant quality standards are maintained
during the manufacturing process. Quality supervisors take samples from each batch of products and
laboratory technicians carry out quality inspections on each batch of finished products and issue inspection
reports based on the results. Samples that fail to pass the inspection are disposed of in accordance with
the requirements of the operating procedures for substandard products. In addition, the quality supervisors
are also responsible for the monitoring and supervision of clean environment of workshops to ensure the
cleanliness requirements of our facilities and the quality supervision of manufacturing process, and record
in a faithful manner to ensure traceability of product quality.
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY
Protection of Our Intellectual Property
We develop and use a number of proprietary methodologies, technologies, trade secrets, know-how
and other intellectual property during the conduct of our business. We rely on a combination of patent,
trademark, intellectual property laws and contractual arrangements to protect our intellectual property. As
of the Latest Practicable Date, the Remaining WXB Group had completed transfer and/or assignment of
material patents, patent applications, registered trademarks and pending trademark applications relating to
our business to us. In particular, we have been assigned with three issued patents relating to the
WuXiDAR4 technologies in the United States, Japan and Taiwan, 13 pending patent applications in China
and overseas, as well as seven registered trademarks relating to the WuXiDAR4 technologies in China, the
United States, the EU, the United Kingdom and Japan. See “Statutory and General Information — C.
Further Information about Our Business — 2. Intellectual Property Rights of Our Group” in Appendix IV
to this prospectus for further details of the material intellectual property rights. In addition, our Group has
not used, and has no intention to use, any intellectual property rights owned or developed by the WXA T
Group. As a result, we do not, and will not, rely on any intellectual property rights, trade secrets and
know-how belonging to our Controlling Shareholders for the operation of our business. See “Relationship
with Our Controlling Shareholders — Independence from Our Controlling Shareholders — Operational
Independence — Intellectual property rights” for detailed discussion on intellectual properties transfer and
assignment. Based on the Sponsors’ independent due diligence on the Company’s historical and current
BUSINESS
— 219 —


--- page 229 ---
IP practices, the Sponsors have no reason to believe that the Company will not be able to carry out its
operations without relying on any intellectual property, trade secrets and know-hows of the Controlling
Shareholders in its ADC CRDMO process.
We also rely on unpatented trade secrets or know-how to develop and maintain our competitive
position. Such trade secrets or know-how include various methodologies or techniques that we have
developed for key processes in the bioconjugate development, such as methods of purifying the desired
conjugation product from other molecules. We rely on such trade secrets and know-how, for example, to
plan, conduct and optimize the conditions for discovery, development and manufacture bioconjugates that
lead to high quality results for our customers. We strategically choose not to pursue patent protections over
certain know-how or trade secrets because we prefer not publishing such information as typically required
in the patent application process or subject such competitive advantages to limited terms of patent
exclusivity.
Our employees are bound by confidentiality obligations under their employment contracts and are
prohibited from disclosing the intellectual property of our customers’ and ours. During the Track Record
Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, to our knowledge, none of our employees breached the
confidentiality obligations under their employment contracts.
We enter into agreements with all of our employees under which they disown all intellectual property
they create during their employment and waive all relevant intellectual property rights or claims. All of
our employees have agreed to disclose and assign to us all inventions conceived by them during their term
of employment.
Protection of our Customers’ Intellectual Property
Our reputation and business success also depend on our ability to protect the intellectual property
rights of our customers. Due to the nature of our services, we typically have access to the drug chemistries,
production processes, formulations and other intellectual property owned by or licensed to our customers.
We strategically focus on the role of the partner of choice in discovering, developing and manufacturing
bioconjugates instead of the role of a drug maker ourselves and therefore do not have interests that conflict
with those of our customers. Our customers generally retain ownership of all intellectual property
associated with their projects, including the intellectual property that they provide to us and the
intellectual property arising from the services we provide.
Protecting the proprietary rights of our customers has been a top priority since our inception. We
have established an intellectual property protection process to properly manage the document transmission
and archiving, preservation of documents related to R&D and manufacturing, supervision and control of
laboratory computers and access to documents in connection with confidential information.
We put a heavy emphasis on record keeping, as our scientists’ notes can be used as original data in
support of regulatory submissions or patent applications. We are now switching from physical notebooks
to electronic notebooks for many of our customers. For physical notebooks, we periodically scan signed
and dated notebooks for electronic archiving. Our process preserves the documentation necessary to
establish intellectual property ownership should any disputes arise in the future. This process not only
significantly enhances the protection of key original information, but also increases customers’ confidence
and trust in our company.
BUSINESS
— 220 —


--- page 230 ---
In addition, we have established virtual and physical firewalls to protect the customer’s projects and
intellectual property. For instance, we have adopted a laboratory information management system
(“LIMS ”) to control information access on a need-to-know basis and to restrict system access in
connection with our bioconjugate discovery, development and manufacturing. The electronic record of one
customer’s project is isolated from that of another customer’s project and can only be accessed by the
relevant team members. We believe that our LIMS complies with all regulatory requirements regarding
security, including data integrity, compatibility and audit-trail generation. To the extent that we are able
to, each customer project has dedicated laboratory space equipped with key-card access control systems.
Most of our laboratory computers are not connected to the external internet, so that they cannot be
accessed by unauthorized external parties and have restricted data-transfer capabilities. We believe that the
firewalls restrict potential leaking or intermingling information of different customers and safeguard their
intellectual property.
Despite the measures and efforts we have taken to protect our own and our customers’ intellectual
property, unauthorized parties may attempt to obtain and use information that we regard as proprietary.
Under our contractual arrangements with our customers, we typically undertake to indemnify our
customers for damages resulting from any third-party intellectual property infringement claims that are
solely based on our intellectual property; our customers typically undertake to indemnify us for damages
resulting from any third-party intellectual property infringement claims other than those that are solely
based on our intellectual property. For more information, see “Risk Factors — Risks Relating to Our
Business and Industry — We may not be successful in protecting the intellectual property owned by us or
our customers or licensed from third parties.” During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest
Practicable Date, we were not subject to, nor were we party to, any intellectual property rights
infringement claims or litigations and were not aware of any material infringement of our intellectual
property rights that had a material adverse effect on our business. We had complied with all applicable
intellectual property laws and regulations in all material respects during the Track Record Period and up
to the Latest Practicable Date.
COMPETITION
We face competition from other third-party outsourcing service providers for the discovery,
development and manufacturing of ADCs and other bioconjugates. The global ADC and broader
bioconjugates outsourcing services market is relatively concentrated with the top five players accounting
for an aggregate market share of 50.0% in terms of revenue in 2022, according to Frost & Sullivan. Our
global market share by revenue increased from 1.8% in 2020 to 4.6% in 2021 and 9.8% in 2022, ranking
second in the global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market in 2022. We are the only
Chinese company among the top 5 players in terms of revenue in 2022. We ranked first in China, the most
active ADC and broader bioconjugates out-licensing market globally, with a market share of 69.5% in
terms of revenue in 2022, according to the same source.
We face competition based on several factors, including quality and breadth of services, timeliness
of delivery, price and geography, maintenance of GLP , GMP and cGMP standards and depth of customer
relationships. In terms of key success factors, according to Frost & Sullivan, the global ADC and broader
bioconjugates outsourcing services market generally favors participants with integrated and
comprehensive services capabilities, geographical proximity of facilities, proprietary technical
capabilities and proven quality track record to accomplish the highly regulated process. For more details,
see “Industry Overview — Overview of Global ADC and Broader Bioconjugates Outsourcing Services
Market.”
BUSINESS
— 221 —


--- page 231 ---
According to Frost & Sullivan, what has been an emerging trend in the bioconjugate outsourcing
market is the growing preference to CRDMOs like us that provide fully integrated one-stop services with
proven and consistent high-quality assurance. This is because using a single CRDMO brings multiple
advantages for ADC and bioconjugates developments which require interdisciplinary expertise and
collaboration, such as allowing a drug developer to simplify logistics coordination and vendor
management, reduce the complexity of technology transfer and expedited the timeline for its drugs to
reach the market. In the meantime, for smaller CRDMOs, it requires considerable investments of time and
resources that may be out of the reach to build a bioconjugate platform as comprehensive as ours, acquire
the necessary technologies and accumulate industry know-how.
We believe that we are able to maintain our services’ competitiveness by leveraging our established
position in the global ADC and other bioconjugate outsourcing services market and capitalizing on the
opportunities offered by the booming ADC and broader bioconjugate market globally. We are also of the
view that a comprehensive and integrated service portfolio and effective quality assurance are critical to
the continuing success of our business. In addition, our expanding capacity enables us to satisfy the
increasing needs of bioconjugate outsourcing and grow with our customers to establish long-term
relationships.
INSURANCE
We maintain (1) property insurance policies covering physical damage to, or loss of, our facilities
and their improvements, equipment, office furniture and inventory; (2) employer’s liability insurance
generally covering death or work injury of employees; (3) product liability and professional errors and
omissions insurance covering product liability claims arising from the use or operation of our
payload-linkers, ADCs or other bioconjugate molecules and claims arising from negligence in connection
with our services to customers; (4) public liability insurance covering the legal liability for damages in
respect of bodily injury, property damage or other contingencies caused in connection with our business;
(5) machinery breakdown insurance covering unforeseen and sudden physical loss or damage to our
machinery; (6) cargo insurance covering physical loss or damage to freight during transportation; and (7)
directors and officers liability insurance. We do not maintain key-man life insurance for any members of
our senior management or other key personnel or business disruption insurance.
We believe that our insurance coverage is adequate. Nevertheless, our insurance coverage may be
insufficient to cover all liabilities against or damages to us and could therefore result in substantial costs
or a diversion of resources. See “Risk Factors — Risks Relating to Our Business and Industry — We have
limited insurance coverage, and any claims beyond our insurance coverage may result in us incurring
substantial costs and a diversion of resources.”
BUSINESS
— 222 —


--- page 232 ---
PROPERTIES
We have owned and leased a number of properties in Shanghai, Changzhou and Wuxi in China. The
following table sets forth a summary of the properties owned or leased by us as of the Latest Practicable
Date. None of our properties were used as the collateral for mortgages.
Location Type of Property Area (sq.m.) Ownership Term/Expiry Date
Pudong New District,
Shanghai, China .....
Facilities and office 4,499 (the parcel of land),
8,927.16 (the GFA)
Owned March 2042
Xinwu District, Wuxi,
Jiangsu Province,
China ............
Facilities and office 26,392 (the parcel of
land), 48,067.66 (the
GFA)
Owned April 2051
Pudong New District,
Shanghai, China .....
Office 845.11 (the GFA) Leased January 2026
Xinbei District,
Changzhou, Jiangsu
Province, China .....
Facilities and office 819.52 (the GFA) Leased December 2023
Xinwu District, Wuxi,
Jiangsu Province,
China ............
Dormitory 572 (the GFA) Leased June 2024
Xinwu District, Wuxi,
Jiangsu Province,
China ............
Facilities and office 7,903.74 (the GFA) Leased December 2027
Xinwu District, Wuxi,
Jiangsu Province,
China
(1) ..........
Dormitory 18,172.07 (the GFA) Leased December 2024
(1) Such property is currently not in use.
As of the Latest Practicable Date, none of the properties held by us had a carrying amount of 15%
or more of our consolidated total assets. Therefore, according to Chapter 5 of the Listing Rules and section
6(2) of the Companies (Exemption of Companies and Prospectuses from Compliance with Provisions)
Notice (Cap. 32L of the Laws of Hong Kong), this prospectus is exempted from compliance with the
requirements of section 342(1)(b) of the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions)
Ordinance in relation to paragraph 34(2) of the Third Schedule to the Companies (Winding Up and
Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance, which require a valuation report with respect to all our Group’s
interests in land or buildings.
BUSINESS
— 223 —


--- page 233 ---
ENVIRONMENTAL, SOCIAL AND GOVERNANCE MATTERS
We view environmental, social and governance (“ ESG”) responsibilities as an integral component of
our ethos and business strategy. We acknowledge our responsibilities on environmental protection, social
responsibilities and are aware of the climate-related issues that may have impact on our business. We are
committed to complying with ESG reporting requirements upon Listing.
Our operations and facilities are subject to extensive environmental protection and health and safety
laws and regulations. These laws and regulations govern, among other things, the generation, storage,
handling, use and transportation of hazardous materials and the handling and disposal of hazardous and
biohazardous waste generated at our facilities. See “Regulatory Overview” for more details. We believe
it is critical for us to function in a socially responsible manner to protect the environment and ensure
workplace safety, and we are committed to taking all necessary measures and efforts to that end.
During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, we complied with the relevant
environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations in all material aspects. We do not
expect our costs of complying with current and future environmental protection and health and safety laws
to increase significantly going forwards. However, because the requirements imposed by these laws and
regulations may change, we may be unable to accurately predict the cost of complying with these laws and
regulations. See “Risk Factors — Risks Relating to Our Business and Industry — We are subject to
environmental protection and health and safety laws and regulations and may be exposed to potential costs
for compliance and liabilities, including consequences of accidental contamination, chemical or biological
hazards or personal injury” for more information. We were not subject to any administrative penalties
relating to environmental, health or safety compliance that would have a material adverse effect on our
financial position or results of operations as a whole.
Governance
We regard ESG governance as the cornerstone of corporate sustainable development. Our Board is
our highest decision-making and governing body regarding ESG issues. It has the overall responsibility
for overseeing and determining the ESG-related risks and opportunities, as well as the collective
responsibilities through boardroom deliberations for establishing and adopting the ESG policies, strategies
and targets to manage material ESG risks, reviewing our performance against those targets, and revising
the ESG strategies as appropriate if significant variance from the target is identified. To facilitate our
Board to oversee and manage material risks of ESG matters, our Board has established an ESG committee
that currently comprises four members, including Dr. Jincai Li, our chief executive officer and executive
Director, Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang, our chief operating officer and executive Director, Dr. Weichang Zhou
and Ms. Ming Shi, our non-executive Directors. Both Dr. Jincai Li and Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang have
accumulated hands-on experience in managing business operations and productions through serving their
prior roles with the WXB Group, and have in-depth exposure to and knowledge in ESG matters. The ESG
committee serves as a supportive role to our Board to (i) formulate and review the Company’s
responsibilities, vision, strategy, framework, principles, policies and (ii) monitor the implementation of
the ESG policies passed by the Board to oversee and guide our Company’s ESG initiatives and to make
recommendations to the Board. The ESG committee is tasked to prepare written materials or oral
presentations to report its observations and proposals to our Board periodically, to keep our Board
informed on the ESG matters to formulate appropriate ESG-related mechanisms and policies.
BUSINESS
— 224 —


--- page 234 ---
Our ESG guidance team, which consists of certain management team members of our Group and key
personnel of operation sites, and ESG department are generally responsible for executing the ESG
policies, evaluating ESG performance, regularly communicating with stakeholders about the material ESG
issues and providing insights, advice, direction and solutions for ESG decision-making. Our ESG guidance
team provides strategic insight to achieve a close correlation of our ESG targets and business operations
and ensures resource support for ESG work. Our ESG department reports to our chief operating officer and
is responsible for providing professional advice and ESG performance evaluation, communicating with
relevant responsible parties and facilitating the implementation of our ESG strategies, objectives and
initiatives to improve the overall ESG performance of our Group. We also encourage our employees in our
functional departments to jointly promote the implementation of our ESG policies and objectives, as well
as keep innovating and refining operational excellence to improve ESG performance.
ESG Policies
We have established a set of ESG policies in accordance with the Listing Rules, under which we
endeavor to reduce negative impacts on the environment through our commitment to energy saving and
sustainable development. Our ESG policies outline, among others, (i) the appropriate risk governance on
ESG matters, including climate-related risks and opportunities, (ii) ESG strategy formulation procedures,
(iii) the identification of key performance indicators, including reduction of greenhouse gas emissions and
(iv) waste treatment and conservation of energy, among other aspects. We continue to promote a positive
workplace for all of our employees, including embracing diversity and equal and respectful treatment of
all of our employees. For social matters, we have adopted policies and frameworks related to (i) workplace
safety, (ii) quality management, (iii) employee compensation and benefits, (iv) employee training,
wellness and professional and personal development and (v) employee complaint handling, among other
aspects.
Potential Impacts and Mitigation of ESG-related Risks
We are subject to various ESG-related laws and regulations in China. During the Track Record
Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, we did not receive any fines or penalties associated with the
breach of any environmental laws or regulations. To the best knowledge and belief of our Directors, we
are not subject to material environmental liability risk and will not incur material compliance costs in the
future.
In view of the nature of our business, to the best knowledge of our directors, climate change will not
have any major impact on our business operation. However, in recent years, disasters due to extreme
weather conditions caused by climate change could cause significant damage to our facilities, resulting in
temporary or long-term closures of our facilities and operations and significant expenses for the repair or
replacement of damaged facilities. We may also experience indirect impacts from disruptions in the supply
chain. Uncontained global warming may elevate temperature, which could force us to increase electricity
consumption and thus operating expenditures.
In the medium to long term, there may be an increasing number of legislations and regulations in
response to the potential impacts of climate change. Such a shift in the regulatory environment may affect
our operations directly or indirectly because of required compliance by our business partners, and may
subject us to additional costs and restrictions, including increased energy and raw material costs, and
pollutant or hazardous waste treatment costs. These additional burdens could negatively affect our
financial condition and results of operations.
BUSINESS
— 225 —


--- page 235 ---
We will continue to identify, assess, manage and mitigate the ESG-related risks. Our approach
includes but is not limited to:
 monitoring relevant laws, regulations and industry standards to regularly assess our compliance
with applicable regulatory rules;
 reviewing and assessing the ESG reports of similar companies in the industry to ensure that all
relevant ESG-related risks are identified on a timely basis;
 discussing among management from time to time to ensure all the material ESG issues are
recognized and reported;
 discussing with key stakeholders on key ESG principles and practices to ensure that the
significant aspects are covered;
 organizing a specific ESG risk management process to identify and manage ESG-related risks
and opportunities as an integrated part of overall business risks and opportunities;
 setting appropriate targets, including with regard to emission, pollution and other impact on the
environment aimed at reducing emissions and natural resource consumption;
 building up sophisticated business continuity management system to handle various kinds of
ESG-related risks and assure our business continuity to the most extent.
We will conduct an enterprise risk assessment at least once a year to cover the current and potential
risks faced by our Group, including, but not limited to, the risks arising from the ESG aspects and strategic
risk around disruptive forces such as climate change. Our Board will assess or, when needed, engage an
external expert to evaluate the risks and review our Group’s existing strategy, target and internal controls,
and necessary improvements will be implemented to mitigate the risks. Our Board, audit committee and
the ESG committee will maintain oversight of our approach to risk management, including climate-related
risks and risks monitored as part of the standard operating processes to ensure the appropriate mitigations
are in place of the regular management reviews. We will work toward integrating ESG in the risk
management mechanism to further strengthen the monitoring and mitigating ESG-related risks across our
Group.
The decision to mitigate, transfer, accept or control risk is influenced by various factors, such as
government regulation and public perception. We will incorporate climate-related issues, including
physical and transition risk analysis, into our risk assessment processes and risk appetite setting. If the risk
and opportunities are considered material, we will refer to them in the course of the strategy and financial
planning process. Upon annual review of the ESG-related risks and our Group’s performance in addressing
the risks, we may revise and adjust the ESG strategies as appropriate.
During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, we had not experienced any
material impact on our business operations, strategies or financial performance as a result of the
ESG-related issues.
BUSINESS
— 226 —


--- page 236 ---
Metrics and Targets
As required by the applicable PRC laws and regulations, our operations sites are required to pass the
environmental impact assessment. Our own Shanghai and Wuxi operation sites passed such assessment in
October 2022 and September 2019, respectively. To the extent possible, our facilities use next-generation
technologies and clean energy sources, which we believe would improve resource conservation and reduce
the level of waste produced by our operations. For example, we have utilized magnetic levitation chillers
and upgraded the inner coating of old water pumps to improve efficiency and electricity-saving, and we
have collected and recycled steam condensate to reuse water and reduce steam consumption and
greenhouse gas emission. We have also leveraged the positive temperature coefficient (PTC) heating
element to control humidity and save energy for our large refrigerated warehouse, as well as operated the
clean air conditioning for our clean room under a dual airflow mode that responds to our activities in the
clean room for energy-saving. We have monitored and recorded the following metrics since 2021 to assess
and manage the environmental and climate-related risks arising from our operations.
Resource Consumption
Electricity consumption. We have monitored our electricity consumption levels and implemented
measures to improve energy efficiency. For the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2022 and the six
months ended June 30, 2023, our electricity consumption levels were approximately 7.0 million kWh, 11.4
million kWh and 8.0 million kWh, respectively.
Water consumption. We have monitored our water consumption levels and implement measures to
promote water conservation. For the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended
June 30, 2023, our water consumption levels were 76,556 m
3, 88,736 m 3 and 97,633 m 3, respectively.
Waste Management
Greenhouse gas and other waste gas. We have monitored our greenhouse gas discharge levels on an
annual basis. For the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2022, our greenhouse gas emissions were
approximately 8,041 tons and 13,056 tons of CO
2 equivalent, respectively. For other waste gas, we have
built activated charcoal filters to ensure the waste gas is safe for emission.
Wastewater . For wastewater generated during our operations, we perform coagulation and
sterilization and then send the processed wastewater to a third party for further processing. We have also
formulated a set of criteria with respect to the wastewater, including its PH value shall be within the range
of 6 to 9 and its chemical oxygen demand value shall not exceed 500 mg/L.
Solid hazardous waste. We store solid hazardous waste in special waste bags, which are then placed
in a special area at our operation sites. We contract with qualified third parties to dispose such hazardous
materials in a safe and environmentally friendly manner. For the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2022
and the six months ended June 30, 2023, our solid hazardous waste discharge levels were approximately
10.7 tons, 27.3 tons and 70.4 tons, respectively. The increase of the discharge level in the first half of 2023
was primarily due to the increased discharge of solid waste generated by the construction of our new
facilities at the Wuxi site. In addition, we generated more solid hazardous waste in line with the growth
of our research, development and manufacturing activities. To the extent feasible, we plan to further
BUSINESS
— 227 —


--- page 237 ---
improve our operational efficiency to reduce the amount of solid waste generated from our operations, and
we will continue to work with qualified third-party waste collectors to appropriately dispose our solid
waste and achieve a reduced environmental impact.
Our Board will set targets at the beginning of each financial year in accordance with the disclosure
requirements of Appendix 27 to the Listing Rules and other relevant rules and regulations upon Listing.
The relevant targets will be reviewed on an annual basis to ensure that they remain appropriate to the needs
of our Group. In setting the ESG-related targets, we will take into account not only our historical
consumption or discharge levels, but also our future business expansion, the overall goals of the WXB
Group and available information from industry peers in a thorough and prudent manner with a view of
balancing business growth and environmental protection to achieve sustainable development. We aim to
reduce our Scope 1 and Scope 2 greenhouse gas emissions intensity by 50% (tons/RMB10,000) by 2030
from a 2021 base year. For the near term, we aim to curb the increment of our resource consumption and
waste generation in spite of the growing size of our business operations. We will adjust the targets and
goals in accordance with our actual business operations, and we will closely monitor the financial and
non-financial impact on our business for actions taken to achieve these goals and targets. We believe that
the implementation of this plan is facilitated by the design of our sites, which utilize natural temperature
and light for tailored heating, ventilation, air conditioning and lighting. We also ensure equipment meets
our energy efficiency requirements. In addition, we have adopted and will continue to adopt various
measures, including but not limited to:
 encouraging all staff to reduce the production of paper waste, reduce consumption of water
resources and electrical appliances by posting water-saving or power-saving signs in
eye-catching areas to cultivate our employees’ awareness of environment protection;
 encouraging our employees to avoid printing hard copies and requiring double-sided printing
whenever possible;
 requiring employees to turn off lights, equipment and other electronic devices when the devices
are not in operation and before they leave the premises;
 using more energy-efficient lighting products, such as LED lighting;
 ensuring air-conditioning is used only when necessary, and at the appropriate temperature;
 regularly conducting inspections of our laboratory equipment to check for abnormal conditions,
and making prompt report to avoid potential damages;
 encouraging teleconferences as opposed to physical meetings to reduce travel;
 offering shuttle services with electric vehicles to reduce staff’s dependence on private cars;
 providing electric vehicle charging stations for employees.
BUSINESS
— 228 —


--- page 238 ---
Workplace Safety
We strive to provide a safe working environment for our employees. To that end, we have adopted
and maintained a series of rules, standard operating procedures and measures. For example, we
implemented safety guidelines that set out information about potential safety hazards and procedures for
handling potent active pharmaceutical ingredients (“ APIs ”) and operating our equipment and facilities. We
also conduct regular safety inspections and maintenance for our manufacturing facilities. With video
surveillance systems installed inside our facilities, we are able to monitor the operations and compliance
with our safety guidelines in real time.
Our operation sites are designed with appropriate safety features to protect our employees who need
to handle hazardous materials, some of which may be OEB5-rated chemicals. In particular, we specifically
design isolated areas for handling APIs, and we have a positively pressurized buffer gowning room at the
entry of the isolated areas to protect employees from potential air-borne spread of APIs, mist shower at
the exit to remove any residual chemicals, and isolators to prevent human contact or inhalation of
hazardous materials. Employees who need to handle APIs must comply with operating procedures in those
areas and wear required personal protective equipment.
Our employees responsible for manufacturing and quality control and assurance are required to
receive the necessary training and hold relevant qualifications, as well as wear the proper safety equipment
during work. We require new employees to participate in safety training and familiarize themselves with
the relevant safety rules and procedures. We also invite experts on fire control safety to conduct training
sessions and regularly perform emergency evacuation drills to prepare our employees for potential fire
accidents.
We did not have any material workplace accidents during the Track Record Period and up to the
Latest Practicable Date.
CERTIFICATES, PERMITS AND LICENSES
During the Track Record Period and as of the Latest Practicable Date, we had obtained all requisite
certificates, permits and licenses that are material for our operations in China, and all of such certificates,
permits and licenses are within their respective effective periods.
The following table sets forth a summary of the key licenses, permits and certificates that we
obtained:
Holder
Certificates/
Permits/Licenses
Certificate/
Permit/
License Number Issuing Authority Issue Date Expiry Date (1)
X D CW u x i ....... Drug Manufacturing
License (͛ପ஢̙
ᗇ)
Su 20200604
(ᘽ20200604)
Jiangsu Medical
Products
Administration
(္
ຖ၍ଣ҅)
January 5,
2023
December 15,
2025
BUSINESS
— 229 —


--- page 239 ---
Holder
Certificates/
Permits/Licenses
Certificate/
Permit/
License Number Issuing Authority Issue Date Expiry Date (1)
X D CW u x i ....... Registration Certificate
of Biosafety
Laboratories (τΌ
ࣣ)
LX2023001 Wuxi Health
Commission
(ೌ፼̹ሊ͛਄
ึ)
February 14,
2023
N/A
X D CW u x i ....... Registration Certificate
of Biosafety
Laboratories (τΌ
ࣣ)
XW2023002 Wuxi Health
Commission
(ೌ፼̹ሊ͛਄
ึ)
February 14,
2023
N/A
X D CW u x i ....... Filing Receipts for
Purchasing the
Precursor Chemicals in
Category II and III ( ୋ
ʷ
׼)
2)
G32231350140044 Anti-Drug
Brigade of
Xinwu Branch
of Wuxi Public
Security
Bureau ( ೌ፼
̹ʮτ҅อю
ɽඟ)
September 26,
2023
December 25,
2023
X D CW u x i ....... Filing Receipts for
Purchasing the
Precursor Chemicals in
Category II and III ( ୋ
ʷ
׼)
2)
G32231456913472 Anti-Drug
Brigade of
Xinwu Branch
of Wuxi Public
Security
Bureau ( ೌ፼
̹ʮτ҅อю
ɽඟ)
October 19,
2023
January 18,
2024
X D CW u x i ....... Filing Receipts for
Purchasing the
Precursor Chemicals in
Category II and III ( ୋ
ʷ
׼)
2)
G32231504858025 Anti-Drug
Brigade of
Xinwu Branch
of Wuxi Public
Security
Bureau ( ೌ፼
̹ʮτ҅อю
ɽඟ)
October 27,
2023
January 26,
2024
X D CW u x i ....... Customs Filing Receipt
of Consignees and
Consigners of
Imported and Exported
Goods ( ऎᗫආ̈ɹ஬
Ϋੂ)
32023409AJ Wuxi Customs
(ೌ፼ऎᗫ)
July 20, 2021 N/A
XDC Shanghai .... Customs Filing Receipt
of Consignees and
Consigners of
Imported and Exported
Goods ( ऎᗫආ̈ɹ஬
Ϋੂ)
31224689BB Shanghai
Waigaoqiao
Customs ( ɪऎ
ऎᗫ̮৷዗ᗫ)
September 23,
2021
N/A
XDC Changzho u... Customs Filing Receipt
of Consignees and
Consigners of
Imported and Exported
Goods ( ऎᗫආ̈ɹ஬
Ϋੂ)
3204965ABG Changzhou
Customs
(੬ψऎᗫ)
August 30,
2021
N/A
(1) “N/A” represents licenses that do not have an expiration date and will remain valid unless revoked.
(2) XDC Wuxi obtained these three filing receipts for three different chemicals used in the operations. Each of these three filing
receipts relates to one of these three chemicals.
BUSINESS
— 230 —


--- page 240 ---
We had not experienced any material difficulty in renewing such certificates, permits and licenses
during the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, and we currently do not expect to
have any material difficulty in renewing them when they expire, if applicable.
LEGAL AND COMPLIANCE MATTERS
Legal Proceedings
We may from time to time be involved in contractual disputes or legal proceedings arising out of the
ordinary course of our business. During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date,
we were not subject to any claims, damages or losses which would have a material adverse effect on our
financial position or results of operations as whole. As of the Latest Practicable Date, no material
litigation, arbitration or administrative proceedings had been threatened against us.
Legal and Regulatory Compliance
We are committed to complying with the laws and regulations applicable to our business. During the
Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, we did not have non-compliance incidents
which our Directors believe would, individually or in the aggregate, have a material operational or
financial impact on our Group as a whole.
Social Insurance and Housing Provident Funds
During the Track Record Period, we had (by ourselves and through a third-party human resource
agency) made full contributions to social insurance and housing provident funds for our employees. As of
the Latest Practicable Date, the said third-party agency made full contributions to social insurance and
housing provident funds for two employees of XDC Wuxi and one employee of XDC Changzhou. The
reason for engaging the third-party agency is that these three employees requested us to contribute their
social insurance and housing provident fund in their respective places of residence, which are not the place
where XDC Changzhou or XDC Wuxi is located.
As advised by our PRC Legal Advisor, as of the Latest Practicable Date, the practice had not been
explicitly prohibited by applicable PRC laws and regulations, however, there remain uncertainties over the
interpretation and implementation of labor-related laws and regulations, and such arrangement may not at
all times be deemed to be in full compliance with relevant laws and regulations, which may subject us to
labor disputes or government investigations.
For detailed legal risks related to this, please refer to the paragraph headed “Risk Factors — Risks
Relating to Our Business and Industry — We are required to make adequate contributions to social
insurance and housing provident fund for our employees under the PRC regulations.”
Title Defects of Lease Properties
As of the Latest Practicable Date, three of our leased properties had title defects that may affect our
ability to continue to use them in the future. The existence of title defects is mainly due to the following
reasons: (1) the lessors of two leased properties are different from the real estate owners of such leased
properties, and (2) the intended purpose contained in the property ownership certificates of one property
is inconsistent with the actual use of the property, namely, we use the property on the industrial land, as
indicated in the property ownership certificate, for office.
BUSINESS
— 231 —


--- page 241 ---
As advised by our PRC Legal Advisor, in respect of the inconsistent use of one of our leased
properties with the intended purpose contained in the property ownership certificate, we may face
challenges from the government authorities regarding our right to continue use the premises. However,
during the Track Record Period and as of the Latest Practicable Date, we are not aware of any claim made
by the government authority that might affect our current occupation of such leased property. Nonetheless,
even if we are required to vacate from the property, we would be able to relocate the leased property in
a timely manner without incurring significant costs, given that (1) there are alternative properties at
comparable rental rates on the market, and (2) most of our equipment at such leased properties is easy to
move, and such relocation will not have a material adverse impact on our business and operations. For
detailed legal risks related to this, please refer to the paragraph headed “Risk Factors — Risks Relating
to Our Business and Industry — Failure to comply with PRC property laws and relevant regulations may
affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.”
Furthermore, we have enhanced our internal control to avoid such risks by the following measures:
 we have assigned designated personnel to follow up with the relevant parties to retrieve the
ownership certificates or other ownership documents of the existing properties with title
defects as soon as possible;
 we have formulated internal policies on the lease management, which explicitly requires that
the actual use of properties should be consistent with the intended purpose contained in the
property ownership certificate, which is also a prerequisite for entering into new lease
agreements; and
 we will conduct our due diligence and reviews more prudently when we lease additional
premises, particularly on the nature, designated use and title certificates for such properties.
As far as the enhanced internal control measures are concerned, the internal control consultant has
conducted a follow-up review on the design of the Company’s internal control mechanism, and no material
deficiencies have been identified.
RISK MANAGEMENT AND INTERNAL CONTROL
Risk Management
Risk management is critical to the success of our business operation. Key operational risks that we
face include changes in the general market conditions and the regulatory environment relating to the global
bioconjugate outsourcing services market, our ability to offer quality bioconjugate CRDMO services, our
ability to manage anticipated growth and to execute on our growth strategies, and our ability to compete
with other bioconjugate outsourcing services providers. See “Risk Factors” in this prospectus for a
discussion of various risks and uncertainties we face. We also face various market risks. In particular, we
are exposed to currency, credit and liquidity risks that arise in the normal course of our business. For more
details, see “Financial Information — Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risks.”
BUSINESS
— 232 —


--- page 242 ---
In response to these challenges, we have developed a risk management framework as summarized
below:
 Our audit committee, chaired by Mr. Hao Zhou, oversees and manages the overall risks
associated with our business operations from time to time. Our audit committee is mainly
responsible for reviewing and overseeing financial reporting procedure, risk management
system and internal control system of our Group.
 The senior management team is responsible for (i) formulating and updating our risk
management policy and objectives; (ii) conducting risk assessment, including the
identification, prioritization, measurement and categorization of all major risks that may have
potential impacts on our operations; (iii) making action plans to mitigate potential risks; and
(iv) reporting material risks to our audit committee.
 Our internal audit department and other relevant functional teams are responsible for
implementing our risk management policy and our day-to-day risk management practices. They
are responsible for (i) gathering information about the risks related to our operations; (ii)
preparing annual reports on risk management and auditing for the review of our chief operating
officer and our audit committee; (iii) proposing and implementing appropriate measures in
response to our risk exposure where necessary; and (iv) continuously monitoring major risks
related to our operations.
 We also adopted internal policies against bribery and corruption. The policies strictly prohibit
any employee or other personnel acting on our behalf from making, proposing or promising
improper payments, directly or indirectly, in any form of cash, physical assets, loans, gifts,
luxury trips, entertainment, donations, other valuables or benefits to anyone, including
government officials, customers or suppliers, for the purposes of acquiring or securing any
business or improper advantage, regardless of whether we benefit from such improper
payments. Our employees and other personnel acting on our behalf are not allowed to accept
or solicit any such improper payments as well. The anti-bribery and anti-corruption policies
also prohibit other misconducts, such as misappropriation and embezzlement, fraud or other
illegal activities. Employees who violate our anti-bribery and anti-corruption policies are
subject to penalties, including termination of employment. During the Track Record Period and
up to the Latest Practicable Date, we had complied with relevant anti-corruption and
anti-bribery laws in all material aspects. We have engaged an internal control consultant to
perform a general internal control review in connection with the Listing and the scope covered
anti-bribery and anti-corruption policies and measures (excluding anti-bribery and anti-
corruption investigation). As of the Latest Practicable Date, there was no material issue about
our internal control policies and measures identified by the internal control consultant in
relation to anti-corruption and anti-bribery compliance. Based on the internal control review
report prepared by our internal control consultant, we believe that our internal control policies
and measures in relation to anti-corruption and anti-bribery compliance are adequate and
effective.
BUSINESS
— 233 —


--- page 243 ---
Internal Controls
We have engaged an internal control consultant to perform certain agreed-upon procedures in
connection with the internal control of our Company and our major operating subsidiaries and to report
factual findings on our Group’s entity-level controls and internal controls of various processes, including
financial reporting and disclosure controls, sales, accounts receivable and collection, procurement,
accounts payable and payment, fixed assets and assets under construction, human resources and payroll
management, cash and treasury management, inventory management, general controls of IT system,
taxation management, production and costing, insurance management, research and development and
intangible assets. The internal control consultant performed procedures in April 2023 and put forward
suggestions for improvement. We have accepted these suggestions and further strengthened the design of
our internal control process. After our rectification, the internal control consultant performed follow-up
procedures in June 2023, and no material issue remained in relation to the internal controls of our Group.
We have adopted a series of internal control policies, measures and procedures designed to provide
reasonable assurance for achieving objectives, including effective and efficient operations, reliable
financial reporting and compliance with applicable laws and regulations. During the Track Record Period,
we regularly reviewed and enhanced our internal control system. Below is a summary of the internal
control policies, measures and procedures we have implemented or plan to implement.
 We have formed a compliance office led by Jerry Jingwei Zhang, who has extensive experience
in internal control and risk management in the pharmaceutical industry. Our compliance office
oversees the overall internal control, corporate governance and legal compliance matters of our
Group. Our compliance office is responsible for formulating and revising internal control
policies, measures and procedures to ensure that we maintain sound and effective internal
controls and compliance with applicable laws and regulations. It also monitors the
implementation of our internal control policies, measures and procedures, and conducts regular
compliance audits.
 We have adopted various measures and procedures regarding each aspect of our business
operation, such as project management, quality assurance, protection of intellectual property,
environmental protection and occupational health and safety. For more information, see “—
Project Management,” “— Quality Management,” “— Intellectual Property” and “—
Environmental, Social and Governance Matters.” We provide periodic training about these
measures and procedures to our employees as part of our employee training programs. We also
constantly monitor the implementation of those measures and procedures.
 We have adopted comprehensive internal control measures for anti-corruption and anti-bribery
by (i) providing regular anti-corruption and anti-bribery compliance training for senior
management and employees, including daily compliance team meeting, annual compliance
training and other ad hoc compliance training sessions, to enhance their knowledge and
compliance with applicable law and regulations; (ii) monitoring books, records and accounts
with respect to supplier management, tendering and bidding process management and financial
payment management to identify any false, misleading or undisclosed entries; (iii) establishing
whistle-blowing mechanisms and encouraging all employees, suppliers, customers and other
third parties to report suspicious activities and violations of the policies.
BUSINESS
— 234 —


--- page 244 ---
 Our compliance office has established a system for handling complaints against our Directors,
senior management, employees, customers and other business partners, as well as a mechanism
for making independent and fair investigations on reported complaints and taking appropriate
actions. The compliance office has also set up an online platform through which our employees
can report their complaints and concerns. In addition, the compliance office evaluates the
effectiveness of and potential loopholes in our internal control system based on complaints
received to improve our internal control policies, measures and procedures accordingly. During
the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date, our compliance office did not
receive any material complaints or concerns.
 We have engaged Somerley Capital Limited as our compliance advisor to provide advice to our
Directors and management team until the end of the first fiscal year after the Listing regarding
matters relating to the Listing Rules. Our compliance advisor is expected to ensure our use of
funding complies with the section headed “Future Plans and Use of Proceeds” in this
prospectus after the Listing, as well as to provide support and advice regarding requirements
of relevant regulatory authorities in a timely fashion.
 We plan to engage a PRC law firm to advise us on and keep us abreast with PRC laws and
regulations after the Listing. We will continue to arrange various trainings to be provided by
external legal advisors from time to time when necessary and/or any appropriate accredited
institution to update our Directors, senior management and relevant employees on the latest
PRC laws and regulations.
 We do not access or process any patient data in the course of providing services to customers
in China, and do not assume the patient data and privacy obligation for our operations in China.
We have no plan to access or process any patient data in our course of providing services to
customers in Singapore, and undertake to comply with any patient data and privacy laws and
regulations in Singapore, whenever applicable.
For information about our corporate governance measures to manage the conflict of interest and
potential competition from our Controlling Shareholders and safeguard the interest of the Shareholders,
see “Relationship with Our Controlling Shareholders.”
BUSINESS
— 235 —


--- page 245 ---
OVERVIEW
As of the Latest Practicable Date, WuXi Biologics was directly interested in 60% of our total issued
share capital and STA Pharmaceutical, an indirect subsidiary of WuXi AppTec, was directly interested in
40% of our total issued share capital. STA Pharmaceutical is directly wholly-owned by STA, which is in
turn held as to 98.56% by WuXi AppTec (Shanghai) and WuXi AppTec (Shanghai) is directly
wholly-owned by WuXi AppTec. Immediately following completion of the Global Offering, WuXi
Biologics and STA Pharmaceutical will respectively own approximately 50.91% and 33.94% of the total
issued share capital of our Company (assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised and without
taking into account any exercise of the share options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes),
or approximately 50.10% and 33.40% of the total issued share capital of our Company (assuming the
Over-allotment Option is exercised in full and without taking into account any exercise of the share
options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes). Immediately upon the Listing, WuXi
Biologics, STA Pharmaceutical, STA, WuXi AppTec (Shanghai) and WuXi AppTec will remain as our
Controlling Shareholders, and our Company will remain as a subsidiary of WuXi Biologics. For more
details, please see the section headed “History, Reorganization and Corporate Structure” in this
prospectus.
BACKGROUND OF OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
WuXi Biologics has been listed on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange since 2017 (Stock Code:
2269) and is a leading global fully-integrated CRDMO which combines the business models of a contract
research organization and a contract development and manufacturing organization to provide one-stop
end-to-end biologics services. The WXB Group’s CRDMO platform enables its clients and partners from
as early as the discovery and pre-clinical stages of product development by establishing a strong position
in terms of program design, to advancing promising programs into the early and late stages of clinical
development and ultimately to commercial manufacturing.
WuXi AppTec has been listed on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange since 2018 (Stock Code:
2359) and the Shanghai Stock Exchange since 2018 (Stock Code: 603259.SH) and is a leading global
pharmaceutical healthcare R&D and manufacturing services platform which provides integrated,
end-to-end services including chemistry drug CRDMO, biology discovery, preclinical testing and clinical
research services, cell and gene therapies CTDMO.
DELINEATION OF BUSINESS
We believe there is clear delineation between our business, on the one hand, and the CRDMO
businesses of the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group, on the other hand. Our core business is
the provision of interdisciplinary and comprehensive services covering bioconjugate discovery, research,
development and manufacturing (the “ Core Business ”). A client/partner that wishes to obtain CRDMO
services for development of a new treatment for a given therapeutic indication will contract with us if the
relevant treatment is an ADC, with the Remaining WXB Group if the relevant treatment is an unconjugated
antibody (or other biologics product) and with the WXA T Group if the relevant treatment is a small
molecule drug (or non-biologics pharmaceutical product). In no event will there be any direct competition
between us and our Controlling Shareholders.
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 236 —


--- page 246 ---
Involvement by us and our Controlling Shareholdings in our ADC CRDMO services
The following diagram depicts the steps of our ADC CRDMO services and the respective
involvement by us and our Controlling Shareholders.
Stage Key Steps
Involvement in our ADC CRDMO Services by
Our Group The Remaining WXB
Group The WXAT Group
Discovery Chemistry Yes No No
Payload-Linker Synthesis Yes No No (5)
Conjugation Discovery Yes No No
Developability Study Yes No No
In Vitro/In Vivo
Characterization Yes No No (6)
IND Enabling Process
Development Yes No No
Analytical Method
Development Yes No No
Non-GMP Manufacturing of
DS and DP Yes No No
CMC Regulatory Support Yes No No
GMP Manufacturing and
ADC DS/DP Testing Release Yes No No
Late-Stage Process
Optimization, Process
Characterization and PPQ
Yes No No
mAb Intermediate
Manufacturing Yes Yes (2)(4) No
Payload-linker Manufacturing Yes No Yes(3)(4)
Bioconjugate DS/DP
Manufacturing Yes No No
Pre-Clinical Development
Early Phase (Phase I & II)
Late Phase (Phase III)
Commercial Production(7)
Target Nomination No Yes (1) No
No Yes(1) NoAntibody Intermediates
Discovery
Drug Discovery
Notes:
(1) As the target nomination and antibody intermediates discovery are not part of the ADC drug development major steps and are
not related to the core competences of our Group, these two steps will be covered by the Remaining WXB Group.
(2) The Remaining WXB Group conducts antibody intermediates manufacturing for use in ADCs when requested by our Group
under the Antibodies Master Services Agreement. For details, please see “Connected Transactions — Non-exempt continuing
connected transactions — 1. Antibodies Master Services Agreement” in this prospectus.
(3) The WXA T Group conducts payload-linker manufacturing for use in ADCs when requested by our Group under the
Payload-Linkers Master Services Agreement. For details, please see “Connected Transactions — Non-exempt continuing
connected transactions — 8. Payload-Linkers Master Services Agreement” in this prospectus.
(4) While the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group conduct antibody intermediates and payload-linker GMP-
manufacturing for use in ADCs to a limited extent, such overlap is being restricted to each one step within our bioconjugates
CRDMO services and at the request of our Company under the framework of the continuing connected transactions as
discussed above. As such, we believe that there will be no direct or material competition between us and the Remaining WXB
Group or the WXA T Group upon the Listing. For details, please see “— Delineation of Business” in this section.
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 237 —


--- page 247 ---
(5) Payload-linker synthesis is one of the steps of our ADC CRDMO services and refers to the development of optimal synthesis
pathways and reaction conditions to chemically generate the payload-linker molecules needed for bioconjugates in high yield
and quality, however such process is less complicated compared to other key steps, such as conjugation discovery. While the
WXA T Group has retained the capability to conduct payload-linker synthesis, since the capability requirements of
payload-linkers synthesis and development of other small molecule drugs (which is part of WXA T’s services) are in nature
similar, it will not do so for ADCs following the sale of the Payload & Linker Business to our Group in 2021.
(6) The WXA T Group has established a collection of in vitro assays and in vivo disease models to demonstrate the target
engagement and to evaluate preclinical efficacies for all compounds and new modalities, which, however, is not considered
as the core service offerings provided by our Group, and thus, would not result in any direct or material competition between
our Group and the WXA T Group.
(7) Commercial production stage does not include the steps of late-stage process optimization, process characterization and
process performance qualification.
The Remaining WXB Group
Fundamentally, our ADC CRDMO services consist of (i) discovery chemistry services, (ii)
payload-linker synthesis services, (iii) conjugation discovery services, and (iv) mAb intermediates,
payload-linker and bioconjugate DS/DP manufacturing services. For details, please see the section headed
“Business — Our Business Model” in this prospectus. With respect to three of these four categories (i.e.,
payload-linker synthesis services, conjugation discovery services and payload-linker and bioconjugate
DS/DP manufacturing services), there is no actual or apparent overlap between our Core Business and the
Remaining WXB Group’s biologics CRDMO business. With respect to antibody intermediates in general,
given that ADCs involve conjugated antibodies and the Remaining WXB Group provides CRDMO
services with respect to unconjugated antibodies, there is in substance no overlap between the two
business with respect to antibodies, for the following reasons.
There is clear delineation between ADCs and unconjugated antibodies in general
ADCs and unconjugated antibodies have very different mechanisms of action and correspondingly
different therapeutic properties. ADCs and unconjugated antibodies can be complementary treatments for
oncology indications (i.e., various types of cancer), rather than competing treatments, as can been seen
from clinical trials of leading ADC players. ADCs approved by key global medical products regulators to
date resemble unconjugated antibodies approved for oncology indications to date solely insofar as both
have antibody intermediates that binds to a protein expressed on the surface of target cancer cells.
However, beyond that point, the approved ADCs have an entirely different mechanism of action. Once the
antibody intermediates of an ADC have bound to the relevant protein on the surface of the target cell, the
entire ADC complex (i.e., the antibody intermediates together with the payload-linker) is internalized by
the cancer cell, and the payload is then released inside the cancer cell, eventually leading to the death of
the cancer cell.
Due to the above difference in mechanism of action, ADCs and unconjugated antibodies can be
complementary modes of treating cancer rather than competing modes. Indeed, a single biopharmaceutical
company could simultaneously develop an unconjugated antibody therapy and an ADC for the treatment
of the same oncology indication without running the risk of competing with itself, since the two different
therapies have different mechanisms of action and can be used in a complementary manner, rather than in
a mutually exclusive manner; and some biopharmaceutical companies are currently doing so.
Our Group will continue to procure antibody intermediates related development, manufacturing and
quality testing services from the Remaining WXB Group after the Listing. For details, please see the
section headed “Connected Transactions — Non-exempt Continuing Connected Transactions — 1.
Antibodies Master Services Agreement” in this prospectus.
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 238 —


--- page 248 ---
Approved ADCs and approved unconjugated antibodies to date are largely distinguishable on the basis
of approved therapeutic indications to date
Of the 15 ADCs approved to date by key global medical products regulators and the 74 unconjugated
antibodies approved by such regulators to date for oncology indications, only five of the ADCs overlap
with the unconjugated antibodies in terms of both target antigen and target oncology indication. Subject
to the foregoing limited exceptions, there is no overlap in terms of oncology indications that the
prospective clients/partners of our business and the Remaining WXB Group’s business (i.e.,
biopharmaceutical and biotechnology companies) have sought to address to date with approved ADCs and
approved unconjugated antibodies by means of the same target antigens.
Even with respect to limited instances of overlapping indications, ADCs and unconjugated antibodies
can be complementary therapies, either in distinct lines of treatment or as combination therapies
administered concurrently.
As a result of targeting multiple key pathways in a synergistic or additive manner, the adoption of
oncology drugs in combination therapies could have the potential to improve efficacy, treatment response
rate and durability as compared to monotherapies. For example, currently, regulatory approvals have been
granted to ADCs in combination with chemo-immunotherapy for hematological cancers, and FDA
breakthrough designation has been granted for the Keytruda/Padcev combination therapy that is disclosed
above. Other than immunotherapies, ADCs in combination with other targeted mAbs, such as the VEGF
inhibitor bevacizumab, also have demonstrated increased efficacy in clinical phase studies.
There are distinct and clearly delineated uses of antibodies in our Core Business and the biologics
CRDMO business, respectively
In the ADC development process, antibodies are developed solely for their targeting function, while
the therapeutic effect of an ADC is delivered entirely by its cytotoxic payload. On the other hand, in the
process of developing an unconjugated antibody therapy, the antibody is developed both for its targeting
function and for its separate therapeutic effect. Antibody intermediates in our Core Business and
antibodies in the biologics CRDMO business are used for distinctive purposes, which leads to clearly
delineated procedures and specifications in the development process that follows. Indeed, according to
Frost & Sullivan, there can be a larger pool of suitable antigens (or targets) and antibody intermediates
for the development of the ADC drugs, and for targets that are considered to be difficult to address with
antibody drugs, corresponding ADC drugs may potentially be developed. To better serve their
development objectives, customers would find specific CRDMOs with the relevant capabilities and
specify the specific purpose for the development of antibodies in the orders to their CRDMOs at the outset,
which, as explained above, are different between our Core Business and the biologics CRDMO business,
and the results of such orders are customized and cannot be substituted by each other.
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 239 —


--- page 249 ---
Our Core Business and the biologics CRDMO business each has a distinct and clearly delineated focus
of antibody intermediates discovery activities
The focus of the discovery process for our ADC CRDMO services versus the Remaining WXB
Group’s biologics CRDMO services is different. In principle, the overall ADC discovery process up to the
identification of a preclinical ADC drug candidate with the desired properties involves the following key
steps: (i) target nomination, (ii) antibody intermediates discovery, (iii) discovery chemistry, (iv)
payload-linker synthesis, (v) conjugation discovery, (vi) developability study, and (vii) in vitro / in vivo
characterization. However, for the purpose of achieving a clear delineation of business between the
Remaining WXB Group and us, the Remaining WXB Group will cover the first two steps, i.e., (i) target
nomination and (ii) antibody intermediates discovery, and our CRDMO services encompasses steps (iii)
through (vii) thereof, i.e., commencing from discovery chemistry through to in vitro / in vivo
characterization. Since the target nomination and antibody intermediates discovery are not part of the ADC
drug development major steps and are not related to the core competences of our Group, our focus on the
overall ADC discovery process thus commences with discovery of the “C” of ADC, i.e., the conjugation
discovery, which encompasses exploration of different payloads, linkers and conjugation technologies to
generate ADC drug candidates with desired stability, safety and efficacy properties for further
assessments. On the other hand, the steps in the ADC discovery process that are included in our CRDMO
services (i.e., discovery chemistry, payload-linker synthesis, conjugation discovery, developability study
and in vitro / in vivo characterization) are all more closely related to the close competences of our Group.
In light of the above, clients/partners may choose to supply their own antibody intermediates either
in-house or through other third party service providers before engaging us for ADC CRDMO services.
Alternatively, if clients/partners choose to engage the Remaining WXB Group for antibody intermediates
discovery, they will enter into service contracts directly with the Remaining WXB Group; if they later
decide to engage us for ADC CRDMO services following the antibody intermediates discovery, they will
enter into service contracts directly with us. Given that such contracts (for different services) are
independent and will not be bundled together, there will not be any reliance by us on the Remaining WXB
Group in the provision of our ADC CRDMO services.
In contrast, in cases where customers source services from the Remaining WXB Group to develop
unconjugated antibody drugs, the primary focus of the discovery activities of the biologics CRDMO
business is to identify suitable antibody drug candidates that both specifically bind to desired
disease-related antigens and elicit robust therapeutic functions. Moreover, discovery of novel antibody
drug candidates in the Remaining WXB Group’s biologic CRDMO business often involves nomination of
novel antibody targets with differentiated disease mechanisms, whereas the discovery of antibody
intermediates for ADCs is commonly based on established antibodies and mechanisms.
The WXAT Group
As a global company with operations across Asia, Europe, and North America, the WXA T Group
provides a broad portfolio of R&D and manufacturing services that enable the global pharmaceutical and
healthcare industry to advance discoveries and deliver groundbreaking treatments to patients. Through its
unique business models, the WXA T Group’s integrated, end-to-end services include chemistry drug
CRDMO, biology discovery, preclinical testing and clinical research services, cell and gene therapies
CTDMO, helping customers improve the productivity of advancing healthcare products through
cost-effective and efficient solutions. According to Frost & Sullivan, most chemistry drugs are small
molecule drugs, and when compared to chemistry drugs which the WXA T Group is involved in, ADCs and
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 240 —


--- page 250 ---
bioconjugate drugs are generally more complex in nature and require a different set of technology and
manufacturing know-how to produce. The costs for chemistry drugs on the one hand and
ADCs/bioconjugates on the other hand also vary significantly as the production process differs. The
WXA T Group will continue to provide the aforementioned services. Notwithstanding that the WXA T
Group will continue to provide us with payload-linkers manufacturing and related services after the
Listing, there is no actual overlap between our business and the WXA T Group’s business which would
interfere with the clear business delineation between the business of the WXA T Group and our business.
Consequently, there will be no direct or material competition between us and the WXA T Group. For further
details of the aforementioned payload-linker and related services provided by the WXA T Group, please see
the section headed “Connected Transactions — Non-exempt Continuing Connected Transactions — 8.
Payload-Linkers Master Services Agreement” in this prospectus.
Conclusion
Our Group and the Remaining WXB Group respectively do not directly commercialize ADCs or
unconjugated antibodies ourselves, but rather our Group and the Remaining WXB Group merely provide
services to clients/partners that are developing and commercializing such products, and neither we nor the
Remaining WXB Group determine which products our respective clients/partners will develop for which
indications. Accordingly, even if there were any competition between an ADC and an unconjugated
antibody therapy with respect to a given therapeutic indication, it would not constitute any direct
competition between us and the Remaining WXB Group, but only competition between one of our
clients/partners and a client/partner of the Remaining WXB Group. For substantially similar reasons, even
if there were any competition between an ADC and chemistry drug with respect to a given therapeutic
indication, it would not constitute any direct competition between us and the WXA T Group, but only
competition between one of our clients/partners and a client/partner of the WXA T Group.
Based on the foregoing, we believe that (i) there is clear delineation between our business, on the
one hand, and the respective businesses of the Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group, on the other
hand; (ii) there will be no direct or material competition between us and the Remaining WXB Group or
the WXA T Group upon the Listing; and (iii) sufficient arrangements are or will be in place to ensure the
clear delineation and minimal competition between us and the Remaining WXB Group or the WXA T
Group.
INDEPENDENCE FROM OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
Having considered the following factors, our Directors are satisfied that we are capable of carrying
out our business independently from our Controlling Shareholders after the Listing. As of the Latest
Practicable Date, our Controlling Shareholders did not have any interest in any business which competes
or is likely to compete, either directly or indirectly with our Company’s business which would require
disclosure under Rule 8.10 of the Listing Rules.
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 241 —


--- page 251 ---
Management Independence
Our business is managed and conducted by our Board and senior management. Our Board comprises
three executive Directors, three non-executive Directors and three independent non-executive Directors.
The table below sets forth the overlapping directors between our Group on the one hand and our
Controlling Shareholders and their respective close associates on the other hand:
Name Positions in our Company
Position and responsibilities in our
Controlling Shareholders
Dr. Zhisheng Chen ...... Non-executive Director
and chairman
Executive director and chief executive officer
of WuXi Biologics and is responsible for
the overseeing the overall management of
the business, strategy and corporate
development of the Remaining WXB Group
Dr. Weichang Zhou ...... Non-executive Director Executive director, president of global
biologics development operations and chief
technology officer of WuXi Biologics and
is responsible for overseeing the
development and manufacturing of
biologics of the Remaining WXB Group
Ms. Ming Shi .......... Non-executive Director Chief financial officer of WuXi AppTec,
director of STA Pharmaceutical and director
of WuXi AppTec (Shanghai)
Dr. Zhisheng Chen, Dr. Weichang Zhou and Ms. Ming Shi are non-executive Directors of our
Company, and they do not hold any management position within our Group except for being our
non-executive Directors, and are not involved in the daily management of our Company. Save as disclosed
above, none of the remaining members of the Board, including our executive Directors and members of
senior management, holds any management positions in our Controlling Shareholders and their respective
close associates.
Despite of the aforesaid overlapping Directors, we believe that our Directors and senior management
are able to function independently from our Controlling Shareholders for the following reasons:
i. each Director is aware of his/her fiduciary duties as a Director of our Company which requires,
among other things, that he/she acts for the benefit and in the best interests of our Company
and does not allow any conflict between his/her duties as a Director and his/her personal
interests;
ii. in the event that there is a potential conflict of interest arising out of any transaction to be
entered into between our Company and our Controlling Shareholders or their respective
associates, the interested Director(s) shall abstain from voting at the relevant board meetings
of our Company in respect of such transactions, and shall not be counted in the quorum;
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 242 —


--- page 252 ---
iii. our Board comprises nine Directors, and three of them are independent non-executive
Directors, which represents one-third of the members of the Board. Our independent
non-executive Directors have extensive experience in different areas and have been appointed
in accordance with the requirements of the Listing Rules to ensure that the decisions of the
Board are made after due consideration of independent and impartial opinions. We believe our
independent non-executive Directors will bring independent judgment to the decision-making
process of our Board. For more details, please see “— Corporate Governance Measures” in this
section; and
iv. our executive Directors and senior management members are independent from our Controlling
Shareholders. They have substantial experience in the industry which we are engaged in.
Accordingly, they are able to discharge their duties independently from our Controlling
Shareholders.
Operational Independence
Although our Controlling Shareholders will remain as the controlling shareholders of our Company
upon the Listing, we are of the view that we will continue to carry out our business operations
independently from our Controlling Shareholders and their respective close associates for the reasons
stated below.
Customers
The sales made by our Group and our Controlling Shareholders to their respective clients/partners
are carried out separately pursuant to individual sales contracts and are not bundled together, and in
particular:
i. prior to entering into a sales contract with our Group, clients/partners are generally aware of
what type of CRDMO services they are seeking from our Group, and they will contract directly
with our Group to obtain the required ADC CRDMO services. The sales contract entered is,
therefore, tailored to the customer’s needs for the development of an ADC as required;
ii. any client/partner that requires CRDMO services in relation to both ADCs and unconjugated
biologics (including, but not limited to, unconjugated mAbs, BsAbs, multispecific antibodies,
proteins and vaccines) would obtain such services separately from our Group (in the case of
ADCs) and from the Remaining WXB Group (in the case of unconjugated biologics);
iii. payments for our ADC CRDMO services are received in accordance with a pre-agreed payment
schedule specified in the relevant contracts. The payment schedule sets out the fees for services
to be provided at relevant discovery, development or manufacturing steps that fall under the
scope of work in the contract;
iv. for each ADC CRDMO project, clients/partners would enter into individual sales contracts with
our Group, and each individual sales contract relates to one particular ADC CRDMO project
only. Accordingly, neither our Group nor the Remaining WXB Group has entered into any sales
contract that covers both biologics CRDMO services and ADC CRDMO services at the same
time; and
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 243 —


--- page 253 ---
v. the WXA T Group provides integrated, end-to-end services including chemistry drug CRDMO,
biology discovery, preclinical testing and clinical research services, cell and gene therapies
CTDMO independently from our Group to its customers.
Sourcing of clients/partners
We conduct our own sales and marketing primarily through our own sales and marketing team.
Further, we acquire new clients/partners mainly through (i) the existing relationship between the
prospective clients/partners and the Remaining WXB Group, and (ii) our Group’s own independent
marketing efforts. Notwithstanding that some of our clients/partners are also clients/partners of the
Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group, we have entered into separate sales contracts with our
clients/partners which are not bundled together with our Controlling Shareholders or their close associates.
The Remaining WXB Group will continue to refer to our Group clients/partners that contemplate on the
development of an ADC on a no-fee basis. In addition, as the business of our Group continues to grow,
we believe will be able to further obtain new clients/partners through our own independent marketing
efforts. Thus, we are able to operate independently from, and do not rely on, our Controlling Shareholders
in terms of provision of services to clients/partners and sourcing of clients/partners.
Suppliers and Procurement
We have established our own procurement team that operates independently of our Controlling
Shareholders. During the Track Record Period, we had sourced certain raw materials through the
centralized procurement system of the WXB Group, and we had also obtained certain project management
services and antibody intermediates manufacturing and other related services from the Remaining WXB
Group, and manufacturing services in relation to payload-linkers and related intermediate products from
the WXA T Group. Despite the foregoing, our Directors are of the view that our procurement does not
result in any reliance on our Controlling Shareholders for the following reasons:
(i) Procurement of raw materials. The raw materials procured by us through the centralized
procurement system of the WXB Group are predominately off-the-shelf lab supplies, such as
various types of liquid containers and mixer bags, tubing, filters and chemicals, and given the
lab supplies are commonly used, some of our major suppliers during the Track Record Period
have overlapped with the Remaining WXB Group’s own suppliers. The procurement of raw
materials through the WXB Group’s centralized procurement system has enabled us to benefit
from the substantial economies of scale that are associated with the magnitude of the WXB
Group’s global business. However, this is not a cause for concern as advised by Frost &
Sullivan, given the raw materials we use are widely available in the market from a large number
of alternative suppliers, in the unlikely event of any shortage of supply, such supplies would
be readily available to our Group from various independent suppliers based on normal and
commercial and comparable terms (including both quality and price). As our procurement team
is still being expanded, we have entered into continuing connected transactions with the
Remaining WXB Group for the supply of raw materials, the transaction amount of which is
expected to decrease in the future given our procurement team will gradually conduct more
procurement for our Group as our business and operation expands. For further details, please
see the section headed “Connected Transactions — Non-exempt Continuing Connected
Transactions — 2. Raw Materials Procurement Services Agreement” in this prospectus.
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 244 —


--- page 254 ---
(ii) Procurement of PPE . During the Track Record Period, we had obtained project management
services from the Remaining WXB Group in relation to the development and construction of
our facilities. We turn to the Remaining WXB Group for these project management services
because, in general, the Remaining WXB Group has world-class experience in the design and
construction of facilities for research and development relating to, and manufacturing of,
biologics, and such experience is highly relevant to the construction of our new facilities. We
also procured certain property, plant and equipment (“ PPE”) from some overlapping suppliers
of the Remaining WXB Group. The procurement of PPE generally relates to the design and
construction of new facilities. Such purchases from the overlapping suppliers were made
directly by our Group with the suppliers on a project-by-project basis and was in the ordinary
course of our business. As advised by Frost & Sullivan, such supplies of PPE would be readily
available to both our Group and the Remaining WXB Group from alternative suppliers on
normal commercial and comparable terms (including both quality and price). After the Listing,
we will continue to procure project management services from the Remaining WXB Group to
provide project management services in respect of our facilities under construction and
planning. For details on the Project Management Services Agreement, please see the section
headed “Connected Transactions — Non-exempt Continuing Connected Transactions — 3.
Project Management Services Agreement” in this prospectus.
(iii) Procurement of antibody intermediates manufacturing and other related services . During the
Track Record Period, we had engaged the Remaining WXB Group in relation to antibody
intermediates development, manufacturing and quality testing services, which we believe is
more desirable and better serves the interests of our Group, as purchase of such services from
the Remaining WXB Group would ensure a stable, uninterrupted and trusted source of supply
of antibody intermediates for our business. As confirmed by Frost & Sullivan, it is common
market practice for third party suppliers to provide antibody intermediates manufacturing
services for the conjugation process in the provision of ADC CRDMO services and apart from
the Remaining WXB Group, which is one of the leading global biologics CRDMO, there are
many other independent third party suppliers from which we may obtain antibody intermediates
manufacturing services on normal and comparable commercial terms (including both quality
and price). Our procurement of antibody intermediates manufacturing and other related
services from the Remaining WXB Group will continue after the Listing. At the same time, we
will continue to build upon our antibody intermediates manufacturing capacity, including our
new Wuxi ADC facility which commenced operation in September 2023, upon which we would
be able to commence in-house antibody intermediates manufacturing and substantially increase
our capacity. Accordingly, our demand for antibody intermediates manufacturing services from
external sources is expected to decrease going forward. For details, please see the section
headed “Connected Transactions — Non-exempt Continuing Connected Transactions — 1.
Antibodies Master Services Agreement” in this prospectus.
(iv) Procurement of payload-linkers manufacturing and other related services. We entered into
agreement to acquire the Payload & Linker Business (which includes the customer resources,
personnel and assets relating to such business) from STA in July 2021 to complement our Core
Business. While the WXA T Group has some residual capabilities on development and
manufacturing of payload-linkers that can be used for an ADC drug for the reason that
payload-linkers are effectively a type of highly active cell-killing toxic small molecule drug
which can also be utilized in a non-ADC application (for example, chemotherapy drugs), the
WXA T Group will utilize such capabilities to manufacture and supply payload-linkers for use
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 245 —


--- page 255 ---
in ADC CDRMO services only at our request under the Payload-Linkers Master Services
Agreement. Consequently, there will be no direct or material competition between us and the
WXA T Group. During the Track Record Period and after our acquisition of the Payload &
Linker Business from STA, we had engaged the WXA T Group for the provision of
manufacturing services of payload-linkers and related intermediate products (which are
chemical intermediates that some of our projects may require depending on the project
specifications of our clients/partner). We believe that it has been beneficial to our Group, as the
WXA T Group is able to ensure a stable, uninterrupted and trusted source of supply of
payload-linkers and related intermediate products for our business. While we will substantially
increase our capacity for the manufacturing of payload-linkers through our new Wuxi ADC
facility which commenced operation in September 2023, we anticipate that our future demand
for payload-linkers will exceed our expanded capacity in the near term, as the demand from
clients/partners for our Group’s ADC CRDMO services, and consequently, payload-linkers, is
expected to grow continuously. Such unfulfilled demand for payload-linkers manufacturing and
related services will be satisfied by the WXA T Group, or if the situation requires, by third party
suppliers as they are commonly available on the market. As confirmed by Frost & Sullivan, it
is common market practice for third party suppliers to provide payload-linkers for the
conjugation process in the provision of ADC CRDMO services, which are readily available on
normal and comparable commercial terms (including both quality and price). As we will
continue to build upon our payload-linkers manufacturing capacity, our demand for payload-
linkers manufacturing services from external sources is expected to decrease going forward,
thereby resulting in a decreasing trend of the annual caps between 2023 and 2025 under the
Payload-Linkers Master Services Agreement. For details, please see the section headed
“Connected Transactions — Non-exempt Continuing Connected Transactions — 8. Payload-
Linkers Master Services Agreement” in this prospectus.
The following table sets forth a breakdown of the source of antibody intermediates and
payload-linkers used in our integrated projects as a percentage of our total number of integrated projects
as of the dates indicated:
As of December 31, As of June 30,
2020 (3) 2021 2022 2023
Source
Number of
projects
% over
total
number of
projects
Number of
projects
% over
total
number of
projects
Number of
projects
% over
total
number of
projects
Number of
projects
% over
total
number of
projects
Antibody
intermediates (1) ..
Supplied by the
Remaining
WXB Group 24 60.0% 36 60.0% 69 73.4% 80 72.7%
Supplied by
clients/partners
or third
parties
(2) 16 40.0% 24 40.0% 25 26.6% 30 27.3%
Payload-linkers . . . Supplied by our
Group/the
WXA T
Group
(4) N/A N/A 26 43.3% 43 45.7% 52 47.3%
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 246 —


--- page 256 ---
As of December 31, As of June 30,
2020 (3) 2021 2022 2023
Source
Number of
projects
% over
total
number of
projects
Number of
projects
% over
total
number of
projects
Number of
projects
% over
total
number of
projects
Number of
projects
% over
total
number of
projects
Supplied by
clients/partners
or third
parties
(2) N/A N/A 34 56.7% 51 54.3% 58 52.7%
Notes:
1. During the Track Record Period, we did not have our own in-house manufacturing capacity with respect to antibody
intermediates. The antibody intermediates used by us in the provision of our ADC CRDMO services were, unless supplied
by our clients/partners, sourced from the Remaining WXB Group through the manufacturing and other related services we
procured from it.
2. Antibody intermediates and payload-linkers supplied by our clients/partners include those manufactured by themselves
internally and those sourced externally directly by them from other third parties.
3. We acquired the Payload-Linker Business in 2021 and commenced operations in the same year.
4. Since our acquisition of the Payload-Linker Business in 2021, we have fulfilled all non-GMP manufacturing needs of
payload-linkers used in our integrated projects. As we did not have large scale GMP manufacturing capabilities for
payload-linkers until completion of our new ADC facility in Wuxi, which commenced operation in September 2023, we have
outsourced the GMP manufacturing of payload-linkers for certain of our integrated projects to the WXA T Group. For
illustrative purposes, among the 26, 43 and 52 of our ongoing integrated projects as of December 31, 2021, December 31, 2022
and June 30, 2023, respectively, the GMP manufacturing of payload-linkers for 23, 37 and 44 projects (representing
approximately 88.5%, 86.0% and 84.6%) were fulfilled by the WXA T Group, respectively, as of the corresponding dates.
Notwithstanding that a substantial portion of our antibody intermediates and payload-linkers was
sourced from our Controlling Shareholders through the manufacturing and other related services we
procured from them during the Track Record Period, with the commencement of our new ADC facility in
Wuxi in September 2023, we will substantially increase our manufacturing capacity, which is expected to
cause our demand for antibody intermediates and payload-linkers manufacturing and other related services
from our Controlling Shareholders to continue to display a decreasing trend. For details, please see the
sections headed “Connected Transactions — Non-exempt Continuing Connected Transactions — 1.
Antibodies Master Services Agreement” and “— 8. Payload-Linkers Master Services Agreement” in this
prospectus. The Remaining WXB Group and WXA T Group does not conduct antibody intermediates and
payload-linkers manufacturing in relation to ADCs for other parties, other than as engaged by our Group.
As such, we believe that there will not be any undue reliance by us on our Controlling Shareholders with
respect to the procurement of antibody intermediates and payload-linker manufacturing and other related
services and that there is a clear delineation between our business and the respective businesses of the
Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group.
Facilities
As of the Latest Practicable Date, we had three facilities in Shanghai, Changzhou and Wuxi, all of
which operate independently of our Controlling Shareholders. We have built another ADC facility in Wuxi
which has dual manufacturing functions of mAbs, payload-linkers, DS and DP , fill/finish and packaging
with target GMP release and has commenced operation in September 2023. We also plan to develop new
facilities and expand our existing facilities with proceeds from the Global Offering, including, without
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 247 —


--- page 257 ---
limitation, the construction of a new facility in Singapore for DS and DP discovery and development,
which is expected to commence operation by 2026. The completion of our new ADC facility in Wuxi and
the expected completion of our new ADC facility in Singapore by 2026 will bring us increased capacity
in development and production and thus, enable us to continue to carry out our business operations
independently of and without any undue reliance on our Controlling Shareholders and their close
associates.
We leased a property from STA Changzhou for our facility in Changzhou for our predominantly
non-GMP manufacturing of payload-linkers for predominately meeting our research and development
needs, an arrangement which will continue after the Listing. We have not acquired or leased any GMP
manufacturing facilities, whether from the WXA T Group or other third parties, since we had drawn up
plans to construct our new all-in-one facilities in Wuxi and Singapore which will provide us with GMP
manufacturing capabilities, and prefer to continue engaging the WXA T Group for the provision of
payload-linker and related services for better commercial benefits. The leased property has a total area of
approximately 820 sq.m. only and is mainly for our laboratory and office use in relation to the
payload-linkers development. For more details of the lease from STA Changzhou, please see the section
headed “Connected Transactions — Non-exempt Continuing Connected Transactions — 9. WXA T
Property Lease” in this prospectus. In view of the demand for the GMP manufacturing of payload-linkers
which we require as part of our ADC CRDMO services, we have historically engaged the WXA T Group
to provide such services, a practice which we expect to continue after the Listing. With the commencement
of operation of our new Wuxi ADC facility in September 2023, we will also be able to substantially
increase our capacity for the GMP manufacturing of payload-linkers. For more details of our facilities,
please see the section headed “Business — Facilities” in this prospectus.
Employees
We recruit our full-time employees independently from our Controlling Shareholders. As of
September 30, 2023 we had 1,110 employees who are responsible for carrying out the business operations
of our Group under the leadership of our senior management team. Since the formation of our Group, the
Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group have respectively transferred around 140 and 50 personnel
to our Group as our full-time employees, who were involved in the R&D function of our Group, of which
five are our key R&D personnel. Set forth below are details of such key personnel:
Current Title of Key Personnel
Previous Role at our
Controlling Shareholders Expertise Material Contributions
Head of mAb/BCM
manufacturing of
our Group ............
Head of mAb/BCM
manufacturing of the
XBCM1 (DP3) business
unit of the WXB Group
Antibody and drug
conjugate substance
production and
process scale-up
Led the production
team of antibody-
conjugated stock
solution
Head of DP
manufacturing of our
Group ..............
Head of DP manufacturing
of the XDP1 (DP3)
business unit of the
WXB Group
Drug clinical and
commercial
production and
project transfer
Led his team to
complete over 220
instances of batch
preparation
production
Head of discovery
service of our Group .....
Head of bioconjugation
discovery service of the
BCD business unit of
the WXB Group
Bioconjugation
discovery
Successfully
contributed to the
advancement of 28
lead molecules to
CMC stage
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 248 —


--- page 258 ---
Current Title of Key Personnel
Previous Role at our
Controlling Shareholders Expertise Material Contributions
Head of bioconjugation
process development of our
Group ..............
Head of bioconjugation
process development of
the BCD business unit
of the WXB Group
Process development,
non-GMP
production,
technology transfer
and process
characterization of
bioconjugates
Led more than 100
bioconjugate drug
process
development
Head of payload-linker
division of our Group ....
Head of payload-linkers
development and
manufacturing of the
payload-linker division
of STA Changzhou
Process development
and manufacturing
of small molecule,
API, HPAPI and
payload-linkers
Led the process
development and
manufacturing
activities of
payload-linkers for
client specific
molecules under
non-GMP and GMP
conditions
We do not rely on any R&D and other key personnel of our Controlling Shareholders in our
operations. Our Controlling Shareholders only provide us with manufacturing and other related services
in respect of antibody intermediates and payload-linkers for our ADC CRDMO services. Given that our
self-sufficient in-house R&D department is manned by 359 dedicated employees, being approximately
41% of the total number of employees of our Group, who collectively possess deep experience and
know-how, and that we will continue to recruit new talents, our Directors are of the view that we have
sufficient expertise and resources to carry out our ongoing projects independently of our Controlling
Shareholders. As our R&D department has been operating as a well-oiled machine since the formation of
our Group and throughout the Track Record Period, we believe that the timely addition of our chief
technology officer Dr. Marie Meiying Zhu, as a well-regarded and seasoned expert in drug development,
in particular, ADC development, will offer great assistance to us in our further development and
enhancement of the scale and capabilities of our R&D department. As of the Latest Practicable date, none
of our key R&D personnel transferred from our Controlling Shareholders was involved in any function of
our Controlling Shareholders.
We have also established independent key functional departments, including finance and internal
audit. Accordingly, our Group has sufficient number of employees necessary to make key decisions on, and
to carry out, our business operations independently of our Controlling Shareholders. For further details,
please see the section headed “Business — Employees” in this prospectus.
Intellectual property rights
We use, and will continue to use, intellectual property rights that are material to our business,
including, without limitations, the patents and trademarks relating to the processes for preparing ADC with
improved homogeneity (WuXiDAR4). Such intellectual property rights related to our ADC CRDMO
services are developed and invented solely by the research and development personnel of our Group,
without the involvement of any personnel of our Controlling Shareholders. The intellectual property rights
which are exclusive to our business were transferred to our Group from the Remaining WXB Group at nil
consideration, given that the rightful ownership of such intellectual property rights belongs to our Group.
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 249 —


--- page 259 ---
The inventors of the patent were employees of the BCD business unit of the Remaining WXB Group,
and the BCD business unit was transferred to our Group. For details of the transfer, please see the section
headed “History, Reorganization and Corporate Structure — Major Acquisition and Transfers during the
Track Record Period — Transfer of the BCD business unit” in this prospectus.
For details of all the patents and patent applications which have been transferred or assigned from
the Remaining WXB Group to us as of the Latest Practicable Date, please see the section headed
“Appendix IV — Statutory and General Information — C. Further Information about our Business — 2.
Intellectual Property Rights of our Group — (b) Patents” in this prospectus.
As of the Latest Practicable Date, relevant members of the Remaining WXB Group have completed
the assignment of the ownership of all the registered intellectual property rights related to our business to
members of our Group. On the other hand, our Group has not used, and has no intention to use, any
intellectual property rights owned or developed by the WXA T Group. As a result, we do not, and will not,
rely on any intellectual property rights, trade secrets and know-how belonging to our Controlling
Shareholders for the operation of our business.
Connected Transactions with our Controlling Shareholders
The connected transactions set out in the section headed “Connected Transactions” in this prospectus
have been, and will be, conducted in the ordinary and usual course of business of our Group, on an arm’s
length basis and on normal commercial terms or better. Given the established long-term relationship
between us and the Remaining WXB Group and WXA T Group, and in particular the fact that each of the
Remaining WXB Group and the WXA T Group will remain to be a controlling shareholder of our Company
after the Listing, such connected transactions are unlikely to be materially adversely changed or
terminated. Even in an unlikely event that our Controlling Shareholders terminates any connected
transactions with us, for the reasons set out above, we do not consider such termination will materially and
adversely affect our business.
By virtue of the aforesaid, our Directors believe that we are able to operate our business
independently from our Controlling Shareholders and their respective close associates.
Financial Independence
As of the Latest Practicable Date, our Group did not have any outstanding loans or advances due to
or from our Controlling Shareholders or their respective close associates or financial assistance
arrangement with our Controlling Shareholders or their respective close associates, and our Group had not
provided any guarantee in respect of any loans of our Controlling Shareholders and their respective close
associates and vice versa.
As of June 30, 2023, the trade receivables to our Group by the Remaining WXB Group amounted
to approximately RMB78.1 million, representing approximately 5.37% of our total current assets. Also, as
of June 30, 2023, the trade payable from the Remaining WXB Group to our Group amounted to
approximately RMB429.6 million, representing approximately 41.35% of our total current liabilities.
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 250 —


--- page 260 ---
As of June 30, 2023, the trade receivables to our Group by the WXA T Group amounted to
approximately RMB10.7 million, representing approximately 0.73% of our total current assets. Also, the
trade payables from the WXA T Group to our Group amounted to approximately RMB55.2 million,
representing approximately 5.31% of our total current liabilities.
Our financial reporting system is independent from that of our Controlling Shareholders and their
respective close associates. Our Group makes financial decisions according to our own business needs, and
the major financial operations are handled by our finance and accounting department, which operates
independently from our Controlling Shareholders and their respective close associates. Further, our Group
will not be dependent on our Controlling Shareholders or future financing, and will be capable of raising
our own finance when required without the support of our Controlling Shareholders. We do not share any
other functions or resources with our Controlling Shareholders or their respective close associates.
Based on the above, our Directors believe that our Group is able to operate with financial
independence from our Controlling Shareholders and their respective close associates.
DEED OF NON-COMPETITION
On October 30, 2023, WuXi Biologics has entered into a deed of non-competition (the “ Deed of
Non-Competition ”) in favor of our Company, pursuant to which WuXi Biologics has undertaken to our
Company that it will not and will procure its close associates (except any member of our Group) not to,
directly or indirectly (whether in the capacity of principal or agent, whether for its own benefit or jointly
with or on behalf of any person, firm or company), commence, engage in, participate in or acquire any
business (other than our business) which competes or may compete directly or indirectly with our Core
Business (“ Restricted Business ”).
WuXi Biologics has further undertaken that during the Restricted Period (as defined below), it shall,
and shall procure its close associates (except any member of our Group) (WuXi Biologics and its close
associates together, “ Offeror ”) to offer any new business investment or other business opportunity (“ New
Business Opportunity ”) relating to the Restricted Business to our Company first in the following manner
when such New Business Opportunity is identified or made available to the Offeror:
i. the Offeror will make referral of the New Business Opportunity to our Company, and will
within thirty (30) days (“ Restricted Period ”) inform us in writing (“ Offer Notice ”) about all
necessary and reasonably required information in respect of any New Business Opportunity
(including but not limited to details of the nature and investment or acquisition cost of the New
Business Opportunity) for our Company to consider (a) whether the relevant New Business
Opportunity will compete with our business, and (b) whether taking up the New Business
Opportunity is in the interest of our Group;
ii. upon receipt of the Offer Notice, the independent non-executive Directors will consider
whether to pursue or decline the New Business Opportunity taking into account whether the
relevant New Business Opportunity would be able to achieve a sustainable profitability level,
whether they are in line with the prevailing development strategies of our Group, and whether
they are in the best interest of the Shareholders. Our Company must inform the Offeror in
writing within thirty (30) Business Days after receipt of the Offer Notice of our decision on
whether the New Business Opportunity will be pursued; and
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 251 —


--- page 261 ---
iii. only when (a) the Offeror has received our notice to decline the New Business Opportunity or
our confirmation that the relevant New Business Opportunity are not considered to be able to
compete with our Restricted Business; or (b) the Offeror has not received the relevant notice
from our Company within the period as stated above in paragraph (ii) after the Offer Notice has
been received by us, then the Offeror is entitled to take up the New Business Opportunity on
terms and conditions not more favorable than those specified in the Offer Notice issued to us.
If there are any material changes in relation to the terms and conditions of the New Business
Opportunity after the referral of which have been made or procured to be made to our Company by the
Offeror, referral of the revised New Business Opportunity shall be made by the Offeror to us again in the
manner as stated above.
The undertakings under the Deed of Non-Competition are not applicable in the following
circumstances:
i. WuXi Biologics and/or its respective close associates engage in the Restricted Business
directly or indirectly through the ownership of equity interest in any member of our Group; or
ii. WuXi Biologics and/or its respective close associates engage in the Restricted Business
directly or indirectly through the ownership of equity interest in listed companies other than
our Group, with the following conditions being satisfied:
a. the Restricted Business (and relevant assets) conducted or carried out by such company
represents less than 10% of the revenue or total assets of such company according to the
latest audited accounts of such company; and
b. WuXi Biologics and/or its respective close associates (except any member of our Group)
hold in aggregate not more than 10% of the issued share capital of relevant class of shares
of such company, and WuXi Biologics and/or its respective close associates (except any
member of our Group) have no right to appoint the majority of directors of such company
or participate in the management of such company.
In addition, our Company has taken, or will take, the following measures to safeguard good corporate
governance standards in respect of the Deed of Non-Competition:
i. the independent non-executive Directors will review the compliance with the undertakings
under the Deed of Non-Competition by WuXi Biologics on an annual basis;
ii. WuXi Biologics will provide or procure the provision of all necessary information required for
the Board’s annual review of compliance with the Deed of Non-Competition; and
iii. WuXi Biologics will make an annual declaration on its compliance with the Deed of
Non-Competition in our annual report;
The Deed of Non-Competition will lapse automatically if WuXi Biologics ceases to be a controlling
shareholder of our Company or if our Shares cease to be listed on the Stock Exchange.
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 252 —


--- page 262 ---
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE MEASURES
We have put in place sufficient corporate governance measures to manage the conflict of interest and
potential competition from our Controlling Shareholders and safeguard the interest of the Shareholders,
including:
i. if a Director has a material interest in a particular transaction, he shall abstain from voting in
any matters relating to such transaction being considered at the Board meeting and he will not
be counted as a quorum of the Board meeting;
ii. if disinterested Directors (including the independent non-executive Directors) reasonably seek
to obtain independent and professional advice (such as financial adviser advice), the costs
incurred for obtaining such advice will be borne by our Company;
iii. our Company has established internal control mechanisms to identify connected transactions.
Upon the Listing, if our Company enters into connected transactions with any of our
Controlling Shareholders and their respective close associates, our Company will comply with
the applicable Listing Rules;
iv. the independent non-executive Directors will review, on an annual basis, whether there are any
conflicts of interests between our Group and our Controlling Shareholders and provide
impartial and professional advice to protect the interests of our minority Shareholders;
v. our Company will disclose in our annual report the decisions (if any) of the independent
non-executive Directors on matters relating to the New Business Opportunity and the relevant
basis;
vi. where our Directors reasonably request the advice of independent professionals, such as
financial advisers, the appointment of such independent professionals will be made at our
Company’s expenses; and
vii. we have appointed Somerley Capital Limited as our compliance advisor to provide advice and
guidance to us in respect of compliance with the applicable laws and regulations in Hong Kong,
as well as the Listing Rules, including various requirements relating to corporate governance
from the Listing Date to the date when our Company distribute our annual report of our
financial results for the first full financial year commencing after the Listing Date.
RELATIONSHIP WITH OUR CONTROLLING SHAREHOLDERS
— 253 —


--- page 263 ---
Upon Listing, the following transactions between us and our connected persons will constitute our
continuing connected transactions under Chapter 14A of the Listing Rules.
OUR CONNECTED PERSONS
We have entered into certain transactions with WuXi Biologics and WuXi AppTec and their
respective associates during the Track Record Period in our ordinary and usual course of business and such
transactions are expected to continue after the Listing:
 WuXi Biologics
As of the Latest Practicable Date, WuXi Biologics directly held 60% equity interest of our Company.
Following the Global Offering (assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised and without taking
into account any Shares which may be issued upon exercise of the options granted under the Pre-IPO Share
Option Schemes), WuXi Biologics will hold 50.91% equity interest of our Company and continue to be
our Controlling Shareholder. Accordingly, WuXi Biologics is a connected person of our Company upon
Listing. WuXi Biologics is a company incorporated under the laws of the Cayman Islands listed on the
Main Board of the Stock Exchange (stock code: 2269). The WXB Group is a leading global biologics
CRDMO platform engaged in the provision of one-stop end-to-end biologics discovery, research,
development and manufacturing services to its clients.
 WuXi Biologics Co., Ltd.
As of the Latest Practicable Date, WuXi Biologics Co., Ltd. was an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary
of WuXi Biologics, and therefore WuXi Biologics Co., Ltd. will be a connected person of our Company
upon Listing. Its principal business is development of, and the provision of consultation services in
relation to, the biopharmaceutical technology.
 WuXi AppTec
As of the Latest Practicable Date, WuXi AppTec indirectly held 98.56% equity interest of STA,
which wholly owns STA Pharmaceutical, being a 40% shareholder of our Company. Following the Global
Offering (assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised and without taking into account any Shares
which may be issued upon exercise of the options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes), STA
Pharmaceutical will hold 33.94% equity interest of our Company. Accordingly, WuXi AppTec will be a
connected person of our Company upon Listing. WuXi AppTec is a joint stock company incorporated in
the PRC with limited liability and is listed on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange (stock code: 2359)
and the Shanghai Stock Exchange (stock code: 603259.SH). The WXA T Group is a leading global
pharmaceutical research and development services platform engaged in the business of discovery,
development and manufacturing of innovative pharmaceuticals.
 STA Changzhou
As of the Latest Practicable Date, WuXi AppTec indirectly held 98.56% equity interest of STA
Changzhou, and therefore STA Changzhou will be a connected person of our Company upon Listing. Its
principal business is research and development, improvement and production services of small molecule
drugs.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 254 —


--- page 264 ---
NON-EXEMPT CONTINUING CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
The transactions described in the summary table below will constitute non-exempt continuing
connected transactions under Chapter 14A of the Listing Rules:
Continuing Connected Transactions with the Remaining WXB Group:
Historical Amount
(RMB million)
Proposed Annual Cap
(RMB million)
For the year ended
December 31,
For the six
months ended
June 30,
For the year ended
December 31,
Nature of
Transaction
Applicable
Listing Rules Waiver Sought 2020 2021 2022 2023 2023 2024 2025
Antibodies Master
Services
Agreement ....
14A.34, 14A.35,
14A.36, 14A.46,
14A.49, 14A.71
Announcement and
the independent
Shareholders’
approval
requirements
1.5 20.2 355.7 445.0 1,081.0 1,015.0 895.0
Raw Materials
Procurement
Services
Agreement ....
14A.34, 14A.35,
14A.49, 14A.71
Announcement
requirements
3.5 15.4 21.9 15.1 34.5 32.6 21.3
Project Management
Services
Agreement ....
14A.34, 14A.35,
14A.36, 14A.46,
14A.49, 14A.71
Announcement and
the independent
Shareholders’
approval
requirements
0.4 6.2 17.7 10.8 31.2 50.0 55.0
Overseas Technical
Support Services
Agreement ....
14A.34, 14A.35,
14A.49, 14A.71
Announcement
requirements
— — 7.9 7.5 12.0 9.6 4.8
ADC Master Services
Agreement ....
14A.34, 14A.35,
14A.36, 14A.46,
14A.49, 14A.71
Announcement and
the independent
Shareholders’
approval
requirements
42.3 195.8 370.8 136.2 218.0 96.0 41.0
General Services
Agreement ....
14A.34, 14A.35,
14A.49, 14A.71
Announcement
requirements
3.8 10.2 18.0 8.6 15.0 11.0 9.0
WXB Property
Lease ......
14A.34, 14A.35,
14A.49, 14A.71
Announcement
requirements
— 5.5 2.8 1.7 5.0 5.0 5.0
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 255 —


--- page 265 ---
Continuing Connected Transactions with WXAT Group:
Historical Amount
(RMB million)
Proposed Annual Cap
(RMB million)
For the year ended
December 31,
For the six
months ended
June 30,
For the year ended
December 31,
Nature of
Transaction
Applicable
Listing Rules Waiver Sought 2020 2021 2022 2023 2023 2024 2025
Payload-Linkers
Master Services
Agreement ....
14A.34, 14A.35,
14A.36, 14A.46,
14A.49, 14A.71
Announcement and
the independent
Shareholders’
approval
requirements
— 21.9 132.9 65.0 206.0 182.0 168.0
WXAT Property
Lease ......
14A.34, 14A.35,
14A.49, 14A.71
Announcement
requirements
— 1.4 4.9 2.2 8.0 4.0 —
1. Antibodies Master Services Agreement
Principal terms
We entered into the antibodies master service framework agreement (the “ Antibodies Master
Services Agreement ”) with WuXi Biologics on November 3, 2023, pursuant to which the Remaining
WXB Group will provide certain development, manufacturing and quality testing services in relation to
antibody intermediates (e.g., mAbs) for use in provision of our CRDMO services. The Antibodies Master
Services Agreement is effective from the Listing Date until December 31, 2025 and is renewable for a term
of three years upon mutual consents and subject to compliance with all applicable laws and regulations
as well as the Listing Rules.
Reasons for the transactions
During the Track Record Period, our Group engaged the Remaining WXB Group in relation to
development, manufacturing and quality testing of antibody intermediates for use in provision of our
CRDMO services, which we believe is desirable and better serves the interests of our Group as the
procurement of such services from the Remaining WXB Group would ensure a stable, uninterrupted and
trusted source of supply of antibody intermediates. For details of the percentages of our integrated projects
related to the Antibodies Master Services Agreement during the Track Record Period, please see the
section headed “Relationship with our Controlling Shareholders – Suppliers and Procurement” in this
prospectus. We expect that the demand from clients/partners for our Group’s ADC CRDMO services will
grow continuously going forward, and further new contracts for our CRDMO services will be entered into
by our Group with our existing and new clients/partners. To enhance the manufacturing capacity of our
Group and reduce our use of external suppliers, we have constructed a second ADC facility in Wuxi which
commenced operation in September 2023, and we will continue to develop and expand our facilities, such
as our new facility in Singapore, using the proceeds from the Global Offering. For more details, please see
the section headed “Business — Our Facility Expansion Plans” in this prospectus.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 256 —


--- page 266 ---
We expect that our existing and new CRDMO projects will maximally utilize our Group’s current and
expected capacity for antibody intermediates production in the near future. In such event, the unfulfilled
demand for antibody intermediates manufacturing services will be satisfied by the Remaining WXB
Group, or if the situation requires, by third party suppliers which, as confirmed by Frost & Sullivan, are
readily available on normal commercial terms (including both quality and price). While we expect to
substantially increase our antibody intermediates manufacturing capacity through our new ADC facility
site in Wuxi which commenced operation in September 2023, we are also exploring other alternatives to
meet any excess demand for antibody intermediates, such as entering into leasing arrangement with
respect to existing facilities with certain independent third parties. With our new ADC facility site in Wuxi
having commenced operation and the availability of other alternative arrangements to satisfy the demand
for antibody intermediates, we currently anticipate that the percentage of the antibody intermediates to be
sourced from the Remaining WXB Group out of the total antibody intermediates to be used in our CMC
development projects will continue to decease in the future. Based on the best estimates of our
management according to their best knowledge and judgment of current events and actions, and taking into
account various factors and assumptions, including (i) the future growth and market potential of the global
ADC markets, including the CAGR of the global ADC markets of approximately 30% between 2022 and
2030, as advised by Frost & Sullivan; (ii) the expected growth in demand for ADC CRDMO services from
our existing and new clients/partners; (iii) the historical transaction amounts incurred by our Group for the
antibody intermediates related services provided by the Remaining WXB Group; and (iv) our current and
expanded manufacturing capacity, we expect that the percentages of our integrated projects related to the
Antibodies Master Services Agreements for the years ended December 2023, 2024 and 2025 will
demonstrate a decreasing trend, representing approximately 95%, 70% and 50%, respectively. Further,
given the established long-term relationship between our Group and the Remaining WXB Group, and in
particular the fact that our Company will remain a subsidiary of WuXi Biologics upon Listing, we also
believe that the transactions under the Antibodies Master Services Agreement are unlikely to be materially
adversely changed or terminated after the Listing.
Pricing policy
The service fees charged by the Remaining WXB Group will be at rates no less favorable than those
rates charged by the Remaining WXB Group to independent third parties for comparable transactions, and
will be determined by the parties through arm’s length negotiation based on standard pricing schedule used
by the Remaining WXB Group for all its customers. When determining the prices set out in the standard
pricing schedule, a number of factors that are relevant to the services provided are being taken into account
including, but not limited to, (i) the nature, scale, frequency and value of the relevant development,
manufacturing and quality testing services; (ii) the complexity of tasks completed by the Remaining WXB
Group at each stage under each work order; (iii) the resources spent on providing specific services; and
(iv) the fees charged for historical transactions of similar nature and the then prevailing market rates. The
pricing policy for the Antibodies Master Services Agreement will continue to be supervised and monitored
by the management and the relevant personnel of our Group to ensure the transactions contemplated
thereunder are conducted on normal commercial terms and will be in the interests of our Company and our
Shareholders as a whole.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 257 —


--- page 267 ---
Historical transaction amounts
For each of the years ending December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and for the six months ended
June 30, 2023, the total amount incurred by our Group for the antibody intermediates related services
provided by the Remaining WXB Group was RMB1.5 million, RMB20.2 million, RMB355.7 million and
RMB445.0 million, respectively, representing approximately 1.7%, 10.2%, 48.8% and 58.2% of our total
cost of services during the corresponding periods.
Annual cap
For each of the years ending December 31, 2023, 2024 and 2025, the total amount payable by our
Group to the Remaining WXB Group for transactions contemplated under the Antibodies Master Services
Agreement is not expected to exceed RMB1,081.0 million, RMB1,015.0 million and RMB895.0 million,
respectively.
The increase in annual cap for the Antibodies Master Services Agreement for the year ended
December 31, 2023 is based on the anticipated rapid and robust business growth in 2023. The surge in
demand for ADC CRDMO services in the first half of 2023 is evidenced by a significant increase in our
Company’s backlog. As of the Latest Practicable Date, the total estimated backlog for antibody
intermediates manufacturing and other related services under the existing ADC CRDMO projects of our
Group has increased to approximately RMB1,099 million. This is in line with the market landscape for
ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services during the same period. As confirmed by Frost &
Sullivan, there was an increasing market trend for ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services
in the PRC in the second quarter compared with the first quarter of 2023, as the number of ADC products
progressed to the clinical stage in the PRC increased by approximately 40% between the first and second
quarters of 2023. On the above basis, our Directors are of the view that the proposed annual caps for the
Antibodies Master Services Agreement are on normal commercial terms, fair and reasonable and in the
interest of our Company and our Shareholders as a whole.
Basis of cap
The above proposed annual caps are determined based on the following factors: (i) our total backlog
for antibody intermediates related services under the existing CRDMO projects as of the Latest Practicable
Date; (ii) the anticipated growth in the demand for antibody intermediates related services in the future
three years ending December 31, 2025; (iii) the expected increase in our manufacturing capacity in
relation to antibody intermediates; and (iv) the amount of antibody intermediates that may be sourced by
us and/or our clients/partners from independent third party suppliers. With our increasing manufacturing
capacity and the availability of other alternative arrangements to satisfy the demand for antibody
intermediates, we expect that our demand for antibody intermediates related services from external sources
will continuously decrease after the Listing.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 258 —


--- page 268 ---
2. Raw Materials Procurement Services Agreement
Principal terms
We entered into a raw materials procurement services framework agreement (the “ Raw Material
Procurement Services Agreement ”) with WuXi Biologics on November 3, 2023, pursuant to which our
Group will procure certain ADC/conjugate-related raw materials (e.g., inner package material,
ultrafiltration membrane package and joints and tubes) together with the ancillary logistics and
warehousing services, material testing and quality control services from the Remaining WXB Group. The
Raw Material Procurement Services Agreement is effective from the Listing Date to December 31, 2025,
and is renewable for a term of three years upon mutual consents and subject to compliance with all
applicable laws and regulations as well as the Listing Rules.
Reasons for the transactions
During the Track Record Period, procurement of raw materials was mainly conducted through
members of the Remaining WXB Group on a centralized basis, which enabled the WXB Group (including
our Company) to benefit from the substantial economies of scale that are associated with the magnitude
of the global business. Furthermore, given that the Remaining WXB Group is familiar with our quality
standards to raw materials, it will be able to satisfy our demand efficiently and reliably with minimal
disruption to our Group’s operations. As such, compared with procuring such raw materials from third
parties independently, we believe that continuing to procure raw materials from the Remaining WXB
Group is beneficial to us and our Shareholders as a whole.
Pricing policy
Purchase prices of raw materials provided by the Remaining WXB Group under the Raw Material
Procurement Services Agreement will be determined with reference to (i) the costs of the relevant raw
materials; and (ii) a 6.5% premium for the relevant raw materials procurement services provided. Our
Directors, after consulting with Frost & Sullivan, are of the view that the percentage of premium charged
under the Raw Material Procurement Services Agreement is generally in line with the prevailing industry
norm for transactions of similar nature.
Historical transaction amounts
For each of the years ending December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and for the six months ended
June 30, 2023, the total amount incurred by our Group for the raw materials and related services provided
by the Remaining WXB Group under was RMB3.5 million, RMB15.4 million, RMB21.9 million and
RMB15.1 million, respectively, representing approximately 4.0%, 7.8%, 3.0% and 2.0% of our total cost
of services during the corresponding periods.
Annual cap
For each of the years ending December 31, 2023, 2024 and 2025, the total amount payable by our
Group for the raw materials and related services to be procured under the Raw Materials Procurement
Services Agreement is not expected to exceed RMB34.5 million, RMB32.6 million and RMB21.3 million,
respectively.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 259 —


--- page 269 ---
Basis of cap
The above proposed annual caps are determined based on the expected revenue growth and business
expansion of our Group. Nevertheless, as our Group’s business scales up, we will further benefit from
economies of scale when procuring raw materials that are required in connection with our ADC CRDMO
business on our own without involvement of the Remaining WXB Group. As a result, it is expected that
the transaction amounts for the Raw Materials Procurement Services Agreement will gradually decrease
for the period from 2023 to 2025, notwithstanding the anticipated increase in the scale of our ADC
CRDMO business over that period.
3. Project Management Services Agreement
Principal terms
We entered into a project management services framework agreement (the “ Project Management
Services Agreement ”) with WuXi Biologics on November 3, 2023, pursuant to which the Remaining
WXB Group will provide certain project management services in relation to the preliminary planning,
design and construction of new facilities (e.g., at Wuxi and Singapore) to our Group. The Project
Management Services Agreement is effective from the Listing Date to December 31, 2025, and is
renewable for a term of three years upon mutual consents and subject to the requirements under the Listing
Rules and other applicable laws and regulations.
Reasons for the transactions
During the Track Record Period, and in particular during the years ended December 31, 2021 and
2022, our Group has engaged the project management team of the Remaining WXB Group for certain
project management services in relation to the design and construction of new facilities, principally our
new ADC facility in Wuxi. Also, our Group intends to obtain project management services from the
Remaining WXB Group in relation to the design and construction of our new facility in Singapore. Given
that the Remaining WXB Group has world-class experience in the design and construction of facilities for
research and development relating to, and manufacturing of, biologics, and such experience is highly
relevant to the construction of our new ADC facilities in Wuxi and Singapore, we believe that it would
be considerably less cost-effective for us to attempt to build up similar know-how in-house or to obtain
such project management services from an unrelated third party.
Pricing policy
The service fees charged by the Remaining WXB Group will be determined based on (i) the costs
and expenses of providing such services (e.g., labor costs, administrative costs and costs of materials); and
(ii) a 7% premium for the relevant project management services provided. Our Directors, after consulting
with Frost & Sullivan, are of the view that the percentage of premium charged under the Project
Management Services Agreement is generally in line with the prevailing industry norm for transactions of
similar nature.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 260 —


--- page 270 ---
Historical transaction amounts
For each of the years ending December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and for the six months ended
June 30, 2023, the total amount incurred by our Group for the project management services provided by
the Remaining WXB Group was RMB0.4 million, RMB6.2 million, RMB17.7 million and RMB10.8
million, respectively, representing approximately 0.5%, 3.1%, 2.4% and 1.4% of our total cost of services
during the corresponding periods.
Annual cap
For each of the years ending December 31, 2023, 2024 and 2025, the total amount payable by our
Group for the project management services to be provided under the Project Management Services
Agreement is not expected to exceed RMB31.2 million, RMB50.0 million and RMB55.0 million,
respectively.
Basis of cap
The above proposed annual caps are determined based on the expected growth in our demand for the
project management services from the Remaining WXB Group for our ongoing construction projects in
Wuxi and Singapore.
4. Overseas Technical Support Services Agreement
Principal terms
We entered into an overseas technical support services framework agreement (the “ Overseas
Technical Support Services Agreement ”) with WuXi Biologics on November 3, 2023, pursuant to which
the CMC (chemistry, manufacturing and controls) professionals of the Remaining WXB Group will
provide CMC services in relation to the life cycle of ADC in overseas jurisdictions (e.g., the United States
and Europe) to our Group. The CMC services provided by the Remaining WXB Group are mainly related
to overseas business development services (i.e., securing new sales orders from potential clients/partners)
and customer support services (i.e., advising existing clients/partners when their projects encounter any
particular difficulties and providing them technical information on such projects). The Overseas Technical
Support Services Agreement is effective from the Listing Date to December 31, 2025, and is renewable
for a term of three years upon mutual consents and subject to the requirements under the Listing Rules and
other applicable laws and regulations.
Reasons for the transactions
As we do not currently have any overseas corporate entity in United States or Europe to allow us to
hire local employees to provide the CMC services in those jurisdictions, and the relevant members of the
Remaining WXB Group have local offices and employees who are familiar with the business needs of our
Company, the requirements of its customers and their practices, we believe it will be cost efficient to
continue engaging the Remaining WXB Group for such services.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 261 —


--- page 271 ---
Pricing policy
The service fees charged by the Remaining WXB Group will be determined based on (i) the costs
and expenses of such services (e.g., salaries of professionals employed and related expenses) provided by
the Remaining WXB Group; and (ii) a 5% premium for the relevant overseas technical support services
provided. Our Directors, after consulting with Frost & Sullivan, are of the view that the percentage of
premium charged under the Overseas Technical Services Agreement is generally in line with the prevailing
industry norm for transactions of similar nature.
Historical transaction amounts
For each of the years ending December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and for the six months ended June
30, 2023, the total amount incurred by our Group for the overseas technical support services provided by
the Remaining WXB Group was nil, nil, RMB7.9 million and RMB7.5 million, respectively, representing
nil, nil, approximately 1.1% and 1.0% of our total cost of services during the corresponding periods.
Annual cap
For each of the years ending December 31, 2023, 2024 and 2025, the total amount payable by our
Group for the overseas technical support services to be provided under the Overseas Technical Support
Services Agreement is not expected to exceed RMB12.0 million, RMB9.6 million and RMB4.8 million,
respectively.
Basis of cap
The above proposed annual caps are determined based on our plan to establish our own local offices
and hire local employees in certain overseas jurisdictions (e.g., the United States and Europe). As we
continue to expand, we have plans to establish new overseas subsidiaries so that we may directly hire local
employees as the CMC officers in those overseas jurisdictions. As such, the proposed annual caps for the
Overseas Technical Support Services Agreement show a decreasing trend for the period from 2023 to
2025.
5. ADC Master Services Agreement
Principal terms
We entered into an ADC master services framework agreement (the “ ADC Master Services
Agreement ”) with WuXi Biologics on November 3, 2023, pursuant to which we will provide certain
discovery, research and development and manufacturing services in relation to ADCs to the Remaining
WXB Group pursuant to certain ADC CRDMO contracts entered into by the Remaining WXB Group with
clients/partners prior to January 2023. The ADC Master Services Agreement is effective from the Listing
Date to December 31, 2025, and is renewable for a term of three years upon mutual consents and subject
to the requirements under the Listing Rules and other applicable laws and regulations.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 262 —


--- page 272 ---
Reasons for the transactions
The above ADC related services arise from certain contracts for the provision of ADC CRDMO
services that were entered into through members of the Remaining WXB Group with clients/partners prior
to January 2023. Since development of an ADC from inception to manufacturing typically is a multi-year
process, these contracts typically are multi-year contracts. In connection with each such contract, the
relevant member of the Remaining WXB Group engaged one or more relevant members of our Group as
a subcontractor to provide the agreed ADC CRDMO services to the client/partner. For the years
ending December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and for the six months ended June 30, 2023, the percentages
of our integrated projects related to the ADC Master Services Agreement were approximately 63%, 63%,
40% and 22%, respectively. As of the Latest Practicable Date, a total of 34 clients/partners have entered
into the legacy contracts which related to 37 integrated projects with members of the Remaining WXB
Group for ADC CRDMO services, with a total backlog of approximately RMB275 million, of which
legacy contracts entered into with 26 clients/partners relating to 30 integrated projects are expected to be
fully performed by 2025, and we will continues to use our reasonable commercial efforts to novate the
legacy contracts of the remaining 8 clients/partners relating to 7 integrated projects from the Remaining
WXB Group to our Group, with the expected year of completion ranging from 1 year to 5 years. Set out
below is a table showing the expected year of completion with respect to the relevant integrated projects
of which the legacy contracts have been fully completed and the estimated backlog in respect of such
legacy contracts:
Expected year of completion
No. of integrated projects
of which the legacy
contracts have been
fully completed (1)
Estimated backlog in
respect of the legacy
contracts that have been
fully completed
(RMB in million) (2)(3)
By 2023 ............................ 2 2 174.5
By 2024 ............................ 3 19.4
By 2025 ............................ 5 10.6
Total .............................. 30 204.5
Notes:
(1) Each integrated project involves multiple legacy contracts (including customer contracts and purchase orders) entered
throughout the development of such integrated project.
(2) The estimated backlog in respect of the legacy contracts only refers to that of the legacy contracts that have been fully
completed by the relevant year but does not represent the total backlog of the relevant integrated projects concerned,
nor take into account those contracts entered into with the clients/partners directly for such integrated projects.
(3) The estimated backlog in respect of the legacy contracts was prepared based on (i) our Group’s existing and expanded
manufacturing capacity upon completion of our new ADC facility site in Wuxi, which commenced operation in
September 2023; (ii) the estimated timeline for completion of the legacy contracts with reference to the expected
completion date specified in the relevant contracts (if any); and (iii) the estimated progress of the legacy contracts
which may be susceptible to unforeseeable material changes or development in the future.
(4) Based on the best estimates of our management according to their best knowledge and judgment of current events and
actions, and taking into account the factors set out in note (3) above, the percentages of our integrated projects related
to the ADC Master Services Agreement for the years ended December 2023, 2024 and 2025 are expected to
demonstrate a decreasing trend, representing approximately 10%, 5% and 3%, respectively.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 263 —


--- page 273 ---
Based on the above, it is currently anticipated that all the transactions in relation to provision of ADC
CRDMO services by our Group to the Remaining WXB Group will terminate by the end of 2025 when
all such legacy contracts are either performed or novated, so that our Group will be able to maintain a
direct contractual relationship with each of our clients/partners going forward. In the event that we are
unable to novate any of the remaining legacy contracts from the Remaining WXB Group to our Group by
2025, we will duly comply with the applicable requirements under Chapter 14A of the Listing Rules
(including but not limited to obtain independent shareholders’ approval) in relation to the provision of
ADC CRDMO services by our Group to the Remaining WXB Group for those remaining legacy contracts.
Pricing policy
The service fees charged by our Group will be at rates no less favorable than the rates charged by
our Group to independent third parties for comparable transactions, and will be determined by the parties
through arm’s length negotiation based on standard pricing schedule used by us for all our customers.
When determining the prices set out in the standard pricing schedule, a number of factors that are relevant
to the services provided are being taken into account including, but not limited to, (i) the nature, scale,
frequency and value of the relevant research and development and testing services; (ii) the complexity of
tasks completed by our Group at each stage under each work order; (iii) the resources spent on providing
specific services; and (iv) the fees charged for historical transactions of similar nature and the then
prevailing market rates. The pricing policy for the ADC Master Services Agreement will continue to be
supervised and monitored by the management and the relevant personnel of our Group to ensure the
transactions contemplated thereunder are conducted on normal commercial terms and will be in the
interests of our Company and our Shareholders as a whole.
Historical transaction amounts
For each of the years ending December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and for the six months ended June
30, 2023, the total amount incurred by the Remaining WXB Group for the ADC CRDMO services
provided by our Group was RMB42.3 million, RMB195.8 million, RMB370.8 million and RMB136.2
million, respectively, representing approximately 43.9%, 62.9%, 37.4% and 13.7% of our total revenue
during the corresponding periods.
Annual cap
For each of the years ending December 31, 2023, 2024 and 2025, the total amount payable by the
Remaining WXB Group for the ADC CRDMO services under the ADC Master Services Agreement is not
expected to exceed RMB218.0 million, RMB96.0 million and RMB41.0 million, respectively.
Basis of cap
The above proposed annual caps are determined based on the following factors: (i) the total backlog
revenue to be generated from the ADC related services upon completion of the relevant milestones under
such legacy contracts; and (ii) the estimated percentage of the legacy contracts that can be novated from
the Remaining WXB Group to our Group after entering into new agreements with the relevant
clients/partners in the future three years ending December 31, 2025. Since January 1, 2023, we have
entered into all new contracts for the provision of ADC CRDMO services directly with our clients/partners
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 264 —


--- page 274 ---
and we have not entered into new contracts through the Remaining WXB Group to provide such services
on a subcontractor basis. Therefore, the above proposed annual caps show a decreasing trend for the period
from 2023 to 2025, reflecting the scheduled performance and novation of such legacy contracts.
6. General Services Agreement
Principal terms
We entered into a general services framework agreement (the “ General Services Agreement ”) with
WuXi Biologics on November 3, 2023, pursuant to which the Remaining WXB Group will provide certain
general services in relation to, among others, business development, public relations, human resources,
information technology as well as other administrative and general supporting services, to our Company.
The General Services Agreement is effective from the Listing Date until December 31, 2025 and is
renewable for a term of three years upon mutual consents and subject to the requirements under the Listing
Rules and other applicable laws and regulations.
Reasons for the transactions
The services provided under the General Services Agreement can help enhance utilization and
economies of scale of the Remaining WXB Group’s operational support resources and, on the other hand,
reduce the administrative costs of our Group in procuring similar services from a wide range of other
providers. The General Services Agreement will allow our Group to better leverage on the mature
infrastructure and coverage already built by the Remaining WXB Group and promote better cooperation
between the Remaining WXB Group and our Group.
Pricing policy
The service fees charged by the Remaining WXB Group will be determined with reference to (i) the
costs and expenses of such services (e.g. administrative and general supporting services); and (ii) a 5%
premium for the relevant general services provided. Our Directors, after consulting with Frost & Sullivan,
are of the view that the percentage of premium charged under the General Services Agreement is generally
in line with the prevailing industry norm for transactions of similar nature.
Historical transaction amounts
For each of the years ending December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and for the six months ended June
30, 2023, the total amount incurred by our Group for the general services provided by the Remaining WXB
Group was RMB3.8 million, RMB10.2 million, RMB18.0 million and RMB8.6 million, respectively,
representing approximately 4.3%, 5.2%, 2.5% and 1.1% of our total cost of services during the
corresponding periods.
Annual cap
For each of the years ending December 31, 2023, 2024 and 2025, the total amount payable by our
Group for the general services is not expected to exceed RMB15.0 million, RMB11.0 million and RMB9.0
million, respectively.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 265 —


--- page 275 ---
Basis of cap
The above proposed annual caps are determined based on: (i) the historical transaction amounts paid
by our Group to the Remaining WXB Group for the relevant general services; and (ii) the estimated
demand for the relevant general services by our Group. As we will continue to expand our own
administrative and supporting functional departments, the proposed annual caps for the General Services
Agreement show a decreasing trend for the period from 2023 to 2025.
7. WXB Property Lease
Principal terms
We entered into a property lease agreement (the “ WXB Property Lease ”) with WuXi Biologics Co.,
Ltd. on November 3, 2023. Pursuant to the WXB Property Lease, our Group agreed to lease a premise
located at Plant No. 2, 11 Xinhui Ring Road, Wuxi with a total gross area of approximately 2,690.5 sq.m.
to WuXi Biologics Co., Ltd. as an assembly line for biologics-related consumables. The WXB Property
Lease is effective from the Listing Date to December 31, 2025, and is renewable for a term of three years
upon mutual consents and subject to the requirements under the Listing Rules and other applicable laws
and regulations.
Reasons for the transactions
The leased premises under the WXB Property Lease have been used by WuXi Biologics Co., Ltd. as
an assembly line for biologics-related consumables since 2021 and the rental amount is based on the
market rent of similar properties in similar locations. As such, we believe that it is in our interest in terms
of cost, time and stability to continue to lease the assembly line to WuXi Biologics Co., Ltd. instead of
requesting it to relocate the assembly line to alternative properties immediately upon Listing.
Pricing policy
While the total rentals charged by our Group under the WXB Property Lease will be determined with
reference to the market price of properties of comparable size and use in the vicinity which are available
to independent third parties as agreed by both parties after arm’s length negotiations.
Historical transaction amounts
For each of the years ending December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and for the six months ended
June 30, 2023, the total rental amount incurred by WuXi Biologics Co., Ltd. to our Group for the leased
property was nil, RMB5.5 million, RMB2.8 million and RMB1.7 million, respectively, representing nil,
approximately 1.8%, 0.3% and 0.2% of our total revenue during the corresponding periods.
Annual cap
For each of the years ending December 31, 2023, 2024 and 2025, the total rental amount payable by
WuXi Biologics Co., Ltd. to our Group under the WXB Property Lease is not expected to exceed RMB5.0
million, RMB5.0 million and RMB5.0 million, respectively.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 266 —


--- page 276 ---
Basis of cap
The above proposed annual caps are determined based on the market rent of similar properties in
similar locations and it is expected to remain steady, as no material adjustment is expected to be made to
such rentals during the term of the WXB Property Lease. It is currently expected that WuXi Biologics Co.,
Ltd. will relocate such assembly line to new premises by the end of 2025.
8. Payload-Linkers Master Services Agreement
Principal terms
We entered into a payload-linkers master services framework agreement (the “ Payload-Linkers
Master Services Agreement ”) with WuXi AppTec on November 3, 2023, pursuant to which the WXA T
Group will provide research and development and manufacturing services in relation to payload-linkers
and supply the related intermediate products to our Group for use in our ADC CRDMO services. The
Payload-Linkers Master Services Agreement is effective from the Listing Date to December 31, 2025, and
is renewable for a term of three years upon mutual consents and subject to the requirements under the
Listing Rules and other applicable laws and regulations.
Reasons for the transactions
During the Track Record Period, our Group engaged the WXA T Group to provide research and
development and manufacturing services in relation to the production of payload-linkers and supply
payload-linkers intermediate products for our ADC CRDMO services, which we believe is desirable and
better serves the interests of our Group as the procurement of such services from the WXA T Group would
ensure a stable, uninterrupted and trusted source of supply of payload-linkers. For details of the
percentages of our integrated projects related to the Payload-linkers Master Services Agreement during the
Track Record Period, please see the section headed “Relationship with our Controlling Shareholders –
Suppliers and Procurement” in this prospectus.
We expect that the demand from our clients/partners for our ADC CRDMO services is expected to
grow continuously going forward, and further new contracts for our CRDMO services will be entered into
by our Group with our existing and new clients/partners. In particular, we anticipate an even stronger
business growth in the second half of 2023 given the already displayed significant growth in the first half
of 2023 and the increasing market trend for ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services in the
PRC in the second quarter as compared with the first half of 2023, as the number of ADC products
progressed to the clinical stage in the PRC increased by approximately 40% between the first and second
quarter of 2023, as confirmed by Frost & Sullivan. As of the Latest Practicable Date, we had a total
backlog of approximately RMB95.0 million for payload-linkers manufacturing and other services in the
second half of 2023 based on the current timeline for our existing projects. By taking into account of the
backlog for payload-linkers manufacturing and other services under the existing projects and the new
projects that we may secure in the second half of 2023, we currently expect the transaction amount under
the Payload-Linkers Master Services Agreement will be no more than RMB206 million for the year ended
December 31, 2023.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 267 —


--- page 277 ---
To enhance the manufacturing capacity of our Group and reduce our use of external suppliers, we
have constructed a second ADC facility in Wuxi City which commenced operation in September 2023, and
we will continue to develop and expand our facilities, such as our new facility in Singapore, using the
proceeds from the Global Offering. For more details, please see the section headed “Business — Our
Facility Expansion Plans” in this prospectus.
We expect that our existing and new CRDMO projects will maximally utilize our Group’s current and
expected capacity for payload-linkers production in the near future. In such event, the unfulfilled demand
for payload-linkers manufacturing services will be satisfied by the WXA T Group, or if the situation
requires, by third party suppliers which, as confirmed by Frost & Sullivan, are readily available on normal
commercial terms (including both quality and price). While we expect to substantially increase our
payload-linkers manufacturing capacity upon the commencement of our new ADC facility site in Wuxi in
September 2023, we are also exploring other alternatives to meet any excess demand for payload-linkers,
such as entering into leasing arrangement with respect to existing facilities with certain independent third
parties. With the completion of our new ADC facility site in Wuxi in September 2023, we currently
anticipate that the percentage of the payload-linkers to be sourced from the WXA T Group out of the total
payload-linkers to be used in our CMC development projects will continue to decease in the future. Based
on the best estimates of our management according to their best knowledge and judgment of current events
and actions, and taking into account various factors and assumptions, including (i) the future growth and
market potential of the global ADC markets, including the CAGR of the global ADC markets of
approximately 30% between 2022 and 2030, as advised by Frost & Sullivan; (ii) the expected growth in
demand for ADC CRDMO services from our existing and new clients/partners; (iii) the historical
transaction amounts incurred by our Group for the antibody intermediates related services provided by the
Remaining WXB Group; and (iv) our current and expanded manufacturing capacity, we expect that the
percentages of our integrated projects related to the Payload-Linkers Master Services Agreement for the
years ended December 2023, 2024 and 2025 will demonstrate a decreasing trend, representing
approximately 85%, 55% and 30%, respectively.
Further, given the established long-term relationship between our Group and the WXA T Group, and
in particular, the fact that WuXi AppTec will remain as our Controlling Shareholder upon the Listing, we
believe that the transactions under the Payload-Linkers Master Services Agreement are unlikely to be
materially adversely changed or terminated after the Listing.
Pricing policy
The service fees charged by the WXA T Group will be at rates no less favorable than the rates charged
by the WXA T Group to independent third parties for comparable transactions, and will be determined by
the parties through arm’s length negotiation based on standard pricing schedule used by the WXA T Group
for all its customers. When determining the prices set out in the standard pricing schedule, a number of
factors that are relevant to the services provided are being taken into account, including but not limited
to (i) the nature, scale, frequency and value of the relevant research and development and manufacturing
services; (ii) the complexity of tasks completed by the WXA T Group at each stage under each work order;
(iii) the resources spent on providing specific services; and (iv) the fees charged for historical transactions
of similar nature and the then prevailing market rates. The pricing policy for the Payload-Linkers Master
Services Agreement will continue to be supervised and monitored by the management and the relevant
personnel of our Group to ensure the transactions contemplated thereunder are conducted on normal
commercial terms and will be in the interests of our Company and our Shareholders as a whole.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 268 —


--- page 278 ---
Historical transaction amounts
For each of the three years ending December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and for the six months ended
June 30, 2023, the total amount incurred by our Group for the payload-linkers related services provided
by the WXA T Group was nil, RMB21.9 million, RMB132.9 million and RMB65.0 million, respectively,
representing approximately 0%, 11.1%, 18.2% and 8.5% of our total cost of services during the
corresponding periods.
Annual cap
For each of the three years ending December 31, 2023, 2024 and 2025, the total amount payable by
our Group to the WXA T Group under the Payload-Linkers Master Services Agreement is not expected to
exceed RMB206.0 million, RMB182.0 million and RMB168.0 million, respectively.
Basis of cap
The above proposed annual caps are determined based on the following factors: (i) the historical
transaction amounts paid by our Group to the WXA T Group for the payload-linkers related services; (ii)
the historical and anticipated growth of the global ADC market; (iii) the expected increase in our
manufacturing capacity in relation to payload-linkers; and (iv) the amount of payload-linkers that may be
sourced by us and/or our clients/partners from independent third party suppliers. With our increasing
manufacturing capacity for payload-linkers, we expect that our demand for payload-linkers related
services from external sources will continuously decrease after the Listing.
9. WXAT Property Lease
Principal terms
We entered into a property lease (the “ WXAT Property Lease ”) with STA Changzhou on November
3, 2023, pursuant to which our Company leases from STA Changzhou the premises with a total area of
approximately 820 sq.m. located at No. 589 North Y ulong Road, Xinbei District, Changzhou City, Jiangsu
Province, the PRC, for laboratory and office use in relation to the payload-linkers development. STA
Changzhou has also agreed to provide certain general supporting services (e.g., parking, security and
cleaning services) in relation to the leased premises to our Company. The WXA T Property Lease is
effective from the Listing Date until December 31, 2024.
Reasons for the transactions
Since 2021, we have leased the above premises for developing and manufacturing payload-linkers.
To avoid unnecessary interruption of the administration and extra relocation cost of manufacturing
facilities, we believe that the continuation of such lease is cost efficient and beneficial to our operations.
Pricing policy
While the total rentals charged by STA Changzhou under the WXA T Property Lease will be
determined with reference to the market price of properties of comparable size and use in the vicinity
which are available to independent third parties as agreed by both parties after arm’s length negotiations,
the service fees charged by STA Changzhou to our Group for the general supporting services under the
WXA T Property Lease will be determined with reference to the cost of the general supporting services
provided and a 6% premium.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 269 —


--- page 279 ---
Historical transaction amounts
For each of the years ending December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and for the six months ended
June 30, 2023, the total rentals and service fees incurred by us to STA Changzhou for the leased premises
were nil, RMB1.4 million, RMB4.9 million and RMB2.2 million, respectively, representing nil,
approximately 0.7%, 0.7% and 0.3% of our total cost of services during the corresponding periods.
Annual cap
For each of the years ending December 31, 2023 and 2024, the total rentals and service fees payable
by us to STA Changzhou under the WXA T Property Lease are not expected to exceed RMB8.0 million and
RMB4.0 million, respectively.
Basis of cap
The above proposed annual caps for the rentals are determined based on the market rent of similar
properties in similar locations and the service fees are determined based on the cost of the general
supporting services provided by STA Changzhou to our Group with a 6% premium. It is currently expected
that we will relocate such manufacturing line from the leased premises to our new ADC facility in Wuxi
by the end of 2024.
D. W AIVERS GRANTED BY THE STOCK EXCHANGE
In respect of the transactions under the Raw Materials Procurement Services Agreement, the
Overseas Technical Support Services Agreement, the General Services Agreement, the WXB Property
Lease and the WXA T Property Lease, the highest applicable percentage ratio is more than 0.1% but less
than 5%, the transactions contemplated thereunder are subject to the announcement and annual reporting
requirements under Rule 14A.35, Rule 14A.49 and 14A.71 of the Listing Rules.
In respect of the transactions under the Antibodies Master Services Agreement, the Project
Management Services Agreement, the ADC Master Services Agreement and the Payload-Linkers Master
Services Agreement, the highest applicable percentage ratio is more than 5%, the transactions
contemplated thereunder are subject to the announcement, circular, independent shareholders’ approval
and annual reporting requirements under Rule 14A.35, Rule 14A.36, Rule 14A.46, Rule 14A.49 and Rule
14A.71 of the Listing Rules.
We have applied for, and the Stock Exchange has granted a waiver to us from strict compliance with
(i) the announcement requirement under the Listing Rules in respect of the transactions under the Raw
Materials Procurement Services Agreement, the Overseas Technical Support Services Agreement, the
General Services Agreement, the WXB Property Lease and the WXA T Property Lease provided that the
total transaction amount of the transactions under the respective agreement for each of the years ending
December 31, 2023, 2024 and 2025 will not exceed the relevant proposed annual cap set forth above; and
(ii) the announcement, circular and independent shareholders’ approval requirement under the Listing
Rules in respect of the transactions under the Antibodies Master Services Agreement, the Project
Management Services Agreement, the ADC Master Services Agreement and the Payload-Linkers Master
Services Agreement provided that the total transaction amount of the transactions thereunder for each of
the years ending December 31, 2023, 2024 and 2025 will not exceed the relevant proposed annual cap set
forth above.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 270 —


--- page 280 ---
In addition, our Directors confirm that we will comply with the applicable requirements under
Chapter 14A of the Listing Rules and will immediately inform the Stock Exchange if any of the proposed
annual caps set out above are exceeded, or when there is a material change in the terms of the transactions.
If the Listing Rules impose more stringent requirements in respect of the non-exempt continuing
connected transactions in the future, we will promptly adopt measures within a reasonable time to ensure
compliance with such new requirements.
DIRECTORS’ VIEWS
Our Directors (including our independent non-executive Directors) consider that the above
non-exempt continuing connected transactions have been, and will be, entered into in our ordinary and
usual course of business and on normal commercial terms, are fair and reasonable and in the interest of
our Company and Shareholders as a whole. The proposed annual caps in respect of the non-exempt
continuing connected transactions are also fair and reasonable and in the interest of our Company and our
Shareholders as a whole.
JOINT SPONSORS’ CONFIRMATION
The Joint Sponsors have reviewed the relevant information and historical figures prepared and
provided by us in relation to the non-exempt continuing connected transactions as set out above, and have
also discussed these transactions with us and obtained various representations from us. Based on the
aforementioned due diligence work, the Joint Sponsors are of the view that (i) the non-exempt continuing
connected transactions as set out above have been entered into in the ordinary and usual course of business
of our Group, on normal commercial terms or better, and are fair and reasonable and in the interests of
our Group and Shareholders as a whole; and (ii) the proposed annual caps for such transactions are fair
and reasonable and in the interests of our Company and Shareholders as a whole.
CONNECTED TRANSACTIONS
— 271 —


--- page 281 ---
BOARD OF DIRECTORS
Our Board will consist of nine Directors upon Listing, of whom three are executive Directors, three
are non-executive Directors and three are independent non-executive Directors. Our Board is responsible
and has general powers for the management and conduct of our business.
The table below sets out certain information in respect of the members of the Board:
Name Age Position
Time of joining
our Group or
the Remaining
WXB Group (3)
Time of
appointment as
Director
Roles and
Responsibilities
Dr. Jincai Li (1)
(ҽᎀʑ).......
50 Executive Director
and chief executive
officer
September 2011 December 2020 Formulating overall
strategic plans,
business development
and daily operations
of our Group
Mr. Jerry
Jingwei Zhang
(ੵཨਃ).......
55 Executive Director
and chief operating
officer
April 2019 June 2023 Managing the supply
chain and operations
of our Group
Mr. Xiaojie Xi
(ወઠ).......
47 Executive Director,
chief financial
officer and
company secretary
May 2023 June 2023 Overseeing the overall
financial
management,
financial matters and
strategic
development of our
Group
Dr. Zhisheng Chen
(1)
(௓౽௷).......
50 Chairman and
non-executive
Director
June 2011 December 2020 Providing overall
guidance on the
business, strategy
and corporate
development of our
Group
Dr. Weichang Zhou
(1)
(׹.......)
59 Non-executive
Director
December 2012 December 2020 Providing guidance on
corporate strategy
and governance to
our Group
Ms. Ming Shi
(1)(2)
(׼݄.........)
48 Non-executive
Director
June 2023 June 2023 Providing guidance on
corporate strategy
and governance to
our Group
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 272 —


--- page 282 ---
Name Age Position
Time of joining
our Group or
the Remaining
WXB Group (3)
Time of
appointment as
Director
Roles and
Responsibilities
Dr. Ulf Grawunder . . 58 Independent non-
executive Director
Listing Date Listing Date Supervising and
providing
independent
judgment to our
Board
Mr. Stewart
John Hen .......
56 Independent non-
executive Director
Listing Date Listing Date Supervising and
providing
independent
judgment to our
Board
Mr. Hao Zhou ..... 4 7 Independent non-
executive Director
Listing Date Listing Date Supervising and
providing
independent
judgment to our
Board
(1) At the incorporation of our Company, WuXi Biologics appointed Dr. Zhisheng Chen, Dr. Weichang Zhou and Dr. Jincai Li
as Directors, and STA Pharmaceutical appointed Dr. Ge Li and Mr. Minzhang Chen as Directors. On May 31, 2021, Dr. Ge
Li was replaced by Mr. Steve Qing Y ang due to internal personnel reallocation, as the representative of STA Pharmaceutical
at the Board.
(2) On June 30, 2023, Dr. Minzhang Chen and Dr. Steve Qing Y ang, our former Directors and the representatives of STA
Pharmaceutical, resigned and were replaced by Ms. Ming Shi due to internal personnel reallocation, as the representative of
STA Pharmaceutical at the Board.
(3) Denotes the time from which the relevant Director first became involved in matters relating to the business of our Group while
under the employment of the Remaining WXB Group or our Group (where applicable).
Executive Directors
Dr. Jincai Li ( ҽᎀʑ), aged 50, has been a Director since the incorporation of our Company in
December 2020, and re-designated as an executive Director and appointed as the chief executive officer
of our Company since June 2023. He is primarily responsible for formulating overall strategic plans,
business development and daily operations of our Group. Dr. Li has over 20 years of experience in
biologics process development, scale-up and cGMP manufacturing. Under his leadership, our Group
became a leading ADC and bioconjugates CRDMO, which was recognized by the 2022 World ADC
Awards’ Runner Up prize in the “Best CMO Provider” category and the winner of the 2023 World ADC
Awards’ prize in the “Best Contract Development Manufacturing Organization (CDMO)” category.
Dr. Li joined the WXB Group in September 2011 and since May 2020 had served as the senior vice
president at the WXB Group. Throughout 2021 and 2022, Dr. Li spearheaded the integration of the ADC
capabilities into our Group and accumulatively his team had completed more than 40 ADCs/bioconjugates
IND filings in China, US and Europe. From September 2011, Dr. Li built and led the cell culture process
development and non-GMP pilot plant production group of the WXB Group, and went on to manage the
MFG1, MFG3 cGMP facilities, as well as the start-up of the MFG5 cGMP facility. During his tenure with
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 273 —


--- page 283 ---
MFG1, Dr. Li led the efforts to successfully pass our first FDA and EMA pre-license inspections and
achieved the first FDA biologics BLA approval in China. Before Dr. Li joined the WXB Group, from
August 2007 to September 2011, Dr. Li had also served as a group leader at Genentech, Inc. where he was
responsible for cell culture process development. From April 2006 to July 2007, Dr. Li had also been a
scientist at Tanox, Inc., and from August 2001 to March 2006, Dr. Li was a staff scientist at Diversa
Corporation (now BASF) where he was in charge of process development for multiple biologics projects.
Dr. Li obtained a bachelor’s degree in chemical engineering and technology and minor in chemistry
from Tsinghua University ( ૶ശɽኪ) in China in July 1996 and obtained a doctoral degree majoring in
chemical and biochemical engineering from University of Maryland Baltimore County in the United States
in August 2001.
Dr. Li does not have any current or past directorships in listed companies in the last three years.
Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang ( ੵཨਃ), aged 55, has been an executive Director and the chief operating
officer of our Company since April 2023. He is primarily responsible for managing the supply chain and
operations of our Group. Mr. Zhang has over 25 years of experience in the biotech industry.
Mr. Zhang served as a senior vice president of global strategic operations of the WXB Group and was
responsible for supply chain planning, global procurement, warehouse management and environment,
health and safety from April 2019 to March 2023, while he was also involved in the supply chain
operations of our business. Before that, Mr. Zhang worked as an operations finance controller for the
global operations and supply chain department of Axalta Coating Systems Ltd. in the United States from
April 2016 to April 2019 and served as a finance director for the corporate financial shared services of TE
Connectivity Ltd. in the United States from March 2010 to April 2016. From December 1999 to February
2010, Mr. Zhang served at Pfizer Inc. in the United States as the finance director for supporting sales,
global manufacturing, logistics, procurement and supply chain operation.
Mr. Zhang obtained his bachelor’s degree in biomedical science from Nankai University (කɽኪ)
in China in July 1990 and received his master’s degree in business administration from New Y ork
University, Stern School of Business in the United States in May 2002.
Mr. Zhang does not have any current or past directorships in listed companies in the last three years.
Mr. Xiaojie Xi (ወઠ), aged 47, has been an executive Director since June 2023 and the chief
financial officer of our Company since May 2023. Mr. Xi is primarily responsible for overseeing the
overall financial management, financial matters and strategic development of our Group. He brings over
18 years of financial industry experience in the United States and China to our Company, including
investment banking and private equity investment with many public and private companies.
Prior to joining our Group, from November 2018 to May 2023, Mr. Xi served as the chief financial
officer and simultaneously from April 2020 to May 2023, a joint company secretary of Akeso, Inc., a
company listed on the Stock Exchange (stock code: 09926), where during his tenure he was recognised
as a “Best CFO” by Institutional Investor magazine. Before that, from August 2017 to October 2018, he
was a director at SIN Capital (HK) Limited, focusing on investments in healthcare industry in China, and
from April 2015 to July 2017, he served as a director head of corporate finance and capital markets at
CLSA Limited. Between October 2013 and April 2015, Mr. Xi was the vice president of investment
banking and strategic advisory department at Credit Suisse AG Hong Kong branch. From March 2010 to
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 274 —


--- page 284 ---
April 2013, Mr. Xi served as the vice president of investment banking division at Morgan Stanley Asia
Limited. During his time with the aforementioned investment banks, Mr. Xi had executed high profile
transactions, including IPOs, debt and equity financings and M&As for leading companies in China.
Mr. Xi obtained his bachelor’s degree in biochemistry from Wuhan University (ဏɽኪ) in China
in 1997 and obtained his master’s degree in science from Rutgers, The State University of New Jersey in
the United States in 2002. He further obtained his MBA degree with distinction from New Y ork University,
Stern School of Business in the United States in 2008.
Mr. Xi does not have any current or past directorships in listed companies in the last three years.
Non-executive Directors
Dr. Zhisheng Chen ( ௓౽௷), aged 50, has been a Director since the incorporation of our Company
in December 2020 and was re-designated as a non-executive Director since June 2023. He was appointed
as the chairman of the Board in May 2021. Dr. Chen is primarily responsible for providing overall
guidance on the business, strategy and corporate development of our Group. Dr. Chen has over 20 years
of experience in the biotech industry.
Dr. Chen has joined the WXB Group since June 2011 and served in several roles including, but not
limited to, as WuXi Biologics’ executive director from February 2014 and chief executive officer from
January 2016. From June 2011 to January 2016, Dr. Chen also served as a senior vice president of WuXi
Biologics Co. Ltd. (previously known as WuXi AppTec Biotechnology Co., Ltd. (Ҧஔ
ʮ̡)) where he was responsible for the management of biologics development and manufacturing.
Before that, Dr. Chen also worked in a number of pharmaceutical companies, including (i) as the chief
operating officer of Shanghai Celgen Bio-Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. (ʮ̡) from
August 2008 to June 2011 where he was responsible for the development, manufacturing and quality
control of biologics, (ii) as a director of production at Applied Molecular Evolution, Inc., a subsidiary of
Eli Lilly and Company, a global pharmaceutical company listed on NYSE (stock code: LL Y) from
November 2005 to August 2008 and (iii) as a process engineer and manager of Merck & Co. Inc., a
pharmaceutical company listed on NYSE (stock code: MRK) from June 2000 to November 2005.
Dr. Chen obtained a bachelor’s degree in chemical engineering and technology from Tsinghua
University ( ૶ശɽኪ) in China in July 1994 and a doctoral degree in chemical engineering from
University of Delaware in the United States in August 2000. In November 2018, Dr. Chen was appointed
by International Society for Pharmaceutical Engineering (ISPE) to serve on the International Board of
Directors.
Save as disclosed above, Dr. Chen does not have any current or past directorships in listed companies
in the last three years.
Dr. Weichang Zhou (׹)aged 59, has been a Director since December 2020 and was
re-designated as a non-executive Director since June 2023. He is primarily responsible for providing
guidance on corporate strategy and governance to our Group. Dr. Zhou has around 30 years of experience
in the biotech industry.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 275 —


--- page 285 ---
Dr. Zhou first joined WuXi Biologics Co. Ltd. (previously known as WuXi AppTec Biotechnology
Co., Ltd. (ʮ̡)) in December 2012 as a vice president responsible for the
management of biologics development and manufacturing functions. Dr. Zhou served in several roles of
WuXi Biologics including, but not limited to, as its executive director from May 2016, chief technology
officer from November 2016 and president of global biologics development and operations from October
2022. He is primarily responsible for overseeing the development and manufacturing of biologics. He is
also responsible for several global operational functions such as global IT since October 2022.
Prior to that, Dr. Zhou served as a senior director of Genzyme Corporation (now part of Sanofi S.A.)
from March 2008 to December 2012, and was responsible for process engineering and development. From
October 2002 to February 2008, Dr. Zhou served as a senior director of PDL BioPharma Inc., a
biopharmaceutical company listed on NASDAQ (stock code: PDLI), and was responsible for process
sciences and engineering functions. From May 1994 to October 2002, Dr. Zhou served as up to an
associate director of Merck & Co., Inc. and was responsible for fermentation and cell culture process
development.
Dr. Zhou obtained a bachelor’s degree in organic chemical engineering from Jiangxi University of
Technology ( ϪГʈኪ৫) in China in July 1982 and obtained a doctoral degree in natural sciences from
the University of Hannover in Germany in 1989.
Save as disclosed above, Dr. Zhou does not have any current or past directorships in listed companies
in the last three years.
Ms. Ming Shi (׼݄)aged 48, has been a non-executive Director since June 2023. She is primarily
responsible for providing guidance on corporate strategy and governance to our Group. Ms. Shi has had
over 20 years of management experience in the fields of finance, business development and operations.
Prior to joining our Group, Ms. Shi has also been serving as the chief financial officer of WuXi
AppTec since January 2022, and was its senior vice president in finance from April 2021 to January 2022.
Before that, from September 2005 to April 2021, Ms. Shi successively held several senior management
roles at General Electric in various business departments mainly in Greater China area and Asia Pacific
area, with her last position as the managing director of BD and chief financial officer at General Electric
(China) Co., Ltd. from August 2019 to April 2021. Ms. Shi successively served as the internal control
manager and financial controller at Pacific Millennium Paper Group Limited (ʮ
̡) from February 2002 to August 2005. Ms. Shi also worked at other multinational corporations earlier
in her career, including Ernst & Y oung Hua Ming LLP , from July 1997 to February 2002.
Ms. Shi obtained her bachelor’s degree in international finance from the International Business
School of Shanghai University ( ɪऎɽኪ਷ყਠኪ৫) in China in July 1997. She has been a member of
the Chinese Institute of Certified Public Accountants since September 2016 and a graduate of GE’s
Executive Financial Leadership Program (EFLP).
Ms. Shi does not have any current or past directorships in listed companies in the last three years.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 276 —


--- page 286 ---
Independent non-executive Directors
Dr. Ulf Grawunder , age 58, has been appointed as our independent non-executive Director and his
appointment will take effect from the Listing Date. He is primarily responsible for supervising and
providing independent judgment to our Board. Dr. Grawunder is an experienced Swiss life-science
entrepreneur with over 20 years of experience in the therapeutic antibody development industry.
Dr. Grawunder has been a co-founder, and since September 2022 serves as chief executive officer,
of T-CURX GmbH in Germany, a company that focuses on the development of next-generation CAR-T cell
therapies for cancer patients. Furthermore, since January 2022, he serves as the managing partner of
Viopas V enture Consulting GmbH, Switzerland. Before that, from June 2012 to November 2021, Dr.
Grawunder was founder and chief executive officer of NBE-Therapeutics AG in Switzerland, a biotech
company developing antibody-drug conjugates (ADCs) for cancer therapy. Dr. Grawunder began his career
in biotechnology by co-founding 4-Antibody AG in September 2003, a therapeutic antibody discovery
company, where he initially served as start-up chief executive officer and later as the chief scientific
officer from August 2006 to June 2012.
Dr. Grawunder is known for his post-doctoral research on the mechanism of V(D)J recombination,
the process that generates antibody and T-cell receptor diversity in the immune system. He was the
investigator of his research at the University of Basel, Switzerland, and at the University of Ulm, Germany
from December 2000 to August 2003 and the scientific collaborator of his research at the Basel Institute
for Immunology from October 1998 to December 1999. Prior to that, he was a post-doctoral fellow in the
laboratory of Prof. Michael Lieber at the University of Southern California, School of Medicine from 1997
to 1998 and at Washington University School of Medicine from 1995 to 1997.
Dr. Grawunder obtained his bachelor’s degree in biochemistry in October 1988 and his master’s
degree in Biochemistry in July 1991, both from the University of Bayreuth, Germany. He subsequently
obtained his doctoral degree in cell biology from the University of Basel in Switzerland in July 1994. In
addition, Dr. Grawunder holds a diploma in Technology Entrepreneurship from the University St. Gallen,
School of Business in Switzerland.
Dr. Grawunder does not have any current or past directorships in listed companies in the last three
years.
Mr. Stewart John Hen , aged 56, has been appointed as our independent non-executive Director and
his appointment will take effect from the Listing Date. He is primarily responsible for supervising and
providing independent judgment to our Board. Mr. Hen has over 20 years of deep and extensive experience
working in the biopharmaceutical and life sciences industry.
Mr. Hen has been the managing partner of Serrado Capital LLC since October 2010 and primarily
invested in publicly traded companies that are of biotech, biopharma, CRO or CRDMO in nature. Prior
to that, Mr. Hen was a managing director at Warburg Pincus LLC from May 2000 to August 2010 where
he made investments in both private and publicly traded companies that are of biopharma, CRO or
CRDMO in nature, and he also served as a consultant at McKinsey & Company from September 1996 to
May 2000. His experience in analysing and investing in biotech and big pharmaceutical companies has
enabled him to gain technical industry knowledge and will allow him to positively contribute to the
matters of our Company.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 277 —


--- page 287 ---
Mr. Hen obtained his bachelor’s degree in chemical engineering from the University of Delaware in
the United States in May 1989 and his master’s degree in chemical engineering practice from
Massachusetts Institute of Technology in the United States in February 1992. He also obtained an MBA
from the University of Pennsylvania in the United States in May 1996.
Mr. Hen does not have any current or past directorships in listed companies in the last three years.
Mr. Hao Zhou , aged 47, has been appointed as our independent non-executive Director and his
appointment will take effect from the Listing Date. He is primarily responsible for supervising and
providing independent judgment to our Board.
Mr. Zhou served as the chief strategy officer of Anjuke Group Inc. (܄֢the housing subsidiary
of 58.com Inc. from November 2020 to March 2023. Prior to that, from June 2011 to November 2020,
Mr. Zhou held several roles in 58.com Inc., which is a company that operates online marketplace serving
local merchants and consumers in the PRC and listed on NYSE (stock code: WUBA) and served as its
chief financial officer from June 2011 to September 2019, and subsequently redesignated as the head of
international business in September 2019 and as its chief strategic officer in April 2020. From September
2010 to June 2011, Mr. Zhou joined CITIC Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. (ʮ̡), a
pharmaceutical service provider that supplies medicine and related consumables to hospitals, as its chief
financial officer, and from May 2009 to September 2010, Mr. Zhou was the vice president of finance and
the chief financial officer at Wuxi PharmaTech (Cayman) Inc. Before that, Mr. Zhou joined General
Electric (China) Co., Ltd. ( ஷ͜ཥं(ʕ਷)ʮ̡) in January 2007 as its financial manager.
Mr. Zhou has served as an independent non-executive director of Angelalign Technology Inc. a
company listed on the Stock Exchange (stock code: 6699) since April 2023, an independent non-executive
director of Bairong Inc., a company listed on the Stock Exchange (stock code: 6608) since March 2021
and an independent non-executive director of Meitu, Inc., a company listed on the Stock Exchange (stock
code: 1357) since 2016.
Mr. Zhou obtained his bachelor’s degree from the Shanghai International Studies University ( ɪऎ
̮਷Ⴇɽኪ) in the PRC in July 1998.
Save as disclosed above, Mr. Zhou does not have any current or past directorships in listed
companies in the last three years.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 278 —


--- page 288 ---
SENIOR MANAGEMENT
Our senior management is responsible for the day-to-day management of our business. The table
below sets out certain information regarding our senior management.
Name Age Position
Date of appointment
as Senior
Management
Date of joining
our Group or
the Remaining
WXB Group (1) Roles and Responsibilities
Dr. Jincai Li
(ҽᎀʑ) .....
50 Executive Director
and chief executive
officer
June 2023 September 2011 Formulating overall
strategic plans,
business development
and daily operations
of our Group
Mr. Jerry Jingwei
Zhang
(ੵཨਃ) .....
55 Executive Director
and chief operating
officer
June 2023 April 2019 Managing the supply
chain and operations
of our Group
Mr. Xiaojie Xi
(ወઠ) .....
47 Executive Director,
chief financial
officer and
company secretary
June 2023 May 2023 Overseeing the overall
financial management,
financial matters and
strategic development
of our Group
Dr. Marie Meiying
Zhu (ߵ..)
58 Chief technology
officer
July 2023 July 2023 Supervising the research
and CMC
development of new
ADC drugs
Dr. Jianjun Luo
(ࠏܔ.....)
56 Vice president June 2023 November 2011 Supervising ADC
conjugate and drug
product manufacturing
(1) Denotes the time from which the relevant senior management first became involved in matters relating to the business of our
Group while under the employment of the Remaining WXB Group or our Group (where applicable).
Dr. Jincai Li ( ҽᎀʑ) is an executive Director and the chief executive officer of our Company. See
“— Board of Directors — Executive Directors” in this section for his biographical details.
Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang ( ੵཨਃ) is an executive Director and the chief operating officer of our
Company. See “— Board of Directors — Executive Directors” in this section for his biographical details.
Mr. Xiaojie Xi (ወઠ) is an executive Director and the chief financial officer of our Company. See
“— Board of Directors — Executive Directors” in this section for his biographical details.
Dr. Marie Meiying Zhu (ߵ)aged 58, has been the chief technology officer of our Company
since July 2023. She is primarily responsible for early discovery of new drugs, drug-linkers, and novel
conjugation technologies and leading CMC development of ADC drugs. Dr. Zhu is a well-regarded expert
and executive with over 28 years of drug development experience in the biotech industry.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 279 —


--- page 289 ---
Prior to joining our Company, Dr. Zhu served as the chief technical officer of RemeGen Ltd. in
Y antai, Shandong, from September 2019 to July 2023 where she is primarily responsible for the research
and development of new ADC products as well as leading the whole CMC team to bring the RC48 ADC
to commercialization. Prior to that, she was the chief executive officer at MabPlex USA in California and
managed its operations including building the site and the team, establishing strategic plans for the site
operation, managing business development and technical development for the site. Before that, Dr. Zhu
served as up to the senior director of process sciences and manufacturing at Agensys/Astellas Pharma Inc
in California where she was responsible for biologic drug development and clinical production from DNA
to ADC drug substance. Before that, Dr. Zhu was the associate director of the process development
department at Xencor Inc. in California and previously she was the manager of bioprocess development
of the biotechnology division at Bristol-Myer Squibb Company in New Y ork. Prior to that, Dr. Zhu held
various successive roles at Pfizer Inc. in Connecticut including research scientist, senior research scientist
and a group leader of bioprocess research and development.
Dr. Zhu obtained her bachelor’s degree in chemical engineering from Tsinghua University ( ૶ശɽ
ኪ) in China in July 1987 and later obtained her master’s degree in chemical engineering from Illinois
Institute of Technology in the United States in December 1991. In May 1999, Dr. Zhu earned her doctoral
degree in chemical engineering from the University of Wisconsin-Madison in the United States.
Dr. Jianjun Luo (ࠏܔ)aged 56, has been our vice president of our Company since June 2023.
He is primarily responsible for supervising ADC conjugate and drug product manufacturing of our Group.
Dr. Luo has over 30 years of experience in the biopharmaceuticals industry.
Dr. Luo has been the vice president of the bioconjugate drug product manufacturing of XDC Wuxi
in August 2021. Prior to that, since February 2020, Dr. Luo has been the vice president of ADC conjugate
and drug product manufacturing of the WXB Group primarily responsible for the management of
manufacturing business of the production facilities of XDC Wuxi and its operations. Before that, from
December 2011 to February 2020, Dr. Luo held several positions within the WXB Group, including senior
director of biologics formulation development and manufacturing department and executive director,
where he was responsible for establishing the biologics formulation development department of the
Shanghai site and the GMP drug product manufacturing department of the Wuxi site and establishing the
new bioconjugation facility. Before joining the WXB Group, he served as a senior scientist in sterile
development of Catalent Pharma Solutions and was responsible for sterile product development and
manufacturing support, as a scientist in Biopharmaceutical Development of KBI BioPharma, Inc., and was
responsible for biologics formulation development, as a chemical engineer in New Jersey Center for
Engineered Particulates, New Jersey Institute of Technology in the United States, and as a researcher in
the field of Biochemical Engineering in Institute of Process Engineering (ה)
formerly known as Institute of Chemical Metallurgy), Chinese Academy of Sciences in China.
Dr. Luo obtained a bachelor’s degree in chemical engineering from Beijing University of Chemical
Technology ( ̏ԯʷʈɽኪ) in July 1988 and a master’s degree in chemical engineering from Institute of
Process Engineering, Chinese Academy of Sciences (הin July 1991. In May
2002, Dr. Luo obtained a doctoral degree in chemical engineering from Dalhousie University in Canada.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 280 —


--- page 290 ---
COMPANY SECRETARY
Mr. Xiaojie Xi is our company secretary. For details of Mr. Xi’s background, see “— Board of
Directors — Executive Directors” in this section for his biographical details.
As disclosed in Mr. Xi’s biography, he had been a joint company secretary of Akeso, Inc. for over
three years from April 2020 to May 2023, and had previously obtained waivers from the Stock Exchange
from strict compliance with the requirements under Rule 3.28 of the Listing Rules on the condition that
Mr. Xi would be assisted by another qualified joint company secretary, so as to enable Mr. Xi to acquire
the “relevant experienced” required by the Listing Rules. Similar to our Company, Akeso, Inc. is also a
biotech company that has developed an end-to-end platform which encompasses drug discovery and
development, CMC and GMP-compliant manufacturing, and is a company listed on the Main Board of the
Stock Exchange, and has allowed Mr. Xi to accumulate deep extensive experience and working knowledge
in assisting a biotech company listed on the Stock Exchange that is required of a company secretary.
Furthermore, Mr. Xi is also proficient and knowledgeable in the capital markets industry. Throughout his
career, Mr. Xi was involved in several high profile capital markets (including IPOs) and merger and
acquisition transactions, which requires him to be well-versed with the Listing Rules and the Companies
Ordinance of Hong Kong. Moreover, Mr. Xi has undertaken continuing professional development and
attended various training seminars in each year from 2020 to 2022 of not less than 15 hours of relevant
professional conducted by professional bodies including HKCGI, HKICPA and various law firms. As such,
the Board is of the view that Mr. Xi has the requisite relevant experience capable of discharging the
functions of a company secretary within the meaning of note 2 of Rule 3.28 of the Listing Rules and is
qualified to act as the company secretary of our Company.
Save as disclosed above, none of the Directors or senior management members has held any
directorship in any public company the securities of which are listed on any securities market in Hong
Kong or overseas during the three years immediately preceding the Latest Practicable Date.
As of the Latest Practicable Date and save as disclosed above, (i) none of the Directors or members
of the senior management of our Company is related to any other Directors and members of the senior
management of our Company, and (ii) there is no additional matter with respect to the appointment of the
Directors that needs to be brought to the attention of the Shareholders, and there is no additional
information relating to the Directors that is required to be disclosed pursuant to Rule 13.51(2)(h) to (v)
of the Listing Rules. Save as disclosed in the section headed “Statutory and General Information — D.
Further Information of Our Directors and Substantial Shareholders” in Appendix IV to this prospectus, as
of the Latest Practicable Date, none of our Directors held any interest in the securities within the meaning
of Part XV of the SFO.
BOARD COMMITTEES
In accordance with the relevant laws, regulations, the Articles and the corporate governance practice
prescribed in the Listing Rules, we have formed five board committees, namely, the audit committee of
the Board (the “ Audit Committee ”), the remuneration committee of the Board (the “ Remuneration
Committee ”), the nomination committee of the Board (the “ Nomination Committee ”), the strategy
committee of the Board (the “ Strategy Committee ”) and the ESG committee of the Board (the “ ESG
Committee ”).
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 281 —


--- page 291 ---
Audit Committee
We established an audit committee with written terms of reference in compliance with Rule 3.21 of
the Listing Rules and the Corporate Governance Code as set out in Appendix 14 to the Listing Rules. The
primary duties of the Audit Committee are to (i) review and supervise the financial reporting process and
the internal control system of our Group; (ii) oversee the audit process; (iii) provide advice and comments
to our Board; and (iv) perform other duties and responsibilities as assigned by our Board.
The Audit Committee currently comprises Mr. Hao Zhou, Dr. Ulf Grawunder and Mr. Stewart John
Hen, our independent non-executive Directors. Mr. Hao Zhou is the chairman of the Audit Committee.
Remuneration Committee
We established a remuneration committee with written terms of reference in compliance with Rule
3.25 of the Listing Rules and the Corporate Governance Code as set out in Appendix 14 to the Listing
Rules. The primary duties of the Remuneration Committee include, among others, (i) establish, review and
provide advice to our Board on the policy and structure of the remuneration for our Directors and senior
management and on the establishment of a formal and transparent procedure for developing policies
concerning remuneration; (ii) determine the terms of the specific remuneration package of each Director
and member of our senior management; and (iii) review and approve performance-based remuneration by
reference to corporate goals and objectives resolved by our Directors from time to time.
The Remuneration Committee currently comprises Ms. Ming Shi, our non-executive Director, and
Dr. Ulf Grawunder and Mr. Stewart John Hen, our independent non-executive Directors. Dr. Ulf
Grawunder is the chairman of the Remuneration Committee.
Nomination Committee
We established a nomination committee with written terms of reference in compliance with the
Corporate Governance Code as set out in Appendix 14 to the Listing Rules. The primary responsibilities
of the Nomination Committee include (i) review the structure, size and composition of the Board on a
regular basis and make recommendations to our Board regarding any proposed changes to the composition
of our Board, (ii) identify, select or make recommendations to our Board on the selection of individuals
nominated for directorship, and ensure the diversity of our Board members, (iii) assess the independence
of our independent non-executive Directors and (iv) make recommendations to our Board on relevant
matters relating to the appointment, re-appointment and removal of our Directors and succession planning
for our Directors.
The Nomination Committee currently comprises Dr. Zhisheng Chen, our non-executive Director, Dr.
Ulf Grawunder and Mr. Hao Zhou, our independent non-executive Directors. Dr. Zhisheng Chen is the
chairman of the Nomination Committee.
Strategy Committee
We established a strategy committee with the primary responsibilities of assisting the full Board, in
conjunction with management, in addressing our Company’s overall mission, vision and strategic
direction. Areas of focus will include (i) providing to the Board and management, as applicable, input and
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 282 —


--- page 292 ---
recommendations with respect to key strategic initiatives and major research and development programs
and partnerships, and (ii) assisting management in establishing a strategic planning process, (iii)
identifying and addressing organizational challenges and (iv) evaluating strategic alternatives.
The Strategy Committee currently comprises Dr. Jincai Li, our chief executive officer and executive
Director, Dr. Zhisheng Chen and Dr. Weichang Zhou, our non-executive Directors and Dr. Ulf Grawunder
and Mr. Stewart John Hen, our independent non-executive Directors. Dr. Jincai Li is the chairman of the
Strategy Committee.
ESG Committee
We established an ESG committee with the primary responsibilities of (i) formulating and reviewing
our Company’s responsibilities, vision, strategy, framework, principles, policies and (ii) monitoring the
implementations of the ESG policies passed by the Board to oversee and guide our Company’s ESG
initiatives and to make recommendations to the Board.
The ESG Committee currently comprises Dr. Jincai Li, our chief executive officer and executive
Director, Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang, our executive Director, and Dr. Weichang Zhou and Ms. Ming Shi, our
non-executive Directors. Dr. Jincai Li is the chairman of the ESG Committee.
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
Our Directors recognize the importance of incorporating elements of good corporate governance in
the management structures and internal procedures of our Group so as to achieve effective accountability
and are committed to ensure the lawful, ethical and responsible operation of our Group’s businesses. Our
Company has adopted the core provisions stated in the Corporate Governance Code, with internal
compliance policies in place which set out our compliance requirements so as to ensure consistency with
the code provisions stated in the Corporate Governance Code.
In addition, our Company provides regular and topical trainings to our employees to familiarize them
with our internal compliance policies and equip them with the necessary knowledge for effective and
consistent implementation of our internal compliance policies. Our Company is also committed to the view
that our Board should include a balanced composition of executive Directors and independent
non-executive Directors to ensure a strong independent element on our Board, which allows for effective
exercise of independent judgment.
In addition, pursuant to the Corporate Governance Code as set out in Appendix 14 to the Listing
Rules, our Board will regularly review whether each of our Directors is devoting sufficient time and
attention to the affairs of our Group including but not limited to the review of the attendance record of
Board meetings or Board committee meetings. Should there be concerns on the time commitments by the
relevant Director(s) to our Group, our Board may request the relevant Director(s) to provide an update to
our Board in relation to any changes with respect to his significant commitments.
As at the Latest Practicable Date, to the best of the knowledge, information and belief of our
Directors having made all reasonable enquiries, our Directors were not aware of any deviation from the
code provisions of the Corporate Governance Code as set out in Appendix 14 to the Listing Rules.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 283 —


--- page 293 ---
BOARD DIVERSITY
We recognize and embrace the benefits of having a diverse Board to capture different talents so as
to further bolster our Board’s performance. This would also enable us in achieving a sustainable and
balanced development in the long run. Our Board has adopted a board diversity policy which sets out the
approach to achieve and maintain its diversity. The board diversity policy provides that the selection of
Board candidates should be based on a range of diversity considerations, including but not limited to
professional experience, skills, knowledge, gender, age, cultural and educational background, ethnicity
and length of service. Our Directors have a balanced mix of knowledge and skills, including knowledge
and experience in the areas of business management, biotechnology, life science, finance, investment and
accounting. They obtained degrees in various areas including chemistry and bio-engineering, biochemical
science, chemical engineering, business administration, international finance and accounting. Our board
diversity policy is well implemented as evidenced by the fact that there are Directors ranging from 47
years old to 59 years old with experience from different industries and sectors.
Given that one out of nine of our Directors are female upon Listing, we will continue to take steps
to promote gender diversity of our Board. After Listing, we will continue to implement measures and steps
to promote and enhance gender diversity at all levels of our Company. We will select potential Board
candidates based on merit and his/her potential contribution to our Board while taking into account our
board diversity policy and other factors, including but not limited to, his/her integration into our
management mind set and business model and any specific requirements from time to time. In addition,
we target to achieve a gender diversity in the composition of our Board by having female representation
of 20% of the members of our Board within three years upon Listing. To ensure gender diversity of our
Board in the long run, our Group will take opportunities to increase the proportion of female members of
the Board, identify and select several female individuals with a diverse range of skills, experience and
knowledge in different fields from time to time, and maintain a list of such females who possess qualities
to become our Board Members, which will be reviewed by our Nomination Committee periodically in
order to develop a pipeline of potential successors to our Board to promote gender diversity of our Board.
We plan to offer all-rounded trainings to female employees who we consider to have the suitable
experience, skills and knowledge of our operation and business, including but not limited to, business
operation, management, accounting and finance, legal and compliance and research and development.
After the Listing, the Nomination Committee of our Board will review the board diversity policy and
its implementation from time to time to ensure its implementation and monitor its continued effectiveness,
and the same will be disclosed in our corporate governance report in accordance with the Listing Rules
after the Listing.
EMOLUMENT OF DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
We offer our executive Directors and senior management members, who are also employees of our
Company, emolument in the form of salaries, remuneration, pension, discretionary bonus and other
welfares. Our non-executive Director does not receive any emolument from our Group. Our independent
non-executive Directors receive emolument based on their responsibilities (including being members or
chairman of Board committees). We adopt a market and incentive-based employee emolument structure
and implement a multi-layered evaluation system which focuses on performance and management goals.
We also adopted the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes to attract, retain and motivate employees. For further
details of the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, please see the section headed “Statutory and General
Information — E. Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes” in Appendix IV to this prospectus.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 284 —


--- page 294 ---
The aggregate amount of emolument (including salaries, remuneration, pension, discretionary bonus
and other welfare) paid to our Directors for the three years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and
the six months ended June 30, 2023 were RMB5.20 million, RMB8.88 million, RMB19.83 million and
RMB9.65 million, respectively. It is estimated that under the arrangements currently in force, the
aggregate emolument payable to the Directors for the year ending December 31, 2023, will be
approximately RMB25.0 million.
For the three years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30,
2023, the aggregate amount of emolument paid to the five highest paid individuals of our Group, including
Directors, were RMB10.19 million, RMB16.40 million, RMB29.59 million, and RMB13.71 million,
respectively.
During the Track Record Period, no remuneration was paid to, or receivable by, our Directors or the
five highest paid individuals of our Company as an inducement to join or upon joining our Company or
as a compensation for loss of office in the Track Record Period. Further, none of our Directors had waived
any emolument during the same period.
Except as disclosed above, no other payments have been paid, or are payable, by our Company or
any of our subsidiaries to our Directors or the five highest paid individuals of our Company during the
Track Record Period.
Each of our executive Directors has entered into a service contract with us on October 30, 2023, and
we have also entered into letters of appointment with each of our non-executive Directors and independent
non-executive Directors on October 30, 2023. For details, see the section headed “Statutory and General
Information — D. Further Information of Our Directors and Substantial Shareholders” in Appendix IV to
this prospectus.
COMPLIANCE ADVISOR
We have appointed Somerley Capital Limited as our compliance advisor pursuant to Rules 3A.19 of
the Listing Rules. Pursuant to Rule 3A.23 of the Listing Rules, we must consult with and, if necessary,
seek advice from our compliance advisor on a timely basis in the following circumstances:
(a) before the publication of any regulatory announcement, circular or financial report;
(b) where a transaction, which might be a notifiable or connected transaction, is contemplated,
including share issues and share repurchases;
(c) where we propose to use the proceeds of the Global Offering in a manner different from that
detailed in this prospectus or where our business activities, developments or results deviate
from any forecast, estimate or other information in this prospectus; and
(d) where the Stock Exchange makes an inquiry of us regarding unusual movements in the price
or trading volume of our shares.
The term of the appointment will commence on the Listing Date and end on the date on which we
distribute the annual report of the first full financial year commencing after the Listing and such
appointment may be subject to extension by mutual agreement.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 285 —


--- page 295 ---
COMPETITION
Each of our Directors confirms that as of the Latest Practicable Date, he or she did not have any
interest in a business which competes or is likely to compete, directly or indirectly, with our business and
requires disclosure under Rule 8.10 of the Listing Rules.
From time to time our non-executive Directors may serve on the boards of both private and public
companies within the broader healthcare and biopharmaceutical industries. However, as these non-
executive Directors are not members of our executive management team, we do not believe that their
interests in such companies as directors would render us incapable of carrying on our business
independently from the other companies in which these Directors may hold directorships from time to
time.
DIRECTORS AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT
— 286 —


--- page 296 ---
SUBSTANTIAL SHAREHOLDERS
So far as our Directors are aware as of the Latest Practicable Date, immediately following the
completion of the Listing (assuming no changes to our issued and outstanding share capital between the
Latest Practicable Date and the Listing and assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised), the
following persons will have interests and/or short positions (as applicable) in the Shares or underlying
Shares which would fall to be disclosed to our Company and the Stock Exchange pursuant to the
provisions of Divisions 2 and 3 of Part XV of the SFO, or, will be, directly or indirectly, interested in 5%
or more of the issued voting rights of our Company or any other member of our Group:
Substantial Shareholder Capacity/Nature of Interest
Total number of
Shares/underlying shares
Approximate
percentage of interest in
our Company upon the
completion of the Global
Offering (assuming the
Over-allotment Option is
not exercised)
WuXi Biologics ...... Beneficial interest 600,000,000 50.91%
WuXi AppTec (1) ...... Interest in controlled
corporation
400,000,000 33.94%
WuXi AppTec
(Shanghai) ........
Interest in controlled
corporation
400,000,000 33.94%
S T A .............. Interest in controlled
corporation
400,000,000 33.94%
STA Pharmaceutical . . . Beneficial interest 400,000,000 33.94%
Note:
(1) As of the Latest Practicable Date, STA Pharmaceutical, a wholly-owned subsidiary of STA which is owned by WuXi AppTec
(Shanghai) as to 98.56%, a wholly-owned subsidiary of WuXi AppTec, a company whose H shares are listed on the Stock
Exchange (stock code: 2359) and A shares listed on the Shanghai Stock Exchange (stock code: 603259). As such, under the
SFO, WuXi AppTec. (through its interest in a controlled corporation) is deemed to be interested in the 400,000,000 Shares
held by STA Pharmaceutical.
Save as disclosed herein, our Directors are not aware of any other person who will, immediately
following the completion of the Listing (assuming no changes to our issued and outstanding share capital
between the Latest Practicable Date and the Listing and assuming the Over-allotment Option is not
exercised), have any interest and/or short positions in the Shares or underlying Shares which would fall
to be disclosed to us pursuant to the provisions of Divisions 2 and 3 of Part XV of the SFO, or, will be,
directly or indirectly, interested in 5% or more of the issued voting shares of our Company or any other
member of our Group. Our Directors are not aware of any arrangement which may at a subsequent date
result in a change of control of our Company or any other member of our Group.
SUBSTANTIAL SHAREHOLDERS
— 287 —


--- page 297 ---
THE CORNERSTONE PLACING
We have entered into cornerstone investment agreements (each a “ Cornerstone Investment
Agreement ”, and together the “ Cornerstone Investment Agreements ”) with the cornerstone investors set
out below (each a “ Cornerstone Investor ”, and together the “ Cornerstone Investors ”), pursuant to
which the Cornerstone Investors have agreed to, subject to certain conditions, subscribe, or cause their
designated entities to subscribe, for such number of Offer Shares that may be purchased with an aggregate
amount of approximately HK$2,346.6 million (exclusive of brokerage, SFC transaction levy, Stock
Exchange trading fee and AFRC Transaction Levy) at the Offer Price (the “ Cornerstone Placing ”).
Assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised, immediately after the completion of the
Global Offering:
1. Based on the Offer Price of HK$20.60 per Offer Share, being the high-end of the indicative
Offer Price range set out in this prospectus, the total number of Offer Shares to be subscribed
by the Cornerstone Investors would be 113,910,000 Offer Shares, representing approximately
(i) 63.83% of the Shares offered pursuant to the Global offering; and (ii) 9.67% of our total
issued share capital immediately upon completion of the Global Offering.
2. Based on the Offer Price of HK$20.25 per Offer Share, being the mid-point of the indicative
Offer Price range set out in this prospectus, the total number of Offer Shares to be subscribed
by the Cornerstone Investors would be 115,879,000 Offer Shares, representing approximately
(i) 64.94% of the Shares offered pursuant to the Global offering; and (ii) 9.83% of our total
issued share capital immediately upon completion of the Global Offering.
3. Based on the Offer Price of HK$19.90 per Offer Share, being the low-end of the indicative
Offer Price range set out in this prospectus, the total number of Offer Shares to be subscribed
by the Cornerstone Investors would be 117,917,000 Offer Shares, representing approximately
(i) 66.08% of the Shares offered pursuant to the Global offering; and (ii) 10.01% of our total
issued share capital immediately upon completion of the Global Offering.
Assuming the Over-allotment Option is fully exercised, immediately after the completion of the
Global Offering:
1. Based on the Offer Price of HK$20.60 per Offer Share, being the high-end of the indicative
Offer Price range set out in this prospectus, the total number of Offer Shares to be subscribed
by the Cornerstone Investors would be 113,910,000 Offer Shares, representing approximately
(i) 57.65% of the Shares offered pursuant to the Global offering; and (ii) 9.51% of our total
issued share capital immediately upon completion of the Global Offering.
2. Based on the Offer Price of HK$20.25 per Offer Share, being the mid-point of the indicative
Offer Price range set out in this prospectus, the total number of Offer Shares to be subscribed
by the Cornerstone Investors would be 115,879,000 Offer Shares, representing approximately
(i) 58.64% of the Shares offered pursuant to the Global offering; and (ii) 9.68% of our total
issued share capital immediately upon completion of the Global Offering.
CORNERSTONE INVESTORS
— 288 —


--- page 298 ---
3. Based on the Offer Price of HK$19.90 per Offer Share, being the low-end of the indicative
Offer Price range set out in this prospectus, the total number of Offer Shares to be subscribed
by the Cornerstone Investors would be 117,917,000 Offer Shares, representing approximately
(i) 59.67% of the Shares offered pursuant to the Global offering; and (ii) 9.85% of our total
issued share capital immediately upon completion of the Global Offering.
We believe that the Cornerstone Placing demonstrates our Cornerstone Investors’ confidence in our
Company and its business prospect, and that our Company will be able to leverage our Cornerstone
Investors’ experience and insights in the industry in which we operate.
The Cornerstone Placing will form part of the International Offering, and the Cornerstone Investors
will not acquire any Offer Shares under the Global Offering other than pursuant to the Cornerstone
Investment Agreements (except for Cornerstone Investors who are also Qualifying WXB Shareholders
who are eligible to apply for the Reserved Shares in the Preferential Offering, if qualified to do so). The
Offer Shares to be subscribed by the Cornerstone Investors will rank pari passu in all respects with the
fully paid Shares in issue following the completion of the Global Offering and will be listed on the Stock
Exchange, and will be counted towards the public float of our Company. Other than the existing
Shareholders or their close associates who are Cornerstone Investors as described below, our Company
became acquainted with each of the Cornerstone Investors through the introduction by some of the
Underwriters in the Global Offering.
Other than a guaranteed allocation of the relevant Offer Shares at the final Offer Price, the
Cornerstone Investors do not have any preferential rights under each of their respective Cornerstone
Investment Agreements, as compared with other public Shareholders. There are no side arrangements
between us and the Cornerstone Investors or any benefit, direct or indirect, conferred on the Cornerstone
Investors by virtue of or in relation to the Cornerstone Placing, other than a guaranteed allocation of the
relevant Offer Shares at the final Offer Price, following the principles as set out in the Guidance Letter
HKEX-GL51-13.
To our Company’s best knowledge, other than (i) UBS Asset Management (Singapore) Ltd. (whose
ultimate holding company UBS Group AG is listed on the SIX Swiss Exchange (Ticker Symbol: UBSG)
and on the New Y ork Stock Exchange (Ticker Symbol: UBS)) and (ii) Invesco Advisers, Inc. (whose
ultimate holding company Invesco Ltd. is listed on the New Y ork Stock Exchange (Ticker Symbol: IVZ),
none of the Cornerstone Investors or their respective controlling entity is listed on any stock exchange.
Each of the Cornerstone Investors has confirmed that all necessary approvals have been obtained with
respect to the Cornerstone Placing and that no specific approval from any stock exchange (if relevant) or
its shareholders is required for the relevant cornerstone investment as each of them has general authority
to invest.
To our Company’s best knowledge, each of the Cornerstone Investors is (i) not accustomed to take
instructions from our Company, our Directors, chief executive of our Company, our Controlling
Shareholders, substantial shareholders of our Company or existing Shareholders or any of its subsidiaries
or their respective close associates in relation to the acquisition, disposal, voting or other disposition of
the Shares registered in their name or otherwise held by them; (ii) not financed by us, our Directors, chief
executive, our Controlling Shareholders, substantial shareholders, existing Shareholders or any of its
subsidiaries or their respective close associates; and (iii) other than (a) Lake Bleu Innovation Healthcare
Master Fund Limited and Lake Bleu Prime Healthcare Master Fund Limited; and (b) HSG Growth VII
Holdco, Ltd and HCHP Master Fund, an independent third party of the other Cornerstone Investors, our
Group, our connected persons and their respective associates, and is not a connected person (as defined
CORNERSTONE INVESTORS
— 289 —


--- page 299 ---
in the Listing Rules) of our Group and an existing shareholder or a close associate of our Group. Further,
immediately after the completion of the Global Offering, none of the Cornerstone Investors will have any
Board representation in our Company, and none of the Cornerstone Investors will become a substantial
shareholder of our Company.
There will be no delayed delivery or deferred settlement of Offer Shares to be subscribed by the
Cornerstone Investors and the consideration will be settled by the Cornerstone Investors before the Listing
Date. The Offer Shares to be subscribed by the Cornerstone Investors may be affected by reallocation in
the event of over-subscription under the Hong Kong Public Offering, as described in the paragraph headed
“Structure of the Global Offering – The Hong Kong Public Offering – Reallocation and Clawback” in this
prospectus. Details of the actual number of Offer Shares to be allocated to the Cornerstone Investors will
be disclosed in the allotment results announcement to be issued by us on or around Thursday, November
16, 2023.
As confirmed by each Cornerstone Investor, its subscription under the Cornerstone Placing would be
financed by its own internal financial resources. Each of the Cornerstone Investors has confirmed that all
necessary approvals have been obtained with respect to the Cornerstone Placing and that no specific
approval from any stock exchange (if relevant) or its shareholders or other regulatory authority is required
for the relevant Cornerstone Placing.
The table below sets forth details of the Cornerstone Placing:
Approximate % of total
number of Offer Shares
Approximate % of total
Shares in issue immediately
following the completion of the
Global Offering
Based on the Offer Price at:
Investment
Amount (1)
Number of Offer
Shares (rounded
down to nearest
whole board lot
of 500 Shares)
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is not
exercised
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is fully
exercised
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is not
exercised
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is fully
exercised
(in million) (approximate) (approximate) (approximate) (approximate)
HK$19.90 being the
low-end of the indicative
Offer Price range)
Invesco Advisers, Inc. ..... HK$782.2 39,306,000 22.03% 19.89% 3.34% 3.28%
General Atlantic Singapore
SPV 64 Pte. Ltd. ...... HK$391.1 19,653,000 11.01% 9.95% 1.67% 1.64%
Al-Rayyan Holding LLC .... HK$352.0 17,687,500 9.91% 8.95% 1.50% 1.48%
UBS Asset Management
(Singapore) Ltd. ....... HK$312.9 15,722,000 8.81% 7.96% 1.33% 1.31%
HongShan Funds ........ HK$234.7 11,791,500 6.61% 5.97% 1.00% 0.98%
Novo Holdings A/S ....... HK$195.5 9,826,500 5.51% 4.97% 0.83% 0.82%
Lake Bleu Funds ........ HK$78.2 3,930,500 2.20% 1.99% 0.33% 0.33%
Total............... HK$2,346.6 117,917,000 66.08% 59.67% 10.01% 9.85%
CORNERSTONE INVESTORS
— 290 —


--- page 300 ---
Approximate % of total
number of Offer Shares
Approximate % of total
Shares in issue immediately
following the completion of the
Global Offering
Based on the Offer Price at:
Investment
Amount (1)
Number of Offer
Shares (rounded
down to nearest
whole board lot
of 500 Shares)
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is not
exercised
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is fully
exercised
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is not
exercised
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is fully
exercised
(in million) (approximate) (approximate) (approximate) (approximate)
HK$20.25 being the
mid-point of the indicative
Offer Price range)
Invesco Advisers, Inc. ..... HK$782.2 38,626,500 21.65% 19.55% 3.28% 3.23%
General Atlantic Singapore
SPV 64 Pte. Ltd. ...... HK$391.1 19,313,000 10.82% 9.77% 1.64% 1.61%
Al-Rayyan Holding LLC .... HK$352.0 17,382,000 9.74% 8.80% 1.47% 1.45%
UBS Asset Management
(Singapore) Ltd. ....... HK$312.9 15,450,500 8.66% 7.82% 1.31% 1.29%
HongShan Funds ........ HK$234.7 11,588,000 6.49% 5.86% 0.98% 0.97%
Novo Holdings A/S ....... HK$195.5 9,656,500 5.41% 4.89% 0.82% 0.81%
Lake Bleu Funds ........ HK$78.2 3,862,500 2.16% 1.95% 0.33% 0.32%
Total............... HK$2,346.6 115,879,000 64.94% 58.64% 9.83% 9.68%
Approximate % of total
number of Offer Shares
Approximate % of total
Shares in issue immediately
following the completion of the
Global Offering
Based on the Offer Price at:
Investment
Amount (1)
Number of Offer
Shares (rounded
down to nearest
whole board lot
of 500 Shares)
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is not
exercised
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is fully
exercised
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is not
exercised
Assuming the
Over-
allotment
Option is fully
exercised
(in million) (approximate) (approximate) (approximate) (approximate)
HK$20.60 being the
high-end of the indicative
Offer Price range)
Invesco Advisers, Inc. ..... HK$782.2 37,970,000 21.28% 19.22% 3.22% 3.17%
General Atlantic Singapore
SPV 64 Pte. Ltd. ...... HK$391.1 18,985,000 10.64% 9.61% 1.61% 1.59%
Al-Rayyan Holding LLC .... HK$352.0 17,086,500 9.58% 8.65% 1.45% 1.43%
UBS Asset Management
(Singapore) Ltd. ....... HK$312.9 15,188,000 8.51% 7.69% 1.29% 1.27%
HongShan Funds ........ HK$234.7 11,391,000 6.38% 5.76% 0.97% 0.95%
Novo Holdings A/S ....... HK$195.5 9,492,500 5.32% 4.80% 0.81% 0.79%
Lake Bleu Funds ........ HK$78.2 3,797,000 2.13% 1.92% 0.32% 0.32%
Total............... HK$2,346.6 113,910,000 63.83% 57.65% 9.67% 9.51%
Notes:
1. Calculated based on the exchange rate set out in the section headed “Information about this Prospectus and the Global
Offering — Exchange rate conversion”
CORNERSTONE INVESTORS
— 291 —


--- page 301 ---
THE CORNERSTONE INVESTORS
The information about our Cornerstone Investors set forth below has been provided by the
Cornerstone Investors in connection with the Cornerstone Placing.
1. Invesco Advisers, Inc.
Invesco Ltd. (“ Invesco ”), a Bermuda-incorporated company, is a leading independent investment
management firm with approximately US$1,527.7 billion in assets under management as of August 31,
2023. Invesco is a global company focused on investment management, and its services are provided
through a number of affiliated investment advisers to a wide range of clients throughout the world,
including open-end mutual funds, closed-end funds, exchange-traded funds, collective trust funds, UCITS,
real estate investment trusts, unit investment trusts and other pooled investment vehicles, as well as
pensions, endowments, insurance companies and sovereign wealth funds. Invesco is a public company and
is listed on the New Y ork Stock Exchange (Stock Code: IVZ.NY). Invesco’s shareholders’ and New Y ork
Stock Exchange’s approval are not required for Invesco’s subscription for the Offer Shares pursuant to the
relevant cornerstone investment agreement.
Invesco Advisers, Inc. (“ IAI”) is the principal U.S. investment advisory subsidiary of Invesco and
is registered with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission as an investment adviser. IAI, acting as
discretionary investment adviser for and on behalf of various discretionary funds (the “ IAI Managed
Funds ”), has agreed to participate in the Global Offering and for such IAI Managed Funds to invest in our
Shares as cornerstone investors.
The IAI Managed Funds are open-end mutual funds, collective trust fund and other pooled
investment vehicles established under various jurisdictions and have multiple holders (who together with
their ultimate beneficial owners are, to the best of the knowledge, information and belief of our Company,
Independent Third Parties).
2. General Atlantic Singapore SPV 64 Pte. Ltd.
General Atlantic Singapore SPV 64 Pte. Ltd. is private company limited by shares, incorporated
under laws of Singapore in 2022. It is wholly owned by General Atlantic Singapore Fund Pte. Ltd.
(“GASF ”). GASF, which is incorporated in Singapore, is a private equity fund based in Singapore that
makes and holds investments in growth companies in Asia, including the PRC, Hong Kong, India,
Singapore, Indonesia and other regions of Asia. It is part of the General Atlantic private equity group, a
leading global growth equity firm providing capital and strategic support for growth companies. The
manager of GASF is General Atlantic Singapore Fund Management Pte. Ltd. (“ GASFM ”). GASFM is
wholly-owned by General Atlantic Service Company, L.P . (“ GASC ”), an investment advisor registered
with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission. To the best of the knowledge, information
and belief of our Company, General Atlantic Singapore SPV 64 Pte. Ltd., GASF, GASFM and GASC are
independent third parties.
3. Al-Rayyan Holding LLC
Al-Rayyan Holding LLC is a subsidiary of Qatar Investment Authority, the sovereign wealth fund of
the State of Qatar.
CORNERSTONE INVESTORS
— 292 —


--- page 302 ---
4. UBS Asset Management (Singapore) Ltd .
UBS Asset Management (Singapore) Ltd. (“ UBS AM Singapore ”), a company incorporated in
Singapore in December 1993, has entered into a cornerstone investment agreement with the Company and
the Joint Sponsors, in its capacity as the investment advisor for and on behalf of the following funds
(together the “ UBS Funds ”, which together with their ultimate beneficial owners are, to the best of the
knowledge, information and belief of our Company, independent third parties): UBS (Lux) Equity Fund
— China Opportunity (USD), UBS (Lux) Equity SICA V — All China, UBS (Lux) Equity Fund — Greater
China, UBS (Lux) Key Selection SICA V — China Allocation Opportunity, UBS (Lux) Key Selection
SICA V — China Equity Unconstrained, UBS (HK) Fund Series — China Opportunity Equity, UBS (HK)
Fund Series — China Health Care Equity and UBS (Lux) Equity SICA V — China Health Care.
UBS AM Singapore is a wholly owned subsidiary of UBS Asset Management AG (“ UBS Asset
Management ”), an investment management company, which is wholly ultimately owned by UBS Group
AG, which is a company organized under Swiss law as a corporation that has issued shares of common
stock to investors. UBS Group AG’s shares are listed on the SIX Swiss Exchange (stock code: UBSG) and
the New Y ork Stock Exchange (stock code: UBS). UBS Asset Management is a business division of UBS
Group AG and is operated as a dedicated asset management business with independence in all investment
decision making. UBS Asset Management is a global large-scale and diversified asset manager, with a
presence in 23 markets. UBS Asset Management offers investment capabilities and styles across all
major traditional and alternative asset classes as well as advisory support to institutions, wholesale
intermediaries and its global wealth management clients. As at March 31, 2023, invested assets under
management of UBS Asset Management globally totaled USD1.1 trillion. UBS AM Singapore’s
shareholders’ and New Y ork Stock Exchange’s approval are not required for UBS AM Singapore’s
subscription for the Investor Shares.
5. HongShan Funds
HSG Growth VII Holdco, Ltd. (“ HongShan Growth ”) is a company incorporated in the Cayman
Islands with limited liability, which is wholly owned by HongShan Capital Growth Fund VII, L.P .
(“HongShan GVII Fund ”). HongShan GVII Fund is an investment fund whose primary purpose is to
make equity investments in private companies. The general partner of HongShan GVII Fund is HSG
Growth VII Management, L.P ., whose general partner is HSG Holding Limited, a wholly-owned subsidiary
of SNP China Enterprises Limited. Neil Nanpeng Shen is the sole shareholder of SNP China Enterprises
Limited.
HCHP Master Fund is an exempted company incorporated with limited liability under the laws of the
Cayman Islands, which is managed by HCHP Management Limited as investment manager, which is in
turn wholly-owned by HCHP Management Holding Limited. The majority voting rights of HCHP
Management Holding Limited are indirectly held by its non-executive director, Neil Nanpeng Shen. HCHP
Master Fund is an investment fund whose primary purpose is to make China-related public equity
investments in healthcare sector. HCHP Management Limited was incorporated under the laws of Hong
Kong in 2021 and is licensed for Type 9 regulated activities under the SFO. To the best of the knowledge,
information and belief of our Company, HongShan Growth and HCHP Master Fund, together with their
ultimate beneficial owners, are independent third parties.
CORNERSTONE INVESTORS
— 293 —


--- page 303 ---
6. Novo Holdings A/S
Novo Holdings A/S (“ Novo Holdings ”) is a holding and investment company that is responsible for
managing the assets and wealth of the Novo Nordisk Foundation. The board of directors of the Novo
Nordisk Foundation (who are, to the best of the knowledge, information and belief of our Company,
independent third parties) are considered the beneficial owners of Novo Holdings A/S under the laws of
the relevant jurisdiction. The purpose of Novo Holdings is to improve people’s health and the
sustainability of society and the planet by generating attractive long-term returns on the assets of the Novo
Nordisk Foundation. Wholly owned by the Novo Nordisk Foundation, Novo Holdings is the controlling
shareholder of Novo Nordisk A/S and Novozymes A/S and manages an investment portfolio with a
long-term return perspective. Novo Holdings invests in life science companies at all stages of development
and also manages a broad portfolio of equities, bonds, real estate and infrastructure assets as well as
private equity investments. As of year-end 2022, Novo Holdings had total assets of EUR 108 billion.
7. Lake Bleu Funds
Lake Bleu Prime Healthcare Master Fund Limited (“ Lake Bleu Prime ”) is managed by Lake Bleu
Capital (Hong Kong) Limited. Lake Bleu Prime is a long-bias public equity fund focusing in Asia/Greater
China healthcare. The fund primarily invests in public equities. The fund invests across the entire
healthcare value chain, in pharmaceuticals, biotech, medical devices, hospitals and mobile health.
Recently, Lake Bleu Prime acts as a cornerstone investor for Joinn Laboratories (stock code 6127), Suzhou
Basecare Medical (stock code 2170), New Horizon Health (stock code 6606), JD Health International Inc.
(stock code 6618), MicroPort CardioFlow Medtech Corporation (stock code 2160), Akeso, Inc. (stock code
9926), Pharmaron Beijing Co., Ltd. (stock code 3759), RemeGen Co., Ltd. (stock code 9995), Hygeia
Healthcare Holdings Co., Limited (stock code 6078), and Kangji Medical Holdings Limited (stock code
9997). Lake Bleu Prime, as a healthcare specialist, is keen to help the portfolio companies on value-added
activities and has successfully helped many companies on this front. Lake Bleu Capital (Hong Kong)
Limited is also licensed by the SFC to carry out type 9 regulated activities.
Lake Bleu Innovation Healthcare Master Fund Limited (“ Lake Bleu innovation ”) is managed by
Lake Bleu Capital (Hong Kong) Limited. Lake Bleu innovation is a long-bias public equity fund focusing
in Asia/Greater China healthcare. The fund primarily invests in public equities. The fund invests across
the entire healthcare value chain, in pharmaceuticals, biotech, medical devices, hospitals and mobile
health. Lake Bleu innovation, as a healthcare specialist, is keen to help the portfolio companies on
value-added activities and has successfully helped many companies on this front. Lake Bleu Capital (Hong
Kong) Limited is also licensed by the SFC to carry out type 9 regulated activities. To the best of the
knowledge, information and belief of our Company, Lake Bleu Prime and Lake Bleu innovation, together
with their ultimate beneficial owners, are independent third parties.
CORNERSTONE INVESTORS
— 294 —


--- page 304 ---
CLOSING CONDITIONS
The subscription obligation of each Cornerstone Investor under the respective Cornerstone
Investment Agreement is subject to, among other things, the following closing conditions (as the case may
be):
(i) the Underwriting Agreements being entered into and having become effective and
unconditional (in accordance with their respective original terms or as subsequently waived or
varied by agreement of the parties thereto) by no later than the time and date as specified in
the Underwriting Agreements, and neither of the Underwriting Agreements having been
terminated;
(ii) the Offer Price having been agreed according to the Underwriting Agreements and price
determination agreement to be signed among the parties thereto in connection with the Global
Offering;
(iii) the Listing Committee having granted the listing of, and permission to deal in, the Shares
(including the Shares under the Cornerstone Placing) as well as other applicable waivers and
approvals and such approval, permission or waiver having not been revoked prior to the
commencement of dealings in the Shares on the Stock Exchange;
(iv) no laws shall have been enacted or promulgated by any governmental authority which prohibits
the consummation of the transactions contemplated in the Global Offering or in the respective
Cornerstone Investment Agreement and there shall be no orders or injunctions from a court of
competent jurisdiction in effect precluding or prohibiting consummation of such transactions;
(v) the respective representations, warranties, undertakings and confirmations of such Cornerstone
Investor under the respective Cornerstone Investment Agreement are accurate and true in all
respects or all material respects (as the case may be) and not misleading or deceptive and that
there is no material breach of such Cornerstone Investment Agreement on the part of such
Cornerstone Investor; and
(vi) the respective representations, warranties, undertakings and confirmations of our Company
under such Cornerstone Investment Agreement are accurate and true and not misleading in all
material (where applicable) respects and that there is no material breach of such Cornerstone
Investment Agreement on the part of our Company.
RESTRICTIONS ON DISPOSALS BY THE CORNERSTONE INVESTORS
Each of the Cornerstone Investors has agreed that it will not, whether directly or indirectly, at any
time during the period of six months from the Listing Date (the “ Lock-up Period ”), dispose of any of the
Offer Shares they have purchased pursuant to the relevant Cornerstone Investment Agreements, save for
certain limited circumstances, such as transfers to any of its wholly-owned subsidiaries, who will be bound
by the same obligations of such Cornerstone Investor, including the Lock-up Period restriction.
CORNERSTONE INVESTORS
— 295 —


--- page 305 ---
AUTHORIZED AND ISSUED SHARE CAPITAL
The following is a description of the (i) authorized and issued share capital of our Company; and (ii)
shares in issue and to be issued as fully paid or credited as fully paid immediately following the
completion of the Global Offering (without taking into account any exercise of the share options granted
under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes):
As of the Latest Practicable Date, our authorized share capital is US$500,000 divided into
10,000,000,000 ordinary shares, with a par value of US$0.00005 each. As of the Latest Practicable Date,
our issued share capital consisted of 1,000,000,000 Shares.
Assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised and without taking into account any exercise
of the share options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, the share capital of our Company
immediately after the Global Offering will be as follows:
Description of Shares Number of Shares
Aggregate nominal
value of Shares
Approximate
percentage of issued
share capital
(US$) (%)
Shares in issue .................... 1,000,000,000 50,000 84.86
Shares to be issued under the Global
Offering ........................ 178,446,000 8,922.3 15.14
Total ........................... 1,178,446,000 58,922.3 100.00
Assuming the Over-allotment Option is exercised in full but without taking into account any exercise
of the share options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, the share capital of our Company
upon completion of the Global Offering will be as follows:
Description of Shares Number of Shares
Aggregate nominal
value of Shares
Approximate
percentage of issued
share capital
(US$) (%)
Shares in issue .................... 1,000,000,000 50,000 83.50
Shares to be issued under the Global
Offering ........................ 197,604,500 9,880.23 16.50
Total ........................... 1,197,604,500 59,880.23 100.00
ASSUMPTIONS
The above tables assume that the Global Offering becomes unconditional and that Shares are issued
pursuant to the Global Offering. The above tables also do not take into account any Shares which may be
issued or repurchased by us under the general mandates granted to our Directors as referred to below.
SHARE CAPITAL
— 296 —


--- page 306 ---
RANKING
The Offer Shares will rank pari passu in all respects with all Shares currently in issue or to be issued
as mentioned in this prospectus, and will qualify and rank equally for all dividends or other distributions
declared, made or paid on the Shares on a record date which falls after the date of this prospectus.
CIRCUMSTANCES UNDER WHICH GENERAL MEETINGS ARE REQUIRED
Our Company will have only one class of Shares, namely ordinary shares, and each ranks pari passu
with the other Shares upon completion of the Global Offering.
Pursuant to the Cayman Companies Act and the terms of the Memorandum of Association and
Articles of Association, our Company may from time to time by ordinary resolution of Shareholders (i)
increase its capital; (ii) consolidate and divide its capital into shares of larger amount; (iii) divide its shares
into several classes; (iv) subdivide its shares into shares of smaller amount; and (v) cancel any shares
which have not been taken. In addition, our Company may subject to the provisions of the Cayman
Companies Act reduce its share capital or capital redemption reserve by its Shareholders passing a special
resolution. See the section headed “Summary of the Constitution of the Company and Cayman Islands
Company Law — Summary of the Constitution of the Company — 2. Articles of Association — 2.4
Alteration of capital” in Appendix III to this prospectus for further details.
GENERAL MANDATE TO ISSUE SHARES
Subject to the Global Offering becoming unconditional, our Directors have been granted a general
unconditional mandate (the “ Issue Mandate ”) to allot, issue and deal with Shares with a total nominal
value of not more than the sum of:
 20% of the issued share capital of our Company immediately following the completion of the
Global Offering (excluding any Shares which may fall to be issued upon the exercise of the
Over-allotment Option and the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes); and
 the number of Shares repurchased by our Company (if any) under the general mandate to
repurchase Shares referred to below.
The Issue Mandate will expire at the earliest of:
 the conclusion of our Company’s next annual general meeting; or
 when varied, revoked or renewed by an ordinary resolution of our Shareholders in a general
meeting.
For further details of the Issue Mandate, please see the section headed “Statutory and General
Information — A. Further Information about Our Group — 4. Resolutions in writing of our Shareholders
passed on October 30, 2023” in Appendix IV to this prospectus.
SHARE CAPITAL
— 297 —


--- page 307 ---
GENERAL MANDATE TO REPURCHASE SHARES
Our Directors have been granted a general unconditional mandate (the “ Repurchase Mandate ”) to
exercise all the powers of our Company to repurchase our own securities with a nominal value of up to
10% of the aggregate number of our Shares in issue as of the Listing Date.
The Repurchase Mandate only relates to repurchases made on the Stock Exchange, or on any other
stock exchange on which our Shares are listed (and which are recognized by the SFC and the Stock
Exchange for this purpose), and which are in accordance with the Listing Rules.
A summary of the relevant Listing Rules is set out in the section headed “Statutory and General
Information — A. Further Information about Our Group — 5. Restrictions on Repurchase” in Appendix
IV to this prospectus.
The Repurchase Mandate will expire at the earliest of:
 the conclusion of our Company’s next annual general meeting; or
 when varied, revoked or renewed by an ordinary resolution of our Shareholders in a general
meeting.
For further details of the Repurchase Mandate, please see the section headed “Statutory and General
Information — A. Further Information about Our Group — 4. Resolutions in writing of our Shareholders
passed on October 30, 2023” in Appendix IV to this prospectus.
SHARE OPTION SCHEMES
Our Company adopted the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme, in November 2021 and in March 2023 respectively. For further details of the Pre-IPO Share
Option Schemes, please see the section headed “Statutory and General Information — E. Pre-IPO Share
Option Schemes” in Appendix IV to this prospectus.
SHARE CAPITAL
— 298 —


--- page 308 ---
You should read the following discussion in conjunction with the consolidated financial
statements and the notes thereto included in the Accountants’ Report set out in Appendix I to this
prospectus which have been prepared in accordance with IFRSs and the selected historical financial
information and operating data included elsewhere in this prospectus. Our historical results do not
necessarily indicate results expected for any future periods. The following discussion and analysis
contains forward-looking statements that involve risks and uncertainties. Our actual results may
differ from those anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of any number of
factors, including those set forth in “Forward-looking Statements” and “Risk Factors.” In
evaluating our business, you should carefully consider the information provided in “Risk Factors”
in this prospectus.
OVERVIEW
We are a leading CRDMO focused on the global ADC and broader bioconjugate market and
dedicated to providing integrated and comprehensive services. We are the second largest CRDMO for
ADCs and other bioconjugates globally in terms of revenue in 2022, according to Frost & Sullivan.
Leveraging expertise in both biologics and small molecules, we offer interdisciplinary and comprehensive
services, covering bioconjugate discovery, research, development and manufacturing. We provide these
services from proximately located and dedicated laboratories and manufacturing facilities, leading to
potentially significant reduction of development timeline and costs. As a fully integrated one-stop
bioconjugate discovery, development and manufacturing platform, our mission is to continuously enhance
our platform, propel and transform the development of the bioconjugate industry, enable global
biopharmaceutical partners and benefit patients worldwide.
With our extensive technical capabilities and impeccable track record, we have become a trusted
partner leading the bioconjugate development globally with a broad, loyal and fast-growing customer base.
We employ an “enable, follow and win the molecule” strategy to not only grow with our existing
customers by providing services from an early stage of their product development cycle, but also win new
customers as their bioconjugates progress. As of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023,
as the result of our “enable” strategy, we had cumulatively progressed 9, 12, 24 and 30 ADC candidates,
respectively, from discovery to CMC development. As the result of our “win the molecule” strategy,
among the 110 ongoing integrated projects we had as of June 30, 2023, 36 were transferred to us from our
customers or their outsourcing service providers. Our diverse and growing customer base includes both
innovative biotechnology companies and global pharmaceutical companies, many of which are leading
players in the ADC and bioconjugate space with potentially first-in-class or best-in-class pipeline
programs. The number of our customers grew significantly from 49 in 2020 to 115 in 2021, 167 in 2022
and 169 in the six months ended June 30, 2023. As of June 30, 2023, we had served 304 customers
cumulatively, including most of the major players in the global ADC and broader bioconjugate market. As
of the same date, we had won ADC development contracts for all ADC candidates in China with dual filing
of IND and/or BLA in China and the United States, and eight out of the 10 China-based companies that
out-licensed their ADC pipelines overseas since 2022 are our customers.
We experienced robust growth in our revenue during the Track Record Period. In 2020, 2021 and
2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, our revenue was RMB96.4 million, RMB311.1
million, RMB990.4 million, RMB329.4 million and RMB993.5 million, respectively. We recorded net
profit of RMB26.3 million, RMB54.9 million, RMB155.7 million, RMB98.3 million and RMB177.2
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 299 —


--- page 309 ---
million for the same periods, respectively. Our adjusted net profit (non-IFRS measure) amounted to
RMB32.8 million, RMB77.1 million, RMB194.4 million, RMB108.9 million and RMB216.4 million in the
same periods, respectively. See “— Non-IFRS Measures.” Our backlog was US$318.0 million as of
December 31, 2022 and US$410.6 million as of June 30, 2023. The aggregate amount of the transaction
price allocated to performance obligations* that are unsatisfied (or partially unsatisfied) were nil,
RMB475 million and RMB1,495 million, and RMB2,958 million as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and
2022, and June 30, 2023, respectively. Our management expects the majority of the transaction price
allocated to the unsatisfied contracts as of each of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023
will be recognized as revenue within five years from such date.
BASIS OF PRESENTATION
We were incorporated in Cayman Islands on December 14, 2020. The historical financial information
has been prepared in accordance with the accounting policies which conform with IFRSs issued by the
International Accounting Standards Board and the convention applicable for certain transfers. See Notes
2 and 4 to the Accountants’ Report for more information on the basis of preparation and presentation of
our historical financial information.
In the application of our accounting policies, our Directors are required to make judgments,
estimates and assumptions about the carrying amounts of assets that are not readily apparent from other
sources. The estimates and underlying assumptions are based on historical experience and other factors
that are considered to be relevant. Actual results may differ from these estimates. The estimates and
underlying assumption are reviewed on an ongoing basis. Revisions to accounting estimates are
recognized in the period in which the estimate is revised if the revision affects only that period, or in the
period of the revision and future periods if revision affects both current and future periods. Judgments
made by our management in the application of IFRSs that have significant effect on the financial
statements and major sources of estimation uncertainty are stated in Note 5 to the Accountants’ Report in
Appendix I to this prospectus.
KEY FACTORS AFFECTING OUR RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
Our results of operations, financial condition and the period-to-period comparability of our financial
results are principally affected by the following factors:
Growth of Global ADC and Broader Bioconjugate Market and the Outsourcing Rate
Our business and results of operations are driven by the demand for outsourcing services for ADCs
and other bioconjugates, which in turn is dependent on the growth of the ADC and broader bioconjugate
market and pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies’ allocated budget on outsourced discovery,
development and manufacturing for ADCs and other bioconjugates. According to Frost & Sullivan, the
size of the global ADC drug market was US$7.9 billion in 2022 and is anticipated to reach US$64.7 billion
in 2030. The outsourcing rate of bioconjugate development has reached approximately 70% by the end of
2022, and the size of the global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market was US$1.5
billion in 2022 and is anticipated to reach US$11.0 billion in 2030, at a CAGR of 28.4%. The increasing
academic and commercial interest in ADCs and other bioconjugates, as well as the robust growth in
* Performance obligation is a promise in a contract with our customers to transfer our services to them.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 300 —


--- page 310 ---
pharmaceutical and biotechnology companies’ spending on outsourcing services, has led to rising demand
for our CRDMO services. We experienced substantial revenue growth during the Track Record Period, and
we expect to continue to benefit from these positive market trends. See “Industry Overview” for a detailed
discussion on the global ADC and broader bioconjugate market and the global ADC and broader
bioconjugates outsourcing services market.
Growth in Project Pipeline and Customer Base
Our business and results of operations depend on our ability to obtain new projects from existing
customers and expand our customer base. Maintaining a strong pipeline and being able to continually
replenish our backlog are crucial to our long-term success as they underpin the continued growth
momentum of our business. Our ability to obtain new projects from both existing customers and new
customers is affected substantially by our brand, service offerings, technology capabilities, service
qualities, pricing, geographic footprint, and proven track record in serving our customers. Leveraging our
advantages in these aspects, we strive to obtain more projects from our existing customers to maintain and
strengthen the current level of business relationship. In addition, these advantages also enable us to further
grow our customer base globally and acquire new customers to expand the size of our backlog. The
number of our customers grew significantly from 49 in 2020 to 115 in 2021, 167 in 2022 and 169 in the
six months ended June 30, 2023. As of June 30, 2023, we had served 304 customers cumulatively,
including most of the major players in the global ADC and bioconjugate market. As of June 30, 2023, we
had 67 ongoing preclinical bioconjugate projects and 43 ongoing post-IND bioconjugate projects. Our
backlog reached US$410.6 million as of June 30, 2023, which represents the aggregate amount of service
fees for services that we have contracted to perform but have not performed yet. The continued increase
in the number of projects during the Track Record Period reflects our customers’ trust in us and foretells
our revenue and profit growth potential.
Success and Service Mix of Our Projects
Our financial performance is affected by whether the discovery and development of our customers’
drug candidates can successfully progress as planned. We generally enter into project-based service
contracts or long-term service contracts under which we receive fee income primarily on a fee-for-service,
or FFS, basis for the services provided. Our service contracts and work orders under the FFS model
typically include a detailed schedule that sets forth specifications of and anticipated time required for
completing each step as well as the corresponding payment. Therefore, predicting our revenue in a
particular period may be difficult and our period-to-period comparisons may be less meaningful. If an
ADC or other bioconjugate candidate is unsuccessful, our services will no longer be needed for the
relevant project, and we will not be able to realize the remaining potential value under the contract for such
project. If a project is delayed due to technical or other issues, we will be required to spend more time and
effort on such project than originally expected. If a project reaches a stage pending regulatory approvals,
such as the IND filing, our services will be pending until the regulatory approvals are obtained. We may
also adopt the full-time-equivalent, or FTE, model, under which we designate employees to the customer’s
projects at a fixed rate per FTE employee per period-of-time.
Our growth momentum and profitability is also affected by the service required for different projects,
depending on a number of factors, such as the specific development stage(s) covered by a project and our
technology and human resources involved. Projects at different stages may have a varied gross profit
margin profile. As a result, our revenue and gross profit margin vary between different projects. As
pre-IND projects advance into the post-IND stage, the typical range of project contract values is expected
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 301 —


--- page 311 ---
to increase. Our revenue from post-IND services, as a percentage of our total revenue, increased from
44.9% in 2020 to 62.6% in the six months ended June 30, 2023. We expect commercial manufacturing
projects to be a strong driver of our future revenue growth after we launch the expected commercial
manufacturing of the first ADC drug in the near future. Any significant change in the mix of projects of
different sizes and types of services may impact our results of operations and our overall profit margin.
Dynamic Pricing Strategy
Pricing is an important factor that affects our business and results of operations. If we are able to
negotiate favorable contract terms with our customers, our revenue and profit margin may further increase.
We determine our pricing strategies based on a variety of factors, such as our market share and growth
strategy, market demand for our services, and pricing dynamics introduced by competitors. We face
competition from other third-party contract service providers for the discovery, development and
manufacturing of ADCs and other bioconjugates on a global basis. We believe our leadership position in
the rapidly growing global ADC drug market, combined with our fully integrated one-stop service
capabilities, will allow us to adopt a flexible and dynamic pricing strategy amid the evolving market trend
and support our continued growth.
Cost Management in Connection with Our Projects
Our ability to manage costs will affect our overall profitability. Our cost of services was RMB88.3
million, RMB197.6 million, RMB729.3 million, RMB225.5 million and RMB764.1 million in 2020, 2021,
2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively, and our gross profit margin was
8.4%, 36.5%, 26.4%, 31.6% and 23.1% in the same periods, respectively.
Direct labor cost was a significant component of our cost of services during the Track Record Period.
Our direct labor cost in connection with our projects include salaries, bonus, share-based compensation
and social security costs for our employees deployed for such projects. We have adopted an employee
share option plan for the primary purpose of rewarding and incentivizing our employees. Fluctuation in
direct labor costs will affect our cost of services and our gross profit margin.
In addition, we have incurred cost of raw materials in connection with our projects. To manage our
costs and improve our profit margins and, at the same time, ensure the cost-effective delivery of our
services, we continually optimize our supply chain management by seeking alternative suppliers for key
raw materials. During the Track Record Period, procurement of raw materials for us was conducted
through the centralized procurement system of WXB Group, and we were able to benefit from the
economies of scale associated with the magnitude of the global business of WXB Group. Going forward,
as our business continues to scale up, we intend to independently procure and gradually benefit from our
own economies of scale in procurement.
Due to surging demand for our services, we started outsourcing externally manufacturing of antibody
intermediates in 2021, which significantly increased our indirect production cost and overhead. We are in
the process of building up our own antibody intermediate manufacturing capacity and plan to gradually
reduce the outsourcing of antibody intermediate manufacturing, which is expected to result in improved
margin profile.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 302 —


--- page 312 ---
Expansions in Service Capabilities
To further grow our business, we have continued to expand our facilities and service capabilities. For
instance, we entered into agreement to acquire Payload & Linker Business in July 2021 to enhance our
discovery, research and development capabilities with respect to payload-linkers. We are also in the
process of building additional manufacturing facilities in our Wuxi site to meet the surging demand.
Additionally, we plan to construct a new manufacturing base in Singapore to meet the growing demand
from customers worldwide for comprehensive bioconjugate CRDMO services and implement a “global
dual sourcing” strategy. See “Business — Facilities — Our Facility Expansion Plans” for details. We have
incurred significant capital investment from these expansions. Our future plan to expand our facilities and
service capabilities will require further capital spending. See “Business — Our Strategies” and “Future
Plans and Use of Proceeds.” Moreover, the ramp-up of production in our manufacturing facilities and the
increase in service efficiency have resulted in greater economies of scale and had a positive impact on our
gross profit margin during the Track Record Period. We expect to further benefit from the increasing
utilization of our facilities.
Fluctuation in Foreign Exchange Rates
During the Track Record Period, a majority of our revenue was generated from sales denominated
in U.S. dollars. However, a majority of our cost of services and operating costs and expenses are
denominated in Renminbi, and our financial information is presented in Renminbi. We are thus subject to
foreign exchange risk. For example, if the U.S. dollar appreciates against the Renminbi after we enter into
a U.S. dollar denominated project-based service contract or a work order with a customer, our cost of
services as a percentage of our revenue attributable to such service contract or work order would decrease
due to such appreciation, increasing both our gross profit and gross profit margin. Conversely, if the
Renminbi appreciates against the U.S. dollar after we enter into a U.S. dollar denominated project-based
service contract or a work order with a customer, our gross profit and gross profit margin would be
adversely affected. We have put in place foreign exchange risk control policies, such as the use of
derivative financial instruments, to manage potential risks we may face during volatile fluctuations in
foreign exchange rates.
CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES, JUDGMENTS AND ESTIMATES
We prepare our consolidated financial information in accordance with accounting policies which
conform with IFRSs issued by the International Accounting Standards Board, which requires us to make
judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, disclosure
of contingent assets and liabilities on the date of the consolidated financial information and the reported
amounts of revenue and expenses during the financial reporting period. We continually evaluate these
estimates and assumptions based on the most recently available information, our own historical experience
and on various other assumptions that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results
of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are
not readily apparent from other sources. Because the use of estimates is an integral component of the
financial reporting process, actual results could differ from those estimates. We will continually assess our
assumptions and estimates going forward. We consider the policies and estimates discussed below to be
critical to an understanding of our consolidated financial information as their application places the most
significant demands on our management’s judgment. For details of our significant accounting policies and
estimates, see Note 5 in the Accountants’ Report set out in Appendix I to this prospectus.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 303 —


--- page 313 ---
Revenue
We recognize revenue when (or as) a performance obligation is satisfied, i.e., when “control” of the
services underlying the particular performance obligation is transferred to the customer. A performance
obligation represents a service (or a bundle of services) that is distinct or a series of distinct services that
are substantially the same.
Control is transferred over time and revenue is recognized over time by reference to the progress
towards complete satisfaction of the relevant performance obligation if one of the following criteria is met:
(i) the customer simultaneously receives and consumes the benefits provided by our performance as we
perform; (ii) our performance creates or enhances an asset that the customer controls as we perform; or
(iii) our performance does not create an asset with an alternative use to us and we have an enforceable right
to payment for performance completed to date.
Otherwise, revenue is recognized at a point in time when the customer obtains control of the distinct
service.
A contract asset represents our right to consideration in exchange for services that we have
transferred to a customer that is not yet unconditional. It is assessed for impairment in accordance with
IFRS 9. In contrast, a receivable represents our unconditional right to consideration, i.e. only the passage
of time is required before payment of that consideration is due. A contract liability represents our
obligation to transfer services to a customer for which we have received consideration (or an amount of
consideration is due) from the customer. A contract asset and a contract liability relating to the same
contract are accounted for and presented on a net basis.
Contracts with Multiple Performance Obligations (Including Allocation of Transaction Price)
For contracts that contain more than one performance obligations (i.e., fee-for-service (“ FFS”)),
contracts usually have multiple deliverable units, which are generally in the form of technical laboratory
reports, samples and/or goods), and we allocate the transaction price to each performance obligation on
a relative stand-alone selling price basis, except for the allocation of discounts and variable consideration.
The stand-alone selling price of the distinct service underlying each performance obligation is
determined at contract inception. It represents the price at which we would sell a promised good or service
separately to a customer. If a stand-alone selling price is not directly observable, we estimate it using
appropriate techniques such that the transaction price ultimately allocated to any performance obligation
reflects the amount of consideration to which we expect to be entitled in exchange for transferring the
promised goods or services to the customer.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 304 —


--- page 314 ---
Over Time Revenue Recognition: Measurement of Progress Towards Complete Satisfaction of a
Performance Obligation
The selection of the method to measure progress towards completion requires judgment and is based
on the nature of the products or services to be provided. Depending on which better depicts the transfer
of value to the customer, we measure its progress using either services transferred to the customer to date
(output method) or cost-to-cost (input method).
The progress towards complete satisfaction of a performance obligation is measured based on input
method, which is to recognize revenue on the basis of our costs incurred to date to the satisfaction of a
performance obligation relative to the total expected costs to the satisfaction of that performance
obligation, that best depict our performance in transferring control of services.
As a practical expedient, if we have a right to consideration in an amount that corresponds directly
with the value of our performance completed to date (for example, service contracts in which we bill a
fixed amount for each hour of service provided), we recognize revenue in the amount to which we have
the right to invoice.
Principal versus Agent
When another party is involved in providing goods or services to a customer, we determine whether
the nature of our promise is a performance obligation to provide the specified goods or services itself
(i.e. we are a principal) or to arrange for those goods or services to be provided by the other party (i.e. we
are an agent). We are a principal if we control the specified good or service before that good or service
is transferred to a customer. We are an agent if our performance obligation is to arrange for the provision
of the specified good or service by another party. In this case, we do not control the specified good or
service provided by another party before that good or service is transferred to the customer. When we act
as an agent, we recognizes revenue in the amount of any fee or commission to which we expect to be
entitled in exchange for arranging for the specified goods or services to be provided by the other party.
Foreign Currencies
In preparing the financial statements of each individual group entity, transactions in currencies other
than functional currency of that entity (foreign currencies) are recognized at the rates of exchanges
prevailing on the dates of the transactions. At the end of the reporting period, monetary items denominated
in foreign currencies are retranslated at the rates prevailing at that date. Non-monetary items that are
measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are not retranslated. Exchange differences
arising on the settlement of monetary items, and on the retranslation of monetary items, are recognized in
profit or loss in the period in which they arise.
For the purposes of presenting the consolidated financial statements, the assets and liabilities of our
foreign operations are translated into our presentation currency (i.e., Renminbi) using exchange rate
prevailing at the end of each reporting period. Income and expense items are translated at the average
exchange rates for the period. Exchange differences arising, if any, are recognized in other comprehensive
income and accumulated in equity under the heading of foreign currency translation reserve.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 305 —


--- page 315 ---
Research and Other Grants
Research and other grants are accounted for in accordance with IAS 20 Accounting for Government
Grants and Disclosure of Government Assistance. Research and other grants are not recognized until there
is reasonable assurance that we will comply with the conditions attaching to them and that the grants will
be received. Research and other grants are recognized in profit or loss on a systematic basis over the
periods in which we recognize as expenses the related costs for which the grants are intended to
compensate. Research and other grants related to income that are receivable as compensation for expenses
or losses already incurred or for the purpose of giving immediate financial support to us with no future
related costs are recognized in profit or loss in the period in which they become receivable. Such grants
are presented under “other income.”
Equity-Settled Share-Based Payment
Share Options Granted to Employees
Equity-settled share-based payments to employees (including our Directors) are measured at the fair
value of the equity instruments at the grant date. The fair value of the equity-settled share-based payments
determined at the grant date without taking into consideration all non-market vesting conditions is
expensed on a straight-line basis over the vesting period, based on our estimate of equity instruments that
will eventually vest, with a corresponding increase in equity (equity-settled share-based compensation
reserve). At the end of each reporting period, we revise our estimate of the number of equity instruments
expected to vest based on assessment of all relevant non-market vesting conditions. The impact of the
revision of the original estimates, if any, is recognized in profit or loss such that the cumulative expense
reflects the revised estimate, with a corresponding adjustment to the equity-settled share-based
compensation reserve.
When the share options are exercised, the amount previously recognized in equity-settled
share-based compensation reserve will be transferred to share premium. When the share options are
forfeited after the vesting date or are still not exercised at the expiry date, the amount previously
recognized in equity-settled share-based compensation reserve will continue to be held in equity-settled
share-based compensation reserve.
Modification to the Terms and Conditions of the Share-based Payment Arrangements
When the terms and conditions of an equity-settled share-based payment arrangement are modified,
we recognize, as a minimum, the services received measured at the grant date fair value of the equity
instruments granted, unless those equity instruments do not vest because of failure to satisfy a vesting
condition (other than a market condition) that was specified at grant date. In addition, if we modify the
vesting conditions (other than a market condition) in a manner that is beneficial to the employees, for
example, by reducing the vesting period, we take the modified vesting conditions into consideration over
the remaining vesting period. The incremental fair value granted, if any, is the difference between the fair
value of the modified equity instruments and that of the original equity instruments, both estimated as of
the date of modification.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 306 —


--- page 316 ---
If the modification occurs during the vesting period, the incremental fair value granted is included
in the measurement of the amount recognized for services received over the period from modification date
until the date when the modified equity instruments are vested, in addition to the amount based on the
grant date fair value of the original equity instruments, which is recognized over the remainder of the
original vesting period. If the modification reduces the total fair value of the share-based arrangement, or
is not otherwise beneficial to the employee, we continue to account for the original equity instruments
granted as if that modification had not occurred.
Equity Instruments Granted by the then Ultimate Holding Company to Our Employees
The grant by the then ultimate holding company of equity instruments under its employee stock
incentive plan to our employees (including directors of the Company) is treated as equity-settled
share-based payments in the consolidated financial statements. An expense for the grant date fair value of
the equity instruments under the employee stock incentive plan is recognized over the vesting period of
the instruments, with a corresponding increase in equity. The increase in equity is treated as a deemed
capital contribution into us and is included in equity-settled share-based compensation reserve.
Property, Plant and Equipment
Property, plant and equipment are tangible assets that are held for use in the production or supply
of goods or services, or for administrative purposes. Property, plant and equipment other than assets under
construction in progress are stated in the consolidated statement of financial position at cost less
subsequent accumulated depreciation and accumulated impairment losses, if any.
Property, plant and equipment in the course of construction for production, supply or administrative
purposes are carried at cost, less any recognized impairment loss. Costs include any costs directly
attributable to bringing the asset to the location and condition necessary for it to be capable of operating
in the manner intended by our management, including costs of testing whether the related assets are
functioning properly and, for qualifying assets, borrowing costs capitalized in accordance with our
accounting policy. Sales proceeds of items that are produced while bringing an item of property, plant and
equipment to the location and condition necessary for it to be capable of operating in the manner intended
by our management (such as samples produced when testing whether the asset is functioning properly),
and the related costs of producing those items are recognized in the profit or loss. The costs of those items
are measured in accordance with the measurement requirements of IAS 2. Depreciation of these assets, on
the same basis as other assets, commences when the assets are ready for their intended use.
Depreciation is recognized so as to write off the cost of assets other than property, plant and
equipment in the course of construction less their residual values over their estimated useful lives, using
the straight-line method. The estimated useful lives, residual values and depreciation method are reviewed
at the end of the reporting period, with the effect of any changes in estimate accounted for on a prospective
basis.
An item of property, plant and equipment is derecognized upon disposal or when no future economic
benefits are expected to arise from the continued use of the asset. Any gain or loss arising on the disposal
or retirement of property, plant and equipment is determined as the difference between the sales proceeds
and the carrying amount of the asset and is recognized in profit or loss.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 307 —


--- page 317 ---
Intangible Assets
Internally-generated Intangible Asset – Research and Development Expenditure
Expenditure on research activities is recognized as an expense in the period in which it is incurred.
An internally-generated intangible asset arising from development activities is recognized if, and only if,
all of the following have been demonstrated: (i) the technical feasibility of completing the intangible asset
so that it will be available for use or sale; (ii) the intention to complete the intangible asset and use or sell
it; (iii) the ability to use or sell the intangible asset; (iv) how the intangible asset will generate probable
future economic benefits; (v) the availability of adequate technical, financial and other resources to
complete the development and to use or sell the intangible asset; and (vi) the ability to measure reliably
the expenditure attributable to the intangible asset during its development.
The amount initially recognized for internally-generated intangible asset is the sum of the
expenditure incurred from the date when the intangible asset first meets the recognition criteria listed
above. If no internally-generated intangible asset can be recognized, development expenditure is
recognized in profit or loss in the period in which it is incurred. Subsequent to initial recognition,
internally-generated intangible assets are reported at cost less accumulated amortization and accumulated
impairment losses (if any), on the same basis as intangible assets that are acquired separately.
Intangible Assets Acquired in a Business Combination
Intangible assets acquired in a business combination are recognized separately from goodwill and are
initially recognized at their fair value at the acquisition date (which is regarded as their cost). Subsequent
to initial recognition, intangible assets acquired in a business combination with finite useful lives are
reported at costs less accumulated amortization and any accumulated impairment losses on the same basis
as intangible assets that are acquired separately. An intangible asset is derecognized on disposal, or when
no future economic benefits are expected from use or disposal. Gains and losses arising from
derecognition of an intangible asset, measured as the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the
carrying amount of the asset, are recognized in profit or loss when the asset is derecognized.
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
The following table set forth our consolidated statements of profit or loss and other comprehensive
income for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Revenue .................. 96,353 100.0 311,131 100.0 990,423 100.0 329,436 100.0 993,468 100.0
Cost of services .............. (88,272) (91.6) (197,637) (63.5) (729,340) (73.6) (225,481) (68.4) (764,068) (76.9)
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 308 —


--- page 318 ---
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Gross profit ................ 8,081 8.4 113,494 36.5 261,083 26.4 103,955 31.6 229,400 23.1
Selling and marketing expenses ..... (478) (0.5) (2,028) (0.7) (8,769) (0.9) (4,152) (1.3) (5,823) (0.6)
Administrative expenses ......... (9,608) (10.0) (27,858) (9.0) (49,210) (5.0) (15,248) (4.6) (42,739) (4.3)
Listing expenses .............. — — — — — — — — (7,374) (0.7)
Research and development expenses . . (4,075) (4.2) (13,815) (4.4) (33,842) (3.4) (11,059) (3.4) (29,749) (3.0)
Finance costs ................ — — (493) (0.2) (2,916) (0.3) (1,573) (0.5) (569) (0.1)
Other income ................ 41,446 43.0 8,966 2.9 26,152 2.6 18,812 5.7 39,579 4.0
Other gains and losses .......... (2,711) (2.8) (855) (0.3) 46,672 4.7 25,679 7.8 4,461 0.4
Impairment losses (recognized)/
reversed, under expected credit loss
model, net of reversal ......... (289) (0.3) (10,558) (3.4) (43,369) (4.4) 2,976 0.9 24,382 2.5
Profit before tax ............. 32,366 33.6 66,853 21.5 195,801 19.8 119,390 36.2 211,568 21.3
Income tax expense ............ (6,067) (6.3) (11,923) (3.8) (40,070) (4.0) (21,123) (6.4) (34,354) (3.5)
Profit for the period ........... 26,299 27.3 54,930 17.7 155,731 15.7 98,267 29.8 177,214 17.8
Other comprehensive
income/(expense)
Items that may be reclassified
subsequently to profit or loss:
Fair value gain/(loss) on cash flow
hedges, net of income tax ....... 1,668 1.7 499 0.2 (3,313) (0.3) (4,025) (1.2) 1,146 0.1
Exchange gain arising on translation of
foreign operations ........... — — — — — — — — 4,635 0.5
Other comprehensive
income/(expense) for the period . . 1,668 1.7 499 0.2 (3,313) (0.3) (4,025) (1.2) 5,781 0.6
Total comprehensive income for the
period .................. 27,967 29.0 55,429 17.8 152,418 15.4 94,242 28.6 182,995 18.4
Non-IFRS Measures:
Adjusted net profit (non-IFRS
measure)
(1) ............... 32,775 34.0 77,087 24.8 194,357 19.6 108,862 33.0 216,368 21.8
EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) (2) .... 45,800 47.5 86,299 27.7 224,917 22.7 134,273 40.8 231,463 23.3
Adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS
measure) (3) ............... 52,276 54.3 108,456 34.9 263,543 26.6 144,868 44.0 270,617 27.2
(1) Adjusted net profit is a non-IFRS measure. We defined “adjusted net profit (non-IFRS measure)” as net profit for the period
adjusted by adding back listing expenses and share-based compensation expense. See “— Non-IFRS Measures.”
(2) EBITDA is a non-IFRS measure. We defined “EBITDA (non-IFRS measure)” as net profit for the period adjusted by adding
back depreciation and amortization, income tax expense and finance costs. See “— Non-IFRS Measures.”
(3) Adjusted EBITDA is a non-IFRS measure. We defined “adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS measure)” as EBITDA (non-IFRS
measure) for the period adjusted by adding back listing expenses and share-based compensation expense. See “— Non-IFRS
Measures.”
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 309 —


--- page 319 ---
NON-IFRS MEASURES
Our consolidated financial information was prepared in accordance with IFRSs. To supplement our
consolidated results which are prepared and presented in accordance with IFRSs, we use adjusted net
profit (non-IFRS measure), EBITDA (non-IFRS measure), and adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) as
additional financial measures, which are not required by, or presented in accordance with, IFRSs. We
believe that these measures facilitate comparisons of operating performance from period to period and
company to company by eliminating the potential impact of items, such as certain non-cash items. The use
of these non-IFRS measures has limitations as an analytical tool, and you should not consider them in
isolation from, as a substitute for, analysis of, or superior to, our results of operations or financial
condition as reported under IFRSs. In addition, these non-IFRS financial measures may be defined
differently from similar terms used by other companies, and may not be comparable to other similarly
titled measure used by other companies.
We define adjusted net profit (non-IFRS measure) as net profit for the period, adjusted by adding
non-cash items. Listing expenses are the expenses relating to the Global Offering. Share-based
compensation expense is non-cash expenses arising from granting restricted share award and options to
senior management and employees. The following table sets forth a reconciliation of our adjusted net
profit (non-IFRS measure) for 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023 to the
nearest measure prepared in accordance with IFRSs.
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months ended
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
(RMB in thousands)
(unaudited)
Profit for the period .......... 26,299 54,930 155,731 98,267 177,214
Add:
Listing expenses .............. ———— 7,374
Share-based compensation
expense .................. 6,476 22,157 38,626 10,595 31,780
Adjusted net profit (non-IFRS
measure) ................. 32,775 77,087 194,357 108,862 216,368
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 310 —


--- page 320 ---
We define EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) as net profit for the period, adjusted by adding back
depreciation and amortization, income tax expenses and finance costs and subtracting interest income from
banks) for the period. We define adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) as EBITDA (non-IFRS measure),
adjusted by adding back listing expenses and share-based compensation expense. The following table sets
forth a reconciliation of our EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) and adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) for
2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023 to the nearest measures prepared in
accordance with IFRSs.
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months ended
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
(RMB in thousands)
(unaudited)
Profit for the period ......... 26,299 54,930 155,731 98,267 177,214
Add:
Income tax expense ........... 6,067 11,923 40,070 21,123 34,354
Depreciation and amortization .... 13,465 18,981 30,812 13,872 22,750
Finance costs ................ — 4 9 3 2,916 1,573 569
Subtract:
Interest income from banks ...... (31) (28) (4,612) (562) (3,424)
EBITDA (non-IFRS measure) . . . 45,800 86,299 224,917 134,273 231,463
Add:
Listing expenses .............. ———— 7,374
Share-based compensation
expense .................. 6,476 22,157 38,626 10,595 31,780
Adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS
measure) ................. 52,276 108,456 263,543 144,868 270,617
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
—3 1 1—


--- page 321 ---
KEY COMPONENTS OF OUR RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
Revenue
During the Track Record Period, we generated revenue from our CRDMO services for ADCs and
other bioconjugates.
Revenue by Project Development Stage
During the Track Record Period, we generated revenue from a mix of bioconjugate projects in
various development stages, which can be broadly categorized into (i) revenue from pre-IND projects,
primarily bioconjugate discovery projects at the drug discovery stage and preclinical development stage,
and (ii) revenue from post-IND projects, primarily at clinical and commercial stage. The following table
sets forth a breakdown of our revenue by development stages of projects, both in absolute amount and as
a percentage of our total revenue, for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Pre-IND services .... 53,122 55.1 152,506 49.0 381,071 38.5 99,267 30.1 371,273 37.4
Post-IND services .... 43,231 44.9 158,625 51.0 609,352 61.5 230,169 69.9 622,195 62.6
Total ........... 96,353 100.0 311,131 100.0 990,423 100.0 329,436 100.0 993,468 100.0
Revenue from post-IND services, as a percentage of our total revenue, increased during the Track
Record Period, primarily due to the increase in the number of our post-IND projects which have relatively
high contract value. As of June 30, 2023, we had 12 non-ADC integrated projects, accounting for 10.9%
of the total number of our ongoing integrated projects as of the same date.
Revenue by Project Type
During the Track Record Period, we generated revenue from both ADC and non-ADC projects in
terms of project types. The following table sets forth a breakdown of our revenue by project types, both
in absolute amount and as a percentage of our total revenue, for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
A D C ........... 91,706 95.2 276,178 88.8 914,965 92.4 290,859 88.3 938,074 94.4
Non-ADC ........ 4,647 4.8 34,953 11.2 75,458 7.6 38,577 11.7 55,394 5.6
Total ........... 96,353 100.0 311,131 100.0 990,423 100.0 329,436 100.0 993,468 100.0
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 312 —


--- page 322 ---
Revenue by Fee Model
During the Track Record Period, we provided CRDMO services on both FFS basis and FTE basis.
The FFS model is our default fee model for a vast majority of our projects during the Track Record Period.
Under the FFS model, a contract or work order typically comprises a number of tasks, each including
several discovery, development and/or manufacturing steps. A task is deemed to have been completed after
all the steps within such task are completed. Our service contracts and work orders under the FFS model
typically include a detailed schedule that sets forth specifications of and anticipated time required for
completing each step as well as the corresponding payment. We are typically required to deliver a
technical laboratory report, product/samples and/or other deliverables and transfer the relevant research
results and rights to the customer upon completion of each discovery, development or manufacturing step.
A particular step is deemed to be completed upon the customer’s acceptance of the deliverables in relation
to such step, which indicates that the customer is satisfied with the services provided by us at such step
and would like us to proceed to the next step of the project. We typically require our customers to make
an upfront payment upon the commencement of each task and the remaining payment after we complete
such task to the satisfaction of our customers. Revenue from the services rendered for a particular step is
recognized only after we receive such acceptance from the customer. As a result, the corresponding service
fee for each step is recorded as unbilled revenue upon the completion of such step until the entire task is
completed, at which time we will bill the customer. Unbilled revenue is converted into a receivable at this
time. A work order may also include pre-set milestones, particularly for projects which utilize our
proprietary technologies such as WuXiDAR4. Milestone fee is recognized immediately upon the project
reaching a pre-set milestone, which may or may not coincide with the completion of a specific step or task
under the work order. During the Track Record Period, we recorded a small amount of milestone fee
income. See “Business — Our Business Model — Our Fee Models — Fee-for-service Model” for details.
To a lesser extent, we also provided CRDMO services on an FTE basis during the Track Record
Period. Under the FTE model, we assemble and assign a project team of employees dedicated to
customers’ project for a specific period of time and charge the customers at a fixed hourly or daily rate
per employee. We typically require the customer to make monthly payments for services rendered and
recognize revenue over the service period. See “Business — Our Business Model — Our Fee Models —
Full-time-equivalent Model” for details.
The following table sets forth a breakdown of our revenue by fee model, both in absolute amount
and as a percentage of our total revenue, for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Services on FFS basis ........ 96,353 100.0 311,131 100.0 974,421 98.4 324,513 98.5 980,144 98.7
Services on FTE basis ........ — — — — 16,002 1.6 4,923 1.5 13,324 1.3
Total ................... 96,353 100.0 311,131 100.0 990,423 100.0 329,436 100.0 993,468 100.0
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 313 —


--- page 323 ---
Revenue by Geographic Coverage
We have a broad, loyal and fast-growing customer base. During the Track Record Period, we
generated revenue from ultimate customers primarily from North America, China and Europe. The
following table sets forth a breakdown of our revenue based on the location of our customers’
headquarters, both in absolute amount and as a percentage of our total revenue, for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
North America ...... 18,068 18.7 89,923 28.9 444,916 44.9 158,311 48.1 367,711 37.0
China ........... 68,688 71.3 128,427 41.3 306,198 30.9 96,605 29.3 356,019 35.9
Europe .......... — — 70,085 22.5 175,225 17.7 51,841 15.7 229,780 23.1
Others (1) ......... 9,597 10.0 22,696 7.3 64,084 6.5 22,679 6.9 39,958 4.0
Total ........... 96,353 100.0 311,131 100.0 990,423 100.0 329,436 100.0 993,468 100.0
* Revenue by geographic coverage is presented based on the location of the ultimate customers. For legacy contracts that were
contracted with Remaining WXB Group but were executed by us, we classify revenue based on the location of the customers’
headquarters, rather than that of Remaining WXB Group.
(1) Includes primarily countries and regions in Asia (excluding China) and Australia.
Revenue from customers in North America, China and Europe increased significantly during the
Track Record Period, as a result of the continual increase in customer demand for our CRDMO services
globally and in these markets particularly, driven by the development of the global ADC market and our
established industry position as a leading CRDMO service provider for ADC and other bioconjugates.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 314 —


--- page 324 ---
Cost of Services
Our cost of services consisted of indirect production cost and overheads, direct labor costs, cost of
raw materials, and depreciation and amortization. Indirect production cost and overheads primarily
represented costs incurred for the outsourcing of antibody intermediate manufacturing, as well as testing
fees, utilities and maintenance expenses. Direct labor costs primarily consisted of salaries, bonus, social
security expenses and share-based compensation for the employees in our laboratories and manufacturing
facilities. In 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, our share-based
compensation as part of the cost of services amounted to RMB2.6 million, RMB14.4 million, RMB25.7
million, RMB9.7 million and RMB21.5 million, respectively. Cost of raw materials primarily consisted of
costs incurred for the purchase of raw materials used in the provision of our services, such as laboratory
supplies and antibody intermediates. Depreciation and amortization consisted of depreciation relating to
the facilities and equipment and amortization relating to the intangible assets and software used in the
provision of our services. During the Track Record Period, our cost of services was RMB88.3 million,
RMB197.6 million, RMB729.3 million, RMB225.5 million and RMB764.1 million in 2020, 2021, 2022
and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively, primarily driven by our revenue growth.
The following table sets forth a breakdown of our cost of services by nature, both in absolute amount and
as a percentage of total cost of services, for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Indirect production cost
and overheads .... 5,760 6.5 42,746 21.7 460,457 63.1 91,759 40.7 560,954 73.4
Direct labor cost .... 45,237 51.3 82,019 41.5 150,775 20.7 65,503 29.1 109,213 14.2
Cost of raw materials . . 25,797 29.2 60,340 30.5 97,522 13.4 59,092 26.2 78,560 10.4
Depreciation and
amortization ..... 1 1,478 13.0 12,532 6.3 20,586 2.8 9,127 4.0 15,341 2.0
Total ........... 88,272 100.0 197,637 100.0 729,340 100.0 225,481 100.0 764,068 100.0
Gross Profit and Gross Profit Margin
Our gross profit was RMB8.1 million, RMB113.5 million, RMB261.1 million, RMB104.0 million
and RMB229.4 million in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023,
respectively, representing a gross profit margin of 8.4%, 36.5%, 26.4%, 31.6% and 23.1% for the same
periods, respectively. Our gross profit margin fluctuated during the Track Record Period. Although we
operated within the WXB Group’s BCD business unit as early as 2013, we started to build up our
manufacturing facilities in 2018. Our early investment in talent recruitment and facility construction of our
Wuxi site starting in 2018 in an effort to ramp up our operation incurred significant direct labor cost and
depreciation and amortization charges, which resulted in the relatively low gross profit margin of 8.4% in
2020. The growth in our business scale, the ramp-up of production, and the increase in service efficiency
in our manufacturing facilities in 2021 resulted in greater economies of scale and an increase in our gross
profit margin since 2021, and a percentile increase in outsourcing cost with respect to the manufacture of
antibody intermediates lowered our gross profit margin in 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 315 —


--- page 325 ---
Selling and Marketing Expenses
Our selling and marketing expenses primarily consisted of (i) depreciation and amortization,
representing primarily amortization of the customer relationship asset acquired in relation to our
acquisition of the Payload & Linker Business, and (ii) labor cost, representing primarily salaries, bonus,
social security cost and other employee benefits and share-based compensation for our sales and marketing
personnel. We incurred selling and marketing expenses of RMB0.5 million, RMB2.0 million, RMB8.8
million, RMB4.2 million and RMB5.8 million in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022
and 2023, respectively, representing 0.5%, 0.7%, 0.9%, 1.3% and 0.6% of our total revenue for the same
periods, respectively. We have inherited the strong brand recognition of our parent company, WuXi
Biologics, which enables us to enhance our sales and marketing efficiency. The following table sets forth
a breakdown of our selling and marketing expenses, both in absolute amount and as a percentage of total
selling and marketing expenses, for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Depreciation and
amortization ..... — — 1,550 76.4 6,202 70.7 3,101 74.7 3,102 53.3
Labor cost ........ 4 7 8 100.0 478 23.6 2,410 27.5 1,051 25.3 2,549 43.7
Others .......... — — — — 1 5 7 1 . 8 — — 1 7 2 3 . 0
Total selling
and marketing
expenses ....... 4 7 8 100.0 2,028 100.0 8,769 100.0 4,152 100.0 5,823 100.0
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 316 —


--- page 326 ---
Administrative Expenses
Our administrative expenses primarily consisted of (i) labor cost, representing primarily salaries,
bonus, social security cost and other employee benefits and share-based compensation for our
administrative personnel, (ii) expenses incurred by us in connection with our provision of rental and
related services, (iii) logistics and accommodation expenses, representing intra-site transportation
expenses and accommodation expenses incurred by our administrative personnel, (iv) depreciation and
amortization, representing primarily the depreciation of our equipment and facilities used by our
administrative department, (v) professional service fees, representing primarily audit and legal service
fees incurred during our ordinary course of business, and (vi) other administrative expenses primarily
maintenance expense and utilities. We incurred administrative expenses of RMB9.6 million, RMB27.9
million, RMB49.2 million, RMB15.2 million and RMB42.7 million in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six
months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively, representing 10.0%, 9.0%, 5.0%, 4.6% and 4.3% of
our total revenue for the same periods, respectively. The following table sets forth a breakdown of our
administrative expenses, both in absolute amount and as a percentage of total administrative expenses, for
the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Labor cost ........ 4,434 46.1 12,191 43.8 30,100 61.2 7,924 52.0 29,970 70.2
Expenses related to
provision of rental
and other related
services ........ 9 1 2 9 . 5 7,362 26.4 6,349 12.9 2,945 19.3 5,275 12.3
Logistics and
accommodation
expenses ....... 8 0 0 8 . 3 1,036 3.7 4,456 9.1 1,644 10.8 2,189 5.1
Depreciation and
amortization ..... 1,987 20.7 3,432 12.3 1,745 3.5 667 4.4 1,824 4.3
Professional
service fees ...... 1 3 5 1 . 4 1,845 6.6 2,442 5.0 950 6.2 950 2.2
Others
(1) ......... 1,340 14.0 1,992 7.2 4,118 8.3 1,118 7.3 2,531 5.9
Total administrative
expenses ....... 9,608 100.0 27,858 100.0 49,210 100.0 15,248 100.0 42,739 100.0
(1) Includes primarily maintenance expenses and utilities.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 317 —


--- page 327 ---
Our administrative expenses increased significantly during the Track Record Period, primarily due
to the headcount increase in our administrative staff and the recruitment of senior management, resulting
in an increase in labor cost. In particular, our professional service fees increased during the Track Record
Period, primarily driven by the increase in our demand for professional audit and legal services to support
our operational growth. Our logistics and accommodation expenses increased during 2020 and 2022,
primarily due to the increase in our administrative personnel, and remained relatively stable at RMB1.6
million and RMB2.2 million in the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively.
Listing Expenses
We incurred listing expenses of RMB7.4 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023, representing
costs and expenses incurred in connection with the Global Offering.
Research and Development Expenses
Our research and development activities during the Track Record Period primarily related to
development of our technology platform, including conjugation technologies, library of payload-linkers,
as well as process development know-how and analytical methods, among others. Our research and
development expenses primarily consisted of (i) labor cost, representing primarily salaries, bonus, social
security cost and other employee benefits for our R&D staff, (ii) cost of materials, representing supplies
and raw materials used in our R&D activities, and (iii) depreciation and amortization, representing the
depreciation of our equipment and facilities used by our R&D department and the amortization of the
intangible assets used in our R&D activities. We incurred research and development expenses of RMB4.1
million, RMB13.8 million, RMB33.8 million, RMB11.1 million and RMB29.7 million in 2020, 2021, 2022
and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively, representing 4.2%, 4.4%, 3.4%, 3.4% and
3.0% of our total revenue for the same periods, respectively. The following table sets forth a breakdown
of our research and development expenses, both in absolute amount and as a percentage of total research
and development expenses, for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Labor cost ........ 2,695 66.1 8,471 61.3 16,786 49.6 6,442 58.3 14,014 47.2
Cost of materials .... 1,380 33.9 3,877 28.1 14,777 43.7 3,640 32.9 13,252 44.5
Depreciation and
amortization ..... — — 1,467 10.6 2,279 6.7 977 8.8 2,483 8.3
Total research and
development
expenses ....... 4,075 100.0 13,815 100.0 33,842 100.0 11,059 100.0 29,749 100.0
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 318 —


--- page 328 ---
Finance Costs
Finance costs consisted of interest expense arising from intercompany borrowings between us and
Remaining WXB Group and lease liabilities. We incurred finance costs of nil, RMB0.5 million, RMB2.9
million, RMB1.6 million and RMB0.6 million in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022
and 2023, respectively. As of the Latest Practicable Date, all intercompany borrowings between us and the
Remaining WXB Group had been settled in full.
Other Income
Our other income primarily consisted of (i) rental income and other related income, arising from the
lease of our assembly center to the Remaining WXB Group, (ii) sales of materials to related parties,
primarily related to intercompany transfer of materials to the Remaining WXB Group, (iii) interest income
from banks, and (iv) research and other grants related to income, which primarily related to awards
recognizing our contribution to the high-tech industry and economy. We recorded other income of
RMB41.4 million, RMB9.0 million, RMB26.2 million, RMB18.8 million and RMB39.6 million in 2020,
2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively. The following table sets forth
a breakdown of our other income, both in absolute amount and as a percentage of total other income, for
the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Rental and other related
income ........... 1,525 3.7 7,596 84.7 3,831 14.7 1,614 8.6 1,122 2.8
Sales of materials to
related parties ....... 2 4 6 0 . 6 4 4 5 5 . 0 1,930 7.4 1,313 7.0 3,730 9.4
Interest income from
banks ............ 3 1 0 . 1 2 8 0 . 3 4,612 17.6 562 3.0 3,424 8.7
Research and other grants
related to income ..... 39,644 95.6 897 10.0 15,779 60.3 15,323 81.4 31,303 79.1
Total .............. 41,446 100.0 8,966 100.0 26,152 100.0 18,812 100.0 39,579 100.0
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 319 —


--- page 329 ---
Other Gains and Losses
Our other gains and losses primarily included fair value gain on wealth management products and
net foreign exchange gain and loss. We recorded other losses of RMB2.7 million and RMB0.9 million in
2020 and 2021, respectively. We recorded other gains of RMB46.7 million, RMB25.7 million and RMB4.5
million in 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively. The following table sets
forth a breakdown of our other gains and losses, both in absolute amount and as a percentage of total other
gains and losses, for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB % RMB %
(RMB in thousands except for percentages)
(unaudited)
Net foreign exchange
(loss)/gain ....... (2,711) (100.0) (986) (115.3) 46,284 99.2 25,455 99.1 (1,407) (31.5)
Fair value gain
on-wealth
management
products ........ — — — — — — — — 5,543 124.2
Others .......... — — 1 3 1 15.3 388 0.8 224 0.9 325 7.3
Total ........... (2,711) (100.0) (855) (100.0) 46,672 100.0 25,679 100.0 4,461 100.0
Impairment Losses (Recognized)/Reversed, under ECL Model, Net of Reversal
Our impairment losses (recognized)/reversed, under expected credit loss (“ ECL”) model, net of
reversal, primarily consisted of credit loss on our trade receivables. We recognized impairment losses, net
of reversal, of RMB0.3 million, RMB10.6 million and RMB43.4 million in 2020, 2021, 2022, respectively.
We reversed impairment losses of RMB3.0 million and RMB24.4 million in the six months ended June 30,
2022 and 2023, respectively.
Income Tax Expense
Our income tax expense primarily consisted of the current tax at the statutory rates applicable to our
assessable profit before taxation as determined under relevant laws and regulations. In 2020, 2021, 2022
and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, our income tax expense was RMB6.1 million, RMB11.9
million, RMB40.1 million, RMB21.1 million and RMB34.4 million, respectively.
During the Track Record Period, our income tax expense primarily consisted of income tax payable
by our subsidiaries in the PRC and Hong Kong. During the Track Record Period and up to the Latest
Practicable Date, we had paid all relevant taxes when due and there were no matters in dispute or
unresolved with the relevant tax authorities.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 320 —


--- page 330 ---
PRC Enterprise Income Tax
Pursuant to the EIT Law and related regulations, enterprises which operate in China are generally
subject to enterprise income tax at a rate of 25% on the taxable profit. Enterprises recognized as a “high
and new technology enterprise” (“ HNTE ”) are entitled to a preferential tax rate of 15% for three years as
long as the HNTE status is valid, and qualifying entities may re-apply for an additional three years
provided that their business operations continue to qualify for the HNTE status. XDC Wuxi was
recognized as an HNTE in December 2020. As a result, XDC Wuxi was entitled to the preferential tax rate
of 15% in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023. In addition, certain of our operating
subsidiaries in the PRC qualified as “micro and small enterprises” and were entitled preferential tax
treatment. For risks relating to our preferential tax treatments, see “Risk Factors — Risks Relating to Our
Business and Industry — The discontinuation of any of research and other grants or preferential tax
treatment currently available to us could adversely affect our financial position, results of operations, cash
flows and prospects.”
Hong Kong Profits Tax
Hong Kong Profits Tax is calculated at 16.5% on the estimated assessable profit.
Effective Tax Rate
Our effective tax rate, representing income tax expense divided by profit before taxation, was 18.7%,
17.8%, 20.5%, 17.7% and 16.2% in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023,
respectively. Our effective tax rate in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended in June 30, 2022 and
2023 was relatively stable and below the 25% statutory rate, primarily due to the preferential tax treatment
enjoyed by XDC Wuxi.
Profit for the Period
We recorded net profit of RMB26.3 million, RMB54.9 million, RMB155.7 million, RMB98.3
million and RMB177.2 million in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022 and 2023,
respectively. The significant growth of our net profit during the Track Record Period was generally in line
with our revenue and business growth. Our net profit margin decreased from 27.3% in 2020 to 17.7% in
2021, primarily due to the decrease of RMB38.7 million in research and other grants related to income
awarded to us in 2021. Our net profit margin slightly decreased to 15.7% in 2022, primarily due to the
outsourcing of antibody intermediate manufacturing. Our net profit margin decreased from 29.8% in the
six months ended June 30, 2022 to 17.8% in the six months ended June 30, 2023, primarily due to the
increase in our indirect production cost and overheads incurred for the outsourcing of antibody
intermediate manufacturing.
Adjusted Profit for the Period (Non-IFRS Measure)
We recorded adjusted net profit (non-IFRS measure) of RMB32.8 million, RMB77.1 million,
RMB194.4 million, RMB108.9 million and RMB216.4 million in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months
ended June 30, 2022 and 2023, respectively, and adjusted net profit margin (non-IFRS measure) of 34.0%,
24.8%, 19.6%, 33.0% and 21.8% in the same periods, respectively. The fluctuation in our adjusted net
profit (non-IFRS measure) and adjusted net profit margin (non-IFRS measure) were generally consistent
with that of our net profit and net profit margin, respectively. We had an accumulated loss of RMB9.0
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 321 —


--- page 331 ---
million at the beginning of 2020, which was primarily attributable to the fixed cost incurred prior to 2020
as we ramped up our operations and production capacity. In particular, we incurred significant cost as we
constructed our production facilities, such as our DP3 facility, and commenced GMP manufacturing since
August 2019. As we improved the utilization rate of our production facilities, expanded our service
capabilities, and continued to grow our business by attracting more customers and introducing more
projects, we were able to significantly improve our profitability.
Other Comprehensive Income/(Expense)
Our other comprehensive income primarily consisted of fair value gain or loss on cash flow hedges,
net of income tax, representing gain or loss in relation to our foreign exchange forward contracts, and
exchange gain arising from translation of foreign operations. We recorded total other comprehensive
income of RMB1.7 million, RMB0.5 million, and RMB5.8 million in 2020, 2021 and the six months ended
June 30, 2023, respectively. We recorded other comprehensive expense of RMB3.3 million and RMB4.0
million in 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2022, respectively.
PERIOD TO PERIOD COMPARISON OF RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
Six Months Ended June 30, 2023 Compared to Six Months Ended June 30, 2022
Revenue
Our revenue increased significantly from RMB329.4 million in the six months ended June 30, 2022
to RMB993.5 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023. Such increases were primarily due to the
following:
(i) the growth in the number of our customers and projects, driven by the fast growth of the global
ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing service market and our established industry
position as a leading CRDMO service provider for ADC and other bioconjugates; and
(ii) the advancement of our projects into later stages. Such movement can be evidenced by the fact
that 15 of our existing projects had progressed into next stages in the six months ended June
30, 2023.
As our projects continue to progress and move into later stages and typically yield greater contract
values, the average revenue contribution per project tends to increase, which further accelerated our
revenue growth during the Track Record Period. The average revenue contribution of our largest projects
(in terms of revenue contribution) that collectively contributed to 80% of our revenue in a given period
increased from RMB4.5 million in 2020 to RMB8.9 million in 2021, and further to RMB15.0 million in
2022. The number of such largest projects increased from 17 in 2020 to 28 in 2021 and further to 53 in
2022. In the six months ended June 30, 2023, the largest 69 projects collectively contributed to 80% of
our revenue for the period, and the average revenue contribution of the 69 projects amounted to RMB11.5
million, as compared to 63 projects and RMB4.2 million per project for the six months ended June 30,
2022.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 322 —


--- page 332 ---
Cost of Services
Our cost of services increased significantly from RMB225.5 million in the six months ended June
30, 2022 to RMB764.1 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023, primarily due to (i) an increase of
RMB469.2 million in indirect production cost and overheads as a result of the increase in the outsourcing
of antibody intermediate manufacturing, (ii) an increase of RMB43.7 million in direct labor cost, as a
result of the increases in the headcount of and our average compensation level for employees in our
laboratories and manufacturing facilities, and (iii) an increase of RMB19.5 million in cost of raw
materials, as a result of the increase in our material procurement driven by our business growth.
Gross Profit and Gross Profit Margin
As a result of the foregoing, our gross profit increased significantly from RMB104.0 million in the
six months ended June 30, 2022 to RMB229.4 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023. Our gross
profit margin decreased from 31.6% in the six months ended June 30, 2022 to 23.1% in the six months
ended June 30, 2023. During the six months ended June 30, 2023, our customer demands continued to
increase and more projects progressed into post-IND clinical stage, which resulted in increasing demands
for antibody intermediate manufacturing services. As we did not have manufacturing facility for antibody
intermediates, after we started to operate as a separate entity in the second half of 2021, we have
outsourced certain antibody intermediate manufacturing to the Remaining WXB Group and recorded such
outsourcing expenses as indirect production costs in our cost of services. Prior to that, we operated within
the WXB Group’s BCD business unit and were principally involved in the provision of bioconjugation
services only in 2020 and 2021. After our operating as a separate entity from the WXB Group, we acquired
the Payload & Linker Business from STA Changzhou, which enabled us to further expand our service
capabilities. After the acquisition, we have been primarily engaged in the provision of one-stop and fully
integrated CRDMO services for bioconjugate drugs, which expand from our initial bioconjugation
services. The expanded service scope led to a rise in labor cost and other production costs and overheads
in connection with the provision of the integrated CRDMO services. The increased outsourcing of
antibody intermediate manufacturing and the expansion in service scope to provide integrated CRDMO
services resulted in an increase in direct labor cost and indirect production cost and overheads and
therefore a negative impact on our gross profit margin. The decrease in the gross profit margin was
partially offset by the continual increase in our operating leverage from greater economies of scale as we
continue to ramp up our operations.
Selling and Marketing Expenses
Our selling and marketing expenses increased by 40.2% from RMB4.2 million in the six months
ended June 30, 2022 to RMB5.8 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023, primarily representing an
increase of RMB1.5 million in labor cost for our selling and marketing personnel, as a result of the
increase in the headcount of our selling and marketing personnel.
Administrative Expenses
Our administrative expenses increased significantly from RMB15.2 million in the six months ended
June 30, 2022 to RMB42.7 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023, primarily due to (i) an increase
of RMB22.0 million in labor cost, as a result of the increases in the headcount of and average
compensation level for our administrative personnel and management, and (ii) an increase of RMB2.3
million in expenses incurred in connection with our provision of rental and related services.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 323 —


--- page 333 ---
Listing Expenses
Our listing expenses increased from nil in the six months ended June 30, 2022 to RMB7.4 million
in the six months ended June 30, 2023, primarily due to costs and expenses incurred in connection with
the Global Offering.
Research and Development Expenses
Our research and development expenses increased significantly from RMB11.1 million in the six
months ended June 30, 2022 to RMB29.7 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023, primarily due
to (i) an increase of RMB9.6 million in cost of materials, as a result of the increase in material
procurement for our R&D activities, driven by our business growth, and (ii) an increase of RMB7.6
million in labor cost.
Finance Costs
Our finance costs decreased by 63.8% from RMB1.6 million in the six months ended June 30, 2022
to RMB0.6 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023, primarily due to the repayment of our
intercompany borrowings.
Other Income
Our other income increased significantly from RMB18.8 million in the six months ended June 30,
2022 to RMB39.6 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023, primarily due to (i) an increase of
RMB16.0 million in research and other grants related to income, as we received from local authorities of
Wuxi City in relation to our expanded operating scale of RMB28.5 million in the six months ended June
30, 2023 pursuant to local government initiative to support the business development of key industries,
and (ii) an increase of RMB2.9 million in interest income from banks, primarily attributable to the increase
in bank deposits due to our revenue growth.
Other Gains and Losses
Our other gains decreased by 82.6% from RMB25.7 million in the six months ended June 30, 2022
to RMB4.5 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023, primarily due to our net foreign exchange loss
of RMB1.4 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023, as compared to our net foreign exchange gain
of RMB25.5 million in the six months ended June 30, 2022, primarily due to fluctuations in the exchange
rate between U.S. dollar and Renminbi in the six months ended June 30, 2023 as we settled with overseas
customers in U.S. dollars, partially offset by an increase on the fair value gain on wealth management
products of RMB5.5 million.
Impairment Losses (Recognized)/Reversed, under ECL Model, Net of Reversal
Our impairment losses reversed, under ECL model, net of reversal, increased significantly from
RMB3.0 million in the six months ended June 30, 2022 to RMB24.4 million in the six months ended
June 30, 2023, primarily due to the subsequent repayment of trade receivables by certain customers.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 324 —


--- page 334 ---
Income Tax Expense
Our income tax expense increased by 62.6% from RMB21.1 million in the six months ended June
30, 2022 to RMB34.4 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023, generally in line with our revenue
growth.
Profit for the Period
As a result of the above, our net profit increased by 80.3% from RMB98.3 million in the six months
ended June 30, 2022 to RMB177.2 million in the six months ended June 30, 2023. Our net profit margin
decreased from 29.8% in the six months ended June 30, 2022 to 17.8% in the six months ended June 30,
2023.
Y ear Ended December 31, 2022 Compared to Y ear Ended December 31, 2021
Revenue
Our revenue increased significantly from RMB311.1 million in 2021 to RMB990.4 million in 2022.
Such increases were primarily due to the following:
(i) the growth in the number of customers and projects, driven by the fast growth of the global
ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing service market and our further integrated service
capabilities after acquiring Payload & Linker Business. We have further established our leading
industry position by increasing our global market share by revenue from 4.6% in 2021 to 9.8%
in 2022, while the global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market grew by
over 30% in value from US$1.1 billion in 2021 to US$1.5 billion in 2022. The number of
customers served by us increased from 115 in 2021 to 167 in 2022, and the number of our
ongoing integrated projects increased from 60 as of December 31, 2021 to 94 as of December
31, 2022; and
(ii) the increase in the average revenue contribution per project with more projects advancing to
later stages. In 2022, the largest 53 projects (in terms of revenue contribution) collectively
contributed to 80% of our revenue for the period, and the average revenue contribution of the
largest 53 projects amounted to RMB15.0 million, as compared to 28 projects and RMB8.9
million per project for 2021. See “— Six Months Ended June 30, 2023 Compared to Six Months
Ended June 30, 2022.”
Cost of Services
Our cost of services increased significantly from RMB197.6 million in 2021 to RMB729.3 million
in 2022, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB417.7 million in indirect production cost and overheads
as a result of the increase in the outsourcing of antibody intermediate manufacturing, (ii) an increase of
RMB68.8 million in direct labor cost, as a result of the increases in the headcount of and the average
compensation level for employees in our laboratories and manufacturing facilities, and (iii) an increase of
RMB37.2 million in cost of raw materials, as a result of the increase in our material procurement, in line
with our business growth.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 325 —


--- page 335 ---
Gross Profit and Gross Profit Margin
As a result of the foregoing, our gross profit increased significantly from RMB113.5 million in 2021
to RMB261.1 million in 2022. Our gross profit margin decreased from 36.5% in 2021 to 26.4% in 2022.
During 2022, our customer demands continued to increase and more projects progressed into post-IND
clinical stage, which resulted in increasing demands for antibody intermediate manufacturing services. As
we started to contract with end customers directly and provided integrated CRDMO services upon the
establishment of the joint venture in late 2021, the amounts of the outsourcing of antibody intermediate
manufacturing services increased given we did not have manufacturing facility for antibody intermediates,
and after we started to operate as a separate entity in the second half of 2021, we have outsourced certain
antibody intermediate manufacturing to the Remaining WXB Group and recorded such outsourcing
expenses as indirect production costs in our cost of services. Prior to that, we operated within the WXB
Group’s BCD business unit and were principally involved in the provision of bioconjugation services only
in 2020 and 2021. After our operating as a separate entity from the WXB Group, we acquired the Payload
& Linker Business from STA Changzhou, which enabled us to further expand our service capabilities.
After the acquisition, we have been primarily engaged in the provision of one-stop and fully integrated
CRDMO services for bioconjugate drugs, which expand from our initial bioconjugation services. The
expanded service scope led to a rise in labor cost and other production costs and overheads in connection
with the provision of the integrated CRDMO services. The increased outsourcing of antibody intermediate
manufacturing and the expansion in service scope to provide integrated CRDMO services resulted in an
increase in direct labor cost and indirect production cost and overheads and therefore a negative impact
on our gross profit margin.
Selling and Marketing Expenses
Our selling and marketing expenses increased significantly from RMB2.0 million in 2021 to RMB8.8
million in 2022, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB4.6 million from RMB1.6 million to RMB 6.2
million in depreciation and amortization, representing the amortization of customer relationship asset
acquired in relation to our acquisition of the Payload & Linker Business, and (ii) an increase in labor cost.
Administrative Expenses
Our administrative expenses increased by 76.6% from RMB27.9 million in 2021 to RMB49.2 million
in 2022, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB17.9 million from RMB12.2 million to RMB30.1 million
in labor cost, as a result of the increases in the headcount of and the average compensation level for our
administrative personnel, and (ii) an increase of RMB3.5 million from RMB1.0 million to RMB4.5 million
in logistics and accommodation expenses, which was primarily due to the increase in the number of
administrative employees.
Research and Development Expenses
Our research and development expenses increased significantly from RMB13.8 million in 2021 to
RMB33.8 million in 2022, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB10.9 million from RMB3.9 million to
RMB14.8 million in cost of materials as a result of the increase in material procurement for our R&D
activities, driven by our business growth, and (ii) an increase of RMB8.3 million from RMB8.5 million
to RMB16.8 million in labor cost as a result of the increases in the headcount of and the average
compensation level for our R&D personnel.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 326 —


--- page 336 ---
Finance Costs
Our finance costs increased significantly from RMB0.5 million in 2021 to RMB2.9 million in 2022,
primarily due to an increase of RMB2.2 million in interest expense arising from intercompany borrowings
from the Remaining WXB Group to us.
Other Income
Our other income increased significantly from RMB9.0 million in 2021 to RMB26.2 million in 2022,
primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB14.9 million in research and other grants related to income, as we
received award from local authorities of Wuxi City in relation to our expanded operating scale of
RMB15.8 million in 2022 pursuant to local government initiative to support the business development of
key industries, and (ii) an increase of RMB4.6 million in interest income from banks, as a result of an
increase in our demand deposits in relation to the capital injection by our shareholders.
Other Gains and Losses
We recorded other gains of RMB46.7 million in 2022, as compared to other losses of RMB0.9
million in 2021, primarily due to our net foreign exchange gain of RMB46.3 million in 2022, as a result
of the depreciation of the Renminbi against the U.S. dollar in 2022.
Impairment Losses (Recognized)/Reversed, under ECL Model, Net of Reversal
Our impairment losses recognized, under ECL loss model, net of reversal, increased significantly
from RMB10.6 million in 2021 to RMB43.4 million in 2022, generally consistent with our business
growth.
Income Tax Expense
Our income tax expense increased significantly from RMB11.9 million in 2021 to RMB40.1 million
in 2022, primarily due to the increase in our taxable income, generally in line with our revenue growth.
Profit for the Y ear
As a result of the above, our net profit increased significantly from RMB54.9 million in 2021 to
RMB155.7 million in 2022. Our net profit margin decreased from 17.7% in 2021 to 15.7% in 2022.
Y ear Ended December 31, 2021 Compared to Y ear Ended December 31, 2020
Revenue
Our revenue increased significantly from RMB96.4 million in 2020 to RMB311.1 million in 2021
primarily due to the increase in customer demand for our CRDMO services as shown by an increase of
customers served by us from 49 in 2020 to 115 in 2021, driven by (i) our continued expansion of service
capabilities and ability to provide integrated CRDMO services, including the acquisition of the Payload
& Linker Business, (ii) the expansion of our geographical footprint, as evidenced by the increase in our
revenue generated from ultimate customers in North America and our tapping into the European market,
and (iii) the increase in our global market share from 1.8% to 4.6%, combined with the fast growth of the
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 327 —


--- page 337 ---
global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing service market, which grew by over 30% in value from
US$0.8 billion in 2020 to US$1.1 billion in 2021. The increase in our average revenue contribution per
project also further accelerated our revenue growth. In 2021, the largest 28 projects (in terms of revenue
contribution) collectively contributed to 80% of our revenue for the period, and the average revenue
contribution of the largest 28 projects amounted to RMB8.9 million, as compared to 17 projects and
RMB4.5 million per project for 2020. See “— Six Months Ended June 30, 2023 Compared to Six Months
Ended June 30, 2022.”
Cost of Services
Our cost of services increased significantly from RMB88.3 million in 2020 to RMB197.6 million in
2021, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB37.0 million in indirect production cost and overheads as
a result of the increase in the outsourcing of antibody intermediate manufacturing, (ii) an increase of
RMB36.8 million in direct labor cost, as a result of the increases in the headcount of and the average
compensation level for the employees in our laboratories and manufacturing facilities, and (iii) an increase
of RMB34.5 million in cost of raw materials, as a result of the increase in our material procurement, in
line with our business growth.
Gross Profit and Gross Profit Margin
As a result of the foregoing, our gross profit increased significantly from RMB8.1 million in 2020
to RMB113.5 million in 2021. Our gross profit margin increased from 8.4% in 2020 to 36.5% in 2021,
primarily due to the ramp-up of production in our manufacturing facilities and the increase in service
efficiency which resulted in greater economies of scale.
Selling and Marketing Expenses
Our selling and marketing expenses increased significantly from RMB0.5 million in 2020 to RMB2.0
million in 2021, representing the amortization of customer relationship asset acquired as a result of our
acquisition of the Payload & Linker Business.
Administrative Expenses
Our administrative expenses increased significantly from RMB9.6 million in 2020 to RMB27.9
million in 2021, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB7.8 million from RMB4.4 million to RMB12.2
million in labor cost, as a result of the increases in the headcount of and the average compensation level
for our administrative personnel, (ii) an increase of RMB6.5 million from RMB0.9 million to RMB7.4
million in expenses incurred in connection with our provision of rental and related services, increase
maintenance and utilities expenses in connection with the rental services, and (iii) an increase of RMB1.7
million in professional service fees as a result of the increase in our demand for professional audit and
legal services.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 328 —


--- page 338 ---
Research and Development Expenses
Our research and development expenses increased significantly from RMB4.1 million in 2020 to
RMB13.8 million in 2021, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB5.8 million from RMB2.7 million to
RMB8.5 million in labor cost, as a result of the increases in the headcount of and the average
compensation level for our R&D personnel, and (ii) an increase of RMB2.5 million from RMB1.4 million
to RMB3.9 million in cost of materials as a result of the increase in material procurement for our R&D
activities, driven by our business growth.
Finance Costs
Our finance costs increased significantly from nil in 2020 to RMB0.5 million in 2021, primarily
representing interest expense on intercompany borrowings from Remaining WXB Group to us.
Other Income
Our other income decreased by 78.4% from RMB41.4 million in 2020 to RMB9.0 million in 2021,
primarily due to the decrease of RMB38.7 million in research and other grants related to income, as we
received a one-off operating subsidy provided by local authorities of RMB39.6 million in 2020.
Other Gains and Losses
Our other losses decreased by 68.5% from RMB2.7 million in 2020 to RMB0.9 million in 2021,
primarily due to a decrease of RMB1.7 million in net foreign exchange loss, as a result of the appreciation
of the Renminbi against the U.S. dollar since June 2020.
Impairment Losses (Recognized)/Reversed, under ECL, Net of Reversal
Our impairment losses recognized, under ECL, net of reversal, increased significantly from RMB0.3
million in 2020 to RMB10.6 million in 2021, primarily due to the increase in credit loss of our trade
receivables as a result of impaired recoverability of trade receivables in relation to certain small-sized
biotechnology companies.
Income Tax Expense
Our income tax expense increased by 96.5% from RMB6.1 million in 2020 to RMB11.9 million in
2021, primarily due to the increase in our taxable income, generally in line with our revenue growth.
Profit for the Y ear
As a result of the above, our net profit increased significantly from RMB26.3 million in 2020 to
RMB54.9 million in 2021. Our net profit margin decreased from 27.3% in 2020 to 17.7% in 2021.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 329 —


--- page 339 ---
DISCUSSION OF MAJOR BALANCE SHEET ITEMS
The following table sets forth details of our summary combined statements of financial position as
of the dates indicated.
As of December 31, As of
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment ........ 303,205 335,684 798,575 987,555
Investment property ................ — 13,215 12,812 12,610
Right-of-use asset ................. — 2,223 5,280 4,529
Goodwill ....................... — 215,193 215,193 215,193
Intangible assets .................. 4,808 60,990 50,648 57,047
Deferred tax assets ................ 3 8 7 1,995 11,540 8,557
Other long-term deposits
and prepayments ................ 1 5 0 1 5 0 — 3 6 8
Total non-current assets ............. 308,550 629,450 1,094,048 1,285,859
Current assets
Inventories ...................... 7,678 23,786 62,934 47,403
Trade and other receivables .......... 44,060 150,236 505,604 757,245
Contract assets ................... 1,028 10,717 17,309 24,665
Contract costs .................... 13,875 36,690 80,713 63,134
Tax recoverable ................... 2,66 3———
Derivative financial assets ........... 2,224 2,549 799 —
Financial assets at FVTPL ........... — — 400,000 —
Bank balances and cash ............. 28,390 26,325 334,972 561,644
Total current assets ................. 99,918 250,303 1,402,331 1,454,091
Total assets ....................... 408,468 879,753 2,496,379 2,739,950
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables ............ 32,080 818,653 773,313 773,149
Loans from related parties ........... — 22,343 71,144 —
Contract liabilities ................. 1 5 1 10,020 151,450 232,418
Income tax payable ................ — 5,225 11,506 30,457
Lease liabilities ................... — 2,249 4,413 2,828
Derivative financial liabilities ........ — — 2,147 —
Total current liabilities .............. 32,231 858,490 1,013,973 1,038,852
Net current assets/(liabilities) ......... 67,687 (608,187) 388,358 415,239
Total assets less current liabilities ...... 376,237 21,263 1,482,406 1,701,098
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 330 —


--- page 340 ---
As of December 31, As of
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Non-current liabilities
Deferred tax liabilities .............. 5 5 6 3 8 2 — —
Lease liabilities ................... — — 1,627 2,477
Total non-current liabilities ........... 5 5 6 3 8 2 1,627 2,477
Total liabilities .................... 32,787 858,872 1,015,600 1,041,329
Net assets ........................ 375,681 20,881 1,480,779 1,698,621
Capital and reserve
Share capital ..................... — — 3 1 9 3 1 9
Reserves ........................ 375,681 20,881 1,480,460 1,698,302
375,681 20,881 1,480,779 1,698,621
Property, Plant and Equipment
Our property, plant and equipment primarily consisted of machinery, furniture, fixtures and
equipment, land and buildings, leasehold improvements and construction in progress. We had property,
plant and equipment of RMB303.2 million, RMB335.7 million, RMB798.6 million and RMB987.6 million
as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023, respectively. The following table sets forth
the components of our property, plant and equipment as of the dates indicated.
As of December 31, As of
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Machinery ........................ 62,540 75,679 139,697 175,595
Furniture, fixtures and equipment ....... 5,459 6,552 18,339 22,039
Land and buildings .................. 1 12,092 95,583 92,667 192,684
Leasehold improvements .............. 89,246 89,977 119,672 179,070
Construction in progress .............. 33,868 67,893 428,200 418,167
Total ............................ 303,205 335,684 798,575 987,555
Our property, plant and equipment increased by 10.7% from RMB303.2 million as of December 31,
2020 to RMB335.7 million as of December 31, 2021, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB34.0 million
in construction in progress, (ii) an increase of RMB13.1 million in machinery as a result of the
procurement of manufacturing equipment and process equipment, and (iii) an increase of RMB1.1 million
in furniture, fixtures and equipment, all in connection with the expansion of our Wuxi site.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 331 —


--- page 341 ---
Our property, plant and equipment increased significantly from RMB335.7 million as of December
31, 2021 to RMB798.6 million as of December 31, 2022, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB360.3
million in construction in progress in relation to the expansion of our Wuxi site, (ii) an increase of
RMB64.0 million in machinery as a result of the procurement of equipment for quality control and R&D
laboratories on Wuxi site and the reclassification of relevant items from construction in progress, (iii) an
increase of RMB29.7 million in leasehold improvements in relation to renovations on leased properties on
Wuxi site, and (iv) an increase of RMB11.8 million in furniture, fixtures and equipment as a result of the
addition of utility facilities as a result of the expansion of our Wuxi site and the reclassification of relevant
items from construction in progress, partially offset by a decrease of RMB2.9 million in land and buildings
as a result of depreciation.
Our property, plant and equipment increased by 23.7% from RMB798.6 million as of December 31,
2022 to RMB987.6 million as of June 30, 2023, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB100.0 million in
land and buildings, as a result of the expansion of our Wuxi site and the addition of our properties in
Shanghai, (ii) an increase of RMB59.4 million in leasehold improvements, and (iii) an increase of
RMB35.9 million in machinery, both in connection with the expansion of our Wuxi site, partially offset
by a decrease of RMB10.0 million in construction in progress, as a result of the reclassification of
construction in progress into other categories of property, plant and equipment, after completion of the
relevant construction projects.
Investment Property
We recorded investment property of nil, RMB13.2 million, RMB12.8 million and RMB12.6 million
as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023. We leased out an assembly center under
operating leases to the Remaining WXB Group, which had an initial term of four years and will expire in
2025.
Goodwill
We recorded goodwill of nil, RMB215.2 million, RMB215.2 million and RMB215.2 million as of
December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023, in relation to our acquisition of Payload & Linker
Business in 2021.
For the purposes of impairment testing, the acquired Payload & Linker Business is allocated as an
individual cash-generating unit (the “ Payload & Linker Unit ”). The recoverable amount of the Payload
& Linker Unit has been determined based on a value in use calculation, which uses cash flow projections
based on financial budgets approved by our management covering a five-year period. The following table
sets out the key assumptions for the value in use calculation of the Payload & Linker Unit.
As at December 31,
2021 2022
RMB’000 RMB’000
Pre-tax discount rate (1) ........................... 1 6 % 1 7 %
Expected annual growth rate in 5 years (2) .............. 10.0%-30.0% 5.0%-30.0%
(1) Pre-tax discount rate applied reflects the current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific
to the Payload and Linker Unit.
(2) The estimation of expected annual growth rate is based on the revenue backlog and management’s expectation for the
market development.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 332 —


--- page 342 ---
The cash flows beyond the five-year period are extrapolated using a growth rate based on the
relevant industry growth forecasts and does not exceed the average long-term growth rate for the relevant
industry. Our performed sensitivity test on the key assumptions by increasing 1% of pre-tax discount rate
or decreasing of 5% expected annual growth rate, with all other variables held constant. The impact on the
amount by which the goodwill’s recoverable amount above its carrying amount (headroom) are as below:
As at December 31,
2021 2022
RMB’000 RMB’000
Headroom .................................... N / A (1) 83,068
Impact by increasing pre-tax discount rate of 1% ........ (26,373) (32,019)
Impact by decreasing annual growth rate of 5% ......... (45,513) (47,174)
(1) As the acquisition date of Payload & Linker Business was near the end of financial year 2021, our management
considers recoverable amount approximates the carrying amount as of December 31, 2021.
In accordance with our accounting policies, goodwill is tested for impairment on an annual basis at
each year end. As of June 30, 2023, the management was not aware of any significant adverse changes on
the Payload & Linker Unit, which indicates that the carrying amount of the Payload & Linker Unit exceeds
the recoverable amount. Consequently, no interim impairment assessment as of June 30, 2023 was
performed.
Based on the above assessment, our management determines that there is no impairment on the
Payload & Linker Unit during and at the end of the reporting period. Our management believes that any
reasonably possible change in any of these assumptions would not result in impairment.
Intangible Assets
Our intangible assets primarily consisted of technology and customer relationship. Our intangible
assets increased significantly from RMB4.8 million as of December 31, 2020 to RMB61.0 million as of
December 31, 2021, primarily due to an increase of RMB56.9 million in customer relationship asset, as
a result of our acquisition of Payload & Linker Business, partially offset by a decrease of RMB0.7 million
in technology as a result of amortization. Our intangible assets then decreased by 17.0% to RMB50.6
million as of December 31, 2022, primarily due to (i) a decrease of RMB6.2 million in customer
relationship asset and (ii) a decrease of RMB4.1 million in technology, both as a result of amortization.
Our intangible assets then increased by 12.6% to RMB57.0 million as of June 30, 2023, primarily
representing addition of certain license-in technologies.
Inventories
Our inventories consisted primarily of raw materials, pharmaceutical intermediates and
consumables. Our inventories level increased from RMB7.7 million as of December 31, 2020 to RMB23.8
million as of December 31, 2021, and to RMB62.9 million as of December 31, 2022, generally in line with
our business growth. Our inventories decreased to RMB47.4 million as of June 30, 2023, primarily
representing inventory consumed for our manufacturing activities and our inventory optimization strategy
to lower our inventory level to approximately two to three months’ supply.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 333 —


--- page 343 ---
Our inventory turnover days was 29.1 days, 21.7 days and 13.1 days in 2021, 2022 and the six
months ended June 30, 2023. During the Track Record Period, our inventory turnover days generally
decreased as a result of the optimization of our procurement strategy and the resulting higher inventory
consumption rate. The following table sets forth the number of our inventory turnover days for the periods
indicated.
Y ear ended December 31,
Six
months ended
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
Inventory turnover days (1) ............. N / A 29.1 21.7 13.1
(1) Inventory turnover days were calculated based on the average of opening and closing inventory balance for the relevant period
(the opening balance in 2020 being unavailable), divided by the cost of services for the same period, and multiplied by the
number of days in that period.
As of September 30, 2023, approximately RMB17.0 million, or 36.0%, of our inventories as of June
30, 2023 had been consumed. Such inventory consumption rate was attributable to our inventory
procurement practices, and we typically procure raw materials based on our project status and business
projections for the forthcoming year, so as to save procurement cost and improve operating efficiency. The
following table sets forth the aging analysis of our inventories as of the dates indicated.
Y ear ended December 31,
Six
months ended
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Within three months ................. 1,561 11,161 30,191 9,296
Over three months but within one year . . . 3,942 11,298 26,675 28,932
Over one year ..................... 2,175 1,327 6,068 9,175
Total ............................ 7,678 23,786 62,934 47,403
Our Directors concluded that we do not have any material recoverability issue for our inventories and
the write-down of inventories was adequate and reasonable for the following reasons. During the Track
Record Period, we had a relatively quick inventory turnover, as reflected by the relatively short inventory
turnover days of 29.1 days, 21.7 days and 13.1 days in 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023.
We also have in place dedicated personnel who continually monitor aging conditions of our inventories
with a view to identify obsolete and slow-moving inventories so that we can promptly take appropriate
remedial measures accordingly. Our management also reviews the recoverability of our inventories as of
the end of each reporting period to ensure that adequate impairment losses are made for irrecoverable
amounts. During the Track Record Period, we recorded a relatively insignificant amount of write-down of
inventories, net of reversal, of nil, RMB0.4 million, RMB0.1 million and RMB0.3 million in 2020, 2021,
2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively. In light of the foregoing, we do not expect
to experience any material issue in recoverability of inventories in the foreseeable future.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 334 —


--- page 344 ---
Trade and Other Receivables
The following table sets forth a breakdown of our trade and other receivables as of the dates
indicated.
As of December 31, As of
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Trade receivables from contracts with
customers, net of loss allowance
— Related parties ................ 18,347 63,209 134,666 88,748
Less: allowance for credit losses ...... (261) (6,405) (13,520) (3,349)
— Third parties .................. 5,824 36,827 370,495 612,038
Less: allowance for credit losses ...... (20) (4,438) (38,370) (24,749)
23,890 89,193 453,271 672,688
Receivables for purchase of raw materials
on behalf of customers ............. 3 6 3 1,096 5,246 —
Less: allowance for credit losses ...... ( 8 ) ( 2 ) (2,175) —
355 1,094 3,071 —
Advance to suppliers ................ 1,460 413 937 815
Other receivables
— Related parties ................ 3 8 43,210 2,312 4,753
— Third parties .................. 2,649 860 581 641
Deferred issue cost .................. — — — 1,054
Prepayments ....................... 2 1 1 0 7 2 1 4 8 5 1
V alue-added tax recoverable ........... 15,647 15,359 45,218 76,443
Total ............................ 44,060 150,236 505,604 757,245
Trade receivables from related parties primarily comprised outstanding amounts receivable from the
Remaining WXB Group. Trade receivables from third parties primarily represented the outstanding
amounts receivable from other customers for our CRDMO services. Apart from trade receivables, we also
had (i) receivables for purchase of raw materials on behalf of customers, (ii) advances to suppliers, (iii)
other receivables, representing deposits and income tax paid on behalf of our employees, (iv) deferred
issue cost, (v) prepayments, and (vi) value-added tax recoverable.
Our trade and other receivables increased significantly from RMB44.1 million as of December 31,
2020 to RMB150.2 million as of December 31, 2021, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB65.3 million
in trade receivables, net of loss allowances, generally in line with our business growth and (ii) an increase
of RMB41.4 million in other receivables primarily attributable to a one-time disposal of certain facilities
to the Remaining WXB Group.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 335 —


--- page 345 ---
Our trade and other receivables increased significantly from RMB150.2 million as of December 31,
2021 to RMB505.6 million as of December 31, 2022, primarily due to (i) an increase of RMB364.1 million
in trade receivables, net of loss allowances, generally in line with our business growth and (ii) an increase
of RMB29.9 million in value-added tax recoverable as a result of the increase in our input V A T in line with
our business growth, partially offset by a decrease of RMB41.2 million in other receivables.
Our trade and other receivables increased by 49.8% from RMB505.6 million as of December 31,
2022 to RMB757.2 million as of June 30, 2023, primarily due to an increase of RMB219.4 million in trade
receivables, primarily attributable to third parties, in line with our business growth.
The following table sets forth an aging analysis of our trade receivables, based on the invoice date
and net of loss allowance, as of the dates indicated.
As of December 31, As of
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Not past due ....................... 1,221 81,187 273,897 401,805
Overdue:
Within 90 days ..................... 18,329 5,422 141,332 165,468
91 days to one year ................. 4,340 2,584 36,301 98,196
Over one year ..................... — — 1,741 7,219
Total ............................ 23,890 89,193 453,271 672,688
Our trade receivables turnover days was 66.3 days, 100.0 days and 102.6 days in 2021, 2022 and the
six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively. The increases in our trade receivables turnover days in 2022
and the six months ended June 30, 2023 were primarily because (1) we gradually phased out settlements
through the Remaining WXB Group, which would occasionally adjust settlement pace according to our
capital and liquidity needs, and (2) we were increasingly dealing with third party customers directly, who
typically have a longer settlement cycle for trade receivables. The following table sets forth the number
of our trade receivables turnover days for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
Trade receivables turnover days (1) ....... N / A 66.3 100.0 102.6
(1) Trade receivables turnover days were calculated based on the average of opening and closing balance of trade receivables (the
opening balance in 2020 being unavailable), net of allowance for credit loss, for the relevant period, divided by the revenue
for the same period, and multiplied by the number of days in that period.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 336 —


--- page 346 ---
We allow customers a credit period ranging from 10 to 90 days. Our Directors concluded that we do
not have any material recoverability issue for our trade receivables and the allowance for expected credit
losses was adequate and reasonable for the following reasons.
 We apply the simplified approach to provide for expected credit losses prescribed by IFRS 9,
which permits the use of the lifetime ECL provision for all trade receivables. The amount of
ECL is updated at each reporting date to reflect changes in credit risk since initial recognition.
Except for the customers which are assessed individually, we determine the ECL on these items
by using a provision matrix and categorize our customers into three types: low credit risk
customers, normal credit risk customers and high credit risk customers, based on the financial
quality of debtors and their historical credit loss experience according to the past due status
adjusted, as appropriate, to reflect current conditions and estimates of future economic
conditions.
 The percentage of trade receivables not past due and due within 90 days, which is within the
typical range of our credit period granted to customers, accounted for 81.8%, 97.1%, 91.6%
and 84.3% of our total trade receivables as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30,
2023, respectively. As of September 30, 2023, approximately RMB530.4 million, or 75.7%, of
our trade receivables as of June 30, 2023 had been settled.
 We maintain strict control over our outstanding trade receivables and oversee our trade
receivables to minimize credit risk. Our senior management regularly review the overdue
balances to ensure relevant information about specific debtors is updated.
As of September 30, 2023, approximately RMB535.8 million, or 75.9%, of our trade and other
receivables as of June 30, 2023 had been settled.
Contract Assets
Our contract assets represented our accrued revenue. We recorded contract assets of RMB1.0 million,
RMB10.7 million, RMB17.3 million and RMB24.7 million as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and
June 30, 2023, respectively. We recorded allowance for credit losses in relation to our contract assets of
nil, RMB2,000, RMB0.2 million and RMB1.7 million in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended June
30, 2023, respectively.
Our contract assets increased significantly from RMB1.0 million as of December 31, 2020 to
RMB10.7 million as of December 31, 2021, and further to RMB17.3 million as of December 31, 2022 and
RMB24.7 million as of June 30, 2023, generally in line with our business growth. As of September 30,
2023, approximately RMB19.2 million, or 72.8%, of our contract assets as of June 30, 2023 had been
billed and accounted as trade receivables.
Contract Cost
Our contract cost represented recoverable costs incurred for fulfilling contracts, revenue of which
had not been recognized, and we recorded contract cost of RMB13.9 million, RMB36.7 million, RMB80.7
million and RMB63.1 million as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and June 30, 2023, respectively.
Our contract cost increased significantly from RMB13.9 million as of December 31, 2020 to RMB36.7
million as of December 31, 2021, and further to RMB80.7 million as of December 31, 2022, generally in
line with our business growth. Our contract cost decreased to RMB63.1 million as of June 30, 2023,
primarily due to the reclassification of our contract cost to cost of services after project delivery.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 337 —


--- page 347 ---
Financial Assets at Fair Value through Profit or Loss
Our financial assets measured at fair value through profit or loss (“ FVTPL ”) primarily consisted of
our investment in wealth management products. We had financial assets at FVTPL of RMB400.0 million
as of December 31, 2022, representing our wealth management products with a bank with a maturity term
of within 12 months. The fair value of our financial assets at FVTPL is measured using level 2 input. For
the wealth management products, returns are determined with reference to the performance of the
underlying instruments in the currency market. The average return rate of our wealth management
products is 3.7% and 9.4% per annum for the year ended December 31, 2022 and the six months ended
June 30, 2023, respectively. We held nil financial assets at FVTPL as of December 31, 2020 and 2021 and
June 30, 2023.
We believe we can make better use of our cash by making appropriate investments in wealth
management products of low-to-medium risk, which generate income without interfering with our
business operation or capital expenditures. Our investment decisions with respect to financial products are
made on a case-by-case basis and after due and careful consideration of a number of factors, including,
but not limited to, the market conditions, the economic developments, the anticipated investment
conditions, the investment cost, the duration of the investment and the expected benefit and potential loss
of the investment. We have established a set of internal measures which allow us to achieve reasonable
returns on our investment while mitigating our exposure to high investment risks. Our finance department
is responsible for the analysis and research of investment in wealth management products based on our
cash positions. Investment decisions on wealth management products must be approved by our chief
financial officer. Redemption of wealth management products prior to their maturity must be initiated by
finance managers and approved by our chief financial officer. These policies and measures were
formulated by our senior management, and the implementation of our investment policies and measures
was supervised by our Board. We will comply with requirements under Chapter 14 of the Listing Rules
and disclose the details of our investments and other notifiable transactions to the extent necessary and as
appropriate after the Global Offering.
Bank Balances and Cash
Our bank balances and cash remained stable at RMB28.4 million as of December 31, 2020 and
RMB26.3 million as of December 31, 2021. Our bank balances and cash increased significantly to
RMB335.0 million as of December 31, 2022, primarily due to our revenue growth in 2022 and capital
injection from our Shareholders. Our bank balances and cash increased by 67.7% to RMB561.6 million
as of June 30, 2023, primarily due to our revenue growth. During the Track Record Period, most of our
bank balances were denominated in U.S. dollars. See “— Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about
Market Risks — Currency Risk” for details.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 338 —


--- page 348 ---
Trade and Other Payables
The following table sets forth a breakdown of our trade and other payables as of the dates indicated.
As of December 31, As of
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Trade payables
— Related parties ................ 2 4 22,505 457,295 484,756
— Third parties .................. 4,520 10,285 23,537 21,928
4,544 32,790 480,832 506,684
Other payables and accrual
— Related parties ................ 1,692 41,267 109,153 131,672
— Third parties .................. 3,333 17,131 25,060 20,780
5,025 58,398 134,213 152,452
Payable for purchase of property, plant and
equipment ....................... 14,273 25,543 116,870 79,934
Consideration payable to a related party
for acquisition of Payload and Linker
Business ........................ — 280,000 — —
Consideration payable to a related party
for acquisition of XDC Wuxi ........ — 404,413 — —
Consideration payable to a related party
for acquisition of BCD business unit . . . — — 15,587 5,710
Salary and bonus payables ............ 7,824 11,253 24,589 19,137
Accrued listing expenses .............. — — — 6,785
Accrued issue cost .................. — — — 9 5 0
Other taxes payable ................. 4 1 4 6,256 1,222 1,497
Total ............................ 32,080 818,653 773,313 773,149
Trade payables to related parties comprised outstanding amounts payable to the Remaining WXB
Group and the WXA T Group in relation to, among others, the development, manufacturing and testing
services for antibody and payload-linkers, raw material procurement services and project management
services that we procured from these related parties. Trade payables to third parties primarily represented
the balances due to our suppliers for purchase of raw materials and consumables. Other payables and
accrual to related parties mainly arose from administrative services provided by our related parties and
rental expenses. Other payables and accruals to third parties represented payables arising from our
construction in progress. For considerations payables to related parties during the Track Period, see
“History, Reorganization and Corporate Structure — Major Acquisition and Transfers during the Track
Record Period.” Salary and bonus payables represented outstanding amounts payable to our employees as
of the period end. Accrued listing expenses and accrued issue cost represented outstanding amounts
payable in connection with the Global Offering. Other taxes payable primarily represented payables in
relation to V A T.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 339 —


--- page 349 ---
Our trade and other payables increased significantly from RMB32.1 million as of December 31, 2020
to RMB818.7 million as of December 31, 2021, primarily due to (i) consideration payable to a related
party for the acquisition of XDC Wuxi from WuXi Biologics Investment of RMB404.4 million, and (ii)
consideration payable to a related party for acquisition of business of RMB280.0 million in relation to our
acquisition of Payload & Linker Business.
Our trade and other payables decreased by 5.5% from RMB818.7 million as of December 31, 2021
to RMB773.3 million as of December 31, 2022, primarily due to the payment settlement of RMB404.4
million in consideration payable to a related party for the acquisition of XDC Wuxi from WuXi Biologics
Investment and of RMB280.0 million in consideration payable to a related party for acquisition of business
in relation to our acquisition of Payload & Linker Business in 2021, partially offset by (i) an increase of
RMB434.8 million in trade payables to related parties as a result of the increase in our demands for
services provided by our related parties, driven by our business growth, (ii) an increase of RMB67.9
million in other payables and accruals to related parties, as a result of the increase in administrative
services received from our related parties, and (iii) an increase of RMB91.3 million in payable for
purchase of property, plant and equipment as a result of the expansion of our Wuxi site.
Our trade and other payables remained relatively stable at RMB773.1 million as of June 30, 2023.
The following table sets forth an aging analysis of our trade payables, based on the invoice dates,
as of the dates indicated.
As of December 31, As of
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Within 90 days ..................... 3,439 30,838 432,756 500,563
91 days to one year ................. 1,105 1,930 47,853 5,732
One to two years ................... — 2 2 2 2 3 3 6 0
Over two years ..................... — — — 2 9
4,544 32,790 480,832 506,684
Our trade payables turnover days increased from 34.5 days in 2021 to 128.5 days in 2022, primarily
due to the significant increase in our trade payables as a result of the increase in antibody intermediate
manufacturing outsourced to our related parties, with whom we typically enjoy a longer credit period. Our
trade payable turnover days for the six months ended June 30, 2023 remained largely stable at 117.0 days.
The credit period on trade payables is within 90 days. The following table sets forth the number of our
trade payables turnover days for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31,
Six
months ended
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
Trade payables turnover days (1) ......... N / A 34.5 128.5 117.0
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 340 —


--- page 350 ---
(1) Trade payables turnover days were calculated based on the average of opening and closing balance of trade payables for the
relevant period (the opening balance in 2020 being unavailable), divided by the cost of services for the same period, multiplied
by the number of days in that period.
As of September 30, 2023, approximately RMB493.3 million, or 97.4%, of our trade payables as of
June 30, 2023 had been settled, and approximately RMB645.5 million, or 97.9%, of our trade and other
payables as of June 30, 2023 had been settled.
Contract Liabilities
Our contract liabilities consisted primarily of deposits paid by customers. We typically charge an
upfront deposit from customers before we commence work under the relevant contract. We reclassify
contract liabilities into revenue, which is recognized over the course of the projects based on completion
of relevant tasks. Our contract liabilities increased from RMB0.2 million as of December 31, 2020 to
RMB10.0 million as of December 31, 2021, to RMB151.5 million as of December 31, 2022, and further
to RMB232.4 million as of June 30, 2023, generally in line with the increase in the number of our projects
initiated in the respective period. As of September 30, 2023, approximately RMB161.5 million, or 69.5%,
of our contract liabilities as of June 30, 2023 had been recognized as revenue.
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
Sources of Liquidity and Working Capital
Our primary use of cash is to fund our working capital requirements and payment for the purchase
of plant and equipment and other recurring expenses. During the Track Record Period, we financed our
capital expenditures and working capital requirements primarily through a combination of cash generated
from our operating activities, loans and advances from related parties and capital contribution from
Shareholders. Going forward, we believe that our liquidity requirements will be satisfied with a
combination of cash generated from our operating activities and net proceeds from the Global Offering and
other funds raised from the capital markets from time to time. As of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022
and June 30, 2023, we had bank balances and cash of RMB28.4 million, RMB26.3 million, RMB335.0
million and RMB561.6 million, respectively. Taking into account the financial resources available to us,
our Directors are of the view that we have sufficient working capital to meet our present requirements and
for the next 12 months from the date of this prospectus.
During the Track Record Period and as of the Latest Practicable Date, we did not maintain any
banking facilities, and we have decided to take out intercompany loans from the Remaining WXB Group
and capital contribution from Shareholders to finance our operations. As of the Latest Practicable Date,
all intercompany borrowings between us and the Remaining WXB Group had been settled in full. We opted
for taking out loans from the Remaining WXB Group instead of banks or other independent third parties
primarily because borrowing from third parties typically involves more lengthy review and administrative
processes, which may cause delays to the implementation of our capital expenditure plans. Although we
did not apply for any bank loans or lines of credit during the Track Record Period, we do not foresee any
difficulties in obtaining bank loans or lines of credit at reasonable terms. Going forward, we intend to
finance our operations primarily with a combination of cash generated from our operating activities and
net proceeds from the Global Offering and other funds raised from the capital markets from time to time.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 341 —


--- page 351 ---
Cash Flows
The following table sets forth a summary of our cash flows for the periods indicated.
Y ear ended December 31,
Six
months ended
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Operating cash flows before movements in
working capital .................. 51,677 123,626 300,940 240,103
Changes in working capital ............ (21,845) (58,847) (5,991) (67,851)
Cash generated from operations ........ 29,832 64,779 294,949 172,252
Income taxes paid .................. (8,978) (5,643) (43,133) (12,621)
Net cash from operating activities ...... 20,854 59,136 251,816 159,631
Net cash (used in)/from investing
activities ....................... (52,424) (51,587) (1,279,543) 137,117
Interest paid ....................... — — (325) (149)
Net cash from/(used in) financing
activities ....................... 69,116 22,343 1,328,213 (73,729)
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash
equivalents ...................... 24,627 (2,065) 308,647 226,672
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning
of the period .................... 3,763 28,390 26,325 334,972
Cash and cash equivalents at end of the
period ......................... 28,390 26,325 334,972 561,644
Net Cash Generated from Operating Activities
Net cash generated from operating activities was RMB159.6 million in the six months ended June
30, 2023, primarily due to our profit before tax of RMB211.6 million, minus income tax paid of RMB12.6
million, as adjusted by (i) certain non-cash and non-operating items, primarily including share-based
compensation expense of RMB31.8 million, impairment losses, net of reversal, in relation to our trade and
other receivables of RMB26.0 million, and depreciation of property, plant and equipment of RMB17.7
million; and (ii) changes in working capital that positively affected the cash flow from operating activities,
primarily including an increase in contract liabilities of RMB81.0 million and a decrease in contract costs
of RMB25.1 million; (iii) partially offset by changes in working capital that negatively affected the cash
flow from operating activities, primarily including an increase in trade and other receivables of RMB224.6
million. We plan to improve our net operating cash flow position by continuing to maintain strict control
over our outstanding trade receivable, monitor customer payment status and strengthen account collection
efforts. In order to ensure steady operations and improve our net operating cash outflows position, we plan
to take the following measures to improve working capital efficiency: (i) strengthening our service
capabilities and implementing procurement decisions in accordance with market demands, (ii) engaging
in frequent communication with major customers that have large outstanding trade receivables with us for
timely account collection; and (iii) enhancing cooperation with suppliers to reduce the amount of
prepayments required.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 342 —


--- page 352 ---
Net cash generated from operating activities was RMB251.8 million in 2022, primarily due to our
profit before tax of RMB195.8 million, minus income tax paid of RMB43.1 million, as adjusted by (i)
certain non-cash and non-operating items, primarily including impairment loss, net of reversal, of
RMB43.4 million, share-based compensation expense of RMB38.6 million and depreciation of property,
plant and equipment of RMB17.5 million; and (ii) changes in working capital that positively affected the
cash flow from operating activities, primarily including an increase of trade and other payables of
RMB539.0 million and increase in contract liabilities of RMB141.6 million; (iii) partially offset by
changes in working capital that negatively affected the cash flow from operating activities, primarily
including an increase in trade and other receivables of RMB592.2 million.
Net cash generated from operating activities was RMB59.1 million in 2021, primarily due to our
profit before tax of RMB66.9 million, minus income tax paid of RMB5.6 million, as adjusted by (i) certain
non-cash and non-operating items, primarily including share-based compensation expense of RMB22.2
million and depreciation of property, plant and equipment of RMB16.3 million; and (ii) changes in
working capital that positively affected the cash flow from operating activities, primarily including an
increase of trade and other payables of RMB94.9 million; (iii) partially offset by changes in working
capital that negatively affected the cash flow from operating activities, primarily including an increase in
trade and other receivables of RMB116.7 million.
Net cash generated from operating activities was RMB20.9 million in 2020, primarily due to our
profit before tax of RMB32.4 million, minus income tax paid of RMB9.0 million, as adjusted by (i) certain
non-cash and non-operating items, primarily including depreciation of property, plant and equipment of
RMB13.0 million and share-based compensation expense of RMB6.5 million; and (ii) changes in working
capital that positively affected the cash flow from operating activities, primarily including an increase in
inventories of RMB4.1 million; (iii) partially offset by changes in working capital that negatively affected
the cash flow from operating activities, primarily including an increase in trade and other receivables of
RMB13.1 million and an increase in contract costs of RMB9.4 million.
Net Cash (Used in)/from Investing Activities
Net cash flows from investing activities was RMB137.1 million in the six months ended June 30,
2023, primarily due to withdrawal of financial assets at FVTPL of RMB1,469.6 million, partially offset
by purchase of financial assets at FVTPL of RMB1,068.8 million.
Net cash flows used in investing activities was RMB1,279.5 million in 2022, primarily due to (i)
payment for acquisition of a subsidiary pursuant to transfer of XDC Wuxi of RMB404.4 million, (ii)
placement of financial assets at FVTPL of RMB400.0 million, (iii) purchase of property, plant and
equipment of RMB201.4 million, and (iv) payment for acquisition of business of RMB280.0 million.
Net cash flows used in investing activities was RMB51.6 million in 2021, primarily due to (i)
purchase of property, plant and equipment of RMB50.8 million and (ii) payment for right-of-use assets of
RMB1.2 million.
Net cash flows used in investing activities was RMB52.4 million in 2020, primarily due to purchase
of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets of RMB52.9 million, partially offset by proceeds
on disposal of property, plant and equipment of RMB0.4 million.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 343 —


--- page 353 ---
Net Cash (Used in)/from Financing Activities
Net cash flows used in financing activities was RMB73.7 million in the six months ended June 30,
2023, primarily due to repayments of loan from related parties of RMB99.8 million, partially offset by
loan from related parties of RMB28.6 million.
Net cash flows from financing activities was RMB1,328.2 million in 2022, primarily due to proceeds
from issue of share of RMB1,285.5 million and loan from related parties of RMB137.3 million, partially
offset by repayment of loan from related parties of RMB88.5 million.
Net cash flows from financing activities was RMB22.3 million in 2021, representing loans from
related parties.
Net cash flows from financing activities was RMB69.1 million in 2020, representing capital
contribution from our equity holders.
Current Assets and Current Liabilities
The following table sets forth our current assets and liabilities as of the dates indicated.
As of December 31, As of
June 30,
2023
As of
September 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
(Unaudited)
Current assets
Inventories .................. 7,678 23,786 62,934 47,403 47,777
Trade and other receivables ...... 44,060 150,236 505,604 757,245 834,166
Contract assets ................ 1,028 10,717 17,309 24,665 29,328
Contract costs ................ 13,875 36,690 80,713 63,134 88,779
Tax recoverable ............... 2,66 3——— —
Derivative financial assets ....... 2,224 2,549 799 — —
Financial assets at FVTPL ....... — — 400,000 — —
Bank balances and cash ......... 28,390 26,325 334,972 561,644 440,644
Total current assets ............. 99,918 250,303 1,402,331 1,454,091 1,440,694
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables ........ 32,080 818,653 773,313 773,149 775,523
Loans from related parties ....... — 22,343 71,144 — —
Contract liabilities ............. 1 5 1 10,020 151,450 232,418 276,735
Income tax payable ............ — 5,225 11,506 30,457 30,173
Lease liabilities ............... — 2,249 4,413 2,828 1,718
Derivative financial liabilities ..... — — 2,147 — —
Total current liabilities .......... 32,231 858,490 1,013,973 1,038,852 1,084,149
Net current assets/(liabilities) ..... 67,687 (608,187) 388,358 415,239 356,545
Total assets less current liabilities . . 376,237 21,263 1,482,406 1,701,098 1,794,636
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 344 —


--- page 354 ---
We had net current assets of RMB67.7 million, RMB388.4 million, RMB415.2 million and
RMB356.5 million as of December 31, 2020 and 2022, June 30, 2023 and September 30, 2023,
respectively. Our net current assets position as of each of these days was primarily attributable to our trade
and other receivables and bank balances and cash, partially offset by trade and other payables and contract
liabilities. We had net current liabilities of RMB608.2 million as of December 31, 2021, primarily due to
the consideration payable to a related party for transfer of XDC Wuxi and consideration payable for
acquisition of Payload & Linker Business.
Our net current asset decreased from RMB415.2 million as of June 30, 2023 to RMB356.5 million
as of September 30, 2023, primarily due to a decrease of RMB121.0 million in bank balances and cash,
primarily due to payment made for our construction in progress at Wuxi site.
Our net current asset increased from RMB388.4 million as of December 31, 2022 to RMB415.2
million as of June 30, 2023, primarily due to an increase of RMB251.6 million in trade and other
receivables, an increase of RMB226.7 million in bank balance and cash, and a decrease of RMB71.1
million in loans from related parties.
We had net current liabilities of RMB608.2 million as of December 31, 2021, compared to net
current assets of RMB388.4 million as of December 31, 2022, primarily due to an increase of RMB400.0
million in financial assets at FVTPL, an increase of RMB333.7 million in trade receivables from third
parties, and an increase of RMB308.6 million in bank balances and cash, as a result of our business growth
and capital injection from our Shareholders, partially offset by an increase of RMB141.4 million in
contract liabilities, in line with the increase of the number of projects initiated in 2022.
We had net current assets of RMB67.7 million as of December 31, 2020 compared to net current
liabilities of RMB608.2 million as of December 31, 2021, primarily due to the consideration payable as
part of transfer of XDC Wuxi and the consideration for acquisition of Payload & Linker Business.
CAPITAL EXPENDITURES AND COMMITMENTS
Our capital expenditures during the Track Record Period primarily related to our purchase of
property, plant and equipment and intangible assets, and amounted to RMB52.9 million, RMB50.8 million,
RMB201.4 million and RMB257.8 million, respectively, in 2020, 2021, 2022 and the six months ended
June 30, 2023. We funded our capital expenditure requirements during the Track Record Period mainly
from a combination of cash generated from our operating activities, loans and advances from related
parties and capital contribution from Shareholders.
We plan to fund our planned capital expenditure by using the cash flow generated from our
operations and the net proceeds received from the Global Offering. See “Future Plans and Use of
Proceeds” for the portion of capital expenditures to be funded by the proceeds from the Global Offering.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 345 —


--- page 355 ---
Capital Commitments
Our capital commitments primarily related to purchase of property, plant and equipment and building
construction. The following sets forth a summary of our capital commitments as of the dates indicated.
As of December 31, As of
June 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
Contracted but not provided for:
Property, plant and equipment ........ 39,766 124,413 126,572 159,922
Total ............................ 39,766 124,413 126,572 159,922
ACQUISITION OF PAYLOAD & LINKER BUSINESS
We entered into agreement to acquire Payload & Linker Business in July 2021, which focused on the
research, development and manufacturing of payload-linkers. To facilitate our investors to understand the
financial performance of the Acquired Business during the Track Record Period and before the acquisition
was completed, the following table is a summary of the major components of the consolidated financial
statements of the Payload & Linker Business up to September 30, 2021.
Y ear ended
December 31, 2020
Nine months ended
September 30, 2021
(RMB in thousands)
Revenue ........................................ 58,181 131,341
Cost of sales and services .......................... (19,210) (56,021)
Gross profit ..................................... 38,971 75,320
Other gains and losses ............................. — ( 1 1 )
Impairment losses, under ECL model, net of reversal ....... ( 1 1 5 ) 7
Selling and marketing expenses ....................... ( 7 ) ( 7 )
Administrative expenses ............................ (1,306) (926)
Research and development expenses ................... (1,506) (1,322)
Profit before tax .................................. 36,037 73,061
Income tax expenses ............................... (5,615) (10,971)
Profit and total comprehensive income
for the year/period .............................. 30,422 62,090
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 346 —


--- page 356 ---
The following table is a summary of major components of the consolidated statements of financial
position of the Payload & Linker Business up to September 30, 2021.
As of
December 31, 2020
As of
September 30, 2021
(RMB in thousands)
Non-current asset
Property and equipment ......................... 6,971 6,407
Current assets
Trade receivables ............................. 12,564 —
Contract costs ................................ 17,850 —
Total current assets ............................ 30,414 —
Current liabilities
Other payables ............................... 2 2 1 —
Contract liabilities ............................. 6,576 —
Total current liabilities ......................... 6,797 —
Net current assets .............................. 23,617 6,407
Total assets less current liabilities .................. 30,588 6,407
Net assets .................................... 30,588 6,407
Capital and reserves
Retained earnings ............................. 44,456 106,546
Other reserve ................................ (13,868) (100,139)
Total equity ................................... 30,588 6,407
INDEBTEDNESS
Our indebtedness during the Track Record Period consisted of lease liabilities and loans from related
parties. Our lease liabilities and loans from related parties as of December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022,
June 30, 2023 and September 30, 2023, being the latest practicable date for the purpose of indebtedness
statement, were as follows.
As of December 31, As of
June 30,
2023
As of
September 30,
20232020 2021 2022
(RMB in thousands)
(unaudited)
Lease liabilities (current) . . . — 2,249 4,413 2,828 1,718
Lease liabilities
(non-current) .......... — — 1,627 2,477 2,363
Loans from related parties . . — 22,343 71,144 — —
Total .................. — 24,592 77,184 5,305 4,081
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 347 —


--- page 357 ---
As of September 30, 2023, RMB1.3 million of our lease liabilities was unguaranteed and secured by
the rental deposits while the remaining portion of the lease liabilities was unguaranteed and unsecured.
Save as disclosed above, we did not have any outstanding loan, capital issued or agreed to be issued, debt
securities, mortgages, charges, debentures, bank overdrafts, loans or other similar indebtedness, liabilities
under acceptances or acceptance credits, hire purchase commitments, guarantees or other contingent
liabilities as of September 30, 2023. We had not guaranteed the indebtedness of any independent third
parties as of the Latest Practicable Date. Our Directors confirm that there has not been any material change
in our indebtedness since September 30, 2023.
Our Directors confirm that as of the Latest Practicable Date, there was no material covenant on any
of our outstanding debt and there was no breach of any covenant during the Track Record Period and up
to the Latest Practicable Date. Our Directors further confirm that we did not experience any difficulty in
obtaining bank loans and other borrowings, default in payment of bank loans and other borrowings or
breach of covenants during the Track Record Period and up to the Latest Practicable Date.
CONTINGENT LIABILITIES
As of the Latest Practicable Date, we did not have any material contingent liabilities, guarantees or
any litigations or claims of material importance, pending or threatened against any member of our
Company.
LISTING EXPENSES
We expect to incur a total of approximately RMB174.8 million (HK$190.5 million) of listing
expenses in connection with the Global Offering, representing approximately 5.3% of the proceeds from
the Global Offering (assuming an Offer Price of HK$20.25, being the mid-point of the indicative Offer
Price range between HK$19.90 and HK$20.60, and assuming that the Over-allotment Option is not
exercised), including (1) sponsor fees and underwriting commissions, SFC transaction levy, Stock
Exchange trading fees and AFRC transaction levy for all Offer Shares of approximately RMB116.3 million
(HK$126.8 million), and (2) non-underwriting expenses of approximately RMB58.5 million (HK$63.7
million), which consist of (i) fees and expenses of legal advisors and accountants of approximately
RMB37.1 million (HK$40.4 million), and (ii) other fees and expenses of approximately RMB21.4 million
(HK$23.3 million). Approximately RMB7.4 million has been charged to our consolidated statements of
profit or loss in the six months ended June 30, 2023, approximately RMB54.5 million is expected to be
charged to our consolidated statements of profit and loss after the Track Record Period, and approximately
RMB112.9 million is expected to be deducted from equity. The listing expenses above are the best estimate
as of the Latest Practicable Date and for reference only. The actual amount may differ from this estimate.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 348 —


--- page 358 ---
KEY FINANCIAL RATIOS
As of/for the year ended December 31,
As of/for the six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
(unaudited)
Profitability ratios
Gross profit margin (1) .......... 8.4% 36.5% 26.4% 31.6% 23.1%
Net profit margin (2)............ 27.3% 17.7% 15.7% 29.8% 17.8%
Adjusted net profit margin (non-
IFRS measure) (3) ............ 34.0% 24.8% 19.6% 33.0% 21.8%
EBITDA margin (non-IFRS
measure) (4) ................ 47.5% 27.7% 22.7% 40.8% 23.3%
Adjusted EBITDA margin (non-
IFRS measure) (5) ............ 54.3% 34.9% 26.6% 44.0% 27.2%
Return on total assets (6) ........ 6.4% 6.2% 6.2% N/A NM (8)
Liquidity ratios
Current ratio (7) ............... 3 . 1 0 . 3 1 . 4 N / A 1 . 4
(1) Gross profit for the period divided by revenue for the respective period and multiplied by 100.0.
(2) Profit or loss for the period divided by revenue for the respective period and multiplied by 100.0.
(3) Adjusted net profit (non-IFRS measure), defined as profit for the period adjusted by adding back listing expenses and
share-based compensation expense, divided by revenue for the respective period and multiplied by 100.0.
(4) EBITDA (non-IFRS measure), defined as profit for the period adjusted by adding back depreciation and amortization, income
tax expense and finance costs and subtracting interest income from banks, divided by revenue for the respective period and
multiplied by 100.0.
(5) Adjusted EBITDA (non-IFRS measure), defined as profit for the period adjusted by adding back listing expenses and
share-based compensation expense, depreciation and amortization, income tax expense and finance costs and subtracting
interest income from banks, divided by revenue for the respective period and multiplied by 100.0.
(6) Profit for the period divided by the closing balance of total assets of for the respective period and multiplied by 100.0.
(7) Current assets divided by current liabilities as of period end.
(8) Not meaningful.
Analysis of Key Financial Ratios
Gross Profit Margin and Net Profit Margin
See “— Period to Period Comparison of Results of Operations” for a discussion of the factors
affecting our gross profit margin and net profit margin during the Track Record Period.
Adjusted Net Profit Margin (Non-IFRS Measure), EBITDA Margin (Non-IFRS Measure) and Adjusted
EBITDA Margin (Non-IFRS Measure)
Our adjusted net profit margin (non-IFRS measure) decreased from 34.0% in 2020 to 24.8% in 2021
and further to 19.6% in 2022, and from 33.0% in the six months ended June 30, 2022 to 21.8% in the six
months ended June 30, 2023. Our EBITDA margin (non-IFRS measure) decreased from 47.5% in 2020 to
27.7% in 2021 and further to 22.7% in 2022, and from 40.8% in the six months ended June 30, 2022 to
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 349 —


--- page 359 ---
23.3% in the six months ended June 30, 2023. Our adjusted EBITDA margin (non-IFRS measure)
decreased from 54.3% in 2020 to 34.9% in 2021 and further to 26.6% in 2022, and from 44.0% in the six
months ended June 30, 2022 to 27.2% in the six months ended June 30, 2023. The decrease in our adjusted
net profit margin (non-IFRS measure), EBITDA margin (non-IFRS measure) and adjusted EBITDA margin
(non-IFRS measure) during the Track Record Period was primarily due to the outsourcing of antibody
intermediate manufacturing, which lowered our margin, partially offset by the continual increase in our
operating leverage from greater economies of scale as we continue to ramp up our operations and increase
service efficiency, which had a positive impact on our margin.
Return on Total Assets
Our return on total assets ratio remained relatively stable at 6.4%, 6.2% and 6.2% in 2020, 2021 and
2022, respectively.
Current Ratio
Our current ratio decreased from 3.1 as of December 31, 2020 to 0.3 as of December 31, 2021,
primarily due to the increase in our trade and other payables, especially the consideration for transfer of
XDC Wuxi and acquisition of Payload & Linker Business. Our current ratio increased to 1.4 as of
December 31, 2022, primarily due to the increase in our financial assets at FVTPL and trade and other
receivables, as a result of our business growth and capital injection by our Shareholders. Our current ratio
remained relatively stable at 1.4 as of June 30, 2023.
RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
We enter into transactions with our related parties from time to time during our ordinary course of
business and on terms of transactions with other entities that are not related parties. During the Track
Record Period, we entered into a number of related party transactions. For details of our related party
transactions, see Note 37 to the Accountants’ Report in Appendix I to this prospectus. Our Directors are
of the view that each of the related party transactions was conducted in the ordinary and usual course of
business and on normal commercial terms between the relevant parties and does not distort our Track
Record Period results or make our historical results not reflective of future performance.
OFF-BALANCE SHEET COMMITMENTS AND ARRANGEMENTS
As of the Latest Practicable Date, we had not entered into any off-balance sheet transactions.
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISKS
We are exposed to currency, credit and liquidity risks arising from the normal course of our business.
We manage and monitor these exposures to ensure appropriate measures are implemented on a timely and
effective manner.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 350 —


--- page 360 ---
Currency Risk
Our foreign currency transactions, including sales, expose us to foreign currency risk. Certain of our
bank balances and cash, trade and other receivables and trade and other payables are denominated in
currencies other than the functional currency of the relevant group entities and expose us to such foreign
currency risk. The following table details our sensitivity to a 5% increase and decrease in RMB against
U.S. dollars, Euro, Hong Kong dollars and Swiss franc, the foreign currencies with which we may have
a material exposure. No sensitivity analysis has been disclosed for the Hong Kong dollar-denominated and
Swiss franc-denominated assets/liabilities as the impact on profit is immaterial. The sensitivity rate of 5%
represents our management’s assessment of the reasonably possible change in foreign exchange rate. The
sensitivity analysis uses outstanding foreign currency denominated monetary items as a base and adjusts
their translation at the end of the reporting period for a 5% change in foreign currency rate. A negative
number below indicates a decrease in post-tax profit where Renminbi strengthens 5% against U.S. dollars
and Euro.
Y ear ended December 31
Six months ended
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
(RMB in thousands)
(unaudited)
Impact on profit or loss
sensitivity:
U S D .................. (1,671) (2,804) (13,624) (7,739) (13,572)
E U R .................. 1 5 3 (901) (140) (451)
For more details about our currency risk, see Note 33(c) to the Accountants’ Report in Appendix I
to this prospectus.
Credit Risk
Credit risk refers to the risk that a counterparty will default on its contractual obligations resulting
in financial loss to us. At the end of each reporting period, our maximum exposure to credit risk which
cause a financial loss to us due to failure to discharge an obligation by the counterparties is arising from
the carrying amount of the respective recognized financial assets as stated in the consolidated statement
of the financial position.
In order to minimize credit risk, we have developed and maintained our credit risk grading to
categorize exposures according to their degree of risk of default. Management uses publicly available
financial information and our own historical repayment records to rate its major customers and other
debtors. Our exposure and the credit ratings of its counterparties are continuously monitored and reviewed
at the end of the reporting period to ensure the adequate impairment losses are made for irrecoverable
amount. For more details about our credit risk, see Note 33(c) to the Accountants’ Report in Appendix I
to this prospectus.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 351 —


--- page 361 ---
Liquidity Risk
In the management of the liquidity risk, we monitor and maintain a level of bank balances and cash
deemed adequate by our management to finance our operations and mitigate the effects of fluctuations in
cash flows. For more details about our liquidity risk, including a maturity profile of our financial liabilities
and derivative instruments, see Note 33(c) to the Accountants’ Report in Appendix I to this prospectus.
DIVIDEND
During the Track Record Period, we did not pay or declare any dividend. According to our dividend
policy adopted on October 30, 2023, the Articles of Association and applicable laws and regulations, the
determination to pay dividends will be made at the discretion of our Directors, subject to the Listing Rules,
and will depend upon, among others, the financial results, cash flow, business conditions and strategies,
future operations and earnings, capital requirements and expenditure plans, any restrictions on payment of
dividends, and other factors that our Directors may consider relevant. We do not have a pre-determined
dividend payout ratio. We will continue to re-evaluate our dividend policy in light of our financial
condition and the prevailing economic environment.
As advised by our Cayman Islands legal advisors, we are a holding company incorporated under the
laws of the Cayman Islands, pursuant to which, a company may declare and pay a dividend out of either
profits or share premium account. The financial position of accumulated losses does not prohibit us from
declaring and paying dividends to our Shareholders, as dividends may still be declared and paid out of our
share premium account notwithstanding our profitability, provided that this would not result in our
Company being unable to pay debts as they fall due in the ordinary course of business.
DISTRIBUTABLE RESERVES
As of June 30, 2023, our Company had distributable reserves of RMB1,698.3 million, which were
available for distribution to our equity shareholders.
DISCLOSURE REQUIRED UNDER CHAPTER 13 OF THE LISTING RULES
Our Directors have confirmed that, as of the Latest Practicable Date, there are no circumstances
which, had we been required to comply with Rules 13.13 to 13.19 in Chapter 13 of the Listing Rules,
would have given rise to a disclosure requirement under Rules 13.13 to 13.19 of the Listing Rules.
COVID-19 OUTBREAK AND EFFECTS ON OUR BUSINESS
Since the COVID-19 outbreak, a series of precautionary and control measures have been
implemented worldwide to contain the virus. We adopted several precautionary measures to maintain a
safe and hygienic working environment, such as adopting COVID-19 disinfecting techniques for our
offices, distributing masks for employees, adopting flexible working schedules and locations, and
implementing internal reporting system. We did not experience any suspension of operation during the
COVID-19 pandemic Our Directors confirmed that, up to the Latest Practicable Date, the COVID-19
outbreak had not had a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial
condition. See “Risk Factors — Risks Relating to Our Business and Industry — An occurrence of a natural
disaster, wide-spread health epidemic or other outbreaks, such as the COVID-19 pandemic, could have a
material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition” for more details of
the risks we are exposed to due to health epidemics and other outbreaks.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 352 —


--- page 362 ---
NO MATERIAL ADVERSE CHANGE
After performing sufficient due diligence work which our Directors consider appropriate and after
due and careful consideration, our Directors confirm that, as of the date of this prospectus, there has been
no material adverse change in our financial and trading positions or prospects since June 30, 2023, being
the date on which our latest audited consolidated financial statements were prepared, and that there is no
event since June 30, 2023 which would materially affect the information in the Accountants’ Report set
out in Appendix I to this prospectus.
UNAUDITED PRO FORMA ADJUSTED CONSOLIDATED NET TANGIBLE ASSETS
The following unaudited pro forma statement of adjusted consolidated net tangible assets attributable
to our owners which has been prepared in accordance with paragraph 4.29 of the Listing Rules is for
illustration only, and is set out to illustrate the effect of the proposed Global Offering (as defined in this
prospectus) on our consolidated net tangible assets attributable to our owners as of June 30, 2023, as if
the Global Offering had taken place on that date.
Our unaudited pro forma statement of adjusted consolidated net tangible assets attributable to our
owners has been prepared for illustrative purposes only and, because of its hypothetical nature, it may not
give a true picture of our consolidated net tangible assets attributable to our owners as of June 30, 2023
or as of any subsequent dates following the Global Offering.
The following unaudited pro forma statement of our adjusted consolidated net tangible assets
attributable to our owners is prepared based on our audited consolidated net tangible assets attributable to
our owners as of June 30, 2023 as derived from the Accountants’ Report set out in Appendix I to this
prospectus, and adjusted as described below.
Audited
consolidated net
tangible assets
attributable to
our owners as of
June 30, 2023
Estimated net
proceeds from
the Global
Offering
Unaudited pro
forma adjusted
consolidated net
tangible assets
attributable to
our owners as of
June 30, 2023
Unaudited pro forma adjusted
consolidated net tangible assets
attributable to our owners per Share
as of June 30, 2023
(RMB in thousands) RMB HK$
(Note 1) (Note 2) (Note 3) (Note 4)
Based on the offer
price of HK$20.60
per Offer Share .... 1,426,381 3,203,954 4,630,335 3.93 4.28
Based on the offer
price of HK$19.90
per Offer Share .... 1,426,381 3,093,346 4,519,727 3.84 4.18
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 353 —


--- page 363 ---
1. Our audited consolidated net tangible assets attributable to our owners as of June 30, 2023 is arrived at after deducting
goodwill and intangible assets attributable to our owners of RMB215,193,000 and RMB57,047,000 from our audited
consolidated net assets attributable to our owners of RMB1,698,621,000 as of June 30, 2023 as extracted from the
accountants’ report set out in Appendix I to this prospectus.
2. The estimated net proceeds from the issue of Offer Shares pursuant to the Global Offering are based on 178,446,000 Shares
at the offer price of HK$20.60 (equivalent to RMB18.90) and HK$19.90 (equivalent to RMB18.26) per Offer Share, being
the high-end and low-end of the stated offer price range, after deduction of the estimated underwriting fees and commissions
and other listing related expenses not yet recognized in profit or loss up to June 30, 2023. It does not take into account of
any Share which may be allotted and issued (i) upon the exercise of the Over-allotment Option; (ii) under Pre-IPO Share
Option Schemes; or (iii) under the general mandates for the allotment and issue of shares granted to the directors of the
Company.
For the purpose of this unaudited pro forma financial information, the estimated net proceeds from the Global Offering is
converted from Hong Kong dollars into Renminbi at an exchange rate of HK$1.00 to RMB0.91769, which was the exchange
rate prevailing on October 30, 2023 with reference to the rate published by the State Administration of Foreign Exchange of
the PRC. No representation is made that Hong Kong dollar amounts have been, could have been or may be converted to
Renminbi, or vice versa, at that rate or at all.
3. Our unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets attributable to our owners per Share as of June 30, 2023
is arrived on the basis that 1,178,446,000 shares including 1,000,000,000 existing ordinary shares in issue and 178,446,000
Offer Shares to be issued assuming that the Global Offering had been completed on June 30, 2023 and it does not take into
account of any Share which may be allotted and issued (i) upon the exercise of the Over-allotment Option; (ii) under Pre-IPO
Share Option Schemes; or (iii) under the general mandates for the allotment and issue of shares granted to the directors of
the Company.
4. For the purpose of this unaudited pro forma financial information, our unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible
assets attributable to our owners per Share as of June 30, 2023 is converted from Renminbi to Hong Kong dollars at an
exchange rate of RMB0.91769 to HK$1.00, which was the exchange rate prevailing on October 30, 2023 with reference to
the rate published by the State Administration of Foreign Exchange of the PRC. No representation is made that Renminbi
amounts have been, could have been or may be converted to Hong Kong dollars, or vice versa, at that rate or at all.
5. No adjustment has been made to our unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets attributable to our owners
as of June 30, 2023 to reflect any trading result or our other transaction entered into subsequent to June 30, 2023. In particular,
our unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets attributable to our owners per Share as of June 30, 2023
have not been adjusted to illustrate the effect of the subsequent events as disclosed in Note 44 to Appendix I in this prospectus
as such subsequent events would not have material impact on the unaudited pro forma financial information.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— 354 —


--- page 364 ---
FUTURE PLANS
For further disclosure of our business objectives and strategies, see “Business — Our Strategies.”
USE OF PROCEEDS
We estimate that the net proceeds of the Global Offering, after deducting the estimated underwriting
commissions and other fees and expenses payable by us in connection with the Global Offering, will be
approximately HK$3,423.0 million, assuming an Offer Price of HK$20.25 per Share (being the mid-point
of the indicative range of the Offer Price of HK$19.90 to HK$20.60 per Share), without the exercise of
the Over-allotment Option.
We currently intend to use the net proceeds from the Global Offering for the purposes and in the
amounts as set out below:
 Approximately 67% of the net proceeds, or HK$2,293.4 million, will be used to further expand
our service capability and capacity by (i) constructing our facilities in Singapore and (ii)
expanding our service capability and capacity in China. The rationale behind our strategic
choice to expand our service capability and capacity rests on the following factors: (i) the
worldwide footprint of an expanding customer base, with 69.1% of our revenue originating
from international clients beyond China in 2022, (ii) the escalating number of ongoing projects,
notably our ongoing post-IND bioconjugate projects, which reached 43 as of June 30, 2023,
and (iii) the tremendous industry growth potential. We anticipate substantial market potential
for our integrated CRDMO services going forward, as supported by the historical rapid growth
of the global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market from US$0.5 billion
in 2018 to US$1.5 billion in 2022 at a CAGR of 34.5% and the continual increase in our global
market share by revenue from 1.8% in 2020 to 4.6% in 2021 and 9.8% in 2022, which
evidences our competitive edge over other industry peers. We expect the projected growth of
the global ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market, combined with the
benchmark effect of our industry leadership, will further drive the market demand for our
integrated CRDMO services. As we plan to lower outsourcing and procurement of antibody
intermediates and payload-linkers from our Controlling Shareholders going forward so as to
improve our margin profile, it is pivotal for us to strengthen our service capabilities and scaling
up production capacity in advance so as to continue to provide high-quality services and
successfully accommodate the surge in demand for our services. More specifically:
(1) approximately 51% of the net proceeds, or HK$1,745.7 million, will be used to construct
our facilities at our Singapore site;
o approximately 33%, or HK$1,129.6 million, to be used for the establishment of our
facilities at the Singapore site, with a total site area of approximately 18,500 sq.m.
to meet the growing demand from customers worldwide for end-to-end bioconjugate
CRDMO services and implement a “global dual sourcing” strategy.
We selected Singapore site as the location of our new manufacturing facility
because, (i) Singapore is a vibrant hub of the global biopharmaceutical industry, and
its pro-business environment and thriving research ecosystems attract top
pharmaceutical companies to build their operation and manufacturing facilities,
FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS
— 355 —


--- page 365 ---
which may bring us significant opportunities in brand promotion and customer
acquisition; (ii) in addition to its open and liberal trade region and low corporate tax
rates, Singapore launched favorable policies in recent years, such as the Pharma
Innovation Programme Singapore, launched in 2017, which brings together
researchers in the public sector and key global players to help improve
manufacturing operations and technologies, as well as substantial government
investment to further health and biomedical sciences research, to support the
development of its pharmaceutical industry, and has attracted worldwide talents and
strengthened its manufacturing capabilities; (iii) its proximity to our current
facilities in China enables us to better coordinate the day-to-day operations of our
various sites; and (iv) constructing and maintaining operations in Singapore require
less capital investment than operations in North America and Europe would
otherwise require, and we also expect to incur less operating expenses such as labor
cost with operations in Singapore. Therefore, we believe Singapore will be a
suitable location for us to expand our operations and access the global market.
As of the Latest Practicable Date, the WXB Group had secured a land offer from the
relevant authority in Singapore for its Singapore expansion as well as our Singapore
site. Such arrangements with the Remaining WXB Group was primarily because (i)
the WXB Group contemplated and engaged in discussion for expansion in
Singapore well before the proposed Spin-off; (ii) it is easier for government
authorities in Singapore to deal with the WXB Group as a whole instead of
separately engaging with the Remaining WXB Group and us; and (iii) leveraging
the industry leadership and worldwide reputation of the WXB Group, we expect to
gain more access to favorable local government policies and expedite the
application process for regulatory approval. The Remaining WXB Group will not
participate in the operation of our Singapore site. We have entered into strategic
collaboration agreement with suppliers for the modularized construction of our
Singapore facility and commenced concept design, and we expect to commence
construction of our Singapore site by January 2024. Our Directors currently do not
expect any impediment in obtaining all requisite regulatory approvals for the
commencement of the construction and on any other material aspects, and nothing
has come to the attention of the Joint Sponsors to disagree with the above view of
the Directors. We expect to complete and commence GMP-compliant operation of
our Singapore site by 2026. See “Business — Facilities — Our Facility Expansion
Plans — Singapore Site.”
Our Singapore facility will be primarily used to serve overseas customers, in
particular, customers with demands for CRDMO services at late-stage clinical and
commercial phases, while services for projects at discovery and preclinical stages
will be provided from our headquarters in China. Once projects for overseas
customers progress into late-stage clinical and commercial phases and need to be
transferred to our Singapore site, our facilities in China will provide necessary
technical support, and will, in particular, transfer relevant technologies and data to
our Singapore site for further provision of CRDMO services. Moreover, our
facilities in China will supply the payload-linkers needed for the operations at our
Singapore site. We do not expect the transport of such payload-linkers will
significantly increase the operating costs of our facilities, as the transportation of
FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS
— 356 —


--- page 366 ---
payload-linkers is generally uncomplicated, and we plan to utilize bulk shipment to
lower potential transportation and logistics expenses. Our fully integrated service
offering platform, single-source solution, and extensive experience enable us to
conduct multiple steps in parallel and run iterations seamlessly to improve the
overall productivity and efficiency.
Both the global and China’s ADC and broader bioconjugates markets are expected
to grow rapidly in the near future. According to Frost & Sullivan, the global market
for ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services reached US$1.5 billion in
2022, at a CAGR of 34.5% from 2018 and 2022, and is expected to expand
significantly to reach US$11.0 billion by 2030, at a CAGR of 28.4% from 2022 to
2030. The ADC and broader bioconjugates outsourcing services market in China
will reach an estimated value of RMB16.5 billion by 2030, at a CAGR of 35.9%
from 2022 to 2030. See “Industry Overview.” We believe that companies possessing
competitive strengths in technology, operational and cost efficiency and can
seamlessly meet customer demands, including clinical and commercial
manufacturing demands, will set themselves apart from competitors and acquire a
larger market share. As an increasing number of our projects are expected to
progress into the clinical and commercial stage, we expect our existing
manufacturing capacity will not be sufficient to satisfy growing demands from both
domestic and overseas customers for clinical and commercial manufacturing. Our
Singapore site will focus on serving overseas customer demands for clinical-stage
and commercial manufacturing, while our domestic facilities will be used primarily
for manufacturing for customers in China. Our Singapore site and domestic facility
will be under the vertical management of the same management team to ensure
coordinated and uniform management throughout the organization; and
o approximately 18%, or HK$616.1 million, to be used to purchase manufacturing
and R&D equipment and systems and recruit manufacturing, R&D and management
personnel for the operation of our Singapore site;
We plan to deploy four production lines in our Singapore site, including a
dual-function production line for antibody intermediates for bioconjugates and drug
substance (“ XBCM3 ”) which will focus on commercial manufacturing, a
production line for drug substance (“ XBCM4 ”) which will focus on clinical-stage
manufacturing, as well as two drug product manufacturing lines (“ DP3” and
“DP4”), each focusing on commercial and clinical-stage manufacturing,
respectively. We plan to recruit a total of 592 employees and management personnel
for our Singapore site, including 163 personnel for the R&D and production work
for XBCM3, 127 personnel for the R&D and production work for XBCM4, 147
personnel for the R&D and production work for DP3, 132 personnel for the R&D
and production work for DP4, and 23 management personnel. We plan to recruit
approximately 100, 60 and 100 personnel in 2024, 2025 and 2026 for our Singapore
site, respectively, and we will formulate recruitment plan for 2027 and onward
based on the ramp-up status of the production capacity for our Singapore site.
According to Frost & Sullivan, Singapore has sufficient talent supply for our
recruitment plan set out above. We may also relocate certain employees in China to
Singapore to implement our expansion plan. Singapore imposes certain restrictions
FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS
— 357 —


--- page 367 ---
on a local company’s foreign employee quota, and we will ensure compliance with
such requirements when formulating and implementing our recruitment plan. We
plan to initiate staff recruiting for our Singapore site in 2024, who will provide
facility construction support and perform the validation work for our Singapore site
prior to the commencement of operations, as typically required for construction of
drug manufacturing facilities;
We expect to incur approximately US$300 million in implementing our expansion
plan for the Singapore site, approximately 74% of which will be funded by the net
proceeds of the Global Offering, assuming an Offer Price of HK$20.25 per Share,
being the mid-point of our indicative Offer Price range; and
(2) approximately 16% of the net proceeds, or HK$547.7 million, will be used to expand our
production capacity in China;
o approximately 9%, or HK$308.1 million, to be used to purchase manufacturing and
R&D equipment and systems, such as bioreactors, steam sterilizers, capillary
electrophoresis instrument and enzyme labeling apparatus, among others;
o approximately 7%, or HK$239.6 million, to be used for the establishment,
maintenance and improvement of our manufacturing plants at our Wuxi site,
including building up a kilogram-scale payload-linker production line. We
have recently commenced GMP-compliant operations of a newly established
dual-function production line for antibody intermediates and drug substance, which
has a designed capacity of 200 liters to 2,000 liters per batch for monoclonal
antibody intermediate productions and up to 2,000 liters per batch for bioconjugate
drug substance production. As our business continues to grow, we will plan and
build additional manufacturing facilities at our Wuxi site. See “Business —
Facilities — Our Facility Expansion Plans — Wuxi Site”;
We expect to incur approximately US$100 million in completing our expansion plan
for our production capacity in China, approximately 70% of which will be funded
by the net proceeds of the Global Offering, assuming an Offer Price of HK$20.25
per Share, being the mid-point of our indicative Offer Price range.
 Approximately 23% of the net proceeds, or HK$787.3 million, will be used to selectively
pursue strategic alliances, investment and acquisition opportunities primarily to enrich our
technology platform and service offerings and capabilities.
We plan, in part, to invest in or acquire unique technologies that we perceive to be not only
innovative within the bioconjugate industry, but also complementary to our existing
capabilities. When evaluating target companies, we will take into consideration (i) their
potential to generate effective synergy with our existing platform, (ii) their technology and
expertise, (iii) their operating history, (iv) their ability to bring in new business opportunities,
and (v) their financial performance. We plan to seek acquisition and investment opportunities
with companies specializing in various fields of conjugation technologies, such as enzyme
conjugation, self immolation linkers and linker modification technologies. We expect to
establish a conjugation drug development platform through such acquisition and investment, as
FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS
— 358 —


--- page 368 ---
well as external technology collaboration, technology license-in and internal development, to
bring customers a greater selection of drug components and promote their project progression.
We plan to acquire or invest in target companies with a valuation ranging from US$100 million
to US$300 million. Based on our industry intelligence and concurred by Frost & Sullivan, our
Directors believe that we will be able to identify suitable acquisition targets that satisfy our
selection criteria. As advised by Frost & Sullivan, there are a sufficient number of suitable
acquisition targets in the relevant markets. We will leverage our industry resources and network
and continue to monitor the market conditions and engage financial and legal advisors to
explore and evaluate, from time to time, potential acquisition opportunities when they arise. As
of the Latest Practicable Date, we had not identified any investment or acquisition target or
enter into any definitive investment or acquisition agreement.
We expect to incur approximately US$170 million in completing our expansion plan for the
pursuit of strategic alliances, investment and acquisition opportunities, approximately 59% of
which will be funded by the net proceeds of the Global Offering, assuming an Offer Price of
HK$20.25 per Share, being the mid-point of our indicative Offer Price range.
 Approximately 10% of the net proceeds, or HK$342.3 million, for working capital and other
general corporate purposes.
The above allocation of the proceeds will be adjusted on a pro rata basis in the event that the Offer
Price is fixed below or above the mid-point of the indicative price range. If the Offer Price is set at
HK$20.60 per Share, which is the high end of our indicative Offer Price range, the net proceeds from the
Global Offering will increase to approximately HK$3,483.3 million. If the Offer Price is set at HK$19.90
per Share, which is the low end of our indicative Offer Price range, the net proceeds from the Global
Offering will decrease to approximately HK$3,362.8 million. Any additional proceeds received from the
exercise of the Over-allotment Option will also be allocated to the above purposes on a pro rata basis. In
the event that the Over-allotment Option is exercised in full, we will receive net proceeds of HK$3,797.4
million (after deducting the estimated underwriting commissions and other fees and expenses payable by
us in connection with the Global Offering and assuming an Offer Price of HK$20.25 per Share, being the
mid-point of our indicative Offer Price range).
To the extent that the net proceeds are not immediately applied to the above purposes, we intend to
deposit the net proceeds into short-term demand deposits with one or more licensed banks or financial
institutions so long as it is deemed to be in the best interests of our Company.
FUTURE PLANS AND USE OF PROCEEDS
— 359 —


--- page 369 ---
HONG KONG UNDERWRITERS
Morgan Stanley Asia Limited
Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C.
J.P . Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited
China International Capital Corporation Hong Kong Securities Limited
Citigroup Global Markets Asia Limited
Huatai Financial Holdings (Hong Kong) Limited
UNDERWRITING ARRANGEMENTS AND EXPENSES
Hong Kong Public Offering
Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement
The Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement was entered into on November 6, 2023. As described in the
Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement, we are offering the Hong Kong Public Offer Shares for subscription
on the terms and subject to the terms and conditions of this prospectus and the Application Forms at the
Offer Price. Subject to the Listing Committee granting the listing of, and permission to deal in, our Shares
in issue and to be issued as mentioned herein (including any Shares which may be issued pursuant to the
exercise of the Over-allotment Option and options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes), and
to certain other conditions set out in the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement, the Hong Kong
Underwriters have agreed to subscribe or procure subscribers for the Hong Kong Public Offer Shares
which are being offered but are not taken up under the Hong Kong Public Offering on the terms and subject
to the conditions of this prospectus, the Application Forms and the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement.
The Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement is conditional upon and subject to the International
Underwriting Agreement having been signed and becoming and remaining unconditional and not having
been terminated in accordance with its terms.
Grounds for Termination
The Joint Sponsors and the Overall Coordinators (for themselves and on behalf of the Hong Kong
Underwriters) shall be entitled by notice to the Company to terminate the Hong Kong Underwriting
Agreement with immediate effect if prior to 8:00 a.m. on the Listing Date:
(a) there shall develop, occur, exist or come into effect:
(i) any event, or series of events, in the nature of force majeure (including, without
limitation, any acts of government, declaration of a regional, national or international
emergency or war, calamity, crisis, epidemic, pandemic, large scale outbreaks of diseases
(including, without limitation, SARS, swine or avian flu, H5N1, H1N1, H7N9,
contagious coronavirus (COVID-19) and such related/mutated forms), accident or
interruption or delay in transportation, economic sanctions, strikes, labour disputes,
lock-outs, fire, explosion, flooding, tsunami, earthquake, volcanic eruption, civil
commotion, riots, rebellion, public disorder, acts of war, outbreak or escalation of
hostilities (whether or not war is declared), acts of God or acts of terrorism (whether or
UNDERWRITING
— 360 —


--- page 370 ---
not responsibility has been claimed)) in or affecting Hong Kong, Singapore, Japan, the
PRC, the Cayman Islands, the United States, the United Kingdom or the European Union
(or any member thereof) (collectively, the “ Relevant Jurisdictions ”);
(ii) any change or development involving a prospective change, or any event or
circumstances or series of events likely to result in any change or development involving
a prospective change, in any local, national, regional or international financial, economic,
political, military, industrial, legal, fiscal, regulatory, currency, credit or market matters
or conditions, equity securities or exchange control or any monetary or trading settlement
system or other financial markets (including, without limitation, conditions in the stock
and bond markets, money and foreign exchange markets, the interbank markets and credit
markets), in or affecting any of the Relevant Jurisdictions;
(iii) any moratorium, suspension or restriction (including, without limitation, any imposition
of or requirement for any minimum or maximum price limit or price range) in or on
trading in securities generally on the Stock Exchange, the New Y ork Stock Exchange, the
NASDAQ Global Market, the London Stock Exchange, the Shanghai Stock Exchange, the
Shenzhen Stock Exchange, the Singapore Stock Exchange or the Tokyo Stock Exchange;
(iv) any general moratorium on commercial banking activities in Hong Kong (imposed by the
Financial Secretary or the Hong Kong Monetary Authority or other competent authority),
New Y ork (imposed at the U.S. Federal or New Y ork State level or by any other
competent authority), London, the PRC, the European Union (or any member thereof),
Japan, Singapore or any of the other Relevant Jurisdictions (declared by the relevant
authorities) or any disruption in commercial banking or foreign exchange trading or
securities settlement or clearance services, procedures or matters in or affecting any of
the Relevant Jurisdictions;
(v) any new law or regulation or any change or any development involving a prospective
change or any event or circumstance likely to result in a change or a development
involving a prospective change in existing laws or regulations or any change or
development involving a prospective change in the interpretation or application thereof
by any court or any governmental authority in or affecting any of the Relevant
Jurisdictions;
(vi) the imposition of economic sanctions, in whatever form, directly or indirectly, by, or for,
any of the Relevant Jurisdictions in respect of any jurisdiction relevant to the business
operations of any member of the Group;
(vii) the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of the Company is vacating his office;
(viii) any change or development involving a prospective change or amendment in or affecting
taxation or foreign exchange control, currency exchange rates or foreign investment
regulations (including, without limitation, a material devaluation of the Hong Kong dollar
or RMB against any foreign currencies, a change in the system under which the value of
the Hong Kong dollar is linked to that of the United States dollar or RMB is linked to any
foreign currency or currencies), or the implementation of any exchange control, in any of
the Relevant Jurisdictions or adversely affecting an investment in the Offer Shares;
UNDERWRITING
— 361 —


--- page 371 ---
(ix) the issue or requirement to issue by the Company of a supplement or amendment to this
prospectus, the Application Forms or other documents in connection with the offer and
sale of the Offer Shares pursuant to the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous
Provisions) Ordinance or the Listing Rules or upon any requirement or request of the
Stock Exchange and/or the SFC;
(x) a valid demand by any creditor for repayment or payment of any material indebtedness
of any member of the Group or in respect of which any member of the Group is liable
prior to its stated maturity;
(xi) there is any order or petition for the winding-up of any member of the Group or any
composition or arrangement made by any member of the Group with its creditors or a
scheme of arrangement entered into by any member of the Group or any resolution for the
winding-up of any member of the Group or the appointment of a provisional liquidator,
receiver or manager over all or part of the material assets or undertaking of any member
of the Group or anything analogous thereto occurring in respect of any member of the
Group;
(xii) any change or development involving a prospective change in, or a materialization of, any
of the risks set out in the section headed “Risk Factors” of this prospectus;
(xiii) any litigation, dispute, legal action or claim being threatened or instigated against any
member of the Group;
(xiv) any contravention by the Company or any member of the Group of any applicable laws
and regulations including the Listing Rules; or
(xv) any non-compliance of this prospectus, the CSRC Filings (as defined in the Hong Kong
Underwriting Agreement) (or any other documents used in connection with the
contemplated subscription and sale of the Offer Shares) or any aspect of the Global
Offering with the Listing Rules or any other applicable laws (including, without
limitation, the Companies Ordinance, the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous
Provisions) Ordinance and the CSRC Rules (as defined in the Hong Kong Underwriting
Agreement)) and regulations,
which, individually or in the aggregate, in the sole and absolute opinion of the Joint Sponsors
and the Overall Coordinators (for themselves and on behalf of the Hong Kong Underwriters):
(1) has or will or may have a material adverse effect, or any development involving a
prospective material adverse effect, on or affecting the assets, liabilities, business,
general affairs, management, prospects, shareholders’ equity, profits, losses, results of
operations, position or condition, financial or otherwise, or performance of the Company
and the other members of the Group, taken as a whole;
(2) has or will have or may have a material adverse effect on the success of the Global
Offering or the level of applications under the Hong Kong Public Offering or the level of
interest under the International Offering;
(3) makes or will make it inadvisable, inexpedient, impracticable or incapable for the Hong
Kong Public Offering and/or the International Offering to proceed or to market the Global
Offering; or
UNDERWRITING
— 362 —


--- page 372 ---
(4) has or will or may have the effect of making any material part of the Hong Kong
Underwriting Agreement (including underwriting) incapable of performance in
accordance with its terms or preventing the processing of applications and/or payments
pursuant to the Global Offering or pursuant to the underwriting thereof; or
(b) there has come to the notice of the Joint Sponsors and the Overall Coordinators (for themselves
and on behalf of the Hong Kong Underwriters) that:
(i) any statement contained in the Offering Documents, the Operative Documents, the
Preliminary Offering Circular (as defined in the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement),
and/or any notices, announcements, advertisements, communications or other documents
(including any announcement, circular, document or other communication pursuant to the
Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement) issued or used by or on behalf of the Company in
connection with the Hong Kong Public Offering, the Preferential Offering and the
International Offering (excluding the Preferential Offering) (including any supplement or
amendment thereto (the “ Offer-Related Documents ”) but excluding information relating
to the Underwriters) was, when it was issued, or has become, untrue, incorrect,
inaccurate, incomplete in any material respects or misleading or deceptive, or that any
estimate, forecast, expression of opinion, intention or expectation contained in any of
such documents is not fair and honest and based on reasonable grounds or reasonable
assumptions;
(ii) any matter has arisen or has been discovered which would, had it arisen or been
discovered immediately before the date of the Hong Kong Prospectus, constitute a
material omission from, or misstatement in, any of the Offer-Related Documents;
(iii) there is a material breach of any of the obligations imposed upon the Company or WuXi
Biologics under the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement, as applicable;
(iv) there is an event, act or omission which gives or is likely to give rise to any material
liability of the Company or WuXi Biologics pursuant to the indemnities given by any of
them under the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement or the International Underwriting
Agreement, as applicable;
(v) there is any material adverse change or development or likely to be any prospective
material adverse change or development in the assets, liabilities, general affairs, business,
management, prospects, shareholders’ equity, profits, losses, earnings, solvency, liquidity
position, funding, results of operations, performance, position or condition, financial or
otherwise, of the Group as a whole;
UNDERWRITING
— 363 —


--- page 373 ---
(vi) there is a breach of, or any event or circumstance rendering untrue, incorrect, incomplete
or misleading in any respect, any of the warranties given by the Company and WuXi
Biologics in the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement or the International Underwriting
Agreement, as applicable;
(vii) a Director as named in this prospectus has been charged with an indictable offence or
prohibited by operation of Law or otherwise disqualified from taking part in the
management or taking directorship of a company;
(viii) the approval of the Listing Committee of the listing of, and permission to deal in, the
Shares in issue and the Shares to be issued pursuant to the Global Offering (including the
additional Shares which may be issued upon the exercise of the Over-allotment Option)
is refused or not granted, other than subject to customary conditions, on or before the date
of the Listing, or if granted, the approval is subsequently withdrawn, cancelled, qualified
(other than by customary conditions), revoked or withheld;
(ix) any person has withdrawn its consent to the issue of this prospectus with the inclusion of
its reports, letters and/or legal opinions (as the case may be) and references to its name
included in the form and context in which it respectively appears;
(x) the Company withdraws this prospectus (and/or any other documents issued or used in
connection with the Global Offering) or the Global Offering;
(xi) that a material portion of the orders placed or confirmed in the bookbuilding process, or
of the investment commitments made by any cornerstone investors under agreements
signed with such cornerstone investors, have been withdrawn, terminated or cancelled, or
any Cornerstone Investment Agreement is terminated; and
(xii) there is a prohibition on the Company for whatever reason from offering, allotting,
issuing or selling any of the Offer Shares (including any additional Shares to be issued
pursuant to the Over-allotment Option) pursuant to the terms of the Global Offering.
Lock-up
Undertakings to the Stock Exchange pursuant to the Listing Rules
Undertakings by our Company
Pursuant to Rule 10.08 of the Listing Rules, our Company will not, any time within six months from
the Listing Date, issue any Shares or other securities convertible into equity securities (whether or not of
a class already listed) of our Company or enter into any agreement or arrangement to issue such shares
or securities (whether or not such issue of shares or securities will be completed within six months from
the Listing Date), except pursuant to the Global Offering or for the circumstances prescribed by Rule
10.08 of the Listing Rules.
UNDERWRITING
— 364 —


--- page 374 ---
Undertakings by our Controlling Shareholders
Pursuant to Rule 10.07 of the Listing Rules, each of our Controlling Shareholders has undertaken to
us and to the Stock Exchange, that he or it will not, without the prior written consent of the Stock
Exchange or unless otherwise in compliance with applicable requirements of the Listing Rules:
(a) in the period commencing on the Latest Practicable Date and ending on the date which is six
months from the Listing Date (the “ First Six-month Period ”), dispose of, or enter into any
agreement to dispose of or otherwise create any options, rights, interests or encumbrances in
respect of, any of our Shares in respect of which he or it is shown by this prospectus to be the
beneficial owner (as defined in Rule 10.07(2) of the Listing Rules) (“ Controlling
Shareholders’ Shares ”) (except pursuant to the Global Offering, the Over-allotment Option,
the Stock Borrowing Agreement and unless in compliance with the requirements of the Listing
Rules); or
(b) during the period of six months commencing on the date on which the First Six-month Period
expires (the “ Second Six-month Period ”), dispose of, or enter into any agreement to dispose
of or otherwise create any options, rights, interests or encumbrances in respect of, any of the
Controlling Shareholders’ Shares to such an extent that immediately following such disposal,
or upon the exercise or enforcement of such options, rights, interests or encumbrances, he or
it would cease to be our Controlling Shareholders (as defined in the Listing Rules).
Further, pursuant to Note (3) to Rule 10.07(2) of the Listing Rules, each of our Controlling
Shareholders has undertaken to us and to the Stock Exchange that, during the First Six-month Period and
the Second Six-month Period, it will:
(a) if it pledges or charges any of our securities beneficially owned by him or it in favor of an
authorized institution (as defined in the Banking Ordinance, Chapter 155 of the Laws of Hong
Kong) for a bona fide commercial loan, immediately inform us of such pledge or charge
together with the number of securities so pledged or charged; and
(b) if it receives indications, either verbal or written, from the pledgee or chargee that any of his
or its pledged or charged securities will be disposed of, immediately inform us of such
indications.
We will also inform the Stock Exchange as soon as we have been informed of the above matters, if
any, by any of our Controlling Shareholders and disclose such matters in accordance with the publication
requirements under Rule 2.07C of the Listing Rules as soon as possible after being so informed.
Undertakings Pursuant to the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement
Undertakings by our Company
Except for the issue, offer or sale of the Offer Shares by the Company pursuant to the Global
Offering (including pursuant to the Over-allotment Option), during the First Six-month Period, the
Company has undertaken to each of the Joint Sponsors, the Joint Global Coordinators, the Overall
Coordinators, the Joint Bookrunners, the Joint Lead Managers, the Hong Kong Underwriters and the
UNDERWRITING
— 365 —


--- page 375 ---
Capital Market Intermediaries not to and to procure each other member of the Group not to, without the
prior written consent of the Joint Sponsors and the Overall Coordinators (for themselves and on behalf of
the Hong Kong Underwriters) and unless in compliance with the requirements of the Listing Rules:
(i) offer, allot, issue, sell, accept subscription for, contract to allot, issue or sell, contract or agree
to allot, issue or sell, assign, grant or sell any option, warrant, right or contract to purchase,
purchase any option or contract to sell, grant or agree to grant any option, right or warrant to
purchase or subscribe for, or otherwise transfer or dispose of or create an claim, mortgage,
charge, pledge, lien or other security interest or any option, restriction, right of first refusal,
right of pre-emption or other third party claim, right, interest or preference or any other
encumbrance of any kind (the “ Encumbrance ”) over, or agree to transfer or dispose of or
create an Encumbrance over, either directly or indirectly, conditionally or unconditionally, or
repurchase, any legal or beneficial interest in any Shares or other securities of the Company,
or any shares or other securities of such other member of the Group, as applicable, or any
interests in any of the foregoing (including, but not limited to, any securities that are
convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for, or that represent the right to receive, or any
warrants or other rights to purchase, any Shares), or deposit any Shares or other securities of
the Company or any shares, as applicable, with a depositary in connection with the issue of
depositary receipts; or
(ii) enter into any swap or other arrangement that transfers to another, in whole or in part, any of
the economic consequences of subscription or ownership (legal or beneficial) of any Shares or
other securities of the Company or any shares, as applicable, or any interest therein (including,
without limitation, any securities of which are convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable
for, or represent the right to receive, or any warrants or other rights to purchase any Shares); or
(iii) enter into any transaction with the same economic effect as any transaction specified in
paragraphs (i) or (ii) above; or
(iv) offer to or contract to or agree to announce, or publicly disclose that the Company will or may
enter into any transaction described in paragraphs (i), (ii) or (iii) above,
in each case, whether any of the transactions specified in paragraphs (i), (ii) or (iii) above is to be
settled by delivery of Shares or other securities of the Company or shares, as applicable, in cash or
otherwise (whether or not the issue of such Shares or other securities will be completed within the
First Six-month Period).
In the event that, during the Second Six-Month Period, the Company enters into any of the
transactions specified in paragraphs (i), (ii) or (iii) above or offers to or agrees to or contracts to or
announces, or publicly discloses, any intention to, enter into any such transactions, the Company shall take
all reasonable steps to ensure that it will not create a disorderly or false market in the securities of the
Company.
UNDERWRITING
— 366 —


--- page 376 ---
Undertakings by WuXi Biologics
WuXi Biologics has undertaken to us, the Overall Coordinators, the Joint Global Coordinators, the
Joint Sponsors, the Joint Bookrunners, the Joint Lead Managers, the Hong Kong Underwriters and the
Capital Market Intermediaries that, except pursuant to (A) the Global Offering, (B) the Over-allotment
Option or (C) the Stock Borrowing Agreement, it will not, without the prior written consent of the Joint
Sponsors and the Overall Coordinators (for themselves and on behalf of the Hong Kong Underwriters) and
unless in compliance with the requirements of the Listing Rules, at any time during the period
commencing on the date of the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement and ending on, and including, the
date that is twenty-four months after the Listing Date (the “ Twenty Four-Month Period ”):
(i) offer, pledge, charge, sell, contract or agree to sell, mortgage, charge, hypothecate, lend, grant
or sell any option, warrant, contract or right to purchase, grant, or purchase any option, warrant,
contract or right to sell, grant or agree to grant any option, right or warrant to purchase or
subscribe for, lend or otherwise transfer or dispose of or create an encumbrance over, either
directly or indirectly, conditionally or unconditionally, any Shares or other securities of the
Company or any interest in any of the foregoing (including, but not limited to, any securities
that are convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for, or that represent the right to
receive, or any warrants or other rights to purchase, any Shares or other securities of the
Company) beneficially owned by it as of the Listing Date (the “ Locked-up Securities ”);
(ii) enter into any swap or other arrangement that transfers to another, in whole or in part, any of
the economic consequences of ownership of, any Locked-up Securities;
(iii) enter into any transaction with the same economic effect as any transaction described in
paragraphs (i) or (ii) above; or
(iv) offer to or contract to or agree to or publicly disclose that it will or may enter into any
transaction described in paragraphs (i), (ii) or (iii) above,
whether any such transaction described in paragraphs (i), (ii) or (iii) above is to be settled by delivery
of such Shares or other securities of the Company, in cash or otherwise (whether or not the settlement
or delivery of such Shares or other securities will be completed within the Twenty Four-Month
Period).
Indemnity
We and WuXi Biologics have agreed to indemnify, amongst others, the Joint Sponsors, the Overall
Coordinators, the Joint Global Coordinators, the Joint Bookrunners, the Joint Lead Managers, the Hong
Kong Underwriters and the Capital Market Intermediaries for certain losses which they may suffer,
including, amongst others, losses arising from the performance of their obligations under the Hong Kong
Underwriting Agreement and any breach or alleged breach by our Company of the Hong Kong
Underwriting Agreement, as the case may be.
UNDERWRITING
— 367 —


--- page 377 ---
International Offering
International Underwriting Agreement
In connection with the International Offering, it is expected that we will enter into the International
Underwriting Agreement with WuXi Biologics, the Overall Coordinators and the International
Underwriters. Under the International Underwriting Agreement, the International Underwriters would,
subject to certain conditions set forth therein, agree, severally and not jointly, by themselves or through
their respective affiliates to procure purchasers for, or failing which, to purchase itself or through their
respective affiliates to procure purchasers for, or failing which to purchase the International Offer Shares
being offered pursuant to the International Offering.
It is expected that our Company will grant to the International Underwriters the Over-allotment
Option, exercisable by the Overall Coordinators (for themselves and on behalf of the International
Underwriters) at any time from the date of the International Underwriting Agreement until Sunday,
December 10, 2023, being the 30th day from the last day for lodging applications under the Hong Kong
Public Offering, to require our Company to issue and allot up to an aggregate of 19,158,500 additional
Shares, representing approximately 10.74% of the initial Offer Shares, at the Offer Price, to cover
over-allocations in the International Offering, if any.
Potential investors should note that if the International Underwriting Agreement is not entered into,
or is terminated, the Global Offering will not proceed.
Commission and Expenses
The Underwriters will receive an underwriting commission of 2.7% of the aggregate Offer Price of
all the Offer Shares (including any Offer Shares to be issued pursuant to the exercise of the Over-allotment
Option) (the “ Fixed Fees ”), out of which they will pay any sub-underwriting commissions and other fees.
The Company may, at its sole discretion, pay to any one or more of the Underwriters a discretionary
incentive fee of an aggregate of up to 0.8% of the Offer Price for each Offer Share (the “ Discretionary
Fees ”). Assuming that the Discretionary Fees are paid in full, the ratio of the Fixed Fees and Discretionary
Fees payable is expected to be approximately 77:23 assuming the Discretionary Fees will be paid in full.
Assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised at all and based on an Offer Price of HK$20.25,
being the mid-point of the Offer Price range of HK$19.90 to HK$20.60 per Share, the fees and
commissions (assuming full payment of the Discretionary Fees) in connection with the Hong Kong Public
Offering and the International Offering (save for the underwriting commissions), together with listing fees,
the Stock Exchange trading fee, the SFC transaction levy, AFRC transaction levy, legal and other
professional fees, printing and other expenses relating to the Global Offering, are estimated to amount to
approximately RMB174.8 million (HK$190.5 million) in aggregate. Such commissions, the Stock
Exchange trading fee and the SFC transaction levy and the fees and expenses of professional advisors and
service providers engaged in relation to the Global Offering are payable and borne by us.
UNDERWRITING
— 368 —


--- page 378 ---
Underwriters’ Interests in our Company
Save for their respective obligations under the Underwriting Agreements and save as otherwise
disclosed in this prospectus, none of the Underwriters is interested legally or beneficially in any shares of
any members of our Group or has any right or option (whether legally enforceable or not) to subscribe for
or purchase or to nominate persons to subscribe for or purchase securities in any members of our Group
in the Global Offering.
Following the completion of the Global Offering, the Underwriters and their affiliated companies
may hold a certain portion of Share as a result of fulfilling their obligations under the Underwriting
Agreements.
JOINT SPONSORS’ INDEPENDENCE
The Joint Sponsors satisfy the independence criteria applicable to sponsors set out in Rule 3A.07 of
the Listing Rules.
ACTIVITIES BY SYNDICATE MEMBERS
We describe below a variety of activities that underwriters of the Hong Kong Public Offering and
the International Offering, together referred to as “Syndicate Members”, may each individually undertake,
and which do not form part of the underwriting or the stabilizing process. When engaging in any of these
activities, it should be noted that the Syndicate Members are subject to restrictions, including the
following:
(i) under the agreement among the Syndicate Members, all of them (except for the Stabilizing
Manager, its affiliates or any person acting for it) must not, in connection with the distribution
of the Offer Shares, effect any transactions (including issuing or entering into any option or
other derivative transactions relating to the Offer Shares), whether in the open market or
otherwise, with a view to stabilizing or maintaining the market price of any of the Offer Shares
at levels other than those which might otherwise prevail in the open market; and
(ii) all of them must comply with all applicable laws, including the market misconduct provisions
of the SFO, including the provisions prohibiting insider dealing, false trading, price rigging and
stock market manipulation.
The Syndicate Members and their affiliates are diversified financial institutions with relationships in
countries around the world. These entities engage in a wide range of commercial and investment banking,
brokerage, funds management, trading, hedging, investing and other activities for their own account and
for the account of others. In relation to the Shares, those activities could include acting as agent for buyers
and sellers of the Shares, entering into transactions with those buyers and sellers in a principal capacity,
proprietary trading in the Shares and entering into over the counter or listed derivative transactions or
listed and unlisted securities transactions (including issuing securities such as derivative warrants listed
on a stock exchange) which have the Shares as their or part of their underlying assets. Those activities may
require hedging activity by those entities involving, directly or indirectly, buying and selling the Shares.
UNDERWRITING
— 369 —


--- page 379 ---
All such activities could occur in Hong Kong and elsewhere in the world and may result in the Syndicate
Members and their affiliates holding long and/or short positions in the Shares, in baskets of securities or
indices including the Shares, in units of funds that may purchase the Shares, or in derivatives related to
any of the foregoing.
In relation to issues by Syndicate Members or their affiliates of any listed securities having the
Shares as their or part of their underlying assets, whether on the Stock Exchange or on any other stock
exchange, the rules of the relevant exchange may require the issuer of those securities (or one of its
affiliates or agents) to act as a market maker or liquidity provider in the security, and this will also result
in hedging activity in the Shares in most cases.
All of these activities may occur both during and after the end of the stabilizing period described
under the section headed “Structure of the Global Offering — Stabilization” in this prospectus. These
activities may affect the market price or value of the Shares, the liquidity or trading volume in the Shares
and the volatility of their share price, and the extent to which this occurs from day to day cannot be
estimated.
Certain of the Syndicate Members or their respective affiliates have provided from time to time and
expect to provide in the future, investment banking and other services to our Company and its affiliates
for which such Syndicate Members or their respective affiliates have received or will receive customary
fees and commission.
UNDERWRITING
— 370 —


--- page 380 ---
THE GLOBAL OFFERING
This prospectus is published in connection with the Hong Kong Public Offering as part of the Global
Offering.
178,446,000 Offer Shares will be made available under the Global Offering comprising:
(a) the Hong Kong Public Offering of 17,845,000 Shares (subject to reallocation) in Hong Kong
as described in “— The Hong Kong Public Offering” below; and
(b) the International Offering of 160,601,000 Shares (subject to reallocation and the Over-
allotment Option) (i) in the United States only to QIBs in reliance on Rule 144A or another
available exemption from, or in transactions not subject to, the registration requirements of the
U.S. Securities Act and (ii) outside the United States in reliance on Regulation S of the U.S.
Securities Act as described in “— The International Offering” below.
Of the 160,601,000 Offer Shares initially being offered under the International Offering, 8,922,000
Offer Shares will be made available for subscription by Qualifying WXB Shareholders under the
Preferential Offering as Assured Entitlement as described in the paragraph headed “The Preferential
Offering” in this section below.
Investors may either:
(a) apply for the Offer Shares under the Hong Kong Public Offering; or
(b) indicate an interest, if qualified to do so, for the Offer Shares under the International Offering,
but may not do both (except that Qualifying WXB Shareholders who are eligible to apply for the Reserved
Shares in the Preferential Offering may either (i) apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares under the Hong Kong
Public Offering, if eligible, or (ii) indicate an interest for International Offer Shares under the International
Offering, if qualified to do so).
Qualifying WXB Shareholders may make an application for the Reserved Shares and, in addition,
will be entitled to apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares under the Hong Kong Public Offering but may not
also indicate an interest for International Offer Shares under the International Offering (other than an
application to subscribe for the Reserved Shares under the Preferential Offering).
The Offer Shares will represent approximately 15.14% of the total Shares in issue immediately
following the completion of the Global Offering, assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised. If
the Over-allotment Option is exercised in full, the Offer Shares will represent approximately 16.50% of
the total Shares in issue immediately following the completion of the Global Offering and the exercise of
the Over-allotment Option.
References in this prospectus to applications, Application Forms, application or subscription monies,
or procedure for applications relate solely to the Hong Kong Public Offering and the Preferential Offering.
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 371 —


--- page 381 ---
THE HONG KONG PUBLIC OFFERING
Number of Offer Shares initially offered
Our Company is initially offering 17,845,000 Offer Shares for subscription by the public in Hong
Kong at the Offer Price, representing 10% of the total number of Offer Shares initially available under the
Global Offering. The number of Shares offered under the Hong Kong Public Offering, subject to any
reallocation of Offer Shares between the International Offering and the Hong Kong Public Offering, will
represent 1.51% of the total Shares in issue immediately following the completion of the Global Offering,
assuming that the Over-allotment Option is not exercised.
The Hong Kong Public Offering is open to members of the public in Hong Kong as well as to
institutional and professional investors. The Hong Kong Offer Shares will represent approximately 1.51%
of the Company’s enlarged share capital immediately after completion of the Global Offering, assuming
that the Over-allotment Option is not exercised. Professional investors generally include brokers, dealers,
companies (including fund managers) whose ordinary business involves dealing in shares and other
securities and corporate entities which regularly invest in shares and other securities.
Completion of the Hong Kong Public Offering is subject to the conditions as set out in the paragraph
headed “— The International Offering — Conditions of the Global Offering” below.
Allocation
Allocation of the Offer Shares to investors under the Hong Kong Public Offering will be based solely
on the level of valid applications received under the Hong Kong Public Offering. The basis of allocation
may vary, depending on the number of Hong Kong Offer Shares validly applied for by applicants. Such
allocation could, where appropriate, consist of balloting, which would mean that some applicants may
receive a higher allocation than others who have applied for the same number of Hong Kong Offer Shares,
and those applicants who are not successful in the ballot may not receive any Hong Kong Offer Shares.
For allocation purposes only, the total number of the Offer Shares initially available under the Hong
Kong Public Offering (after taking account of any reallocation in the number of Offer Shares allocated
between the Hong Kong Public Offering and the International Offering referred to below) will be divided
equally into two pools: pool A and pool B, with any odd board lot being allocated to pool A.
Pool A will comprise 8,922,500 Hong Kong Offer Shares and pool B will comprise 8,922,500 Hong
Kong Offer Shares, both of which are available on an equitable basis to successful applicants. All valid
applications that have been received for Hong Kong Offer Shares with a total amount (excluding brokerage
of 1.0%, the SFC transaction levy of 0.0027%, the Stock Exchange trading fee 0.00565% and the AFRC
transaction levy of 0.00015%) of HK$5.0 million or below will fall into pool A and all valid applications
that have been received for Hong Kong Offer Shares with a total amount (excluding brokerage of 1.0%,
the SFC transaction levy of 0.0027%, the Stock Exchange trading fee 0.00565% and the AFRC transaction
levy of 0.00015%) of over HK$5.0 million and up to the total value of pool B will fall into pool B.
For the purpose of this paragraph only, the “subscription price” for our Hong Kong Offer Shares
means the price payable on application therefor (without regard to the Offer Price as finally determined).
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 372 —


--- page 382 ---
Investors should be aware that applications in pool A and applications in pool B may receive
different allocation ratios. If the Hong Kong Offer Shares in one (but not both) of the pools are
undersubscribed, the surplus Hong Kong Offer Shares will be transferred to the other pool to satisfy
demand in that other pool and be allocated accordingly. Applicants can only apply for Hong Kong Offer
Shares from either pool A or pool B but not from both pools and can only receive Hong Kong Offer Shares
from either pool A or pool B but not from both pools. Multiple or suspected multiple applications within
either pool or between pools will be rejected.
No application will be accepted from applicants for more than 8,922,500 Hong Kong Offer Shares
(being 50% of the initial number of Hong Kong Offer Shares).
Reallocation and Clawback
The allocation of Shares between the Hong Kong Public Offering and the International Offering is
subject to reallocation at the sole discretion of the Overall Coordinators. The Reserved Shares which are
offered under the Preferential Offering to Qualifying WXB Shareholders out of the Offer Shares being
offered under the International Offering will not be subject to reallocation between the Hong Kong Public
Offering and the International Offering. If there are any odd lot number of the Reserved Shares left after
satisfying the excess applications, such Reserved Shares will be re-allocated, at the discretion of the
Overall Coordinators, to the International Offering.
If the Hong Kong Offer Shares are undersubscribed and the International Offering is fully subscribed
or oversubscribed, the Overall Coordinators may reallocate all or any unsubscribed Hong Kong Offer
Shares to the International Offering, in such proportions as the Overall Coordinators deem appropriate. In
the event that the International Offer Shares are fully subscribed or oversubscribed, if the number of
Shares validly applied for in the Hong Kong Public Offering represents (i) 15 times or more but less than
50 times, (ii) 50 times or more but less than 100 times, and (iii) 100 times or more, of the number of Hong
Kong Offer Shares initially available under the Hong Kong Public Offering, the total number of Hong
Kong Offer Shares available under the Hong Kong Public Offering will be increased to 53,534,000,
71,378,500 and 89,223,000 Shares, respectively, representing approximately 30% (in the case of (i)),
approximately 40% (in the case of (ii)) and 50% (in the case of (iii)), respectively, of the total number of
Offer Shares initially available under the Global Offering (before any exercise of the Over-allotment
Option), reallocation being referred to in this prospectus as “Mandatory Reallocation”. In such cases, the
number of Offer Shares allocated in the International Offering will be correspondingly reduced, in such
manner as the Overall Coordinators deem appropriate, and such additional Offer Shares will be reallocated
to pool A and pool B. In addition to any Mandatory Reallocation which may be required, the Overall
Coordinators may, at their discretion, reallocate Shares initially allocated for the International Offering to
the Hong Kong Public Offering to satisfy valid applications in pool A and pool B under the Hong Kong
Public Offering.
If both the Hong Kong Public Offering and the International Offering are undersubscribed, the
Global Offering will not proceed unless it is fully underwritten by the Underwriters. In the event that (i)
the International Offer Shares are undersubscribed and the Hong Kong Offer Shares are fully subscribed
or oversubscribed irrespective of the number of times; or (ii) the International Offer Shares are fully
subscribed or oversubscribed and the Hong Kong Offer Shares are fully subscribed or oversubscribed as
to less than 15 times of the number of Hong Kong Offer Shares initially available under the Hong Kong
Public Offering, provided that the Offer Price would be set at HK$19.90 per Share (being the low end of
the indicative Offer Price range), up to 17,845,000 Offer Shares may be reallocated to the Hong Kong
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 373 —


--- page 383 ---
Public Offering from the International Offering, so that the total number of the Shares available under the
Hong Kong Public Offer will be increased to 35,690,000 Offer Shares, representing double of the number
of the Offer Shares initially available under the Hong Kong Public Offering (before any exercise of the
Over-allotment Option) in accordance with the Guidance Letter HKEX-GL91-18 issued by the Stock
Exchange.
References in this prospectus to applications, Application Forms, application monies or to the
procedure for application relate solely to the Hong Kong Public Offering.
The Reserved Shares which are offered under the Preferential Offering to Qualifying WXB
Shareholders out of the Offer Shares being offered under the International Offering will not be subject to
reallocation between the Hong Kong Public Offering and the International Offering.
Applications
Each applicant under the Hong Kong Public Offering will also be required to give an undertaking
and confirmation in the application submitted by him that he and any person(s) for whose benefit he is
making the application have not applied for or taken up, or indicated an interest for, and will not apply
for or take up, or indicate an interest for, any International Offer Shares under the International Offering.
Such applicant’s application is liable to be rejected if such undertaking and/or confirmation is/are breached
and/or untrue (as the case may be) or it has been or will be placed or allocated International Offer Shares
under the International Offering.
The listing of the Shares on the Stock Exchange is sponsored by the Joint Sponsors. Applicants under
the Hong Kong Public Offering are required to pay, on application, the maximum Offer Price of HK$20.60
per Offer Share in addition to the brokerage, SFC transaction levy, Stock Exchange trading fee and AFRC
transaction levy payable on each Offer Share. If the Offer Price, as finally determined in the manner
described in “— Pricing and Allocation” below, is less than the maximum Offer Price of HK$20.60 per
Offer Share, appropriate refund payments (including the brokerage, SFC transaction levy, Stock Exchange
trading fee and AFRC transaction levy attributable to the surplus application monies) will be made to
successful applicants, without interest. Further details are set out below in “How to Apply for Hong Kong
Offer Shares and Reserved Shares” in this prospectus.
THE PREFERENTIAL OFFERING
Basis of the Assured Entitlement
In order to enable WXB Shareholders to participate in the Global Offering on a preferential basis as
to allocation only, subject to the Stock Exchange granting approval for the listing of, and permission to
deal in, the Shares on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange and the Global Offering becoming
unconditional, Qualifying WXB Shareholders are being invited to apply for an aggregate of 8,922,000
Reserved Shares in the Preferential Offering, representing approximately 5.00% of the Offer Shares
available under the Global Offering (without taking into account of the Shares which may be issued and
allotted pursuant to the exercise of the Over-allotment Option) as Assured Entitlement. The Reserved
Shares are being offered out of the International Offer Shares under the International Offering and are not
subject to reallocation as described in “— The Hong Kong Public Offering — Reallocation and Clawback”
above. In the event that the Over-allotment Option is exercised, the number of the Reserved Shares will
not change.
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 374 —


--- page 384 ---
The basis of the Assured Entitlement is one Reserved Share for every integral multiple of 477
WXB Shares held by Qualifying WXB Shareholders on the Record Date.
Qualifying WXB Shareholders should note that Assured Entitlement to the Reserved Shares may not
represent a number of a full board lot of 500 Shares. No odd lot matching services will be provided.
Further, the Reserved Shares allocated to the Qualifying WXB Shareholders will be rounded down to the
closest whole number if required, and dealings in odd lots of the Reserved Shares may be at a price below
the prevailing market price for full board lots of the Reserved Shares.
Assured Entitlement of Qualifying WXB Shareholders to the Reserved Shares are not
transferable and there will be no trading in nil-paid entitlements on the Stock Exchange.
Qualifying WXB Shareholders who hold less than 477 WXB Shares on the Record Date and
therefore will not have an Assured Entitlement to the Reserved Shares will still be entitled to participate
the Preferential Offering by applying only for excess Reserved Shares as further described below.
Basis of Allocation for Applications for the Reserved Shares
Qualifying WXB Shareholders may apply for a number of Reserved Shares which is greater than,
less than or equal to their Assured Entitlement under the Preferential Offering.
A valid application for a number of Reserved Shares which is less than or equal to a Qualifying WXB
Shareholder’s Assured Entitlement under the Preferential Offering will be accepted in full, subject to the
terms and conditions set out in the BLUE Application Forms, and assuming the conditions of the
Preferential Offering are satisfied.
Where a Qualifying WXB Shareholder applies for a number of Reserved Shares which is greater than
the Qualifying WXB Shareholder’s Assured Entitlement under the Preferential Offering, the relevant
Assured Entitlement will be satisfied in full (subject to terms and conditions mentioned above) but the
excess portion of such application will only be satisfied to the extent that there are sufficient Available
Reserved Shares as described below.
Where a Qualifying WXB Shareholder applies for excess Reserved Shares only under the
Preferential Offering, such application will only be satisfied to the extent that there are sufficient Available
Reserved Shares as defined and described below.
Qualifying WXB Shareholders (other than HKSCC Nominees) who intend to apply for less than their
Assured Entitlement using the BLUE Application Forms for Assured Entitlement or who intend to apply
for excess Reserved Shares using the BLUE Application Forms for excess Reserved Shares, should apply
for a number which is one of the numbers set out in the table of numbers and payments in the BLUE
Application Form make a payment of the corresponding amount. If the number of the Reserved Shares
applied for is not one of the numbers set out in the table, you must calculate the correct amount payable
on application by using the formula set out in the BLUE Application Form.
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 375 —


--- page 385 ---
To the extent that the excess applications for the Reserved Shares are:
(a) less than the Reserved Shares not taken up by the Qualifying WXB Shareholders’ Assured
Entitlement (the “ Available Reserved Shares ”), the Available Reserved Shares will first be
allocated to satisfy such excess applications for the Reserved Shares in full and thereafter will
be allocated, at the discretion of the Overall Coordinators, to the International Offering;
(b) equal to the Available Reserved Shares, the Available Reserved Shares will be allocated to
satisfy such excess applications for the Reserved Shares in full; or
(c) more than the Available Reserved Shares, the Available Reserved Shares will be allocated on
a fair and reasonable basis, which is consistent with the allocation basis commonly used in the
case of oversubscriptions in public offerings in Hong Kong, where a higher allocation
percentage will be applied in respect of smaller applications of excess Reserved Shares. If there
is an odd lot number of Shares left after satisfying the excess applications, such number of odd
lot Shares will be re-allocated, at the discretion of the Overall Coordinators to the International
Offering.
Save for the above, the Preferential Offering will not be subject to the clawback arrangement
between the International Offering and the Hong Kong Public Offering.
Beneficial WXB Shareholders whose WXB Shares are held by a nominee company should note that
our Company will regard the nominee company as a single WXB Shareholder according to the register of
members of WuXi Biologics. Accordingly, such Beneficial WXB Shareholders whose WXB Shares are
held by a nominee company should note that the arrangement under paragraph (c) above will not apply
to them individually. Any Beneficial WXB Shareholders whose WXB Shares are registered in the name
of a nominee, trustee or registered holder in any other capacity should make arrangements with such
nominee, trustee or registered holder in relation to applications for the Reserved Shares under the
Preferential Offering. Any such person is advised to consider whether it wishes to arrange for the
registration of the relevant WXB Shares in the name of the beneficial owner prior to the Record Date.
Applications by Qualifying WXB Shareholders for Hong Kong Offer Shares
In addition to any application for the Reserved Shares made on BLUE Application Form, Qualifying
WXB Shareholders will be entitled to make one application for Hong Kong Offer Shares by giving
electronic application instructions to HKSCC via CCASS (if you are a CCASS Investor Participant or
act through a CCASS Clearing or Custodian Participant) or through the White Form eIPO service.
Qualifying WXB Shareholders will receive no preference as to entitlement or allocation in respect of
applications for Hong Kong Offer Shares made by giving electronic application instructions to HKSCC
or through the White Form eIPO service under the Hong Kong Public Offering.
Beneficial WXB Shareholders who hold WXB Shares through Shanghai-Hong Kong Stock Connect
or Shenzhen-Hong Kong Stock Connect
As of the Latest Practicable Date, WXB Shares are eligible stock for southbound trading under
Shanghai-Hong Kong Stock Connect and the Shenzhen-Hong Kong Stock Connect. Beneficial WXB
Shareholders who hold WXB Shares through Shanghai-Hong Kong Stock Connect and/or Shenzhen-Hong
Kong Stock Connect should note that pursuant to Article 23 of the Implementation Rules for Registration,
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 376 —


--- page 386 ---
Depository and Clearing Services under the Mainland China-Hong Kong Stock Markets Connect Program
(), CSDCC does not provide
services relating to the subscription of newly issued shares. Accordingly, Beneficial WXB Shareholders
who hold WXB Shares through Shanghai-Hong Kong Stock Connect and/or Shenzhen-Hong Kong Stock
Connect cannot participate in the Preferential Offering and will not be able to take up their respective
Assured Entitlement to the Reserved Shares under the Preferential Offering through the trading
mechanism of Shanghai-Hong Kong Stock Connect and/or Shenzhen-Hong Kong Stock Connect.
Qualifying WXB Shareholders and Non-Qualifying WXB Shareholders
Only WXB Shareholders whose names appeared on the register of members of WuXi Biologics on
the Record Date and who are not Non-Qualifying WXB Shareholders are entitled to subscribe for the
Reserved Shares under the Preferential Offering. Non-Qualifying WXB Shareholders are those WXB
Shareholders with registered addresses in, or who are otherwise known by WuXi Biologics to be residents
of, jurisdictions outside Hong Kong on the Record Date, in respect of whom the directors of WuXi
Biologics and our Company, based on the enquiries made by them, consider it necessary or expedient to
exclude from the Preferential Offering on account either of the legal restrictions under the laws of the
relevant jurisdiction in which the relevant WXB Shareholder is resident or the requirements of the relevant
regulatory body or stock exchange in that jurisdiction.
The directors of WuXi Biologics and our Company have made enquiries regarding the legal
restrictions under the applicable securities legislation of the Specified Territories and the requirements of
the relevant regulatory bodies or stock exchanges with respect to the offer of the Reserved Shares to the
WXB Shareholders in the Specified Territories. Having considered the circumstances, the directors of
WuXi Biologics and our Company have formed the view that it is necessary or expedient to restrict the
ability of WXB Shareholders in the Specified Territories to take up their Assured Entitlement to the
Reserved Shares under the Preferential Offering due to the time and costs involved in the registration or
filing of this prospectus and/or approval required by the relevant authorities in those territories and/or
additional steps which our Company and the WXB Shareholders would need to take to comply with the
local legal and/or other requirements which would need to be satisfied in order to comply with the relevant
local or regulatory requirements in those territories.
Accordingly, for the purposes of the Preferential Offering, the Non-Qualifying WXB Shareholders
are:
(a) WXB Shareholders whose names appeared in the register of members of WuXi Biologics on
the Record Date and whose addresses as shown in such register are in any of the Specified
Territories; and
(b) WXB Shareholders or Beneficial WXB Shareholders on the Record Date who are otherwise
known by WuXi Biologics to be resident in any of the Specified Territories.
Notwithstanding any other provision in this prospectus or the BLUE Application Forms, our
Company reserves the right to permit any WXB Shareholder to take up his/her/its Assured Entitlement to
the Reserved Shares if our Company, in its absolute discretion, is satisfied that the transaction in question
is exempt from or not subject to the legislation or regulations giving rise to the restrictions described
above.
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 377 —


--- page 387 ---
Distribution of this prospectus and the BLUE Application Forms
BLUE Application Forms have been despatched to all Qualifying WXB Shareholders. In addition,
Qualifying WXB Shareholders will receive a copy of this prospectus in the manner in which they have
elected, or are deemed to have elected, to receive corporate communications under WuXi Biologics’
corporate communications policy.
If a Qualifying WXB Shareholder has elected to receive corporate communications from WuXi
Biologics in printed form, or has not been asked to elect the means of receiving WuXi Biologics’ corporate
communications, a printed copy of this prospectus in the elected language version(s) will be despatched
to such Qualifying WXB Shareholder.
If a Qualifying WXB Shareholder (a) has elected to receive an electronic version of corporate
communications or (b) is deemed to have consented to receiving the electronic version of corporate
communications from WuXi Biologics, an electronic version of this prospectus (which is identical to the
printed prospectus) can be accessed and downloaded from the website of the Stock Exchange
(www.hkexnews.hk ) and the website of our Company ( www.wuxixdc.com ).
Distribution of this prospectus and/or the BLUE Application Form(s) into any jurisdiction other than
Hong Kong may be restricted by law. Persons into whose possession this prospectus and/or the BLUE
Application Form(s) come (including, without limitation, agents, custodians, nominees and trustees)
should inform themselves of, and observe, any such restriction. Any failure to comply with such restriction
may constitute a violation of the securities laws of any such jurisdiction.
Receipt of this prospectus and/or the BLUE Application Form(s) does not and will not constitute an
offer in those jurisdictions in which it would be illegal to make an offer and, in those circumstances, this
prospectus and/or the BLUE Application Form(s) must be treated as sent for information only and should
not be copied or redistributed.
Application Procedures
The procedures for application under and the terms and conditions of the Preferential Offering are
set out in “How to Apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares — B. Applications for the
Reserved Shares” in this prospectus and on the BLUE Application Forms.
The documents to be issued in connection with the Hong Kong Public Offering and the
Preferential Offering will not be registered or filed under applicable securities or equivalent
legislation of any jurisdiction other than Hong Kong. No action has been taken to permit an offering
of the Hong Kong Offer Shares and the Reserved Shares or the distribution of this prospectus in any
jurisdiction other than Hong Kong. Accordingly, this prospectus may not be used for the purpose of,
and does not constitute, an offer or invitation in any jurisdiction or in any circumstances in which
such an offer or invitation is not authorized or to any person to whom it is unlawful to make such
an offer or invitation.
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 378 —


--- page 388 ---
THE INTERNATIONAL OFFERING
Number of Offer Shares offered
Subject to reallocation as described above, the International Offering will consist of an offering of
initially 160,601,000 Offer Shares, representing 90% of the total number of Offer Shares initially available
under the Global Offering. The International Offering is subject to the Hong Kong Public Offering
becoming unconditional. The Reserved Shares being offered pursuant to the Preferential Offering are
being offered out of the International Offer Shares.
Allocation
The International Offering will include selective marketing of Offer Shares to institutional and
professional investors and other investors anticipated to have a sizeable demand for such Offer Shares.
Professional investors generally include brokers, dealers, companies (including fund managers) whose
ordinary business involves dealing in shares and other securities and corporate entities which regularly
invest in shares and other securities. Allocation of Offer Shares pursuant to the International Offering will
be effected in accordance with the “bookbuilding” process described in “— Pricing and Allocation” below
and based on a number of factors, including the level and timing of demand, the total size of the relevant
investor’s invested assets or equity assets in the relevant sector and whether or not it is expected that the
relevant investor is likely to buy further Offer Shares, and/or hold or sell its Offer Shares, after the Listing.
Such allocation is intended to result in a distribution of the Offer Shares on a basis which would lead to
the establishment of a solid professional and institutional shareholder base to the benefit of our Company
and the Shareholders as a whole.
The Overall Coordinators (on behalf of the Underwriters) may require any investor who has been
offered Offer Shares under the International Offering, and who has made an application under the Hong
Kong Public Offering to provide sufficient information to the Overall Coordinators so as to allow them
to identify the relevant application under the Hong Kong Public Offering and to ensure that it is excluded
from any application of Offer Shares under the Hong Kong Public Offering.
Reallocation
The total number of Offer Shares to be issued or sold pursuant to the International Offering may
change as a result of the reallocation arrangement described in “— The Hong Kong Public Offering”
above, the exercise of the Over-allotment Option in whole or in part and/or any reallocation of
unsubscribed Offer Shares originally included in the Hong Kong Public Offering.
Over-allotment Option
In connection with the Global Offering, our Company is expected to grant an Over-allotment Option
to the International Underwriters exercisable by the Overall Coordinators (on behalf of the International
Underwriters). Pursuant to the Over-allotment Option, the International Underwriters have the right,
exercisable by the Overall Coordinators (on behalf of the International Underwriters) at any time from the
Listing Date until 30 days after the last date for the lodging of applications under the Hong Kong Public
Offering, to require our Company to issue and allot up to 19,158,500 additional Offer Shares, representing
approximately 10.74% of the initial Offer Shares, at the same price per Offer Share under the International
Offering to cover over-allocation in the International Offering, if any. If the Over-allotment Option is
exercised in full, the additional Offer Shares will represent approximately 1.60% of the total Shares in
issue immediately following the completion of the Global Offering and the exercise of the Over-allotment
Option. In the event that the Over-allotment Option is exercised, an announcement will be made.
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 379 —


--- page 389 ---
STABILIZATION
Stabilization is a practice used by underwriters in some markets to facilitate the distribution of
securities. To stabilize, the underwriters may bid for, or purchase, the securities in the secondary market,
during a specified period of time inter alia, to retard and, if possible, prevent, a decline in the market price
of the securities below the offer price. Such transactions may be effected in all jurisdictions where it is
permissible to do so, in each case in compliance with all applicable laws and regulatory requirements,
including those of Hong Kong. In Hong Kong, the price at which stabilization is effected is not permitted
to exceed the offer price.
In connection with the Global Offering, the Stabilizing Manager or any person acting for it, on behalf
of the Underwriters, may over-allocate or effect short sales or any other stabilizing transactions with a
view to stabilizing or maintaining the market price of the Shares for a limited period after the Listing Date
at a level higher than that which might otherwise prevail in the open market. Short sales involve the sale
by the Stabilizing Manager of a greater number of Shares than the Underwriters are required to purchase
in the Global Offering. “Covered” short sales are sales made in an amount not greater than the
Over-allotment Option. The Stabilizing Manager may close out the covered short position by either
exercising the Over-allotment Option to purchase additional Shares or purchasing Shares in the open
market. In determining the source of the Shares to close out the covered short position, the Stabilizing
Manager will consider, among others, the price of Shares in the open market as compared to the price at
which they may purchase additional Shares pursuant to the Over-allotment Option. Stabilizing transactions
consist of certain bids or purchases made for the purpose of preventing or retarding a decline in the market
price of the Shares while the Global Offering is in progress. Any market purchases of the Shares may be
effected on any stock exchange, including the Stock Exchange, any over-the-counter market or otherwise,
provided that they are made in compliance with all applicable laws and regulatory requirements. However,
there is no obligation on the Stabilizing Manager or any person acting for it to conduct any such stabilizing
action, which if taken, (a) will be conducted at the absolute discretion of the Stabilizing Manager or any
person acting for it, (b) may be discontinued at any time, and (c) is required to be brought to an end within
30 days after the last day for the lodging of applications under the Hong Kong Public Offering. The
number of the Shares that may be over-allocated will not exceed the number of the Shares that may be
issued under the Over-allotment Option, namely, 19,158,500 Offer Shares, which is 10.74% of the number
of Offer Shares initially available under the Global Offering, in the event that the whole or part of the
Over-allotment Option is exercised.
In Hong Kong, stabilizing activities must be carried out in accordance with the Securities and
Futures (Price Stabilizing) Rules. Stabilizing actions permitted pursuant to the Securities and Futures
(Price Stabilizing) Rules include:
(a) over-allocating for the purpose of preventing or minimizing any reduction in the market price
of the Shares;
(b) selling or agreeing to sell the Shares so as to establish a short position in them for the purpose
of preventing or minimizing any deduction in the market price of the Shares;
(c) subscribing, or agreeing to subscribe, for the Shares pursuant to the Over-allotment Option in
order to close out any position established under (a) or (b) above;
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 380 —


--- page 390 ---
(d) purchasing, or agreeing to purchase, any of the Shares for the sole purpose of preventing or
minimizing any reduction in the market price of the Shares;
(e) selling or agreeing to sell any Shares to liquidate any position established as a result of those
purchases; and
(f) offering or attempting to do anything described in (b), (c), (d) and (e) above.
Stabilizing actions by the Stabilizing Manager, or any person acting for it, will be entered into in
accordance with the laws, rules and regulations in place in Hong Kong on stabilization.
Prospective applications for investors in the Offer Shares should note that:
(a) as a result of effecting transactions to stabilize or maintain the market price of the Shares, the
Stabilizing Manager, or any person acting for it, may maintain a long position in the Shares;
(b) the size of the long position, and the period for which the Stabilizing Manager, or any person
acting for it, will maintain the long position is at the discretion of the Stabilizing Manager and
is uncertain;
(c) liquidation of any such long position by the Stabilizing Manager and selling in the open market
may lead to a decline in the market price of the Shares;
(d) no stabilizing action can be taken to support the price of the Shares for longer than the
stabilizing period, which begins on the Listing Date, and is expected to expire on Sunday,
December 10, 2023, being the 30th day after the last day for the lodging of applications under
the Hong Kong Public Offering. After this date, when no further stabilizing action may be
taken, demand for the Shares, and their market price, could fall after the end of the stabilizing
period. These activities by the Stabilizing Manager may stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect
the market price of the Shares. As a result, the price of the Shares may be higher than the price
that otherwise may exist in the open market;
(e) any stabilizing action taken by the Stabilizing Manager, or any person acting for it, may not
necessarily result in the market price of the Shares staying at or above the Offer Price either
during or after the stabilizing period; and
(f) stabilizing bids or transactions effected in the course of the stabilizing action may be made at
a price at or below the Offer Price and therefore at or below the price paid by applicants for,
or investors in, the Offer Shares.
An announcement in compliance with the Securities and Futures (Price Stabilizing) Rules will be
made within seven days of the expiration of the stabilizing period.
Over-Allocation
Following any over-allocation of Shares in connection with the Global Offering, the Stabilizing
Manager or any person acting for it may cover such over-allocations by exercising the Over-allotment
Option in full or in part, by using Shares purchased by the Stabilizing Manager or any person acting for
it in the secondary market at prices that do not exceed the Offer Price, or through the stock borrowing
arrangement as detailed below or a combination of these means.
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 381 —


--- page 391 ---
Stock Borrowing Arrangement
To facilitate the settlement of over-allocation in connection with the Global Offering, the Stabilizing
Manager may choose to borrow, whether on its own or through its affiliates, up to 19,158,500 Shares,
representing approximately 10.74% of the Offer Shares (being the maximum number of Offer Shares
which may be issued upon exercise of the Over-allotment Option), from WuXi Biologics, pursuant to the
Stock Borrowing Agreement which is expected to be entered into between the Stabilizing Manager and
WuXi Biologics. Such stock borrowing arrangement under the Stock Borrowing Agreement, if entered
into, will not be subject to the restrictions of Rule 10.07(1)(a) of the Listing Rules provided that the
requirements set out in Rule 10.07(3) of the Listing Rules are complied with.
Such stock borrowing arrangement is fully described in this prospectus and must be for the sole
purpose of covering any short position prior to the exercise of the Over-allotment Option. The same
number of Offer Shares so borrowed must be returned to WuXi Biologics or its nominees on or before the
third Business Day following the earlier of (a) the last day on which the Over-allotment Option may be
exercised, (b) the day on which the Over-allotment Option is exercised in full, or (c) such earlier time as
the Stabilizing Manager and WuXi Biologics may agree in writing. No payment will be made to WuXi
Biologics or its agent in relation to such stock borrowing arrangement.
PRICING AND ALLOCATION
The Offer Price is expected to be fixed by agreement between us and the Overall Coordinators (on
behalf of the Underwriters) on the Price Determination Date, when market demand for the Offer Shares
will be determined. The Price Determination Date is expected to be on or around Friday, November 10,
2023 (Hong Kong time), and in any event, no later than Wednesday, November 15, 2023. Prospective
investors should be aware that the Offer Price to be determined on the Price Determination Date may be,
but is not expected to be, lower than the Offer Price range stated in this prospectus.
The Offer Price will not be more than HK$20.60 and is expected to be not less than HK$19.90, unless
otherwise announced by no later than the morning of the last day for lodging applications under the Hong
Kong Public Offering and/or Preferential Offering as further explained below. If you apply for the Offer
Shares under the Hong Kong Public Offering and/or Preferential Offering, you must pay the maximum
offer price of HK$20.60 per Offer Share, plus 1.0% brokerage fee, 0.0027% SFC transaction levy,
0.00565% Stock Exchange trading fee and 0.00015% AFRC transaction levy.
If the Offer Price, as finally determined in the manner described below, is lower than HK$20.60, we
will refund the respective difference, including the brokerage fee, the Stock Exchange trading fee, the SFC
transaction levy and the AFRC transaction levy attributable to the surplus application monies. We will not
pay interest on any refunded amounts. For details, see “How to Apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and
Reserved Shares.”
The International Underwriters will be soliciting from prospective investors indications of interest
in acquiring Offer Shares in the International Offering. Prospective professional and institutional investors
will be required to specify the number of Offer Shares under the International Offering they would be
prepared to acquire either at different prices or at a particular price. This process, known as
“bookbuilding,” is expected to continue up to, and to cease on or around, the last day for lodging
applications under the Hong Kong Public Offering.
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 382 —


--- page 392 ---
The Overall Coordinators, on behalf of the Hong Kong Underwriters, may, where considered
appropriate based on the level of interest expressed by prospective professional, institutional and other
investors during the bookbuilding process, and with the consent of our Company, reduce the number of
Offer Shares and/or the indicative Offer Price range below that stated in this prospectus prior to the
morning of the last day for lodging applications under the Hong Kong Public Offering and/or Preferential
Offering. In such a case, we will as soon as practicable following the decision to make such reduction and
in any event not later than the morning of the last day for lodging applications under the Hong Kong Public
Offering publish a notice on the website of the Stock Exchange www.hkexnews.hk and on our website
www.wuxixdc.com (the contents of the website do not form a part of this prospectus).
Upon issue of such a notice, the revised number of Offer Shares and/or Offer Price range will be final
and conclusive and the Offer Price, if agreed upon by us, will be fixed within such revised Offer Price
range. Before submitting applications for the Hong Kong Offer Shares and/or the Reserved Shares,
applicants should have regard to the possibility that any announcement of a reduction in the number of
Offer Shares and/or the Offer Price range may not be made until the last day for lodging applications under
the Hong Kong Public Offering and/or Preferential Offering. Such notice will also confirm or revise, as
appropriate, the working capital statement, the Global Offering statistics as currently set out in
“Summary,” and any other financial information which may change as a result of such reduction. In the
absence of any such notice so published, the Offer Price, if agreed upon with our Company and the Overall
Coordinators will under no circumstances be set outside the Offer Price range stated in this prospectus.
If you have already submitted an application for the Hong Kong Offer Shares and/or the Reserved
Shares before the last day for lodging applications under the Hong Kong Public Offering and/or
Preferential Offering, you will not be allowed to subsequently withdraw your application. However, if the
number of Offer Shares and/or the Offer Price range is reduced, applicants will be notified that they are
required to confirm their applications. If applicants have been so notified but have not confirmed their
applications in accordance with the procedure to be notified, all unconfirmed applications will be deemed
revoked.
The Offer Price, an indication of the level of interest in the International Offering, the basis of
allotment of Offer Shares available under the Hong Kong Public Offering and the Hong Kong identity
card/passport/Hong Kong business registration numbers of successful applicants under the Hong Kong
Public Offering are expected to be made available in a variety of channels in the manner described in
“How to Apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares — F. Publication of Results” in this
prospectus.
UNDERWRITING AGREEMENTS
The Hong Kong Public Offering is fully underwritten by the Hong Kong Underwriters under the
terms of the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement and is conditional upon the International Underwriting
Agreement being signed and becoming unconditional.
We expect to enter into the International Underwriting Agreement relating to the International
Offering on or around the Price Determination Date. The underwriting arrangements under the Hong Kong
Underwriting Agreement and the International Underwriting Agreement are summarized in the section
“Underwriting” in this prospectus.
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 383 —


--- page 393 ---
CONDITIONS OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
Acceptance of all applications for Offer Shares will be conditional on:
(i) the Stock Exchange granting approval for the listing of, and permission to deal in, the Shares
in issued and to be offered pursuant to the Global Offering as mentioned in this prospectus
(including any additional Shares which may be issued pursuant to the exercise of the
Over-allotment Option) and Shares to be issued upon the exercise of any options to be granted
under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, and such approval not having been withdrawn;
(ii) the Offer Price having been fixed on or around the Price Determination Date;
(iii) the execution and delivery of the International Underwriting Agreement on or around the Price
Determination Date; and
(iv) the obligations of the Underwriters under each of the respective Underwriting Agreements
becoming and remaining unconditional and not having been terminated in accordance with the
terms of the respective Underwriting Agreements.
If, for any reason, the Offer Price is not agreed between our Company and the Overall Coordinators
(on behalf of the Underwriters) on or before Wednesday, November 15, 2023, the Global Offering will not
proceed and will lapse.
The consummation of each of the Hong Kong Public Offering and the International Offering is
conditional upon, among other things, the other offering becoming unconditional and not having been
terminated in accordance with its terms.
If the above conditions are not fulfilled or waived prior to the times and dates specified, the Global
Offering will lapse and the Stock Exchange will be notified immediately. Notice of the lapse of the Hong
Kong Public Offering and the Preferential Offering will be published by our Company on the website of
the Stock Exchange at www.hkexnews.hk and the website of our Company at www.wuxixdc.com on the
next business day following such lapse. In such event, all application monies will be returned, without
interest, on the terms set out in “How to Apply for Hong Kong Offer Shares and Reserved Shares” in this
prospectus. In the meantime, all application monies will be held in (a) separate bank account(s) with the
receiving bank or other licensed bank(s) in Hong Kong licensed under the Banking Ordinance (Chapter
155 of the Laws of Hong Kong) (as amended).
Share certificates for the Offer Shares are expected to be issued on Thursday, November 16, 2023
but will only become valid evidence of title at 8:00 a.m. on Friday, November 17, 2023 provided that (i)
the Global Offering has become unconditional in all respects and (ii) the right of termination as described
in “Underwriting — Grounds for Termination” in this prospectus has not been exercised at or before that
time.
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 384 —


--- page 394 ---
SHARES WILL BE ELIGIBLE FOR CCASS
All necessary arrangements have been made enabling our Shares to be admitted into CCASS. If the
Stock Exchange grants the listing of, and permission to deal in, our Shares and our Company complies
with the stock admission requirements of HKSCC, our Shares will be accepted as eligible securities by
HKSCC for deposit, clearance and settlement in CCASS with effect from the date of commencement of
dealings in our Shares on the Stock Exchange or any other date HKSCC chooses. Settlement of
transactions between participants of the Stock Exchange is required to take place in CCASS on the second
settlement day after any trading day. All activities under CCASS are subject to the General Rules of
CCASS and CCASS Operational Procedures in effect from time to time.
DEALING ARRANGEMENTS
Assuming that the Hong Kong Public Offering becomes unconditional at or before 8:00 a.m. in Hong
Kong on Friday, November 17, 2023, it is expected that dealings in our Shares on the Stock Exchange will
commence at 9:00 a.m. on Friday, November 17, 2023. The Shares will be traded in board lots of 500
Shares. The stock code of the Shares will be 2268.
STRUCTURE OF THE GLOBAL OFFERING
— 385 —


--- page 395 ---
IMPORTANT NOTICE TO INVESTORS:
FULLY ELECTRONIC APPLICATION PROCESS
We have adopted a fully electronic application process for the Hong Kong Public
Offering. We will not provide any printed copies of this prospectus or any printed copies of any
application forms for use by the public.
This prospectus is available at the website of the Hong Kong Stock Exchange at
www.hkexnews.hk under the “HKEXnews > New Listings > New Listing Information” section, and
our website at www.wuxixdc.com . If you require a printed copy of this prospectus, you may
download and print from the website addresses above.
The contents of the electronic version of this prospectus are identical to the printed Prospectus
as registered with the Registrar of Companies in Hong Kong pursuant to Section 342C of the
Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance.
Set out below are procedures through which you can apply for the Hong Kong Offer Shares
electronically. We will not provide any physical channels to accept any application for the Hong
Kong Offer Shares by the public.
If you are an intermediary , broker or agent , please remind your customers, clients or
principals, as applicable, that this prospectus is available online at the website addresses above.
A. APPLICATIONS FOR THE HONG KONG OFFER SHARES
1. How to Apply
We will not provide any printed application forms for use by the public.
To apply for the Hong Kong Offer Shares, you may:
(1) apply online through the White Form eIPO service at www.eipo.com.hk ;
(2) apply through CCASS EIPO service to electronically cause HKSCC Nominees to apply on
your behalf, including by:
(i) instructing your broker or custodian who is a CCASS Clearing Participant or a CCASS
Custodian Participant to give electronic application instructions via CCASS terminals
to apply for the Hong Kong Offer Shares on your behalf.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 386 —


--- page 396 ---
(ii) (if you are an existing CCASS Investor Participant ) giving electronic application
instructions through the CCASS Internet System ( https://ip.ccass.com ) or through the
CCASS Phone System by calling +852 2979 7888 (using the procedures in HKSCC’s “An
Operating Guide for Investor Participants” in effect from time to time). HKSCC can also
input electronic application instructions for CCASS Investor Participants through
HKSCC’s Customer Service Center at 1/F., One & Two Exchange Square, 8 Connaught
Place, Central, Hong Kong by completing an input request.
If you apply through channel (1) above, the Hong Kong Offer Shares successfully applied for will
be issued in your own name.
If you apply through channels (2)(i) or (2)(ii) above, the Hong Kong Offer Shares successfully
applied for will be issued in the name of HKSCC Nominees and deposited directly into CCASS to be
credited to your or a designated CCASS Participant’s stock account.
None of you or your joint applicant(s) may make more than one application, except where you are
a nominee and provide the required information in your application.
We, the Overall Coordinators, the White Form eIPO Service Provider and our and their respective
agents may reject or accept any application, in full or in part, for any reason at our or their discretion.
2. Who Can Apply
Eligibility for the Application
Y ou can apply for the Hong Kong Offer Shares if you or any person(s) for whose benefit you are
applying:
(a) are 18 years of age or older; and
(b) have a Hong Kong address.
If an application is made by a person under a power of attorney, we and the Overall Coordinators
may accept it at our or their discretion, and on any conditions we or they think fit, including requiring
evidence of the attorney’s authority.
The number of joint applicants may not exceed four and they may not apply by means of the White
Form eIPO service for the Hong Kong Offer Shares.
Unless permitted by the Listing Rules or any relevant waivers that have been granted by the Hong
Kong Stock Exchange (details of the relevant waivers are set out in “Waivers and Exemption from Strict
Compliance with the Listing Rules and the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions)
Ordinance”), you cannot apply for any Hong Kong Offer Shares if:
(a) you are an existing beneficial owner of Shares and/or a substantial shareholder of any of our
subsidiaries;
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 387 —


--- page 397 ---
(b) you are our director or chief executive officer and/or a director or chief executive officer of our
subsidiaries;
(c) you are a close associate of any of the above persons; or
(d) you have been allocated or have applied for any International Offer Shares or otherwise
participate in the International Offering (except in respect of Reserved Shares applied for
pursuant to the Preferential Offering).
Items Required for the Application
If you apply for the Hong Kong Offer Shares online through the White Form eIPO service, you
must:
(a) have a valid Hong Kong identity card number; and
(b) provide a valid e-mail address and a contact telephone number.
If you are applying for the Hong Kong Offer Shares online by instructing your broker or custodian
who is a CCASS Clearing Participant or a CCASS Custodian Participant to give electronic application
instructions via CCASS terminals, please contact them for the items required for the application.
3. Terms and Conditions of an Application
By applying through the application channels specified in this prospectus you:
(a) undertake to execute all relevant documents and instruct and authorize us and/or the Overall
Coordinators (or their agents or nominees), as our agents, to execute any documents for you
and to do on your behalf all things necessary to register any Hong Kong Offer Shares allocated
to you in your name or in the name of HKSCC Nominees as required by the Articles of
Association;
(b) agree to comply with our Memorandum and Articles of Association, the Companies (Winding
Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance and the Cayman Companies Act;
(c) confirm that you have read the terms and conditions and application procedures set out in this
prospectus and agree to be bound by them;
(d) confirm that you have received and read this prospectus and have relied only on the information
and representations in this prospectus in making your application and will not rely on any other
information or representations, except those in any supplement to this prospectus;
(e) confirm that you are aware of the restrictions on the Global Offering set out in this prospectus;
(f) agree that none of us, the Joint Sponsors, the Overall Coordinators, the Joint Global
Coordinators, the Joint Bookrunners, the Joint Lead Managers, the Capital Market
Intermediaries, the Underwriters, their respective directors, officers, employees, partners,
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 388 —


--- page 398 ---
agents, advisors and any other parties involved in the Global Offering (the “ Relevant
Persons ”) and the White Form eIPO Service Provider is or will be liable for any information
and representations not in this prospectus (and any supplement to this prospectus);
(g) undertake and confirm that you or the person(s) for whose benefit you have made the
application have not applied for or taken up, or indicated an interest for, and will not apply for
or take up, or indicate an interest for, any International Offer Shares nor participated in the
International Offering (except in respect of Reserved Shares applied for pursuant to the
Preferential Offering);
(h) agree to disclose to us, the Hong Kong Share Registrar, the receiving banks and the Relevant
Persons any personal data which we or any of them may require about you and the person(s)
for whose benefit you have made the application;
(i) if the laws of any place outside Hong Kong apply to your application, agree and warrant that
you have complied with all such laws and neither we nor the Relevant Persons will breach any
laws outside Hong Kong as a result of the acceptance of your offer to purchase, or any action
arising from your rights and obligations under the terms and conditions in this prospectus;
(j) agree that once your application has been accepted, you may not rescind it because of an
innocent misrepresentation;
(k) agree that your application, any acceptance of it and the resulting contract will be governed by,
and construed in accordance with the laws of Hong Kong;
(l) warrant that the information you have provided is true and accurate;
(m) agree to accept the Hong Kong Offer Shares applied for or any lesser number allocated to you
under the application;
(n) authorize (i) us to place your name(s) or the name of HKSCC Nominees on our register of
members as the holder(s) of any Hong Kong Offer Shares allocated to you and such other
registers as required under our Memorandum and Articles of Association and (ii) us and/or our
agents to send any share certificate(s) and/or any e-Refund payment instructions and/or any
refund check(s) to you or the first-named applicant for joint applications by ordinary post at
your own risk to the address stated on the application, unless you have fulfilled the criteria
mentioned in the paragraph headed “— Personal Collection” below to collect the share
certificate(s) and/or refund check(s) in person;
(o) declare and represent that except for the application made by a Qualifying WXB Shareholder
under the Preferential Offering this is the only application made and the only application
intended by you to be made to benefit you or the person for whose benefit you are applying;
(p) understand that we, our directors and the Overall Coordinators will rely on your declarations
and representations in deciding whether or not to allocate any of the Hong Kong Offer Shares
to you and that you may be prosecuted for making a false declaration;
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 389 —


--- page 399 ---
(q) (if the application is made for your own benefit) warrant that no other application has been or
will be made for your benefit by giving electronic application instructions to HKSCC directly
or indirectly or through the White Form eIPO service or by any one as your agent or by any
other person; and
(r) (if you are making the application as an agent for the benefit of another person) warrant that
(i) no other application has been or will be made by you as agent for or for the benefit of that
person or by that person or by any other person as agent for that person by giving electronic
application instructions to HKSCC and (ii) you have due authority to give electronic
application instructions on behalf of that other person as its agent.
For the avoidance of doubt, we and all other parties involved in the preparation of this prospectus
acknowledge that each applicant and CCASS Participant who gives or causes to give electronic
application instructions is a person who may be entitled to compensation under Section 40 of the
Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance (as applied by Section 342E of the
Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance).
4. Minimum Application Amount and Permitted Numbers
Y our application through the White Form eIPO service or the CCASS EIPO service must be for
a minimum of 500 Hong Kong Offer Shares and in one of the numbers set out in the table. Y ou are required
to pay the amount next to the number you select.
No. of
Hong Kong
Offer Shares
applied for
Amount
payable on
application
No. of
Hong Kong
Offer Shares
applied for
Amount
payable on
application
No. of
Hong Kong
Offer Shares
applied for
Amount
payable on
application
No. of
Hong Kong
Offer Shares
applied for
Amount
payable on
application
HK$ HK$ HK$ HK$
500 10,403.88 7,000 145,654.26 50,000 1,040,387.56 250,000 5,201,937.76
1,000 20,807.75 8,000 166,462.01 60,000 1,248,465.05 500,000 10,403,875.50
1,500 31,211.63 9,000 187,269.77 70,000 1,456,542.56 750,000 15,605,813.26
2,000 41,615.50 10,000 208,077.51 80,000 1,664,620.08 1,000,000 20,807,751.00
2,500 52,019.38 15,000 312,116.26 90,000 1,872,697.59 2,000,000 41,615,502.00
3,000 62,423.25 20,000 416,155.02 100,000 2,080,775.10 3,000,000 62,423,253.00
3,500 72,827.13 25,000 520,193.78 125,000 2,600,968.88 4,000,000 83,231,004.00
4,000 83,231.00 30,000 624,232.54 150,000 3,121,162.66 5,000,000 104,038,755.00
4,500 93,634.88 35,000 728,271.29 175,000 3,641,356.43 6,000,000 124,846,506.00
5,000 104,038.75 40,000 832,310.05 200,000 4,161,550.20 7,000,000 145,654,257.00
6,000 124,846.51 45,000 936,348.80 225,000 4,681,743.98 8,922,500
(Note) 185,657,158.30
Note: Maximum number of Hong Kong Offer Share you may apply for.
No application for any other number of the Hong Kong Offer Shares will be considered and any such
application is liable to be rejected.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 390 —


--- page 400 ---
5. Applying Through the White Form eIPO Service
General
Individuals who meet the criteria in the paragraph headed “— 2. Who Can Apply” above may apply
through the White Form eIPO service for the Offer Shares to be allocated and registered in their own
names through the designated website at www.eipo.com.hk .
Detailed instructions for application through the White Form eIPO service are set out on the
designated website. If you do not follow the instructions, your application may be rejected and may not
be submitted to us. If you apply through the designated website, you authorize the White Form eIPO
Service Provider to apply on the terms and conditions in this prospectus, as supplemented and amended
by the terms and conditions of the White Form eIPO Service Provider.
Time for Submitting Applications under the White Form eIPO Service
Y ou may submit your application through the White Form eIPO service through the designated
website at www.eipo.com.hk (24 hours daily, except on the last day for applications) from 9:00 a.m. on
Tuesday, November 7, 2023 until 11:30 a.m. on Friday, November 10, 2023 and the latest time for
completing full payment of application monies in respect of such applications will be 12:00 noon on
Friday, November 10, 2023, the last day for applications, or such later time as described in the paragraph
headed “E. Effect of Bad Weather and Extreme Conditions on the Opening and Closing of the Application
Lists” below.
No Multiple Applications
If you apply by means of White Form eIPO , once you complete payment in respect of any
electronic application instruction given by you or for your benefit through the White Form eIPO
service to make an application for Hong Kong Offer Shares, an actual application shall be deemed to have
been made. For the avoidance of doubt, giving an electronic application instruction under White Form
eIPO service more than once and obtaining different application reference numbers without effecting full
payment in respect of a particular reference number will not constitute an actual application.
If you are suspected of submitting more than one application through the White Form eIPO service
or by any other means, all of your applications are liable to be rejected.
6. Applying Through CCASS EIPO Service
General
Y ou may instruct your broker or custodian who is a CCASS Clearing Participant or a CCASS
Custodian Participant to give electronic application instructions via CCASS terminals to apply for the
Hong Kong Offer Shares on your behalf. CCASS Participants may give electronic application
instructions to apply for the Hong Kong Offer Shares and to arrange payment of the money due on
application and payment of refunds under their participant agreements with HKSCC and the General Rules
of CCASS and the CCASS Operational Procedures.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 391 —


--- page 401 ---
If you are a CCASS Investor Participant, you may give these electronic application instructions
through the CCASS Internet System ( https://ip.ccass.com ) or through the CCASS Phone System by
calling +852 2979 7888 (using the procedures in HKSCC’s “An Operating Guide for Investor Participants”
in effect from time to time). HKSCC can also input electronic application instructions for CCASS
Investor Participants through HKSCC’s Customer Service Center at 1/F, One & Two Exchange Square, 8
Connaught Place, Central, Hong Kong by completing an input request.
Y ou will be deemed to have authorized HKSCC and/or HKSCC Nominees to transfer the details of
your application to us, the Joint Sponsors, the Overall Coordinators and the Hong Kong Share Registrar.
Applying through CCASS EIPO Service
Where you have applied through CCASS EIPO service (either indirectly through a broker or
custodian or directly) and an application is made by HKSCC Nominees on your behalf:
(a) HKSCC Nominees will only be acting as a nominee for you and is not liable for any breach
of the terms and conditions of this prospectus; and
(b) HKSCC Nominees will do the following things on your behalf:
 agree that the Hong Kong Offer Shares to be allocated shall be registered in the name of
HKSCC Nominees and deposited directly into CCASS for the credit of the CCASS
Participant’s stock account on your behalf or your CCASS Investor Participant’s stock
account;
 agree to accept the Hong Kong Offer Shares applied for or any lesser number allocated;
 undertake and confirm that you have not applied for or taken up, or indicated an interest
for, and will not apply for or take up, or indicate an interest for, any International Offer
Shares nor participated in the International Offering (except in respect of Reserved Shares
applied for pursuant to the Preferential Offering);
( if the electronic application instructions are given for your benefit ) declare that only
one set of electronic application instructions has been given for your benefit;
 (if you are an agent for another person) declare that you have only given one set of
electronic application instructions for the other person’s benefit and are duly authorized
to give those instructions as its agent;
 confirm that you understand that we, our directors and the Overall Coordinators will rely
on your declarations and representations in deciding whether or not to allocate any of the
Hong Kong Offer Shares to you and that you may be prosecuted for making a false
declaration;
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 392 —


--- page 402 ---
 authorize us to place HKSCC Nominees’ name on our register of members as the holder
of the Hong Kong Offer Shares allocated to you, and despatch Share certificate(s) and/or
refund monies in accordance with the arrangements separately agreed between us and
HKSCC;
 confirm that you have read the terms and conditions and application procedures set out
in this prospectus and agree to be bound by them;
 confirm that you have received and read this prospectus and have relied only on the
information and representations in this prospectus in causing the application to be made
and will not rely on any other information or representations, except those in any
supplement to this prospectus;
 agree that neither we nor any of the Relevant Persons is or will be liable for any
information and representations not in this prospectus (and any supplement to this
prospectus);
 agree to disclose to us, the Hong Kong Share Registrar, the receiving banks and the
Relevant Persons any personal data which we or they may require about you;
 agree (without prejudice to any other rights which you may have) that once HKSCC
Nominees’ application has been accepted, it cannot be rescinded for innocent
misrepresentation;
 agree that any application made by HKSCC Nominees on your behalf is irrevocable on
or before the fifth day after the time of opening of the application lists (excluding any
days which is Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in Hong Kong), such agreement to take
effect as a collateral contract with us, and to become binding when you give the
instructions and such collateral contract to be in consideration of our agreeing that we
will not offer any Hong Kong Offer Shares to any person on or before the fifth day after
the time of opening of the application lists (excluding any days which is Saturday, Sunday
or public holiday in Hong Kong) except by means of one of the procedures referred to in
this prospectus. However, HKSCC Nominees may revoke the application on or before the
fifth day after the time of opening of the application lists (excluding any days which is
Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in Hong Kong) if a person responsible for this
prospectus under Section 40 of the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous
Provisions) Ordinance (as applied by Section 342E of the Companies (Winding Up and
Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance) gives a public notice under that section on or
before the fifth day after the time of the opening of the application lists (excluding any
day which is a Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in Hong Kong) which excludes or
limits that person’s responsibility for this prospectus;
 agree that once HKSCC Nominees’ application is accepted, neither that application nor
your electronic application instructions can be revoked, and that acceptance of that
application will be evidenced by the announcement of the results of the Hong Kong
Public Offering by us;
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 393 —


--- page 403 ---
 agree to the arrangements, undertakings and warranties under the participant agreement
between you and HKSCC, read with the General Rules of CCASS and the CCASS
Operational Procedures, for giving electronic application instructions to apply for the
Hong Kong Offer Shares;
 agree with us, for ourselves and for the benefit of each shareholder (and so that we will
be deemed by our acceptance in whole or in part of the application by HKSCC Nominees
to have agreed, for us and on behalf of each shareholder, with each CCASS Participant
giving electronic application instructions ) to observe and comply with our
Memorandum and Articles of Association, the Companies (Winding Up and
Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance and the Cayman Companies Act; and
 agree that your application, any acceptance of it and the resulting contract will be
governed by, and construed in accordance with the laws of Hong Kong.
Effect of Applying through CCASS EIPO Service
By applying through CCASS EIPO service, you (and, if you are joint applicants, each of you jointly
and severally) are deemed to have done the following things. Neither HKSCC nor HKSCC Nominees will
be liable to us or any other person in respect of the things mentioned below:
(a) instructed and authorized HKSCC to cause HKSCC Nominees (acting as nominee for the
relevant CCASS Participants) to apply for the Hong Kong Offer Shares on your behalf;
(b) instructed and authorized HKSCC to arrange payment of the maximum Hong Kong Offer Price,
brokerage, SFC transaction levy, AFRC Transaction levy and Hong Kong Stock Exchange
trading fee by debiting your designated bank account and, in the case of a wholly or partially
unsuccessful application and/or if the Hong Kong Offer Price is less than the maximum Hong
Kong Offer Price initially paid on application, refund of the application monies (including
brokerage, SFC transaction levy, AFRC Transaction levy and Hong Kong Stock Exchange
trading fee) by crediting your designated bank account; and
(c) instructed and authorized HKSCC to cause HKSCC Nominees to do on your behalf all the
things stated in this prospectus.
Time for Inputting Electronic Application Instructions
Note
CCASS Clearing/Custodian Participants can input electronic application instructions at the
following times on the following dates:
Tuesday, November 7, 2023 — 9:00 a.m. to 8:30 p.m.
Wednesday, November 8, 2023 — 8:00 a.m. to 8:30 p.m.
Thursday, November 9, 2023 — 8:00 a.m. to 8:30 p.m.
Friday, November 10, 2023 — 8:00 a.m. to 12:00 noon
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 394 —


--- page 404 ---
CCASS Investor Participants can input electronic application instructions from 9:00 a.m. on
Tuesday, November 7, 2023 until 12:00 noon on Friday, November 10, 2023 (24 hours daily, except on
Friday, November 10, 2023, the last day for applications).
The latest time for inputting your electronic application instructions will be 12:00 noon on Friday,
November 10, 2023, the last day for applications, or such later time as described in the paragraph headed
“E. Effect of Bad Weather and Extreme Conditions on the Opening and Closing of the Application Lists”
below.
Note:
The times in this sub-section are subject to change as HKSCC may determine from time to time with prior notification to
CCASS Clearing Participants, CCASS Custodian Participants and/or CCASS Investor Participants.
If you are instructing your broker or custodian who is a CCASS Clearing Participant or a CCASS
Custodian Participant to give electronic application instructions via CCASS terminals to apply for the
Hong Kong Offer Shares on your behalf, you are advised to contact your broker or custodian for the latest
time for giving such instructions which may be different from the latest time as stated above.
Personal Data
The following Personal Information Collection Statement applies to any personal data held by us, the
Hong Kong Share Registrar, the receiving banks and the Relevant Persons about you in the same way as
it applies to personal data about applicants other than HKSCC Nominees. By applying through CCASS
EIPO service, you agree to all of the terms of the Personal Information Collection Statement below.
Personal Information Collection Statement
This Personal Information Collection Statement informs applicant for, and holder of, the Hong Kong
Offer Shares, of the policies and practices of us and our Hong Kong Share Registrar in relation to personal
data and the Personal Data (Privacy) Ordinance (Chapter 486 of the Laws of Hong Kong).
Reasons for the collection of your personal data
It is necessary for applicants and registered holders of the Hong Kong Offer Shares to supply correct
personal data to us or our agents and the Hong Kong Share Registrar when applying for the Hong Kong
Offer Shares or transferring the Hong Kong Offer Shares into or out of their names or in procuring the
services of the Hong Kong Share Registrar.
Failure to supply the requested data may result in your application for the Hong Kong Offer Shares
being rejected, or in delay or the inability of us or our Hong Kong Share Registrar to effect transfers or
otherwise render their services. It may also prevent or delay registration or transfers of the Hong Kong
Offer Shares which you have successfully applied for and/or the despatch of share certificate(s) to which
you are entitled.
It is important that the holders of the Hong Kong Offer Shares inform us and the Hong Kong Share
Registrar immediately of any inaccuracies in the personal data supplied.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 395 —


--- page 405 ---
Purposes
Y our personal data may be used, held, processed, and/or stored (by whatever means) for the
following purposes:
(a) processing your application and refund check, where applicable, verification of compliance
with the terms and application procedures set out in this prospectus and announcing results of
allocation of the Hong Kong Offer Shares;
(b) compliance with applicable laws and regulations in Hong Kong and elsewhere;
(c) registering new issues or transfers into or out of the names of the holders of our Shares
including, where applicable, HKSCC Nominees;
(d) maintaining or updating our Register of Members;
(e) verifying identities of the holders of our Shares;
(f) establishing benefit entitlements of holders of our Shares, such as dividends, rights issues,
bonus issues, etc.;
(g) distributing communications from us and our subsidiaries;
(h) compiling statistical information and profiles of the holder of our Shares;
(i) disclosing relevant information to facilitate claims on entitlements; and
(j) any other incidental or associated purposes relating to the above and/or to enable us and the
Hong Kong Share Registrar to discharge our or their obligations to holders of our Shares and/or
regulators and/or any other purposes to which the securities’ holders may from time to time
agree.
Transfer of personal data
Personal data held by us and our Hong Kong Share Registrar relating to the holders of the Hong
Kong Offer Shares will be kept confidential but we and our Hong Kong Share Registrar may, to the extent
necessary for achieving any of the above purposes, disclose, obtain or transfer (whether within or outside
Hong Kong) the personal data to, from or with any of the following:
(a) our appointed agents such as financial advisers, receiving bankers and overseas principal share
registrar;
(b) where applicants for the Hong Kong Offer Shares request a deposit into CCASS, HKSCC or
HKSCC Nominees, who will use the personal data for the purposes of operating CCASS;
(c) any agents, contractors or third-party service providers who offer administrative,
telecommunications, computer, payment or other services to us or the Hong Kong Share
Registrar in connection with their respective business operation;
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 396 —


--- page 406 ---
(d) the Hong Kong Stock Exchange, the SFC and any other statutory regulatory or governmental
bodies or otherwise as required by laws, rules or regulations; and
(e) any persons or institutions with which the holders of the Hong Kong Offer Shares have or
propose to have dealings, such as their bankers, solicitors, accountants or stockbrokers etc.
Retention of personal data
We and our Hong Kong Share Registrar will keep the personal data of the applicants and holders of
the Hong Kong Offer Shares for as long as necessary to fulfill the purposes for which the personal data
were collected. Personal data which is no longer required will be destroyed or dealt with in accordance
with the Personal Data (Privacy) Ordinance.
Access to and correction of personal data
Holders of the Hong Kong Offer Shares have the right to ascertain whether we or the Hong Kong
Share Registrar hold their personal data, to obtain a copy of that data, and to correct any data that is
inaccurate. We and the Hong Kong Share Registrar have the right to charge a reasonable fee for the
processing of such requests. All requests for access to data or correction of data should be addressed to
us, at our registered address disclosed in “Corporate Information” or as notified from time to time, for the
attention of the secretary, or our Hong Kong Share Registrar for the attention of the privacy compliance
officer.
7. Warning for Electronic Applications
The application for the Hong Kong Offer Shares by CCASS EIPO service (directly or indirectly
through your broker or custodian ) is only a facility provided to CCASS Participants.
Similarly, the application for the Hong Kong Offer Shares through the White Form eIPO service is
only a facility provided by the White Form eIPO Service Provider to public investors. Such facilities are
subject to capacity limitations and potential service interruptions and you are advised not to wait until the
last day for applications to make your electronic application. We, the Relevant Persons, the White Form
eIPO Service Provider take no responsibility for such applications and provide no assurance that any
CCASS Participant applying through CCASS EIPO service or person applying through the White Form
eIPO service will be allocated any Hong Kong Offer Shares.
To ensure that CCASS Investor Participants can give their electronic application instructions , they
are advised not to wait until the last minute to input their instructions to the systems.
In the event that CCASS Investor Participants have problems in the connection to CCASS Phone
System/CCASS Internet System for submission of electronic application instructions , they should go to
HKSCC’s Customer Service Center at 1/F., One & Two Exchange Square, 8 Connaught Place, Central,
Hong Kong to complete an input request form for electronic application instructions before 12:00 noon
on Friday, November 10, 2023.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 397 —


--- page 407 ---
8. How Many Applications Can Y ou Make
Multiple applications for the Hong Kong Offer Shares are not allowed except by nominees.
If you are a Qualifying WXB Shareholder applying for Reserved Shares under the Preferential
Offering on the BLUE Application Form, you may also make one application for Hong Kong Offer Shares
electronically through CCASS (if you are a CCASS Investor Participant or act through a CCASS Clearing
or Custodian Participant) or submit an application through the White Form eIPO service through the
designated website at www.eipo.com.hk . However, in respect of any application for Hong Kong Offer
Shares using the above methods, you will not enjoy the preferential treatment accorded to you under the
Preferential Offering as described in “Structure of the Global Offering — The Preferential Offering.”
All of your applications will be rejected if more than one application through the CCASS EIPO
service (directly or indirectly through your broker or custodian ) or through the White Form eIPO
service is made for your benefit (including the part of the application made by HKSCC Nominees acting
on electronic application instructions ), and the number of Hong Kong Offer Shares applied by HKSCC
Nominees will be automatically reduced by the number of Hong Kong Offer Shares for which you have
given such instructions and/or for which such instructions have been given for your behalf.
For the avoidance of doubt, giving an electronic application instruction under the White Form
eIPO service more than once and obtaining different application reference numbers without effecting full
payment in respect of a particular reference number will not constitute an actual application. However, any
electronic application instructions to make an application for the Hong Kong Offer Shares given by you
or for your behalf to HKSCC will be deemed to be an actual application for the purposes of considering
whether multiple applications have been made.
If an Unlisted Company makes an application and:
(a) the principal business of that company is dealing in securities; and
(b) you exercise statutory control over that company, then the application will be treated as being
made for your benefit.
“Unlisted company ” means a company with no equity securities listed on the Hong Kong Stock
Exchange.
“Statutory control ” means you:
(a) control the composition of the board of directors of the company;
(b) control more than half of the voting power of the company; or
(c) hold more than half of the issued share capital of the company (not counting any part of it
which carries no right to participate beyond a specified amount in a distribution of either profits
or capital).
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 398 —


--- page 408 ---
B. APPLICATIONS FOR THE RESERVED SHARES
1. Who Can Apply
Only WXB Shareholders whose names appeared on the register of members of WuXi Biologics on
the Record Date and who are not Non-Qualifying WXB Shareholders are entitled to subscribe for the
Reserved Shares under the Preferential Offering.
Non-Qualifying WXB Shareholders are those WXB Shareholders with registered addresses in, or
who are otherwise known by WuXi Biologics to be residents of, jurisdictions outside Hong Kong on the
Record Date, in respect of whom the directors of WuXi Biologics and the Company, based on the enquiries
made by them, consider it necessary or expedient to exclude them from the Preferential Offering on
account either of the legal restrictions under the laws of the relevant jurisdiction in which the relevant
WXB Shareholder is resident or the requirements of the relevant regulatory body or stock exchange in that
jurisdiction.
The directors of WuXi Biologics and the Company have made enquiries regarding the legal
restrictions under the applicable securities legislation of the relevant countries and the requirements of the
regulatory bodies or stock exchanges with respect to the offer of the Reserved Shares to the WXB
Shareholders in the relevant countries. Having considered the circumstances, the directors of WuXi
Biologics and the Company are of the view that it is necessary or expedient to restrict the ability of WXB
Shareholders in the relevant countries to take up their Assured Entitlement of Reserved Shares under the
Preferential Offering due to the time and costs involved in the registration or filing of this prospectus
and/or approval required by the relevant authorities in those countries and/or additional procedures which
the Company and the WXB Shareholders would need to take to comply with the local legal and/or other
requirements which would need to be satisfied in order to comply with the local or regulatory requirements
in those countries.
Accordingly, for the purposes of the Preferential Offering, the Non-Qualifying WXB Shareholders
are:
(a) WXB Shareholders whose names appeared in the register of members of WuXi Biologics on
the Record Date and whose addresses as shown in such register are in any of the Specified
Territories; and
(b) WXB Shareholders or Beneficial WXB Shareholders on the Record Date who are otherwise
known by WuXi Biologics to be resident in any of the Specified Territories.
Notwithstanding any other provision in this prospectus or the BLUE Application Forms, the
Company reserves the right to permit any WXB Shareholder to take up his/her/its Assured Entitlement of
Reserved Shares if the Company, in its absolute discretion, is satisfied that the transaction in question is
exempt from or not subject to the legislation or regulations giving rise to the restrictions described above.
With respect to the relevant countries, WuXi Biologics has sent a letter to CCASS Participants (other
than CCASS Investor Participants) notifying them that in light of applicable laws and regulations of the
relevant countries, for the WXB Shares being held on behalf of the Non-Qualifying WXB Shareholders,
they are not allowed to participate in the Preferential Offering.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 399 —


--- page 409 ---
The Qualifying WXB Shareholders are entitled to apply for Assured Entitlement on the basis of one
Reserved Share for every integral multiple of 477 WXB Shares being held on the Record Date.
The Qualifying WXB Shareholders who hold less than 477 WXB Shares on the Record Date will not
have Assured Entitlement of Reserved Shares but will still be entitled to participate in the Preferential
Offering by applying for excess Reserved Shares.
If the applicant is a firm, the application must be made in the name of an individual member and not
the firm. If the applicant is a body corporate, the BLUE Application Form must be signed by a duly
authorized officer, who must state his representative capacity, and stamped with the corporation’s chop.
If application is made by a duly authorized person under a valid power of attorney, the Company and
the Overall Coordinators, as the Company’s agents, may accept it at their discretion and on conditions they
may think fit, including the evidence of the attorney’s authority. The Company and the Overall
Coordinators, as the Company’s agents, shall have absolute discretion to reject or accept any application,
in full or in part, without giving any reason.
Unless permitted by the Listing Rules or any relevant waivers that have been granted by the Hong
Kong Stock Exchange (details of the relevant waivers are set out in “Waivers and Exemption from Strict
Compliance with the Listing Rules and the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions)
Ordinance”), you cannot apply for any Reserved Shares if you are:
 an existing beneficial owner of Shares in the Company and/or any of its subsidiaries;
 a Director or chief executive of the Company and/or any of the Company’s subsidiaries;
 a close associate of any of the above persons; or
 a Non-Qualifying WXB Shareholder (as defined in the section headed “Definitions” of this
prospectus).
2. How to Apply
Application for Reserved Shares under the Preferential Offering shall only be made by the
Qualifying WXB Shareholders using BLUE Application Forms despatched to the Qualifying WXB
Shareholders by the Company.
The Qualifying WXB Shareholders may apply for a number of Reserved Shares which is greater
than, less than or equal to their Assured Entitlement or may apply only for excess Reserved Shares under
the Preferential Offering.
A valid application for a number of Reserved Shares which is less than or equal to a Qualifying WXB
Shareholder’s Assured Entitlement under the Preferential Offering will be accepted in full, subject to the
terms and conditions set out in the BLUE Application Forms and assuming the conditions of the
Preferential Offering are satisfied.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 400 —


--- page 410 ---
Where a Qualifying WXB Shareholder applies for a number of Reserved Shares which is greater than
the Qualifying WXB Shareholder’s Assured Entitlement under the Preferential Offering, the Assured
Entitlement will be satisfied in full, subject as mentioned above, but the excess portion of such application
will only be satisfied to the extent that there are sufficient Available Reserved Shares as described below.
Where a Qualifying WXB Shareholder only applies for excess Reserved Shares under the
Preferential Offering, the application will be satisfied to the extent that there are sufficient Available
Reserved Shares as described below.
The Qualifying WXB Shareholders (other than HKSCC Nominees) who intend to apply for less than
their Assured Entitlement using the BLUE Application Forms or who intend to apply for excess Reserved
Shares using the BLUE Application Forms, should apply for Reserved Shares of one of the numbers set
out in the table of “number of reserved shares that may be applied for and payments” in the BLUE
Application Form and make payment accordingly.
To the extent that excess applications for the Reserved Shares are:
(a) less than the Available Reserved Shares, the Available Reserved Shares will first be allocated
to satisfy such excess applications in full and thereafter will be allocated, at the discretion of
the Overall Coordinators, to the International Offering;
(b) equal to the Available Reserved Shares, the Available Reserved Shares will be allocated to
satisfy such excess applications for the Reserved Shares in full; or
(c) more than the Available Reserved Shares, the Available Reserved Shares will be allocated on
the basis commonly used for oversubscription in public offerings in Hong Kong, where smaller
applications will have higher allocation percentage. If there are any odd lot number of Reserved
Shares remaining after satisfying the excess applications, such Shares will be reallocated, at the
discretion of the Overall Coordinators, to the International Offering. No preference will be
given to any excess applications made to top up odd lot of Shares.
Save for the above, the Preferential Offering will not be subject to the clawback arrangement
between the International Offering and the Hong Kong Public Offering.
The Qualifying WXB Shareholders who have applied for Reserved Shares under the Preferential
Offering or on the BLUE Application Form, may also make one application by giving electronic
application instructions to HKSCC via CCASS (if you are a CCASS Investor Participant or act through
a CCASS Clearing or Custodian Participant) or through the White Form eIPO service for the Hong Kong
Offer Shares in the Hong Kong Public Offering. However, Qualifying WXB Shareholders will receive no
preference as to entitlement or allocation in respect of applications for Hong Kong Offer Shares made by
giving electronic application instructions to HKSCC or through the White Form eIPO service under the
Hong Kong Public Offering.
Persons who held their WXB Shares on the Record Date in CCASS indirectly through a
broker/custodian, and wish to participate in the Preferential Offering, should instruct their broker or
custodian to apply for the Reserved Shares on their behalf by no later than the deadline set by HKSCC
or HKSCC Nominees. In order to meet the deadline set by HKSCC, such persons should check with their
broker/custodian for the timing on the processing of their instructions, and submit their instructions to
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 401 —


--- page 411 ---
their broker/custodian as required. Persons who held their WXB Shares on the Record Date in CCASS
directly as a CCASS Investor Participant, and wish to participate in the Preferential Offering, should give
their instruction to HKSCC via the CCASS Phone System or CCASS Internet System by no later than the
deadline set by HKSCC or HKSCC Nominees.
3. Distribution of this prospectus and the BLUE Application Forms
BLUE Application Forms have been despatched to all Qualifying WXB Shareholders. In addition,
Qualifying WXB Shareholders will receive a copy of this prospectus in the manner in which they have
elected, or are deemed to have elected, to receive corporate communications under WuXi Biologics’
corporate communications policy.
If a Qualifying WXB Shareholder has elected to receive corporate communications from WuXi
Biologics in printed form, or has not been asked to elect the means of receiving WuXi Biologics’ corporate
communications, a printed copy of this prospectus in the elected language version(s) will be despatched
to such Qualifying WXB Shareholder.
If a Qualifying WXB Shareholder (a) has elected to receive an electronic version of corporate
communications or (b) is deemed to have consented to receiving the electronic version of corporate
communications from WuXi Biologics, an electronic version of this prospectus (which is identical to the
printed prospectus) can be accessed and downloaded from the website of the Stock Exchange at
www.hkexnews.hk and the website of our Company at www.wuxixdc.com .
Qualifying WXB Shareholders who require a replacement BLUE Application Form should contact
Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services Limited at 17M Floor, Hopewell Centre, 183 Queen’s Road
East, Wanchai, Hong Kong.
Distribution of this prospectus and/or the BLUE Application Forms into any jurisdiction other than
Hong Kong may be restricted by law. Persons who come into possession of this prospectus and/or the
BLUE Application Forms (including, without limitation, agents, custodians, nominees and trustees)
should inform themselves of, and observe, any such restrictions. Any failure to comply with such
restrictions may constitute a violation of the securities laws of any such jurisdiction. In particular, this
prospectus should not be distributed, forwarded or transmitted in, into or from any of the relevant
countries with or without the BLUE Application Forms, except to the Qualifying WXB Shareholders as
specified in this prospectus.
Receipt of this prospectus and/or the BLUE Application Forms does not and will not constitute an
offer in those jurisdictions in which it would be illegal to make an offer and, in those circumstances, this
prospectus and/or the BLUE Application Forms must be treated as sent for information only and should
not be copied or redistributed. Persons (including, without limitation, agents, custodians, nominees and
trustees) who receive a copy of this Prospectus and/or the BLUE Application Forms should not, in
connection with the Preferential Offering, distribute or send the same in, into or from, any of the relevant
countries. If the BLUE Application Form is received by any person in any such countries, or by his/her/its
agent or nominee, he/she/it should not apply for any Reserved Shares unless the directors of WuXi
Biologics and the Company determine that such actions would not violate the applicable legal or
regulatory requirements. Any person (including, without limitation, agents, custodians, nominees and
trustees) who forwards this prospectus and/or the BLUE Application Form(s) in, into or from any relevant
countries (whether under a contractual or legal obligation or otherwise) should draw the recipient’s
attention to the contents of this section.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 402 —


--- page 412 ---
4. Applying by Using BLUE Application Forms
(a) The BLUE Application Form will be rejected by the Company if:
 the BLUE Application Form is not completed in accordance with the instructions as
stated therein;
 the BLUE Application Form has not been duly signed (only written signatures are
acceptable) (or in the case of a joint application, not all applicants have signed);
 in respect of applicants who are corporate entities, the BLUE Application Form has not
been duly signed (only written signature is acceptable) by an authorized officer or affixed
with a company chop;
 the cheque/banker’s cashier order/ BLUE Application Form is defective;
 the BLUE Application Form for either Reserved Shares of Assured Entitlement or excess
Reserved Shares is not accompanied with a cheque/banker’s cashier order or is
accompanied by more than one cheque/banker’s cashier order for each of the application
for Assured Entitlement and excess application for Reserved Shares;
 the account name on the cheque/banker’s cashier order is not pre-printed or certified by
the issuing bank;
 the cheque/banker’s cashier order is not drawn on a Hong Kong dollar bank account in
Hong Kong;
 the name of the payee indicated on the cheque/banker’s cashier order is not “BANK OF
CHINA (HONG KONG) NOMINEES LIMITED — WUXI XDC PREFERENTIAL
OFFER”;
 the cheque has not been crossed “Account Payee Only”;
 the cheque was post-dated;
 the applicant’s payment is not made correctly or if the applicant pays by cheque or
banker’s cashier order the cheque or banker’s cashier order is dishonored on its first
presentation;
 the applicant’s name/the first applicant’s name on the joint application is not the same as
the name pre-printed or certified/endorsed by the drawee bank on the cheque/banker’s
cashier order;
 any alteration(s) to the application details on the BLUE Application Form has or have not
been initialed by the applicant(s);
 the application is completed by pencil;
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 403 —


--- page 413 ---
 the Company believes that by accepting the application, the Company would violate the
applicable securities or other laws, rules or regulations of the jurisdiction where the
BLUE Application Form is received or where the applicant’s address is located; or
 the Company and the Overall Coordinators, and their respective agents or nominees,
exercise their discretion to reject or accept any application, or to accept only part of any
application without giving any reason.
(b) If you are applying by using the BLUE Application Form for Assured Entitlement, you may
apply for a number of Reserved Shares under your Assured Entitlement that is equal to or less
than the number stated in Box B of the BLUE Application Form. If you intend to apply for a
number of Reserved Shares that is less than your Assured Entitlement, you MUST apply for
Reserved Shares of a number set out in the table in the BLUE Application Form and make a
payment of the corresponding amount (other than HKSCC Nominees). Y ou need to complete
and sign the BLUE Application Form for Assured Entitlement and submit one cheque (or
banker’s cashier order) for the exact amount of remittance printed in Box B or the
corresponding amount payable as set out in the table in the BLUE Application Form.
(c) If you are applying by using the BLUE Application Form for excess Reserved Shares, you
MUST apply for Reserved Shares of one of the numbers set out in the table in the BLUE
Application Form and make a payment of the corresponding amount (other than HKSCC
Nominees). Y ou need to complete and sign the BLUE Application Form for excess Reserved
Shares and submit one separate cheque (or banker’s cashier order) for the exact amount of
remittance.
(d) If you intend to apply for both Reserved Shares pursuant to your Assured Entitlement and
excess Reserved Shares, you must submit both the BLUE Application Form for Assured
Entitlement and the BLUE Application Form for excess Reserved Shares. Each BLUE
Application Form must be accompanied by a separate cheque (or banker’s cashier order) for the
exact amount of remittance.
5. When may Applications be Made
(a) Applications on BLUE Application Form(s)
Y our completed BLUE Application Form, together with a cheque or a banker’s cashier order attached
and marked payable to “BANK OF CHINA (HONG KONG) NOMINEES LIMITED — WUXI XDC
PREFERENTIAL OFFER” for the payment, should be deposited in the special collection boxes provided
at Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services Limited at 17M Floor, Hopewell Centre, 183 Queen’s
Road East, Wanchai, Hong Kong at the following times:
Tuesday, November 7, 2023 — 9:00 a.m. to 4:30 p.m.
Wednesday, November 8, 2023 — 9:00 a.m. to 4:30 p.m.
Thursday, November 9, 2023 — 9:00 a.m. to 4:30 p.m.
Friday, November 10, 2023 — 9:00 a.m. to 12:00 noon
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 404 —


--- page 414 ---
Completed BLUE Application Forms, together with payment attached, must be lodged by 12:00
noon on Friday, November 10, 2023, the last day for applications, or such later time as described in “—
E. Effect of Bad Weather and Extreme Conditions on the Opening and Closing of the Application Lists”
below.
(b) Application Lists
The application lists will be open from 11:45 a.m. to 12:00 noon on Friday, November 10, 2023, the
last day for applications, or such later time as described in “— E. Effect of Bad Weather and Extreme
Conditions on the Opening and Closing of the Application Lists” below.
6. How Many Applications May Be Made
Y ou should refer to “— A. Applications for the Hong Kong Offer Shares — 8. How Many
Applications Can Y ou Make” above for the situations where you may make an application for Hong Kong
Offer Shares under the Hong Kong Public Offering in addition to application(s) for Reserved Shares under
the Preferential Offering.
7. Additional Terms and Conditions and Instructions
Y ou should refer to the BLUE Application Form for details of the additional terms, conditions and
instructions which apply to applications for Reserved Shares.
C. W ARNING FOR ELECTRONIC APPLICATIONS
The subscription of the Hong Kong Offer Shares by giving electronic application instructions to
HKSCC is only a facility provided to CCASS Participants. Similarly, the application for Hong Kong Offer
Shares through the White Form eIPO service, is also only a facility provided by the White Form eIPO
Service Provider to public investors. Such facilities are subject to capacity limitations and potential
service interruptions and you are advised not to wait until the last application day in making your
electronic applications. Our Company, our Directors, the Joint Sponsors, the Overall Coordinators, the
Joint Global Coordinators, the Joint Bookrunners, the Joint Lead Managers and the Underwriters take no
responsibility for such applications and provide no assurance that any CCASS Participant or person
applying through the White Form eIPO service will be allotted any Hong Kong Offer Shares or Reserved
Shares (as the case may be).
To ensure that CCASS Investor Participants can give their electronic application instructions , they
are advised not to wait until the last minute to input their instructions to the systems. In the event that
CCASS Investor Participants have problems in the connection to CCASS Phone System/CCASS Internet
System for submission of electronic application instructions , they should go to HKSCC’s Customer
Service Centre to complete an input request form for electronic application instructions before 12:00
noon on Friday, November 10, 2023.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 405 —


--- page 415 ---
D. HOW MUCH ARE THE HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND THE RESERVED SHARES
The maximum Offer Price is HK$20.60 per Offer Share. Y ou must also pay brokerage of 1.0%, SFC
transaction levy of 0.0027%, Hong Kong Stock Exchange trading fee of 0.00565% and AFRC transaction
levy of 0.00015%. This means that for one board lot of 500 Hong Kong Offer Shares or one board lot of
500 Reserved Shares, you will pay HK$10,403.88.
Y ou must pay the maximum Offer Price, brokerage, SFC transaction levy, the Stock Exchange
trading fee and AFRC transaction levy in full upon application for the Hong Kong Offer Shares.
Y ou may submit an application through the White Form eIPO service or the CCASS EIPO service
in respect of a minimum of 500 Hong Kong Offer Shares. Each application or electronic application
instruction in respect of more than 500 Hong Kong Offer Shares must be in one of the numbers as sets
out in the table in “— A. Applications for the Hong Kong Offer Shares — 4. Minimum Application
Amount and Permitted Numbers” in this section, or as otherwise specified on the designated website at
www.eipo.com.hk .
For applicants on the BLUE Application Form, if the number of Reserved Shares applied for is not
one of the numbers set out in the table, you must calculate the correct amount payable on application by
using the formula set out in the BLUE Application Form.
If your application is successful, brokerage will be paid to the Exchange Participants (as defined in
the Listing Rules), and the SFC transaction levy, the Stock Exchange trading fee and AFRC transaction
levy are paid to the Stock Exchange (in the case of the SFC transaction levy, collected by the Stock
Exchange on behalf of the SFC, and in the case of AFRC transaction levy, collected by the Stock Exchange
on behalf of the AFRC).
For further details on the Offer Price, see “Structure of the Global Offering — Pricing and
Allocation” in this prospectus.
E. EFFECT OF BAD WEATHER AND EXTREME CONDITIONS ON THE OPENING AND
CLOSING OF THE APPLICATION LISTS
The application lists will not open or close if there is/are:
(a) a tropical cyclone warning signal number 8 or above;
(b) a “black” rainstorm warning; and/or
(c) Extreme Conditions,
in force in Hong Kong at any time between 9:00 a.m. and 12:00 noon on Friday, November 10, 2023.
Instead, they will open between 11:45 a.m. and 12:00 noon on the next business day which does not have
any of those warnings or Extreme Conditions in force in Hong Kong at any time between 9:00 a.m. and
12:00 noon.
If the application lists do not open and close on Friday, November 10, 2023 or if there is/are a
tropical cyclone warning signal number 8 or above, a “black” rainstorm warning signal and/or Extreme
Conditions in force in Hong Kong that may affect the dates mentioned in the section headed “Expected
Timetable” in this prospectus, we will make an announcement on our websites at www.wuxixdc.com and
the website of the Hong Kong Stock Exchange at www.hkexnews.hk .
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 406 —


--- page 416 ---
F. PUBLICATION OF RESULTS
We expect to announce the pricing of the Offer Shares on Thursday, November 16, 2023 on our
website at www.wuxixdc.com and the website of the Hong Kong Stock Exchange at www.hkexnews.hk .
We expect to announce the level of indications of interest in the International Offering, the level of
applications in the Hong Kong Public Offering and the Preferential Offering and the basis of allocations
of the Hong Kong Offer Shares and the Reserved Shares on Thursday, November 16, 2023 on our website
at www.wuxixdc.com and the website of the Hong Kong Stock Exchange at www.hkexnews.hk .
The results of allocations and the Hong Kong identity card/passport/Hong Kong business registration
numbers of successful applicants under the Hong Kong Public Offering and the Preferential Offering will
be available at the times and dates and in the manner set out below:
(a) in the announcement to be posted on our website and the website of the Hong Kong Stock
Exchange at www.wuxixdc.com and www.hkexnews.hk , respectively, by no later than 9:00
a.m. on Thursday, November 16, 2023;
(b) from the designated results of allocations website at www.iporesults.com.hk (alternatively:
English https://www.eipo.com.hk/en/Allotment ; Chinese https://www.eipo.com.hk/zh-hk/Allotment )
with a “search by ID” function on a 24 hour basis from 8:00 a.m. on Thursday, November 16,
2023 to 12:00 midnight on Wednesday, November 22, 2023; and
(c) from the allocation results telephone enquiry line by calling +852 2862 8555 between 9:00 a.m.
and 6:00 p.m. on Thursday, November 16, 2023, Friday, November 17, 2023, Monday,
November 20, 2023 and Tuesday, November 21, 2023.
If we accept your offer to purchase (in whole or in part), which we may do by announcing the basis
of allocations and/or making available the results of allocations publicly, there will be a binding contract
under which you will be required to purchase the Hong Kong Offer Shares and/or the Reserved Shares (as
the case may be) if all the conditions of the Global Offering are satisfied and the Global Offering is not
otherwise terminated. Further details are set out in “Structure of the Global Offering.”
Y ou will not be entitled to exercise any remedy of rescission for innocent misrepresentation at any
time after acceptance of your application. This does not affect any other right you may have.
G. CIRCUMSTANCES IN WHICH YOU WILL NOT BE ALLOCATED THE HONG KONG
OFFER SHARES AND/OR THE RESERVED SHARES
Y ou should note the following situations in which the Hong Kong Offer Shares will not be allocated
to you:
(i) If your application is revoked:
By applying through the CCASS EIPO service or through the White Form eIPO service, you agree
that your application or the application made by HKSCC Nominees on your behalf cannot be revoked on
or before the fifth day after the time of opening of the application lists (excluding any days which is
Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in Hong Kong). This agreement will take effect as a collateral contract
with us.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 407 —


--- page 417 ---
Y our application or the application made by HKSCC Nominees on your behalf may only be revoked
on or before the fifth day after the time of opening of the application lists (excluding any days which is
Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in Hong Kong) in the following circumstances:
(a) if a person responsible for this prospectus under Section 40 of the Companies (Winding Up and
Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance (as applied by Section 342E of the Companies (Winding
Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance) gives a public notice under that section on or
before the fifth day after the time of the opening of the application lists (excluding any day
which is a Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in Hong Kong) which excludes or limits that
person’s responsibility for this prospectus; or
(b) if any supplement to this prospectus is issued, in which case we will notify applicants who have
already submitted an application that they are required to confirm their applications. If
applicants have been so notified but have not confirmed their applications in accordance with
the procedure to be notified, all unconfirmed applications will be deemed revoked.
If your application or the application made by HKSCC Nominees on your behalf has been accepted,
it cannot be revoked. For this purpose, acceptance of applications which are not rejected will be
constituted by notification in the press of the results of allocation, and where such basis of allocation is
subject to certain conditions or provides for allocation by ballot, such acceptance will be subject to the
satisfaction of such conditions or results of the ballot, respectively.
(ii) If we or our agents exercise discretion to reject your application:
We, the Overall Coordinators, the White Form eIPO Service Provider and our and their respective
agents or nominees have full discretion to reject or accept any application, or to accept only part of any
application, without giving any reasons.
(iii) If the allotment of Hong Kong Offer Shares and/or Reserved Shares is void:
The allotment of Hong Kong Offer Shares and/or Reserved Shares will be void if the Listing
Committee of the Stock Exchange does not grant permission to list the Shares either:
 within three weeks from the closing date of the application lists; or
 within a longer period of up to six weeks if the Listing Committee notifies the Company of that
longer period within three weeks of the closing date of the application lists.
(iv) If:
(a) you make multiple applications or are suspected of making multiple applications (other than an
application (if any) made on the BLUE Application Form in your capacity as a Qualifying
WXB Shareholder);
(b) you or the person for whose benefit you apply for, have applied for or taken up, or indicated
an interest for, or have been or will be placed or allocated (including conditionally and/or
provisionally) the Hong Kong Offer Shares and the International Offer Shares (except in
respect of Reserved Shares applied for pursuant to the Preferential Offering);
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 408 —


--- page 418 ---
(c) your payment is not made correctly;
(d) your electronic application instructions through the White Form eIPO service are not
completed in accordance with the instructions, terms and conditions on the designated website
at www.eipo.com.hk ;
(e) you apply for more than 50% of the Hong Kong Offer Shares initially available under the Hong
Kong Public Offering;
(f) we or the Overall Coordinators believe that by accepting your application, a violation of
applicable securities or other laws, rules or regulations would result; or
(g) the Underwriting Agreements do not become unconditional or are terminated.
H. REFUND OF APPLICATION MONIES
If an application is rejected, not accepted or accepted in part only, or if the Hong Kong Offer Price
as finally determined is less than the maximum Hong Kong Offer Price per Offer Share (excluding
brokerage, SFC transaction levy, AFRC transaction levy and Hong Kong Stock Exchange trading fee
payable thereon) paid on application, or if the conditions of the Global Offering as set out in “Structure
of the Global Offering — Conditions of the Global Offering” are not satisfied or if any application is
revoked, the application monies, or the appropriate portion thereof, together with the related brokerage,
SFC transaction levy, AFRC transaction levy and Hong Kong Stock Exchange trading fee, will be
refunded, without interest.
Any refund of your application monies will be made on or before Thursday, November 16, 2023.
I. DISPATCH/COLLECTION OF SHARE CERTIFICATES/e-REFUND PAYMENT
INSTRUCTIONS/REFUND CHEQUES
Y ou will receive one share certificate for all Hong Kong Offer Shares allocated to you under the
Hong Kong Public Offering (except pursuant to applications made through the CCASS EIPO service
where the share certificates will be deposited into CCASS as described below) and one share certificate
for all Reserved Shares allocated to you under the Preferential Offering.
The Company will not issue temporary document of title in respect of the Offer Shares. The
Company will not issue receipt for sums paid on application.
Subject to arrangement on dispatch/collection of share certificates and refund cheques as mentioned
below, any refund cheques and share certificate(s) are expected to be posted on or before Thursday,
November 16, 2023. The right is reserved to retain any share certificate(s) and any surplus application
monies pending clearance of check(s) or banker’s cashier order(s).
Share certificates will only become valid evidence of title at 8:00 a.m. on Friday, November 17,
2023, provided that the Global Offering has become unconditional in all respects at or before that time.
Investors who trade Shares on the basis of publicly available allocation details or prior to the receipt
of the share certificates or prior to the share certificates becoming valid do so entirely at their own risk.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 409 —


--- page 419 ---
Personal Collection
If you apply through White Form eIPO service:
(a) If you apply for 1,000,000 or more Hong Kong Offer Shares through the White Form eIPO service,
you may collect your share certificate(s) from Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services Limited
at Shops 1712-1716, 17/F Hopewell Centre, 183 Queen’s Road East, Wanchai, Hong Kong, from
9:00 a.m. to 1:00 p.m. on Thursday, November 16, 2023, or such other date as notified by our
Company by announcement as the date of despatch/collection of share certificates/e-Refund payment
instructions/refund cheques.
(b) If you do not collect your share certificate(s) personally within the time specified for collection, they
will be sent to the address specified in your application instructions by ordinary post at your own
risk.
(c) If you apply for less than 1,000,000 Hong Kong Offer Shares through the White Form eIPO service,
your share certificate(s) (where applicable) will be sent to the address specified in your application
instructions on or before Thursday, November 16, 2023 by ordinary post at your own risk.
(d) If you apply and pay the application monies from a single bank account, any refund monies will be
despatched to that bank account in the form of e-Refund instructions. If you apply and pay the
application monies from multiple bank accounts, any refund monies will be despatched to the
address as specified in your application instructions in the form of refund cheque(s) in your name
(or, in the case of joint applications, the first-named applicant) by ordinary post at your own risk.
If you apply through CCASS EIPO service:
Allocation of the Hong Kong Offer Shares
For the purposes of allocating the Hong Kong Offer Shares, HKSCC Nominees will not be treated
as an applicant. Instead, each CCASS Participant who gives electronic application instructions or each
person for whose benefit instructions are given will be treated as an applicant.
Deposit of Share Certificates into CCASS and Refund of Application Monies
(a) If your application is wholly or partially successful, your share certificate(s) will be issued in the
name of HKSCC Nominees and deposited into CCASS for the credit of your designated CCASS
Participant’s stock account or your CCASS Investor Participant stock account on Thursday,
November 16, 2023 or on any other date determined by HKSCC or HKSCC Nominees.
(b) We expect to publish the application results of CCASS Participants (and where the CCASS
Participant is a broker or custodian , we will include information relating to the relevant beneficial
owner), your Hong Kong identity card/passport/Hong Kong business registration number or other
identification code (Hong Kong business registration number for corporations) and the basis of
allocations of the Hong Kong Offer Shares in the manner as described in the paragraph headed “—
F. Publication of Results” above on Thursday, November 16, 2023. Y ou should check the
announcement published by us and report any discrepancies to HKSCC before 5:00 p.m. on
Thursday, November 16, 2023 or such other date as determined by HKSCC or HKSCC Nominees.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 410 —


--- page 420 ---
(c) If you have instructed your broker or custodian who is a CCASS Clearing Participant or a CCASS
Custodian Participant to give electronic application instructions via CCASS terminals to apply for
the Hong Kong Offer Shares on your behalf, you can also check the number of the Hong Kong Offer
Shares allocated to you and the amount of refund monies (if any) payable to you with that broker
or custodian .
(d) If you have applied as a CCASS Investor Participant, you can also check the number of the Hong
Kong Offer Shares allocated to you and the amount of refund monies (if any) payable to you via the
CCASS Phone System and the CCASS Internet System (under the procedures contained in HKSCC’s
“An Operating Guide for Investor Participants” in effect from time to time) on Thursday, November
16, 2023. Immediately following the credit of the Hong Kong Offer Shares to your stock account and
the credit of the refund monies to your bank account, HKSCC will also make available to you an
activity statement showing the number of the Hong Kong Offer Shares credited to your CCASS
Investor Participant stock account and the amount of refund monies (if any) credited to your
designated bank account.
(e) Refund of your application monies (if any) in respect of wholly and partially unsuccessful
applications and/or difference between the Hong Kong Offer Price and the maximum Hong Kong
Offer Price per Offer Share initially paid on application (including brokerage, SFC transaction levy,
AFRC transaction levy and Hong Kong Stock Exchange trading fee but without interest) will be
credited to your designated bank account or the designated bank account of your broker or
custodian on Thursday, November 16, 2023.
If you apply using a BLUE Application Form:
If you apply for 1,000,000 or more Reserved Shares on a BLUE Application Form and have provided
all information required by your BLUE Application Form, you may collect your refund cheque(s) and/or
share certificate(s) from our Hong Kong Share Registrar, Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services
Limited at Shops 1712-1716, 17/F Hopewell Centre, 183 Queen’s Road East, Wanchai, Hong Kong, from
9:00 a.m. to 1:00 p.m. on Thursday, November 16, 2023 or such other date as notified by us by
announcement.
If you are an individual who is eligible for personal collection, you must not authorize any other
person to collect for you. If you are a corporate applicant which is eligible for personal collection, your
authorized representative must bear a letter of authorization from your corporation stamped with your
corporation’s chop. Both individuals and authorized representatives must produce, at the time of
collection, evidence of identity acceptable to the Hong Kong Share Registrar.
If you do not collect your refund cheque(s) and/or share certificate(s) personally within the time
specified for collection, they will be despatched promptly to the address specified in your BLUE
Application Form by ordinary post at your own risk.
If you apply for less than 1,000,000 Reserved Shares on a BLUE Application Form, your refund
cheque(s) and/or share certificate(s) will be sent to the address on the BLUE Application Form on or
before Thursday, November 16, 2023, by ordinary post and at your own risk.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
—4 1 1—


--- page 421 ---
J. ADMISSION OF THE SHARES INTO CCASS
If the Hong Kong Stock Exchange grants the listing of, and permission to deal in, the Shares and we
comply with the stock admission requirements of HKSCC, the Shares will be accepted as eligible
securities by HKSCC for deposit, clearance and settlement in CCASS with effect from the date of
commencement of dealings in the Shares on the Hong Kong Stock Exchange or any other date HKSCC
chooses. Settlement of transactions between Exchange Participants (as defined in the Listing Rules) is
required to take place in CCASS on the second settlement day after any trading day.
All activities under CCASS are subject to the General Rules of CCASS and CCASS Operational
Procedures in effect from time to time.
Investors should seek the advice of their stockbroker or other professional adviser for details of the
settlement arrangements as such arrangements may affect their rights and interests.
We have made all necessary arrangements to enable the Shares to be admitted into CCASS.
HOW TO APPLY FOR HONG KONG OFFER SHARES AND RESERVED SHARES
— 412 —


--- page 422 ---
The following is the text of a report set out on pages I-1 to I-110, received from the Company’ s
reporting accountants, Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu, Certified Public Accountants, Hong Kong, for the
purpose of incorporation in this prospectus.
ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION TO THE
DIRECTORS OF WUXI XDC CAYMAN INC. AND MORGAN STANLEY ASIA LIMITED,
GOLDMAN SACHS (ASIA) L.L.C. AND J.P. MORGAN SECURITIES (FAR EAST) LIMITED
Introduction
We report on the historical financial information of WuXi XDC Cayman Inc. (the “Company”) and
its subsidiaries (collectively referred to as the “Group”) set out on pages I-4 to I-110, which comprises the
consolidated statements of financial position of the Group as at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and
June 30, 2023, the statements of financial position of the Company as at December 31, 2020, 2021 and
2022, and June 30, 2023, and the consolidated statements of profit or loss and other comprehensive
income, the consolidated statements of changes in equity and the consolidated statements of cash flows
of the Group for each of the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and six months ended June
30, 2023 (the “Track Record Period”) and material accounting policy information and other explanatory
information (together, the “Historical Financial Information”). The Historical Financial Information set
out on pages I-4 to I-110 forms an integral part of this report, which has been prepared for inclusion in
the prospectus of the Company dated November 7, 2023 (the “Prospectus”) in connection with the initial
listing of shares of the Company on the Main Board of The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited (the
“Stock Exchange”).
Directors’ responsibility for the Historical Financial Information
The directors of the Company are responsible for the preparation of the Historical Financial
Information that gives a true and fair view in accordance with the basis of preparation and presentation
set out in Note 2 to the Historical Financial Information, and for such internal control as the directors of
the Company determine is necessary to enable the preparation of the Historical Financial Information that
is free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.
Reporting accountants’ responsibility
Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Historical Financial Information and to report our
opinion to you. We conducted our work in accordance with Hong Kong Standard on Investment Circular
Reporting Engagements 200 “Accountants’ Reports on Historical Financial Information in Investment
Circulars” issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants (the “HKICPA”). This
standard requires that we comply with ethical standards and plan and perform our work to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the Historical Financial Information is free from material
misstatement.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-1 —


--- page 423 ---
Our work involved performing procedures to obtain evidence about the amounts and disclosures in
the Historical Financial Information. The procedures selected depend on the reporting accountants’
judgement, including the assessment of risks of material misstatement of the Historical Financial
Information, whether due to fraud or error. In making those risk assessments, the reporting accountants
consider internal control relevant to the entity’s preparation of the Historical Financial Information that
gives a true and fair view in accordance with the basis of preparation and presentation set out in Note 2
to the Historical Financial Information in order to design procedures that are appropriate in the
circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the entity’s internal
control. Our work also included evaluating the appropriateness of accounting policies used and the
reasonableness of accounting estimates made by the directors of the Company, as well as evaluating the
overall presentation of the Historical Financial Information.
We believe that the evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for
our opinion.
Opinion
In our opinion, the Historical Financial Information gives, for the purposes of the accountants’
report, a true and fair view of the Group’s and the Company’s financial positions as at December 31, 2020,
2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023 and of the Group’s financial performance and cash flows for the Track
Record Period in accordance with the basis of preparation and presentation set out in Note 2 to the
Historical Financial Information.
Review of stub period comparative financial information
We have reviewed the stub period comparative financial information of the Group which comprises
the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income, the consolidated statement
of changes in equity and the consolidated statement of cash flows for six months ended June 30, 2022 and
other explanatory information (the “Stub Period Comparative Financial Information”). The directors of the
Company are responsible for the preparation and presentation of the Stub Period Comparative Financial
Information in accordance with the basis of preparation and presentation set out in Note 2 to the Historical
Financial Information. Our responsibility is to express a conclusion on the Stub Period Comparative
Financial Information based on our review. We conducted our review in accordance with Hong Kong
Standard on Review Engagements 2410 “Review of Interim Financial Information Performed by the
Independent Auditor of the Entity” issued by the HKICPA. A review consists of making inquiries,
primarily of persons responsible for financial and accounting matters, and applying analytical and other
review procedures. A review is substantially less in scope than an audit conducted in accordance with
Hong Kong Standards on Auditing and consequently does not enable us to obtain assurance that we would
become aware of all significant matters that might be identified in an audit. Accordingly, we do not express
an audit opinion. Based on our review, nothing has come to our attention that causes us to believe that the
Stub Period Comparative Financial Information, for the purposes of the accountants’ report, is not
prepared, in all material respects, in accordance with the basis of preparation and presentation set out in
Note 2 to the Historical Financial Information.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-2 —


--- page 424 ---
Report on matters under the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on the Stock Exchange and
the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance
Adjustments
In preparing the Historical Financial Information, no adjustments to the Underlying Financial
Statements as defined on page I-4 have been made.
Dividends
We refer to Note 14 to the Historical Financial Information which contains information about the
dividends declared and paid by the Company in respect of the Track Record Period and states that no
dividend was declared or paid by the Company since its incorporation.
Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu
Certified Public Accountants
Hong Kong
November 7, 2023
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-3 —


--- page 425 ---
HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE GROUP
Preparation of Historical Financial Information
Set out below is the Historical Financial Information which forms an integral part of this
accountants’ report.
The consolidated financial statements of the Group for the Track Record Period, on which the
Historical Financial Information in this report is based, have been prepared in accordance with the
accounting policies which conform with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRSs”) issued by
the International Accounting Standards Board (the “IASB”) and were audited by us in accordance with
International Standards on Auditing issued by the International Auditing and Assurance Standards Board
(the “Underlying Financial Statements”).
The Historical Financial Information is presented in Renminbi (“RMB”) and all values are rounded
to the nearest thousand (RMB’000) except when otherwise indicated.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-4 —


--- page 426 ---
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF PROFIT OR LOSS AND OTHER COMPREHENSIVE
INCOME
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
Notes 2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Revenue ................... 6 96,353 311,131 990,423 329,436 993,468
Cost of services ............. (88,272) (197,637) (729,340) (225,481) (764,068)
Gross profit ................ 8,081 113,494 261,083 103,955 229,400
Other income ............... 7 41,446 8,966 26,152 18,812 39,579
Other gains and losses ......... 8 (2,711) (855) 46,672 25,679 4,461
Impairment losses (recognized)
reversed, under expected credit
loss model, net of reversal .... 1 0 (289) (10,558) (43,369) 2,976 24,382
Selling and marketing expenses . . (478) (2,028) (8,769) (4,152) (5,823)
Administrative expenses ....... (9,608) (27,858) (49,210) (15,248) (42,739)
Listing expenses ............. — — — — (7,374)
Research and development
expenses ................. (4,075) (13,815) (33,842) (11,059) (29,749)
Finance costs ............... 9 — (493) (2,916) (1,573) (569)
Profit before tax ............. 1 0 32,366 66,853 195,801 119,390 211,568
Income tax expenses .......... 1 1 (6,067) (11,923) (40,070) (21,123) (34,354)
Profit for the year/period ..... 26,299 54,930 155,731 98,267 177,214
Other comprehensive income
(expense)
Items that may be reclassified
subsequently to profit or loss:
Fair value gain(loss) on hedging
instruments designated in cash
flow hedges, net of income tax. 1,668 499 (3,313) (4,025) 1,146
Exchange gain arising on
translation of foreign
operations ................ — — — — 4,635
Other comprehensive income
(expense) for the year/period . 1,668 499 (3,313) (4,025) 5,781
Total comprehensive income for
the year/period ............ 27,967 55,429 152,418 94,242 182,995
Earnings per share
Basic (RMB) ............... 1 3 0.04 0.09 0.18 0.14 0.18
Diluted (RMB) .............. 0.04 0.09 0.18 0.14 0.17
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-5 —


--- page 427 ---
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL POSITION
As at December 31,
As at
June 30,
Notes 2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Non-current assets
Property, plant and equipment ......... 1 5 303,205 335,684 798,575 987,555
Investment property ................. 1 6 — 13,215 12,812 12,610
Right-of-use assets ................. 1 7 — 2,223 5,280 4,529
Goodwill ........................ 1 8 — 215,193 215,193 215,193
Intangible assets ................... 2 0 4,808 60,990 50,648 57,047
Deferred tax assets ................. 1 9 3 8 7 1,995 11,540 8,557
Other long term deposits and
prepayments .................... 1 5 0 1 5 0 — 3 6 8
308,550 629,450 1,094,048 1,285,859
Current assets
Inventories ....................... 2 2 7,678 23,786 62,934 47,403
Trade and other receivables ........... 2 4 44,060 150,236 505,604 757,245
Contract assets .................... 2 5 1,028 10,717 17,309 24,665
Contract costs ..................... 2 3 13,875 36,690 80,713 63,134
Tax recoverable .................... 2,66 3———
Derivative financial assets ............ 3 0 2,224 2,549 799 —
Financial assets at fair value through
profit or loss (“FVTPL”) ........... 2 1 — — 400,000 —
Bank balances and cash .............. 2 6 28,390 26,325 334,972 561,644
99,918 250,303 1,402,331 1,454,091
Current liabilities
Trade and other payables ............. 2 7 32,080 818,653 773,313 773,149
Loans from related parties ............ 2 8 — 22,343 71,144 —
Contract liabilities .................. 2 9 1 5 1 10,020 151,450 232,418
Income tax payable ................. — 5,225 11,506 30,457
Lease liabilities .................... 3 1 — 2,249 4,413 2,828
Derivative financial liabilities ......... 3 0 — — 2,147 —
32,231 858,490 1,013,973 1,038,852
Net current assets (liabilities) ........ 67,687 (608,187) 388,358 415,239
Total assets less current liabilities ..... 376,237 21,263 1,482,406 1,701,098
Non-current liabilities
Deferred tax liabilities ............... 1 9 5 5 6 3 8 2 — —
Lease liabilities .................... 3 1 — — 1,627 2,477
Net assets ........................ 375,681 20,881 1,480,779 1,698,621
Capital and reserves
Share capital ...................... 3 2 — — 3 1 9 3 1 9
Reserves ......................... 375,681 20,881 1,480,460 1,698,302
Total equity ...................... 375,681 20,881 1,480,779 1,698,621
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-6 —


--- page 428 ---
STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL POSITION OF THE COMPANY
As at December 31,
As at
June 30,
Notes 2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Non-current asset
Investment in subsidiaries ......... 4 1 — — 1,334,030 1,364,229
Current assets
Other receivables ............... 2 4 — — — 1,054
Bank balances and cash .......... — 3 2 9 5 9 1 5 4
— 329 591 1,108
Current liability
Other payables ................. 2 7 — 9 6 9 1,812 10,031
Net current liability ............ — (640) (1,221) (8,923)
Total assets less current liability/
Net (liabilities) assets .......... — (640) 1,332,809 1,355,306
Capital and reserves
Share capital .................. 3 2 — — 3 1 9 3 1 9
Reserves ..................... 4 2 — (640) 1,332,490 1,354,987
Total (deficit) equity ............ — (640) 1,332,809 1,355,306
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-7 —


--- page 429 ---
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN EQUITY
Share
capital
Share
premium
Merger
reserve
Special
reserve
Other
reserve
Statutory
reserve
Equity-settled
share-based
compensation
reserve
Cash flow
hedging
reserve
Foreign
currency
translation
reserve
(Accumulated
loss) Retained
earnings Total
(note ii) (note iii) (note v) (note i) (note iv)
As at January 1, 2020. . . — — 275,048 16,062 885 73 — — — (8,989) 283,079
Profit for the year .... — — — — — — — — — 26,299 26,299
Other comprehensive
income for the year
– Fair value adjustments
on cash flow hedges. . — — — — — — — 1,668 — — 1,668
Total comprehensive
income for the year . . — — — — — — — 1,668 — 26,299 27,967
Transfer to statutory
reserve ....... — — — — — 5 7 0 — — — (570) —
Recognition of equity-
settled share-based
compensation ..... — — — — 6,476 — — — — — 6,476
Capital contribution from
equity holders of
XDC Wuxi
(note ii(a)) ...... — — 69,116 — — — — — — — 69,116
Deemed contribution from
equity holders of the
Company
(note ii(c)) ...... — — 2,852 — — — — — — — 2,852
Net distribution to
Biologics Shanghai
(note iii(a)) ..... — — — (13,809) — — — — — — (13,809)
Profit for the year from
BCD Business Unit
transferred to special
reserve (note iii(b)) . . — — — 18,736 — — — — — (18,736) —
As at December 31, 2020 . — — 347,016 20,989 7,361 643 — 1,668 — (1,996) 375,681
Profit for the year .... — — — — — — — — — 54,930 54,930
Other comprehensive
income for the year
– Fair value adjustments
on cash flow hedges. . — — — — — — — 499 — — 499
Total comprehensive
income for the year . . — — — — — — — 499 — 54,930 55,429
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-8 —


--- page 430 ---
Share
capital
Share
premium
Merger
reserve
Special
reserve
Other
reserve
Statutory
reserve
Equity-settled
share-based
compensation
reserve
Cash flow
hedging
reserve
Foreign
currency
translation
reserve
(Accumulated
loss) Retained
earnings Total
(note ii) (note iii) (note v) (note i) (note iv)
Transfer to statutory
reserve ....... — — — — — 5,558 — — — (5,558) —
Recognition of equity-
settled share-based
compensation ..... — — — — 22,157 — — — — — 22,157
Deemed distribution to
equity holders of
the company
(note ii(b)) ...... — — (404,413) — — — — — — — (404,413)
Deemed contribution from
equity holders of the
Company (note ii(c)) . — — 3,650 — — — — — — — 3,650
Net distribution to
Biologics Shanghai
(note iii(a)) ..... — — — (31,623) — — — — — — (31,623)
Profit for the year from
BCD Business Unit
transferred to special
reserve (note iii(b)) . . — — — 27,242 — — — — — (27,242) —
As at December 31,
2021 ........ — — (53,747) 16,608 29,518 6,201 — 2,167 — 20,134 20,881
Profit for the year .... — — — — — — — — — 155,731 155,731
Other comprehensive
expense for the year. .
– Fair value adjustments
on cash flow hedges. . — — — — — — — (3,313) — — (3,313)
Total comprehensive
(expense) income for
the year ....... — — — — — — — (3,313) — 155,731 152,418
Transfer to statutory
reserve ....... — — — — — 6,666 — — — (6,666) —
Recognition of equity-
settled share-based
compensation ..... — — — — 10,876 — 27,750 — — — 38,626
Shares fully paid
(Note 32) ...... 3 1 9 1,285,143 — — — — — — — — 1,285,462
Deemed distribution to
Biologics Shanghai
(note iii(a)) ..... — — — (16,608) — — — — — — (16,608)
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-9 —


--- page 431 ---
Share
capital
Share
premium
Merger
reserve
Special
reserve
Other
reserve
Statutory
reserve
Equity-settled
share-based
compensation
reserve
Cash flow
hedging
reserve
Foreign
currency
translation
reserve
(Accumulated
loss) Retained
earnings Total
(note ii) (note iii) (note v) (note i) (note iv)
As at December 31,
2022 ........ 3 1 9 1,285,143 (53,747) — 40,394 12,867 27,750 (1,146) — 169,199 1,480,779
Profit for the period . . . — — — — — — — — — 177,214 177,214
Other comprehensive
income for the
period ........
– Fair value adjustments
on cash flow
hedges ....... — — — — — — — 1,146 — — 1,146
– Exchange gain arising
on translation of
foreign operations . . — — — — — — — — 4,635 — 4,635
Total comprehensive
income for
the period ...... — — — — — — — 1,146 4,635 177,214 182,995
Recognition of equity-
settled share-based
compensation .... — — — — 4,702 — 30,145 — — — 34,847
As at June 30, 2023 . . . 319 1,285,143 (53,747) — 45,096 12,867 57,895 — 4,635 346,413 1,698,621
As at December 31,
2021 ........ — — (53,747) 16,608 29,518 6,201 — 2,167 — 20,134 20,881
Profit for the period . . . — — — — — — — — — 98,267 98,267
Other comprehensive
expense for the period
– Fair value adjustments
on cash flow hedges. . — — — — — — — (4,025) — — (4,025)
Total comprehensive
(expense) income for
the period ...... — — — — — — — (4,025) — 98,267 94,242
Recognition of equity-
settled share-based
compensation ..... — — — — 8,804 — 1,791 — — — 10,595
Shares fully paid
(Note 32) ...... 3 1 9 1,285,143 — — — — — — — — 1,285,462
Deemed distribution to
Biologics Shanghai
(note iii(a)) ..... — — — (16,608) — — — — — — (16,608)
As at June 30, 2022
(unaudited) ..... 3 1 9 1,285,143 (53,747) — 38,322 6,201 1,791 (1,858) — 118,401 1,394,572
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-10 —


--- page 432 ---
Notes:
i. In accordance with the Articles of Association of all subsidiaries established in the People’s Republic of China (the “PRC”),
they are required to transfer 10% of the profit after tax to the statutory reserve until the reserve reaches 50% of their registered
capital. Transfer to this reserve must be made before distributing dividends to equity holders. The statutory reserve can be
used to make up for previous years’ losses, expand the existing operations or convert into additional capital of the subsidiaries.
ii. Merger reserve as of January 1, 2020 represents the capital contribution in WuXi XDC Co., Ltd. (“XDC Wuxi”) by the then
shareholders before the transfer of XDC Wuxi (as set out in Note 2). The amounts recorded in merger reserve during the Track
Record Period are resulted from the following movements:
a. The movement represents additional capital injection into XDC Wuxi by the then shareholders before the transfer of
XDC Wuxi.
b. The amount represents consideration paid/payable by the Group for acquisition of XDC Wuxi from the then
shareholders.
c. The movement represents administrative service cost borne on behalf of XDC Wuxi by fellow subsidiaries that the then
shareholders did not demand repayment, hence it was treated as a deemed contribution from equity holders of the
Company.
iii. Historically, part of the Group’s principal business, which is discovery and development platform for antibody drug
conjugates, was carried out by WuXi Biologics (Shanghai) Co., Ltd. (“Biologics Shanghai”), a wholly-owned subsidiary of
WuXi Biologics (Cayman) Inc. (“Biologics Cayman”) during the Track Record Period until, as part of the Transfers (as
defined in Note 2), Biologics Shanghai ceased to operate discovery and development service for antibody drug conjugates (the
“BCD Business Unit”) and transferred to WuXi XDC (Shanghai) Co., Ltd. (“XDC Shanghai”) all relevant assets and liabilities
related specifically to the discovery and development service (the “Business Transfer”), as further disclosed in Note 2.
The special reserve reflects reserve movements related to the operations of the BCD Business Unit.
a. The net distribution to Biologics Shanghai represents the funding generated by the BCD Business Unit and retained
in Biologics Shanghai prior to the Business Transfer.
b. The profit in respect of the operations of the BCD Business Unit carried out by Biologics Shanghai prior to the
Business Transfer was legally belonged to Biologics Shanghai. As such profit is non-distributable, the net profit in
respect of the BCD Business Unit was transferred to special reserve.
iv. The amount represents the equity-settled share-based compensation in respect of share option for shares of Company granted
by the Group to certain directors and employees of the Group for their services rendered to the Group as set out in Note 38.
v. The amount represents the equity-settled share-based compensation in respect of share options for shares of Biologics
Cayman, the ultimate holding company of the Company granted by Biologics Cayman to certain directors and employees of
the Group for their service rendered to the Group.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-11 —


--- page 433 ---
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
OPERATING ACTIVITIES
Profit before tax .............. 32,366 66,853 195,801 119,390 211,568
Adjustments for:
Finance costs ................ — 4 9 3 2,916 1,573 569
Interest income from banks ...... (31) (28) (4,612) (562) (3,424)
Depreciation of property, plant and
equipment ................. 13,008 16,279 17,510 8,092 17,740
Depreciation of investment
property .................. — 1 6 8 4 0 3 2 0 2 2 0 2
Depreciation of right-of-use assets . — 846 4,959 2,710 1,856
Amortization of intangible assets . . 457 1,688 7,940 2,868 2,952
Impairment losses, net of reversal
– Trade and other receivables .... 2 8 9 10,556 43,220 (2,976) (25,967)
– Contract assets ............. — 2 1 4 9 — 1,585
Write down of inventories, net of
reversal .................. — 3 6 3 1 2 0 5 8 2 7 3
Write down of contract costs ..... 1 3,810 2,005 3,929 765
Net foreign exchange (gain) loss . . (889) 331 (8,162) (15,498) 223
Loss (gain) on disposal of
property, plant and equipment . . — 108 65 29 (19)
Share-based compensation
expense .................. 6,476 22,157 38,626 10,595 31,780
Operating cash flows before
movements in working capital . . 51,677 123,626 300,940 130,410 240,103
Decrease (increase) in inventories . 4,059 (16,471) (39,268) (11,563) 15,258
Increase in trade and other
receivables ................ (13,136) (116,732) (592,233) (154,009) (224,622)
Decrease (increase) in other long-
term deposits and
prepayments ............... — — 1 5 0 1 5 0 (368)
Decrease (increase) in contract
assets .................... 2 1 7 (9,689) (9,776) (5,938) (8,941)
(Increase) decrease in contract
costs ..................... (9,392) (20,716) (45,481) (32,335) 25,131
(Decrease) increase in trade and
other payables .............. (3,696) 94,892 539,030 141,498 44,723
Increase in contract liabilities .... 1 0 3 9,869 141,587 97,858 80,968
Cash generated from operations . . . 29,832 64,779 294,949 166,071 172,252
Income taxes paid ............. (8,978) (5,643) (43,133) (13,112) (12,621)
NET CASH FROM
OPERATING ACTIVITIES . . . 20,854 59,136 251,816 152,959 159,631
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-12 —


--- page 434 ---
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
INVESTING ACTIVITIES
Proceeds on disposal of property,
plant and equipment ......... 4 2 5 2 9 2 1,640 625 617
Payments for property, plant and
equipment ................. (49,280) (50,753) (201,382) (179,699) (247,805)
Payments for intangible assets . . . (3,600) — — — (10,000)
Payments for right-of-use assets . . — (1,154) — — —
Receipt of bank interest income. . . 31 28 4,612 562 3,424
Payment for transfer of
XDC Wuxi to the Group ...... — — (404,413) (404,413) —
Settlement of consideration
payable for acquisition of
Payload and Linker Business . . . — — (280,000) (280,000) —
Settlement of consideration
payable for acquisition of BCD
Business Unit ............. ———— (9,877)
Placement of financial assets at
FVTPL ................... — — (400,000) — (1,068,843)
Withdrawal of financial assets at
FVTPL ................... ———— 1,469,601
NET CASH (USED IN) FROM
INVESTING ACTIVITIES .... (52,424) (51,587) (1,279,543) (862,925) 137,117
FINANCING ACTIVITIES
Loans from related parties ....... — 22,343 137,255 86,216 28,626
Repayments of loans from related
parties ................... — — (88,454) (37,315) (99,770)
Repayments of lease liabilities . . . — — (5,725) (2,581) (2,332)
Interest paid ................. — — (325) (192) (149)
Payment of accrued issue costs . . . ———— (104)
Capital contribution from equity
holders of XDC Wuxi ........ 69,11 6————
Fully paid of issued shares ...... — — 1,285,462 1,285,462 —
NET CASH FROM (USED IN)
FINANCING ACTIVITIES . . . 69,116 22,343 1,328,213 1,331,590 (73,729)
Net distribution to Biologics
Shanghai by BCD Business Unit
(note) .................... (13,809) (31,623) — — —
Effects of exchange rate
changes .................. 8 9 0 (334) 8,161 15,498 3,653
NET INCREASE (DECREASE)
IN CASH AND CASH
EQUIV ALENTS ............ 24,627 (2,065) 308,647 637,122 226,672
Cash and cash equivalents at
beginning of the year/period . . . 3,763 28,390 26,325 26,325 334,972
Cash and cash equivalents at
end of the year/period,
represented by bank balances
and cash ................. 28,390 26,325 334,972 663,447 561,644
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-13 —


--- page 435 ---
Note: Prior to transfer of the BCD Business Unit as detailed in Note 2, the BCD Business Unit was operated under Biologics
Shanghai and no separate bank accounts were maintained for the BCD Business Unit. Accordingly, the net equity generated
by the BCD Business Unit prior to completion of the Business Transfer that would not have an impact to the cash and cash
equivalents of the Group, are reflected as “Net distribution to Biologics Shanghai by BCD Business Unit” in the consolidated
statements of cash flows and were presented as “Net distribution to Biologics Shanghai” in the consolidated statements of
changes in equity.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-14 —


--- page 436 ---
NOTES TO THE HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
1. GENERAL INFORMATION
The Company is an exempted limited liability company incorporated in the Cayman Islands on
December 14, 2020. The addresses of the registered office and principal place of business of the Company
are disclosed in the section “Corporate Information” of the Prospectus.
The Company is an investment holding company. During the Track Record Period, the subsidiaries
of the Company as set out in Note 41 (hereinafter together with the Company collectively referred to as
the “Group”) are principally engaged in research, discovery, development and manufacturing of the drug
substances and drug products of antibody drug conjugates and other bioconjugates. Throughout the Track
Record Period and as at the date of this report, Biologics Cayman is the ultimate holding company of the
Company before and after the transfers and acquisition as set out in Note 2 below.
Items included in the financial statements of each of the Group’s entities are recorded using the
currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity operates (the “functional currency”).
The Historical Financial Information is presented in RMB, which is also the functional currency of the
Company.
No statutory financial statements of the Company has been prepared since its date of incorporation
as it is incorporated in a jurisdiction where there are no statutory requirements.
2. HISTORY, GROUP REORGANIZATION AND BASIS OF PREPARATION AND
PRESENTATION OF HISTORICAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
The Historical Financial Information has been prepared based on the accounting policies set out in
Note 4 which conform with IFRSs issued by IASB and the convention applicable for the Transfers (as
defined and detailed below).
History and group reorganization
To rationalize the structure of the Group in preparation for the separate listing of the Company’s
shares on the Main Board of the Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited (the “Spin-off”), Biologics
Cayman underwent a series of group reorganization as further described below. Apart from the acquisition
of Payload and Linker Business as set out in note (vii) below, the Company and the then subsidiaries are
under the common control of Biologics Cayman, the transfer of XDC Wuxi and BCD Business Unit (as
defined below) (the “Transfers”) from Biologics Cayman to the Group had been accounted for as business
combination involving entities and business under common control using the principle of merger
accounting.
i. WuXi XDC Hong Kong Limited (“XDC HK”) was incorporated on June 7, 2021 and is directly
wholly-owned by the Company.
ii. XDC Wuxi was established in the PRC on March 13, 2018 by Biologics Cayman Investments
Limited (“Biologics Investment”), a subsidiary of Biologics Cayman. On July 9, 2021, XDC
HK entered into a share transfer agreement with Biologics Investment for acquisition of 100%
equity interest in XDC Wuxi from Biologics Investment at a cash consideration of
approximately RMB404,413,100.
iii. XDC Shanghai was established on March 31, 2021 and is directly wholly-owned by XDC
Wuxi.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-15 —


--- page 437 ---
iv. Wuxi XDC (Changzhou) Co., Ltd. (“XDC Changzhou”) was established on July 2, 2021 and
is directly wholly-owned by WuXi XDC.
v. Wuxi XDC Singapore Private Limited (“XDC Singapore”) was established on November 16,
2022 and is directly wholly-owned by XDC HK.
vi. On July 20, 2021, XDC Shanghai entered into a business transfer agreement with Biologics
Shanghai, a subsidiary of Biologics Cayman, for transferring of the bioconjugate drug business
unit (the “BCD Business Unit”) to XDC Shanghai (the “Business Transfer”) at a cash
consideration of approximately RMB15,587,000.
vii. On July 20, 2021, XDC Changzhou entered into a business acquisition agreement with a related
party, Changzhou SynTheAll Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. (“STA Changzhou”), which is a fellow
subsidiary of the Company’s shareholder namely STA HK (as defined in Note 32), pursuant to
which, XDC Changzhou had acquired the payload & linker business of STA Changzhou (the
“Payload & Linker Business”) at a total cash consideration of RMB280 million. This
acquisition is accounted for using the acquisition accounting method. The transaction was
completed on October 1, 2021. The pre-acquisition financial information of Payload & Linker
Business is set out in Note 36.
The consideration for the above Transfers and acquisition are determined by reference to valuation
reports prepared by the professional valuer independent to the Group and Biologics Cayman, namely ̏
ப΂ʮ̡ (Beijing Zhongfeng Assets Appraisal Company
#) with registered address of
8th Floor Block B Zhongguancun Intellectual Property Mansion, Haidian South Road No. 21, Beijing.
Basis of preparation and presentation
The Transfers have been reflected in the Historical Financial Information of the Group using the
principle of merger accounting as if they had been combined from the date when the Group, XDC Wuxi
and BCD Business Unit first came under the control of Biologics Cayman. Accordingly, the assets and
liabilities of XDC Wuxi and BCD Business Unit have been accounted for in the consolidated statements
of financial position of the Group at their existing book values from Biologics Cayman’s perspective. No
amount is recognized in respect of goodwill nor adjustment made in respect of differences between the fair
values of XDC Wuxi and BCD Business Unit’s identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities and
their carrying amounts. The consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income
includes the results of XDC Wuxi and BCD Business Unit since the date when they first came under the
common control of Biologics Cayman.
Prior to completing the transfer of BCD Business Unit to the Group, it was a business unit operated
under Biologics Shanghai, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Biologics Cayman. To the extent the assets,
liabilities, income and expenses that are specifically identified to the BCD Business Unit, such items are
included in the Historical Financial Information throughout the Track Record Period. To the extent the
assets, liabilities, income and expenses that are impracticable to identify specifically, these items are
allocated to the BCD Business Unit on the basis set out below (such items include certain selling and
marketing expenses, administrative expenses and income tax expense). Items that do not meet the criteria
above are not included in the Historical Financial Information of the Group.
# English name is for illustrative purpose only.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-16 —


--- page 438 ---
Expenses which are impracticable to identify specifically to the BCD Business Unit are determined
on the following basis: (1) included in the administrative expenses are administrative and support
department staff salaries and staff welfare which were allocated based on the percentage of headcount of
the BCD Business Unit to the total headcount of Biologics Shanghai; (2) selling and marketing expenses
incurred by Biologics Shanghai’s marketing unit were allocated based on the percentage of BCD Business
Unit’s revenue to Biologics Shanghai’s total revenue; and (3) income tax expense was calculated based on
the tax rate of Biologics Shanghai as if the BCD Business Unit is a separate tax reporting entity. The
directors of the Company believe that the method of allocation of the above expense items presents a
reasonable basis of estimating what BCD Business Unit’s operating results would have been on a
stand-alone basis for the Track Record Period. Other than those items mentioned above, all other items of
assets and liabilities, income and expenses of BCD Business Unit are specifically identified.
Pursuant to the Transfers and acquisition set out above, the Company became the holding company
of the companies now comprising the Group and Biologics Cayman continues to be the Company’s
ultimate holding company.
3. APPLICATION OF NEW AND AMENDMENTS TO IFRSs
For the purpose of preparing and presenting the Historical Financial Information for the Track
Record Period, the Group has consistently adopted the accounting policies which conform with IFRSs
issued by the IASB, which are effective for the Group’s accounting period beginning on January 1, 2023,
throughout the Track Record Period.
New and amendments to IFRSs in issue but not yet effective
The Group has not early applied the following new and amendments to IFRSs that have been issued
but are not yet effective:
Amendments to IFRS 10 and IAS 28 ........ Sale or Contribution of Assets between an
Investor and its Associate or Joint V enture
1
Amendment to IFRS 16 .................. Lease Liability in a Sale and Leaseback 2
Amendments to IAS 1 ................... Classification of Liabilities as Current or
Non-current 2
Amendments to IAS 1 ................... Non-current Liabilities with Covenants 2
Amendments to IAS 7 and IFRS 7 .......... Supplier Finance Arrangements 2
Amendments to IAS 21 .................. Lack of Exchangeability 3
1 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after a date to be determined
2 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2024
3 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2025
The directors of the Company anticipate that the application of the above new and amendments to
IFRSs, will have no material impact on the Historical Financial Information in the foreseeable future.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-17 —


--- page 439 ---
4. BASIS OF PREPARATION AND PRESENTATION OF HISTORICAL FINANCIAL
INFORMATION AND MATERIAL ACCOUNTING POLICY INFORMATION
4.1 Basis of preparation of Historical Financial Information
The Historical Financial Information has been prepared in accordance with the following accounting
policies which conform with IFRSs issued by the IASB. For the purpose of preparation of Historical
Financial Information, information is considered material if such information is reasonably expected to
influence decisions made by primary users. In addition, the Historical Financial Information includes
applicable disclosures required by the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on The Stock Exchange
of Hong Kong Limited (“Listing Rules”) and by the Hong Kong Companies Ordinance.
The Historical Financial Information has been prepared on the historical cost basis except for certain
financial instruments that are measured at fair values at the end of each reporting period, as explained in
the accounting policies set out below.
Historical cost is generally based on the fair value of the consideration given in exchange for goods
and services.
Fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an
orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date, regardless of whether that price
is directly observable or estimated using another valuation technique. In estimating the fair value of an
asset or a liability, the Group takes into account the characteristics of the asset or liability if market
participants would take those characteristics into account when pricing the asset or liability at the
measurement date. Fair value for measurement and/or disclosure purposes in the Historical Financial
Information is determined on such a basis, except for share-based payment transactions that are within the
scope of IFRS 2 Share-based Payment , leasing transactions that are accounted for in accordance with IFRS
16, and measurements that have some similarities to fair value but are not fair value, such as net realizable
value in IAS 2 Inventories or value in use in IAS 36 Impairment of Assets .
A fair value measurement of a non-financial asset takes into account a market participant’s ability
to generate economic benefits by using the asset in its highest and best use or by selling it to another
market participant that would use the asset in its highest and best use.
In addition, for financial reporting purposes, fair value measurements are categorized into Level 1,
2 or 3 based on the degree to which the inputs to the fair value measurements are observable and the
significance of the inputs to the fair value measurement in its entirety, which are described as follows:
 Level 1 inputs are quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities
that the entity can access at the measurement date;
 Level 2 inputs are inputs, other than quoted prices included within Level 1, that are observable
for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly; and
 Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or liability.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-18 —


--- page 440 ---
4.2 Material accounting policy information
Basis of consolidation
The Historical Financial Information incorporate the financial statements of the Company and
entities controlled by the Company and its subsidiaries. Control is achieved when the Company:
 has power over the investee;
 is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the investee; and
 has the ability to use its power to affect its returns.
The Group reassesses whether or not it controls an investee if facts and circumstances indicate that
there are changes to one or more of the three elements of control listed above.
Consolidation of a subsidiary begins when the Group obtains control over the subsidiary and ceases
when the Group loses control of the subsidiary. Specifically, income and expenses of a subsidiary acquired
or disposed of during the year are included in the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other
comprehensive income from the date the Group gains control until the date when the Group ceases to
control the subsidiary.
Profit or loss and each item of other comprehensive income are attributed to the owners of the
Company and to the non-controlling interests. Total comprehensive income of subsidiaries is attributed to
the owners of the Company and to the non-controlling interests even if this results in the non-controlling
interests having a deficit balance.
When necessary, adjustments are made to the financial statements of subsidiaries to bring their
accounting policies in line with the Group’s accounting policies.
All intragroup assets and liabilities, equity, income, expenses and cash flows relating to transactions
between members of the Group are eliminated in full on consolidation.
Business combinations
A business is an integrated set of activities and assets which includes an input and a substantive
process that together significantly contribute to the ability to create outputs. The acquired processes are
considered substantive if they are critical to the ability to continue producing outputs, including an
organized workforce with the necessary skills, knowledge, or experience to perform the related processes
or they significantly contribute to the ability to continue producing outputs and are considered unique or
scarce or cannot be replaced without significant cost, effort, or delay in the ability to continue producing
outputs.
Acquisitions of businesses, other than business combination under common control are accounted for
using the acquisition method. The consideration transferred in a business combination is measured at fair
value, which is calculated as the sum of the acquisition-date fair values of the assets transferred by the
Group, liabilities incurred by the Group to the former owners of the acquiree and the equity interests
issued by the Group in exchange for control of the acquiree. Acquisition-related costs are generally
recognized in profit or loss as incurred.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-19 —


--- page 441 ---
For business combinations in which the acquisition date is on or after January 1, 2022, the
identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed must meet the definitions of an asset and a liability in
the Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting issued by International Accounting Standards Board
in March 2018 (the “Conceptual Framework”) except for transactions and events within the scope of IAS
37 or IFRIC 21, in which the Group applies IAS 37 or IFRIC 21 instead of the Conceptual Framework to
identify the liabilities it has assumed in a business combination. Contingent assets are not recognized.
At the acquisition date, the identifiable assets acquired and the liabilities assumed are recognized at
their fair value, except that:
 deferred tax assets or liabilities, and assets or liabilities related to employee benefit
arrangements are recognized and measured in accordance with IAS 12 Income Taxes and IAS
19 Employee Benefits respectively;
 liabilities or equity instruments related to share-based payment arrangements of the acquiree or
share-based payment arrangements of the Group entered into to replace share-based payment
arrangements of the acquiree are measured in accordance with IFRS 2 Share-based Payment at
the acquisition date (see the accounting policy below);
 assets (or disposal groups) that are classified as held for sale in accordance with IFRS 5
Non-current Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations are measured in accordance
with that standard; and
 lease liabilities are recognized and measured at the present value of the remaining lease
payments (as defined in IFRS 16) as if the acquired leases were new leases at the acquisition
date, except for leases for which the lease term ends within 12 months of the acquisition date.
Right-of-use assets are recognized and measured at the same amount as the relevant lease
liabilities, adjusted to reflect favourable or unfavourable terms of the lease when compared
with market terms.
Goodwill is measured as the excess of the sum of the consideration transferred, the amount of any
non-controlling interests in the acquiree, and the fair value of the acquirer’s previously held equity interest
in the acquiree (if any) over the net amount of the identifiable assets acquired and the liabilities assumed
as at acquisition date. If, after re-assessment, the net amount of the identifiable assets acquired and
liabilities assumed exceeds the sum of the consideration transferred, the amount of any non-controlling
interests in the acquiree and the fair value of the acquirer’s previously held interest in the acquiree (if any),
the excess is recognized immediately in profit or loss as a bargain purchase gain.
Goodwill
Goodwill arising on an acquisition of a business is carried at cost as established at the date of
acquisition of the business (see the accounting policy above) less accumulated impairment losses, if any.
For the purposes of impairment testing, goodwill is allocated to each of the Group’s cash-generating
units (or group of cash-generating units) that is expected to benefit from the synergies of the combination,
which represent the lowest level at which the goodwill is monitored for internal management purposes and
not larger than an operating segment.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-20 —


--- page 442 ---
A cash-generating unit (or group of cash-generating units) to which goodwill has been allocated is
tested for impairment annually or more frequently when there is indication that the unit may be impaired.
For goodwill arising on an acquisition in a reporting period, the cash-generating unit (or group of
cash-generating units) to which goodwill has been allocated is tested for impairment before the end of that
reporting period. If the recoverable amount is less than its carrying amount, the impairment loss is
allocated first to reduce the carrying amount of any goodwill and then to the other assets on a pro-rata
basis based on the carrying amount of each asset in the unit (or group of cash-generating units).
On disposal of the relevant cash-generating unit or any of the cash-generating unit within the group
of cash-generating units, the attributable amount of goodwill is included in the determination of the
amount of profit or loss on disposal. When the Group disposes of an operation within the cash-generating
unit (or a cash-generating unit within a group of cash-generating units), the amount of goodwill disposed
of is measured on the basis of the relative values of the operation (or the cash-generating unit) disposed
of and the portion of the cash-generating unit (or the group of cash-generating units) retained.
Investments in subsidiaries
Investments in subsidiaries are stated at cost less than any identified impairment loss on the
statement of financial position of the Company.
Merger accounting for business combination involving businesses under common control
The Historical Financial Information incorporates the financial statements items of the combining
businesses in which the common control combination occurs as if they had been combined from the date
when the combining businesses first came under the control of the controlling party.
The net assets of the combining businesses are consolidated using the existing book values from the
controlling party’s perspective. No amount is recognised in respect of goodwill or bargain purchase gain
at the time of common control combination.
The consolidated statements of profit or loss and the other comprehensive income include the results
of each of the combining businesses from the earliest date presented or since the date when the combining
businesses first came under the common control, where there is a short period.
The Historical Financial Information is presented as if the businesses had been combined at the
beginning of the previous reporting period or when they first came under common control, whichever is
shorter.
Revenue from contracts with customers
The Group recognizes revenue when (or as) a performance obligation is satisfied, i.e. when “control”
of the services underlying the particular performance obligation is transferred to the customer.
A performance obligation represents a service (or a bundle of services) that is distinct or a series of
distinct services that are substantially the same.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-21 —


--- page 443 ---
Control is transferred over time and revenue is recognized over time by reference to the progress
towards complete satisfaction of the relevant performance obligation if one of the following criteria is met:
 the customer simultaneously receives and consumes the benefits provided by the Group’s
performance as the Group performs;
 the Group’s performance creates or enhances an asset that the customer controls as the Group
performs; or
 the Group’s performance does not create an asset with an alternative use to the Group and the
Group has an enforceable right to payment for performance completed to date.
Otherwise, revenue is recognized at a point in time when the customer obtains control of the distinct
service.
A contract asset represents the Group’s right to consideration in exchange for services that the Group
has transferred to a customer that is not yet unconditional. It is assessed for impairment in accordance with
IFRS 9. In contrast, a receivable represents the Group’s unconditional right to consideration, i.e. only the
passage of time is required before payment of that consideration is due.
A contract liability represents the Group’s obligation to transfer services to a customer for which the
Group has received consideration (or an amount of consideration is due) from the customer.
A contract asset and a contract liability relating to the same contract are accounted for and presented
on a net basis.
Contracts with multiple performance obligations (including allocation of transaction price)
For contracts that contain more than one performance obligations (i.e. fee-for-service (“FFS”))
contracts usually have multiple deliverable units, which are generally in the form of technical laboratory
reports, samples and/or goods), the Group allocates the transaction price to each performance obligation
on a relative stand-alone selling price basis, except for the allocation of discounts and variable
consideration.
The stand-alone selling price of the distinct service underlying each performance obligation is
determined at contract inception. It represents the price at which the Group would sell a promised good
or service separately to a customer. If a stand-alone selling price is not directly observable, the Group
estimates it using appropriate techniques such that the transaction price ultimately allocated to any
performance obligation reflects the amount of consideration to which the Group expects to be entitled in
exchange for transferring the promised goods or services to the customer.
Over time revenue recognition: measurement of progress towards complete satisfaction of a performance
obligation.
The selection of the method to measure progress towards completion requires judgement and is based
on the nature of the services to be provided. Depending on which better depicts the transfer of value to
the customer, the Group measures its progress using either services transferred to the customer to date
(output method) or cost-to-cost (input method).
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-22 —


--- page 444 ---
Output method:
The progress towards complete satisfaction of a performance obligation is measured based on output
method, which is to recognize revenue on the basis of direct measurements of the value of the goods or
services transferred to the customer to date relative to the remaining goods or services promised under the
contract, that best depict the Group’s performance in transferring control of goods or services.
As a practical expedient, if the Group has a right to consideration in an amount that corresponds
directly with the value of the Group’s performance completed to date (for example, service contracts in
which the Group bills a fixed amount for each hour of service provided), the Group recognizes revenue
in the amount to which the Group has the right to invoice.
Input method:
The progress towards complete satisfaction of a performance obligation is measured based on input
method, which is to recognize revenue on the basis of the Group’s costs incurred to date to the satisfaction
of a performance obligation relative to the total expected costs to the satisfaction of that performance
obligation, that best depict the Group’s performance in transferring control of services.
As a practical expedient, if the Group has a right to consideration in an amount that corresponds
directly with the value of the Group’s performance completed to date (for example, service contracts in
which the Group bills a fixed amount for each hour of service provided), the Group recognizes revenue
in the amount to which the Group has the right to invoice.
Principal versus agent
When another party is involved in providing goods or services to a customer, the Group determines
whether the nature of its promise is a performance obligation to provide the specified goods or services
itself (i.e. the Group is a principal) or to arrange for those goods or services to be provided by the other
party (i.e. the Group is an agent).
The Group is a principal if it controls the specified good or service before that good or service is
transferred to a customer.
The Group is an agent if its performance obligation is to arrange for the provision of the specified
good or service by another party. In this case, the Group does not control the specified good or service
provided by another party before that good or service is transferred to the customer. When the Group acts
as an agent, it recognizes revenue in the amount of any fee or commission to which it expects to be entitled
in exchange for arranging for the specified goods or services to be provided by the other party.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-23 —


--- page 445 ---
Contract costs
Costs to fulfil a contract
The Group incurs costs to fulfil a contact in its service contracts. The Group first assesses whether
these costs qualify for recognition as an asset in terms of other relevant standards, failing which it
recognizes an asset for these costs only if they meet all of the following criteria:
(a) the costs relate directly to a contract or to an anticipated contract that the Group can
specifically identify;
(b) the costs generate or enhance resources of the Group that will be used in satisfying (or in
continuing to satisfy) performance obligations in the future; and
(c) the costs are expected to be recovered.
The asset so recognized is subsequently amortized to profit or loss on a systematic basis that is
consistent with the transfer to the customer of the goods or services to which the assets relate. The asset
is also subject to impairment review.
Leases
Definition of a lease
A contract is, or contains, a lease if the contract conveys the right to control the use of an identified
asset for a period of time in exchange for consideration.
For contracts entered into or modified on or after the date of initial application of IFRS 16 or arising
from business combinations, the Group assesses whether a contract is or contains a lease based on the
definition under IFRS 16 at inception, modification date or acquisition date, as appropriate. Such contract
will not be reassessed unless the terms and conditions of the contract are subsequently changed.
The Group as lessee
Allocation of consideration to components of a contract
For a contract that contains a lease component and one or more additional lease or non-lease
components, the Group allocates the consideration in the contract to each lease component on the basis
of the relative stand-alone price of the lease component and the aggregate stand-alone price of the
non-lease components.
Non-lease components are separated from lease component on the basis of their relative stand-alone
prices and are accounted for by applying other applicable standards.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-24 —


--- page 446 ---
Short-term leases
The Group applies the short-term lease recognition exemption to leases that have a lease term of 12
months or less from the commencement date and do not contain a purchase option. Lease payments on
short-term leases are recognized as expense on a straight-line basis or another systematic basis over the
lease term.
Right-of-use assets
The cost of right-of-use assets includes:
 the amount of the initial measurement of the lease liability;
 any lease payments made at or before the commencement date, less any lease incentives
received;
 any initial direct costs incurred by the Group; and
 an estimate of costs to be incurred by the Group in dismantling and removing the underlying
assets, restoring the site on which it is located or restoring the underlying asset to the condition
required by the terms and conditions of the lease, unless those costs are incurred to produce
inventories.
Right-of-use assets are measured at cost, less any accumulated depreciation and impairment losses,
and adjusted for any remeasurement of lease liabilities.
Right-of-use assets in which the Group is reasonably certain to obtain ownership of the underlying
leased assets at the end of the lease term are depreciated from commencement date to the end of the useful
life. Otherwise, right-of-use assets are depreciated on a straight-line basis over the shorter of its estimated
useful life and the lease term.
When the Group obtains ownership of the underlying leased assets at the end of the lease term, upon
exercising purchase options, the cost of the relevant right-of-use assets and the related accumulated
depreciation and impairment loss are transferred to property, plant and equipment.
The Group presents right-of-use assets as a separate line item on the consolidated statement of
financial position. Right-of-use assets that meet the definition of investment property are presented within
“investment property”.
Refundable rental deposits
Refundable rental deposits paid are accounted under IFRS 9 and initially measured at fair value.
Adjustments to fair value at initial recognition are considered as additional lease payments and included
in the cost of right-of-use assets.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-25 —


--- page 447 ---
Lease liabilities
At the commencement date of a lease, the Group recognizes and measures the lease liability at the
present value of lease payments that are unpaid at that date. In calculating the present value of lease
payments, the Group uses the incremental borrowing rate at the lease commencement date if the interest
rate implicit in the lease is not readily determinable.
The lease payments include:
 fixed payments (including in-substance fixed payments) less any lease incentives receivable;
 variable lease payments that depend on an index or a rate, initially measured using the index
or rate as at the commencement date;
 amounts expected to be payable by the Group under residual value guarantees;
 the exercise price of a purchase option if the Group is reasonably certain to exercise the option;
and
 payments of penalties for terminating a lease, if the lease term reflects the Group exercising an
option to terminate the lease.
V ariable lease payments that reflect changes in market rental rates are initially measured using the
market rental rates as at the commencement date. V ariable lease payments that do not depend on an index
or a rate are not included in the measurement of lease liabilities and right-of-use assets, and are recognized
as expense in the period in which the event or condition that triggers the payment occurs.
After the commencement date, lease liabilities are adjusted by interest accretion and lease payments.
The Group remeasures lease liabilities (and makes a corresponding adjustment to the related
right-of-use assets) whenever:
 the lease term has changed or there is a change in the assessment of exercise of a purchase
option, in which case the related lease liability is remeasured by discounting the revised lease
payments using a revised discount rate at the date of reassessment.
 the lease payments change due to changes in market rental rates following a market rent review,
in which cases the related lease liability is remeasured by discounting the revised lease
payments using the initial discount rate.
The Group presents lease liabilities as a separate line item on the consolidated statement of financial
position.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-26 —


--- page 448 ---
Lease modifications
The Group accounts for a lease modification as a separate lease if:
 the modification increases the scope of the lease by adding the right to use one or more
underlying assets; and
 the consideration for the leases increases by an amount commensurate with the stand-alone
price for the increase in scope and any appropriate adjustments to that stand-alone price to
reflect the circumstances of the particular contract.
For a lease modification that is not accounted for as a separate lease, the Group remeasures the lease
liability based on the lease term of the modified lease by discounting the revised lease payments using a
revised discount rate at the effective date of the modification.
The Group accounts for the remeasurement of lease liabilities by making corresponding adjustments
to the relevant right-of-use assets.
When the modified contract contains a lease component and one or more additional lease or
non-lease components, the Group allocates the consideration in the modified contract to each lease
component on the basis of the relative stand-alone price of the lease component and the aggregate
stand-alone price of the non-lease components.
The Group as a lessor
Classification and measurement of leases
Leases for which the Group is a lessor are classified as finance or operating leases. Whenever the
terms of the lease transfer substantially all the risks and rewards incidental to ownership of an underlying
asset to the lessee, the contract is classified as a finance lease. All other leases are classified as operating
leases.
Amounts due from lessees under finance leases are recognized as receivables at commencement date
at amounts equal to net investments in the leases, measured using the interest rate implicit in the respective
leases. Initial direct costs are included in the initial measurement of the net investments in the leases.
Interest income is allocated to accounting periods so as to reflect a constant periodic rate of return on the
Group’s net investment outstanding in respect of the leases.
Rental income from operating leases is recognized in profit or loss on a straight-line basis over the
term of the relevant lease. Initial direct costs incurred in negotiating and arranging an operating lease are
added to the carrying amount of the leased asset, and such costs are recognized as an expense on a
straight-line basis over the lease term.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-27 —


--- page 449 ---
Foreign currencies
In preparing the financial statements of each individual group entity, transactions in currencies other
than functional currency of that entity (foreign currencies) are recognized at the rates of exchanges
prevailing on the dates of the transactions. At the end of the reporting period, monetary items denominated
in foreign currencies are retranslated at the rates prevailing at that date. Non-monetary items that are
measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are not retranslated.
Exchange differences arising on the settlement of monetary items, and on the retranslation of
monetary items, are recognized in profit or loss in the period in which they arise.
For the purposes of presenting the Historical Financial Information, the assets and liabilities of the
Group’s foreign operations are translated into the presentation currency of the Group (i.e. Renminbi) using
exchange rate prevailing at the end of each reporting period. Income and expense items are translated at
the average exchange rates for the period. Exchange differences arising, if any, are recognized in other
comprehensive income and accumulated in equity under the heading of foreign currency translation
reserve.
Research and other grants
Research and other grants are accounted for in accordance with IAS 20 Accounting for Government
Grants and Disclosure of Government Assistance . Research and other grants are not recognized until there
is reasonable assurance that the Group will comply with the conditions attaching to them and that the
grants will be received.
Research and other grants are recognized in profit or loss on a systematic basis over the periods in
which the Group recognizes as expenses the related costs for which the grants are intended to compensate.
Research and other grants related to income that are receivable as compensation for expenses or
losses already incurred or for the purpose of giving immediate financial support to the Group with no
future related costs are recognized in profit or loss in the period in which they become receivable. Such
grants are presented under “other income”.
Employee benefits
Retirement benefit costs
Payments to defined contribution retirement benefit plans are recognized as an expense when
employees have rendered service entitling them to the contributions.
Pension obligations
The Group participates in state-managed retirement benefit schemes, which are defined contribution
schemes, pursuant to which the Group pays a fixed percentage of its qualifying staff’s wages as
contributions to the schemes. Payments to such retirement benefit schemes are charged as an expense
when employees have rendered service entitling them to the contributions.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-28 —


--- page 450 ---
Short-term employee benefits
Short-term employee benefits are recognized at the undiscounted amount of the benefits expected to
be paid as and when employees rendered the services. All short-term employee benefits are recognized as
an expense unless another IFRS requires or permits the inclusion of the benefit in the cost of an asset.
A liability is recognized for benefits accruing to employees (such as wages and salaries, annual leave
and sick leave) after deducting any amount already paid.
Share-based payments
Equity-settled share-based payment transactions
Share options granted to employees
Equity-settled share-based payments to employees (including directors of the Company) are
measured at the fair value of the equity instruments at the grant date.
The fair value of the equity-settled share-based payments determined at the grant date without taking
into consideration all non-market vesting conditions is expensed on a straight-line basis over the vesting
period, based on the Group’s estimate of equity instruments that will eventually vest, with a corresponding
increase in equity (equity-settled share-based compensation reserve). At the end of each reporting period,
the Group revises its estimate of the number of equity instruments expected to vest based on assessment
of all relevant non-market vesting conditions. The impact of the revision of the original estimates, if any,
is recognized in profit or loss such that the cumulative expense reflects the revised estimate, with a
corresponding adjustment to the equity-settled share-based compensation reserve.
When the share options are exercised, the amount previously recognized in equity-settled
share-based compensation reserve will be transferred to share premium. When the share options are
forfeited after the vesting date or are still not exercised at the expiry date, the amount previously
recognized in equity-settled share-based compensation reserve will continue to be held in equity-settled
share-based compensation reserve.
Equity instruments granted by the ultimate holding company to employees of the Group
The grant by the ultimate holding company of equity instruments under its employee stock incentive
plan to the employees of the Group (including directors of the Company) is treated as equity-settled
share-based payments in the Historical Financial Information. An expense for the grant date fair value of
the equity instruments under the employee stock incentive plan is recognized over the vesting period of
the instruments, with a corresponding increase in equity. The increase in equity is treated as a deemed
capital contribution into the Group and is included in other reserve.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-29 —


--- page 451 ---
Restricted share award payment transactions
For shares granted by the ultimate holding company under WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme and
WXB Global Partner Program Share Scheme (“Restricted Shares”), the fair value of the employee services
received is determined by reference to the fair value of the Restricted Shares granted at the grant date and
is expensed on a straight-line basis over the vesting period, with a corresponding increase in equity (other
reserve). At the end of each reporting period, the Group revises its estimates of the number of Restricted
Shares that are expected to vest based on assessment of all relevant non-market vesting conditions. The
impact of the revision of the estimates, if any, is recognized in the profit or loss such that the cumulative
expense reflects the revised estimate, with a corresponding adjustment to other reserve.
Taxation
Income tax expense represents the sum of the tax currently payable and deferred tax.
The tax currently payable is based on taxable profit for the year. Taxable profit differs from profit
before tax because of income or expense that are taxable or deductible in other years and items that are
never taxable or deductible. The Group’s liability for current tax is calculated using tax rates that have
been enacted or substantively enacted by the end of the reporting period.
Deferred tax is recognized on temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and
liabilities in the Historical Financial Information and the corresponding tax bases used in the computation
of taxable profit. Deferred tax liabilities are generally recognized for all taxable temporary differences.
Deferred tax assets are generally recognized for all deductible temporary differences to the extent that it
is probable that taxable profits will be available against which those deductible temporary differences can
be utilized. Such deferred tax assets and liabilities are not recognized if the temporary difference arises
from the initial recognition (other than in a business combination) of assets and liabilities in a transaction
that affects neither the taxable profit nor the accounting profit. In addition, deferred tax liabilities are not
recognized if the temporary differences arises from the initial recognition of goodwill.
Deferred tax liabilities are recognized for taxable temporary differences associated with investments
in subsidiaries and associates except where the Group is able to control the reversal of the temporary
difference and it is probable that the temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future.
Deferred tax assets arising from deductible temporary differences associated with such investments are
only recognized to the extent that it is probable that there will be sufficient taxable profits against which
to utilize the benefits of the temporary differences and they are expected to reverse in the foreseeable
future.
The carrying amount of deferred tax assets is reviewed at the end of each reporting period and
reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable that sufficient taxable profits will be available to allow
all or part of the asset to be recovered.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the
period in which the liability is settled or the asset is realized, based on tax rate (and tax laws) that have
been enacted or substantively enacted by the end of the reporting period.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-30 —


--- page 452 ---
The measurement of deferred tax liabilities and assets reflects the tax consequences that would
follow from the manner in which the Group expects, at the end of the reporting period, to recover or settle
the carrying amount of its assets and liabilities.
For the purposes of measuring deferred tax for leasing transactions in which the Group recognizes
the right-of-use assets and the related lease liabilities, the Group first determines whether the tax
deductions are attributable to the right-of-use assets or the lease liabilities.
For leasing transactions in which the tax deductions are attributable to the lease liabilities, the Group
applies IAS 12 requirements to the lease liabilities and the related assets separately. The Group recognizes
a deferred tax asset related to lease liabilities to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be
available against which the deductible temporary difference can be utilized and a deferred tax liability for
all taxable temporary differences.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to set off current
tax assets against current tax liabilities and when they relate to income taxes levied to the same taxable
entity by the same taxation authority.
Current and deferred tax are recognized in profit or loss, except when they relate to items that are
recognized in other comprehensive income or directly in equity, in which case, the current and deferred
tax are also recognized in other comprehensive income or directly in equity respectively. Where current
tax or deferred tax arises from the initial accounting for a business combination, the tax effect is included
in the accounting for the business combination.
In assessing any uncertainty over income tax treatments, the Group considers whether it is probable
that the relevant tax authority will accept the uncertain tax treatment used, or proposed to be use by
individual group entities in their income tax filings. If it is probable, the current and deferred taxes are
determined consistently with the tax treatment in the income tax filings. If it is not probable that the
relevant taxation authority will accept an uncertain tax treatment, the effect of each uncertainty is reflected
by using either the most likely amount or the expected value.
Property, plant and equipment
Property, plant and equipment are tangible assets that are held for use in the production or supply
of goods or services, or for administrative purposes. Property, plant and equipment other than assets under
construction in progress are stated in the consolidated statement of financial position at cost less
subsequent accumulated depreciation and accumulated impairment losses, if any.
Property, plant and equipment in the course of construction for production, supply or administrative
purposes are carried at cost, less any recognized impairment loss. Costs include any costs directly
attributable to bringing the asset to the location and condition necessary for it to be capable of operating
in the manner intended by management, including costs of testing whether the related assets is functioning
properly and, for qualifying assets, borrowing costs capitalized in accordance with the Group’s accounting
policy. Sale proceeds of items that are produced while bringing an item of property, plant and equipment
to the location and condition necessary for it to be capable of operating in the manner intended by
management (such as samples produced when testing whether the asset is functioning properly), and the
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-31 —


--- page 453 ---
related costs of producing those items are recognized in the profit or loss. The cost of those items are
measured in accordance with the measurement requirements of IAS 2. Depreciation of these assets, on the
same basis as other assets, commences when the assets are ready for their intended use.
When the Group makes payments for ownership interests of properties which includes both leasehold
land and building elements, the entire consideration is allocated between the leasehold land and the
building elements in proportion to the relative fair values at initial recognition. To the extent the allocation
of the relevant payments can be made reliably, interest in leasehold land is presented as “right-of-use
assets” in the consolidated statements of financial position. When the consideration cannot be allocated
reliably between non-lease building element and undivided interest in the underlying leasehold land, the
entire properties are classified as property, plant and equipment.
Depreciation is recognized so as to write off the cost of assets other than property, plant and
equipment in the course of construction less their residual values over their estimated useful lives, using
the straight-line method. The estimated useful lives, residual values and depreciation method are reviewed
at the end of the reporting period, with the effect of any changes in estimate accounted for on a prospective
basis.
An item of property, plant and equipment is derecognized upon disposal or when no future economic
benefits are expected to arise from the continued use of the asset. Any gain or loss arising on the disposal
or retirement of property, plant and equipment is determined as the difference between the sales proceeds
and the carrying amount of the asset and is recognized in profit or loss.
Intangible assets
Intangible assets acquired separately
Intangible assets with finite useful lives that are acquired separately are carried at costs less
accumulated amortization and any accumulated impairment losses. Amortization for intangible assets with
finite useful lives is recognized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. The estimated
useful life and amortization method are reviewed at the end of each reporting period, with the effect of
any changes in estimate being accounted for on a prospective basis. Intangible assets with indefinite useful
lives that are acquired separately are carried at cost less any subsequent accumulated impairment losses.
Internally-generated intangible asset — research and development expenditure
Expenditure on research activities is recognized as an expense in the period in which it is incurred.
An internally-generated intangible asset arising from development activities is recognized if, and
only if, all of the following have been demonstrated:
 the technical feasibility of completing the intangible asset so that it will be available for use
or sale;
 the intention to complete the intangible asset and use or sell it;
 the ability to use or sell the intangible asset;
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-32 —


--- page 454 ---
 how the intangible asset will generate probable future economic benefits;
 the availability of adequate technical, financial and other resources to complete the
development and to use or sell the intangible asset; and
 the ability to measure reliably the expenditure attributable to the intangible asset during its
development.
The amount initially recognized for internally-generated intangible asset is the sum of the
expenditure incurred from the date when the intangible asset first meets the recognition criteria listed
above. Where no internally-generated intangible asset can be recognized, development expenditure is
recognized in profit or loss in the period in which it is incurred.
Subsequent to initial recognition, internally-generated intangible assets are reported at cost less
accumulated amortization and accumulated impairment losses (if any), on the same basis as intangible
assets that are acquired separately.
Intangible assets acquired in a business combination
Intangible assets acquired in a business combination are recognized separately from goodwill and are
initially recognized at their fair value at the acquisition date (which is regarded as their cost).
Subsequent to initial recognition, intangible assets acquired in a business combination with finite
useful lives are reported at costs less accumulated amortization and any accumulated impairment losses
on the same basis as intangible assets that are acquired separately.
An intangible asset is derecognized on disposal, or when no future economic benefits are expected
from use or disposal. Gains and losses arising from derecognition of an intangible asset, measured as the
difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset, are recognized in profit
or loss when the asset is derecognized.
Impairment on property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets, contract costs and intangible assets
other than goodwill
At the end of the reporting period, the Group reviews the carrying amounts of its property, plant and
equipment, right-of-use assets, contract costs and intangible assets with finite useful lives to determine
whether there is any indication that these assets have suffered an impairment loss. If any such indication
exists, the recoverable amount of the relevant asset is estimated in order to determine the extent of the
impairment loss (if any).
The recoverable amount of property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets, and intangible assets
are estimated individually. When it is not possible to estimate the recoverable amount individually, the
Group estimates the recoverable amount of the cash-generating unit to which the asset belongs.
In testing a cash-generating unit for impairment, corporate assets are allocated to the relevant
cash-generating unit when a reasonable and consistent basis of allocation can be established, or otherwise
they are allocated to the smallest group of cash-generating units for which a reasonable and consistent
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-33 —


--- page 455 ---
allocation basis can be established. The recoverable amount is determined for the cash-generating unit or
group of cash-generating units to which the corporate asset belongs, and is compared with the carrying
amount of the relevant cash-generating unit or group of cash-generating units.
Before the Group recognizes an impairment loss for assets capitalized as contract costs under IFRS
15, the Group assesses and recognizes any impairment loss on other assets related to the relevant contracts
in accordance with applicable standards. Then, impairment loss, if any, for assets capitalized as contract
costs is recognized to the extent the carrying amounts exceeds the remaining amount of consideration that
the Group expects to receive in exchange for related goods or services less the costs which relate directly
to providing those goods or services that have not been recognized as expenses. The assets capitalized as
contract costs are then included in the carrying amount of the cash-generating unit to which they belong
for the purpose of evaluating impairment of that cash-generating unit.
Recoverable amount is the higher of fair value less costs of disposal and value in use. In assessing
value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discounted to their present value using a pre-tax discount
rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset
(or a cash-generating unit) for which the estimates of future cash flows have not been adjusted.
If the recoverable amount of an asset (or a cash-generating unit) is estimated to be less than its
carrying amount, the carrying amount of the asset (or a cash-generating unit) is reduced to its recoverable
amount. For corporate assets or portion of corporate assets which cannot be allocated on a reasonable and
consistent basis to a cash-generating unit, the Group compares the carrying amount of a group of
cash-generating units, including the carrying amounts of the corporate assets or portion of corporate assets
allocated to that group of cash-generating units, with the recoverable amount of the group of
cash-generating units. In allocating the impairment loss, the impairment loss is allocated first to reduce
the carrying amount of any goodwill (if applicable) and then to the other assets on a pro-rata basis based
on the carrying amount of each asset in the unit or the group of cash-generating units. The carrying amount
of an asset is not reduced below the highest of its fair value less costs of disposal (if measurable), its value
in use (if determinable) and zero. The amount of the impairment loss that would otherwise have been
allocated to the asset is allocated pro rata to the other assets of the unit or the group of cash-generating
units. An impairment loss is recognized immediately in profit or loss.
Where an impairment loss subsequently reverses, the carrying amount of the asset (or cash-
generating unit or a group of cash-generating units) is increased to the revised estimate of its recoverable
amount, but so that the increased carrying amount does not exceed the carrying amount that would have
been determined had no impairment loss been recognized for the asset (or a cash-generating unit or a group
of cash-generating units) in prior years. A reversal of an impairment loss is recognized immediately in
profit or loss.
Cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents presented on the consolidated statement of financial position include cash,
which comprises of cash on hand and demand deposits.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-34 —


--- page 456 ---
Inventories
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realizable value. Costs of inventories are
determined on a weighted average method. Net realizable value represents the contracted selling price less
all estimated costs of completion and costs necessary to make the sale. Costs necessary to make the sale
include incremental costs directly attributable to the sale and non-incremental costs which the Group must
incur to make the sale.
Financial instruments
Financial assets and financial liabilities are recognized when a group entity becomes a party to the
contractual provisions of the instrument. All regular way purchases or sales of financial assets are
recognized and derecognized on a trade date basis. Regular way purchases or sales are purchases or sales
of financial assets that require delivery of assets within the time frame established by regulation or
convention in the market place.
Financial assets and financial liabilities are initially measured at fair value except for trade
receivables arising from contracts with customers which are initially measured in accordance with IFRS
15. Transaction costs that are directly attributable to the acquisition or issue of financial assets and
financial liabilities (other than financial assets or financial liabilities at FVTPL are added to or deducted
from the fair value of the financial assets or financial liabilities, as appropriate, on initial recognition.
Transaction costs directly attributable to the acquisition of financial assets at FVTPL are recognized
immediately in profit or loss.
The effective interest method is a method of calculating the amortized cost of a financial asset or
financial liability and of allocating interest income and interest expense over the relevant period. The
effective interest rate is the rate that exactly discounts estimated future cash receipts and payments
(including all fees and points paid or received that form an integral part of the effective interest rate,
transaction costs and other premiums or discounts) through the expected life of the financial asset or
financial liability, or, where appropriate, a shorter period, to the net carrying amount on initial recognition.
Financial assets
Classification and subsequent measurement of financial assets
Financial assets that meet the following conditions are subsequently measured at amortized cost:
 the financial asset is held within a business model whose objective is to collect contractual cash
flows; and
 the contractual terms give rise on specified dates to cash flows that are solely payments of
principal and interest on the principal amount outstanding.
All other financial assets are subsequently measured at FVTPL, except that at initial recognition of
a financial asset the Group may irrevocably elect to present subsequent changes in fair value of an equity
investment in other comprehensive income if that equity investment is neither held for trading nor
contingent consideration recognized by an acquirer in a business combination to which IFRS 3 Business
Combinations applies.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-35 —


--- page 457 ---
In addition, the Group may irrevocably designate a financial asset that is required to be measured at
the amortized cost or fair value through other comprehensive income (“FVTOCI”) as measured at FVTPL
if doing so eliminates or significantly reduces an accounting mismatch.
(i) Amortized cost and interest income
Interest income is recognized using the effective interest method for financial assets measured
subsequently at amortized cost. Interest income is calculated by applying the effective interest rate to the
gross carrying amount of a financial asset, except for financial assets that have subsequently become
credit-impaired. For financial assets that have subsequently become credit-impaired, interest income is
recognized by applying the effective interest rate to the amortized cost of the financial asset from the next
reporting period. If the credit risk on the credit-impaired financial instrument improves so that the
financial asset is no longer credit-impaired, interest income is recognized by applying the effective interest
rate to the gross carrying amount of the financial asset from the beginning of the reporting period
following the determination that the asset is no longer credit-impaired.
(ii) Financial assets at FVTPL
Financial assets that do not meet the criteria for being measured at amortized cost or FVTOCI or
designated as FVTOCI are measured at FVTPL.
Financial assets as FVTPL are measured at fair value at the end of each reporting, with any fair value
gains or losses recognized in profit or loss. The net gain or loss recognized in profit or loss includes any
interest earned on the financial asset and is included in the “other gains and losses” line item.
Impairment of financial assets and other items subject to impairment assessment under IFRS 9
The Group performs impairment assessment under expected credit loss (“ECL”) model on financial
assets (including trade receivables, receivables for purchase of raw materials on behalf of customers, other
receivables, other long-term deposits and bank balances) and other item (including contract assets) which
are subject to impairment assessment under IFRS 9. The amount of ECL is updated at each reporting date
to reflect changes in credit risk since initial recognition.
Lifetime ECL represents the ECL that will result from all possible default events over the expected
life of the relevant instrument. In contrast, 12-month ECL (“12m ECL”) represents the portion of lifetime
ECL that is expected to result from default events that are possible within 12 months after the reporting
date. Assessment is done based on the Group’s historical credit loss experience, adjusted for factors that
are specific to the debtors, general economic conditions and an assessment of both the current conditions
at the reporting date as well as the forecast of future conditions.
The Group always recognizes lifetime ECL for trade receivable and contract assets.
For all other instruments, the Group measures the loss allowance equal to 12m ECL, unless when
there has been a significant increase in credit risk since initial recognition, in which case the Group
recognizes lifetime ECL. The assessment of whether lifetime ECL should be recognized is based on
significant increases in the likelihood or risk of a default occurring since initial recognition.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-36 —


--- page 458 ---
(i) Significant increase in credit risk
In assessing whether the credit risk has increased significantly since initial recognition, the Group
compares the risk of a default occurring on the financial instrument as at the reporting date with the risk
of a default occurring on the financial instrument as at the date of initial recognition. In making this
assessment, the Group considers both quantitative and qualitative information that is reasonable and
supportable, including historical experience and forward-looking information that is available without
undue cost or effort.
In particular, the following information is taken into account when assessing whether credit risk has
increased significantly:
 an actual or expected significant deterioration in the financial instrument’s external (if
available) or internal credit rating;
 significant deterioration in external market indicators of credit risk, e.g. a significant increase
in the credit spread, the credit default swap prices for the debtor;
 existing or forecast adverse changes in business, financial or economic conditions that are
expected to cause a significant decrease in the debtor’s ability to meet its debt obligations;
 an actual or expected significant deterioration in the operating results of the debtor;
 an actual or expected significant adverse change in the regulatory, economic, or technological
environment of the debtor that results in a significant decrease in the debtor’s ability to meet
its debt obligations.
Irrespective of the outcome of the above assessment, the Group presumes that the credit risk has
increased significantly since initial recognition when contractual payments are more than 60 days past due,
unless the Group has reasonable and supportable information that demonstrates otherwise.
The Group regularly monitors the effectiveness of the criteria used to identify whether there has been
a significant increase in credit risk and revises them as appropriate to ensure that the criteria are capable
of identifying significant increase in credit risk before the amount becomes past due.
(ii) Definition of default
For internal credit risk management, the Group considers an event of default occurs when
information developed internally or obtained from external sources indicates that the debtor is unlikely to
pay its creditors, including the Group, in full (without taking into account any collaterals held by the
Group).
Irrespective of the above analysis, the Group considers that default has occurred when a financial
asset is more than 180 days past due unless the Group has reasonable and supportable information to
demonstrate that a more lagging default criterion is more appropriate.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-37 —


--- page 459 ---
(iii) Credit-impaired financial assets
A financial asset is credit-impaired when one or more events of default that have a detrimental
impact on the estimated future cash flows of that financial asset have occurred. Evidence that a financial
asset is credit-impaired includes observable data about the following events:
(a) significant financial difficulty of the issuer or the borrower;
(b) a breach of contract, such as a default or past due event;
(c) the lender(s) of the borrower, for economic or contractual reasons relating to the borrower’s
financial difficulty, having granted to the borrower a concession(s) that the lender(s) would not
otherwise consider;
(d) it is becoming probable that the borrower will enter bankruptcy or other financial
reorganization; or
(e) the disappearance of an active market for that financial asset because of financial difficulties.
(iv) Write-off policy
The Group writes off a financial asset when there is information indicating that the counterparty is
in severe financial difficulty and there is no realistic prospect of recovery. Financial assets written off may
still be subject to enforcement activities under the Group’s recovery procedures, taking into account legal
advice where appropriate. A write-off constitutes a derecognition event. Any subsequent recoveries are
recognized in profit or loss.
(v) Measurement and recognition of ECL
The measurement of ECL is a function of the probability of default, loss given default (i.e. the
magnitude of the loss if there is a default) and the exposure at default. The assessment of the probability
of default and loss given default is based on historical data and forward-looking information. Estimation
of ECL reflects an unbiased and probability-weighted amount that is determined with the respective risks
of default occurring as the weights.
Generally, the ECL is the difference between all contractual cash flows that are due to the Group in
accordance with the contract and the cash flows that the Group expects to receive, discounted at the
effective interest rate determined at initial recognition.
Lifetime ECL for certain trade receivables/contract assets are considered on a collective basis taking
into consideration past due information and relevant credit information such as forward looking
macroeconomic information.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-38 —


--- page 460 ---
For collective assessment, the Group takes into consideration the following characteristics when
formulating the grouping:
 Past-due status;
 Nature, size and industry of debtors; and
 External credit ratings where available.
The grouping is regularly reviewed by management to ensure the constituents of each group continue
to share similar credit risk characteristics.
Interest income is calculated based on the gross carrying amount of the financial asset unless the
financial asset is credit-impaired, in which case interest income is calculated based on amortized cost of
the financial asset.
The Group recognizes an impairment gain or loss in profit or loss for all financial instruments by
adjusting their carrying amount, with the exception of trade receivables, other receivables and contract
assets where the corresponding adjustment is recognized through a loss allowance account.
Derecognition/modification of financial assets
The Group derecognizes a financial asset only when the contractual rights to the cash flows from the
asset expire, or when it transfers the financial asset and substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership
of the asset to another entity. If the Group neither transfers nor retains substantially all the risks and
rewards of ownership and continues to control the transferred asset, the Group recognizes its retained
interest in the asset and an associated liability for amounts it may have to pay. If the Group retains
substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of a transferred financial asset, the Group continues
to recognize the financial asset and also recognizes a collateralized borrowing for the proceeds received.
On derecognition of a financial asset measured at amortized cost, the difference between the asset’s
carrying amount and the sum of the consideration received and receivable is recognized in profit or loss.
A modification of a financial asset occurs if the contractual cash flows are renegotiated or otherwise
modified.
When the contractual terms of a financial asset are modified, the Group assesses whether the revised
terms result in a substantial modification from original terms taking into account all relevant facts and
circumstances including qualitative factors. If qualitative assessment is not conclusive, the Group
considers the terms are substantially different if the discounted present value of the cash flows under the
new terms, including any fees paid net of any fees received, and discounted using the original effective
interest rate, is at least 10 per cent different from the discounted present value of the remaining cash flows
of the original financial asset.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-39 —


--- page 461 ---
For non-substantial modifications of financial assets that do not result in derecognition, the carrying
amount of the relevant financial assets will be calculated at the present value of the modified contractual
cash flows discounted at the financial assets’ original effective interest rate. Transaction costs or fees
incurred are adjusted to the carrying amount of the modified financial assets and are amortized over the
remaining term. Any adjustment to the carrying amount of the financial asset is recognized in profit or loss
at the date of modification.
Financial liabilities and equity
Classification as debt or equity
Debt and equity instruments issued by a group entity are classified as either financial liabilities or
as equity in accordance with the substance of the contractual arrangements and the definitions of a
financial liability and an equity instrument.
Equity instruments
An equity instrument is any contract that evidences a residual interest in the assets of an entity after
deducting all of its liabilities. Equity instruments issued by the Company are recognized at the proceeds
received, net of direct issue costs.
Repurchase of the Company’s own equity instruments is recognized and deducted directly in equity.
No gain or loss is recognized in profit or loss on the purchase, sale, issue or cancellation of the Company’s
own equity instruments.
Financial liabilities at amortized cost
Financial liabilities including trade and other payables and loans from related parties are
subsequently measured at amortized cost, using the effective interest method.
Derecognition of financial liabilities
The Group derecognizes financial liabilities when, and only when, the Group’s obligations are
discharged, cancelled or have expired. The difference between the carrying amount of the financial
liability derecognized and the consideration paid and payable is recognized in profit or loss.
Derivative financial instruments
Derivatives are initially recognized at fair value at the date when derivative contracts are entered into
and are subsequently remeasured to their fair value at the end of the reporting period. The resulting gain
or loss is recognized in profit or loss unless the derivative is designated and effective as a hedging
instrument, in which event the timing of the recognition in profit or loss depends on the nature of the hedge
relationship.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-40 —


--- page 462 ---
Offsetting a financial asset and a financial liability
A financial asset and a financial liability are offset and the net amount presented in the consolidated
statement of financial position when, and only when, the Group currently has a legally enforceable right
to set off the recognised amounts; and intends either to settle on a net basis, or to realise the asset and settle
the liability simultaneously.
Hedge accounting
The Group designates certain derivatives as hedging instruments for cash flow hedges.
At the inception of the hedging relationship the Group documents the relationship between the
hedging instrument and the hedged item, along with its risk management objectives and its strategy for
undertaking various hedge transactions. Furthermore, at the inception of the hedge and on an ongoing
basis, the Group documents whether the hedging instrument is highly effective in offsetting changes in fair
values or cash flows of the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk.
For the purpose of determining whether a forecast transaction (or a component thereof) is highly
probable, the Group assumes that the interest rate benchmark on which the hedged cash flows
(contractually or non-contractually specified) are based is not altered as a result of interest rate benchmark
reform.
Assessment of hedging relationship and effectiveness
For hedge effectiveness assessment, the Group considers whether the hedging instrument is effective
in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk, which
is when the hedging relationships meet all of the following hedge effectiveness requirements:
 there is an economic relationship between the hedged item and the hedging instrument;
 the effect of credit risk does not dominate the value changes that result from that economic
relationship; and
 the hedge ratio of the hedging relationship is the same as that resulting from the quantity of the
hedged item that the Group actually hedges and the quantity of the hedging instrument that the
entity actually uses to hedge that quantity of hedged item.
If a hedging relationship ceases to meet the hedge effectiveness requirement relating to the hedge
ratio but the risk management objective for that designated hedging relationship remains the same, the
Group adjusts the hedge ratio of the hedging relationship (i.e. rebalances the hedge) so that it meets the
qualifying criteria again.
For changes made to the hedged risk, hedged item or hedging instrument required by interest rate
benchmark reform, the Group amends the formal designation of a hedging relationship to reflect the
changes by the end of the reporting period during which the relevant changes were made. Such an
amendment to the formal designation of the hedging relationship constitutes neither the discontinuation of
the hedging relationship nor the designation of a new hedging relationship.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-41 —


--- page 463 ---
Cash flow hedges
The effective portion of changes in the fair value of derivatives instruments that are designated and
qualify as cash flow hedges is recognized in other comprehensive income and accumulated under the
heading of cash flow hedging reserve, limited to the cumulative change in fair value of the hedged item
from inception of the hedge. The gain or loss relating to the ineffective portion is recognized immediately
in profit or loss, and is included in the “other gains and losses” line item.
When a hedged item in a cash flow hedge is amended to reflect the changes that are required by the
interest rate benchmark reform, the amount accumulated in the cash flow hedge reserve is deemed to be
based on the alternative benchmark rate on which the hedged future cash flows are determined.
Amounts previously recognized in other comprehensive income and accumulated in equity are
reclassified to profit or loss in the periods when the hedged item affects profit or loss, in the same line
as the recognized hedged item. Furthermore, if the Group expects that some or all of the loss accumulated
in the cash flow hedging reserve will not be recovered in the future that amount is immediately reclassified
to profit or loss.
Discontinuation of hedge accounting
The Group discontinues hedge accounting prospectively only when the hedging relationship (or a
part thereof) ceases to meet the qualifying criteria (after rebalancing, if applicable). This includes
instances when the hedging instrument expires or is sold, terminated or exercised. Discontinuing hedge
accounting can either affect a hedging relationship in its entirety or only a part of it (in which case hedge
accounting continues for the remainder of the hedging relationship).
For cash flow hedge, any gain or loss recognized in other comprehensive income and accumulated
in equity at that time remains in equity and is recognized when the forecast transactions is ultimately
recognized in profit or loss. When a forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur, the gain or loss
accumulated in equity is recognized immediately in profit or loss.
5. CRITICAL ACCOUNTING JUDGEMENTS AND KEY SOURCES OF ESTIMATION
UNCERTAINTY
In the application of the Group’s accounting policies, which are described in Note 4, the directors
of the Company are required to make judgements, estimates and assumptions about the carrying amounts
of assets that are not readily apparent from other sources. The estimates and underlying assumptions are
based on historical experience and other factors that are considered to be relevant. Actual results may
differ from these estimates.
The estimates and underlying assumption are reviewed on an on-going basis. Revisions to accounting
estimates are recognized in the period in which the estimate is revised if the revision affects only that
period, or in the period of the revision and future periods if revision affects both current and future
periods.
Critical judgements in applying accounting policies
The following are the critical judgements, apart from those involving estimations, that the directors
of the Company have made in the process of applying the Group’s accounting policies and that have the
most significant effect on the amounts recognized in the Historical Financial Information.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-42 —


--- page 464 ---
Performance obligation determination
For contracts that contain more than one performance obligations (i.e. FFS contracts usually have
multiple deliverable units, which are generally in the form of technical laboratory reports, samples and/or
goods), the Group allocates the transaction price to each performance obligation on a relative stand-alone
selling price basis, except for the allocation of discounts and variable consideration.
A performance obligation represents a good and service that is distinct or a series of distinct goods
or services that are substantially the same. In certain sales contracts, the Group is required to fulfil
multiple promised goods and/or services. In determining performance obligations, the management of the
Group used judgements and interpretation of the contracts in identification of contractual components and
related performance obligations, based on which the management of the Group concluded those goods
and/or services as single or combined performance obligations.
Key sources of estimation uncertainty
The following are the key assumptions concerning the future, and other key sources of estimation
uncertainty at the end of the reporting period that may have a significant risk of causing a material
adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities in the future periods.
Provision of ECL for trade receivables and contract assets
Trade receivables with significant balances and credit-impaired are assessed to ECL individually. In
estimating ECL on trade receivables and contract assets, the Group uses the provision rates which are
based on internal credit ratings as groupings of various debtors taking into consideration the Group’s
historical default rates and forward-looking information that is reasonable and supportable available
without undue costs or effort. At every reporting date, the historical observed default rates are reassessed
and changes in the forward-looking information are considered.
The provision of ECL is sensitive to changes in estimates. The information about the ECL and the
Group’s trade receivables and contract assets are disclosed in Note 33(c).
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, the carrying amounts of trade
receivables are RMB23,890,000, RMB89,193,000 and RMB453,271,000, and RMB672,688,000
respectively.
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, the carrying amounts of contract assets
are RMB1,028,000, RMB10,717,000 and RMB17,309,000, and RMB24,665,000 respectively.
Estimated impairment of goodwill
Determining whether goodwill is impaired requires an estimation of the recoverable amount of the
cash-generating unit (or group of cash-generating units) to which goodwill has been allocated, which is
the value in use. The value in use calculation requires the Group to estimate the future cash flows expected
to arise from the cash-generating unit (or a group of cash-generating units) and an appropriate discount
rate in order to calculate the present value. Where the actual future cash flows are less than expected, or
change in facts and circumstances which results in downward revision of future cash flows or upward
revision of discount rate, a material impairment loss may arise.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-43 —


--- page 465 ---
As at December 31, 2021, 2022 and June 30, 2023, the carrying amount of goodwill is
RMB215,193,000. Details of the recoverable amount calculation are disclosed in Note 18.
Estimated impairment of property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets and intangible assets
Property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets and intangible assets are stated at costs less
accumulated depreciation/amortization and impairment, if any. In determining whether an asset is
impaired, the Group has to exercise judgement and make estimation, particularly in assessing: (1) whether
an event has occurred or any indicators that may affect the asset value; (2) whether the carrying value of
an asset can be supported by the recoverable amount, in the case of value in use, the net present value of
future cash flows which are estimated based upon the continued use of the asset; and (3) the appropriate
key assumptions to be applied in estimating the recoverable amounts including cash flow projections and
an appropriate discount rate. When it is not possible to estimate the recoverable amount of an individual
asset (including right-of-use assets), the Group estimates the recoverable amount of the cash-generating
unit to which the assets belongs, including allocation of corporate assets when a reasonable and consistent
basis of allocation can be established, otherwise recoverable amount is determined at the smallest group
of cash-generating units, for which the relevant corporate assets have been allocated. Changing the
assumptions and estimates, including the discount rates or the growth rate in the cash flow projections,
could materially affect recoverable amounts.
During the Track Record Period, the management of the Group assessed whether an event, has
occurred or any indicators that may affect the asset value. The management concluded that there were no
indications of impairment or the recoverable amounts of the related assets that may have impairment
indications were higher than the carrying amounts, thus no impairment loss has been recognized on
property, plant and equipment, right-of-use assets and intangible assets.
Impairment of contract costs
The Group assesses periodically if contract costs may not be recoverable based on an assessment of
the remaining amount of consideration the Group expects to receive in exchange of goods or services.
Impairment are applied to contract costs where events or changes in circumstances indicate that the
remaining amount of consideration to receive less the costs directly related to providing goods or services
that have not been recognized as expense is lower than the carrying amount of contract costs. The
remaining amount of consideration to receive has been determined based on the remaining amount of
consideration expected to be recognized upon the completion of the contract. Where the expectation is
different from the original estimate, such difference will impact the carrying value of contract costs in the
year in which such estimate changes.
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, the carrying amounts of contract costs
are RMB13,875,000, RMB36,690,000 and RMB80,713,000, and RMB63,l34,000.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-44 —


--- page 466 ---
6. REVENUE AND SEGMENT INFORMATION
(i) Disaggregation of revenue from contracts with customers
The Group derives its revenue from the transfer of services at a point in time and over time in the
following major service lines:
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Type of services
Services
– Research services
on FFS basis .......... 96,353 311,131 974,421 324,513 980,144
– Research services on full-
time- equivalent (“FTE”)
basis ................ — — 16,002 4,923 13,324
Total .................. 96,353 311,131 990,423 329,436 993,468
Timing of revenue
recognition
A point in time
– Research services
on FFS basis .......... 96,353 310,266 973,929 318,948 971,062
Over time
– Research services
on FFS basis .......... — 8 6 5 4 9 2 5,565 9,082
– Research services
on FTE basis .......... — — 16,002 4,923 13,324
Total .................. 96,353 311,131 990,423 329,436 993,468
(ii) Performance obligations for contracts with customers
Research services on FFS basis
The Group primarily earns revenue by providing research services to its customers through FFS
contracts. Contract duration ranges from few months to years.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-45 —


--- page 467 ---
Majority of FFS contracts entered by the Group contain multiple deliverable units, which are
generally in the form of technical laboratory reports and/or samples, each with individual selling price
specified in the contract. Usually, the Group identifies each deliverable unit as a separate performance
obligation, and recognizes FFS revenue of contractual elements at the point upon acceptance of the
deliverable units or after the end of a confirmation period. The contracts include payment schedules which
require stage payments over the research period once certain specified milestones are reached. The
Group’s performance does not create an asset with alternative future use since the Group cannot redirect
the asset for use on another customer, and at the same time the Group has a present right to payment from
the customers for services performed only upon acceptance of the deliverable units, therefore, the directors
of the Company have concluded that the performance obligation of such FFS contract is satisfied at a point
in time and recognized the FFS revenue at a point in time.
In addition, usually there is a performance obligation embedded in the abovementioned FFS
contracts namely project management service for which the directors of the Company have assessed that
the customers simultaneously receive and consume benefit provided by the Group’s performances. As
such, the directors of the Company concluded that the performance obligation of the project management
service is satisfied over time and the associated revenue is recognized over the service period using input
method.
Research services on FTE basis
For the research services provided on a FTE basis, the Group provides its customer with a project
team of employees dedicated to the customer’s studies for a specific period of time and charges the
customer at a fixed hourly/daily rate per employee. For the services under FTE model, the directors of the
Company have assessed that the customers simultaneously receive and consume benefit provided by the
Group’s performances. Therefore, the performance obligation of FTE services is satisfied over time and
FTE revenue is recognized over the service period. The customers shall pay the Group a prorated amount
for the service based on the fixed rate per employee.
(iii) Transaction price allocated to the remaining performance obligation for contracts with
customers
The aggregate amount of the transaction price allocated to performance obligations that are
unsatisfied (or partially unsatisfied) were nil, RMB475 million and RMB1,495 million, and RMB2,958
million as at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, respectively. The management of the
Group expects the majority of the transaction price allocated to the unsatisfied contracts as of each
reporting date during the reporting period will be recognized as revenue within five years from the
reporting date.
For the purpose of resources allocation and performance assessment, the chief operating decision
maker (i.e. the chief executive officer of the Company) reviews the overall results and financial position
of the Group as a whole prepared based on the same accounting policies as set out in Note 4. Accordingly,
the Group has only one single operating and reportable segment and no further analysis of this single
segment is presented.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-46 —


--- page 468 ---
Geographical information
An analysis of the Group’s revenue from customers, analyzed by their respective country/region of
operation, is detailed below:
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Revenue
– North America ......... — 5,399 259,521 59,449 290,158
– t h eP R C .............. 96,353 291,104 566,475 237,656 471,096
– Europe ............... — 5,265 128,647 22,491 213,363
– Rest of the world ....... — 9,363 35,780 9,840 18,851
96,353 311,131 990,423 329,436 993,468
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, the Group’s non-current assets are all located in the PRC.
As at June 30, 2023, except for non-current assets of the Group amounted to RMB1,421,000 are located
in Singapore, the Group’s remaining non-current assets are located in the PRC.
Information about major customers
Revenue from customers of the corresponding periods contributing over 10% of the total sales of the
Group are as follows:
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Customer A (note) ........ 81,041 252,420 375,466 237,156 140,484
Customer B (note) ........ N/A N/A N/A N/A 131,199
Customer C (note) ........ N / A N / A N / A N / A 129,844
Note: N/A: not disclosed as amount less than 10% of total revenue.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-47 —


--- page 469 ---
7. OTHER INCOME
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months ended
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Rental and other related
income (note i) ......... 1,525 7,596 3,831 1,614 1,122
Sales of materials to related
parties ............... 2 4 6 4 4 5 1,930 1,313 3,730
Interest income from banks . . 31 28 4,612 562 3,424
Research and other grants
related to income (note ii) . 39,644 897 15,779 15,323 31,303
41,446 8,966 26,152 18,812 39,579
Notes:
(i) In respect of the rental income, there are direct operating expenses incurred for investment property that generated
rental income amounting to RMB406,000, RMB561,000 and RMB2,346,000 for the years ended December 31, 2020,
2021 and 2022, respectively, and RMB1,082,000 and RMB946,000 for the period ended June 30, 2022 (unaudited) and
June 30, 2023, respectively.
(ii) The research and other grants received by the Group during the Track Record Period were mainly related to the Group’s
contribution to the local high-tech industry and economy. These grants are unconditional and accounted for as
immediate financial support with neither future related costs expected to be incurred nor related to any assets of the
Group.
8. OTHER GAINS AND LOSSES
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months ended
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Net foreign exchange
(loss)gain ............. (2,711) (986) 46,284 25,455 (1,407)
Fair value gain on wealth
management products .... ———— 5,543
Others ................. — 1 3 1 3 8 8 2 2 4 3 2 5
(2,711) (855) 46,672 25,679 4,461
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-48 —


--- page 470 ---
9. FINANCE COSTS
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Interest expense on loans
from related parties ...... — 4 2 4 2,591 1,381 420
Interest expense on lease
liabilities ............. — 6 9 3 2 5 1 9 2 1 4 9
— 493 2,916 1,573 569
10. PROFIT BEFORE TAX
Profit before tax has been arrived at after charging (crediting):
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Depreciation for property,
plant and equipment ..... 16,064 21,390 22,808 9,748 22,546
Depreciation for investment
property .............. — 1 6 8 4 0 3 2 0 2 2 0 2
Depreciation of right-of-use
assets ................ — 1 , 1 1 2 6,459 3,229 2,348
Amortization of intangible
assets ................ 5 6 5 2,218 10,342 3,417 3,601
16,629 24,888 40,012 16,596 28,697
Staff cost (including
directors’ emoluments):
– Salaries and other
benefits .............. 41,641 78,057 144,213 49,330 112,001
– Retirement benefits
scheme contributions
(note) ............... 285 6,850 14,526 5,378 12,286
– Share-based payment
expenses ............. 6,476 22,157 38,626 10,595 34,847
48,402 107,064 197,365 65,303 159,134
Less: Capitalized in contract
costs and property, plant
and equipment .......... (7,556) (6,833) (44,532) (13,136) (34,140)
57,475 125,119 192,845 68,763 153,691
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-49 —


--- page 471 ---
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Impairment losses recognized
(reversed), under expected
credit loss model, net of
reversal
– Trade receivables ....... 2 8 1 10,562 41,047 (2,976) (23,792)
– Contract assets ......... — 2 1 4 9 — 1,585
– Receivables for purchase
of raw materials on behalf
of customers .......... 8 ( 6 ) 2,173 — (2,175)
289 10,558 43,369 (2,976) (24,382)
Listing expenses .......... ———— 7,374
Auditors’ remuneration ..... 1 2 3 7 5 0 5 7 9 2 8 1 2 8 6
Write-down of inventories
(included in cost of
services) .............. — 3 6 3 4 4 8 3 8 5 3 8 0
Reversals of write-down of
inventories (included in
cost of services) ........ — — (328) (327) (107)
Write-down of contract costs
(included in cost of
services) .............. 1 3,811 5,815 7,739 2,720
Reversals of write-down of
contract costs (included in
cost of services) ........ — ( 1 ) (3,810) (3,810) (1,955)
(Loss) gain on disposal of
property, plant and
equipment ............. — (108) (65) (29) 19
Cost of inventories
recognized as an expense . . — 41,964 96,460 58,295 80,833
Note: During the year ended December 31, 2020, pursuant to the notice released by the relevant PRC authority, certain
domestic subsidiaries of the Group have been fully or partially waived to undertake a number of retirement benefit
scheme contributions and other social insurance.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-50 —


--- page 472 ---
11. INCOME TAX EXPENSES
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Current tax
– the PRC Enterprise
Income Tax (“EIT”) ..... 6,316 14,918 47,230 20,322 33,462
– Hong Kong profits tax . . . — — 2,231 912 3,573
Deferred tax (Note 19) ..... (249) (1,608) (9,342) (72) 2,780
Over provision in prior
years ................ — (1,387) (49) (39) (5,461)
Total income tax expenses. . . 6,067 11,923 40,070 21,123 34,354
Under the Law of the PRC on Enterprise Income Tax (the “EIT Law”) and Implementation
Regulation of the EIT Law, the EIT rate of the PRC subsidiaries is 25%.
Hong Kong Profits Tax is calculated at 16.5% on the estimated assessable profit.
For certain Group’s subsidiaries operating in the PRC are eligible for certain concessions, which
were accredited as “High and New Technology Enterprise” or “Micro and Small Enterprise” were
therefore entitled to a preferential EIT rate or certain concessions.
The directors of the Company are of the view that it is very probable that the subsidiaries which are
eligible for “High and New Technology Enterprise” tax preference are able to extend their accreditation
upon expiry.
Taxation arising in other jurisdictions is calculated at the rates prevailing in the relevant
jurisdictions.
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Profit before tax .......... 32,366 66,853 195,801 119,390 211,568
Tax charge at the EIT rate of
2 5 %................. 8,092 16,713 48,950 29,848 52,892
Tax effect of income that is
exempt from taxation ..... — — (5,536) (11) (1,093)
Tax effect of expenses not
deductible for tax purpose
(note) ................ 2,334 6,464 12,612 4,878 9,091
Over provision in respect of
prior years ............ — (1,387) (49) (39) (5,461)
Effect of additional
deduction on research and
development expense ..... (381) (1,605) (2,438) (1,048) (5,855)
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-51 —


--- page 473 ---
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Effect of unused tax losses
not recognized as deferred
tax assets ............. — 2 2 9 — — 4 9
Utilization of tax losses
previously not recognized
as deferred tax assets ..... (1,802) ————
Tax at concessionary rates. . . (2,176) (8,790) (7,646) (6,916) (16,360)
Decrease in opening deferred
tax assets resulting from a
decrease in applicable tax
rate ................. — 1 3 8———
Effect of different tax rate of
operating entities in other
jurisdiction ............ — 1 6 1 (5,823) (5,589) 1,091
Income tax expenses ....... 6,067 11,923 40,070 21,123 34,354
Note: Tax effect of expenses not deductible for tax purpose was mainly resulted from share-based payment expenses.
12. DIRECTORS’, CHIEF EXECUTIVE’S AND EMPLOYEES’ EMOLUMENTS
Details of the emoluments paid or payable to the individuals who were appointed as the directors and
chief executive of the Company (including emoluments for services as employees/directors of the group
entities prior to becoming the directors of the Company), during the Track Record Period, disclosed
pursuant to the applicable Listing Rules and Hong Kong Companies Ordinance, are as follows:
For the year ended December 31, 2020
Date of
appointment Director’s fee
Salaries and
other benefits
Performance-
based bonus
Retirement
benefit
scheme
contributions
Share-based
compensation Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Executive director and chief
executive officer:
Dr. Jincai Li ............ December 14,
2020
(note i)
— 1,341 504 — 939 2,784
Executive director and chief
financial officer:
Mr. Xiaojie Xi ........... June 30, 2023 — — — — — —
Executive director and chief
operating officer:
Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang ..... June 30, 2023 — 1,200 480 — 739 2,419
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-52 —


--- page 474 ---
Date of
appointment Director’s fee
Salaries and
other benefits
Performance-
based bonus
Retirement
benefit
scheme
contributions
Share-based
compensation Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Non-executive director:
Dr. Zhisheng Chen ........ December 14,
2020
(note ii)
—— —— ——
Dr. Weichang Zhou ........ December 14,
2020
(note ii)
—— —— ——
Ms. Ming Shi ........... June 30, 2023 — — — — — —
Director:
D r . G e L i .............. December 14,
2020
(note iii)
—— —— ——
Dr. Minzhang Chen ........ December 14,
2020
(note iv)
—— —— ——
Dr. Steve Qing Y ang ....... M a y 3 1 , 2021
(note iv)
—— —— ——
— 2,541 984 — 1,678 5,203
For the year ended December 31, 2021
Date of
appointment Director’s fee
Salaries and
other benefits
Performance-
based bonus
Retirement
benefit
scheme
contributions
Share-based
compensation Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Executive director and chief
executive officer:
Dr. Jincai Li ............ December 14,
2020
(note i)
— 1,389 552 — 3,713 5,654
Executive director and chief
financial officer:
Mr. Xiaojie Xi ........... June 30, 2023 — — — — — —
Executive director and chief
operating officer:
Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang ..... June 30, 2023 — 1,211 480 — 1,537 3,228
Non-executive director:
Dr. Zhisheng Chen ........ December 14,
2020
(note ii)
—— —— ——
Dr. Weichang Zhou ........ December 14,
2020
(note ii)
—— —— ——
Ms. Ming Shi ........... June 30, 2023 — — — — — —
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-53 —


--- page 475 ---
Date of
appointment Director’s fee
Salaries and
other benefits
Performance-
based bonus
Retirement
benefit
scheme
contributions
Share-based
compensation Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Director:
D r . G e L i .............. December 14,
2020
(note iii)
—— —— ——
Dr. Minzhang Chen ........ December 14,
2020
(note iv)
—— —— ——
Dr. Steve Qing Y ang ....... M a y 3 1 , 2021
(note iv)
—— —— ——
— 2,600 1,032 — 5,250 8,882
For the year ended December 31, 2022
Date of
appointment Director’s fee
Salaries and
other benefits
Performance-
based bonus
Retirement
benefit
scheme
contributions
Share-based
compensation Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Executive director and chief
executive officer:
Dr. Jincai Li ............ December 14,
2020
(note i)
— 2,013 805 — 11,938 14,756
Executive director and chief
financial officer:
Mr. Xiaojie Xi ........... June 30, 2023 — — — — — —
Executive director and chief
operating officer:
Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang ..... June 30, 2023 — 1,230 492 — 3,350 5,072
Non-executive director:
Dr. Zhisheng Chen ........ December 14,
2020
(note ii)
—— —— ——
Dr. Weichang Zhou ........ December 14,
2020
(note ii)
—— —— ——
Ms. Ming Shi ........... June 30, 2023 — — — — — —
Director:
Dr. Minzhang Chen ........ December 14,
2020
(note iv)
—— —— ——
Dr. Steve Qing Y ang ....... M a y 3 1 , 2021
(note iv)
—— —— ——
— 3,243 1,297 — 15,288 19,828
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-54 —


--- page 476 ---
For the six months ended June 30, 2022 (unaudited)
Date of
appointment Director’s fee
Salaries and
other benefits
Performance-
based bonus
Retirement
benefit
scheme
contributions
Share-based
compensation Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Executive director and chief
executive officer:
Dr. Jincai Li ............ December 14,
2020
(note i)
— 978 391 — 3,328 4,697
Executive director and chief
financial officer:
Mr. Xiaojie Xi ........... June 30, 2023 — — — — — —
Executive director and chief
operating officer:
Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang ..... June 30, 2023 — 600 240 — 1,656 2,496
Non-executive director:
Dr. Zhisheng Chen ........ December 14,
2020
(note ii)
—— —— ——
Dr. Weichang Zhou ........ December 14,
2020
(note ii)
—— —— ——
Ms. Ming Shi ........... June 30, 2023 — — — — — —
Director:
Dr. Minzhang Chen ........ December 14,
2020
(note iv)
—— —— ——
Dr. Steve Qing Y ang ....... M a y 3 1 , 2021
(note iv)
—— —— ——
— 1,578 631 — 4,984 7,193
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-55 —


--- page 477 ---
For the six months ended June 30, 2023
Date of
appointment Director’s fee
Salaries and
other benefits
Performance-
based bonus
Retirement
benefit
scheme
contributions
Share-based
compensation Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Executive director and chief
executive officer:
Dr. Jincai Li ............ December 14,
2020
(note i)
— 1,035 414 — 5,023 6,472
Executive director and chief
financial officer:
Mr. Xiaojie Xi ........... June 30, 2023 — 415 166 3 — 584
Executive director and chief
operating officer:
Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang ..... June 30, 2023 — 699 276 — 1,620 2,595
Non-executive director:
Dr. Zhisheng Chen ........ December 14,
2020
(note ii)
—— —— ——
Dr. Weichang Zhou ........ December 14,
2020
(note ii)
—— —— ——
Ms. Ming Shi ........... June 30, 2023 — — — — — —
Director:
Dr. Minzhang Chen ........ December 14,
2020
(note iv)
—— —— ——
Dr. Steve Qing Y ang ....... M a y 3 1 , 2021
(note iv)
—— —— ——
— 2,149 856 3 6,643 9,651
Notes:
(i) Dr. Jincai Li was appointed as director on December 14, 2020, then re-designated to executive director with effect from June
30, 2023.
(ii) Dr. Zhisheng Chen and Dr. Weichang Zhou were appointed as director on December 14, 2020, then re-designated to
non-executive director with effect from June 30, 2023.
(iii) Dr. Ge Li was appointed as director on December 14, 2020 and resigned on May 31, 2021.
(iv) Dr. Minzhang Chen and Dr. Steve Qing Y ang were appointed as director on December 14, 2020 and May 31, 2021,
respectively, and resigned on June 30, 2023.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-56 —


--- page 478 ---
Five highest paid individuals’ emoluments
The five highest paid employees of the Group included two directors of the Company whose
emoluments are set out above throughout the Track Record Period. The emoluments of the remaining three
individuals throughout the Track Record Period, were as follows:
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Salaries and other benefits ....... 2,216 2,373 2,517 1,242 2,295
Performance-based bonus ....... 7 1 9 7 9 2 8 2 6 4 1 0 7 8 0
Retirement benefit scheme
contributions ............... 4 5 8 5 9 5 4 7 —
Share-based compensation ....... 2,005 4,265 6,327 2,395 1,565
4,985 7,515 9,765 4,094 4,640
During the Track Record Period, no emoluments were paid by the Group to the directors of the
Company or the five highest paid individuals (including directors and employees) as an inducement to join
or upon joining the Group or as compensation for loss of office. None of the directors of the Company
have waived any emoluments during the Track Record Period.
The emoluments of the five highest paid individuals were within the following bands:
Number of individuals
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
(unaudited)
HK$1,000,001 to HK$1,500,000 .... 1 — — 1 1
HK$1,500,001 to HK$2,000,000 .... 1 — — 1 1
HK$2,000,001 to HK$2,500,000 .... 2 1 — 1 1
HK$2,500,001 to HK$3,000,000 .... — 1 1 — 1
HK$3,000,001 to HK$3,500,000 .... 1 2 — 1 —
HK$4,000,001 to HK$4,500,000 .... — — 2 — —
HK$5,500,001 to HK$6,000,000 .... — — 1 1 —
HK$6,500,001 to HK$7,000,000 .... — 1———
HK$7,000,001 to HK$7,500,001 .... ———— 1
HK$17,000,001 to HK$17,500,000 . . — — 1 — —
55555
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-57 —


--- page 479 ---
13. EARNINGS PER SHARE
The calculation of the basic earnings per share attributable to owners of the Company is based on
the following data:
Y ear ended December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Earnings:
Earnings for the purpose of
calculating basic and diluted
earnings per share ......... 26,299 54,930 155,731 98,267 177,214
Number of shares
Number of shares:
Weighted average number of
ordinary shares for the purpose
of calculating basic earnings per
share ................ 600,000,000 600,000,000 881,643,836 680,000,000 1,000,000,000
Effect of dilutive potential ordinary
shares ................
Share options ............. ———— 23,010,525
Weighted average number of
ordinary shares for the purpose
of calculating diluted earnings
per share .............. 600,000,000 600,000,000 881,643,836 680,000,000 1,023,010,525
The weighted average number of shares for the purpose of basic earnings per share for Track Record
Period is calculated based on the assumptions as disclosed in Note 32 having been adjusted retrospectively
after taking into account the impact of 400,000,000 shares paid up in April 2022.
No computation of diluted earnings per share for the years December 31, 2020 and 2021 as there
were no potential dilutive ordinary shares in issue. The computation of diluted earnings per share for the
year ended December 31, 2022 and for the six months ended June 30, 2022 (unaudited) does not assume
the exercise of share option scheme granted by the Company as set out in Note 38 since their exercise
prices plus fair value of services yet to be rendered are higher than the average share prices of the
Company.
14. DIVIDENDS
No dividend was paid or proposed for ordinary shareholders of the Company during the Track
Record Period nor has any dividend been proposed since the end of the reporting period.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-58 —


--- page 480 ---
15. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
Machinery
Furniture,
fixtures and
equipment
Land and
buildings
Leasehold
improvements
Construction
in progress
(“CIP”) Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
COST
As at January 1, 2020 ..... 60,838 3,505 — 84,883 132,305 281,531
Additions .............. 2,083 115 — — 51,319 53,517
Transfer in from CIP ..... 20,025 2,831 114,304 12,596 (149,756) —
Disposals .............. (1,074) — — (156) — (1,230)
As at December 31, 2020 . . 81,872 6,451 114,304 97,323 33,868 333,818
Additions .............. 6,883 252 — — 98,700 105,835
Transfer in from CIP ..... 24,434 2,089 25 37,992 (64,540) —
Transfer out to investment
property ............. — — (13,383) — — (13,383)
Disposals .............. (8,395) (80) — (31,767) (135) (40,377)
As at December 31, 2021 . . 104,794 8,712 100,946 103,548 67,893 385,893
Additions .............. 16,752 5,838 — — 464,684 487,274
Transfer in from CIP ..... 58,114 9,609 — 35,433 (103,156) —
Disposals .............. (577) (12) — — (1,221) (1,810)
As at December 31, 2022 . . 179,083 24,147 100,946 138,981 428,200 871,357
Additions .............. 2,171 498 — — 209,493 212,162
Transfer in from CIP ..... 46,208 5,477 103,095 64,746 (219,526) —
Disposals .............. (755) (354) — — — (1,109)
As at June 30, 2023 ...... 226,707 29,768 204,041 203,727 418,167 1,082,410
DEPRECIATION
As at January 1, 2020 ..... (10,542) (425) — (3,679) — (14,646)
Provided for the year ..... (8,842) (567) (2,212) (4,443) — (16,064)
Eliminated on
disposals ............ 5 2 — — 4 5 — 9 7
As at December 31, 2020 . . (19,332) (992) (2,212) (8,077) — (30,613)
Provided for the year ..... (10,324) (1,194) (3,319) (6,553) — (21,390)
Transfer out to investment
property ............. — — 1 6 8 — — 1 6 8
Eliminated on
disposals ............ 5 4 1 2 6 — 1,059 — 1,626
As at December 31, 2021 . . (29,115) (2,160) (5,363) (13,571) — (50,209)
Provided for the year ..... (10,499) (3,655) (2,916) (5,738) — (22,808)
Eliminated on
disposals ............ 2 2 8 7 — — — 2 3 5
As at December 31, 2022 . . (39,386) (5,808) (8,279) (19,309) — (72,782)
Provided for the period .... (12,025) (2,095) (3,078) (5,348) — (22,546)
Eliminated on disposals . . . 299 174 — — — 473
As at June 30, 2023 ...... (51,112) (7,729) (11,357) (24,657) — (94,855)
CARRYING V ALUES
At December 31, 2020 .... 62,540 5,459 112,092 89,246 33,868 303,205
At December 31, 2021 .... 75,679 6,552 95,583 89,977 67,893 335,684
At December 31, 2022 .... 139,697 18,339 92,667 119,672 428,200 798,575
As at June 30, 2023 ...... 175,595 22,039 192,684 179,070 418,167 987,555
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-59 —


--- page 481 ---
Except for CIP , the above items of property, plant and equipment are depreciated on a straight-line
basis after taking into account of the residual value as follows:
Machinery ........................... 9%-23% per annum
Furniture, fixtures and equipment .......... 9%-23% per annum
Land and buildings ..................... 3 %p e r annum
Leasehold improvements ................. 2 0 %p e r annum
16. INVESTMENT PROPERTY
The Group leases out an assembly center under operating lease with rentals payable annually. The
lease runs for an initial period of 2 to 4 years with unilateral rights to extend the lease beyond initial period
held by lessee only. The lease contract contains market review clauses in the event the lessee exercises the
option to extend.
The lease contract does not contain residual value guarantee and/or lessee’s option to purchase the
property at the end of lease term.
Leased property
RMB’000
COST
As at December 31, 2020 ....................................... —
Transfer in from property, plant and equipment ....................... 13,383
As at December 31, 2021, 2022 and June 30, 2023 ..................... 13,383
DEPRECIATION
As at December 31, 2020 ....................................... —
Charge for the year ............................................ (168)
As at December 31, 2021 ....................................... (168)
Charge for the year ............................................ (403)
As at December 31, 2022 ....................................... (571)
Charge for the period .......................................... (202)
As at June 30, 2023 ........................................... (773)
CARRYING V ALUES
As at December 31, 2020 ....................................... —
As at December 31, 2021 ....................................... 13,215
As at December 31, 2022 ....................................... 12,812
As at June 30, 2023 ........................................... 12,610
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-60 —


--- page 482 ---
The fair value of the Group’s investment property at December 31, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023
were RMB13,619,000 and RMB13,431,000, and RMB13,288,000, respectively. The fair value has been
arrived at based on a valuation carried out by PricewaterhouseCoopers Consultants (Shenzhen) Limited,
Shanghai Branch with registered address of 42/F New Bund Center, 588 Dongyu Road, Pudong New Area,
Shanghai 200126, PRC, independent valuer not connected with the Group.
The fair value was determined based on the income approach, where the market rentals of all lettable
units of the properties are assessed and discounted at the market yield expected by investors for this type
of properties. The market rentals are assessed by reference to the rentals achieved in the lettable units of
the properties as well as other lettings of similar properties in the neighbourhood. The discount rate is
determined by reference to the yields derived from analysing the sales transactions of similar commercial
properties and adjusted to take into account the market expectation from property investors to reflect
factors specific to the Group’s investment property. There has been no change from the valuation
technique used throughout the Track Record Period.
In estimating the fair value of the property, the highest and best use of the property is its current use.
Details of the Group’s investment property and information about the fair value hierarchy as at the
end of the reporting period are as follows:
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Carrying amount
Assembly center ................ — 13,215 12,812 12,610
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Fair value at Level 2 hierarchy
Assembly center ................ — 13,619 13,431 13,288
The above investment property is depreciated on a straight-line basis at the following rate per
annum:
Assembly center ....................... 3 1 years
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-61 —


--- page 483 ---
17. RIGHT-OF-USE ASSETS
The Group as lessee
Leased properties
RMB’000
As at December 31, 2020
Carrying amount .............................................. —
As at December 31, 2021
Carrying amount .............................................. 2,223
As at December 31, 2022
Carrying amount .............................................. 5,280
As at June 30, 2023
Carrying amount .............................................. 4,529
For the year ended December 31, 2020
Depreciation charge ........................................... —
For the year ended December 31, 2021
Depreciation charge ........................................... 1 , 1 1 2
For the year ended December 31, 2022
Depreciation charge ........................................... 6,459
For the period ended June 30, 2023
Depreciation charge ........................................... 2,348
Y ear ended December 31,
Six
months ended
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Expenses relating to short-term leases . . 862 1,659 3,122 4,955
Total cash outflow for leases ......... 8 6 2 1,659 9,172 7,436
Additions to right-of-use assets ....... — 2,180 9,516 1,597
Throughout the Track Record Period, the Group leases various offices and laboratories for its
operations. Lease contracts are entered into for a fixed term of 1.5 to 6 years, but may have extension
options as described in Note 5. Lease terms are negotiated on an individual basis and contain a wide range
of different terms and conditions. In determining the lease term and assessing the length of the
non-cancellable period, the Group applies the definition of a contract and determines the period for which
the contract is enforceable.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-62 —


--- page 484 ---
The Group regularly entered into short-term leases for equipment, offices and laboratories. As at
December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, the portfolio of short-term leases is similar to the
portfolio of short-term leases to which the short-term lease expenses are disclosed above.
Restrictions or covenants on leases
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, lease liabilities of nil, RMB2,249,000,
RMB6,040,000 and RMB5,305,000, are recognized with related right-of-use assets of nil, RMB2,223,000
and RMB5,280,000, RMB4,529,000 respectively. The lease agreements do not impose any covenants other
than the security interests in the leased assets that are held by the lessor. Leased assets may not be used
as security for borrowing purposes. The Group is restricted from assigning and subleasing the leased assets
outside the Group.
18. GOODWILL
Acquisition of
Payload and
Linker Business
RMB’000
COST AND CARRYING V ALUES
As at December 31, 2021, 2022, and June 30, 2023 .................... 215,193
The goodwill amounted to RMB215,193,000 was arising from the Group’s acquisition of Payload
and Linker Business during the year ended December 31, 2021.
For the purposes of impairment testing, the acquired Payload and Linker Business is allocated as an
individual cash-generating unit (the “Payload and Linker Unit”). The recoverable amount of the Payload
and Linker Unit has been determined based on a value in use calculation. That calculation uses cash flow
projections based on financial budgets approved by management covering a 5-year period.
The following table sets out the key assumptions for the value in use calculation of the Payload and
Linker Unit.
As at December 31,
2021 2022
RMB’000 RMB’000
Pre-tax discount rate (note i) ....................... 1 6 % 1 7 %
Expected annual growth rate in 5 years (note ii) ......... 10.0%-30.0% 5.0%-30.0%
Notes:
i. Pre-tax discount rate applied reflects the current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific
to the Payload and Linker Unit.
ii. The estimation of expected annual growth rate is based on the revenue backlog and management’s expectation for the
market development.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-63 —


--- page 485 ---
The cash flows beyond the 5-year period are extrapolated using a growth rate based on the relevant
industry growth forecasts and does not exceed the average long-term growth rate for the relevant industry.
The management of the Group performed sensitivity test on the key assumptions by increasing 1%
of pre-tax discount rate or decreasing of 5% expected annual growth rate, with all other variables held
constant. The impact on the amount by which the goodwill’s recoverable amount above its carrying
amount (headroom) are as below:
As at December 31,
2021 2022
RMB’000 RMB’000
Headroom .................................... N / A (note) 83,068
Impact by increasing pre-tax discount rate of 1% ........ (26,373) (32,019)
Impact by decreasing annual growth rate of 5% ......... (45,513) (47,174)
Note: As the acquisition date of Payload and Linker Business was near the end of financial year 2021, the management of
the Group considers recoverable amount approximates the carrying amount as at December 31, 2021.
Impairment assessment as at June 30, 2023
In accordance with the Group’s accounting policies, goodwill is tested for impairment on an annual
basis at each year end. As at June 30, 2023, the management was not aware of any significant adverse
changes on the Payload and Linker Unit, which indicates that the carrying amount of the Payload and
Linker Unit exceeds the recoverable amount. Consequently, no interim impairment assessment as at
June 30, 2023 was performed.
Based on the above assessment, management of the Group determines that there is no impairment
on the Payload and Linker Unit during and at the end of the reporting period. Management of the Group
believes that any reasonably possible change in any of these assumptions would not result in impairment.
19. DEFERRED TAXATION
For the purpose of presentation in the consolidated statement of financial position, certain deferred
tax assets and liabilities have been offset. The following is a summary of the deferred tax balances for
financial reporting purposes:
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Deferred tax assets .............. 3 8 7 1,995 11,540 8,557
Deferred tax liabilities ........... (556) (382) — —
(169) 1,613 11,540 8,557
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-64 —


--- page 486 ---
The following are the major deferred tax assets and liabilities recognized and movements thereon
before offsetting during the reporting periods:
Allowance on
inventories and
credit losses
Lease liability
under IFRS 16
Right-of-use
assets under
IFRS 16
Derivative
financial
instruments
Accrued
expenses Tax losses Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
As at January 1,
2020 ......... — — — — 1 3 8 — 1 3 8
Credited to profit or
loss .......... 4 4 — — — 2 0 5 — 2 4 9
Charged to other
comprehensive
income (“OCI”) . . — — — (556) — — (556)
As at December 31,
2020 ......... 4 4 — — (556) 343 — (169)
Credited (charged) to
profit or loss .... 1,638 563 (556) — (37) — 1,608
Credited to OCI .... — — — 1 7 4 — — 1 7 4
As at December 31,
2021 ......... 1,682 563 (556) (382) 306 — 1,613
Credited (charged) to
profit or loss .... 8,551 592 (441) — 640 — 9,342
Credited to OCI .... — — — 5 8 5 — — 5 8 5
As at December 31,
2022 ......... 10,233 1,155 (997) 203 946 — 11,540
(Charged) credited to
profit or loss .... (3,936) 5 (19) — — 1,170 (2,780)
Charged to OCI .... — — — (203) — — (203)
As at June 30, 2023 . 6,297 1,160 (1,016) — 946 1,170 8,557
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, the Group had unused tax losses of
nil, RMB915,000, nil, and RMB4,875,000, respectively available to offset against future profits. As at
December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, no deferred tax asset has been recognized in respect of these unused
tax losses due to the unpredictability of future profit streams. As at June 30, 2023, a deferred tax asset has
been recognized, in respect of approximately RMB4,678,000 of such losses, and no deferred tax has been
recognized in respect of the remaining approximately RMB197,000 due to the unpredictable of future
profit streams.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-65 —


--- page 487 ---
The unrecognized tax losses as at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023 include nil,
RMB203,000 and nil, and RMB197,000 of the losses arising from subsidiaries located in Hong Kong and
Singapore which will be carried forward indefinitely until it’s fully offset. The remaining unrecognized tax
losses will be carried forward and expire in years as follows:
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
2024 ........................ ————
2025 ........................ ————
2026 ........................ — 7 1 2 — —
2027 ........................ ————
2028 ........................ ————
Indefinitely ................... — 2 0 3 — 1 9 7
— 915 — 197
20. INTANGIBLE ASSETS
Technology License
Customer
relationship Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
COST
As at January 1, 2020 .................. 1,838 — — 1,838
Additions ........................... 3,600 — — 3,600
As at December 31, 2020 ................ 5,438 — — 5,438
Acquisition of Payload and Linker Business . . — — 58,400 58,400
As at December 31, 2021 and 2022 ........ 5,438 — 58,400 63,838
Additions ........................... — 10,000 — 10,000
As at June 30, 2023 .................... 5,438 10,000 58,400 73,838
AMORTIZATION
As at January 1, 2020 .................. (65) — — (65)
Charge for the year .................... (565) — — (565)
As at December 31, 2020 ................ (630) — — (630)
Charge for the year .................... (668) — (1,550) (2,218)
As at December 31, 2021 ................ (1,298) — (1,550) (2,848)
Charge for the year .................... (4,140) — (6,202) (10,342)
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-66 —


--- page 488 ---
Technology License
Customer
relationship Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(note i) (note ii)
As at December 31, 2022 ................ (5,438) — (7,752) (13,190)
Charge for the period ................... — (500) (3,101) (3,601)
As at June 30, 2023 .................... (5,438) (500) (10,853) (16,791)
CARRYING V ALUES
As at December 31, 2020 ................ 4,808 — — 4,808
As at December 31, 2021 ................ 4,140 — 56,850 60,990
As at December 31, 2022 ................ — — 50,648 50,648
As at June 30, 2023 .................... — 9,500 47,547 57,047
Notes:
(i) License fee paid is amortized on a straight-line basis over its estimated useful life of 5 years which represents the
average duration of contracts benefit from the license estimated by the management of the Group.
(ii) Customer relationship was recognized as a result of the acquisition of Payload and Linker Business in 2021. The
amount represented the intellectual property and existing customer relationships which have finite useful life and are
amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives of 9 years which was estimated by the management
of the Group as at the acquisition date based on the expected duration of business relationships with customers of
Payload and Linker Business with reference to the historical attrition pattern.
21. FINANCIAL ASSETS AT FVTPL
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Current asset
Wealth management products (note). . — — 400,000 —
Note: During the year ended December 31, 2022 and six months ended June 30, 2023, the Group entered into contracts of
wealth management products with a bank with maturity term within 12 months. The returns of the wealth management
products are determined by reference to the performance of the underlying instruments in the currency market,
therefore they are recognized as financial assets at FVTPL. The weighted average return rate is 3.7% and 9.4% for the
year ended December 31, 2022 and six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively.
The Group has redeemed all the wealth management products as at June 30, 2023.
Details of the fair value measurement of the financial assets at FVTPL are set out in Note 33(d).
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-67 —


--- page 489 ---
22. INVENTORIES
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Raw material and consumables ..... 7,678 23,786 62,934 47,403
Raw materials and consumables are net of a write-down of approximately nil, RMB363,000,
RMB483,000 and RMB756,000 as at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023.
23. CONTRACT COSTS
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Costs to fulfill contracts .......... 13,875 36,690 80,713 63,134
Contract costs are net of a write-down of approximately RMB1,000, RMB3,810,000 and
RMB2,005,000, and RMB765,000 for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and six months
ended June 30, 2023.
24. TRADE AND OTHER RECEIV ABLES
The Group
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Trade receivables from contracts with
customers
– Related parties ............... 18,347 63,209 134,666 88,748
Less: allowance for credit losses .... (261) (6,405) (13,520) (3,349)
– Third parties ................ 5,824 36,827 370,495 612,038
Less: allowance for credit losses .... (20) (4,438) (38,370) (24,749)
23,890 89,193 453,271 672,688
Receivables for purchase of raw
materials on behalf of customers . . 363 1,096 5,246 —
Less: allowance for credit losses .... ( 8 ) ( 2 ) (2,175) —
355 1,094 3,071 —
Advances to suppliers
– Third parties ................ 1,460 413 937 815
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-68 —


--- page 490 ---
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Other receivables
– Related parties ............... 3 8 43,210 2,312 4,753
– Third parties ................ 2,649 860 581 641
Deferred issue cost .............. — — — 1,054
Prepayments ................... 2 1 1 0 7 2 1 4 8 5 1
V alue added tax recoverable ....... 15,647 15,359 45,218 76,443
Total trade and other receivables .... 44,060 150,236 505,604 757,245
Details of the trade and other receivables due from related parties are set out in Note 37(b).
The Group allows a credit period ranging from 10 to 90 days to its customers. The following
is an aged analysis of trade receivables (net of allowance for credit losses) presented based on the
invoice dates:
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Not past due ................... 1,221 81,187 273,897 401,805
Overdue:
– Within 90 days ............... 18,329 5,422 141,332 165,468
– 91 days to 1 year ............. 4,340 2,584 36,301 98,196
– Over 1 year ................. — — 1,741 7,219
23,890 89,193 453,271 672,688
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, included in the Group’s trade
receivables balance are debtors with aggregate carrying amount of RMB22,669,000, RMB8,006,000
and RMB179,374,000, and RMB270,883,000, respectively, which are past due as at the reporting
date. Out of the past due balances, RMB4,340,000, RMB2,584,000 and RMB38,042,000, and
RMB105,415,000 has been past due 90 days or more and is not considered as in default as the
management of the Group believed that the amounts will be settled by the customers based on the
customers’ committed promise and historical experience. The Group does not hold any collateral
over these balances.
Details of impairment assessment of trade receivables, other receivables and receivables for
purchase of raw materials on behalf of customers are set out in Note 33(c).
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-69 —


--- page 491 ---
Trade and other receivables that are denominated in currencies other than the functional
currency of the respective group entities are set out below:
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
U S $ ......................... 18,384 87,904 364,454 424,574
Euro (“EUR”) .................. — — 17,861 2,194
The Company
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
Deferred issue cost .............. — — — 1,054
25. CONTRACT ASSETS
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Contract assets
– Related parties ................ — 7,684 7,685 7,685
Less: allowance for credit losses .... — ( 2 ) (44) (73)
– Third parties ................. 1,028 3,035 9,775 18,716
Less: allowance for credit losses .... — — (107) (1,663)
1,028 10,717 17,309 24,665
The contract assets primarily relate to the Group’s right to consideration for work completed and not
billed because the rights are conditioned upon the Group’s future performance in achieving specified
milestones as stipulated in the contract. The contract assets are transferred to trade receivables when the
rights become unconditional.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-70 —


--- page 492 ---
Typical payment terms which impact on the amount of contract assets recognized are as follows:
— Revenue on FFS basis
The Group’s FFS contracts include payment schedules which require stage payments over the
research or manufacturing period once certain specified milestones are reached or control of goods
are transferred to customers. The Group requires certain customers to pay 20%-50% of total contract
value as project start-up cost as part of its credit risk management policies.
The Group classifies these contract assets as current because the Group expects to realize these
contracts assets in their normal operating cycle.
Details of the impairment assessment of contract assets are set out in Note 33(c).
26. BANK BALANCES AND CASH
Bank balances and cash of the Group comprised of cash and short term bank deposits with an original
maturity of three months or less. The short term bank deposits are carried interests at market rates which
ranged from 0% to 2.38%, 0% to 2.1% and 0% to 2.03%, and 0% to 4.2% per annum for the years ended
December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and six months ended June 30, 2023 respectively.
The Group performed impairment assessment on bank balances and concluded that the associated
credit risk is limited because the counterparties are banks with high credit rating and good reputation.
Bank balances and cash that are denominated in currencies other than the functional currency of the
respective group entities are set out below:
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
U S $ ......................... 22,776 6,020 184,656 139,649
E U R ........................ — — 5,540 8,716
H K $ ........................ — — 5 1,663
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-71 —


--- page 493 ---
27. TRADE AND OTHER PAYABLES
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Trade payables
– Related parties .................. 2 4 22,505 457,295 484,756
– Third parties ................... 4,520 10,285 23,537 21,928
4,544 32,790 480,832 506,684
Other payables and accrual
– Related parties .................. 1,692 41,267 109,153 131,672
– Third parties ................... 3,333 17,131 25,060 20,780
Payable for purchase of property,
plant and equipment ............. 14,273 25,543 116,870 79,934
Consideration payable to a related party
for acquisition of Payload and Linker
Business ...................... — 280,000 — —
Consideration payable to a related party
for acquisition of XDC Wuxi ...... — 404,413 — —
Consideration payable to a related party
for acquisition of BCD Business Unit — — 15,587 5,710
Salary and bonus payables .......... 7,824 11,253 24,589 19,137
Accrued listing expenses ............ — — — 6,785
Accrued issue cost ................ — — — 9 5 0
Other taxes payable ............... 4 1 4 6,256 1,222 1,497
Trade and other payables ........... 32,080 818,653 773,313 773,149
Details of the trade and other payables due to related parties are set out in Note 37(b).
Payment terms with suppliers are mainly on credit within 90 days from the time when the goods are
received from the suppliers. The following is an aged analysis of trade payables presented based on
invoice date at the end of the reporting period:
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Within 90 days ................. 3,439 30,838 432,756 500,563
91 days to 1 year ............... 1,105 1,930 47,853 5,732
1 to 2 years ................... — 2 2 2 2 3 3 6 0
Over 2 years .................. — — — 2 9
4,544 32,790 480,832 506,684
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-72 —


--- page 494 ---
Trade and other payables that are denominated in currencies other than the functional currency of the
respective group entities are set out below:
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
U S $ ......................... 2 0 25,688 206,525 240,153
E U R ........................ 3 7 3 7 5 7 4 0 1 3 1
C H F ........................ — — 4 8 3 7 3 7
The Company
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
Other payables and accruals
– related parties ................ — 3 8 3 7 1 8 9 0 8
– third parties .................. — 5 8 6 1,094 1,388
Accrued listing expenses .......... — — — 6,785
Accrued issue cost .............. — — — 9 5 0
— 969 1,812 10,031
28. LOANS FROM RELATED PARTIES
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Loan from ultimate holding company:
Biologics Cayman .............. — 6 1 9 3 0 0 —
Loans from fellow subsidiaries: ......
WuXi Biologics Co., Ltd
(“W ABIO”)................. — 21,724 844 —
WuXi Biologics Biosafety Testing
(Suzhou) Co., Ltd. (“W ADT”) .... — — 70,000 —
Biologics Shanghai ............. ————
— 22,343 71,144 —
The loans from related parties are non-trade related, unsecured, repayable on demand and carry
interest at the fixed rate of nil, ranging from 1.50% to 1.85% and 1.75% to 4.58%, and 1.86% to 4.58%
per annum for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, respectively. The loans had been repaid
in full on April 21, 2023.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-73 —


--- page 495 ---
29. CONTRACT LIABILITIES
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Current
Contract liabilities
– Third parties ................. 1 5 1 10,020 151,450 232,418
As at January 1, 2020, contract liabilities amounted to nil.
Revenue of nil, RMB151,000 and RMB10,020,000, and RMB131,666,000 were recognized during
the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and six months ended June 30, 2023, respectively that
were included in the contract liabilities at the beginning of the relevant reporting periods.
Typical payment terms which impact on the amount of contract liabilities recognized are as follows:
— Revenue on FFS basis
The Group normally requires certain customers to pay 20% to 50% of total contract value as
down payment as project start-up cost as part of its credit risk management policies. The advance
payment schemes result in contract liabilities which represent the Group’s obligation to transfer
services to a customer for which the Group has received consideration (or an amount of consideration
is due) from the customer.
30. DERIV ATIVE FINANCIAL ASSETS AND LIABILITIES
Assets
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Derivatives under hedge accounting
Cash flow hedges
– Foreign currency forward ....... 2,224 2,549 799 —
Liabilities
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Derivatives under hedge accounting
Cash flow hedges
– Foreign currency forward ....... — — 2,147 —
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-74 —


--- page 496 ---
Derivatives under hedge accounting
In view of the management of the Group, the foreign currency forward contracts are highly effective
hedging instruments and qualified as cash flow hedges.
For the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, certain subsidiaries of the Group entered
into foreign currency forward contracts with a fellow subsidiary of Biologics Cayman, which is acting as
corporate treasury function within the WuXi Biologics group (as defined in Note 37) for entering into
hedging contracts with external banks, to minimize the exposure to fluctuations in foreign currency
exchange rate arising from anticipated foreign currency sales transactions, in particular, the exchange rate
between US$ and RMB for foreign currency sales transactions which is designated as cash flow hedges.
The major terms of these contracts on a net settlement basis as at each relevant Track Record Period
presented are as follows:
As at December 31, 2020
Average strike/
forward rate
Foreign
currency
Total outstanding
notional value
Fair value
assets
Fair value
liabilities
US$’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Sell US$
Less than 3 months .................. 6.5520-7.1787 1,047 7,407 552 —
3 to 6 months ..................... 6.5984-7.2870 1,877 13,407 1,052 —
7 to 12 months .................... 6.6312-6.9715 3,439 23,469 620 —
As at December 31, 2021
Average strike/
forward rate
Foreign
currency
Total outstanding
notional value
Fair value
assets
Fair value
liabilities
US$’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Sell US$
Less than 3 months .................. 6.5995-6.7465 4,755 31,789 1,330 —
3 to 6 months ..................... 6.5175-6.7115 6,237 41,124 918 —
7 to 12 months .................... 6.5080-6.6502 10,366 67,722 301 —
As at December 31, 2022
Average strike/
forward rate
Foreign
currency
Total outstanding
notional value
Fair value
assets
Fair value
liabilities
US$’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Sell US$
Less than 3 months .................. 6.4105-7.0525 5,805 38,374 68 (1,985)
4 to 6 months ..................... 6.8210-7.0185 2,119 14,655 141 (88)
7 to 11 months ..................... 6.7130-7.0050 4,607 32,037 590 (74)
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-75 —


--- page 497 ---
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, the aggregate amount after tax under foreign currency
forward contracts recognized in other comprehensive income relating to the exposure on anticipated future
sales transactions in US$ was gains of RMB1,668,000, gains of RMB2,167,000 and losses of
RMB1,146,000. The Group separates the intrinsic value and time value of forward extra contracts,
designating only the intrinsic value as the hedging instrument. The time value, including any gains or
losses, is recognized in other comprehensive income until the hedged transaction occurs and is recognized
in profit or loss. It is anticipated that the sales denominated in US$ related to foreign currency forward
contracts will take place within next 12 months as at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 at which time
the amount deferred in equity will be recycled to profit or loss.
During the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and six months ended June 30, 2023,
the aggregated amount of previously recognized in comprehensive income and accumulated in equity of
gains of RMB733,000, gains of RMB6,103,000 and losses of RMB4,661,000, and losses of RMB611,000
are reclassified to revenue when the hedged item affects profit or loss.
31. LEASE LIABILITIES
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Lease liabilities payable:
Within one year ................ — 2,249 4,413 2,828
Within a period of more than one
year but not exceeding two years . . — — 1,627 2,477
— 2,249 6,040 5,305
Less: amounts due within one year
shown under current liabilities .... — (2,249) (4,413) (2,828)
Amounts shown under non-current
liabilities ................... — — 1,627 2,477
For the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and six months ended June 30, 2023, the
weighted average incremental borrowing rate applied to lease liabilities is nil, 4.75% and 4.90%, and
4.90%.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-76 —


--- page 498 ---
32. SHARE CAPITAL
AUTHORIZED:
Number of
shares Par value
Authorized
share capital
US$ US$
On incorporation and as at
December 31, 2020 .............. 50,000 1 50,000
Subdivision on September 13, 2021 and
balance as at December 31, 2021 and
2022 (notes iii and iv) ............ 1,000,000,000 0.00005 50,000
Creation of new shares (note vi) ...... 9,000,000,000 0.00005 450,000
As at June 30, 2023 ............... 10,000,000,000 0.00005 500,000
ISSUED AND FULL Y PAID:
Number of
shares Par value Share capital
Share
premium
US$ US$
RMB’000
equivalent
RMB’000
equivalent
As at January 1, 2020 ....... — ————
Issue of new shares (note i) . . . 11 1 * —
As at December 31, 2020 ..... 1 1 1 * —
Repurchase (note i) ......... (1) 1 (1) — —
Issue of new shares (note ii). . . 51 5 * —
51 5 * —
After subdivision:
Subdivision of 5 shares into
100,000 shares of
US$0.00005 each (note iii) . . 100,000 0.00005 5 * —
Issue of new shares (note iv) . . 999,900,000 0.00005 N/A N/A N/A
As at December 31, 2021 ..... 1,000,000,000 0.00005 5 * —
Cancellation of shares
(note v) ................ (400,000,000) 0.00005 N/A N/A N/A
Shares fully paid (note iv) .... N/A N/A 49,995 319 1,285,143
Re-issue of shares (note v) .... 400,000,000 0.00005 N/A N/A N/A
As at December 31, 2022 and
June 30, 2023 ............ 1,000,000,000 0.00005 50,000 319 1,285,143
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-77 —


--- page 499 ---
Notes:
i. On December 14, 2020, the Company issued 1 new ordinary share to the initial subscriber at cash consideration of
US$1. On the same day, the ordinary share was transferred to Biologics Cayman at the same cash consideration.
Subsequent on June 4, 2021, the Company repurchased the 1 ordinary share from Biologics Cayman at same cash
consideration.
ii. On June 4, 2021, the Company issued and allotted 3 and 2 new ordinary shares at par value of US$1 per share for cash
consideration to Biologics Cayman and STA Pharmaceutical Hong Kong Investment Limited (“STA HK”), respectively.
iii. Further on September 13, 2021, the Company subdivided each ordinary share of a par value of US$1 per share to
20,000 ordinary shares of a par value of US$0.00005 per share.
iv. On September 29, 2021, additional 599,940,000 shares and 399,960,000 shares were issued and allotted at par to
Biologics Cayman and STA HK, respectively. After the subdivision and the second allotment of shares, Biologics
Cayman and STA HK held 600,000,000 and 400,000,000 shares, representing 60% and 40% shareholding in the
Company, respectively. The total cash consideration for these shares amounted to approximately RMB1,285,462,000
was paid up in April 2022, to which RMB1,285,143,000 was recognized in share premium.
v. The 400,000,000 shares held by STA HK were cancelled on January 28, 2022, and re-issued on June 8, 2022,
respectively.
vi. On June 30, 2023, the authorized share capital of the Company was increased from 1,000,000,000 ordinary shares to
10,000,000,000 ordinary shares by the creation of 9,000,000,000 ordinary shares at par value of US$0.00005 each.
* Amount below RMB1,000.
33. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
a. Capital risk management
The Group manages its capital to ensure that entities in the Group will be able to continue as going
concern while maximizing the return to shareholders through the optimization of the debt and equity
balance.
The capital structure of the Group consists of net debt, which includes loans from related parties and
lease liabilities disclosed in Notes 28 and 31 respectively, net of cash and cash equivalents, and equity
attributable to the Company, comprising issued share capital and reserves. The directors of the Company
review the capital structure on a continuous basis taking into account the cost of capital and the risks
associated with each class of capital. The Group will balance its overall capital structure through the issue
of new shares and bank borrowing, if necessary.
b. Categories of financial instruments
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Financial assets
Financial assets at amortized cost . . . 55,472 160,832 794,207 1,241,149
Financial assets at FVTPL ......... — — 400,000 —
Derivative financial assets ......... 2,224 2,549 799 —
Financial liabilities
Financial liabilities at amortized cost . 17,899 813,236 777,891 726,548
Derivative financial liabilities ...... — — 2,147 —
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-78 —


--- page 500 ---
c. Financial risk management objectives and policies
The Group’s major financial assets and liabilities include trade and other receivables, financial assets
at FVTPL, derivative financial assets, other long-term deposits, bank balances and cash, derivative
financial liabilities, trade and other payables and loans from related parties. Details of these financial
instruments are disclosed in the respective notes. The risks associated with these financial instruments and
the policies on how to mitigate these risks are set out below. The management of the Group manages and
monitors these exposures to ensure appropriate measures are implemented on a timely and effective
manner.
Market risk
The Group’s activities expose it primarily to currency risk. There had been no change in the Group’s
exposure to this risk or the manner in which it managed and measured the risk during the Track Record
Period.
Currency risk
Certain group entities have foreign currency transactions, including sales, which expose the Group
to foreign currency risk. Certain of the Group’s bank balances and cash, trade and other receivables and
trade and other payables are denominated in currencies other than the functional currency of the relevant
group entities and expose to such foreign currency risk. The carrying amounts of relevant group entities’
foreign currency denominated monetary assets and liabilities other than their functional currency are
disclosed in the respective notes.
The carrying amounts of the Group’s foreign currency denominated monetary assets (trade and other
receivables and bank balances and cash) and liabilities (trade and other payables and loans from related
parties) at the end of the reporting period are as follows:
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Assets
U S $ ......................... 41,160 93,924 549,110 564,223
E U R ........................ — — 23,401 10,910
H K $ ........................ — — 5 1,663
Liabilities
U S $ ......................... 2 0 25,688 206,525 240,153
E U R ........................ 3 7 3 7 5 7 4 0 1 3 1
C H F ........................ — — 4 8 3 7 3 7
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-79 —


--- page 501 ---
Sensitivity analysis
The following table details the Group’s sensitivity to a 5% increase and decrease in RMB against
US$, EUR, CHF and HK$, the foreign currencies with which the Group may have a material exposure. No
sensitivity analysis has been disclosed for the CHF and HK$ denominated assets/liabilities as the impact
on profit is immaterial. 5% represents management’s assessment of the reasonably possible change in
foreign exchange rate. The sensitivity analysis uses outstanding foreign currency denominated monetary
items as a base and adjusts their translation at the end of the reporting period for a 5% change in foreign
currency rate. A negative number below indicates a decrease in post-tax profit where RMB strengthens 5%
against the relevant currency. For a 5% weakening of RMB against the relevant currency, there would be
an equal and opposite impact an post-tax profit and the amounts below would be positive.
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Impact on profit or loss
sensitivity:
U S $....................... (1,671) (2,804) (13,624) (7,739) (13,572)
E U R ....................... 1 5 3 (901) (140) (451)
Interest rate risk
The Group is exposed to fair value interest rate risk in relation to fixed-rate loans from related parties
and lease liabilities (see Notes 28 and 31 for details). The Group currently does not have any interest rate
hedging policy. The management of the Group monitors the Group’s exposure on an on-going basis and
will consider hedging interest rate risk should the need arises.
The Group is also exposed to cash flow interest rate risk in relation to bank balances.
Sensitivity analysis
Bank balances are excluded from sensitivity analysis as the management considers that the exposure
of cash flow interest rate risk arising from variable-rate bank balances is insignificant.
Credit risk and impairment assessment
Credit risk refers to the risk that a counterparty will default on its contractual obligations resulting
in financial loss to the Group. The Group’s credit risk exposures are primarily attributable to trade and
other receivables, contract assets, other long-term deposits, financial assets at FVTPL, and bank balances
and cash. At the end of each reporting period, the Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk which cause
a financial loss to the Group due to failure to discharge an obligation by the counterparties is arising from
the carrying amount of the respective recognized financial assets as stated in the consolidated statement
of the financial position.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-80 —


--- page 502 ---
In order to minimize credit risk, the Group has developed and maintained the Group’s credit risk
grading to categorize exposures according to their degree of risk of default. Management uses publicly
available financial information and the Group’s own historical repayment records to rate its major
customers and other debtors. The Group’s exposure and the credit ratings of its counterparties are
continuously monitored and reviewed at the end of the reporting period to ensure the adequate impairment
losses are made for irrecoverable amount.
The Group’s current credit risk grading framework comprises the following categories:
Internal credit rating Description
Trade receivables/
contract assets Other financial assets
Low risk ......... T h e counterparty has a low
risk of default and does not
have any past due amounts
Lifetime ECL –
not credit-
impaired
12-month ECL
Watch list ......... Debtor frequently repays after
due dates but usually settle
after due date in full
Lifetime ECL –
not credit-
impaired
12-month ECL
Doubtful ......... There has been a significant
increase in credit risk since
initial recognition through
information developed
internally or external
resources
Lifetime ECL –
not credit-
impaired
Lifetime ECL –
not credit-
impaired
Loss ............ There is evidence indicating
the asset is credit-impaired
Lifetime ECL –
credit-impaired
Lifetime ECL –
credit impaired
Write-off ......... There is evidence indicating
that the debtor is in severe
financial difficulty and the
Group has no realistic
prospect of recovery
Amount is written
off
Amount is written
off
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-81 —


--- page 503 ---
The tables below detail the credit risk exposures of the Group’s financial assets and contract assets
which are subject to ECL assessment:
As at December 31,
As at
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
Internal
credit
rating 12-month or lifetime ECL
Gross
carrying
amount
Gross
carrying
amount
Gross
carrying
amount
Gross
carrying
amount
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Financial assets at
amortized cost
Bank balances ....... L o w risk 12-month ECL 28,390 26,325 334,972 561,644
Other receivables ..... L o w risk 12-month ECL 2,687 44,070 2,893 5,394
Receivables for purchase
of raw materials on
behalf of customers . .
(note i) 12-month ECL 96 1,096 414 —
Lifetime ECL
(not credit- impaired)
267 — — —
Lifetime ECL
(credit-impaired)
— — 4,832 —
Trade receivables ..... (note ii) Lifetime ECL (collective
assessment)
24,171 100,036 443,381 691,247
Lifetime ECL (individual
assessment)
— — 61,780 9,539
Other long-term
deposit ..........
Low risk 12-month ECL 150 150 — 368
Other item
Contract assets ....... (note ii) Lifetime ECL (collective
assessment)
1,028 10,719 17,460 26,401
Notes:
i. For the purposes of internal credit risk management, the Group has applied the general approach in IFRS 9 to measure
the loss allowance equal to 12m ECL for those current exposure at default of the debtors being assessed as not having
significant increase in credit risk since initial recognition. For those having significant increase in credit risk since
initial recognition, the Group recognized lifetime ECL.
ii. For trade receivables and contract assets, the Group determines the ECL on collective basis by categorizing its
customers into three types: low credit risk customers, normal credit risk customers and high credit risk customers,
based on the financial quality of debtors and their historical credit loss experience according to the past due status
adjusted, as appropriate, to reflect estimates of future economic conditions. Except for the customers which are
assessed individually, the Group determines the ECL based on their historical credit loss experience according to the
past due status adjusted, as appropriate, to reflect current conditions and estimates of future economic conditions.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-82 —


--- page 504 ---
Trade receivables and contract assets
The Group performs impairment assessment under ECL model on trade receivables with significant
balances and different credit risk characteristics individually and/or collectively based on appropriate
groupings. Except for items which are assessed for impairment individually, the remaining trade
receivables and contract assets are grouped based on shared credit risk characteristics by reference to the
Group’s internal credit ratings.
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, the Group provided RMB281,000,
RMB10,843,000 and RMB23,998,000, and RMB24,931,000 impairment allowance for trade receivables,
based on collective assessment.
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, the Group provided nil, RMB2,000
and RMB151,000, and RMB1,736,000 impairment allowance for contract assets, based on collective
assessment.
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, impairment allowance of nil, nil and
RMB27,892,000, and RMB3,167,000 was assessed individually on trade receivables with gross carrying
amount of nil, nil and RMB61,780,000, and RMB9,539,000.
The following table provides information about the exposure to credit risk for trade receivables and
contract assets which are assessed based on collective basis within lifetime ECL (not credit-impaired) as
at December 31, 2022, 2021 and 2020, and June 30, 2023 within lifetime ECL:
Gross carrying amount
As at December 31, 2020
Internal credit rating
Average loss
rate
Trade
receivables Contract assets
RMB’000 RMB’000
Grade A: Low risk and watch list ........... 0.03% 24,171 1,028
Grade B: Doubtful ...................... N / A — —
Grade C: Loss ......................... N / A — —
24,171 1,028
Gross carrying amount
As at December 31, 2021
Internal credit rating
Average loss
rate
Trade
receivables Contract assets
RMB’000 RMB’000
Grade A: Low risk and watch list ........... 0.03% 100,036 10,719
Grade B: Doubtful ...................... N / A — —
Grade C: Loss ......................... N / A — —
100,036 10,719
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-83 —


--- page 505 ---
Gross carrying amount
As at December 31, 2022
Internal credit rating
Average loss
rate
Trade
receivables Contract assets
RMB’000 RMB’000
Grade A: Low risk and watch list ........... 0.03% 372,025 15,665
Grade B: Doubtful ...................... 0.61% 62,560 1,707
Grade C: Loss ......................... 100% 8,796 88
443,381 17,460
Gross carrying amount
As at June 30, 2023
Internal credit rating
Average loss
rate
Trade
receivables Contract assets
RMB’000 RMB’000
Grade A: Low risk and watch list ........... 0.03% 433,730 18,974
Grade B: Doubtful ...................... 0.89% 230,022 7,427
Grade C: Loss ......................... 100% 27,495 —
691,247 26,401
The estimated loss rates are estimated based on historical observed default rates over the expected
life of the debtors and are adjusted for forward-looking information that is available without undue cost
or effort. The grouping is regularly reviewed by management of the Group to ensure relevant information
about specific debtors is updated. The contract assets have substantially the same risk characteristics as
the trade receivables for the same type of contracts. The relevant inputs used in determining the expected
credit loss rate for grade A customers were relatively stable during the Track Record Period, as such, the
expected credit loss rate for grade A customers remained the same during the Track Record Period. The
Group has therefore concluded that the loss rates for trade receivables are a reasonable approximation of
the loss rates for contract assets.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-84 —


--- page 506 ---
The following table shows the movement in lifetime ECL that has been recognized for trade
receivables and contract assets under the simplified approach.
Lifetime ECL
(not credit-impaired)
Lifetime ECL
(credit-impaired) Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
As at January 1, 2020 .............. — — —
– Impairment losses recognized ........ (281) — (281)
As at December 31, 2020 ........... (281) — (281)
– Impairment losses recognized ........ (6,229) (4,335) (10,564)
As at December 31, 2021 ........... (6,510) (4,335) (10,845)
– Impairment losses recognized ........ (8,788) (32,408) (41,196)
As at December 31, 2022 ........... (15,298) (36,743) (52,041)
– Impairment losses reversed ......... 6,587 15,620 22,207
As at June 30, 2023 ............... (8,711) (21,123) (29,834)
The following table shows the reconciliation of loss allowances that has been recognized for
receivables for purchase of raw materials on behalf of customers.
Lifetime ECL
(not credit-impaired)
RMB’000
As at January 1, 2020 ....................................... —
– Impairment losses recognized ................................. ( 8 )
As at December 31, 2020 ..................................... ( 8 )
– Impairment losses reversed ................................... 6
As at December 31, 2021 ..................................... ( 2 )
– Impairment losses recognized ................................. (2,173)
As at December 31, 2022 ..................................... (2,175)
– Impairment losses reversed ................................... 2,175
As at June 30, 2023 ......................................... —
For the purposes of impairment assessment, other financial assets including other receivables,
financial assets at FVTPL, and bank balances and cash are considered to have low credit risk. Accordingly,
for the purpose of impairment assessment for these financial assets, the loss allowance is measured at an
amount equal to 12-month ECL. In determining the ECL for these financial assets at amortized cost, the
directors of the Company have taken into account the historical default experience and the future prospects
of the industries and/or considering various external sources of actual and forecast economic information,
as appropriate, in estimating the probability of default of each of the other financial assets at amortized
cost occurring within their respective loss assessment time horizon, as well as the loss upon default in each
case. The directors of the Company considered that the 12-month ECL allowance is insignificant at the end
of each reporting period.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-85 —


--- page 507 ---
Liquidity risk
In the management of the liquidity risk, the Group monitors and maintains a level of bank balances
and cash deemed adequate by the management to finance the Group’s operations and mitigate the effects
of fluctuations in cash flows.
The following table details the Group’s remaining contractual maturity for its financial liabilities and
derivative instrument. The table has been drawn up based on the undiscounted cash flows of financial
liabilities according to the earliest date on which the Group is required to pay. The table includes both
interest and principal cash flows. To the extent that interest flows are floating rate, the undiscounted
amount is derived from interest rate at the end of the reporting period.
In addition, the following table details the Group’s liquidity analysis for its derivative financial
instruments. The tables have been drawn up based on the undiscounted contractual net cash (inflows) and
outflows on derivative instruments that settle on a net basis. When the amount payable is not fixed, the
amount disclosed has been determined by reference to the projected interest rates as illustrated by the yield
curves existing at the end of the reporting period. The liquidity analysis for the Group’s derivative
financial instruments are prepared based on the contractual settlement dates as the management considers
that the settlement dates are essential for an understanding of the timing of the cash flows of derivatives.
Weighted
average
interest rate
On demand
or less than
one year
One to
five years
More than 5
years
Total un-
discounted
cash flows
Total
carrying
amounts
% RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
As at December 31, 2020
Trade and other payables . . N/A 17,899 — — 17,899 17,899
As at December 31, 2021
Trade and other payables . . N/A 790,893 — — 790,893 790,893
Loans from related parties . 1.85-4.18 22,763 — — 22,763 22,343
Total financial liabilities . . 813,656 — — 813,656 813,236
Lease liabilities ........ 4.75 2,308 — — 2,308 2,249
815,964 — — 815,964 815,485
As at December 31, 2022
Trade and other payables . . N/A 706,747 — — 706,747 706,747
Loans from related parties . 1.75-4.36 73,708 — — 73,708 71,144
Total financial liabilities . . 780,455 — — 780,455 777,891
Lease liabilities ........ 4.90 4,531 1,958 — 6,489 6,040
784,986 1,958 — 786,944 783,931
Derivative – net
settlement
Foreign currency forward . . 2,147 — — 2,147 2,147
As at June 30, 2023
Trade and other payables . . N/A 726,548 — — 726,548 726,548
Lease liabilities ........ 4.90 2,860 2,849 — 5,709 5,305
729,408 2,849 — 732,257 731,853
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-86 —


--- page 508 ---
d. Fair value measurements of financial instruments
Some of the Group’s financial instruments are measured at fair value for financial reporting
purposes. The directors of the Company have set up a valuation committee, which is headed up by the
Chief Financial Officer of the Company, to determine the appropriate valuation techniques and inputs for
fair value measurements.
In estimating the fair value, the Group uses market-observable data to the extent it is available.
(i) Fair value of the Group’s financial assets and financial liabilities that are measured at fair value
on a recurring basis
Some of the Group’s financial assets and financial liabilities are measured at fair value at the end
of the reporting period. The following table gives information about how the fair values of these financial
assets and financial liabilities are determined (in particular, the valuation technique(s) and inputs used).
Financial assets/
financial liabilities
Fair value as at
December 31, 2020
Fair value
hierarchy
Valuation technique and
key inputs
Significant
unobservable
inputs
Foreign currency forward . . Derivative financial
assets:
RMB2,224,000
Level 2 Future cash flows are
estimated based on forward
exchange rates and
contracted forward rates,
discounted at a rate that
reflects the credit risk of
the banks.
N/A
Financial assets/
financial liabilities
Fair value as at
December 31, 2021
Fair value
hierarchy
Valuation technique and
key inputs
Significant
unobservable
inputs
Foreign currency forward . . Derivative financial
assets:
RMB2,549,000
Level 2 Future cash flows are
estimated based on forward
exchange rates and
contracted forward rates,
discounted at a rate that
reflects the credit risk of
the banks.
N/A
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-87 —


--- page 509 ---
Financial assets/
financial liabilities
Fair value as at
December 31, 2022
Fair value
hierarchy
Valuation technique and
key inputs
Significant
unobservable
inputs
Financial assets at FVTPL . Wealth management
products:
RMB400,000,000
Level 2 Discounted cash flows
method, estimated based on
expected return and market
foreign exchange rate
N/A
Foreign currency forward . . Derivative financial
assets:
RMB799,000
Derivative
financial
liabilities:
RMB2,147,000
Level 2 Future cash flows are
estimated based on forward
exchange rates and
contracted forward rates,
discounted at a rate that
reflects the credit risk of
the banks.
N/A
(ii) Fair value of financial assets and financial liabilities that are not measured at fair value on a
recurring basis
The management of the Group considers the carrying amounts of financial assets and financial
liabilities recorded at amortized cost in the Historical Financial Information approximate their fair value.
The fair values of these financial assets and financial liabilities at amortized cost are determined in
accordance with generally accepted pricing models based on discounted cash flow analysis with the most
significant inputs being the discount rate that reflects the credit risk of counterparties.
34. RETIREMENT BENEFIT PLANS
The employees of the Group’s subsidiaries are members of the state-managed retirement benefits
schemes operated by government. The subsidiaries are required to contribute a certain percentage of
payroll costs to the retirement benefits schemes to fund the benefits. The only obligation of the Group with
respect to the retirement benefits schemes is to make the specified contributions.
The total cost charged to profit or loss in respect of the above-mentioned schemes amounted to
approximately RMB285,000, RMB6,850,000, RMB14,526,000 for the years ended December 31, 2020,
2021 and 2022, respectively and RMB5,378,000 and RMB12,286,000 for six months ended June 30, 2022
(unaudited) and June 30, 2023, respectively.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-88 —


--- page 510 ---
35. RECONCILIATION OF LIABILITIES ARISING FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES
The table below details changes in the Group’s liabilities arising from financing activities, including
both the cash and non-cash changes. Liabilities arising from financing activities are those for which cash
flows were, or future cash flows will be classified in the Group’s consolidated statement of cash flows as
cash flows from financing activities.
Obligations
arising from
equity
transaction
Lease
liabilities
Accrued
issue cost
Loans from
related
parties Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
As at January 1, 2020 .......... —————
Net financing cash flows ........ 69,116 — — — 69,116
Capital contribution from
equity holders .............. (69,116) — — — (69,116)
As at December 31, 2020 ....... —————
Net financing cash flows ........ — — — 22,343 22,343
Non-cash changes
Interest expenses ............ — 6 9 — — 6 9
New lease extended .......... — 3,335 — — 3,335
Lease modification .......... — (1,155) — — (1,155)
As at December 31, 2021 ....... — 2,249 — 22,343 24,592
Net financing cash flows ........ 1,285,462 (6,050) — 48,801 1,328,213
Issue of shares ............... (1,285,462) — — — (1,285,462)
Non-cash changes
Interest expenses ............ — 3 2 5 — — 3 2 5
New lease extended .......... — 1,514 — — 1,514
Lease modification .......... — 8,002 — — 8,002
As at December 31, 2022 ....... — 6,040 — 71,144 77,184
Net financing cash flows ....... — (2,481) (104) (71,144) (73,729)
Non-cash changes
Interest expenses ........... — 1 4 9 — — 1 4 9
Deferred issue cost .......... — — 1,054 — 1,054
New lease extended ......... — 1,597 — — 1,597
As at June 30, 2023 ........... — 5,305 950 — 6,255
As at December 31, 2021 ....... — 2,249 — 22,343 24,592
Net financing cash flows ....... 1,285,462 (2,773) — 48,901 1,331,590
Issue of shares .............. (1,285,462) — — — (1,285,462)
Non-cash changes
Interest expenses ............ — 1 9 2 — — 1 9 2
New lease extended ......... — 1,514 — — 1,514
Lease modification .......... — 8,002 — — 8,002
As at June 30, 2022 (unaudited) . . — 9,184 — 71,244 80,428
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-89 —


--- page 511 ---
36. ACQUISITION OF BUSINESS
Acquisition of Payload and Linker Business
XDC Changzhou, a subsidiary of the Group, entered into an agreement with STA Changzhou, a
related party, to acquire the payload and linker business (the “Payload and Linker Business”) for a cash
consideration of RMB280,000,000. The purpose of the acquisition was to reinforce the Group’s
capabilities of end-to-end contract development and manufacturing of bioconjugates including antibody-
drug conjugates.
The acquisition has been accounted for as acquisition of business using the acquisition method.
Acquisition-related costs were not material and have been expensed as incurred as part of administrative
expenses in the consolidated statement of profit or loss and other comprehensive income.
Assets as at September 30, 2021
RMB’000
Property, plant and equipment ........................................ 6,407
Intangible assets .................................................. 58,400
64,807
Goodwill arising on acquisition
RMB’000
Consideration payable .............................................. 280,000
Less: recognized amounts of net assets acquired ........................... (64,807)
Goodwill arising on acquisition ....................................... 215,193
Goodwill arose on the acquisition of Payload and Linker Business because the acquisition included
the assembled workforce as well as ongoing and potential projects from existing customers as at the date
of acquisition. These benefits are not recognised separately from goodwill because they do not meet the
recognition criteria for identifiable intangible assets.
None of the goodwill arising on the acquisitions is expected to be deductible for tax purposes.
Impact of acquisition on the results of the Group
Included in the profit for the years/period ended December 31, 2020, 2021, 2022 and June 30, 2023
are nil, loss of RMB1,547,000, profit of RMB57,716,000 and profit of RMB28,210,000, respectively,
attributable to the Payload and Linker Business. Revenue generated from Payload and Linker Business for
the years/period ended December 31, 2020, 2021, 2022 and June 30, 2023 included nil, RMB8,156,000,
RMB220,423,000 and RMBl19,280,000, respectively.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-90 —


--- page 512 ---
Had the acquisition of Payload and Linker Business been completed on January 1, 2020, revenue for
the years ended December 31, 2020 and 2021 of the Group from continuing operations would have been
RMB154,534,000 and RMB442,472,000, respectively, and profit for the years ended December 31, 2020
and 2021 from continuing operations would have been RMB52,327,000 and RMB113,647,000,
respectively. The pro forma information is for illustrative purposes only and is not necessarily an
indication of revenue and results of operations of the Group that actually would have been achieved had
the acquisition been completed on January 1, 2020, nor is it intended to be a projection of future results.
In determining the ‘pro-forma’ revenue and profit of the Group had Payload and Linker Business
been acquired at the beginning of the Track Record Period, the management of the Group calculated
depreciation of property, plant and equipment and amortization of intangible assets based on the
recognized amounts of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets at the date of the acquisition.
Pre-acquisition financial information
The pre-acquisition financial information of Payload and Linker Business is for the period from
January 1, 2020 to September 30, 2021 (the “Pre-acquisition Period”), has been prepared in accordance
with the accounting policies set out in Note 4 above, which conform with IFRSs issued by IASB.
Statement of Profit or Loss and Other Comprehensive Income
Y ear ended
December 31,
Nine months ended
September 30,
2020 2021
RMB’000 RMB’000
Revenue .......................................... 58,181 131,341
Cost of sales and services ............................. (19,210) (56,021)
Gross profit ....................................... 38,971 75,320
Other gains and losses ............................... — ( 1 1 )
Impairment losses, under expected credit loss model,
net of reversal .................................... ( 1 1 5 ) 7
Selling and marketing expenses ......................... ( 7 ) ( 7 )
Administrative expenses .............................. (1,306) (926)
Research and development expenses ..................... (1,506) (1,322)
Profit before tax .................................... 36,037 73,061
Income tax expenses ................................. (5,615) (10,971)
Profit and total comprehensive income for the year/period . . . 30,422 62,090
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-91 —


--- page 513 ---
Statement of Financial Position
As at
December 31,
As at
September 30,
2020 2021
RMB’000 RMB’000
Non-current asset
Property and equipment .............................. 6,971 6,407
Current assets
Trade receivables ................................... 12,564 —
Contract costs ...................................... 17,850 —
30,414 —
Current liabilities
Other payables ..................................... 2 2 1 —
Contract liabilities .................................. 6,576 —
6,797 —
Net current assets .................................. 23,617 —
Total assets less current liabilities/Net assets .............. 30,588 6,407
Capital and reserve
Retained earnings ................................... 44,456 106,546
Other reserve ...................................... (13,868) (100,139)
Total equity ....................................... 30,588 6,407
Statement of Changes in Equity
Retained
earnings Other reserve Total equity
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
At January 1, 2020 .......................... 14,034 514 14,548
Total comprehensive income for the year .......... 30,422 – 30,422
Net distribution to STA Changzhou (note) ......... – (14,382) (14,382)
As at December 31, 2020 ..................... 44,456 (13,868) 30,588
Total comprehensive income for the period ........ 62,090 — 62,090
Net distribution to STA Changzhou (note) ......... — (86,271) (86,271)
As at September 30, 2021 ..................... 106,546 (100,139) 6,407
Note: Net distribution to STA Changzhou represents the net equity generated by the Payload and Linker Business and retained in
STA Changzhou prior to acquisition.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-92 —


--- page 514 ---
Statement of Cash Flows
Prior to acquisition of the Payload and Linker Business, the Payload and Linker Business was
operated under STA Changzhou and no separate bank accounts were maintained for the Payload and Linker
Business. The treasury and cash disbursement functions of the Payload and Linker Business were centrally
administrated by STA Changzhou. The net equity generated in respect of the operations of Payload and
Linker Business by STA Changzhou, are reflected in “Net distribution to STA Changzhou” in the statement
of cash flows and presented as movements in the equity.
For the purpose of presenting a complete set of pre-acquisition financial information of the Payload
and Linker Business, the following comprises the information of cash inflow/outflow of the Payload and
Linker Business received/paid by STA Changzhou prior to and during the transition period after the
transfer of Payload and Linker Business.
Y ear ended
December 31,
Nine months ended
September 30,
2020 2021
RMB’000 RMB’000
OPERATING ACTIVITIES
Profit before tax ................................ 36,037 73,061
Adjustments for:
Depreciation of property and equipment ............... 8 7 5 5 5 3
Impairment loss, net of reversal
– Trade receivables .............................. 1 1 5 ( 7 )
Operating cash flows before movements in working capital. 37,027 73,607
(Increase) decrease in trade receivables ............... (4,886) 12,572
(Increase) decrease in contract costs ................. (17,157) 17,850
Increase (decrease) in other payables ................. 7 0 1 (222)
Increase (decrease) in contract liabilities .............. 6,576 (6,576)
Cash generated from operations ..................... 22,261 97,231
NET CASH FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES ....... 22,261 97,231
INVESTING ACTIVITIES
Proceeds on disposal of property and equipment ......... 4 6 1 1
Purchases of property and equipment ................. (1,592) —
NET CASH (USED IN) FROM IN INVESTING
ACTIVITIES ................................ (1,546) 11
Net distribution to STA Changzhou .................. (20,715) (97,242)
NET INCREASE IN CASH AND
CASH EQUIV ALENTS ........................ — —
Cash and cash equivalents at end of the year/period,
represented by bank balances and cash ............ — —
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-93 —


--- page 515 ---
(a) Revenue and segment information
Y ear ended
December 31,
Nine months ended
September 30,
2020 2021
RMB’000 RMB’000
Timing of revenue recognition
A point in time
– Research services on FFS basis ................... 58,181 131,341
Geographical information
An analysis of the Group’s revenue from external customers, analyzed by their respective
country/region of operation, is detailed below:
Y ear ended
December 31, 2020
Nine months ended
September 30,
2021
RMB’000 RMB’000
Revenue
– North America ................................ 38,778 84,437
–P R C....................................... 5,909 8,209
– Europe ..................................... 1 1,248 38,695
– Rest of the world .............................. 2,246 —
58,181 131,341
(b) Profit before tax
Profit before tax for has been arrived at after charging (crediting):
Y ear ended
December 31,
Nine months ended
September 30,
2020 2021
RMB’000 RMB’000
Depreciation for property and equipment .............. 8 7 5 5 5 3
Staff cost (including directors’ emoluments):
– Salaries and other benefits ....................... 7,929 18,638
– Retirement benefits scheme contributions ............ 1,308 3,075
Impairment losses, under expected credit loss model,
net of reversal
– Trade receivables .............................. 1 1 5 ( 7 )
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-94 —


--- page 516 ---
(c) Income tax expenses
Y ear ended
December 31,
Nine months ended
September 30,
2020 2021
RMB’000 RMB’000
Current tax
–E I T ........................................ 5,615 10,971
Income tax expense was calculated based on the tax rate of STA Changzhou at 15% as if the Payload
and Linker Business is a separate tax reporting entity.
STA Changzhou operating in the PRC is accredited as “High and New Technology Enterprise” and
therefore entitled to a preferential EIT rate.
(d) Property and equipment
Machinery
Furniture,
fixture and
equipment Total
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
COST
As at January 1, 2020 .................... 7,018 253 7,271
Additions ............................. 1,552 40 1,592
As at December 31, 2020 ................. 8,570 293 8,863
Disposals ............................. (40) (6) (46)
As at September 30, 2021 ................. 8,530 287 8,817
DEPRECIATION
As at January 1, 2020 .................... 9 6 5 5 2 1,017
Provided for the year .................... 8 3 4 4 1 8 7 5
As at December 31, 2020 ................. 1,799 93 1,892
Provided for the period ................... 5 2 4 2 9 5 5 3
Eliminated on disposals .................. (33) (2) (35)
As at September 30, 2021 ................. 2,290 120 2,410
CARRYING V ALUES
As at December 31, 2020 ................. 6,771 200 6,971
As at September 30, 2021 ................. 6,240 167 6,407
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-95 —


--- page 517 ---
(e) Contract costs
As at
December 31,
As at
September 30,
2020 2021
RMB’000 RMB’000
Costs to fulfill contracts .......................... 17,850 —
(f) Trade receivables
As at
December 31,
As at
September 30,
2020 2021
RMB’000 RMB’000
Trade receivables ............................... 12,679 —
Less: allowance for credit losses .................... ( 1 1 5 ) —
Total trade receivables ........................... 12,564 —
The Payload and Linker Business allows a credit period ranging from 10 to 90 days to its customers.
The following is an aged analysis of trade receivables (net of allowance for credit losses) presented based
on the invoice dates:
As at
December 31,
As at
September 30,
2020 2021
RMB’000 RMB’000
Not past due ................................... 7,878 —
Overdue:
– Within 180 days .............................. 3,335 —
– 181 days to 1 year ............................. 1,351 —
12,564 —
(g) Contract liabilities
As at
December 31,
As at
September 30,
2020 2021
RMB’000 RMB’000
Within one year ................................ 6,576 —
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-96 —


--- page 518 ---
37. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES
The related parties and the relationship with the Group are as follows:
WuXi Biologics group represents Biologics Cayman, its subsidiaries and its associates excluding the
Group.
WuXi AppTec group represents WuXi AppTec Co., Ltd. and its subsidiaries. WuXi AppTec Group
is ultimately controlled by certain substantial shareholders of the Group’s ultimate holding company.
Chengdu Kangde Renze Real Estate Co., Ltd (“Renze”) is controlled by one of the directors of the
Group’s ultimate holding company.
In addition to the balances disclosed in Notes 24, 25, 27 and 28, the Group had the following
significant transactions and balances with related parties:
(a) Related party transactions
Provision of antibody drug conjugates discovery, research & development and manufacturing services
(included in revenue)
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
WuXi Biologics group ..... 81,730 258,460 370,805 215,422 136,244
WuXi AppTec group ....... – 7,311 2,323 1,248 7,983
81,730 265,771 373,128 216,670 144,227
Sales of materials to related parties (included in other income)
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
WuXi Biologics group ..... 2 4 6 4 4 5 1,930 1,313 3,730
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-97 —


--- page 519 ---
Sales of property, plant and equipment to related parties
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
WuXi Biologics group ..... 1,125 38,265 1,633 41 254
Provision of leasing and other services to related parties (included in other income)
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
WuXi Biologics group ..... 3 9 6,668 3,831 1,614 1,122
Antibodies master services (included in cost of sales and services)
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
WuXi Biologics group ..... 1,476 20,193 355,710 57,971 444,974
WuXi AppTec group ....... – 19,479 66,547 9,225 59,529
1,476 39,672 422,257 67,196 504,503
Other service received (included in cost of sales and services and administrative expenses)
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
WuXi Biologics group ..... 4 0 7 9,779 85,437 15,405 32,187
WuXi AppTec group ....... – 2 9 4 1,034 396 3,019
407 10,073 86,471 15,801 35,206
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-98 —


--- page 520 ---
Purchase of materials (included in cost of sales and services)
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
WuXi Biologics group ..... 3,690 15,887 23,755 8,611 15,951
WuXi AppTec group ....... – 3,569 65,324 6,340 2,443
3,690 19,456 89,079 14,951 18,394
Purchase of property, plant and equipment
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
WuXi Biologics group ..... 9 6 4 2 1 3 1,618 156 5,020
WuXi AppTec group ....... 2 6 – – 4 5 –
Renze ................. – – 3,599 – 30
990 213 5,217 201 5,050
Interest expense on loans from related parties
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
WuXi Biologics group ..... – 4 2 4 2,591 1,381 420
Interest expense on lease liabilities
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
WuXi AppTec group ....... – 6 9 3 2 5 1 9 2 1 4 9
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-99 —


--- page 521 ---
Expense relating to leases
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
WuXi AppTec group ....... – 1,154 3,865 2,148 2,154
(b) Related party balances
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and six months ended June 30, 2023, the Group had
balances with related parties as follows:
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Amounts due from related
parties – Trade related
Included in trade receivables:
WuXi Biologics group ........... 18,347 63,209 132,204 78,080
WuXi AppTec group ............. – – 2,462 10,668
18,347 63,209 134,666 88,748
Included in other receivables:
Wuxi Biologics group ............ – 42,805 679 4,750
Less: allowance for credit losses .... (261) (6,405) (13,520) (3,349)
18,086 99,609 121,825 90,149
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Amounts due from related
parties – Non-trade related
Included in other receivables:
WuXi Biologics group ........... 3 8 4 0 5 1,633 3
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Contract assets – Trade related
WuXi AppTec group ............. – 7,684 7,685 7,685
Less: allowance for credit losses .... – ( 2 ) (44) (73)
– 7,682 7,641 7,612
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-100 —


--- page 522 ---
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Amounts due to related
parties – Trade related
Included in trade payables:
WuXi Biologics group ........... 2 4 8 5 9 378,779 429,597
WuXi AppTec group ............. – 21,646 78,516 55,159
24 22,505 457,295 484,756
Included in other payables:
WuXi Biologics group ........... 7 0 2 39,484 84,752 127,427
WuXi AppTec group ............. – 1,570 22,594 1,882
726 63,559 564,641 614,065
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Amounts due to related
parties – Non-trade related
Included in other payables:
WuXi Biologics group ........... 9 9 0 2 1 3 1,618 2,144
Renze ....................... – – 1 8 9 2 1 9
990 213 1,807 2,363
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Loans from related
parties – Non-trade related
WuXi Biologics group ........... – 22,343 71,144 –
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Consideration payable
for acquisition Payload
and Linker Business – Non-trade
related
WuXi AppTec group ............ — 280,000 — —
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-101 —


--- page 523 ---
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Consideration payable for
acquisition of XDC Wuxi to the
Group – Non-trade related
WuXi Biologics group ........... — 404,413 — —
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Consideration payable for
acquisition of BCD Business Unit
to the Group – Non-trade related
WuXi Biologics group ........... — — 15,587 5,710
Except for loan payables and lease liabilities, all the above balances with related parties are
unsecured, interest free and repayable on demand. The non-trade related balances as at December 31,
2020, 2021, 2022 and June 30, 2023 will be settled prior to the Listing.
(c) Compensation of key management personnel
The remuneration of the directors of the Company and other members of key management of the
Group during the Track Record Period was as follows:
Y ear ended December 31, Six months ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
(unaudited)
Director’s fee ................. —————
Salaries and other benefits ....... 2,541 2,600 3,243 1,578 2,149
Performance-based bonus ........ 9 8 4 1,032 1,297 631 856
Retirement benefits scheme
contributions ................ ———— 3
Share-based compensation ........ 1,678 5,250 15,288 4,984 6,643
5,203 8,882 19,828 7,193 9,651
The remuneration of key management is determined with reference to the performance of the
individuals and market trends.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-102 —


--- page 524 ---
38. SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION
Equity instruments granted by Biologics Cayman to employees of the Group
Pursuant to the WXB Share Option Scheme, WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme and WXB Global
Partner Program Share Scheme, certain directors of the Company and employees of the Group were issued
shares of Biologics Cayman.
(a) WXB Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
Biologics Cayman’s Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme was adopted pursuant to resolutions passed on
January 5, 2016 for the primary purpose of attracting, retaining and motivating employees and directors.
Under the WXB Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, the directors of the Biologics Cayman may grant up to
144,600,000 (before the effect of the Share Subdivision
1) share options to eligible employees, including
the directors of Biologics Cayman and its subsidiaries, to subscribe for shares in Biologics Cayman.
Grantee accepting an option grant offered by Biologics Cayman has to sign an acceptance letter and pay
to Biologics Cayman an amount of HK$1.00 (before the effect of the Share Subdivision) as consideration
for the grant.
The Group recognized total expense of approximately RMB709,000, RMB377,000 and RMB59,000
for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, respectively and RMB59,000 and nil for six
months ended June 30, 2022 (unaudited) and June 30, 2023, respectively in relation to share options
granted by Biologics Cayman under the WXB Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme.
(b) WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme
On January 15, 2018, Biologics Cayman adopted the WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme for the
primary purpose of (i) recognizing the contributions by certain employees of the Group of Biologics
Cayman and directors of Biologics Cayman (the “Selected Participants under WXB Restricted Share
Award Scheme”); (ii) encouraging, motivate and retain the Selected Participants under WXB Restricted
Share Award Scheme, whose contributions are beneficial to the continual operation, development and
long-term growth of the Group of Biologics Cayman; and (iii) providing additional incentive for the
Selected Participants under WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme to achieve performance goals, with a
view to achieving the objectives of increasing the value of the Group of Biologics Cayman and aligning
the interests of the Selected Participants under WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme to the shareholders
of Biologics Cayman through ownership of shares. The total number of the restricted shares underlying
all grants made pursuant to the WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme shall not exceed three percent of the
issued share capital of Biologics Cayman as at the adoption date (i.e. 34,953,032 shares before the effect
of the Share Subdivision).
1 Pursuant to a shareholders’ resolution passed at an extraordinary general meeting on November 12, 2020, the authorized and
issue shares of Biologics Cayman were subdivided on the basis that every one issued share is subdivided into three subdivided
shares (the “Share Subdivision”). The Share Subdivision became effective on November 16, 2020.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-103 —


--- page 525 ---
During the year ended December 31, 2022, certain employees of Biologics Cayman were offered,
and agreed to join the Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme. Upon participating in the Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme, share options under the Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme were granted to the employees while the
outstanding restricted shares granted under the WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme held by the
respective employees were cancelled in the same time accordingly. The directors of Biologics Cayman
considered that most of the cancelled restricted shares under the WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme
were replaced by the share options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, which was accounted
for as a modification of the original equity instruments with no incremental fair value granted, therefore,
such outstanding restricted shares would continue to be measured at the original grant-date fair value and
the corresponding share-based compensation expense would be recognized in profit or loss over the
original vesting periods. The remaining cancelled restricted shares were deemed to be accounted for as an
acceleration of vesting, and the Group recognized immediately the amount that otherwise would have been
recognized for services received over the remainder of the vesting period.
The Group recognized total expense of approximately RMB5,767,000, RMB21,780,000 and
RMB10,505,000 for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, respectively and RMB8,686,000
and RMB4,702,000 for six months ended June 30, 2022 (unaudited) and June 30, 2023, respectively in
relation to restricted shares granted by Biologics Cayman under the WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme.
(c) WXB Global Partner Program Share Scheme
On June 16, 2021, Biologics Cayman adopted a global partner program share scheme to further
reward and incentivize the Group of Biologics Cayman’s top employees and attract key talents (the
“Selected Participants under WXB Global Partner Program Share Scheme”) to ensure the continuous
business development and growth of Biologics Cayman and to further align the interests of the top
employees and the shareholders of Biologics Cayman. The Selected Participants under WXB Global
Partner Program Share Scheme who have significant contributions to the Group of Biologics Cayman’s
business development and growth will be granted restricted shares under the WXB Global Partner Program
Share Scheme. The number of restricted shares to be granted will be determined based on various
performance-related considerations, such as the fulfilment by the respective Selected Participants under
WXB Global Partner Program Share Scheme of their individual performance targets as well as the overall
business performance of the Group of Biologics Cayman as a whole. The total number of the restricted
shares underlying all grants made pursuant to the WXB Global Partner Program Share Scheme shall not
exceed three percent of the total number of shares of Biologics Cayman in issue as at the adoption date
(i.e. 126,982,689 shares).
The Group recognized total expense of approximately nil, nil and RMB312,000 for the years ended
December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, respectively and RMB59,000 and nil for six months ended June 30,
2022 (unaudited) and June 30, 2023, respectively in relation to restricted shares granted by Biologics
Cayman under the WXB Global Partner Program Share Scheme.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-104 —


--- page 526 ---
Equity instruments granted by the Company to employees of the Group
(a) 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
On November 23, 2021 the Company adopted the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme for the
primary purpose to enable the Company to grant share options to eligible participants as incentives or
rewards for their contribution to the Group so as to enable the Group to recruit and retain high-calibre
employees and attract human resources that are valuable to the Group. Eligible participants for the 2021
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme include any full-time or part-time employees, executives, officers or
directors of the Company. The maximum number of the Company shares which may be issued upon
exercise of all share options to be granted under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and other share
option schemes of the Company shall not in aggregate exceed 10% of the total number of the Company
shares in issue as at the adoption date (i.e. 100,000,000 shares) (the “2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
Mandate Limit”). Share options lapsed in accordance with the terms of the Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
will not be counted for the purpose of calculating the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme Mandate Limit.
The option granted under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme can only be vested in the following
manners (each date on which any portion of options granted shall be vested is hereinafter referred to as
a “V esting Date of 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme” and each batch on which any portion of options
granted shall be vested is hereinafter referred to as a “Batch under 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme”):
Batch under 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme Vesting Date of 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
Twenty percent (20%) of the restricted shares so
granted .............................
Second (2nd) anniversary of the grant date
for a Company’s share option
Twenty percent (20%) of the restricted shares so
granted .............................
Third (3rd) anniversary of the grant date for a
Company’s share option
Twenty percent (20%) of the restricted shares so
granted .............................
Fourth (4th) anniversary of the grant date for
a Company’s share option
Forty percent (40%) of the restricted shares so
granted .............................
Fifth (5th) anniversary of the grant date for a
Company’s share option
Set out below are details of the movements of the outstanding share options granted under the 2021
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme during the year ended December 31, 2022 and six months ended June 30,
2023:
Batch
Outstanding
as at
January 1,
2022 Granted Exercised Forfeited
Outstanding
as at
December 31,
2022
Employee
April 1, 2022 ............ — 20,907,270 — 2,537,721 18,369,549
August 18, 2022 .......... — 9,052,830 — 450,574 8,602,256
Director
June 10, 2022 ............ — 32,160,000 — — 32,160,000
— 62,120,100 — 2,988,295 59,131,805
Exercisable at the end of the
year ................. — —
Weighted average exercise
price (RMB) ........... — 1.6860 — 1.6869 1.6859
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-105 —


--- page 527 ---
Batch
Outstanding
as at
January 1,
2023 Granted Exercised Forfeited
Outstanding
as at
June 30,
2023
Employee
April 1, 2022 ............ 18,369,54 9——— 18,369,549
August 18, 2022 .......... 8,602,25 6——— 8,602,256
January 6, 2023 .......... — 18,517,841 — — 18,517,841
Director
June 10, 2022 ............ 32,160,00 0——— 32,160,000
59,131,805 18,517,841 — — 77,649,646
Exercisable at the end of the
period ................ — —
Weighted average exercise
price (RMB) ........... 1.6859 1.6859 — — 1.6859
The estimated fair value of the share options at the date of grant were approximately
RMB20,602,000, RMB34,331,000, RMB8,984,000 and RMB17,330,000 for the April 1, 2022, June 10,
2022, August 18, 2022 and January 6, 2023 option batch, respectively. The fair value was calculated using
the Binomial model. The major inputs into the model are as follows:
Grant date
April 1,
2022
June 10,
2022
August 18,
2022
January 6,
2023
Equity value per share (RMB) ...... 1.658 1.658 1.845 1.865
Exercise price (RMB) ............ 1.658 1.658 1.850 1.868
Expected volatility .............. 47.6% 47.9% 47.9% 43.6%
Expected life (years) ............. 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0
Risk-free interest rate ............ 2.81% 2.81% 2.78% 2.89%
Forfeiture rate ................. 3.70% — 3.70% 3.70%
The risk-free interest rate was based on market yield rate of China government bonds with the term
corresponding to the contractual life of the options. Expected volatility was determined by using the
historical volatility of the comparable companies. Changes in variables and assumptions may result in
changes in the fair values of the share options.
The variables and assumptions used in computing the fair value of the share options are based on the
directors’ best estimate. The value of an option varies with different variables of certain subjective
assumptions.
The Group recognized total expense of approximately nil, nil and RMB27,750,000 for the years
ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, respectively and RMB1,791,000 and RMB30,145,000 for six
months ended June 30, 2022 (unaudited) and June 30, 2023, respectively in relation to options granted by
the Company under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-106 —


--- page 528 ---
(b) 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
The Group adopted the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme on March 22, 2023, the principal terms
of which are summarized in “2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme” in Appendix IV to this prospectus.
39. CAPITAL COMMITMENTS
The Group had capital commitments for equipment purchase and building construction under
non-cancellable contracts as follows:
As at December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Contracted but not provided for
– Property, plant and equipment . . . 39,766 124,413 126,572 159,922
40. OPERATING LEASE ARRANGEMENTS
The Group as lessor
As at December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, and June 30, 2023, the Group’s investment property with
carrying amounts of nil, RMB13,215,000 and RMB12,812,000, and RMB12,610,000 were held for rental
purposes.
Undiscounted lease payments receivable on leases are as follows:
As at December 31,
Six months
ended June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Within one year ............... — 2,963 2,963 2,963
In the second year ............. — 2,963 2,963 2,963
In the third year ............... — 2,963 2,963 2,963
In the fourth year .............. — 2,963 — —
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-107 —


--- page 529 ---
41. DETAILS OF SUBSIDIARIES
The Company
As at December 31, As at June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
Unlisted shares, at cost ........... — — 1,306,543 1,306,543
Deemed capital contributions (note) . . — — 27,487 57,686
— — 1,334,030 1,364,229
Note: The amounts represent the equity-settled share-based compensation in respect of the respective share options granted
by the Company to certain subsidiaries’ employees for their services rendered to the respective subsidiaries under the
Company’s Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme as disclosed in Note 38. Since the subsidiaries have no obligation to
reimburse such expense to the Company, the amounts are treated as deemed capital contribution by the Company to
the subsidiaries and regarded as the Company’s cost of investments in subsidiaries.
The direct and indirect interests in the following subsidiaries held by the Company during the years
ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022, six months ended June 30, 2023, and as of the date of this
report are as follows:
Name of
subsidiaries
Place of
incorporation/
operation,
date of
incorporation
Authorized
share/
registered
capital Paid up capital
Attributable equity interests held by
the Company Date of
this
report
Principal
activitiesAs at December 31,
As at
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
WuXi XDC Hong
Kong Limited
(note i) ......
Hong Kong
June 7, 2021
HK$1 — N/A 100% 100% 100% 100% International sales
contracting
service
Ҧ
ʮ̡ (ಀ͜
ਅᑌ
ʮ̡)
(WuXi XDC Co.,
Ltd.)
# (note ii
and v) ......
The PRC
March 13,
2018
US$200,000,000 US$162,500,000 100% 100% 100% 100% 100% Biologics
discovery,
development and
manufacturing
service
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-108 —


--- page 530 ---
Name of
subsidiaries
Place of
incorporation/
operation,
date of
incorporation
Authorized
share/
registered
capital Paid up capital
Attributable equity interests held by
the Company Date of
this
report
Principal
activitiesAs at December 31,
As at
June 30,
2020 2021 2022 2023
Ҧ
ʮ̡ (ಀ͜
Όᑌ
ʮ̡)
(WuXi XDC
(Shanghai) Co.,
Ltd.)
#
(note iii and iv) ..
The PRC
March 31,
2021
RMB30,000,000 RMB30,000,000 N/A 100% 100% 100% 100% Biologics
discovery,
development and
manufacturing
service
Ҧ
ʮ̡ (WuXi
XDC (Changzhou)
Co., Ltd.)
#
(note iii and iv) ..
The PRC
July 2, 2021
RMB300,000,000 RMB300,000,000 N/A 100% 100% 100% 100% Biologics
discovery,
development and
manufacturing
service
WuXi XDC Singapore
Private Limited
(note v) ......
Singapore
November 16,
2022
US$5,000,000 — N/A N/A 100% 100% 100% Biologics
manufacturing
service
# English name is for identification purpose only.
None of the subsidiaries had issued any debt securities at the end of the period.
Notes:
(i) The statutory financial statements of the entity for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2022 prepared under IFRSs
were audited by Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu Certified Public Accountants LLP .
(ii) The statutory financial statements of the entity for the years ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 prepared under
China Accounting Standards (“CASs”) were audited by Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu Certified Public Accountants LLP .
(iii) The statutory financial statements of the entity for the years ended December 31, 2021 and 2022 prepared under CASs
were audited by Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu Certified Public Accountants LLP .
(iv) This Company is a wholly-domestic owned enterprise.
(v) This Company is a wholly-foreign owned enterprise.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-109 —


--- page 531 ---
42. RESERVES MOVEMENT OF THE COMPANY
The movement of the reserves of the Company are as follows:
Share premium
Equity-settled
share-based
compensation
reserve
Retained
earnings
(Accumulated
losses) Total reserves
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000
As at January 1, 2020 and December 31,
2020 ....................... ————
Total comprehensive expense for the year . . — — (640) (640)
As at December 31, 2021 ............ — — (640) (640)
Total comprehensive income for the year . . — — 20,237 20,237
Issue of shares (Note 32) ............ 1,285,143 — — 1,285,143
Recognition of equity-settled share-based
compensation .................. — 27,750 — 27,750
As at December 31, 2022 ............ 1,285,143 27,750 19,597 1,332,490
Total comprehensive expense for the
period ...................... — — (7,648) (7,648)
Recognition of equity-settled share-based
compensation .................. — 30,145 — 30,145
As at June 30, 2023 ............... 1,285,143 57,895 11,949 1,354,987
43. SUBSEQUENT FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
No audited financial statements of the Group, the Company or any of its subsidiaries have been
prepared in respect of any period subsequent to December 31, 2022 and up to the date of this report.
44. SUBSEQUENT EVENTS
On July 6, 2023, August 24, 2023 and October 30, 2023, 34,819,569, 4,663,081 and 1,687,916 share
options were granted under the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme with a vesting period of five years,
respectively.
APPENDIX I ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT
— I-110 —


--- page 532 ---
The information set forth in this Appendix does not form part of the accountants’ report on the
historical financial information of the Group for each of three years ended December 31, 2022 and the
six months ended June 30, 2023 (the “Accountants’ Report”) prepared by Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu,
Certified Public Accountants, Hong Kong, the reporting accountants of the Company, as set forth in
Appendix I to this prospectus, and is included herein for information only.
The unaudited pro forma financial information should be read in conjunction with the section headed
“Financial Information” in this prospectus and the consolidated financial statements set forth in Appendix
I to this prospectus.
A. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA STATEMENT OF ADJUSTED CONSOLIDATED NET
TANGIBLE ASSETS OF THE GROUP ATTRIBUTABLE TO OWNERS OF THE COMPANY
The following unaudited pro forma statement of adjusted consolidated net tangible assets of the
Group attributable to owners of the Company which has been prepared in accordance with paragraph 4.29
of the Listing Rules is for illustration only, and is set out to illustrate the effect of the proposed Global
Offering (as defined in this prospectus) on the consolidated net tangible assets of the Group attributable
to the owners of the Company as at June 30, 2023, as if the Global Offering had taken place on that date.
The unaudited pro forma statement of adjusted consolidated net tangible assets of the Group
attributable to owners of the Company has been prepared for illustrative purposes only and, because of its
hypothetical nature, it may not give a true picture of the consolidated net tangible assets of the Group
attributable to owners of the Company as at June 30, 2023 or as at any subsequent dates following the
Global Offering.
The following unaudited pro forma statement of adjusted consolidated net tangible assets of the
Group attributable to owners of the Company is prepared based on the audited consolidated net tangible
assets of the Group attributable to owners of the Company as at June 30, 2023 as derived from the
Accountants’ Report set out in Appendix I to this prospectus, and adjusted as described below.
Audited consolidated net
tangible assets of the
Group attributable to
owners of the Company
as at June 30, 2023
Estimated net
proceeds from
the Global
Offering
Unaudited pro forma
adjusted consolidated
net tangible assets of the
Group attributable to
owners of the Company
as at June 30, 2023
Unaudited pro forma
adjusted consolidated net
tangible assets of the Group
attributable to owners of
the Company per Share as
at June 30, 2023
RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB’000 RMB
Hong Kong
dollars
(“HK$”)
(Note 1) (Note 2) (Note 3) (Note 4)
Based on the offer price of
HK$20.60 per Offer Share .... 1,426,381 3,203,954 4,630,335 3.93 4.28
Based on the offer price of
HK$19.90 per Offer Share .... 1,426,381 3,093,346 4,519,727 3.84 4.18
Notes:
1. The audited consolidated net tangible assets of the Group attributable to owners of the Company as at June 30, 2023 is arrived
at after deducting goodwill and intangible assets attributable to owners of the Company of RMB215,193,000 and
RMB57,047,000 from the audited consolidated net assets attributable to owners of the Company of RMB1,698,621,000 as at
June 30, 2023 as extracted from the accountants’ report set out in Appendix I to this prospectus.
APPENDIX II UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— II-1 —


--- page 533 ---
2. The estimated net proceeds from the issue of Offer Shares pursuant to the Global Offering are based on 178,446,000 Shares
at the offer price of HK$20.60 (equivalent to RMB18.90) and HK$19.90 (equivalent to RMB18.26) per Offer Share, being
the high-end and low-end of the stated offer price range, after deduction of the estimated underwriting fees and commissions
and other listing related expenses not yet recognized in profit or loss up to June 30, 2023. It does not take into account of
any Share which may be allotted and issued (i) upon the exercise of the over-allotment option; (ii) under Pre-IPO Share Option
Schemes; or (iii) under the general mandates for the allotment and issue of shares granted to the directors of the Company.
For the purpose of this unaudited pro forma financial information, the estimated net proceeds from the Global Offering is
converted from Hong Kong dollars into Renminbi at an exchange rate of HK$1.00 to RMB0.91769, which was the exchange
rate prevailing on October 30, 2023 with reference to the rate published by the State Administration of Foreign Exchange of
the PRC. No representation is made that Hong Kong dollar amounts have been, could have been or may be converted to
Renminbi, or vice versa, at that rate or at all.
3. The unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets of the Group attributable to owners of the Company per
Share as at June 30, 2023 is arrived on the basis that 1,178,446,000 shares including 1,000,000,000 existing ordinary shares
in issue and 178,446,000 Offer Shares to be issued assuming that the Global Offering had been completed on June 30, 2023
and it does not take into account of any Share which may be allotted and issued (i) upon the exercise of the over-allotment
option; (ii) under Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes; or (iii) under the general mandates for the allotment and issue of shares
granted to the directors of the Company.
4. For the purpose of the unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated tangible assets of the Group attributable to the owners of
the Company per Share as at June 30, 2023 is converted from Renminbi to Hong Kong dollars at an exchange rate of
RMB0.91769 to HK$1.00, which was the exchange rate prevailing on October 30, 2023 with reference to the rate published
by the State Administration of Foreign Exchange of the PRC. No representation is made that Renminbi amounts have been,
could have been or may be converted to Hong Kong dollars, or vice versa, at that rate or at all.
5. No adjustment has been made to the unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets of the Group attributable
to owners of the Company as at June 30, 2023 to reflect any trading result or other transaction of the Group entered into
subsequent to June 30, 2023. In particular, the unaudited pro forma adjusted consolidated net tangible assets of the Group
attributable to owners of the Company per Share as at June 30, 2023 have not been adjusted to illustrate the effect of the
subsequent events as disclosed in Note 44 “Subsequent Events” to Appendix I in this prospectus as such subsequent events
would not have material impact on the unaudited pro forma financial information.
B. INDEPENDENT REPORTING ACCOUNTANTS’ ASSURANCE REPORT ON THE
COMPILATION OF UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION
The following is the text of the independent reporting accountants’ assurance report received from
Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu, Certified Public Accountants, Hong Kong, the reporting accountants of the
Company, in respect of the Group’ s unaudited pro forma financial information prepared for the purpose
of incorporation in this prospectus.
To the Directors of WuXi XDC Cayman Inc.
We have completed our assurance engagement to report on the compilation of unaudited pro forma
financial information of WuXi XDC Cayman Inc. (the “Company”) and its subsidiaries (hereinafter
collectively referred to as the “Group”) by the directors of the Company (the “Directors”) for illustrative
purposes only. The unaudited pro forma financial information consists of the unaudited pro forma
statement of adjusted consolidated net tangible assets as at June 30, 2023 and related notes as set out on
pages II-1 to II-2 of Appendix II to the prospectus issued by the Company dated November 7, 2023 (the
“Prospectus”). The applicable criteria on the basis of which the Directors have compiled the unaudited pro
forma financial information are described on pages II-1 to II-2 of Appendix II to the Prospectus.
APPENDIX II UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— II-2 —


--- page 534 ---
The unaudited pro forma financial information has been compiled by the Directors to illustrate the
impact of the proposed Global Offering (as defined in the Prospectus) on the Group’s financial position
as at June 30, 2023 as if the proposed Global Offering had taken place at June 30, 2023. As part of this
process, information about the Group’s financial position has been extracted by the Directors from the
Group’s historical financial information for each of the three years ended December 31, 2022 and six
months ended June 30, 2023, on which an accountants’ report set out in Appendix I to the Prospectus has
been published.
Directors’ Responsibilities for the Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information
The Directors are responsible for compiling the unaudited pro forma financial information in
accordance with paragraph 4.29 of the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on The Stock Exchange
of Hong Kong Limited (the “Listing Rules”) and with reference to Accounting Guideline 7 “Preparation
of Pro Forma Financial Information for Inclusion in Investment Circulars” (“AG 7”) issued by the Hong
Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants (the “HKICPA”).
Our Independence and Quality Control
We have complied with the independence and other ethical requirements of the “Code of Ethics for
Professional Accountants” issued by the HKICPA, which is founded on fundamental principles of
integrity, objectivity, professional competence and due care, confidentiality and professional behavior.
Our firm applies Hong Kong Standard on Quality Management (HKSQM) 1 “Quality Management
for Firms that Perform Audits or Reviews of Financial Statements, or Other Assurance or Related Services
Engagements” issued by the HKICPA, which requires the firm to design, implement and operate a system
of quality management including policies and procedures regarding compliance with ethical requirements,
professional standards and applicable legal and regulatory requirements.
Reporting Accountants’ Responsibilities
Our responsibility is to express an opinion, as required by paragraph 4.29(7) of the Listing Rules,
on the unaudited pro forma financial information and to report our opinion to you. We do not accept any
responsibility for any reports previously given by us on any financial information used in the compilation
of the unaudited pro forma financial information beyond that owed to those to whom those reports were
addressed by us at the dates of their issue.
We conducted our engagement in accordance with Hong Kong Standard on Assurance Engagements
3420 “Assurance Engagements to Report on the Compilation of Pro Forma Financial Information Included
in a Prospectus” issued by the HKICPA. This standard requires that the reporting accountants plan and
perform procedures to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the Directors have compiled the
unaudited pro forma financial information in accordance with paragraph 4.29 of the Listing Rules and with
reference to AG 7 issued by the HKICPA.
For purposes of this engagement, we are not responsible for updating or reissuing any reports or
opinions on any historical financial information used in compiling the unaudited pro forma financial
information, nor have we, in the course of this engagement, performed an audit or review of the financial
information used in compiling the unaudited pro forma financial information.
APPENDIX II UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— II-3 —


--- page 535 ---
The purpose of unaudited pro forma financial information included in an investment circular is solely
to illustrate the impact of a significant event or transaction on unadjusted financial information of the
Group as if the event had occurred or the transaction had been undertaken at an earlier date selected for
purposes of the illustration. Accordingly, we do not provide any assurance that the actual outcome of the
event or transaction at June 30, 2023 would have been as presented.
A reasonable assurance engagement to report on whether the unaudited pro forma financial
information has been properly compiled on the basis of the applicable criteria involves performing
procedures to assess whether the applicable criteria used by the Directors in the compilation of the
unaudited pro forma financial information provide a reasonable basis for presenting the significant effects
directly attributable to the event or transaction, and to obtain sufficient appropriate evidence about
whether:
 the related pro forma adjustments give appropriate effect to those criteria; and
 the unaudited pro forma financial information reflects the proper application of those
adjustments to the unadjusted financial information.
The procedures selected depend on the reporting accountants’ judgement, having regard to the
reporting accountants’ understanding of the nature of the Group, the event or transaction in respect of
which the unaudited pro forma financial information has been compiled, and other relevant engagement
circumstances.
The engagement also involves evaluating the overall presentation of the unaudited pro forma
financial information.
We believe that the evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for
our opinion.
Opinion
In our opinion:
(a) the unaudited pro forma financial information has been properly compiled on the basis stated;
(b) such basis is consistent with the accounting policies of the Group; and
(c) the adjustments are appropriate for the purposes of the unaudited pro forma financial
information as disclosed pursuant to paragraph 4.29(1) of the Listing Rules.
Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu
Certified Public Accountants
Hong Kong
November 7, 2023
APPENDIX II UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION
— II-4 —


--- page 536 ---
SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE COMPANY
1 Memorandum of Association
The Memorandum of Association of the Company was conditionally adopted on October 30, 2023
and states, inter alia, that the liability of the members of the Company is limited, that the objects for which
the Company is established are unrestricted and the Company shall have full power and authority to carry
out any object not prohibited by the Companies Act or any other law of the Cayman Islands.
The Memorandum of Association is on display on the websites of the Stock Exchange and the
Company as specified in Appendix V in the section headed “Documents on display”.
2 Articles of Association
The Articles of Association of the Company were conditionally adopted on October 30, 2023 and
include provisions to the following effect:
2.1 Directors
(a) Power to allot and issue Shares
Subject to the provisions in the Memorandum of Association (and to any direction that may be
given by the Company in general meeting) and without prejudice to any rights attached to any
existing shares, the Directors may allot, issue, grant options over or otherwise dispose of shares with
or without preferred, deferred or other rights or restrictions, whether in regard to dividend or other
distribution, voting, return of capital or otherwise and to such persons, at such times and on such
other terms as the Directors think proper.
(b) Power to dispose of the assets of the Company or any subsidiary
Subject to the provisions of the Companies Act, the Memorandum and Articles of Association
and to any directions given by special resolution, the business of the Company shall be managed by
the Directors who may exercise all the powers of the Company. No alteration of the Memorandum
and Articles of Association and no such direction shall invalidate any prior act of the Directors which
would have been valid if that alteration had not been made or that direction had not been given.
(c) Compensation or payment for loss of office
There are no provisions in the Articles of Association relating to compensation or payment for
loss of office of a Director.
(d) Loans to Directors
There are no provisions in the Articles of Association relating to making of loans to Directors.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-1 —


--- page 537 ---
(e) Financial assistance to purchase Shares
There are no provisions in the Articles of Association relating to the giving of financial
assistance by the Company to purchase shares in the Company or its subsidiaries.
(f) Disclosure of interest in contracts with the Company or any of its subsidiaries
No person shall be disqualified from the office of Director or alternate Director or prevented
by such office from contracting with the Company, either as vendor, purchaser or otherwise, nor shall
any such contract or any contract or transaction entered into by or on behalf of the Company in which
any Director or alternate Director shall be in any way interested be or be liable to be avoided, nor
shall any Director or alternate Director so contracting or being so interested be liable to account to
the Company for any profit realised by or arising in connection with any such contract or transaction
by reason of such Director or alternate Director holding office or of the fiduciary relationship thereby
established, provided that the nature of the interest of any Director or any alternate Director in any
such contract or transaction shall be disclosed by them at or prior to its consideration and any vote
thereon.
A Director shall not be entitled to vote on (nor shall the Director be counted in the quorum in
relation to) any resolution of the Directors in respect of any contract or arrangement or any other
proposal in which the Director or any of his close associates has any material interest, and if he shall
do so his vote shall not be counted (nor shall he be counted in the quorum for the resolution), but
this prohibition shall not apply to any of the following matters, namely:
(i) the giving to such Director or any of his close associates of any security or indemnity in
respect of money lent or obligations incurred or undertaken by him or any of them at the
request of or for the benefit of the Company or any of its subsidiaries;
(ii) the giving of any security or indemnity to a third party in respect of a debt or obligation
of the Company or any of its subsidiaries for which the Director or any of his close
associates has himself/themselves assumed responsibility in whole or in part and whether
alone or jointly under a guarantee or indemnity or by the giving of security;
(iii) any proposal concerning an offer of shares, debentures or other securities of or by the
Company or any other company which the Company may promote or be interested in for
subscription or purchase where the Director or any of his close associates is/are or is/are
to be interested as a participant in the underwriting or sub-underwriting of the offer;
(iv) any proposal or arrangement concerning the benefit of employees of the Company or any
of its subsidiaries including:
(A) the adoption, modification or operation of any employees’ share scheme or any
share incentive scheme or share option scheme under which the Director or any of
his close associates may benefit; or
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-2 —


--- page 538 ---
(B) the adoption, modification or operation of a pension fund or retirement, death or
disability benefits scheme which relates to the Director, his close associates and
employees of the Company or any of its subsidiaries and does not provide in respect
of any Director or any of his close associates, as such any privilege or advantage not
generally accorded to the class of persons to which such scheme or fund relates; and
(v) any contract or arrangement in which the Director or any of his close associates is/are
interested in the same manner as other holders of shares or debentures or other securities
of the Company by virtue only of their interest in shares or debentures or other securities
of the Company.
(g) Remuneration
The remuneration to be paid to the Directors, if any, shall be such remuneration as the Directors
shall determine. The Directors shall also be entitled to be paid all travelling, hotel and other expenses
properly incurred by them in connection with their attendance at meetings of Directors or committees
of Directors, or general meetings of the Company, or separate meetings of the holders of any class
of shares or debentures of the Company, or otherwise in connection with the business of the
Company or the discharge of their duties as a Director, or to receive a fixed allowance in respect
thereof as may be determined by the Directors, or a combination partly of one such method and
partly the other.
The Directors may approve additional remuneration to any Director for any services which in
the opinion of the Directors go beyond that Director’s ordinary routine work as a Director. Any fees
paid to a Director who is also counsel, attorney or solicitor to the Company, or otherwise serves it
in a professional capacity shall be in addition to their remuneration as a Director.
(h) Retirement, appointment and removal
The Company may by ordinary resolution appoint any person to be a Director, either to fill a
vacancy or as an additional Director.
The Company may by ordinary resolution remove any Director (including a managing or other
executive Director) before the expiration of such Director’s term of office, notwithstanding anything
in the Articles of Association or in any agreement between the Company and such Director, and may
by ordinary resolution elect another person in their stead. Nothing shall be taken as depriving a
Director so removed of compensation or damages payable to such Director in respect of the
termination of his appointment as Director or of any other appointment or office as a result of the
termination of his appointment as Director.
The Directors may appoint any person to be a Director, either to fill a vacancy or as an
additional Director provided that the appointment does not cause the number of Directors to exceed
any number fixed by or in accordance with the Articles of Association as the maximum number of
Directors. Any Director so appointed shall hold office only until the first annual general meeting of
the Company after such Director’s appointment and shall then be eligible for re-election at that
meeting.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-3 —


--- page 539 ---
There is no shareholding qualification for Directors nor is there any specified age limit for
Directors.
The office of a Director shall be vacated if:
(i) the Director gives notice in writing to the Company that he resigns the office of Director;
(ii) the Director is absent (for the avoidance of doubt, without being represented by proxy or
an alternate Director appointed by him) for a continuous period of 12 months without
special leave of absence from the Directors, and the Directors pass a resolution that he
has by reason of such absence vacated office;
(iii) the Director dies, becomes bankrupt or makes any arrangement or composition with his
creditors generally;
(iv) the Director is found to be or becomes of unsound mind; or
(v) the Director is removed from office by notice in writing served upon such Director signed
by not less than three-fourths in number (or, if that is not a round number, the nearest
lower round number) of the Directors then in office (including such Director).
At every annual general meeting of the Company one-third of the Directors for the time being,
or, if their number is not three or a multiple of three, then the number nearest to, but not less than,
one-third, shall retire from office by rotation, provided that every Director (including those
appointed for a specific term) shall be subject to retirement by rotation at least once every three
years. A retiring Director shall retain office until the close of the meeting at which he retires and shall
be eligible for re-election at such meeting. The Company at any annual general meeting at which any
Directors retire may fill the vacated office by electing a like number of persons to be Directors.
(i) Borrowing powers
The Directors may exercise all the powers of the Company to borrow money and to mortgage
or charge its undertaking, property and assets (present and future) and uncalled capital or any part
thereof and to issue debentures, debenture stock, mortgages, bonds and other such securities whether
outright or as security for any debt, liability or obligation of the Company or of any third party.
2.2 Alteration to constitutional documents
No alteration or amendment to the Memorandum or Articles of Association may be made except by
special resolution.
2.3 V ariation of rights of existing shares or classes of shares
If at any time the share capital of the Company is divided into different classes of shares, all or any
of the rights attached to any class for the time being issued (unless otherwise provided by the terms of
issue of the shares of that class) may, whether or not the Company is being wound up, be varied only with
the consent in writing of the holders of not less than three-fourths of the voting rights of the issued shares
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-4 —


--- page 540 ---
of that class, or with the approval of a resolution passed by a majority of not less than three-fourths of the
votes cast at a separate meeting of the holders of the shares of that class. To any such meeting all the
provisions of the Articles of Association relating to general meetings shall apply mutatis mutandis , except
that the necessary quorum shall be one or more persons holding or representing by proxy or duly
authorised representative at least one-third of the voting rights of the issued shares of that class.
The rights conferred upon the holders of shares of any class shall not, unless otherwise expressly
provided in the rights attaching to or the terms of issue of the shares of that class, be deemed to be varied
by the creation or issue of further shares ranking pari passu therewith.
2.4 Alteration of capital
The Company may by ordinary resolution:
(a) increase its share capital by such sum as the ordinary resolution shall prescribe and with such
rights, priorities and privileges annexed thereto, as the Company in general meeting may
determine;
(b) consolidate and divide all or any of its share capital into shares of larger amount than its
existing shares. On any consolidation of fully paid shares and division into shares of larger
amount, the Directors may settle any difficulty which may arise as they think expedient and in
particular (but without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing) may as between the holders
of shares to be consolidated determine which particular shares are to be consolidated into each
consolidated share, and if it shall happen that any person shall become entitled to fractions of
a consolidated share or shares, such fractions may be sold by some person appointed by the
Directors for that purpose and the person so appointed may transfer the shares so sold to the
purchasers thereof and the validity of such transfer shall not be questioned, and so that the net
proceeds of such sale (after deduction of the expenses of such sale) may either be distributed
among the persons who would otherwise be entitled to a fraction or fractions of a consolidated
share or shares rateably in accordance with their rights and interests or may be paid to the
Company for the Company’s benefit;
(c) by subdivision of its existing shares or any of them divide the whole or any part of its share
capital into shares of smaller amount than is fixed by the Memorandum of Association or into
shares without par value; and
(d) cancel any shares that at the date of the passing of the ordinary resolution have not been taken
or agreed to be taken by any person and diminish the amount of its share capital by the amount
of the shares so cancelled.
The Company may by special resolution reduce its share capital or any capital redemption reserve
fund, subject to the provisions of the Companies Act.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-5 —


--- page 541 ---
2.5 Special resolution – majority required
A “special resolution” is defined in the Articles of Association to have the same meaning as in the
Companies Act, for which purpose, the requisite majority shall be not less than three-fourths of the votes
of such members of the Company as, being entitled to do so, vote in person or, in the case of corporations,
by their duly authorised representatives or, where proxies are allowed, by proxy at a general meeting of
which notice specifying the intention to propose the resolution as a special resolution has been duly given
and includes a special resolution approved in writing by all of the members of the Company entitled to
vote at a general meeting of the Company in one or more instruments each signed by one or more of such
members, and the effective date of the special resolution so adopted shall be the date on which the
instrument or the last of such instruments (if more than one) is executed.
In contrast, an “ordinary resolution” is defined in the Articles of Association to mean a resolution
passed by a simple majority of the votes of such members of the Company as, being entitled to do so, vote
in person or, in the case of corporations, by their duly authorised representatives or, where proxies are
allowed, by proxy at a general meeting held in accordance with the Articles of Association and includes
an ordinary resolution approved in writing by all the members of the Company aforesaid.
2.6 V oting rights
Subject to any rights or restrictions attached to any shares, at any general meeting every member of
the Company present in person (or, in the case of a member being a corporation, by its duly authorised
representative) or by proxy shall have (a) the right to speak; (b) one vote on a show of hands; and (c) one
vote for every share of which he is the holder on a poll.
Where any member is, under the Listing Rules, required to abstain from voting on any particular
resolution or restricted to voting only for or only against any particular resolution, any votes cast by or
on behalf of such member in contravention of such requirement or restriction shall not be counted.
In the case of joint holders the vote of the senior holder who tenders a vote, whether in person or
by proxy (or in the case of a corporation or other non-natural person, by its duly authorised representative
or proxy) shall be accepted to the exclusion of the votes of the other joint holders, and seniority shall be
determined by the order in which the names of the holders stand in the register of members of the
Company.
A member of unsound mind, or in respect of whom an order has been made by any court having
jurisdiction in lunacy, may vote, whether on a show of hands or on a poll, by their committee, receiver,
curator bonis, or other person on such member’s behalf appointed by that court, and any such committee,
receiver, curator bonis or other person may vote by proxy.
No person shall be counted in a quorum or be entitled to vote at any general meeting unless he is
registered as a member on the record date for such meeting, nor unless all calls or other monies then
payable by him in respect of shares have been paid.
At any general meeting a resolution put to the vote of the meeting shall be decided by way of a poll
save that the chairperson of the meeting may allow a resolution which relates purely to a procedural or
administrative matter as prescribed under the Listing Rules to be voted on by a show of hands.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-6 —


--- page 542 ---
Any corporation or other non-natural person which is a member of the Company may in accordance
with its constitutional documents, or in the absence of such provision by resolution of its directors or other
governing body, authorise such person as it thinks fit to act as its representative at any meeting of the
Company or of any class of members, and the person so authorised shall be entitled to exercise the same
powers as the corporation could exercise if it were an individual member.
If a recognised clearing house (or its nominee(s)) is a member of the Company it may authorise such
person or persons as it thinks fit to act as its representative(s) at any general meeting of the Company or
at any general meeting of any class of members of the Company, provided that, if more than one person
is so authorised, the authorisation shall specify the number and class of shares in respect of which each
such person is so authorised. A person authorised pursuant to this provision shall be entitled to exercise
the same rights and powers on behalf of the recognised clearing house (or its nominee(s)) which that
person represents as that recognised clearing house (or its nominee(s)) could exercise as if such person
were an individual member of the Company holding the number and class of shares specified in such
authorisation, including the right to speak and, where a show of hands is allowed, the right to vote
individually on a show of hands.
2.7 Annual general meetings and extraordinary general meetings
The Company shall hold a general meeting as its annual general meeting for each financial year
within six months (or such other period as may be permitted by the Listing Rules or the Stock Exchange)
after the end of such financial year. An annual general meeting shall be specified as such in the notices
calling it.
The Directors may call general meetings, and they shall on a members’ requisition forthwith proceed
to convene an extraordinary general meeting of the Company. A members’ requisition is a requisition of
one or more members holding at the date of deposit of the requisition not less than 10% of the voting
rights, on a one vote per share basis, of the issued shares which as at that date carry the right to vote at
general meetings of the Company. The members’ requisition must state the objects and the resolutions to
be added to the agenda of the meeting and must be signed by the requisitionists and deposited at the
principal office of the Company in Hong Kong or, in the event the Company ceases to have such a
principal office, the registered office of the Company, and may consist of several documents in like form
each signed by one or more requisitionists. If there are no Directors as at the date of the deposit of the
members’ requisition or if the Directors do not within 21 days from the date of the deposit of the members’
requisition duly proceed to convene a general meeting to be held within a further 21 days, the
requisitionists, or any of them representing more than one-half of the total voting rights of all the
requisitionists, may themselves convene a general meeting, but any meeting so convened shall be held no
later than the day which falls three months after the expiration of the said 21 day period. A general meeting
convened by requisitionists shall be convened in the same manner as nearly as possible as that in which
general meetings are to be convened by Directors.
2.8 Accounts and audit
The Directors shall cause proper books of account to be kept with respect to all sums of money
received and expended by the Company and the matters in respect of which the receipt or expenditure
takes place, all sales and purchases of goods by the Company and the assets and liabilities of the Company.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-7 —


--- page 543 ---
Such books of account must be retained for a minimum period of five years from the date on which they
are prepared. Proper books shall not be deemed to be kept if there are not kept such books of account as
are necessary to give a true and fair view of the state of the Company’s affairs and to explain its
transactions.
The Directors shall determine whether and to what extent and at what times and places and under
what conditions or regulations the accounts and books of the Company or any of them shall be open to
the inspection of members of the Company not being Directors, and no member (not being a Director)
shall have any right of inspecting any account or book or document of the Company except as conferred
by the Companies Act or authorised by the Directors or by the Company in general meeting.
The Directors shall cause to be prepared and to be laid before the Company at every annual general
meeting a profit and loss account for the period since the preceding account, together with a balance sheet
as at the date to which the profit and loss account is made up, a Directors’ report with respect to the profit
or loss of the Company for the period covered by the profit and loss account and the state of the
Company’s affairs as at the end of such period, an auditors’ report on such accounts and such other reports
and accounts as may be required by law.
2.9 Auditors
The Company shall at every annual general meeting by ordinary resolution appoint an auditor or
auditors of the Company who shall hold office until the next annual general meeting. The Company may
by ordinary resolution remove an auditor before the expiration of his period of office. No person may be
appointed as an auditor of the Company unless such person is independent of the Company. The
remuneration of the auditors shall be fixed by the Company at the annual general meeting at which they
are appointed by ordinary resolution, or in the manner specified in such resolution.
2.10 Notice of meetings and business to be conducted thereat
An annual general meeting shall be called by not less than 21 days’ notice and any extraordinary
general meeting shall be called by not less than 14 days’ notice, which shall be exclusive of the day on
which it is served or deemed to be served and of the day for which it is given. The notice convening an
annual general meeting shall specify the meeting as such, and the notice convening a meeting to pass a
special resolution shall specify the intention to propose the resolution as a special resolution. Every notice
shall specify the place, the day and the hour of the meeting, particulars of the resolutions and the general
nature of the business to be conducted at the meeting. Notwithstanding the foregoing, a general meeting
of the Company shall, whether or not the notice specified has been given and whether or not the provisions
of the Articles of Association regarding general meetings have been complied with, be deemed to have
been duly convened if it is so agreed:
(a) in the case of an annual general meeting, by all members of the Company entitled to attend and
vote at the meeting; and
(b) in the case of an extraordinary general meeting, by a majority in number of the members having
a right to attend and vote at the meeting, together holding not less than 95% in par value of the
shares giving that right.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-8 —


--- page 544 ---
If, after the notice of a general meeting has been sent but before the meeting is held, or after the
adjournment of a general meeting but before the adjourned meeting is held (whether or not notice of the
adjourned meeting is required), the Directors, in their absolute discretion, consider that it is impractical
or unreasonable for any reason to hold a general meeting on the date or at the time and place specified
in the notice calling such meeting, they may change or postpone the meeting to another date, time and
place.
The Directors also have the power to provide in every notice calling a general meeting that in the
event of a gale warning or a black rainstorm warning is in force at any time on the day of the general
meeting (unless such warning is cancelled at least a minimum period of time prior to the general meeting
as the Directors may specify in the relevant notice), the meeting shall be postponed without further notice
to be reconvened on a later date.
Where a general meeting is postponed:
(a) the Company shall endeavour to cause a notice of such postponement, which shall set out the
reason for the postponement in accordance with the Listing Rules, to be placed on the
Company’s website and published on the Stock Exchange’s website as soon as practicable,
provided that failure to place or publish such notice shall not affect the automatic postponement
of a general meeting due to a gale warning or black rainstorm warning being in force on the
day of the general meeting;
(b) the Directors shall fix the date, time and place for the reconvened meeting and at least seven
clear days’ notice shall be given for the reconvened meeting; and such notice shall specify the
date, time and place at which the postponed meeting will be reconvened and the date and time
by which proxies shall be submitted in order to be valid at such reconvened meeting (provided
that any proxy submitted for the original meeting shall continue to be valid for the reconvened
meeting unless revoked or replaced by a new proxy); and
(c) only the business set out in the notice of the original meeting shall be transacted at the
reconvened meeting, and notice given for the reconvened meeting does not need to specify the
business to be transacted at the reconvened meeting, nor shall any accompanying documents
be required to be recirculated. Where any new business is to be transacted at such reconvened
meeting, the Company shall give a fresh notice for such reconvened meeting in accordance
with the Articles of Association.
2.11 Transfer of shares
Transfers of shares may be effected by an instrument of transfer, which shall be in writing and in any
standard form of transfer as prescribed by the Stock Exchange or such other form as the Directors may
approve. The instrument of transfer shall be executed by or on behalf of the transferor and, unless the
Directors otherwise determine, the transferee, and the transferor shall be deemed to remain the holder of
the share until the name of the transferee is entered in the register of members of the Company.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-9 —


--- page 545 ---
The Directors may decline to register any transfer of any share which is not fully paid up or on which
the Company has a lien. The Directors may also decline to register any transfer of any shares unless:
(a) the instrument of transfer is lodged with the Company accompanied by the certificate for the
shares to which it relates (which shall upon the registration of the transfer be cancelled) and
such other evidence as the Directors may reasonably require to show the right of the transferor
to make the transfer;
(b) the instrument of transfer is in respect of only one class of shares;
(c) the instrument of transfer is properly stamped (in circumstances where stamping is required);
(d) in the case of a transfer to joint holders, the number of joint holders to whom the share is to
be transferred does not exceed four;
(e) the shares concerned are free of any lien in favour of the Company; and
(f) a fee of such amount not exceeding the maximum amount as the Stock Exchange may from
time to time determine to be payable (or such lesser sum as the Directors may from time to time
require) is paid to the Company in respect thereof.
If the Directors refuse to register a transfer of any share they shall notify the transferor and the
transferee within two months of such refusal.
The registration of transfers shall be suspended during such periods as the register of members of
the Company is closed. The Directors may, on at least 10 business days’ notice (or on at least 6 business
days’ notice in the case of a rights issue) being given by advertisement published on the Stock Exchange’s
website, or, subject to the Listing Rules, in the manner in which notices may be served by the Company
by electronic means as provided in the Articles of Association or by advertisement published in the
newspapers, close the register of members at such times and for such periods as the Directors may from
time to time determine, provided that the register of members shall not be closed for more than 30 days
in any year (or such longer period as the members of the Company may by ordinary resolution determine,
provided that such period shall not be extended beyond 60 days in any year).
2.12 Power of the Company to purchase its own shares
Subject to the provisions of the Companies Act, the Company may purchase its own shares provided
that (a) the manner of purchase has first been authorised by the members of the Company by ordinary
resolution, and (b) any such purchase shall only be made in accordance with any relevant code, rules or
regulations issued by the Stock Exchange or the Securities and Futures Commission of Hong Kong from
time to time in force.
2.13 Power of any subsidiary of the Company to own shares
There are no provisions in the Articles of Association relating to the ownership of shares by a
subsidiary.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-10 —


--- page 546 ---
2.14 Dividends and other methods of distribution
Subject to the Companies Act and the Articles of Association, the Company may by ordinary
resolution resolve to pay dividends and other distributions on shares in issue and authorise payment of the
dividends or other distributions out of the funds of the Company lawfully available therefor, provided no
dividends shall exceed the amount recommended by the Directors. No dividend or other distribution shall
be paid except out of the realised or unreleased profits of the Company, out of the share premium account
or as otherwise permitted by law.
The Directors may from time to time pay to the members of the Company such interim dividends as
appear to the Directors to be justified by the profits of the Company. The Directors may in addition from
time to time declare and pay special dividends on shares of such amounts and on such dates as they think
fit.
Except as otherwise provided by the rights attached to any shares, all dividends and other
distributions shall be paid according to the amounts paid up on the shares that a member holds during any
portion or portions of the period in respect of which the dividend is paid. For this purpose no amount paid
up on a share in advance of calls shall be treated as paid up on the share.
The Directors may deduct from any dividends or other distribution payable to any member of the
Company all sums of money (if any) then payable by the member to the Company on account of calls or
otherwise. The Directors may retain any dividends or other monies payable on or in respect of a share upon
which the Company has a lien, and may apply the same in or towards satisfaction of the debts, liabilities
or engagements in respect of which the lien exists.
No dividend shall carry interest against the Company. Except as otherwise provided by the rights
attached to any shares, dividends and other distributions may be paid in any currency.
Whenever the Directors or the Company in general meeting have resolved that a dividend be paid
or declared on the share capital of the Company, the Directors may further resolve: (a) that such dividend
be satisfied wholly or in part in the form of an allotment of shares credited as fully paid up on the basis
that the shares so allotted are to be of the same class as the class already held by the allottee, provided
that the members of the Company entitled thereto will be entitled to elect to receive such dividend (or part
thereof) in cash in lieu of such allotment; or (b) that the members of the Company entitled to such dividend
will be entitled to elect to receive an allotment of shares credited as fully paid up in lieu of the whole or
such part of the dividend as the Directors may think fit on the basis that the shares so allotted are to be
of the same class as the class already held by the allottee. The Company may upon the recommendation
of the Directors by ordinary resolution resolve in respect of any one particular dividend of the Company
that notwithstanding the foregoing a dividend may be satisfied wholly in the form of an allotment of shares
credited as fully paid without offering any right to members of the Company to elect to receive such
dividend in cash in lieu of such allotment.
Any dividend, interest or other monies payable in cash in respect of shares may be paid by wire
transfer to the holder or by cheque or warrant sent through the post directed to the registered address of
the holder or, in the case of joint holders, to the registered address of the holder who is first named on the
register of members of the Company or to such person and to such address as the holder or joint holders
may in writing direct. Every such cheque or warrant shall be made payable to the order of the person to
whom it is sent. Any one of two or more joint holders may give effectual receipts for any dividends, other
distributions, bonuses, or other monies payable in respect of the shares held by them as joint holders.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-11 —


--- page 547 ---
Any dividend or other distribution which remains unclaimed after a period of six years from the date
on which such dividend or distribution becomes payable shall be forfeited and shall revert to the Company.
The Directors, with the sanction of the members of the Company by ordinary resolution, may resolve
that any dividend or other distribution be paid wholly or partly by the distribution of specific assets, and
in particular (but without limitation) by the distribution of shares, debentures, or securities of any other
company or in any one or more of such ways, and where any difficulty arises in regard to such distribution,
the Directors may settle it as they think expedient, and in particular may disregard fractional entitlements,
round the same up or down or provide that the same shall accrue to the benefit of the Company, and may
fix the value for distribution of such specific assets or any part thereof and may determine that cash
payments shall be made to any members of the Company upon the basis of the value so fixed in order to
adjust the rights of all members, and may vest any such specific assets in trustees as may seem expedient
to the Directors.
2.15 Proxies
A member of the Company entitled to attend and vote at a general meeting of the Company shall be
entitled to appoint another person who must be an individual as his proxy to attend and vote instead of
him and a proxy so appointed shall have the same right as the member to speak at the meeting. V otes may
be given either personally or by proxy. A proxy need not be a member of the Company. A member may
appoint any number of proxies to attend in his stead at any one general meeting or at any one class
meeting.
The instrument appointing a proxy shall be in writing and shall be executed under the hand of the
appointor or of his attorney duly authorised in writing, or, if the appointor is a corporation or other
non-natural person, under the hand of its duly authorised representative.
The Directors shall, in the notice convening any meeting or adjourned meeting, or in an instrument
of proxy sent out by the Company, specify the manner (including by electronic means) by which the
instrument appointing a proxy shall be deposited and the place and the time (being not later than the time
appointed for the commencement of the meeting or adjourned meeting to which the proxy relates) at which
the instrument appointing a proxy shall be deposited.
The instrument appointing a proxy may be in any usual or common form (or such other form as the
Directors may approve) and may be expressed to be for a particular meeting or any adjournment thereof
or generally until revoked.
2.16 Calls on shares and forfeiture of shares
Subject to the terms of the allotment and issue of any shares, the Directors may make calls upon the
members of the Company in respect of any monies unpaid on their shares (whether in respect of par value
or premium), and each member of the Company shall (subject to receiving at least 14 clear days’ notice
specifying the times or times of payment) pay to the Company at the time or times so specified the amount
called on his shares. A call may be revoked or postponed, in whole or in part, as the Directors may
determine. A call may be required to be paid by instalments. A person upon whom a call is made shall
remain liable for calls made upon him, notwithstanding the subsequent transfer of the shares in respect of
which the call was made.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-12 —


--- page 548 ---
A call shall be deemed to have been made at the time when the resolution of the Directors authorising
the call was passed. The joint holders of a share shall be jointly and severally liable to pay all calls and
instalments due in respect of such share.
If a call remains unpaid after it has become due and payable, the person from whom it is due shall
pay interest on the amount unpaid from the day it became due and payable until it is paid at such rate as
the Directors may determine (and in addition all expenses that have been incurred by the Company by
reason of such non-payment), but the Directors may waive payment of the interest or expenses wholly or
in part.
If any call or instalment of a call remains unpaid after it has become due and payable, the Directors
may give to the person from whom it is due not less than 14 clear days’ notice requiring payment of the
amount unpaid together with any interest which may have accrued and any expenses incurred by the
Company by reason of such non-payment. The notice shall specify where payment is to be made and shall
state if the notice is not complied with the shares in respect of which the call was made will be liable to
be forfeited.
If such notice is not complied with, any share in respect of which it was given may, before the
payment required by the notice has been made, be forfeited by a resolution of the Directors. Such
forfeiture shall include all dividends, other distributions or other monies payable in respect of the forfeited
shares and not paid before the forfeiture.
A forfeited share may be sold, re-allotted or otherwise disposed of on such terms and in such manner
as the Directors think fit.
A person any of whose shares have been forfeited shall cease to be a member of the Company in
respect of the forfeited shares and shall surrender to the Company for cancellation the certificate for the
shares forfeited and shall remain liable to pay to the Company all monies which at the date of forfeiture
were payable by him to the Company in respect of the shares, together with interest at such rate as the
Directors may determine, but that person’s liability shall cease if and when the Company shall have
received payment in full of all monies due and payable by them in respect of those shares.
2.17 Inspection of register of members
The Company shall maintain or cause to be maintained the register of members of the Company in
accordance with the Companies Act. The Directors may, on giving 10 business days’ notice (or 6 business
days’ notice in the case of a rights issue) by advertisement published on the Stock Exchange’s website or,
subject to the Listing Rules, in the manner in which notices may be served by the Company by electronic
means as provided in the Articles of Association or by advertisement published in the newspapers, close
the register of members at such times and for such periods as the Directors may determine, either generally
or in respect of any class of shares, provided that the register shall not be closed for more than 30 days
in any year (or such longer period as the members of the Company may by ordinary resolution determine,
provided that such period shall not be extended beyond 60 days in any year).
Except when the register is closed, the register of members shall during business hours be kept open
for inspection by any member of the Company without charge.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-13 —


--- page 549 ---
2.18 Quorum for meetings and separate class meetings
No business shall be transacted at any general meeting unless a quorum is present. Two members of
the Company present in person or by proxy, or if a corporation or other non-natural person by its duly
authorised representative or proxy, shall be a quorum unless the Company has only one member entitled
to vote at such general meeting in which case the quorum shall be that one member present in person or
by proxy, or in the case of a corporation or other non-natural person by its duly authorised representative
or proxy.
The quorum for a separate general meeting of the holders of a separate class of shares of the
Company is described in paragraph 2.3 above.
2.19 Rights of minorities in relation to fraud or oppression
There are no provisions in the Articles of Association concerning the rights of minority shareholders
in relation to fraud or oppression.
2.20 Procedure on liquidation
Subject to the Companies Act, the Company may by special resolution resolve that the Company be
wound up voluntarily.
Subject to the rights attaching to any shares, in a winding up:
(a) if the assets available for distribution amongst the members of the Company shall be
insufficient to repay the whole of the Company’s paid-up capital, such assets shall be
distributed so that, as nearly as may be, the losses shall be borne by the members of the
Company in proportion to the capital paid up, or which ought to have been paid up, on the
shares held by them at the commencement of the winding up;
(b) if the assets available for distribution amongst the members of the Company shall be more than
sufficient to repay the whole of the Company’s paid up capital at the commencement of the
winding up, the surplus shall be distributed amongst the members of the Company in
proportion to the capital paid up on the shares held by them at the commencement of the
winding up.
If the Company shall be wound up, the liquidator may with the approval of a special resolution of
the Company and any other approval required by the Companies Act, divide amongst the members of the
Company in kind the whole or any part of the assets of the Company (whether such assets shall consist
of property of the same kind or not) and may, for that purpose, value any assets and determine how the
division shall be carried out as between the members or different classes of members of the Company. The
liquidator may, with the like approval, vest the whole or any part of such assets in trustees upon such trusts
for the benefit of the members of the Company as the liquidator, with the like approval, shall think fit, but
so that no member of the Company shall be compelled to accept any assets, shares or other securities in
respect of which there is a liability.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-14 —


--- page 550 ---
2.21 Untraceable members
The Company shall be entitled to sell any shares of a member of the Company or the shares to which
a person is entitled by virtue of transmission on death or bankruptcy or operation of law if: (a) all cheques
or warrants, not being less than three in number, for any sums payable in cash to the holder of such shares
have remained uncashed for a period of 12 years; (b) the Company has not during that time or before the
expiry of the three month period referred to in (d) below received any indication of the whereabouts or
existence of the member; (c) during the 12-year period, at least three dividends in respect of the shares
in question have become payable and no dividend during that period has been claimed by the member; and
(d) upon expiry of the 12-year period, the Company has caused an advertisement to be published in the
newspapers or, subject to the Listing Rules, by electronic communication in the manner in which notices
may be served by the Company by electronic means as provided in the Articles of Association, giving
notice of its intention to sell such shares and a period of three months has elapsed since such advertisement
and the Stock Exchange has been notified of such intention. The net proceeds of any such sale shall belong
to the Company and upon receipt by the Company of such net proceeds it shall become indebted to the
former member for an amount equal to such net proceeds.
SUMMARY OF CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W AND TAXATION
1 Introduction
The Companies Act is derived, to a large extent, from the older Companies Acts of England, although
there are significant differences between the Companies Act and the current Companies Act of England.
Set out below is a summary of certain provisions of the Companies Act, although this does not purport to
contain all applicable qualifications and exceptions or to be a complete review of all matters of corporate
law and taxation which may differ from equivalent provisions in jurisdictions with which interested parties
may be more familiar.
2 Incorporation
The Company was incorporated in the Cayman Islands as an exempted company with limited
liability on December 14, 2020 under the Companies Act. As such, its operations must be conducted
mainly outside the Cayman Islands. The Company is required to file an annual return each year with the
Registrar of Companies of the Cayman Islands and pay a fee which is based on the size of its authorised
share capital.
3 Share Capital
The Companies Act permits a company to issue ordinary shares, preference shares, redeemable
shares or any combination thereof.
The Companies Act provides that where a company issues shares at a premium, whether for cash or
otherwise, a sum equal to the aggregate amount of the value of the premia on those shares shall be
transferred to an account called the “share premium account”. At the option of a company, these provisions
may not apply to premia on shares of that company allotted pursuant to any arrangement in consideration
of the acquisition or cancellation of shares in any other company and issued at a premium. The Companies
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-15 —


--- page 551 ---
Act provides that the share premium account may be applied by a company, subject to the provisions, if
any, of its memorandum and articles of association, in such manner as the company may from time to time
determine including, but without limitation:
(a) paying distributions or dividends to members;
(b) paying up unissued shares of the company to be issued to members as fully paid bonus shares;
(c) in the redemption and repurchase of shares (subject to the provisions of section 37 of the
Companies Act);
(d) writing-off the preliminary expenses of the company;
(e) writing-off the expenses of, or the commission paid or discount allowed on, any issue of shares
or debentures of the company; and
(f) providing for the premium payable on redemption or purchase of any shares or debentures of
the company.
No distribution or dividend may be paid to members out of the share premium account unless
immediately following the date on which the distribution or dividend is proposed to be paid the company
will be able to pay its debts as they fall due in the ordinary course of business.
The Companies Act provides that, subject to confirmation by the Grand Court of the Cayman Islands,
a company limited by shares or a company limited by guarantee and having a share capital may, if so
authorised by its articles of association, by special resolution reduce its share capital in any way.
Subject to the detailed provisions of the Companies Act, a company limited by shares or a company
limited by guarantee and having a share capital may, if so authorised by its articles of association, issue
shares which are to be redeemed or are liable to be redeemed at the option of the company or a shareholder.
In addition, such a company may, if authorised to do so by its articles of association, purchase its own
shares, including any redeemable shares. The manner of such a purchase must be authorised either by the
articles of association or by an ordinary resolution of the company. The articles of association may provide
that the manner of purchase may be determined by the directors of the company. At no time may a
company redeem or purchase its shares unless they are fully paid. A company may not redeem or purchase
any of its shares if, as a result of the redemption or purchase, there would no longer be any member of
the company holding shares. A payment out of capital by a company for the redemption or purchase of its
own shares is not lawful unless immediately following the date on which the payment is proposed to be
made, the company shall be able to pay its debts as they fall due in the ordinary course of business.
There is no statutory restriction in the Cayman Islands on the provision of financial assistance by a
company for the purchase of, or subscription for, its own or its holding company’s shares. Accordingly,
a company may provide financial assistance if the directors of the company consider, in discharging their
duties of care and to act in good faith, for a proper purpose and in the interests of the company, that such
assistance can properly be given. Such assistance should be on an arm’s-length basis.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-16 —


--- page 552 ---
4 Dividends and Distributions
With the exception of section 34 of the Companies Act, there are no statutory provisions relating to
the payment of dividends. Based upon English case law which is likely to be persuasive in the Cayman
Islands in this area, dividends may be paid only out of profits. In addition, section 34 of the Companies
Act permits, subject to a solvency test and the provisions, if any, of the company’s memorandum and
articles of association, the payment of dividends and distributions out of the share premium account (see
paragraph 3 above for details).
5 Shareholders’ Suits
The Cayman Islands courts can be expected to follow English case law precedents. The rule in Foss
v. Harbottle (and the exceptions thereto which permit a minority shareholder to commence a class action
against or derivative actions in the name of the company to challenge (a) an act which is ultra vires the
company or illegal, (b) an act which constitutes a fraud against the minority where the wrongdoers are
themselves in control of the company, and (c) an action which requires a resolution with a qualified (or
special) majority which has not been obtained) has been applied and followed by the courts in the Cayman
Islands.
6 Protection of Minorities
In the case of a company (not being a bank) having a share capital divided into shares, the Grand
Court of the Cayman Islands may, on the application of members holding not less than one-fifth of the
shares of the company in issue, appoint an inspector to examine into the affairs of the company and to
report thereon in such manner as the Grand Court shall direct.
Any shareholder of a company may petition the Grand Court of the Cayman Islands which may make
a winding up order if the court is of the opinion that it is just and equitable that the company should be
wound up.
Claims against a company by its shareholders must, as a general rule, be based on the general laws
of contract or tort applicable in the Cayman Islands or their individual rights as shareholders as established
by the company’s memorandum and articles of association.
The English common law rule that the majority will not be permitted to commit a fraud on the
minority has been applied and followed by the courts of the Cayman Islands.
7 Disposal of Assets
The Companies Act contains no specific restrictions on the powers of directors to dispose of assets
of a company. As a matter of general law, in the exercise of those powers, the directors must discharge
their duties of care and to act in good faith, for a proper purpose and in the interests of the company.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-17 —


--- page 553 ---
8 Accounting and Auditing Requirements
The Companies Act requires that a company shall cause to be kept proper books of account with
respect to:
(a) all sums of money received and expended by the company and the matters in respect of which
the receipt and expenditure takes place;
(b) all sales and purchases of goods by the company; and
(c) the assets and liabilities of the company.
Proper books of account shall not be deemed to be kept if there are not kept such books as are
necessary to give a true and fair view of the state of the company’s affairs and to explain its transactions.
9 Register of Members
An exempted company may, subject to the provisions of its articles of association, maintain its
principal register of members and any branch registers at such locations, whether within or without the
Cayman Islands, as its directors may from time to time think fit. There is no requirement under the
Companies Act for an exempted company to make any returns of members to the Registrar of Companies
of the Cayman Islands. The names and addresses of the members are, accordingly, not a matter of public
record and are not available for public inspection.
10 Inspection of Books and Records
Members of a company will have no general right under the Companies Act to inspect or obtain
copies of the register of members or corporate records of the company. They will, however, have such
rights as may be set out in the company’s articles of association.
11 Special Resolutions
The Companies Act provides that a resolution is a special resolution when it has been passed by a
majority of at least two-thirds of such members as, being entitled to do so, vote in person or, where proxies
are allowed, by proxy at a general meeting of which notice specifying the intention to propose the
resolution as a special resolution has been duly given, except that a company may in its articles of
association specify that the required majority shall be a number greater than two-thirds, and may
additionally so provide that such majority (being not less than two-thirds) may differ as between matters
required to be approved by a special resolution. Written resolutions signed by all the members entitled to
vote for the time being of the company may take effect as special resolutions if this is authorised by the
articles of association of the company.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-18 —


--- page 554 ---
12 Subsidiary Owning Shares in Parent
The Companies Act does not prohibit a Cayman Islands company acquiring and holding shares in its
parent company provided its objects so permit. The directors of any subsidiary making such acquisition
must discharge their duties of care and to act in good faith, for a proper purpose and in the interests of
the subsidiary.
13 Mergers and Consolidations
The Companies Act permits mergers and consolidations between Cayman Islands companies and
between Cayman Islands companies and non-Cayman Islands companies. For these purposes, (a) “merger”
means the merging of two or more constituent companies and the vesting of their undertaking, property
and liabilities in one of such companies as the surviving company, and (b) “consolidation” means the
combination of two or more constituent companies into a consolidated company and the vesting of the
undertaking, property and liabilities of such companies to the consolidated company. In order to effect
such a merger or consolidation, the directors of each constituent company must approve a written plan of
merger or consolidation, which must then be authorised by (a) a special resolution of each constituent
company and (b) such other authorisation, if any, as may be specified in such constituent company’s
articles of association. The written plan of merger or consolidation must be filed with the Registrar of
Companies of the Cayman Islands together with a declaration as to the solvency of the consolidated or
surviving company, a list of the assets and liabilities of each constituent company and an undertaking that
a copy of the certificate of merger or consolidation will be given to the members and creditors of each
constituent company and that notification of the merger or consolidation will be published in the Cayman
Islands Gazette. Dissenting shareholders have the right to be paid the fair value of their shares (which, if
not agreed between the parties, will be determined by the Cayman Islands court) if they follow the required
procedures, subject to certain exceptions. Court approval is not required for a merger or consolidation
which is effected in compliance with these statutory procedures.
14 Reconstructions
There are statutory provisions which facilitate reconstructions and amalgamations approved by (a)
75% in value of shareholders, or (b) a majority in number representing 75% in value of creditors,
depending on the circumstances, as are present at a meeting called for such purpose and thereafter
sanctioned by the Grand Court of the Cayman Islands. Whilst a dissenting shareholder would have the
right to express to the Grand Court his view that the transaction for which approval is sought would not
provide the shareholders with a fair value for their shares, the Grand Court is unlikely to disapprove the
transaction on that ground alone in the absence of evidence of fraud or bad faith on behalf of management
and if the transaction were approved and consummated, the dissenting shareholder would have no rights
comparable to the appraisal rights (i.e. the right to receive payment in cash for the judicially determined
value of his shares) ordinarily available, for example, to dissenting shareholders of United States
corporations.
15 Take-overs
Where an offer is made by a company for the shares of another company and, within four months
of the offer, the holders of not less than 90% of the shares which are the subject of the offer accept, the
offeror may at any time within two months after the expiration of the said four months, by notice require
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-19 —


--- page 555 ---
the dissenting shareholders to transfer their shares on the terms of the offer. A dissenting shareholder may
apply to the Grand Court of the Cayman Islands within one month of the notice objecting to the transfer.
The burden is on the dissenting shareholder to show that the Grand Court should exercise its discretion,
which it will be unlikely to do unless there is evidence of fraud or bad faith or collusion as between the
offeror and the holders of the shares who have accepted the offer as a means of unfairly forcing out
minority shareholders.
16 Indemnification
Cayman Islands law does not limit the extent to which a company’s articles of association may
provide for indemnification of officers and directors, except to the extent any such provision may be held
by the Cayman Islands courts to be contrary to public policy (e.g. for purporting to provide
indemnification against the consequences of committing a crime).
17 Restructuring
A company may present a petition to the Grand Court of the Cayman Islands for the appointment of
a restructuring officer on the grounds that the company:
(a) is or is likely to become unable to pay its debts; and
(b) intends to present a compromise or arrangement to its creditors (or classes thereof) either
pursuant to the Companies Act, the law of a foreign country or by way of a consensual
restructuring.
The Grand Court may, among other things, make an order appointing a restructuring officer upon
hearing of such petition, with such powers and to carry out such functions as the court may order. At any
time (i) after the presentation of a petition for the appointment of a restructuring officer but before an order
for the appointment of a restructuring officer has been made, and (ii) when an order for the appointment
of a restructuring officer is made, until such order has been discharged, no suit, action or other proceedings
(other than criminal proceedings) shall be proceeded with or commenced against the company, no
resolution to wind up the company shall be passed, and no winding up petition may be presented against
the company, except with the leave of the court. However, notwithstanding the presentation of a petition
for the appointment of a restructuring officer or the appointment of a restructuring officer, a creditor who
has security over the whole or part of the assets of the company is entitled to enforce the security without
the leave of the court and without reference to the restructuring officer appointed.
18 Liquidation
A company may be placed in liquidation compulsorily by an order of the court, or voluntarily (a) by
a special resolution of its members if the company is solvent, or (b) by an ordinary resolution of its
members if the company is insolvent. The liquidator’s duties are to collect the assets of the company
(including the amount (if any) due from the contributories (shareholders)), settle the list of creditors and
discharge the company’s liability to them, rateably if insufficient assets exist to discharge the liabilities
in full, and to settle the list of contributories and divide the surplus assets (if any) amongst them in
accordance with the rights attaching to the shares.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-20 —


--- page 556 ---
19 Stamp Duty on Transfers
No stamp duty is payable in the Cayman Islands on transfers of shares of Cayman Islands companies
except those which hold interests in land in the Cayman Islands.
20 Taxation
Pursuant to section 6 of the Tax Concessions Act (As Revised) of the Cayman Islands, the Company
may obtain an undertaking from the Financial Secretary of the Cayman Islands:
(a) that no law which is enacted in the Cayman Islands imposing any tax to be levied on profits,
income, gains or appreciations shall apply to the Company or its operations; and
(b) in addition, that no tax to be levied on profits, income, gains or appreciations or which is in
the nature of estate duty or inheritance tax shall be payable:
(i) on or in respect of the shares, debentures or other obligations of the Company; or
(ii) by way of the withholding in whole or in part of any relevant payment as defined in
section 6(3) of the Tax Concessions Act (As Revised).
The Cayman Islands currently levy no taxes on individuals or corporations based upon profits,
income, gains or appreciations and there is no taxation in the nature of inheritance tax or estate duty. There
are no other taxes likely to be material to the Company levied by the Government of the Cayman Islands
save certain stamp duties which may be applicable, from time to time, on certain instruments executed in
or brought within the jurisdiction of the Cayman Islands. The Cayman Islands are not party to any double
tax treaties that are applicable to any payments made by or to the Company.
21 Exchange Control
There are no exchange control regulations or currency restrictions in the Cayman Islands.
22 General
Maples and Calder (Hong Kong) LLP , the Company’s legal advisors on Cayman Islands law, have
sent to the Company a letter of advice summarising aspects of Cayman Islands Company Law. This letter,
together with a copy of the Companies Act, is on display on the websites as referred to in the section
headed “Documents on display” in Appendix V . Any person wishing to have a detailed summary of
Cayman Islands Company Law or advice on the differences between it and the laws of any jurisdiction
with which he/she is more familiar is recommended to seek independent legal advice.
APPENDIX III SUMMARY OF THE CONSTITUTION OF THE
COMPANY AND CAYMAN ISLANDS COMPANY LA W
— III-21 —


--- page 557 ---
A. FURTHER INFORMATION ABOUT OUR GROUP
1. Incorporation of Our Company
Our Company was incorporated in the Cayman Islands as an exempted company with limited
liability under the Cayman Companies Act on December 14, 2020 with the name “WuXi XDC Cayman
Inc.” Our registered office address is at the offices of Maples Corporate Services Limited at PO Box 309,
Ugland House, Grand Cayman, KY1-1104, Cayman Islands. Accordingly, our corporate structure and
Memorandum and Articles of Association are subject to the relevant laws of the Cayman Islands. A
summary of our Memorandum and Articles of Association is set out in Appendix III to this prospectus.
We have established a place of business in 31/F, Tower Two, Times Square, 1 Matheson Street,
Causeway Bay, Hong Kong and has been registered as a non-Hong Kong company in Hong Kong under
Part 16 of the Companies Ordinance on June 26, 2023. Ms. Wong Hoi Ting has been appointed as our
authorized person of our Company for the acceptance of service of process in Hong Kong. The address
for service of process is 31/F, Tower Two, Times Square, 1 Matheson Street, Causeway Bay, Hong Kong.
2. Changes in Share Capital of Our Company
On December 14, 2020, being the date of incorporation of our Company, our authorized share capital
was US$50,000, divided into 50,000 ordinary shares of a par value of US$1.00 each.
On December 14, 2020, one share of a par value of US$1.00 each of our Company was issued and
allotted to the initial subscriber, Mapcal Limited, which in turn on the same day transferred the one share
to WuXi Biologics.
On June 4, 2021, our Company repurchased one ordinary share of a par value of US$1.00 from WuXi
Biologics and then issued and allotted three and two new ordinary shares of a par value of US$1.00 each
to WuXi Biologics and STA Pharmaceutical, respectively.
On September 13, 2021, our Company underwent a subdivision of shares whereby each issued and
unissued ordinary share of a par value of US$1.00 was subdivided into 20,000 ordinary shares of a par
value of US$0.00005 each, such that following such subdivision, the authorized share capital of our
Company was US$50,000 divided into 1,000,000,000 ordinary shares of a par value of US$0.00005 each.
On June 30, 2023, our authorized share capital was increased from US$50,000 divided into
1,000,000,000 ordinary shares of a par value of US$0.00005 each to US$500,000 divided into
10,000,000,000 ordinary shares of a par value of US$0.00005 each.
Save as disclosed above, there has been no alteration in the share capital of our Company during the
two years immediately preceding the date of this prospectus.
3. Changes in the Share Capital of Our Subsidiaries
The following sets out the changes in share capital or registered capital of our subsidiaries which
have taken place within the two years preceding the date of this prospectus:
XDC Hong Kong
On June 7, 2021, XDC Hong Kong was incorporated in Hong Kong as a limited liability company
with an initial registered capital of HK$1.00.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
—I V - 1—


--- page 558 ---
XDC Shanghai
On March 31, 2021, XDC Shanghai was established in the PRC as a limited liability company with
an initial registered share capital of RMB30 million.
XDC Changzhou
On July 2, 2021, XDC Changzhou was established in the PRC as a limited liability company with
an initial registered share capital of RMB300 million.
XDC Singapore
On November 16, 2022, XDC Singapore was incorporated in Singapore as a limited liability
company with an initial registered capital of US$5 million.
Save as disclosed above, there has been no alterations in the share capital of our subsidiaries within
two years immediately preceding the date of this prospectus.
4. Resolutions in writing of our Shareholders passed on October 30, 2023
Pursuant to the written resolutions passed by our Shareholders on October 30, 2023, the following
resolutions, among others, were duly passed:
(a) conditional on (aa) the Listing Committee granting listing of, and permission to deal in, the
Shares in issue and to be issued as mentioned in this prospectus; and (bb) the obligations of the
Underwriters under the Underwriting Agreements becoming unconditional and not being
terminated in accordance with the terms of the Underwriting Agreements or otherwise:
(i) the Memorandum and Articles of Association were approved and adopted effective upon
Listing; and
(ii) the Global Offering and the Over-allotment Option were approved and our Directors were
authorized to allot and issue Shares pursuant to the Global Offering and such number of
Shares as may be required to be allotted and issued upon the exercise of the
Over-allotment Option;
(b) a general unconditional mandate was given to our Directors to allot, issue and deal with Shares
or securities convertible into Shares and to make or grant offers, agreements or options
(including any warrants, bonds, notes and debentures conferring any rights to subscribe for or
otherwise receive Shares) which would or might require Shares to be allotted, issued or dealt
with, with an aggregate number of Shares (otherwise than pursuant to, or in consequence of,
the Global Offering, a rights issue or pursuant to the exercise of any subscription rights which
may be granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes and any other share incentive scheme
or any scrip dividend scheme or similar arrangements, any adjustment of rights to subscribe for
Shares under options and warrants or a special authority granted by our Shareholders or an
issue of Shares in lieu of the whole or part of a dividend on Shares in accordance with the
Articles of Association), not exceeding the sum of 20% of the issued share capital immediately
following the completion of the Global Offering but excluding any Shares, which may be
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
—I V - 2—


--- page 559 ---
issued pursuant to the exercise of the Over-allotment Option and the options granted under the
Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, until the conclusion of our next annual general meeting, or the
passing of an ordinary resolution by the Shareholders renewing, revoking or varying the
authority to our Directors, whichever occurs first;
(c) a general unconditional mandate (the “ Repurchase Mandate ”) was given to our Directors to
exercise all powers of our Company to purchase Shares with an aggregate number of Shares
of not exceeding 10% of the issued share capital of our Company immediately following the
completion of the Global Offering but excluding any Shares, which may be issued pursuant to
the exercise of the Over-allotment Option and the options granted under the Pre-IPO Share
Option Schemes until the conclusion of our next annual general meeting, or the passing of an
ordinary resolution by the Shareholders renewing, revoking or varying the authority given to
our Directors, whichever occurs first; and
(d) the extension of the general mandate to allot, issue and deal with Shares to include the number
of Shares repurchased pursuant to paragraph (c) above.
5. Restrictions on Repurchase
This section sets out information required by the Stock Exchange to be included in this prospectus
concerning the repurchase by our Company of its own securities.
(a) Provisions of the Listing Rules
The Listing Rules permit companies with a primary listing on the Stock Exchange to repurchase their
own securities on the Stock Exchange subject to certain restrictions, the more important of which are
summarized below:
(i) Shareholders’ approval
All proposed repurchase of securities (which must be fully paid up in the case of shares) by a
company with a primary listing on the Stock Exchange must be approved in advance by an ordinary
resolution of the shareholders, either by way of general mandate or by specific approval of a
particular transaction.
(ii) Source of funds
Repurchases must be funded out of funds legally available for the purpose in accordance with
the Articles of Association of our Company, the Listing Rules and the applicable laws of the Cayman
Islands. A listed company may not repurchase its own securities on the Stock Exchange for a
consideration other than cash or for settlement otherwise than in accordance with the trading rules
of the Stock Exchange. Subject to the foregoing, any repurchases by our Company may be made out
of profits, or out of the proceeds of a new issue of shares made for the purpose of the repurchase,
or from sums standing to the credit of our share premium account or out of capital, if so authorized
by the Articles of Association and subject to the Cayman Companies Act. Any amount of premium
payable on the purchase over the par value of the shares to be repurchased must be paid out of
profits, or from sums standing to the credit of our Company’s share premium account.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
—I V - 3—


--- page 560 ---
On the basis of the current financial position of us as disclosed in this prospectus and taking
into account the current working capital position of us, our Directors consider that, if the Repurchase
Mandate were to be exercised in full, it might have a material adverse effect on the working capital
and/or the gearing position of us as compared with the position disclosed in this prospectus.
However, our Directors do not propose to exercise the Repurchase Mandate to such an extent as
would, in these circumstances, have a material adverse effect on our working capital requirements
or the gearing levels, which in the opinion of our Directors, are from time to time appropriate for
us.
(iii) Trading restrictions
The total number of shares which a listed company may repurchase on the Stock Exchange is
the number of shares representing up to a maximum of 10% of the aggregate number of shares in
issue. A company may not issue or announce a proposed issue of new securities for a period of 30
days immediately following a repurchase (other than an issue of securities pursuant to an exercise
of warrants, options or similar instruments requiring the company to issue securities, which were
outstanding prior to such repurchase) without the prior approval of the Stock Exchange. In addition,
a listed company is prohibited from repurchasing its shares on the Stock Exchange if the purchase
price is 5% or more than the average closing market price for the five preceding trading days on
which its shares were traded on the Stock Exchange. The Listing Rules also prohibit a listed company
from repurchasing its securities which are in the hands of the public falling below the relevant
prescribed minimum percentage as required by the Stock Exchange. A company is required to
procure that the broker appointed by it to effect a repurchase of securities discloses to the Stock
Exchange such information with respect to the repurchase as the Stock Exchange may require.
(iv) Status of repurchased Shares
All repurchased securities (whether effected on the Stock Exchange or otherwise) will be
automatically delisted and the certificates for those securities must be cancelled and destroyed.
Under the laws of the Cayman Islands, unless, prior to the repurchase, the Directors resolve to hold
the Shares repurchased by our Company as treasury shares, Shares repurchased by our Company
shall be treated as cancelled and the amount of our Company’s issued share capital shall be
diminished by the nominal value of these Shares. However, the repurchase of Shares will not be
taken as reducing the amount of the authorized share capital under Cayman Islands laws.
(v) Suspension of repurchase
A listed company may not make any repurchase of securities after inside information has come
to the knowledge of our Company until such time as the inside information has been made publicly
available. In particular, during the period of one month immediately preceding the earlier of: (i) the
date of the board meeting (as such date is first notified to the Stock Exchange in accordance with
the Listing Rules) for the approval of a listed company’s results for any year, half-year, quarterly or
any other interim period (whether or not required under the Listing Rules); and (ii) the deadline for
publication of an announcement of a listed company’s results for any year or half-year under the
Listing Rules, or quarterly or any other interim period (whether or not required under the Listing
Rules), the listed company may not repurchase its shares on the Stock Exchange other than in
exceptional circumstances. In addition, the Stock Exchange may prohibit a repurchase of securities
on the Stock Exchange if a listed company has breached the Listing Rules.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
—I V - 4—


--- page 561 ---
(vi) Reporting requirements
Certain information relating to repurchases of securities on the Stock Exchange or otherwise
must be reported to the Stock Exchange not later than 30 minutes before the earlier of the
commencement of the morning trading session or any pre-opening session on the following business
day. In addition, a listed company’s annual report is required to disclose details regarding
repurchases of securities made during the year, including a monthly analysis of the number of
securities repurchased, the purchase price per share or the highest and lowest price paid for all such
purchase, where relevant, and the aggregate prices paid.
(vii) Connected persons
A listed company is prohibited from knowingly repurchasing securities on the Stock Exchange
from a “connected person”, that is, a director, chief executive or substantial shareholder of the
company or any of its subsidiaries or their associates and a connected person is prohibited from
knowingly selling his securities to the company.
(viii) General
None of our Directors nor, to the best of their knowledge having made all reasonable enquiries,
any of their associates currently intends to sell any Shares to our Company or our subsidiaries.
Our Directors have undertaken to the Stock Exchange that, so far as the same may be
applicable, they will exercise the Repurchase Mandate in accordance with the Listing Rules and the
applicable laws of the Cayman Islands.
If, as a result of a securities repurchase, a Shareholder’s proportionate interest in the voting
rights of our Company is increased, such increase will be treated as an acquisition for the purpose
of the Takeovers Code. Accordingly, a Shareholder or a group of Shareholders acting in concert
could obtain or consolidate control of our Company and become obliged to make a mandatory offer
in accordance with Rule 26 of the Takeovers Code. Save as aforesaid, our Directors are not aware
of any consequences which would arise under the Takeovers Code as a consequence of any
repurchases pursuant to the Repurchase Mandate.
Our Directors will not exercise the Repurchase Mandate if the repurchase would result in the
number of Shares which are in the hands of the public falling below 25% of the total number of
Shares in issue (or such other percentage as may be prescribed as the minimum public shareholding
under the Listing Rules or waived by the Stock Exchange).
No connected person of our Company has notified us that he/she/it has a present intention to
sell Shares to our Company, or has undertaken not to do so if the Repurchase Mandate is exercised.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
—I V - 5—


--- page 562 ---
(b) Reasons for Repurchases
Our Directors believe that it is in the best interest of our Company and Shareholders for our Directors
to have general authority from the Shareholders to enable our Company to repurchase Shares in the
market. Such repurchases may, depending on market conditions and funding arrangements at the time, lead
to an enhancement of the net asset value per Share and/or earnings per Share and will only be made where
our Directors believe that such repurchases will benefit our Company and Shareholders.
B. CORPORATE ORGANIZATION
Please refer to the section headed “History, Reorganization and Corporate Structure” in this
prospectus.
C. FURTHER INFORMATION ABOUT OUR BUSINESS
1. Summary of Material Contracts
The following contracts (not being contracts entered into in the ordinary course of business) have
been entered into by us or any of our subsidiaries within the two years preceding the date of this prospectus
that are or may be material:
(a) Deed of Non-Competition;
(b) the cornerstone investment agreement dated November 2, 2023 entered into among our
Company, Invesco Advisers, Inc. (in its capacity as the discretionary investment adviser to the
IAI Investors (as set forth in schedule 1 of the cornerstone investment agreement) (severally
and not jointly)), Morgan Stanley Asia Limited, Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C., J.P . Morgan
Securities (Far East) Limited, J.P . Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited, and J.P . Morgan
Securities plc, pursuant to which Invesco Advisers, Inc. agreed to subscribe for Shares at the
Offer Price in the aggregate amount of Hong Kong dollar equivalent of US$100,000,000;
(c) the cornerstone investment agreement dated November 2, 2023 entered into among our
Company, General Atlantic Singapore SPV 64 Pte. Ltd., Morgan Stanley Asia Limited,
Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C., J.P . Morgan Securities (Far East) Limited, J.P . Morgan
Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited, and J.P . Morgan Securities plc, pursuant to which General
Atlantic Singapore SPV 64 Pte. Ltd. agreed to subscribe for Shares at the Offer Price in the
aggregate amount of Hong Kong dollar equivalent of US$50,000,000;
(d) the cornerstone investment agreement dated November 2, 2023 entered into among our
Company, Al-Rayyan Holding LLC, Morgan Stanley Asia Limited, Goldman Sachs (Asia)
L.L.C., J.P . Morgan Securities (Far East) Limited, J.P . Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific)
Limited, and J.P . Morgan Securities plc, pursuant to which Al-Rayyan Holding LLC agreed to
subscribe for Shares at the Offer Price in the aggregate amount of Hong Kong dollar equivalent
of US$45,000,000;
(e) the cornerstone investment agreement dated November 2, 2023 entered into among our
Company, UBS Asset Management (Singapore) Ltd. (in its capacity as the investment advisor
for and on behalf of the investors listed in schedule 3 of the cornerstone investment agreement),
Morgan Stanley Asia Limited, Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C., J.P . Morgan Securities (Far East)
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
—I V - 6—


--- page 563 ---
Limited, J.P . Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited, and J.P . Morgan Securities plc,
pursuant to which UBS Asset Management (Singapore) Ltd. agreed to subscribe for Shares at
the Offer Price in the aggregate amount of Hong Kong dollar equivalent of US$40,000,000;
(f) the cornerstone investment agreement dated November 2, 2023 entered into among our
Company, HSG Growth VII Holdco, Ltd., Morgan Stanley Asia Limited, Goldman Sachs (Asia)
L.L.C., J.P . Morgan Securities (Far East) Limited, J.P . Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific)
Limited, and J.P . Morgan Securities plc, pursuant to which HSG Growth VII Holdco, Ltd.
agreed to subscribe for Shares at the Offer Price in the aggregate amount of Hong Kong dollar
equivalent of US$25,000,000;
(g) the cornerstone investment agreement dated November 2, 2023 entered into among our
Company, HCHP Master Fund, Morgan Stanley Asia Limited, Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C.,
J.P . Morgan Securities (Far East) Limited, J.P . Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited, and
J.P . Morgan Securities plc, pursuant to which HCHP Master Fund agreed to subscribe for
Shares at the Offer Price in the aggregate amount of Hong Kong dollar equivalent of
US$5,000,000;
(h) the cornerstone investment agreement dated November 2, 2023 entered into among our
Company, Novo Holdings A/S, Morgan Stanley Asia Limited, Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C.,
J.P . Morgan Securities (Far East) Limited, J.P . Morgan Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited, and
J.P . Morgan Securities plc, pursuant to which Novo Holdings A/S agreed to subscribe for
Shares at the Offer Price in the aggregate amount of Hong Kong dollar equivalent of
US$25,000,000;
(i) the cornerstone investment agreement dated November 2, 2023 entered into among our
Company, Lake Bleu Prime Healthcare Master Fund Limited, Morgan Stanley Asia Limited,
Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C., J.P . Morgan Securities (Far East) Limited, J.P . Morgan
Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited, and J.P . Morgan Securities plc, pursuant to which Lake Bleu
Prime Healthcare Master Fund Limited agreed to subscribe for Shares at the Offer Price in the
aggregate amount of Hong Kong dollar equivalent of US$7,800,000;
(j) the cornerstone investment agreement dated November 2, 2023 entered into among our
Company, Lake Bleu Innovation Healthcare Master Fund Limited, Morgan Stanley Asia
Limited, Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C., J.P . Morgan Securities (Far East) Limited, J.P . Morgan
Securities (Asia Pacific) Limited, and J.P . Morgan Securities plc, pursuant to which Lake Bleu
Innovation Healthcare Master Fund Limited agreed to subscribe for Shares at the Offer Price
in the aggregate amount of Hong Kong dollar equivalent of US$2,200,000; and
(k) the Hong Kong Underwriting Agreement.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
—I V - 7—


--- page 564 ---
2. Intellectual Property Rights of our Group
As of the Latest Practicable Date, our Company has registered, or has applied for the registration of
the following intellectual property rights which were material to our Group’s business.
(a) Trademarks
As of the Latest Practicable Date, we have registered the following trademarks in Hong Kong which,
in the opinion of our Directors, are material to our business:
No.
Application
Number Trademark Class Registered Owner Expiry Date
1. 306240032
 40,42 XDC Wuxi May 9, 2033
2. 306240041
 40,42 XDC Wuxi May 9, 2033
3. 306240069
 40,42 XDC Wuxi May 9, 2033
4. 306240078
 40,42 XDC Wuxi May 9, 2033
5. 306240087
 40,42 XDC Wuxi May 9, 2033
6. 306240050 XDC 40,42 XDC Wuxi May 9, 2033
7. 306240096 WuXi XDC 40,42 XDC Wuxi May 9, 2033
8. 306272262
40,42 XDC Wuxi June 15, 2033
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
—I V - 8—


--- page 565 ---
As of the Latest Practicable Date, we have registered the following trademarks in the PRC which,
in the opinion of our Directors, are material to our business:
No.
Registration
Number Trademark Class Name of Registered Proprietor Expiry Date
1. 47650788 WuXiDAR4 42 XDC Wuxi March 20,
2031
2. 56445096Υᑌ 40 XDC Wuxi December 13,
2031
3. 56441395Υᑌ 42 XDC Wuxi December 13,
2031
(b) Patents
As of the Latest Practicable Date, we have registered the following patents which we considered to
be material to our business:
No.
Registration
Number Description
Type of
Patent Patent Owner Issuance Date Expiry Date
1. US11478553B2 Process for preparing
antibody-drug conjugates
with improved homogeneity
Utility –
NSPCT
XDC Singapore
(1) October 25,
2022
February 14,
2040
2. JP ,7232925,B2 Process for preparing
antibody-drug conjugates
with improved homogeneity
Utility –
NSPCT
XDC Singapore
(2) February 22,
2023
February 14,
2040
3. TWI756633B Process for preparing
antibody-drug conjugates
with improved homogeneity
Utility –
ORG
XDC Shanghai
(3) March 1,
2022
February 13,
2040
4. CN113365969B Ortho-Phthalaldehyde
containing linkers and use
for preparation of antibody-
drug conjugate
Utility –
NSPCT
XDC Shanghai
(4) September 15,
2023
November 21,
2039
Notes:
(1) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent to XDC Singapore
was completed on April 5, 2023
(2) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent to XDC Singapore
was completed on April 25, 2023
(3) The original patent owner was Biologics (Shanghai) and the transfer/assignment of the patent to XDC Shanghai was
completed on May 24, 2023
(4) The original patent owner was Biologics (Shanghai) and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC Shanghai
was completed on June 29, 2023
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
—I V - 9—


--- page 566 ---
As of the Latest Practicable Date, we have applied for the registration of the following patents which
we considered to be material to our business:
No.
Application
Number Description Type of Patent Patent Applicant Application Date
1. CN202080014311.7 Process for preparing antibody-
drug conjugates with
improved homogeneity
Utility – NSPCT XDC Shanghai
(1) February 14,
2020
2. EP20755234.0 Process for preparing antibody-
drug conjugates with
improved homogeneity
Utility – NSPCT XDC Singapore
(2) February 14,
2020
3. KR10-2021-
7028033
Process for preparing antibody-
drug conjugates with
improved homogeneity
Utility – NSPCT XDC Singapore
(3) February 14,
2020
4. US17/410,574 Process for preparing antibody-
drug conjugates with
improved homogeneity
Utility – CON XDC Singapore
(4) February 14,
2020
5. CN202010657958.3 Process for preparing antibody-
drug conjugates and high-
throughput screening method
thereof
Utility ORG XDC Shanghai
(5) July 9, 2020
6. AU2020318112 Polypeptide complex for
conjugation and use thereof
Utility – NSPCT XDC Singapore (6) July 17, 2020
7. CA3147690 Polypeptide complex for
conjugation and use thereof
Utility – NSPCT XDC Singapore (7) July 17, 2020
8. CN202080051466.8 Polypeptide complex for
conjugation and use thereof
Utility – NSPCT XDC Shanghai (8) July 17, 2020
9. EP20843748.3 Polypeptide complex for
conjugation and use thereof
Utility – NSPCT XDC Singapore (9) July 17, 2020
10. JP2022503470 Polypeptide complex for
conjugation and use thereof
Utility – NSPCT XDC Singapore (10) July 17, 2020
11. KR10-2022-
7004563
Polypeptide complex for
conjugation and use thereof
Utility – NSPCT XDC Singapore (11) July 17, 2020
12. 11202200109P Polypeptide complex for
conjugation and use thereof
Utility – NSPCT XDC Singapore (12) July 17, 2020
13. US17/628,008 Polypeptide complex for
conjugation and use thereof
Utility – NSPCT XDC Singapore (13) July 17, 2020
14. TW109124339 Polypeptide complex for
conjugation and use thereof
Utility – ORG XDC Shanghai (14) July 17, 2020
15. PCT/
CN2022/117308 (18)
Process for preparing highly
homogenous antibody-drug
conjugates for engineered
antibodies
Utility – ORG XDC Shanghai/
XDC Singapore
(15)
September 6,
2022
16. CN2022800102578 (18) Engineered anti-trop2 antibody
and antibody-drug conjugate
thereof
Utility – ORG XDC Shanghai/
XDC Singapore
(16)
January 18, 2022
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-10 —


--- page 567 ---
Notes:
(1) The original patent owner was Biologics (Shanghai) and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC Shanghai
was completed on April 25, 2023
(2) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC
Singapore was completed on April 25, 2023
(3) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC
Singapore was completed on April 19, 2023
(4) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC
Singapore was completed on April 5, 2023
(5) The original patent owner was Biologics (Shanghai) and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC Shanghai
was completed on April 27, 2023
(6) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC
Singapore was completed on April 27, 2023
(7) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC
Singapore was completed on May 1, 2023
(8) The original patent owner was Biologics (Shanghai) and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC Shanghai
was completed on May 12, 2023
(9) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC
Singapore was completed on May 17, 2023
(10) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC
Singapore was completed on April 17, 2023
(11) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC
Singapore was completed on March 30, 2023
(12) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC
Singapore was completed on March 31, 2023
(13) The original patent owner was WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC
Singapore was completed on April 5, 2023
(14) The original patent owner was Biologics (Shanghai) and the transfer/assignment of the patent application to XDC Shanghai
was completed on April 17, 2023
(15) The original patent owners were Biologics (Shanghai) and WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the
patent application to XDC Shanghai and XDC Singapore was completed on March 31, 2023
(16) The original patent owners were Biologics (Shanghai) and WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the
patent application to XDC Shanghai and XDC Singapore was completed on April 27, 2023
(17) The original patent owners were Biologics (Shanghai) and WuXi Biologics Ireland Limited and the transfer/assignment of the
patent application to XDC Shanghai and XDC Singapore was completed on April 17, 2023
(18) PCT refers to the Patent Cooperation Treaty, which assists applicants in seeking patent protection internationally for their
inventions and covers all countries/regions which are party to the Patent Cooperation Treaty on the date the PCT application
is filed.
(c) Domain Names
As of the Latest Practicable Date, we owned the following domain names which we consider to be
or may be material to our business:
No. Domain Name
Name of Registered
Proprietor Registration Date Expiry Date
1. wuxixdc.com XDC Wuxi June 13, 2022 June 13, 2024
2. wuxixdc.cn XDC Wuxi May 14, 2021 May 14, 2024
3. wuxixdc.com.cn XDC Wuxi May 14, 2021 May 14, 2024
Save as aforesaid, as of the Latest Practicable Date, there were no other trade or service marks,
patents, intellectual or industrial property rights which were material in relation to our business.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
—I V - 1 1—


--- page 568 ---
D. FURTHER INFORMATION OF OUR DIRECTORS AND SUBSTANTIAL SHAREHOLDERS
1. Directors’ Service Contracts and Appointment Letters
Executive Directors
Each of the executive Directors has entered into a service contract with our Company pursuant to
which they agreed to act as executive Directors for a term of three years with effect from the Listing Date
or their respective appointment dates, renewable by mutual consent. The office of a Director is liable to
be vacated in certain circumstances pursuant to the Articles of Association. The appointment of each of
the executive Directors may be terminated by either party by giving at least three months’ written notice
to the other. The appointments are subject to the provisions of retirement and rotation of Directors under
the Articles of Association.
Non-executive Directors
Each of the non-executive Directors has entered into a service contract with our Company pursuant
to which they agreed to act as non-executive Directors for a term of three years with effect from the Listing
Date or their respective appointment dates, renewable by mutual consent. The office of a Director is liable
to be vacated in certain circumstances pursuant to the Articles of Association. The appointment of the
non-executive Directors may be terminated by either party by giving at least three months’ written notice
to the other. The appointments are subject to the provisions of retirement and rotation of Directors under
the Articles of Association.
Independent non-executive Directors
Each of the independent non-executive Directors has signed a letter of appointment with us for a
term of three years commencing from the Listing Date, renewable by mutual consent. The appointment of
each of the independent non-executive Directors may be terminated by either party giving at least three
months’ written notice to the other. The appointments are subject to the provisions of retirement and
rotation of Directors under the Articles of Association.
Save as aforesaid, none of our Directors has or is proposed to have a service contract with our
Company or any of our subsidiaries other than contracts expiring or determinable by the employer within
one year without the payment of compensation (other than statutory compensation).
2. Directors’ Remuneration
For details of our Directors’ remuneration, see the section headed “Directors and Senior Management
— Emolument of Directors and Senior Management” in this prospectus and Note 37 to the Accountants’
Report as set out in Appendix I to this prospectus.
3. Disclosure of Interests of substantial shareholders
Save as disclosed in the section headed “Substantial Shareholders” in this prospectus, immediately
following the completion of the Global Offering and assuming the Over-allotment Option is not exercised
and without taking into account any Shares which may be issued upon exercise of the share options
granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, our Directors are not aware of any other person (not
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-12 —


--- page 569 ---
being a Director or chief executive of our Company) who will have an interest or short position in our
Shares or the underlying Shares which would fall to be disclosed to us and the Stock Exchange under the
provisions of Divisions 2 and 3 of Part XV of the SFO, or who is, directly or indirectly, interested in 10%
or more of the issued voting shares of our Company.
Save as disclosed in this prospectus, immediately following the completion of the Global Offering,
no persons will, directly or indirectly, be interested in 10% or more of the issued voting shares of any
member of our Group.
4. Disclosure of interests of Directors and Chief Executive of our Company
Immediately following completion of the Global Offering (assuming the Over-allotment Option is
not exercised without taking into account any Shares which may be issued upon exercise of the share
options granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes) and no Reserved Share was allocated to our
Directors under the Preferential Offering, the interests or short positions of our Directors or chief
executives in the Shares, underlying Shares and debentures of our Company or its associated corporations
(within the meaning of Part XV of the SFO) which will be required to be notified to us and the Stock
Exchange pursuant to Divisions 7 and 8 of Part XV of the SFO (including interests or short positions
which they were taken or deemed to have under such provisions of the SFO) or which will be required,
pursuant to section 352 of the SFO, to be recorded in the register referred to therein, or which will be
required to be notified to our Company and the Stock Exchange, under the Model Code for Securities
Transactions by Directors of Listed Issuers as set out in Appendix 10 to the Listing Rules (the “ Model
Code ”), are listed will be as follows:
Name of Director
Name of Group
member/associated
corporation
Capacity/Nature of
interest
Number and class of
Shares/underlying
Shares (1)
Approximate
percentage of
shareholding
interest
Dr. Jincai Li ............ O u r Company Beneficial owner (2) 32,455,840(L) 2.75%
WuXi Biologics Beneficial owner (3) 1,772,653(L) 0.04% (11)
Mr. Jerry Jingwei Zhang .... O u r Company Beneficial owner (4) 3,254,016(L) 0.28%
WuXi Biologics Beneficial owner (5) 54,993(L) 0.00% (11)
Mr. Xiaojie Xi ........... O u r Company Beneficial owner (6) 10,000,000(L) 0.85%
Dr. Zhisheng Chen ........ W u X i Biologics Beneficial owner (7) 111,467,639(L) 2.62% (11)
Founder of a
discretionary
trust
(8)
10,706,254(L) 0.25% (11)
Dr. Weichang Zhou ........ W u X i Biologics Beneficial owner (9) 17,300,439(L) 0.41% (11)
Ms. Ming Shi ........... W u X i Biologics Interest of
spouse (10)
3,000(L) 0.00% (11)
Notes:
(1) The letter “L” denotes the person’s long position in the Shares.
(2) Interests in options granted pursuant to the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme.
(3) Interests in restricted share units granted pursuant to the restricted share award scheme adopted by WuXi Biologics on January
15, 2018 (the “ WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme ”) and/or the share award scheme for global partner program adopted
by WuXi Biologics on June 16, 2021 (the “ WXB Global Partner Program Share Scheme ”).
(4) Interests in options granted pursuant to the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-13 —


--- page 570 ---
(5) Interests in restricted share units granted pursuant to the WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme and/or the WXB Global
Partner Program Share Scheme.
(6) Interests in options granted pursuant to the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme.
(7) Interests in restricted shares granted pursuant to the WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme and/or the WXB Global Partner
Program Share Scheme and the interests in options granted pursuant to the pre-IPO share option scheme adopted by WuXi
Biologics on January 5, 2016, and amended on August 10, 2016 (the “ WXB Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme ”).
(8) Shares were held by Dr. Zhisheng Chen through a trust of which Dr. Zhisheng Chen is the settlor (founder) and his spouse
and child are the beneficiaries.
(9) Interests in restricted shares granted pursuant to the WXB Restricted Share Award Scheme and/or the WXB Global Partner
Program Share Scheme and the interests in options granted pursuant to the WXB Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme.
(10) Ms. Ming Shi is deemed to be interested in the 3,000 shares in WuXi Biologics held by her husband, Mr. Weimin Jiang.
(11) The calculation is based on the total number of 4,252,987,649 shares of WuXi Biologics in issue as of the Latest Practicable
Date.
Save as disclosed herein, none of the Directors or chief executive of our Company has any interests
and short positions in the Shares, underlying Shares and debentures of our Company or any associated
corporation (within the meaning of Part XV of the SFO) which will have to be notified to our Company
and the Stock Exchange pursuant to Divisions 7 and 8 of Part XV of the SFO (including interests and short
positions which he has taken or deemed to have taken under such provisions of the SFO) or which will
be required, pursuant to section 352 of the SFO, to be entered in the register referred to therein, or will
be required, pursuant to the Model Code for Securities Transactions by Directors of Listed Companies to
be notified to our Company and the Stock Exchange, in each case once the Shares are listed on the Stock
Exchange.
5. Disclaimers
Save as disclosed in this prospectus and as at the Latest Practicable Date:
(a) none of our Directors nor any of the parties listed in “Qualifications of Experts” of this
Appendix was interested in, directly or indirectly, in the promotion of, or in any assets which
have been, within two years immediately preceding the date of this prospectus, acquired or
disposed of by or leased to us, or are proposed to be acquired or disposed of by or leased to
any member of our Group;
(b) save in connection with the Underwriting Agreements, none of our Directors nor any of the
parties listed in the section headed “F. Other Information — 7. Qualifications of Experts” of
this Appendix was materially interested in any contract or arrangement subsisting at the date
of this prospectus which is significant in relation to our Company’s business;
(c) save in connection with the Underwriting Agreements, none of the persons listed in the section
headed “F. Other Information — 7. Qualifications of Experts” below has any shareholding in
any member of our Group or the right (whether legally enforceable or not) to subscribe for or
to nominate persons to subscribe for securities in any member of our Group.
E. PRE-IPO SHARE OPTION SCHEMES
Our Company has adopted the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and the 2023 Pre-IPO Share
Option Scheme on November 23, 2021 and March 22, 2023, respectively.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-14 —


--- page 571 ---
1. 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
(a) Purpose
The purpose of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme is to enable our Company to grant options
to eligible participants as incentives or rewards for their contribution to our Group so as to enable our
Group to recruit and retain high-calibre employees and attract human resources that are valuable to our
Group.
(b) No grant of options on or after the Listing Date
Save for the options which have been granted before the Listing Date, no further options will be
granted under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme on or after the Listing Date.
(c) Administration
The 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme is to be administered by our Board whose decision in
relation to the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme or its interpretation or effect (save as otherwise
provided therein) shall be final and binding on all parties. Subject to due compliance with the applicable
laws and regulations, our Board shall have the right to (i) interpret and construe the provisions of the 2021
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme; (ii) determine the persons who will be awarded options under the 2021
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, and the number and exercise price of options awarded thereto; (iii) make
such appropriate and equitable adjustments to the terms of options granted under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share
Option Scheme as it deems necessary; and (iv) make such other decisions or determinations as it shall
deem appropriate in the administration of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme.
(d) Eligible participants
Eligible participants for the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme include any full-time or part-time
employees, executives, officers or Directors of our Group.
(e) Duration
(i) The 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme shall become valid and effective for a period of ten
years commencing from the date of its adoption.
(ii) The life of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme is ten years. Our Board is entitled to, but
shall not be bound, at any time within ten years after the adoption date of the 2021 Pre-IPO
Share Option Scheme offer to grant an option to any eligible participant, as our Board may in
its absolute discretion select, to take up an option pursuant to which such eligible participant
may, during the share option period, subscribe for such number of our Shares as our Board may
determine at the exercise price for the options. The offer of the grant of an option shall specify
the terms on which the option is to be granted, including the number of our Shares that may
be subscribed for, the exercise price, and may include at the discretion of our Board such other
terms and conditions. Save as determined by our Board and provided in the offer to a grantee,
the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme does not specify that the options must be subject to any
performance target and does not prescribe any specific minimum period for which an option
must be held before it can be exercised.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-15 —


--- page 572 ---
(f) Maximum entitlement of each eligible participant
Each grant of options to any Director, chief executive or substantial shareholder of our Company (or
any of their respective associates) shall be subject to the prior approval of the independent non-executive
Directors (excluding any independent non-executive Director who is a proposed recipient of the grant of
options). Where any grant of options to a substantial shareholder or an independent non-executive
Director, or any of their respective associates, would result in our Shares issued and to be issued upon
exercise of all options already granted and to be granted (including options exercised, cancelled and
outstanding) to such person under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and the other schemes in the
12-month period up to and including the date of grant: (a) representing in aggregate over 0.1% (or such
other percentage as may from time to time be provided under the Listing Rules) of our Shares in issue on
the date of grant; and (b) if and when our Shares are listed on the Stock Exchange, having an aggregate
value, based on the official closing price of our Shares as stated in the daily quotation sheets of the Stock
Exchange on the date of grant, in excess of HK$5 million or such other sum as maybe from time to time
provided under the Listing Rules, such further grant shall be subject to prior approval by the Shareholders
at a duly convened general meeting at which the grantee, his associates and all core connected persons of
our Company who has an interest shall abstain from voting in favor of the resolution concerning the grant
of such option, and/or such other requirements prescribed under the Listing Rules from time to time.
(g) Maximum number of Shares
(i) The overall limit on the number of our Shares which may be issued upon exercise of all
outstanding options granted and yet to be exercised under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme and other share option schemes of our Company must not exceed 30% of our Shares
in issue from time to time.
(ii) The maximum number of our Shares which may be issued upon exercise of all options to be
granted under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and other share option schemes of our
Company shall not in aggregate exceed 10% of the total number of our Shares in issue as at
the adoption date of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme (the “ 2021 Scheme Mandate
Limit ”). Options lapsed in accordance with the terms of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme will not be counted for the purpose of calculating the 2021 Scheme Mandate Limit.
(iii) Our Company may seek approval of the Shareholders in general meeting for refreshing the
2021 Scheme Mandate Limit under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme. However, the total
number of our Shares which may be issued upon exercise of all options to be granted under all
of the option schemes of our Company under the 2021 Scheme Mandate Limit as refreshed
shall not exceed 10% of the total number of our Shares in issue as at the date of the aforesaid
approval of the 2021 Scheme Mandate Limit. Options previously granted under the 2021
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and other share option schemes of our Company (including
those outstanding, cancelled, lapsed in accordance with its terms or exercised options), will not
be counted for the purpose of calculating the limit as refreshed. A circular must be sent to the
Shareholders in connection with the meeting at which their approval will be sought.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-16 —


--- page 573 ---
(iv) Our Company may also seek separate approval of the Shareholders in general meeting for
granting options beyond the 2021 Scheme Mandate Limit provided that the options exceeding
the 2021 Scheme Mandate Limit are granted only to eligible participants specifically identified
by our Board before such approval is sought. A circular shall be sent to the Shareholders
containing a generic description of the specified eligible participants who may be granted such
options, the number and terms of the options to be granted and the purpose of granting options
to the specified eligible participants with an explanation as to how the terms of the options
serve such purpose.
(v) The total number of our Shares issued and to be issued upon exercise of the options granted
to each eligible participant (including both exercised, cancelled and outstanding options) in any
12-month period shall not exceed 1% of our Shares in issue (the “ 2021 Individual Limit ”).
Any further grant of options to an eligible participant which would result in our Shares issued
and to be issued upon exercise of all options granted and to be granted to such eligible
participant (including exercised, cancelled and outstanding options) in the 12-month period up
to and including the date of grant of such further grant of options exceeding the 2021 Individual
Limit shall be subject to approval of the Shareholders in advance with such eligible participant
and his close associates (or his associates if such eligible participant is a connected person)
abstaining from voting. A circular must be sent to the Shareholders disclosing the identity of
such eligible participant and the number and terms of the options granted and to be granted.
The number and terms of options to be granted to such eligible participants shall be fixed
before Shareholders’ approval is sought and the date of the Board meeting for proposing such
further grant shall for all purposes be the date of grant for the purpose of calculating the
exercise price of options.
(h) Offer and grant of options
An offer of the grant of an option shall be deemed to have been granted and accepted by the grantee
and to have taken effect when the duplicate of the offer document constituting acceptance of the offer duly
signed by the grantee with the number of our Shares in respect of which the offer is accepted clearly stated
therein, together with a payment in favor of our Company of HK$1.00 by way of consideration for the
grant thereof is received by our Company on or before the relevant acceptance date, which being a date
not later than 30 days after the relevant offer date. Such payment shall in no circumstances be refundable
and shall be deemed as part payment of the exercise price.
(i) Exercise price
The exercise price of options payable by any grantee shall, subject to the adjustment referred to in
paragraph (m) below, be in such amount as determined by our Board at its absolute discretion to be fair
and reasonable on a case by case basis, after taking into account, among other things, the business
performance of our Company, individual performance of the relevant grantee as well as the net asset value
of our Company as shown in its latest available management accounts, provided that in the event that our
Company resolves to seek a separate listing of its shares on the Stock Exchange, the exercise price of any
option granted after such resolution up to the listing date of our Company shall not be lower than the new
issue price (if any); and in particular, any options granted during the period commencing six months before
the lodgement of the listing application and up to the listing date of our Company shall not be lower than
the new issue price.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-17 —


--- page 574 ---
(j) Ranking of Shares
Our Shares to be allotted upon the exercise of an option shall be subject to all the provisions of the
memorandum and articles of association of our Company and shall rank pari passu in all respects with and
shall have the same voting, dividend, transfer and other rights, including those arising on liquidation of
our Company as attached to the fully-paid our Shares in issue on the date of issue and rights in respect
of any dividend or other distributions paid or made on or after the date of issue.
(k) Sufficient share capital
Subject to the terms of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, our Board shall at all times set aside
for the purpose of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, out of the authorized but unissued share capital
of our Company, such number of our Shares as our Board may from time to time determine to be sufficient
to meet subsisting requirements for the exercise of outstanding options. No dividends shall be payable in
relation to our Shares that are the subject of options that have not been exercised. Our Shares to be allotted
upon the exercise of an option option shall not carry voting rights until completion of the registration of
the grantee (or such other person nominated by the grantee) as the holder thereof.
(l) Lapse of options
Save as determined otherwise by our Board at its sole discretion, an option shall lapse automatically
and not be exercisable (to the extent not already exercised) on the earliest of:
(i) the expiry date relevant to that option;
(ii) the expiry of any of the periods referred to in paragraph (q)(i), (ii), (iii), (iv) or (v);
(iii) the date on which the scheme of arrangement of our Company referred to in paragraph (q)(iv)
becomes effective;
(iv) the date of the commencement of the winding-up of our Company;
(v) the date on which the grantee ceases to be an eligible participant by reason of the termination
of his relationship with our Company or any of its subsidiaries on any one or more of the
grounds that he has been guilty of serious misconduct or has been convicted of any criminal
offence involving his integrity or honesty or in relation to an employee of our Company or any
of its subsidiaries (if so determined by our Board) on any other ground on which an employer
would be entitled to terminate his employment at common law or pursuant to any applicable
laws or under the grantee’s service contract with our Company or its relevant subsidiary. A
resolution of our Board, or the relevant subsidiary of our Company, to the effect that the
relationship of a grantee has or has not been terminated on one or more of the grounds specified
in this paragraph shall be conclusive; and
(vi) the date on which our Board shall exercise its right to cancel the option at any time after the
grantee commits a breach of paragraph (p) or the options are cancelled in accordance with
paragraph (n).
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-18 —


--- page 575 ---
(m) Effect of alterations to share capital
In the event of any capitalization issue, rights issue, sub-division or consolidation of shares or
reduction of capital of our Company, such corresponding alterations (if any) shall be made (except on an
issue of securities of our Company as consideration in a transaction which shall not be regarded as a
circumstance requiring alteration or adjustment) in:
(i) the number of our Shares subject to any outstanding option; and/or
(ii) the exercise price of options,
as the auditors or the approved independent financial adviser shall, at the request of our Company or any
grantee, certify in writing either generally or as regards any particular grantee, to be in their opinion fair
and reasonable, provided that any such alterations shall be made on the basis that a grantee shall have the
same proportion of the equity capital of our Company as that to which that grantee was entitled to
subscribe had he exercised all the options held by him immediately before such adjustments and the
aggregate exercise price of options payable by a grantee on the full exercise of any option shall remain
as nearly as possible the same as (but shall not be greater than) it was before such event and that no such
alterations shall be made if the effect of such alterations would be to enable an our Share to be issued at
less than its nominal value.
(n) Cancellation of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
Any cancellation of options granted but not exercised must be approved by the grantees of the
relevant options in writing. For the avoidance of doubt, such approval is not required in the event any
option is cancelled pursuant to paragraph (p). Where our Company cancels options, the grant of new
options to the same grantee may only be made under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme within the
limits thereto.
(o) Termination
Our Board may at any time resolve to terminate the operation of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme and in such event no further options shall be offered but the provisions of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share
Option Scheme shall remain in force to the extent necessary to give effect to the exercise of any option
granted prior to the termination or otherwise as may be required in accordance with the provisions of the
2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and options granted prior to such termination shall continue to be
valid and exercisable in accordance with the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme.
(p) Options are personal
An option shall be personal to the grantee and shall not be transferable or assignable and no grantee
shall in any way sell, transfer, charge, mortgage, encumber or create any interest (legal or beneficial) in
favor of any third party over or in relation to any option held by him or any offer relating to the grant of
an option made to him or attempt to do so (save that the grantee may nominate a nominee in whose name
our Shares issued pursuant to the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme may be registered). Any breach of
the foregoing shall entitle our Company to cancel any outstanding option or any part thereof granted to
such grantee.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-19 —


--- page 576 ---
(q) Exercise of options
Subject as hereinafter provided, an option may be exercised by the grantee at any time or times
during the option period, provided that:
(i) in the event of the grantee ceasing to be an eligible participant for any reason other than on his
death, ill-health, injury, disability or the termination of his relationship with our Company or
any of its subsidiaries on one or more of the grounds specified in paragraph (l)(v), the grantee
may exercise any option up to his entitlement at the date of cessation of being an eligible
participant (to the extent not already exercised)within the period of one month (or such longer
period as our Board may determine) following the date of such cessation (which date shall be,
in relation to a grantee who is an eligible participant by reason of his employment with our
Company or any of its subsidiaries, the last actual working day with our Company or its
subsidiary whether salary is paid in lieu of notice or not);
(ii) in the case of the grantee ceasing to be an eligible participant by reason of death, ill-health,
injury or disability (all evidenced to the satisfaction of our Board)and none of the events which
would be a ground for termination of his relationship with our Company or any of its
subsidiaries under paragraph (l)(v) has occurred, the grantee or the personal representative(s)
of the grantee shall be entitled within a period of 12 months (or such longer period as our Board
may determine) from the date of cessation of being an eligible participant or death to exercise
the option in full (to the extent not already exercised);
(iii) if a general offer (whether by way of take-over offer, share repurchase offer or scheme of
arrangement or otherwise in like manner) is made to all the holders of our Shares (or all such
holders other than the offer or and/or any person controlled by the offeror and/or any person
acting in association or in concert with the offeror), our Company shall use its best endeavors
to procure that such offer is extended to all the grantees (on the same terms mutatis mutandis,
and assuming that they shall become, by the exercise in full of the options granted to them,
shareholders of our Company). If such offer, having been approved in accordance with
applicable laws and regulatory requirements becomes, or is declared unconditional, the grantee
(or his legal personal representative(s)) shall be entitled to exercise his option in full (to the
extent not already exercised) at any time within 14 days after the date on which such general
offer becomes or is declared unconditional;
(iv) if a compromise or arrangement between our Company and its members and/or creditors is
proposed for the purposes of or in connection with a scheme for the reconstruction of our
Company or its amalgamation with any other company or companies, our Company shall give
notice thereof to all the grantees (together with a notice of the existence of the provisions of
this paragraph) on the same day as it despatches to members and/or creditors of our Company
a notice summoning the meeting to consider such a compromise or arrangement, and thereupon
each grantee shall be entitled to exercise all or any of his options in whole or in part at any time
prior to 12:00 noon (Hong Kong time) on the Business Day immediately preceding the date of
the meeting directed to be convened by the relevant court for the purposes of considering such
compromise or arrangement and if there are more than one meeting for such purpose, the date
of the first meeting. With effect from the date of such meeting, the rights of all grantees to
exercise their respective options shall forthwith be suspended. Upon such compromise or
arrangement becoming effective, all options shall, to the extent that they have not been
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-20 —


--- page 577 ---
exercised, lapsed and determined. Our Board shall endeavor to procure that our Shares issued
as a result of the exercise of options in such circumstances shall for the purposes of such
compromise or arrangement form part of the issued share capital of our Company on the
effective date thereof and that such our Shares shall in all respects be subject to such
compromise or arrangement. If for any reason such compromise or arrangement is not approved
by the relevant court (whether upon the terms presented to the relevant court or upon any other
terms as may be approved by such court) the rights of the grantees to exercise their respective
options shall with effect from the date of the making of the order by the relevant court be
restored in full as if such compromise or arrangement had not been proposed by our Company
and no claim shall lie against our Company or any of its officers for any loss or damage
sustained by any grantee as a result of the aforesaid suspension; and
(v) in the event a notice is given by our Company to its members to convene a general meeting for
the purposes of considering, and if thought fit, approving a resolution to voluntarily wind-up
our Company, our Company shall on the same date as or soon after it despatches such notice
to each member of our Company give notice thereof to all grantees and thereupon, each grantee
(or in the case of the death of the grantee, his personal representative(s)) shall be entitled to
exercise all or any of his options at any time not later than three Business Days prior to the
proposed general meeting of our Company by giving notice in writing to our Company,
accompanied by a payment for the full amount of the aggregate exercise price for our Shares
in respect of which the notice is given whereupon our Company shall as soon as possible and,
in any event, no later than the Business Day immediately prior to the date of the proposed
general meeting referred to above, allot the relevant our Shares to the grantee credited as fully
paid.
Subject to the other terms of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, save as determined otherwise
by our Board at its sole discretion, an option (to the extent that it is exercisable pursuant to the above) may
be exercised by a grantee at any time during the option period in four tranches as follows: (i) twenty
percent (20%) of the options shall be vested on the date falling on the second (2nd) anniversary of the offer
date; (ii) twenty percent (20%) of the options shall be vested on the date falling on the third (3rd)
anniversary of the offer date; (iii) twenty percent (20%) of the options shall be vested on the date falling
on the fourth (4th) anniversary of the offer date; and (iv) forty percent (40%) of the options shall be vested
on the date falling on the fifth (5th) anniversary of the offer date. For the avoidance of doubt, any
proportion of any option that has been vested shall be exercisable by the grantee from the relevant vesting
date until the expiry of the share option period.
(r) Alteration of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
The terms and conditions of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and the regulations for the
administration and operation of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme (provided that the same are not
inconsistent with the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and the Listing Rules) may be altered in any
respect by resolution of our Board.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-21 —


--- page 578 ---
2. 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
(a) Purpose
The purpose of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme is to enable our Company to grant options
to eligible participants as incentives or rewards for their contribution to our Group so as to enable our
Group to recruit and retain high-calibre employees and attract human resources that are valuable to our
Group.
(b) No grant of options on or after the Listing Date
Save for the options which have been granted before the Listing Date, no further options will be
granted under the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme on or after the Listing Date.
(c) Administration
The 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme is to be administered by our Board whose decision in
relation to the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme or its interpretation or effect (save as otherwise
provided therein) shall be final and binding on all parties. Subject to due compliance with the applicable
laws and regulations, our Board shall have the right to (i) interpret and construe the provisions of the 2023
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme; (ii) determine the persons who will be awarded options under the 2023
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, and the number and exercise price of options awarded thereto; (iii) make
such appropriate and equitable adjustments to the terms of options granted under the 2023 Pre-IPO Share
Option Scheme as it deems necessary; and (iv) make such other decisions or determinations as it shall
deem appropriate in the administration of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme.
(d) Eligible participants
Eligible participants for the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme include any full-time or part-time
employee, executive, officer, service provider or director (including executive, non-executive or
independent non-executive director) of our Company or any member of our Group or any associated
company, to be determined at the sole discretion of the Board.
(e) Duration
(i) The 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme shall become valid and effective for a period of ten
years commencing from the date of its adoption.
(ii) The life of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme is ten years. Our Board is entitled to, but
shall not be bound, at any time within ten years after the adoption date of the 2023 Pre-IPO
Share Option Scheme offer to grant an option to any eligible participant, as our Board may in
its absolute discretion select, to take up an option pursuant to which such eligible participant
may, during the share option period, subscribe for such number of our Shares as our Board may
determine at the exercise price for the options. The offer of the grant of an option shall specify
the terms on which the option is to be granted, including the number of our Shares that may
be subscribed for, the exercise price, and may include at the discretion of our Board such other
terms and conditions. Save as determined by our Board and provided in the offer to a grantee,
the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme does not specify that the options must be subject to any
performance target and does not prescribe any specific minimum period for which an option
must be held before it can be exercised.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-22 —


--- page 579 ---
(f) Options to connected persons
If the Board determines to offer the grant any option to any connected persons of our Group, such
grant shall be made in due compliance with the relevant requirements under the Listing Rules.
(g) Maximum number of Shares
(i) The overall limit on the number of our Shares which may be issued upon exercise of all
outstanding options granted and yet to be exercised under the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme and other share option schemes of our Company must not exceed 30% of our Shares
in issue from time to time.
(ii) The maximum number of our Shares which may be issued upon exercise of all options to be
granted under the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and other share option schemes of our
Company shall not in aggregate exceed 4% of the total number of our Shares in issue as at the
adoption date of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme (the “ 2023 Scheme Mandate Limit ”).
Options lapsed in accordance with the terms of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme will not
be counted for the purpose of calculating the 2023 Scheme Mandate Limit.
(iii) Our Company may seek approval of the Shareholders in general meeting for refreshing the
2023 Scheme Mandate Limit under the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme. However, the total
number of our Shares which may be issued upon exercise of all options to be granted under all
of the option schemes of our Company under the 2023 Scheme Mandate Limit as refreshed
shall not exceed 4% of the total number of our Shares in issue as at the date of the aforesaid
approval of the 2023 Scheme Mandate Limit. Options previously granted under the 2023
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and other share option schemes of our Company (including
those outstanding, cancelled, lapsed in accordance with its terms or exercised options), will not
be counted for the purpose of calculating the limit as refreshed. A circular must be sent to the
Shareholders in connection with the meeting at which their approval will be sought.
(iv) Our Company may also seek separate approval of the Shareholders in general meeting for
granting options beyond the 2023 Scheme Mandate Limit provided that the options exceeding
the 2023 Scheme Mandate Limit are granted only to eligible participants specifically identified
by our Board before such approval is sought. A circular shall be sent to the Shareholders
containing a generic description of the specified eligible participants who may be granted such
options, the number and terms of the options to be granted and the purpose of granting options
to the specified eligible participants with an explanation as to how the terms of the options
serve such purpose.
(h) Offer and grant of options
An offer of the grant of an option shall be deemed to have been granted and accepted by the grantee
and to have taken effect when the duplicate of the offer document constituting acceptance of the offer duly
signed by the grantee with the number of our Shares in respect of which the offer is accepted clearly stated
therein, together with a payment in favor of our Company of HK$1.00 by way of consideration for the
grant thereof is received by our Company on or before the relevant acceptance date, which being a date
not later than 30 days after the relevant offer date. Such payment shall in no circumstances be refundable
and shall be deemed as part payment of the exercise price.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-23 —


--- page 580 ---
(i) Exercise price
The exercise price of options payable by any grantee shall, subject to the adjustment referred to in
paragraph (m) below, be in such amount as determined by our Board at its absolute discretion to be fair
and reasonable on a case by case basis, after taking into account, among other things, the business
performance of our Company, individual performance of the relevant grantee as well as the net asset value
of our Company as shown in its latest available management accounts.
(j) Ranking of Shares
Our Shares to be allotted upon the exercise of an option shall be subject to all the provisions of the
memorandum and articles of association of our Company and shall rank pari passu in all respects with and
shall have the same voting, dividend, transfer and other rights, including those arising on liquidation of
our Company as attached to the fully-paid our Shares in issue on the date of issue and rights in respect
of any dividend or other distributions paid or made on or after the date of issue.
(k) Sufficient share capital
Subject to the terms of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, our Board shall at all times set aside
for the purpose of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, out of the authorized but unissued share capital
of our Company, such number of our Shares as our Board may from time to time determine to be sufficient
to meet subsisting requirements for the exercise of outstanding options.
(l) Lapse of options
Save as determined otherwise by our Board at its sole discretion, an option shall lapse automatically
and not be exercisable (to the extent not already exercised) on the earliest of:
(i) the expiry date relevant to that option;
(ii) the expiry of any of the periods referred to in paragraph (q)(i), (ii), (iii), (iv) or (v);
(iii) the date on which the scheme of arrangement of our Company referred to in paragraph (q)(iv)
becomes effective;
(iv) the date of the commencement of the winding-up of our Company;
(v) the date on which the grantee ceases to be an eligible participant by reason of the termination
of his relationship with our Company or any of its subsidiaries on any one or more of the
grounds that he has been guilty of serious misconduct or has been convicted of any criminal
offence involving his integrity or honesty or in relation to an employee of our Company or any
of its subsidiaries (if so determined by our Board) on any other ground on which an employer
would be entitled to terminate his employment at common law or pursuant to any applicable
laws or under the grantee’s service contract with our Company or its relevant subsidiary. A
resolution of our Board, or the relevant subsidiary of our Company, to the effect that the
relationship of a grantee has or has not been terminated on one or more of the grounds specified
in this paragraph shall be conclusive; and
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-24 —


--- page 581 ---
(vi) the date on which our Board shall exercise its right to cancel the option at any time after the
grantee commits a breach of paragraph (p) or the options are cancelled in accordance with
paragraph (n).
(m) Effect of alterations to share capital
In the event of any capitalization issue, rights issue, sub-division or consolidation of shares or
reduction of capital of our Company, such corresponding alterations (if any) shall be made (except on an
issue of securities of our Company as consideration in a transaction which shall not be regarded as a
circumstance requiring alteration or adjustment) in:
(i) the number of our Shares subject to any outstanding option; and/or
(ii) the exercise price of options,
as the Board may as its sole discretion consider to be appropriate, fair and reasonable, provided that any
such alterations shall be made on the basis that a grantee shall have the same proportion of the equity
capital of our Company as that to which that grantee was entitled to subscribe had he exercised all the
options held by him immediately before such adjustments and the aggregate exercise price of options
payable by a grantee on the full exercise of any option shall remain as nearly as possible the same as (but
shall not be greater than) it was before such event and that no such alterations shall be made if the effect
of such alterations would be to enable an our Share to be issued at less than its nominal value.
(n) Cancellation of options
Any cancellation of options granted but not exercised must be approved by the grantees of the
relevant options in writing. For the avoidance of doubt, such approval is not required in the event any
option is cancelled pursuant to paragraph (p).
(o) Termination
Our Board may at any time resolve to terminate the operation of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme and in such event no further options shall be offered but the provisions of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share
Option Scheme shall remain in force to the extent necessary to give effect to the exercise of any option
granted prior to the termination or otherwise as may be required in accordance with the provisions of the
2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and options granted prior to such termination shall continue to be
valid and exercisable in accordance with the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme. Notwithstanding the
aforesaid, the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme shall be terminated upon listing of our Company on the
Stock Exchange.
(p) Options are personal
An option shall be personal to the grantee and, save as determined by the Board in its sole discretion,
shall not be transferable or assignable(other than transfers to a vehicle (such as a trust or a private
company) for the benefit of the Grantee and any family members of such Grantee (e.g. for estate planning
or tax planning purposes)), and no grantee shall in any way sell, transfer, charge, mortgage, encumber or
create any interest (legal or beneficial) in favor of any third party over or in relation to any option held
by him or any offer relating to the grant of an option made to him or attempt to do so (save that the grantee
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-25 —


--- page 582 ---
may nominate a nominee in whose name our Shares issued pursuant to the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme may be registered). Any breach of the foregoing shall entitle our Company to cancel any
outstanding share option or any part thereof granted to such grantee.
(q) Exercise of options
Subject as hereinafter provided, an option may be exercised by the grantee at any time or times
during the share option period, provided that:
(i) in the event of the grantee ceasing to be an eligible participant for any reason other than on his
death, ill-health, injury, disability or the termination of his relationship with our Company or
any of its subsidiaries on one or more of the grounds specified in paragraph (l)(v), the grantee
may exercise any option up to his entitlement at the date of cessation of being an eligible
participant (to the extent not already exercised)within the period of one month (or such longer
period as our Board may determine) following the date of such cessation (which date shall be,
in relation to a grantee who is an eligible participant by reason of his employment with our
Company or any of its subsidiaries, the last actual working day with our Company or its
subsidiary whether salary is paid in lieu of notice or not);
(ii) in the case of the grantee ceasing to be an eligible participant by reason of death, ill-health,
injury or disability (all evidenced to the satisfaction of our Board)and none of the events which
would be a ground for termination of his relationship with our Company or any of its
subsidiaries under paragraph (l)(v) has occurred, the grantee or the personal representative(s)
of the grantee shall be entitled within a period of 12 months (or such longer period as our Board
may determine) from the date of cessation of being an eligible participant or death to exercise
the option in full (to the extent not already exercised);
(iii) if a general offer (whether by way of take-over offer, share repurchase offer or scheme of
arrangement or otherwise in like manner) is made to all the holders of our Shares (or all such
holders other than the offer or and/or any person controlled by the offeror and/or any person
acting in association or in concert with the offeror), our Company shall use its best endeavors
to procure that such offer is extended to all the grantees (on the same terms mutatis mutandis,
and assuming that they shall become, by the exercise in full of the options granted to them,
shareholders of our Company). If such offer, having been approved in accordance with
applicable laws and regulatory requirements becomes, or is declared unconditional, the grantee
(or his legal personal representative(s)) shall be entitled to exercise his option in full (to the
extent not already exercised) at any time within 14 days after the date on which such general
offer becomes or is declared unconditional;
(iv) if a compromise or arrangement between our Company and its members and/or creditors is
proposed for the purposes of or in connection with a scheme for the reconstruction of our
Company or its amalgamation with any other company or companies, our Company shall give
notice thereof to all the grantees (together with a notice of the existence of the provisions of
this paragraph) on the same day as it despatches to members and/or creditors of our Company
a notice summoning the meeting to consider such a compromise or arrangement, and thereupon
each grantee shall be entitled to exercise all or any of his options in whole or in part at any time
prior to 12:00 noon (Hong Kong time) on the Business Day immediately preceding the date of
the meeting directed to be convened by the relevant court for the purposes of considering such
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-26 —


--- page 583 ---
compromise or arrangement and if there are more than one meeting for such purpose, the date
of the first meeting. With effect from the date of such meeting, the rights of all grantees to
exercise their respective options shall forthwith be suspended. Upon such compromise or
arrangement becoming effective, all options shall, to the extent that they have not been
exercised, lapsed and determined. Our Board shall endeavor to procure that our Shares issued
as a result of the exercise of options in such circumstances shall for the purposes of such
compromise or arrangement form part of the issued share capital of our Company on the
effective date thereof and that such our Shares shall in all respects be subject to such
compromise or arrangement. If for any reason such compromise or arrangement is not approved
by the relevant court (whether upon the terms presented to the relevant court or upon any other
terms as may be approved by such court) the rights of the grantees to exercise their respective
options shall with effect from the date of the making of the order by the relevant court be
restored in full as if such compromise or arrangement had not been proposed by our Company
and no claim shall lie against our Company or any of its officers for any loss or damage
sustained by any grantee as a result of the aforesaid suspension; and
(v) in the event a notice is given by our Company to its members to convene a general meeting for
the purposes of considering, and if thought fit, approving a resolution to voluntarily wind-up
our Company, our Company shall on the same date as or soon after it despatches such notice
to each member of our Company give notice thereof to all grantees and thereupon, each grantee
(or in the case of the death of the grantee, his personal representative(s)) shall be entitled to
exercise all or any of his options at any time not later than three Business Days prior to the
proposed general meeting of our Company by giving notice in writing to our Company,
accompanied by a payment for the full amount of the aggregate exercise price for our Shares
in respect of which the notice is given whereupon our Company shall as soon as possible and,
in any event, no later than the Business Day immediately prior to the date of the proposed
general meeting referred to above, allot the relevant our Shares to the grantee credited as fully
paid.
Subject to the other terms of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, save as determined otherwise
by our Board at its sole discretion, an option (to the extent that it is exercisable pursuant to the above) may
be exercised by a grantee at any time during the option period in four tranches as follows: (i) twenty
percent (20%) of the options shall be vested on the date falling on the second (2nd) anniversary of the offer
date; (ii) twenty percent (20%) of the options shall be vested on the date falling on the third (3rd)
anniversary of the offer date; (iii) twenty percent (20%) of the options shall be vested on the date falling
on the fourth (4th) anniversary of the offer date; and (iv) forty percent (40%) of the options shall be vested
on the date falling on the fifth (5th) anniversary of the offer date. For the avoidance of doubt, any
proportion of any option that has been vested shall be exercisable by the grantee from the relevant vesting
date until the expiry of the option period.
(r) Alteration of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
The terms and conditions of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and the regulations for the
administration and operation of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme (provided that the same are not
inconsistent with the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme) may be altered in any respect by resolution of
our Board except that (a) any material alteration to the terms and conditions of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share
Option Scheme (including the principal terms of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme set out above)
or any change to the terms of options granted(except any alterations which take effect automatically under
the terms of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme); or (b) any change to the authority of our Board in
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-27 —


--- page 584 ---
relation to any alteration to the terms of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, may only be made with
the approval of the Shareholders of our Company provided that no alteration shall operate to affect
adversely the terms of issue of any option granted or agreed to be granted prior to such alteration or to
reduce the proportion of the equity capital to which any person was entitled pursuant to such option prior
to such alteration except with (i) the consent in writing of the grantees holding in aggregate options which
if exercised in full on the date immediately preceding that on which such consent is obtained would entitle
them to the issue of three-fourths in nominal value of all our Shares which would fall to be issued upon
the exercise of all options outstanding on that date; or (ii) the sanction of a special resolution.
3. Outstanding Options
As at the date of this Prospectus, the outstanding options to subscribe for an aggregate of
117,262,546 options representing approximately 9.95% of the enlarged issued share capital of our
Company immediately upon completion of the Global Offering (assuming that all options granted under
the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes are exercised, but without taking into account any Shares which may
be allotted and issued upon the exercise of the Over-allotment Option) have been conditionally granted by
our Company under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes.
As of the date of this Prospectus, the maximum aggregate number of options which may be issued
under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme shall not exceed 100,000,000 Shares and the remaining
options that can be issued is 22,737,454 which will not be granted on or after the Listing Date and the
outstanding options to subscribe for an aggregate of 77,262,546 Options are held by 184 grantees under
the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme. All the options under the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme
were granted on April 1, 2022, June 10, 2022, August 18, 2022 and January 6, 2023, respectively, and the
exercise price of the options granted were RMB1.658, RMB1.658, RMB1.850 and RMB1.868 per Share,
respectively.
As of the date of this Prospectus, the maximum aggregate number of options which may be issued
under the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme shall not exceed 40,000,000 Shares and there is no
remaining options that can be issued. As of the date of this Prospectus, the outstanding options to subscribe
for an aggregate of 40,000,000 options are held by 247 grantees under the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option
Scheme. All the options under the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme were granted on July 6, 2023,
August 24, 2023 and October 30, 2023, respectively, and the exercise price of the options granted were
RMB4.500, RMB6.900 and RMB6.900 per Share, respectively.
Assuming 117,262,546 options will be issued upon the full vesting and exercise of all outstanding
options to be granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes, the shareholding of our Shareholders
immediately following completion of the Global Offering (assuming the Over-allotment Option is not
exercised) will be diluted by approximately 9.95%. The dilution effect on our earnings per Share would
be approximately 9.05%.
Save for the options which have been granted before the Listing Date, no further options will be
granted under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes on or after the Listing Date.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-28 —


--- page 585 ---
4. Summary of Grantees
Below is a list of grantees who are Directors, members of senior management and connected persons
of our Company or other grantee who has more than 2,500,000 options under the Pre-IPO Share Option
Schemes:
Name Address
Position in
our Group Date of grant Vesting period Exercise price
Number of
Shares under
options granted
Approximate
percentage of the
issued Shares
immediately after
completion of the
Global Offering
(per Share
in RMB)
Directors
Dr. Jincai
L i ...
Room 601 No.
49, Lane 18
Qing Tong
Road Pudong
New District
Shanghai
China
Executive
Director and
chief
executive
officer
June 10, 2022
and August
24, 2023
(i) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
second anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(ii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
third anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(iii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fourth anniversary
of the date of
grant; and
(iv) 40% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fifth anniversary of
the date of grant.
1.658 and
6.900
32,455,840 2.75%
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-29 —


--- page 586 ---
Name Address
Position in
our Group Date of grant Vesting period Exercise price
Number of
Shares under
options granted
Approximate
percentage of the
issued Shares
immediately after
completion of the
Global Offering
(per Share
in RMB)
Mr. Jerry
Jingwei
Zhang .
Room 601, 6/F
No. 19,
Lane 1399
Huifeng
West Road
Nanqiao
Town,
Fengxian
District
Shanghai
China
Executive
Director and
chief
operating
officer
July 6, 2023 (i) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
second anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(ii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
third anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(iii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fourth anniversary
of the date of
grant; and
(iv) 40% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fifth anniversary of
the date of grant.
4.500 3,254,016 0.28%
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-30 —


--- page 587 ---
Name Address
Position in
our Group Date of grant Vesting period Exercise price
Number of
Shares under
options granted
Approximate
percentage of the
issued Shares
immediately after
completion of the
Global Offering
(per Share
in RMB)
Mr. Xiaojie
X i ...
Flat A, 36/F,
Block 3
Island
Harborview11
Hoi Fai
Road, Tai
Kok Tsui,
Kowloon,
Hong Kong
Executive
Director and
chief
financial
officer
July 6, 2023 (i) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
second anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(ii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
third anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(iii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fourth anniversary
of the date of
grant; and
(iv) 40% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fifth anniversary of
the date of grant.
4.500 10,000,000 0.85%
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-31 —


--- page 588 ---
Name Address
Position in
our Group Date of grant Vesting period Exercise price
Number of
Shares under
options granted
Approximate
percentage of the
issued Shares
immediately after
completion of the
Global Offering
(per Share
in RMB)
Senior Management
Dr. Marie
Meiying
Zhu . . .
No.11 Xinhui
Ring Road,
Xinwu
District,
Wuxi City
Chief
technology
officer
July 6, 2023 (i) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
second anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(ii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
third anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(iii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fourth anniversary
of the date of
grant; and
(iv) 40% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fifth anniversary of
the date of grant.
4.500 4,000,000 0.34%
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-32 —


--- page 589 ---
Name Address
Position in
our Group Date of grant Vesting period Exercise price
Number of
Shares under
options granted
Approximate
percentage of the
issued Shares
immediately after
completion of the
Global Offering
(per Share
in RMB)
Dr. Jianjun
Luo . . .
Room 1101,
No. 2,
Lane 300,
Hongfeng
Road,
Pudong New
District,
Shanghai,
China
Vice president April 1, 2022
and August
24, 2023
(i) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
second anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(ii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
third anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(iii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fourth anniversary
of the date of
grant; and
(iv) 40% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fifth anniversary of
the date of grant.
1.658 and
6.900
2,750,325 0.23%
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-33 —


--- page 590 ---
Name Address
Position in
our Group Date of grant Vesting period Exercise price
Number of
Shares under
options granted
Approximate
percentage of the
issued Shares
immediately after
completion of the
Global Offering
(per Share
in RMB)
Other grantee
Mr. Xudong
W e i ...
Rhode Island 6
Douglas Fir
Way, United
States
Head of
payload-
linkers
development
and
manufacturing
department
July 6, 2023 (i) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
second anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(ii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
third anniversary
of the date of
grant;
(iii) 20% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fourth anniversary
of the date of
grant; and
(iv) 40% of which will
be vested on the
date falling on the
fifth anniversary of
the date of grant.
4.500 2,800,000 0.24%
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-34 —


--- page 591 ---
Below is a list of remaining grantees who have been granted options to subscribe under the Pre-IPO
Share Option Schemes:
Category by
number of
underlying
Shares
Number of
grantees Date of grant Vesting period Exercise price
Number of Shares
under options
granted
Approximate
percentage of the
issued Shares
immediately after
completion of the
Global Offering
(per Share
in RMB)
2,000,001 –
2,500,000 . .
1 From April 1,
2022 to
August 24,
2023
(i) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the second anniversary
of the date of grant;
(ii) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the third anniversary of
the date of grant;
(iii) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the fourth anniversary
of the date of grant; and
(iv) 40% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the fifth anniversary of
the date of grant;
1.658 to 6.900 2,147,655 0.18%
1,000,001 –
2,000,000 . .
8 From April 1,
2022 to
August 24,
2023
(i) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the second anniversary
of the date of grant;
(ii) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the third anniversary of
the date of grant;
(iii) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the fourth anniversary
of the date of grant; and
(iv) 40% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the fifth anniversary of
the date of grant;
1.658 to 6.900 10,245,729 0.87%
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-35 —


--- page 592 ---
Category by
number of
underlying
Shares
Number of
grantees Date of grant Vesting period Exercise price
Number of Shares
under options
granted
Approximate
percentage of the
issued Shares
immediately after
completion of the
Global Offering
(per Share
in RMB)
500,001 –
1,000,000 . .
19 From April 1,
2022 to
October 30,
2023
(i) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the second anniversary
of the date of grant;
(ii) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the third anniversary of
the date of grant;
(iii) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the fourth anniversary
of the date of grant; and
(iv) 40% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the fifth anniversary of
the date of grant.
1.658 to 6.900 13,058,670 1.11%
1-500,000 .... 2 4 5 From April 1,
2022 to
October 30,
2023
(i) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the second anniversary
of the date of grant;
(ii) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the third anniversary of
the date of grant;
(iii) 20% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the fourth anniversary
of the date of grant; and
(iv) 40% of which will be
vested on the date falling
on the fifth anniversary of
the date of grant
1.658 to 6.900 36,550,311 3.10%
Total ...... 273 62,002,365
Save and except as set out above, no other options have been granted or agreed to be granted by our
Company under the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes. Our Company will not grant any further options under
the Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes on or after the Listing Date.
The Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes are not subject to the provisions of Chapter 17 of the Listing
Rules as it will not involve any grant of options by us after the Listing. Application has been made to the
Listing Committee for the listing of and permission to deal in the Shares to be issued pursuant to the
Pre-IPO Share Option Schemes.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-36 —


--- page 593 ---
F. OTHER INFORMATION
1. Estate Duty
Our Directors have been advised that no material liability for estate duty is likely to fall on our
Company or any of our subsidiaries.
2. Litigation
During the Track Record Period and as of the Latest Practicable Date, we were not engaged in any
litigation, arbitration or claim of material importance and no litigation, arbitration or claim of material
importance was known to our Directors to be pending or threatened by or against us, that would have a
material adverse effect on our results of operations or financial conditions.
3. Joint Sponsors
The Joint Sponsors have made an application on our behalf to the Listing Committee of the Stock
Exchange for the listing of, and permission to deal in, the Shares in issue, the Shares to be issued pursuant
to the Global Offering (including any Shares which may fall to be issued pursuant to the exercise of the
Over-allotment Option and any Shares to be allotted and issued pursuant to the Pre-IPO Share Option
Schemes).
The Joint Sponsors satisfy the independence criteria applicable to sponsors set out in Rule 3A.07 of
the Listing Rules.
The fees payable to each of the Joint Sponsors in respect of their services as sponsor for the Listing
are approximately US$500,000 and are payable by us.
4. Preliminary Expenses
We have not incurred any material preliminary expenses in relation to the incorporation of our
Company.
5. Promoter
We do not have any promoter. Within the two years immediately preceding the date of this
prospectus, no cash, securities or other benefits have been paid, allotted or given nor are any proposed
cash, securities or other benefits to be paid, allotted or given to any promoters.
6. Agency fees or commission received
Save as disclosed in this prospectus, no commissions, discounts, brokerages or other special terms
were granted within the two years preceding the date of this prospectus in connection with the issue or sale
of any capital of any member of our Group.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-37 —


--- page 594 ---
7. Qualifications of Experts
The following are the qualifications of the experts who have given opinion or advice contained in
this prospectus:
Name Qualification
Morgan Stanley Asia Limited ........ Licensed to conduct type 1 (dealing in securities), type 4
(advising on securities), type 5 (advising on futures
contracts), type 6 (advising on corporate finance) and type
9 (asset management) regulated activities under the SFO
Goldman Sachs (Asia) L.L.C. ........ A licensed corporation to conduct type 1 (dealing in
securities), type 4 (advising on securities), type 5 (advising
on futures contracts), type 6 (advising on corporate
finance) and type 9 (asset management) regulated activities
under the SFO
J.P . Morgan Securities (Far East)
Limited ........................
Licensed to conduct type 1 (dealing in securities), type 4
(advising on securities) and type 6 (advising on corporate
finance) regulated activities under the SFO
Fangda Partners .................. Qualified PRC Lawyers
Maples and Calder (Hong Kong) LLP . . Legal advisor as to Cayman Islands law
Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu ........... Certified Public Accountants
(Public Interest Entity Auditor registered in accordance
with the Financial Reporting Council Ordinance)
Frost & Sullivan (Beijing) Inc.,
Shanghai Branch Co. ..............
Industry consultant
As of the Latest Practicable Date, none of the experts named above has any shareholding interest in
our Company or any of our subsidiaries or the right (whether legally enforceable or not) to subscribe for
or to nominate persons to subscribe for securities in any member of our Group.
8. Consents of Experts
Each of the persons named in “Qualifications of Experts” has given and has not withdrawn its written
consent to the issue of this prospectus with the inclusion of its report and/or letter and/or legal opinion (as
the case may be) and references to its name included in the form and context in which it respectively
appears.
9. Binding Effect
This prospectus shall have the effect, if an application is made in pursuance of this prospectus, of
rendering all persons concerned bound by all of the provisions (other than the penal provisions) of sections
44A and 44B of the Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance insofar as
applicable.
10. Bilingual Prospectus
The English and Chinese language versions of this prospectus are being published separately, in
reliance upon the exemption provided under section 4 of the Companies (Exemption of Companies and
Prospectuses from Compliance with Provisions) Notice (Chapter 32L of the Laws of Hong Kong).
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-38 —


--- page 595 ---
11. No Material Adverse Change
Our Directors confirm that, up to the date of this prospectus, there has been no material adverse
change in the financial or trading position or prospect of our Group since June 30, 2023 (being the date
to which the latest audited consolidated financial statements of our Group were prepared).
G. MISCELLANEOUS
(a) Save as disclosed in this prospectus, within the two years immediately preceding the date of
this prospectus:
(i) no share or loan capital of our Company or any of its subsidiaries has been issued or
agreed to be issued fully or partly paid either for cash or for a consideration other than
cash;
(ii) no share or loan capital of our Company or any of its subsidiaries is under option or is
agreed conditionally or unconditionally to be put under option;
(iii) neither our Company nor any of its subsidiaries have issued or agreed to issue any
founder shares, management shares or deferred shares;
(iv) no commissions, discounts, brokerage or other special terms have been granted in
connection with the issue or sale of any shares or loan capital of any member of our
Group; and
(v) no commission has been paid or payable (except commissions to the Underwriters) for
subscription, agreeing to subscribe, procuring subscription or agreeing to procure
subscription of any Shares in our Company;
(b) our Company has no outstanding convertible debt securities or debentures;
(c) no company within our Group is presently listed on any stock exchange or traded on any
trading system;
(d) there is no arrangement under which future dividends are waived or agreed to be waived;
(e) the principal register of members of our Company will be maintained in the Cayman Islands
by Maples Fund Services (Cayman) Limited and a branch register of members of our Company
will be maintained in Hong Kong by Computershare Hong Kong Investor Services Limited.
Unless our Directors otherwise agree, all transfer and other documents of title of Shares must
be lodged for registration with and registered by our Company’s share registrar in Hong Kong
and may not be lodged in the Cayman Islands. All necessary arrangements have been made to
enable the Shares to be admitted into CCASS for clearing and settlement;
(f) save as otherwise disclosed in the prospectus, there are no contracts or arrangements subsisting
at the date of this prospectus in which a Director is materially interested or which is significant
in relation to the business of our Group.
APPENDIX IV STATUTORY AND GENERAL INFORMATION
— IV-39 —


--- page 596 ---
1. DOCUMENTS DELIVERED TO THE REGISTRAR OF COMPANIES IN HONG KONG
The documents attached to the copy of this prospectus and delivered to the Registrar of Companies
in Hong Kong for registration were:
(a) a copy of the BLUE and GREEN Application Forms;
(b) a copy of each of the material contracts referred to the section headed “Statutory and General
Information — C. Further Information About Our Business — 1. Summary of Material
Contracts” in Appendix IV to this prospectus; and
(c) the written consents referred to in the section headed “Statutory and General Information — F.
Other Information — 8. Consents of Experts” in Appendix IV to this prospectus.
2. DOCUMENTS ON DISPLAY
Copies of the following documents will be published on the Stock Exchange’s website at
www.hkexnews.hk and our Company’s website at www.wuxixdc.com during a period of 14 days from the
date of this prospectus:
(a) the Memorandum and Articles of Association of our Company;
(b) the Accountant’s Report from Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu covering the three financial years
ended December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023, the texts
of which is set out in Appendix I to this prospectus, including the audited financial information
of Payload-Linker Business for the period from January 1, 2020 to the date of acquisition of
Payload & Linker Business;
(c) the report from Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu in respect of the unaudited pro forma financial
information of our Group, the texts of which is set out in Appendix II to this prospectus;
(d) the audited consolidated financial statements of our Group for the three financial years ended
December 31, 2020, 2021 and 2022 and the six months ended June 30, 2023;
(e) the PRC legal opinions issued by Fangda Partners, our PRC Legal Advisor, in respect of certain
general corporate matters and property interests in the PRC of our Company;
(f) the industry report prepared by Frost & Sullivan referred to in the section headed “Industry
Overview” in this prospectus;
(g) the letter of advice prepared by Maples and Calder (Hong Kong) LLP , our legal advisors on
Cayman Islands law, summarizing the constitution of our Company and certain aspects of the
Cayman Islands company law referred to in Appendix III to this prospectus;
(h) the Cayman Companies Act;
APPENDIX V DOCUMENTS DELIVERED TO THE REGISTRAR OF
COMPANIES IN HONG KONG AND ON DISPLAY
—V - 1—


--- page 597 ---
(i) the written consents referred to in the section headed “Statutory and General Information — F.
Other Information — 8. Consents of Experts” in Appendix IV to this prospectus;
(j) the material contracts referred to the section headed “Statutory and General Information — C.
Further Information About Our Business — 1. Summary of Material Contracts” in Appendix IV
to this prospectus;
(k) the service contracts or letters of appointment referred to in the section headed “Statutory and
General Information — D. Further Information of Our Directors and Substantial Shareholders
— 1. Directors’ Service Contracts and Appointment Letters” in Appendix IV to this prospectus;
(l) the terms of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme; and
(m) the terms of the 2023 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme.
3. DOCUMENTS A V AILABLE FOR INSPECTION
A copy of a list of grantees under each of the 2021 Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme and the 2023
Pre-IPO Share Option Scheme, containing all details as required under the Listing Rules and the
Companies (Winding Up and Miscellaneous Provisions) Ordinance, will be available for inspection at the
offices of Fangda Partners at 26/F, One Exchange Square, 8 Connaught Road, Central, Hong Kong during
normal business hours up to and including the date which is 14 days from the date of this prospectus.
APPENDIX V DOCUMENTS DELIVERED TO THE REGISTRAR OF
COMPANIES IN HONG KONG AND ON DISPLAY
—V - 2—


--- page 598 ---
全球發售
股份代號 : 2268
（ 於開曼群島註冊成立的有限公司）
WuXi XDC Cayman Inc.
藥明合聯生物技術有限公司
*
WuXi XDC Cayman Inc.
藥明合聯生物技術有限公司
*
* 僅供識別
聯席保薦人、整體協調人、聯席全球協調人 、聯席賬簿管理人及聯席牽頭經辦人
聯席全球協調人 、聯席賬簿管理人及聯席牽頭經辦人
 ( 按字母順序 )
